summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes4
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/51746-0.txt12746
-rw-r--r--old/51746-0.zipbin254809 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h.zipbin1468916 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/51746-h.htm14664
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/cover.jpgbin25585 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/fr.jpgbin42705 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-005.jpgbin49098 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-032.jpgbin42104 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-033.jpgbin41610 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-037.jpgbin43798 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-083.jpgbin30398 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-096.jpgbin49413 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-097.jpgbin60237 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-105.jpgbin52446 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-128.jpgbin50710 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-129.jpgbin90859 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-131.jpgbin41726 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-160.jpgbin64081 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-161.jpgbin59641 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-161a.jpgbin47700 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-183.jpgbin48292 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-191.jpgbin41861 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-192.jpgbin28844 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-193.jpgbin29223 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-224.jpgbin41674 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-225.jpgbin51304 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-256.jpgbin52398 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-257a.jpgbin35025 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-257b.jpgbin14524 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-285.jpgbin18822 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-297.jpgbin46743 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/51746-h/images/ill-311.jpgbin28664 -> 0 bytes
35 files changed, 17 insertions, 27410 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d7b82bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+*.txt text eol=lf
+*.htm text eol=lf
+*.html text eol=lf
+*.md text eol=lf
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c2e14f6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #51746 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/51746)
diff --git a/old/51746-0.txt b/old/51746-0.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 37df1c4..0000000
--- a/old/51746-0.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,12746 +0,0 @@
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of My Reminiscences of East Africa, by
-General von Lettow-Vorbeck
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-Title: My Reminiscences of East Africa
-
-Author: General von Lettow-Vorbeck
-
-Release Date: April 12, 2016 [EBook #51746]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK MY REMINISCENCES OF EAST AFRICA ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Giovanni Fini, Brian Coe and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive/Canadian Libraries)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
- TRANSCRIBER’S NOTES:
-
-—Obvious print and punctuation errors were corrected.
-
-
-
-
- _My Reminiscences of East Africa_
-
-[Illustration: General von Lettow-Vorbeck.]
-
-
-
-
- _MY REMINISCENCES
- OF EAST AFRICA_
-
- _By General von Lettow-Vorbeck_
-
-
- _With Portrait, 22 Maps and Sketch-Maps,
- ∷ ∷ and 13 Drawings ∷ ∷
- By General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant_
-
-
- _LONDON: HURST AND BLACKETT, LTD.
- PATERNOSTER HOUSE, E.C._
-
-
-
-
-PREFACE
-
-
-IN all the German colonies, though but a few decades old, a life
-full of promise was discernible. We were beginning to understand the
-national value of our colonial possessions; settlers and capital were
-venturing in; industries and factories were beginning to flourish.
-Compared with that of other nations, the colonizing process of Germany
-had progressed peacefully and steadily, and the inhabitants had
-confidence in the justice of German administration. This development
-had barely commenced when it was destroyed by the world war. In spite
-of all tangible proofs to the contrary, an unjustifiable campaign of
-falsehood is being conducted in order to make the world believe that
-the Germans lacked colonizing talent and were cruel to the natives.
-
-A small force, mainly composed of these very natives, opposed this
-development. Almost without any external means of coercion, even
-without immediate payment, this force, with its numerous native
-followers, faithfully followed its German leaders throughout the whole
-of the prolonged war against a more than hundredfold superiority. When
-the armistice came it was still fit to fight, and imbued with the best
-soldierly spirit. That is a fact which cannot be controverted, and is
-in itself a sufficient answer to the hostile mis-statements.
-
-It has not been possible for me to give an exhaustive account of the
-operations of the German East African Protective Force. The existing
-material is insufficient, much has been lost, and even now I am
-unacquainted with various events, the actors in which have not yet
-returned home. My own records have for the most part been lost, and I
-had not the leisure to prepare a detailed description of the campaign
-in East Africa in addition to my other duties. My account is therefore
-necessarily incomplete. In the main I must rely upon my memory and on
-my personal experiences. Errors in detail are unavoidable.
-
-But in spite of this, the following account may not be without value,
-nor perhaps without interest, since it shows how what is up to the
-present the greatest drama in our colonial history was enacted in
-the head of him who was destined to conduct the military side of it.
-I have endeavoured to set down my recollections of East Africa as
-they actually are, and thus at least to present what is subjectively
-correct.
-
-
-
-
-CONTENTS
-
-
- PART I
-
- EVENTS PREVIOUS TO THE ARRIVAL OF THE SOUTH AFRICANS
-
- PAGE
-
- CHAPTER I.: BEFORE THE OUTBREAK OF WAR 3
-
- Reflections on the duties and purpose of the Protective Force.
- Details of the defensive capacity of the Colony. Distribution,
- armament and training of the Force. Military employment
- and mental attitude of the natives. Economic value of the
- country, and furtherance of the economic power of the natives.
- Horse-breeding and hunting. Several tours of inspection.
- National propaganda on the part of subsequently hostile
- Missions in the neighbouring territories.
-
- CHAPTER II.: THE BEGINNING OF THE WAR 18
-
- Arrival of news of mobilization. Participation in the war
- or neutrality? The strength of the Protective Force and the
- English casualties. The English Consul and his activity. The
- Governor of the Colony, the supreme military authority, and the
- defence of the coastal towns. Preparations for mobilization.
- Lines of communication, maintenance and supplies. Sanitation.
- Malaria.
-
- CHAPTER III.: THE FIRST ACTIONS 27
-
- Bombardment of the wireless tower at Dar-es-Salaam.
- Negotiations for capitulation by the civil authorities. The
- _Königsberg_ and the _Möve_. Capture of Taveta. Transfer
- of the main body to the Northern Railway. New telegraphic
- communications. Bombardment of Bagamoyo. Attack on the British
- Uganda Railway. Attacks on British Karunga on Lake Nyassa.
- Guerilla warfare in the North.
-
- CHAPTER IV.: THE NOVEMBER ACTIONS AT TANGA 35
-
- Reconnaissances at Tanga. Appearance of an English landing
- corps. Concentration of all available troops. First combats at
- Ras-Kasone. Reconnaissance in abandoned Tanga. The surroundings
- of the probable field of battle. Disposition of the companies.
- The hostile landing. The attack. Unfavourable situation of
- the defenders. Counter-attack by the reinforcements. Headlong
- flight of the enemy. Failure of the pursuit. Harassing the
- enemy at the landing-place. Enormous English losses. The
- trained bees. Negotiations for release of the wounded. Great
- booty. Our own losses. In the hospitals. Simultaneous events at
- Longido Mountain.
-
- CHAPTER V.: AWAITING FURTHER EVENTS 49
-
- Withdrawal of the troops to New Moshi. Work at Headquarters.
- Motor transport _versus_ carriers. Reconnaissances by motor.
- Supply and transport. Roads on the lines of communication. The
- burden of work and the joy of work. Abundant supplies. The
- starving Lieutenant. The joys of Sunday sport. Meat supply for
- the troops.
-
- CHAPTER VI.: FURTHER HEAVY FIGHTING IN THE NORTH-EAST 56
-
- Advance of hostile forces at Jassini. Reconnaissance in view of
- a possible battle. Advance of the German Companies against the
- English positions. Surprise and surrounding of the entrenched
- enemy. Bad fighting of the Arab Corps. Gallant defence by the
- enemy. Difficult situation of the attackers. The enemy hoists
- the white flag.
-
- CHAPTER VII.: GUERILLA WARFARE AND FURTHER PREPARATIONS 63
-
- Necessity for economizing men and stores. Care of the wounded.
- A wireless message from home. Raids in the Longido district.
- “A damned good piece of work.” Despatch of patrols to destroy
- the railway. Suffering and death in the steppe. Arrival of a
- relief ship. Feverish manufacture of ammunition. An advance
- near Oldorobo Mountain. Abundance of raw material and lack
- of finished articles. New industries to supply our needs.
- Roadmaking. Increase in numbers and fighting value of the
- troops.
-
- CHAPTER VIII.: AWAITING THE GREAT OFFENSIVE. ENERGETIC USE OF
- THE TIME AVAILABLE 73
-
- CHAPTER IX.: THE SUBSIDIARY THEATRES OF WAR. GUERILLA WARFARE
- ASHORE AND AFLOAT UNTIL NEW YEAR, 1916 82
-
- Hostile Masai attack on Lake Victoria. The _Königsberg_ on the
- Rufiji. Her glorious end. Another success near Kilimandjaro.
- Determined attacks on the English railway. Attack and
- occupation of the English Camp on Kasigao Mountain. The enemy’s
- measures for protecting the railway. Fighting in the bush.
- Consideration of the possibility of resisting an attack by
- large hostile forces. Preparations for retiring to the South.
- Removal of stores. Determined defence of the position on
- Oldorobo Mountain. The new _Mungu_.
-
-
- PART II
-
- THE CONCENTRIC ATTACK BY SUPERIOR FORCES
-
- (From the arrival of the South African Troops to the loss of
- the Colony)
-
- CHAPTER I.: THE ENEMY’S ATTACK AT OLDOROBO MOUNTAIN 103
-
- Several advances by the enemy. The fantastic armoured cars.
- The artillery combat. The South African troops. Alleged cruel
- orders by the enemy. Reinforcement of the enemy near Mount
- Longido. Fight with an Indian patrol. Chivalry of the white
- officers. Our brave Askari and the misleading of the English.
-
- CHAPTER II.: FURTHER ADVANCE OF THE ENEMY AND THE ACTION AT
- REATA 108
-
- Spies at work. The routes of the enemy’s advance. Possibilities
- of defence. The enemy attacks at Kitovo Mountain. The strong
- position on the line Reata-Kitovo. The _Königsberg’s_ gun.
- Reconnaissance by hostile cavalry. The enemy’s attack and
- attempt to surround us. Occupation of new defensive positions.
- The enemy’s withdrawal to Taveta. After the battle. Renewed
- forward movement by the enemy. Headquarters at Neusteglitz. A
- second relief ship.
-
- CHAPTER III.: RETREAT BEFORE OVERWHELMING HOSTILE PRESSURE 119
-
- Plans and considerations. Active attempts at reconnaissance by
- the enemy. Preparations for fighting. An attack on the hostile
- screen of patrols. Heavy losses. Fresh heavy attacks by the
- enemy (21st March). Failure of the counter-attack. An alarmist
- report: the enemy behind us. Retreat to Kissangire. The
- alarmist report proves to be false. Good spirits of the troops.
- Condition of the civilian population. Combat and surrender
- of the 28th Company at Lokisale (5th April). Bringing up
- auxiliaries. Concentration of the troops on the Central Railway.
-
- CHAPTER IV.: THE ENEMY’S ADVANCE IN THE AREA OF THE NORTHERN
- RAILWAY 129
-
- Departure for Korogwe. At Handeni. News from Germany. Obstacles
- on the road. The swollen river. On horseback and by light
- railway to Kimamba. Reconnaissance south of Kondoa. Lines of
- communication and commissariat. In touch with the enemy. In
- position. The enemy seems to be evacuating his positions. An
- unexpected fight in the night. Our heavy losses. Successful
- patrols. Artillery duels. Obtaining supplies from the country.
- Failure of an attack by the enemy.
-
- CHAPTER V.: BETWEEN THE NORTHERN AND CENTRAL RAILWAYS 140
-
- The enemy advances on the whole northern front. Simultaneous
- attacks from the South. Slipping away and outflanking the
- enemy. Looking for the enemy’s weakest point. The smart patrol
- leader. The enemy’s aerial activity increases. Further advance
- to the South by General van Deventer. Weak German forces
- resist on a long line. Fighting near the Central Railway.
- Reconnaissances. Heavy fighting with the advancing enemy. On
- the Wami River.
-
- CHAPTER VI.: CONTINUOUS FIGHTING NEAR THE RUFIJI 149
-
- Hostile attacks from the south-west. What will the enemy do?
- An attempt to surround us. The action at Mlali. Retreat to
- Kissaki. The moral effect of our retreat. The Boma of Kissaki.
- Securing our cattle supply. Defeat of the enemy on the 7th
- September. Annihilation of another hostile detachment. German
- humanity—English gratitude. A surprise attack at Dutumi (9th
- September). Dutumi must be abandoned.
-
- CHAPTER VII.: HOSTILE ATTACKS IN THE SOUTH-EAST OF THE COLONY 159
-
- Our unfavourable position at Kilwa. Futile attacks by the
- enemy at Kissangire. Fat obtained from hippo and elephants.
- At Mpaganya. A pessimist sent about his business. Advance on
- Kissangire. The lost patrol. Successes at Kissangire. The
- Portuguese defeated at Newala. In Utete Camp. In a strong
- position at Kibata. Artillery preparations. Effect of heavy
- shell. An unsuccessful infantry attack. The military situation
- at the end of 1916. Powerful enemy attacks at Dutumi and
- Kissaki. The enemy fails to get behind us.
-
- CHAPTER VIII.: ANXIETIES AND HARDSHIPS DURING OUR STAY IN THE
- RUFIJI COUNTRY 173
-
- The march through the Pori. Camp at Ungwara. The troops lose
- their way. Useless mouths. Steps to remedy the threatening
- shortage of food. Reduction in the number of carriers.
- Reduction of rations. Obstruction. The Askari women. Maize our
- help in trouble. A supply branch of the commissariat. Minor
- actions in the bush at Ungwara. The commencement of the rains.
- Measures for the protection of women and children. The troops
- continue their march to the South.
-
- CHAPTER IX.: THE END OF THE FRONTIER DEFENCE IN THE SUBSIDIARY
- THEATRES 182
-
- On the Ruhuje and Ruaha Rivers. A hostile attack and its sudden
- cessation. The enemy’s mistake. Surrender of Major Grabert.
- Division of General Wahle’s force. The march to Tabora.
- Back to Kilima Njaro. Major Kraut’s march to the Rovuma.
- Supply difficulties and plans for the future. In the rich
- Portuguese territory. Patrols towards Kilva. A heavy defeat
- of the enemy. Experiments with bread-substitute. Primitive
- boots. The crowing cocks. Salt, fat and sugar. The medical
- service. “Lettow-Schnaps.” Bandages. Operations with primitive
- appliances.
-
- CHAPTER X.: LINDI AND KILWA 190
-
- Hostile reinforcements from the direction of Lindi. Flood of
- the Mbemkuru. German advance on Lindi. The enemy penetrates
- into the German camp at Lutende. A smart counter-attack.
- Further minor actions near Ulindi. We march off to the North.
- At Narungombe. Another victory. Too late! Enemy spies under
- the white flag. An Imperial greeting from home. The attack at
- Narunyu. The bomb in the dentist’s study. Removal of women and
- children to Lindi.
-
- CHAPTER XI.: IN THE SOUTH-EAST CORNER OF THE COLONY 207
-
- Concentric advance of the enemy. At Ruponda and Likangara. The
- enemy’s uncertainty. Rumours. Action at Mahiva. A brilliant
- victory. Changing the plan of attack. The tactics of the enemy
- commander. The end of the battle. Losses and booty. Another
- action at Lukuledi. Guerilla warfare.
-
- CHAPTER XII.: THE LAST WEEKS IN GERMAN TERRITORY 216
-
- Consultation with the Governor. Considerations. Departure from
- Lukuledi. Minor actions in the bush. Shortage of ammunition
- and its consequences. Continuous advance of the enemy to
- Chivata. We avoid the blow by moving to Nambindinga. Schemes
- for voluntarily restricting the strength of the troops. On
- the Makonde Plateau. Shortage of water and food. Whither?
- Reorganization of the Force at Newala. The hostile patrol and
- its letter. At them! Out of sight of the enemy.
-
-
- PART III
-
- FIGHTING ON FOREIGN SOIL
-
- (From the Crossing into Portuguese East Africa to the Armistice)
-
- CHAPTER I.: ACROSS THE ROVUMA 229
-
- Crossing the river. The enemy’s camp at Ngomano. Assault on the
- Portuguese defences. The “Day of the old guns.” Rich booty.
- Continuing the march up the Lujenda. Looking for supplies.
- A transparent offer by the enemy. News of the surrender of
- Captain Tafel. Partition of the Force. Difficulties and
- unpleasantness. Capture of several Portuguese camps. Heroic
- action of Lieutenant Kempner. At Nangvare. Buffalo fat and
- forest fruits. Abundant supplies at Chirumba. Patrols. Approach
- of the enemy. Skirmishes. Enemy propaganda. Fresh courage and
- confidence.
-
- CHAPTER II.: EAST OF THE LUDJENDA 245
-
- Supply questions. In the rain. Tobacco. At Nanungu. Building
- pontoons. Patrols across the Msalu River. News of events in
- Europe. A pause in the fighting. Patrols to the coast. The
- precious Pori-pig. A new hostile deployment. The patriotic
- English. Defeat of the enemy at Mahue. Continual skirmishes.
- Against the enemy at Kireka Mountain. An action in the bush.
- A wrong report and its consequences. Casualties on both sides
- in the last actions. Captain Koehl’s successes. Continuation
- of the march to Koroma Mountain. A surprise. The Governor in
- danger. Unpleasant losses.
-
- CHAPTER III.: IN THE REGION OF THE LURIO AND LIKUNGO RIVERS 259
-
- On the road to Keriva. The sick and wounded. Camp on the Lurio.
- Müller’s detachment captures the Boma of Malema. Hostile
- forces approach from various sides. In a rich country. General
- Edwards’ precautions. Fighting in the bush. The march continued
- to Alto Moloque. The Orange-Boma. Continuous fighting by
- patrols. Nampepo Station and other settlements. On the Likunga
- River. Rich booty. The natives’ powers of estimation.
-
- CHAPTER IV.: ON TO THE SOUTH 270
-
- Where is the enemy’s ammunition dump? Looking for it.
- Awkwardness of long columns. Kokosani-Namekurra. Across the
- Lukungo. A success. At Namekurra. The fortified railway
- station. Artillery preparations and assault. Flight of enemy
- across the Namacurra River. The casualties on both sides.
- Extraordinary quantities of supplies and ammunition captured.
-
- CHAPTER V.: BACK NORTH TO THE NAMACURRA RIVER 278
-
- Obstacles in the way of continuing the march to the South.
- The enemy’s operations and our own plans. Back across the
- Likungo. Marching in several parallel columns. A remarkable
- military situation. Looking for booty. At Ociva. The English
- and Portuguese prisoners. Capture of the Boma of Tipa. March
- to Namirrue. Reconnaissance of enemy’s position on the rocky
- mountain. Another enemy appears. Victorious battle with him at
- night. Confusion of the enemy’s columns. Fruitless pursuit of
- the fleeing enemy. The trench mortar and its effect. Assault of
- the rocky mountain. We march away to Pekera. Rest in the camp
- at Chalau.
-
- CHAPTER VI.: BACK TO THE LURIO RIVER 289
-
- At Chalau. An English flag of truce. Approach of the enemy.
- Withdrawal across the Ligonja. At Ili. March to Numarroe.
- Preparing bread for the prisoners. A breakfast in the bush.
- Boma of Numarroe. Success of Goering’s detachment. Capture of
- the Boma. Casualties on both sides. On over the mountains to
- Rigona. Skirmishes. What next? Heavy fighting at Lioma. Heavy
- losses. No prospect of greater success. On to the North.
- Confusion of the detachments. A difficult march through the
- mountains. On the Lurio. Bad health of the troops. Heavy
- casualties on both sides. The influenza epidemic.
-
- CHAPTER VII.: ON GERMAN SOIL ONCE MORE 303
-
- Rapid march to the North. Across the Lujenda. A rest-day at
- Mwemba. Hostile spies. Distant reconnaissance by patrols.
- To Ssongea. Homesickness of the Samarunga. Pangire Mission
- Station. Change of direction. Grave news from Europe. At Mbozi
- Mission Station. Patrol reports.
-
- CHAPTER VIII.: THE ADVANCE INTO BRITISH RHODESIA 309
-
- On the march to Fife. The enemy in a fortified position.
- Fruitless bombardment and continuation of the march. Patrol
- fighting. Abundant supply of quinine captured. Studying the
- map. By forced marches into Rhodesia. Kajambi Mission Station
- and its frightened inhabitants. Capture of Kasawa. Natives
- pillaging by order of the English. On towards the Zambesi.
-
- CHAPTER IX.: THE ARMISTICE AND OUR RETURN HOME 315
-
- The lost English motor-cyclist. Armistice. By cycle to the
- Chambezi ferry. Conditions of the Armistice. Conference with
- the British Commissioner. Situation in Germany. The Armistice
- and the situation of our troops. Release of the prisoners.
- Difficulties in paying off the Askari. March to Abercorn.
- “Surrender” and “Evacuation.” With General Edwards. Handing
- over arms. Fruitless opposition to English interpretation of
- agreement. By ship to Kigoma. Belgian hospitality. By rail to
- Dar-es-Salaam. Internment. Influenza and its victims. The loyal
- Askari. Endeavours to protect private property. Embarkation for
- home. At Rotterdam and at home. Retrospect and a glance at the
- future.
-
-
-
-
-LIST OF MAPS
-
- PAGE
-
- Figs. i. and iii. Kilima Njaro 5
-
- Fig. ii. German East Africa. The Central Railway 5
-
- Fig. iv. Battle of Tanga 37
-
- Fig. v. The Northern Railway 37
-
- Fig. vi. Subsidiary Actions up to August, 1916 83
-
- Fig. vii. Battle of Yasin (Jassini) 105
-
- Fig. viii. Kilima Njaro and Masai Desert 105
-
- Fig. ix. Battle of Reata 105
-
- Fig. x. Battle of Kahe 105
-
- Fig. xi. Invasion of German East Africa by Belgian and British
- columns, middle of 1916 131
-
- Fig. xii. Retreat of German Main Force, August, 1916 131
-
- Fig. xiii. Battles of Kissaki and Dutumi 161
-
- Fig. xiv. March of German Main Force, September, 1916, to
- June, 1917 161
-
- Fig. xv. March of Major-General Wahle in the West 183
-
- Fig. xvi. March of Main Force during operations on interior
- lines west of Lindi, June to November, 1917 191
-
- Fig. xvii. Battle of Mahiwa 191
-
- Fig. xviii. The Action at the Kireka Mountains 257
-
- Fig. xix. The Action at Namirrue, July 23rd, 1918 285
-
- Fig. xx. Through Portuguese East Africa 297
-
- Fig. xxi. The March into Rhodesia 311
-
-
-
-
-LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS
-
-
- General von Lettow-Vorbeck _Frontispiece_
-
- General Map _Facing p._ 32
-
- The Fallen ” 33
-
- Native Women ” 96
-
- Natives Bringing Food ” 97
-
- Masai ” 128
-
- European Dinner-time ” 129
-
- Askari. A Halt ” 160
-
- The Banyan Tree ” 161
-
- Native Types (1) ” 192
-
- Native Types (2) ” 193
-
- Native Types (3) ” 224
-
- Native Types (4) ” 225
-
- Native Types (5) ” 256
-
- Native Types (6) ” 257
-
-
-
-
-PART I
-
-EVENTS PREVIOUS TO THE ARRIVAL OF THE SOUTH AFRICANS
-
-
-
-
-My Reminiscences of East Africa
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER I
-
-BEFORE THE OUTBREAK OF WAR
-
-
-WHEN I landed at Dar-es-Salaam in January, 1914, I hardly suspected
-the nature of the task that was to confront me in a few months’ time.
-But during the past ten years the universal war had more than once
-seemed so imminent that I was obliged seriously to consider whether the
-force under my command would be called upon to take any part in that
-conflict, and, if so, what its task might be. Owing to the position
-of the Colony and the weakness of the existing forces—the peace
-establishment was but little more than two thousand—we could only play
-a subsidiary part. I knew that the fate of the colonies, as of all
-other German possessions, would only be decided on the battlefields of
-Europe. To this decision every German, regardless of where he might be
-at the moment, must contribute his share. In the Colony also it was our
-duty, in case of universal war, to do all in our power for our country.
-The question was whether it was possible for us in our subsidiary
-theatre of war to exercise any influence on the great decision at
-home. Could we, with our small forces, prevent considerable numbers
-of the enemy from intervening in Europe, or in other more important
-theatres, or inflict on our enemies any loss of personnel or war
-material worth mentioning? At that time I answered this question in the
-affirmative. It is true, however, that I did not succeed in interesting
-all authorities in this idea to such an extent as to cause all
-preparations which a war of this kind rendered desirable to be carried
-out.
-
-It was to be considered that hostile troops would allow themselves to
-be held only if we attacked, or at least threatened, the enemy at some
-really sensitive point. It was further to be remembered that, with
-the means available, protection of the Colony could not be ensured
-even by purely defensive tactics, since the total length of land
-frontier and coast-line was about equal to that of Germany. From these
-considerations it followed that it was necessary, not to split up our
-small available forces in local defence, but, on the contrary, to keep
-them together, to grip the enemy by the throat and force him to employ
-his forces for self-defence. If this idea could be successfully carried
-out, we should at the same time protect our coast and our infinitely
-long land frontier in the most effective manner.
-
-In examining the question where to find a point so vital to the enemy
-as to afford us the prospect of a successful attack, or, at any rate,
-of a threat of such an attack, one thought at once of the frontier
-between German and British East Africa. Parallel with it, at a distance
-of a few marches, runs the main artery of the British territory, the
-Uganda Railway, an object which, with a length of quite 440 miles, was
-extremely difficult for the enemy to protect, and would, therefore,
-if effectively threatened, require a large part of his troops for the
-purpose.
-
-[Illustration: Fig i. and iii. Kilima Njaro.
-
-Fig. ii. German East Africa. The Central Railway.]
-
-On my first journey of reconnaissance and inspection, commenced in
-January, 1914, I went by sea from Dar-es-Salaam to Tanga, thence to
-Usambara, and then on into the country round Kilima Njaro and Meru
-Mountain. At Usambara I met an old friend whom I had known well
-since our military college days (_Kriegschule_), Captain von Prince
-(retired). He was an enthusiastic supporter of the idea that, in
-case of a war with England, we East Africans should not remain idle
-spectators, but should take a hand if there should be even a trace of a
-prospect of relieving the pressure in Europe. At the same time, he was
-in a position to inform me that in the Usambara country, round Kilima
-Njaro, and near Meru Mountain, Volunteer Rifle Corps were being formed,
-which in a short time would probably include all the Germans capable of
-bearing arms in these northern territories. In view of the density of
-the settlements in those parts, this was a fact of great importance.
-The main contingent of the three thousand Europeans whom we were able
-to enrol in the Protective Force during the course of the war was
-furnished from these very territories lying along the Usambara Railway.
-It was, indeed, difficult to introduce a workable military organization
-among these voluntary associations, and to make effective use of their
-abundant good will. Still, it was, on the whole, successfully arranged
-that all, even those not legally obliged to do so, should be ready
-in case of war to act under the orders of the Protective Force. The
-District Commissioners also manifested the greatest sympathy; but they
-also expressed the, unfortunately well-founded, doubt whether, in a
-universal war which could certainly cut us off completely from the home
-country and leave us to our own resources, such voluntary organizations
-would possess the requisite cohesion. The armament was also in a bad
-way; although almost every European possessed a useful sporting rifle,
-the variety of patterns and the consequent difficulty of ammunition
-supply had not yet been remedied. The proposals for arming these rifle
-clubs with a uniform military weapon were still pending, and remained
-undecided until the outbreak of war.
-
-At Wilhelmstal I found a detachment of native police under an efficient
-sergeant-major, who came from Ditmarschen. Whereas the Protective
-Force proper was under the Commandant, the various police detachments
-were under the civil authorities, and so each District Commissioner
-had under his orders a detachment of one hundred to two hundred men,
-for the purpose of collecting taxes and supporting his authority.
-There prevailed a constant tendency to increase this police force more
-and more, to the detriment of the Protective Force. In this manner,
-alongside of the latter, a second force of the same strength had come
-into being which was in its very nature a travesty of a military
-organization, and could hardly be anything better. The District
-Commissioner, a civil official, often understood little of military
-matters, and handed over the training and command of his Police-Askari
-to a sergeant-major of police. The latter often worked zealously,
-with the old non-commissioned officer’s usual devotion to duty; but
-he seldom received any guidance from a military superior, since the
-police inspector, an officer, could only visit each district from time
-to time. So the Police-Askari often became slack, and lacked the strict
-discipline necessary to keep them fit for their duties, which demanded
-reliability. To this was added a further defect which ought to have
-been avoided. The police were partly recruited from the native N.C.O.’s
-of the Protective Force. The latter was thereby deprived of its best
-elements, who, after joining the police, lost their good military
-qualities. This, of course, did not obtain in all cases. But, generally
-speaking, it was the case that, in order to obtain a police force of
-inferior military value which in the circumstances could never be of
-any real use, the quality of the Protective Force was steadily impaired.
-
-From New Moshi, the terminus of the Usambara Railway, I proceeded via
-Marangu, where an English planter lived and where I met the English
-Consul King, of Dar-es-Salaam, to the Kilima Njaro country, and thence
-to Arusha. Several German planters, some of them former officers, whom
-I visited at their estates during the march, assured me that the German
-settlers in those parts formed a valuable source of military power.
-
-At that time I made the acquaintance of the charming estate of
-Commander Niemeyer (retired), whose wife entertained us with excellent
-home-grown coffee. Later on she rather hindered us on one occasion:
-when, during the war, her husband was in Engara-Nairobi Camp,
-north-west of Kilima Njaro, we had temporarily lent her a telephone,
-so that she could call up her husband. Immediately afterwards the
-whole telephone service stopped, and after a long, long search, we at
-last discovered that our kind former hostess had not switched off her
-instrument and displayed no intention of doing so.
-
-Close by was the plantation of Lieutenant-Commander Schoenfeld
-(retired), who hospitably offered us a glass of very fine Moselle
-wine, and did so with a military tone like a word of command which
-even then characterized him as the energetic leader who was later to
-defend the mouth of the Rufiji River against a superior enemy with such
-stubbornness. Just short of Arusha we came to the coffee-plantation
-of my old brother-cadet Freiherr von Ledebur, where at table I met
-the charming old retired Lieutenant-Colonel Freiherr von Bock. We
-talked about the Volunteer Rifle Corps which were being formed near
-Meru Mountain, and I did not dream that a few months later this old
-gentleman of over sixty would be one of our toughest patrol leaders
-on the east side of Kilima Njaro, and would often with his few men,
-who were mostly recruits, successfully engage several companies of the
-enemy. His true chivalry and fatherly care soon won him the hearts of
-his black comrades, to such a degree that he was in their eyes the
-bravest of all Germans, and they clung to him with touching loyalty.
-
-At Arusha the first inspection of a company of Askari was held.
-The spirit and discipline of the black unit revealed the admirable
-education they had received at the hands of my predecessor, Colonel
-Freiherr von Schleuntz; but, in accordance with the hitherto accepted
-principles of their employment, their training for fighting against
-an enemy with modern armament had been developed to a lesser degree.
-Like the majority of the Askari companies, this company was still armed
-with the old 1871 pattern rifle, using smoky powder. The opinion was
-widely held that for black troops this was more suitable than a modern
-rifle with smokeless powder, for they had hitherto never been employed
-against an opponent with modern armament, but only in native warfare,
-where the larger calibre is an advantage, while the disadvantage of
-smoke is of no consequence. After the outbreak of war, indeed, the
-enthusiastic supporters of the 1871 rifle changed their minds. Against
-an enemy provided with modern smokeless equipment the smoky rifle was,
-not only at the long ranges obtaining in the open plain, but also in
-bush-fighting, where the combatants are often but a few paces apart,
-decidedly inferior. The man using smokeless powder remains invisible,
-while the cloud of smoke betrays the enemy with rapidity and certainty,
-not only to the sharp eye of the native Askari, but even to the
-European accustomed to office work. Thus, at the beginning of the war,
-the greatest reward which could be earned by an Askari was to give him
-a modern captured rifle in place of his old smoky one.
-
-In distributing the force by companies throughout the country it had
-been necessary to accept the disadvantage that in many cases it was
-impossible to employ them in large formations, or to train the senior
-officers in this respect. It was evident that in war the movement and
-leading in battle of forces greater than a company would be attended
-with great difficulty and friction. According to my view, the force
-had the double duty of preparing to meet an enemy from outside with
-modern armament, as well as a native enemy within our borders; their
-training for battle had therefore to take account of two distinct sets
-of conditions. The exercises in native warfare presented a spectacle
-which differed widely from our European inspections. At Arusha, on this
-occasion, the company marched through thick bush, the “Pori,” and was
-in native fashion surprised on the march. The enemy was represented
-by Meru warriors, who, arrayed in full war-dress, with spears and
-head-dress of ostrich feathers, remained concealed, and then at only
-a few paces distance fell upon the Safari, the column of route, with
-loud war cries. A fight at such close quarters, like the one in which
-Zelewski’s expedition had been overwhelmed in 1891 at Iringa, is
-decided at short range and in a very few minutes. The troops quickly
-rally round their leaders and rush the enemy. In accordance with this
-whole character of native warfare, careful and thorough musketry
-training in the modern sense had hitherto been unnecessary. It was,
-indeed, at a pretty low level, and it may interest the soldier to
-hear that in some companies the average at two hundred yards standing
-without rest barely attained Ring 3, and that only a few companies
-got beyond Ring 5. Neither did the nature of native warfare provide
-a sufficient inducement for thorough training with the machine gun.
-Fortunately, however, I soon discovered among all Europeans of the
-force a complete understanding of the importance of this arm, in
-particular in modern battle. In spite of this not particularly high
-standard of training, the results of field-firing, even at long ranges,
-were not unsatisfactory, and in this the Askari profited in a high
-degree by his sharp eyesight, which enabled him to observe his fire and
-correct his aim accordingly.
-
-The journey was continued via Ufiome Mission, where the excellent
-Father Dürr was settled, to Kondoa-Irangi, Kilimatinde and back to
-Dar-es-Salaam. The impression left by this first inspection was that
-from a military point of view there was still a great deal to be done
-if we wished to be properly prepared in case the English should make
-war on us. Unfortunately I did not succeed in arousing sufficient
-interest in the matter on the part of the authorities. The ruling
-opinion was that we were on exceptionally good terms with the English,
-and that a war, if it came at all, was still in the distant future.
-Thus it happened that when war actually did break out but a few months
-later we were unprepared.
-
-For me, a new-comer in East Africa, the journey had not only been of
-military interest. At Boma la Ngombe, a place between Moshi and Arusha,
-a number of old Askari had been settled by the late Lieutenant-Colonel
-Johannes; they were mainly engaged in cattle-dealing, and had become
-well-to-do. The news of my coming had preceded me, and the people
-appeared in full strength to greet me on my arrival. I had the
-impression that this was not a mere show of loyalty; the people not
-only told me enthusiastically of Germans under whom they had previously
-served, but after the outbreak of war, unasked and without the
-slightest pressure, they placed a large sum of money at our disposal to
-help the force. In that district I also saw the first Masai, who, in
-contrast to the majority of the East African tribes, are pure Hamites,
-and live in a special reservation. It may be mentioned that Merker,
-the best authority on the Masai,[1] considers them to be the original
-Jews. They possess to a marked degree the characteristics of the pure
-inhabitant of the prairie. Occasionally, one of these tall, slim,
-and very swift men acted as my guide on hunting expeditions; their
-vision and skill as trackers are astonishing. In addition, the Masai
-is intelligent, and, at any rate towards strangers, an extraordinary
-liar. He lives in closed villages of mud huts, and, like all nomads,
-wanders with his herds over the prairie. He seldom enlists in the
-force. In agriculture the Masai engages hardly at all, whereas among
-the other tribes this forms the chief occupation and is a necessary
-condition for close settlement. Thus the banana districts on the
-eastern slopes of Kilima Njaro support a native Wajagga population
-of some twenty-five thousand souls, and this number could easily be
-increased. The great wealth of cattle in the neighbourhood of Arusha,
-on the Masai prairie, and near Kondoa-Irangi, showed me that the
-tse-tse fly, the principal enemy of African cattle, is comparatively
-rare in those parts. As a comparison, I may state that the cattle in
-the single district of Arusha are estimated to be more numerous than
-in the whole of South-West Africa. At Kondoa-Irangi and Singida the
-people had come from a great distance, and had lined the road to greet
-me. No traveller who visits these countries can fail to observe that
-in the fertile, elevated interior there is room for the settlement of
-hundreds of thousands of Europeans. Here I would like to record an
-impression which I only obtained later, during the war. At times we
-passed through fertile districts which were completely forsaken by the
-inhabitants, but which were known not to have been occupied even in the
-previous year. They had simply moved away, had settled somewhere else
-in the abundantly available, empty and fertile country, and had there
-begun to cultivate fresh fields. If the country capable of cultivation
-were fully utilized, it would probably be possible to support in German
-East Africa, which has hitherto been inhabited by about eight millions
-only, a population barely less than that of Germany. An Englishman
-captured during the war at Mahenge remarked that it would be possible
-to make East Africa into a second India, and I think he was right.
-My experience in the war has confirmed my opinion that there exist
-many possibilities of economic development, of which we had hardly an
-inkling before the war.
-
-At Singida I saw one of the stud-farms of the country. For breeding
-purposes there were two horse stallions, no mares, a few Muscat donkey
-stallions, and mainly country-bred donkey mares. Of the objects it was
-sought to attain I could get no clear idea; in any case, the crossing
-of horse stallions and donkey mares had produced no results. But the
-district is extraordinarily suitable for horse-breeding, and the
-Government Veterinary Officer Hiffmeister, who was stationed there,
-was very inclined to settle in the country as a private farmer and
-horse-breeder. Similar stud-farms existed at Kilimatinde, Iringa and
-Ubena. From Singida to Kilimatinde I followed the Mpondi River; the
-sportsman will be interested to know that this is the district in which
-the best buffaloes in East Africa are said to be found. A few days
-before I had successfully hunted buffalo, but I had not succeeded in
-getting a shot at a powerful bull, and so, as far as time permitted,
-I was out for buffalo. Besides a native boy, I had as trackers two
-excellent Askari of the Konda Company. As soon as I arrived in camp at
-the end of a march and dismounted from my mule, I would ask Kadunda,
-one of these Askari, who had done the march on foot, whether he was
-ready to hunt. He always agreed with the greatest enthusiasm, and
-away we went through the bush, which was sometimes so dense that
-one had to crawl under the branches in order to get through at all.
-For the European not yet accustomed to the African climate it is
-extraordinarily fatiguing to follow a trail through dense bush and high
-grass reaching over one’s head for hours on end in the blazing sun. The
-wounded buffalo is considered to be the most dangerous game in East
-Africa; he often charges at once with great determination. At Mpondi, a
-short time before, a wounded buffalo had attacked a hunter so suddenly
-that the latter did indeed find himself seated on its neck, but would
-hardly have escaped with his life unless at the critical moment his
-sun-helmet had fallen off. The animal then proceeded to attack the
-helmet, and the man managed to get a shot at its heart. From this and
-similar tales it will be understood that as the trail gets warmer and
-warmer, one’s excitement becomes intense and one’s senses more acute.
-But although I often heard the buffalo breathing only a few paces from
-me, the bush was so thick that I could not get a shot. I had already
-abandoned all hope of success and had marched off with my caravan for
-good and all, when at seven in the morning we crossed a perfectly fresh
-buffalo trail. At this point the forest was clearer, and the guides
-seemed keen to follow the tracks. So we let the caravan go on, and
-after four hours of exhausting tracking got a sight of the buffalo.
-In a clearing, at one hundred yards, I raised my rifle, but Kadunda
-would not allow it, and insisted on our stalking the quarry, which was
-passing us in quite open wood without undergrowth, up to within thirty
-yards. Luckily the bullet cut the main artery; the buffalo fell at
-once, and so any further possible developments of the episode were cut
-short. As often happens, we discovered in the animal’s body a bullet
-from a native gun. Besides this buffalo I had got a large number of
-antelope and gazelle of various kinds; lions we often heard, but never
-caught sight of.
-
-On this march through the “Pori” I learned, to my astonishment, that
-even in the interior of Africa it is no easy matter to disappear
-without a trace. I had marched off without leaving word what road I
-intended to take. Suddenly, in the heart of the bush, a native met us
-on the march, and handed me the oversea mail. The fact is that in their
-interchange of information the inhabitants tell each other everything
-that happens in their vicinity. Calls, fire signals, and the signal
-drums serve to exchange and quickly spread all news. The incredible way
-in which the innumerable rumours spread abroad, with which I became
-acquainted later on, is mainly due to this communicativeness.
-
-After returning to Dar-es-Salaam from the first journey of inspection,
-I immediately made arrangements for re-arming three more companies; up
-to date only three companies had been equipped with modern rifles. It
-subsequently became a factor of the greatest importance that, at any
-rate, these arms, with the necessary ammunition, reached the Colony
-just in time for the outbreak of war.
-
-During a tour of inspection in April to Lindi, where I saw the Third
-Field Company, I fell into a rocky hole and got water on the knee
-so that I could not start my next long journey till the end of May.
-Although the Central Railway was open for public traffic only as far as
-Tabora, the construction had proceeded so far that I could reach Kigoma
-(on Lake Tanganyika) by rail, and was thus already enabled to acquire a
-superficial knowledge of this important means of communication which
-connected our coast directly with the Lake and the rich countries
-bordering on it, and indirectly with the Congo basin. At Kigoma the
-steamer _Coetzen_ was still building, and to reach Bismarckburg I
-made use of the small steamer _Hedwig von Wissman_. At Baudouinville,
-in the Congo Territory, I paid a short visit to the Bishop of the
-White Fathers, without suspecting how soon we would be at war with
-that country. The wonderful church would be an ornament to any of our
-towns. It had been built by the Fathers themselves and the interior was
-decorated with rich carvings. Extensive, splendid orchards surround the
-station. The plague of lions must, however, be very great; the Fathers
-told me that a short time before a lion had one night jumped the wall
-into the court and killed an ox.
-
-Our reception was very friendly, and we were made welcome with a glass
-of fine Algerian wine. We were also well received at Mwasyl Mission
-Station in German territory, where there were also White Fathers,
-mostly Belgians. During the war, however, we captured correspondence
-which proved that the French missionaries, who also lived at stations
-in the Tanganyika country, by no means confined themselves to spreading
-Christianity but intentionally carried on a national propaganda
-as well. One missionary’s letter defines the difference between a
-_missionnaire catholique_ and a _missionnaire français_, remarking
-that the latter is bound, in addition to spreading the Christian
-faith, to carry on French national propaganda. It is well known that
-this national propaganda is a work from which the German missionaries
-generally refrained.
-
-These missions, which are naturally to be found in the densely
-populated and well-cultivated countries, exercise a remarkable
-influence on the education of the natives. The missionary is mostly the
-only permanently settled white man; he becomes well acquainted with
-the country and people, and wins their confidence. The missions have
-deserved extremely well by introducing European handicrafts; everywhere
-one finds carpenters’ shops, shoemakers’ shops and brickworks.
-
-My later tours disclosed that the extremely fertile country around
-Langenburg and Ssonga, where there are many wheatfields (the density
-of population is indicated even on the map by the numerous mission
-stations), was protected by only one company, which was not even
-connected by a direct wire. A telegram could only reach Langenburg
-from Dar-es-Salaam by the English line through South Africa. The
-communication by heliograph from Iringa to Langenburg was too
-unreliable to be considered an efficient substitute. It may be
-mentioned that in that country the natives have not only been educated
-up to agriculture by the Missions and by the German Administration,
-but that considerable native industries have been indigenous there for
-a long time past. Where iron occurs one finds numerous forges, the
-bellows being made in the primitive manner out of hides and perforated
-branches. Very beautiful are the native weavers’ products; basket-work
-is also done here as almost everywhere else in the Colony, and the
-work not only shows good taste, but is so close that the natives use
-wickerwork cups for drinking. The large herds owned by a few European
-farmers suffered, owing to the poorly developed communications, from
-the difficulty of reaching a market; this is especially the case with
-Mbeya Farm, between Lake Nyassa and Tanganyika.
-
-I camped at Mbosi Mission, and the local missionary, Bachmann, who had
-known the country and the people intimately for many years past, told
-me that a striking change was taking place in the views of the natives.
-Foreign Arabs and Swahili were appearing in the country, and were
-telling the people that the Germans would soon be going, and that the
-English would take possession of the land; that was in June, 1914.
-
-The continuation of my journey to Iringa brought me to the places where
-the great chief Kwawa had defied the Germans in the early days, and at
-Rugeno some of the many assembled natives were able to relate to me
-what they had witnessed of the annihilation of Zelewski’s expedition on
-the spot.
-
-In the short period of peace-work that was vouchsafed to me, my
-endeavours to obtain a thorough grip of all my duties in East Africa
-could not produce results sufficient to secure me great personal
-authority among Africans of long standing. I was still considered a raw
-hand. All the same, my career in the service had prepared me to some
-extent for the work that Fate had in store for me.
-
-It was probably about the time when, as a cadet who had been
-transplanted at an early age from my home in Pomerania, I was studying
-Cæsar’s Gallic War, that the German Fatherland was presented by
-Bismarck with its first colonies. In the year 1899-1900, when employed
-on the General Staff, I studied our own colonies as well as many
-foreign ones. During the troubles in China (1900-1901) I made the
-acquaintance, both officially and socially, of all the contingents
-engaged with us in East Asia, particularly the English. The Herero and
-Hottentot Rebellion in South-West Africa (1904-1906) introduced me
-to the peculiarities of bush warfare. At that time I gained abundant
-personal experience, not only of natives, but also of Boers, both
-on the Staff of General von Botha and as an independent Company and
-Detachment Commander. The excellent qualities of this Low German race,
-that had for generations made its home on the African veld, commanded
-my respect. That the Boers would later take a decisive—and in a sense
-tragic—part in anglicizing the German part of Africa I never dreamt.
-
-In 1906, in South-West Africa, I was wounded. This brought me to Cape
-Town, so that I also acquired a superficial knowledge of Cape Colony.
-On my return journey I also touched at the future scene of my work,
-German East Africa, for the first time.
-
-Later, my position as Commander of the Marine Battalion at
-Wilhelmshaven afforded me an insight into the inner life of our
-thriving and growing navy, which was so closely connected with German
-work overseas. I took part in exercises and cruises on large and small
-ships, in naval manœuvres, and in a visit by the Fleet to Norway,
-during which new views of general and military life continually
-presented themselves.
-
-Even after my return to the Army the alternation between regimental
-and staff employment afforded me much inducement and opportunity for
-comparison. In this manner my development had rendered me capable of
-rapidly accommodating myself to new conditions. Grateful as I was for
-every expansion of my horizon, I owe the best of all to the Army at
-home, in which I had the privilege, under the guidance of admirable
-commanders, of learning to know the spirit of military life and true
-discipline, a spirit which was then properly understood.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER II
-
-THE BEGINNING OF THE WAR
-
-
-EARLY in August, 1914, when on my way via the heliograph station of
-Kidodi towards Kilossa, a special messenger brought me a telegram from
-the Governor, to say I was to return immediately to Dar-es-Salaam; and
-on the following day I received the news that His Majesty had ordered
-mobilization, but that the state of war did not extend to the overseas
-possessions. A telegram from the Secretary of State of the Imperial
-Colonial Office called upon us to reassure the settlers.
-
-In contrast to this a wireless message from the Admiralty Staff
-mentioned England also among our probable enemies.
-
-At Kilossa I managed to catch a goods train, and so arrived at
-Dar-es-Salaam on the 3rd August. Here everyone was busy: the
-declaration of war had arrived in the middle of the preparations for a
-big exhibition, in the programme of which was included the ceremonial
-opening of the Tanganyika Railway; numerous Germans had come on a
-visit to Dar-es-Salaam and were now unable to get away. In order to
-assist in the preparations for the exhibition, Captain von Hammerstein,
-commanding the 6th Field Company in Ujiru, had also arrived there, and
-it was very fortunate that I was able at once to employ this energetic
-officer, who not only shared my views, but to whom I was also cordially
-attached, for the work of mobilization.
-
-The question which immediately forced itself upon us was whether,
-in the now obviously imminent universal war in which England would
-almost certainly join, the Colony would remain neutral or not. As I
-have already explained, I considered it to be our military object to
-detain enemy, that is English forces if it could by any means be
-accomplished. This, however, was impossible if we remained neutral.
-In that case the situation would be that we, who did not command the
-sea, would have to remain inactive, with a force which, though small
-at the moment, had behind it a loyal, very efficient population of
-eight millions suitable for military service. England, on the other
-hand, would have no need to employ a single man in East Africa on our
-account; it would be able to take away the very last fit Askari, after
-providing for internal security, for employment in other theatres more
-important than East Africa. It would, therefore, obviously have been an
-advantage for England if any agreement had existed which condemned us
-to neutrality. But this was not the case: the Congo Act, which deals
-with the Equatorial territories, only says that in case of conflict
-between two of the Powers concerned, a third Power may offer its good
-services as a mediator. But as far as I know this step was not taken
-by any Power. We were therefore not obliged to restrict our operations
-out of regard for any agreement. From a military point of view it was
-a disadvantage, not for us, but for England, if war occurred in East
-Africa. The fact that we were not obliged to remain neutral enabled us
-to make use of our favourable coast as a base and refuge for the German
-cruiser operations in the Indian Ocean. But, above all, we were able,
-with our few thousand men, to contain throughout the whole duration of
-the war an enormously superior force of the enemy.
-
-At the outbreak of war the Protective Force consisted of 216 Europeans
-(from whom a part must be deducted as on leave) and 2,540 Askari; there
-were, further, in the Police Force, 45 Europeans and 2,154 Askari;
-these were later increased by the ships’ company of the _Königsberg_
-(which had put to sea), 322 men, and of the _Möve_, 102 men. The total
-numbers enrolled in the Force during the war were about 3,000 Europeans
-and 11,000 Askari.
-
-These figures include all non-combatants, such as those employed on
-police duty, medical personnel, supply and maintenance services, etc.
-How many milliards it cost to try and crush our diminutive force the
-English themselves will presumably some day tell us. We, on the other
-hand, could probably have continued the war for years to come.
-
-For the hostile strengths no authentic figures are at my disposal;
-I quote from the statements of English officers and Press reports,
-and they must bear the responsibility for them. According to them
-over 130 Generals took the field against us, the total strength of
-the hostile troops was about 300,000, the losses in European and
-Indian dead amounted to 20,000; horses and mules, 140,000. These
-numbers, especially those of the General Officers, seem even to me
-rather exaggerated; I can therefore only repeat that they are taken
-from English sources. In any event, however, their losses were very
-considerable; and considering that the number of black soldiers who
-were killed or died is not given, the total number of enemy dead can
-hardly be under 60,000.
-
-We should have been compelled, if a cruiser had sought shelter in our
-harbours, to refuse to admit her, by reason of our neutrality, whereas
-the favourable position and coastal development of East Africa made it
-the natural hiding-place in cruiser warfare in the Indian Ocean. As
-regards the agreements laid down in the Congo Act, it should be borne
-in mind what it would have meant for our Navy if our colonies had been
-declared neutral.
-
-At Dar-es-Salaam it was very interesting during those days of tension
-to watch the proceedings of the English Consul King. He was to be seen
-everywhere, either in the Officers’ Club at a game of bridge, or at the
-Post Office where our telegrams were handed in. The standing orders of
-the English Expeditionary Force, which were subsequently captured at
-Tanga, and which were mainly based on King’s reports, showed how active
-this man had been in the time before the war, and how excellently he
-was informed as to the internal conditions in our Colony. His judgment
-on relevant matters extended so far that he even compared the relative
-fighting value of the Europeans in different districts, and credited
-those of Dar-es-Salaam with little “stomach for fighting.” To be
-honest, it must be admitted that in the case of a large number of the
-Germans in that place (and even of the local Government authorities)
-it actually did take some time before they were imbued with that
-warlike spirit without which the fulfilment of our task was simply
-impossible.
-
-Very difficult was the position of the coast towns, which were
-inhabited by numerous Europeans (among them many women and children),
-and which were of course exposed to bombardment by English men-of-war
-at any minute. The Governor maintained that such a bombardment must
-be avoided under all circumstances. According to an ordinance, which
-certainly did not contemplate the case of foreign war, the supreme
-military power in the Colony was in the hands of the Governor, and
-communication with home having ceased, it was anyhow physically
-impossible to get this altered. So I was obliged to make the best of
-this, from a military point of view, very serious difficulty and to
-reckon with the possibility that, if the Governor’s instructions were
-faithfully executed, Dar-es-Salaam and Tanga for instance, the termini
-of our railways and the obvious bases for hostile operations from the
-coast towards the interior, would fall into the enemy’s hands without a
-struggle.
-
-My view was that we would best protect our colony by threatening the
-enemy in his own territory. We could very effectively tackle him
-at a sensitive point, the Uganda Railway, and one might almost say
-that the numerous German settlers in the country traversed by our
-Northern Railway (Tanga-Moshi) were already deployed for this object.
-The Governor, however, did not agree with the proposal I had already
-previously put forward in case of war, namely, to concentrate our
-forces in the North near Kilima Njaro. But, in order to act at all,
-it was obviously necessary to collect our troops, who were scattered
-all over the country. As this could not be effected in the Kilima
-Njaro country, as I wished, the concentration took place on the
-heights of Pugu, a day’s march west of Dar-es-Salaam. At this place
-the Dar-es-Salaam Company met those from Kilimatinde, Tabora, Ujiji,
-Usambara and Kissendji, which came partly by march routes and partly
-by rail. The Police, who, in accordance with the scanty preparations
-already made, were to join the Protective Force immediately, were in
-part, at any rate, placed at my disposal, a number of old Askari were
-called up, and in this way four new companies (No.’s 15 to 18) were at
-once formed. The German Reservists were mobilized as required, and each
-company was brought up to an establishment of about 16 Europeans, 160
-Askari and 2 machine guns.
-
-In some cases difficulties occurred in calling the Europeans to the
-colours. By mistake, the crews of a few ships of the East African Line,
-lying in the harbour of Dar-es-Salaam, were informed, in response to
-their application, by the Officer in Command at the Railway Station,
-that there was no room for them in the Protective Force. Then, at
-the suggestion of the Governor’s representative, a declaration was
-submitted to them, according to which they were to engage in writing
-to remain neutral during the war. Later on the men saw that this
-constituted an offence against the law relating to liability for
-service, and their own sound feeling was opposed to it. They appealed
-to me, setting forth the circumstances; I had had no inkling of these
-proceedings, and fortunately, as the declaration had not yet fallen
-into the hands of the enemy, the intended decision could be reserved.
-
-The number of carriers allotted to each company varied, and may
-have averaged about 250. The stores of arms, ammunition and other
-war-material, which were lying unprotected in the harbour of
-Dar-es-Salaam, were distributed among various places in the interior
-along the railway, where depots were established. The training of
-the troops was at once vigorously proceeded with, and even then we
-realized the value of rendering our head-dress unrecognizable by
-means of grass and leaves, a measure proposed by a practical Company
-Commander, Captain Tafel. The question of course was whether we, with
-our Askari, would be able to fight modern troops; it was denied by
-many an experienced hand. But from what I had seen during the revolt
-in South-West Africa, from 1904 to 1906, I believed that courage and
-military efficiency could be awakened in the East African native also,
-who belongs to that same great family, the Bantu, as the Herero. That
-certainly was a proof; but the matter was greatly simplified by the
-fact that there was no possible alternative.
-
-All questions of organization, which are usually carefully prepared
-and considered in time of peace, had now to be dealt with and decided
-on the spur of the moment. One of them was the extraordinarily
-important one of establishing a service of subsistence and a complete
-system of supply from the rear. The main point was to consider, in
-the first place, the main roads, which were also important in a
-military sense. Which roads might these be? It was immediately found
-how disadvantageous was the absence of railway communication between
-the Central and Usambara Railways. In time of peace, communication
-had been effected by sea between Dar-es-Salaam and Tanga; this was
-now impossible. Obviously the importance of a military use of the
-lines had not been thought of. As a substitute, we had to develop
-a road between Morogoro and Korogwe, on the Northern Railway. The
-second road ran past the western side of the Masai Reservation, from
-Dodoma via Kondoa-Irangi, and Ufiome to Arusha, and the third from the
-rich district of Tabora, the capital of the Wanyamwesi country, to
-Muansa, on Lake Victoria, into the country of the Wassukume, who were
-recognized even by Consul King as the most important of our tribes.
-This road was also valuable because by it we could draw on the rice
-crops of Lake Victoria as well as on the abundant stocks of cattle.
-Other roads connected Kilossa with the rich territory of Mahenge,
-Iringa, and even Langenburg, which last provided us with a large part
-of our requirements in wheat flour.
-
-The provisional organization of the supply system having been fixed in
-broad and general outline, it was not possible for the details of its
-development to be worked out at Headquarters. Someone had to be found
-whose past military career rendered him capable of working the system,
-not only from the administrative point of view, but also in accordance
-with the sometimes very urgent military requirements, and of adapting
-it to them. Major-General Wahle, a retired officer, who happened to
-have arrived on the 2nd August, on a visit to his son, and to see the
-Dar-es-Salaam Exhibition, at once placed himself at the disposal of the
-Force, and at my request took charge of the Lines of Communication. His
-task was particularly difficult, because where there were no railways,
-the bulk of the work had to be performed by native carriers. I have at
-my disposal no figures showing the total number of carriers employed
-for the service of the troops, and it is very difficult to arrive at it
-at all definitely. It included men who only carried the loads from one
-place to another before the permanent carriers took them over, but I
-am sure I do not exaggerate in saying that, on the whole, hundreds of
-thousands of carriers worked for the troops; and all of them had to be
-fed and medically looked after.
-
-Of our many other difficulties one of a special nature may here be
-mentioned. The peace-time existence of the Europeans in tropical
-colonies had, even for reasons of health, accustomed them to a certain
-degree of comfort. When on _safari_ (a journey) in East Africa, it
-is generally impossible to buy European food; but few Europeans had
-learnt to live on the vegetable products supplied by the natives or by
-Nature. Shelter is rarely to be had. Against mosquitos it is, however,
-imperative to protect oneself. So the white official or soldier seldom
-travelled with less than eleven carriers, who, besides his tent,
-camp-bed and clothing, also carried a considerable quantity of food.
-Such large numbers of carriers were, however, impossible for a force
-which was to be mobile. Another difficulty was that nearly every Askari
-had a boy. With these simple people, whose predilection for their
-ancient traditions and customs is further confirmed by Islam, and
-who are besides very proud and vain, it is particularly difficult to
-interfere with such Dusturis (customs). In individual cases it was not
-always easy for a Company Commander to find the happy mean.
-
-In the tropical warfare which was before us medical care is one of the
-most important factors. Generally speaking, the native is in a great
-measure immune against malaria, and it does not often happen that an
-Askari gets really ill with it; some tribes, however, like the Wajagga,
-on Kilima Njaro, who inhabit elevated, non-malarial districts, and are
-therefore not immune from early youth, suffer severely from malaria
-as soon as they come down to the plains. From the evening until well
-into the morning mechanical protection against the malaria mosquito
-(anopheles), by means of a mosquito net, was strictly enforced for
-every European. For many months I slept on the ground, and even then
-the mosquito-net afforded me a high degree of protection; even so I
-had malaria ten times, for in the field it is not always possible to
-employ preventive measures to the extent that is desirable from a
-hygienic point of view. In our endeavour to attach a medical officer to
-every company we received most welcome assistance from the fact that
-there was a considerable number of them on Lake Tanganyika, and in
-the Southern territories on the Rovuma, who had come out to study and
-combat sleeping-sickness.
-
-The work entailed by all this business of mobilization not only kept us
-going day and night, but also the native telephonist at Pugu, and it
-was extraordinary to see the skill with which the black man worked his
-instrument, both there and elsewhere. His great technical talent proved
-of the greatest value to us. Of difficulties there was, of course, an
-infinity. During the early days it happened that cattle coming from the
-country north of Tabora for the civilian population at Dar-es-Salaam
-met other cattle going in the opposite direction to feed the troops.
-To this day I feel something of a physical shock when I think of a
-collision at Pugu, between a train laden with the finest show cattle
-going at full speed, and another one, which nearly produced a serious
-reduction in the personnel required for working out our mobilization
-scheme.
-
-Our place of concentration at Pugu is some twelve miles inland from
-Dar-es-Salaam. Our camp was situated on the slopes of the Pugu
-Mountains. The forest is extremely thick, and the country densely
-covered by plantations of natives and Europeans. In spite of its
-somewhat elevated position, Pugu is quite in the hot coastal area, and
-although in August we were still in the cold season, the temperature
-was still what we describe as “tropical;” it is that oppressive,
-somewhat damp heat, which makes long marches so exhausting for the
-European. At that time we had tents for the Europeans and a camp-bed
-with the inevitable mosquito net for everyone, so that in this respect
-there were no difficulties. In case of sickness we had established a
-provisional field hospital in the neighbouring Wichmann Plantations.
-Our horses did not suffer unduly. But one after another all our animals
-went down with tse-tse. In camp it was not possible to provide them, as
-we could at Dar-es-Salaam, with tse-tse proof stables, fitted with wire
-gauze similar to fly-proof windows.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER III
-
-THE FIRST ACTIONS
-
-
-IN this Manner We Were Fully Employed in the Camp at Pugu, when, on
-the morning of the 8th August, we heard heavy artillery fire from the
-direction of Dar-es-Salaam. According to reports which soon reached us,
-it emanated from two English light cruisers, _Astræa_ and _Pegasus_,
-who were aiming at the wireless tower. This tower had been erected in
-this exposed position because on the coast it could reach further out
-to sea; it was of importance to us because the high-power station at
-Tabora was not yet finished, and the two smaller ones at Muansa and
-Bukoba were of only local use. The tower was not hit by the English,
-but blown up by us, from a rather excessive fear of its falling into
-the enemy’s hands. A short time later an observation officer reported
-that the enemy was apparently preparing to land at Konduchi, a day’s
-march north of Dar-es-Salaam. The formation of the coast rendered it
-not unlikely. I therefore immediately ordered the seven companies
-of Askari[2] available to march off, so as to seize the favourable
-opportunity of surprising the enemy in the act of landing.
-
-Before they marched off I had a conversation at Pugu Station with the
-Governor, Dr. Schnee, who was passing through by train to Morogoro. He
-seemed quite surprised by the English hostilities, and entirely agreed
-with my proposal to attack them at Konduchi. On the way there I met
-two gentlemen belonging to the Government at Dar-es-Salaam, who showed
-me a document dealing with negotiations for surrendering Dar-es-Salaam
-to the English. As the Governor had said nothing to me about it, and
-I was also rather in a hurry, I only glanced superficially at it. It
-did not occur to me that this might be any kind of agreement drawn
-up with the consent of the Governor. But when, during the night, the
-force had reached a mountain ten miles north of Dar-es-Salaam, and on
-the next morning we obtained a view of the harbour and the English
-cruisers lying off it, it became clear that the report of an attempted
-landing at Konduchi was a mistake. We were able to establish the fact
-that the English ships had communicated with the shore, and now it
-did appear to me probable that negotiations with the enemy had taken
-place. I now advanced on the town, and, as I could not but fear that
-in the confusion of the moment a disadvantageous agreement might be
-concluded at Dar-es-Salaam, I sent Captain Tafel on ahead. He was
-to announce that I was taking over the executive power, and that
-negotiations with the enemy must be conducted through me alone. It was
-only from Captain Tafel that I learned that by order of the Governor
-negotiations for surrender had actually taken place. My intervention
-was not approved by the Governor, in whose hands, according to a
-Protective Force Ordinance intended to meet quite different conditions,
-supreme military power was actually placed. For the moment this had no
-practical consequences. Only a few English Marines had landed, and had
-already gone on board again. But for a soldier it was not inspiring
-to find that here, under the very eyes of a thousand good troops, an
-agreement had been concluded which forbade us to undertake any hostile
-act in Dar-es-Salaam, while the enemy was not so bound, and that we had
-received no information of a step of such great military importance.
-
-The _Königsberg_ had already put to sea from Dar-es-Salaam several
-days before, and the surveying vessel _Möve_, which was in harbour,
-had been blown up by us on the 9th August. This brought the land
-forces a valuable military increase, as the captain of the _Möve_,
-Lieut.-Commander Zimmer, now came under my orders. Lieutenant Horn at
-once proceeded with a few seamen to Kigoma, where he manned and armed
-the small steamer _Hedwig von Wissmann_. On Lake Tanganyika he chased
-the Belgian steamer _Delcommune_, which he surprised and shot to
-pieces after a few days, thereby securing to us the extremely important
-command of the lake. The ability rapidly to transfer troops from the
-Central Railway towards Bismarckburg or Usambara depended entirely
-upon unimpeded transport on Tanganyika, and played a part in the later
-course of the operations.
-
-In the north of the Colony, the 1st Company at Arusha had been
-reinforced by the 13th Company, coming by rapid marches from Kondoa,
-and by another company formed at Moshi from Police Askari. Further, a
-large part of the Europeans of the northern districts had combined to
-form a detachment under Captain von Prince. Most of those troops were
-in the neighbourhood of Moshi. Taveta, which lies to the eastward,
-in English territory, was held by the enemy, who thereby secured a
-valuable sally-port against our European settlements in the north;
-it was, therefore, an urgent matter for us to capture this important
-point without delay. It took considerable time before we were able to
-set the force in motion for this purpose. Many people believed that
-on the strength of the Congo Act we were bound to remain neutral, and
-naturally had little confidence in the instructions they received
-from the new Commandant. It was not until the 15th August that the
-weakly-held place was taken. The course of the fight proved that
-the force still required much further training to render it fit to
-carry out combined operations in unison in the dense bush. In this
-area the command was assumed by Major Kraut, who happened to be in
-the north-eastern frontier district for the purpose of frontier
-delimitations. During the next few days the holder of the supreme
-military power was successfully persuaded to agree to moving the bulk
-of our forces to the Northern Railway. Simple as was this movement in
-itself, under the conditions then existing, it required considerable
-preparations. There were few Germans to be found who were so well
-acquainted with the whole country between Dar-es-Salaam and Morogoro
-on one side, and Tanga and Mombo on the other, that they could give
-reliable information about roads and conditions of subsistence. It was
-necessary to send out reconnaissance officers in order to determine
-the roads on which a suitable quantity of supplies could be found. But
-we could not afford to await the results of all these reconnaissances;
-the marches had to be begun. According to European ideas the country
-was sparsely populated; and on the existing maps the only notes as to
-water and food showed whether the supplies available would suffice for
-bodies of a strength equal to a company at most. Without preparation
-one could therefore hardly put more than one company on each road
-without distribution in depth; the training and skill in the collection
-of supplies which the force had acquired by the end of the war were
-at that time non-existent. Taking it all round, it came to this, that
-the march and supply of a single company in the conditions there
-prevailing required about the same consideration as would a division in
-Germany. It was also necessary in this move to take into account the
-risk arising from the fact that companies would for a prolonged period
-be out of reach of orders. The only telegraphic communication between
-the Central Railway and the north ran close along the coast, and could
-therefore be interrupted whenever the enemy intended to do so.
-
-However, the Director of the Postal Service, Rothe, and Secretary
-Krüger displayed such adaptability in meeting the wishes of
-the troops, and such energy in starting work on the new line
-Morogoro-Handeni-Korogwe, and, under the pressure of circumstances,
-temporarily overcame the normal torpor of the Tropics with such
-success, that the line was completed in only a few weeks. Owing to the
-destructiveness of the termites (white ants) it is the rule in time of
-peace to employ iron telegraph poles, which, owing to the prevalence
-of giraffe in this particular district, have to be very tall and carry
-very heavy conductors. In the first instance, however, the construction
-in this case had to be of a provisional nature, and this, and the use
-of cable, caused continual breakdowns and repairs.
-
-In the meantime I received reports of the advance of small hostile
-detachments at Jassini, two marches north of Tanga, and this confirmed
-me in the belief that the enemy intended to land in that district,
-and would then rapidly advance into the interior along the Northern
-Railway. Consequently, the various companies had marched off from
-different points on the line Dar-es-Salaam-Mpapua, and were for the
-most part converging on Handeni, while some were directed on other
-points on the line Tanga-Korogwe, when I was called up on the telephone
-at Pugu on the afternoon of August 23rd, by Lieutenant von Chappuis,
-who was encamped at Bagamoyo with the 17th Field Company. He reported
-that an English light cruiser was lying off Bagamoyo, and had called
-upon the local Civil Administrator to destroy the telegraph station,
-threatening to bombard the place in case of refusal. I ordered him to
-assume control of the executive and to prevent a hostile landing by
-force of arms. A boat from the man-of-war that attempted to land under
-the white flag was therefore sent back, and the place was bombarded
-in consequence, to the great amusement of the company and the native
-inhabitants, since the enemy scored practically no hits.
-
-At the end of August, Headquarters moved by rail to Kirnamba, near
-Morogoro. On the way, General von Wahle, who was directing the service
-on the Lines of Communication from Morogoro, wished me the best of
-luck in the decisive action which we expected in the neighbourhood
-of Handeni, and to which his son was also proceeding. From there
-Headquarters travelled on towards Handeni in two requisitioned motors.
-After about twenty miles we had to leave them, as the improvement
-of this road had not been completed beyond that point. Captain von
-Hammerstein and I went on on bicycles, and gradually caught up the
-companies on the march. The anticipated landing of the enemy did not
-take place, and early in September we reached Korogwe. In the meantime
-an English cruiser had appeared at Tanga and towed away some lighters
-lying there.
-
-Our next duty was to organize the supply and transport services in
-the north. Captain Schmid, who had until then directed them as Field
-Intendant, had become sick, and it was difficult to find a suitable
-successor. Fortunately we discovered one in Captain Feilke, of
-the Landwehr, who had for many years directed the Prince Albrecht
-Plantations in Usambara, a man of great experience. He was at the time
-in the vicinity of Tanga, and had placed himself at the disposal of
-the force. He had formerly been Adjutant of the 8th Jäger Battalion,
-was fifty-two years of age, a man of much knowledge of the world and a
-skilful officer; he thus combined in the happiest manner the military
-knowledge and business talent necessary for the difficult post of
-Intendant. He came immediately, and we drove to New Moshi together.
-There I met Captain Kraut. On Kilima Njaro preparations had been made
-for guerilla warfare by establishing supply depots, our patrols were
-pushing beyond Taveta towards the British Uganda Railway, and numerous
-minor encounters had already taken place. At that time, however, the
-force lacked the experience necessary for carrying out distant patrols
-like those which at a later stage led so successfully to interruptions
-of the line. The first patrols had arrived at the Uganda Railway in
-a half-starved condition and had been captured. From New Moshi I
-went to Himo Camp, where Captain von Prince was holding a fortified
-position. He accompanied me to Taveta, which was held by an advanced
-post under an officer. Now we could discuss on the spot the problem of
-transferring the main body of the Northern Force to Taveta. The local
-native population was very numerous and placed entire confidence in
-the European administrators appointed by the force: they continued to
-sell their products in the market, and our mutual relationship was
-completely satisfactory.
-
-Directly war broke out the fear of a native rising had been expressed
-in many quarters. Along the Central Railway there were wild rumours
-about a revolt of the Wahehe—the warlike tribe who had so long defied
-German authority in the Iringa country—and around Kilima Njaro a
-rising of the Wajagga was feared. The authorities also thought that
-the large number of black labourers on the European settlements in
-the north were unreliable on account of difficulties of subsistence.
-But none of these fears turned out to be justified. Later, a very
-intelligent captured Belgian Askari told me outright: “You know quite
-well that the natives always side with the stronger party,” and an
-English Masai admitted frankly: “It is all the same to us whether the
-English or the Germans are our masters.”
-
-[Illustration: General Map of the Campaign in East Africa.
-
-—— Track of the German Main Force. 1916-1918.]
-
-[Illustration: The Fallen.
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-It was not till later, after the enemy had penetrated the country, that
-the native became a real danger to us: and then it was, indeed, very
-great. The native has a fine sense of the transfer of real power from
-one hand to the other.
-
-After returning for a short time to Korogwe, Headquarters moved to
-New Moshi, and shortly afterwards to Taveta. Three companies who had
-reached the Northern Railway from the Central Railway were concentrated
-at Tanga, the remaining five were moved into the Kilima Njaro country.
-At Dar-es-Salaam there remained for the moment only Captain von
-Kornatzki with the newly-formed 18th Field Company.
-
-During the following period several enterprises were carried out by
-flying columns, of the strength of one company each, the intention
-being to drive away the hostile detachments who were reported to be
-guarding the watering-places in the adjoining English territory, to
-inflict losses upon them, and so to open the way for our patrols to
-operate against the Uganda and Magad Railway. Thus, at the end of
-September, Captain Schulz had marched with his company from Kilima
-Njaro down the Tsavo River to the Uganda Railway, where he had met
-an enemy detachment of several companies, who had probably been
-concentrated by means of the railway. North of Kilima Njaro Captain
-Tafel had with his company and a detachment of fifty Europeans pursued
-a column of English Horse, but had then been attacked by the latter
-in his camp in the dense bush on Engito Mountain. This was the first
-serious engagement fought by our Askari in the north. Although the
-enemy consisted of English and Boer farmers, who were therefore good
-horsemen and good shots, our Askari attacked them with the bayonet with
-such dash, that out of a strength of eighty Europeans some twenty dead
-were left behind, and their total casualties may therefore be estimated
-at half their number.
-
-In the same way the expeditions undertaken by Captain Baumstark, who
-commanded the three companies at Tanga, led to fighting in the frontier
-districts between Jassini and Mombasa. An equally important object of
-all these enterprises was to secure the most indispensable information
-about this theatre of operations, as it had not been reconnoitred in
-time of peace, and the conditions as to water-supply and cultivation
-were unknown to us. In this manner we gradually obtained a clear
-idea of the country and its inhabitants. Along the coast the English
-frontier district was well settled and highly cultivated. Further
-inland it is a dry desert covered with thorn scrub and partly with
-thick bush. Out of the desert rise a number of mountain ranges, which
-often attain the character of steep masses of rock. The troops were
-quartered in several fortified camps east of Kilima Njaro, but, owing
-to the difficulty of communication from Taveta, Headquarters were moved
-back to Moshi. Later, when the Director of the Field Postal Service
-arrived, and I asked him what he thought of the line between Moshi and
-Taveta, he could only describe it as “pretty.” The insulators were made
-from knocked off bottle-necks, fastened to poles or branches of trees,
-the wire had been taken from the fences of the plantations. But the
-breakdowns really were so frequent that the great volume of reports and
-information in connection with the working of Headquarters could not
-have been carried on this line for a prolonged period.
-
-Since the outbreak of war our communication with the outside world had
-been to all intents and purposes cut off; at first, indeed, we did pick
-up wireless messages from Kamina (in Togo), and then occasionally,
-under favourable weather conditions, from Nauen (Germany); but
-otherwise we had to depend for fresh news on picking up enemy wireless
-messages, or on obtaining possession of enemy mails or other papers.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IV
-
-THE NOVEMBER ACTIONS AT TANGA
-
-
-CAPTURED English newspapers stated that it would be particularly
-painful to Germany to lose her beloved colonies, its “little chicks,”
-and that German East Africa was the most valuable mouthful. Captured
-mails spoke of an impending attack by an Indian expeditionary force of
-10,000 men, and, as I had from general considerations always expected a
-hostile attack on a large scale in the neighbourhood of Tanga, I went
-there at the end of October, drove all over the country in a car I had
-brought with me, and discussed the matter on the spot with Captain
-Adler, commanding the 17th Company, and with District Commissioner
-Auracher. I was pleased to find that the latter was of my opinion that,
-in the event of Tanga being seriously threatened, the prime necessity
-would be unity of action, and I assured him that I would, of course,
-undertake the responsibility for any consequences that might ensue.
-This was particularly important for the reason that, according to the
-Governor’s instructions, a bombardment of Tanga was to be avoided under
-all circumstances. Opinions as to what should be done or left undone in
-any given case might therefore differ very widely.
-
-On the 2nd November, a few days after my return to New Moshi, a wire
-from Tanga informed me that fourteen hostile transports and two
-cruisers had appeared off the place. They demanded unconditional
-surrender of the town; the negotiations were protracted, as District
-Commissioner Auracher, who had gone on board, pointed out that he must
-obtain special instructions, and prevented the threatened bombardment
-by remarking that Tanga was an open and undefended place. Captain
-Baumstark, who was with two companies in the frontier district
-north of Tanga, was at once moved off towards Tanga. Similarly the
-two companies of Europeans and the Askari companies were moved by
-forced marches from near Taveta and Kilima Njaro to New Moshi. Two
-lorries which were employed on supply work between New Moshi and
-Taveta rendered valuable service in this move. My intention to collect
-all available troops as rapidly as possible, to meet the obviously
-impending landing at Tanga, could only be executed, in spite of
-the long marches expected of the troops, if the Northern Railway
-exerted its capacity to the utmost limit, and this, with only eight
-locomotives, was asking a great deal. The railway is a narrow gauge
-line of 190 miles, on which, in a fully-loaded train of 24 to 32
-axles, only one company could be carried with complete baggage, or two
-companies without either baggage or carriers. That the transport of the
-troops could be carried out at all is entirely due to the willingness
-of all those connected with it—I specially mention Railway Commissary
-Kröber, who had been called up to the Force as a 2nd Lieutenant, and
-the traffic director Kühlwein—who at Tanga conducted the trains up on
-to the actual battlefield under fire. As early as the 2nd November the
-troops actually at New Moshi, one and a half companies, were pushed
-off by train, followed on the morning of the 3rd by Headquarters and
-another company. Three other companies followed later. Similarly, all
-the smaller detachments employed on railway protection duty were moved
-to Tanga. The spirit of the departing troops was magnificent, but this
-may have been due, not so much to the fact that the Askari clearly
-understood the gravity of the situation, as that for him a trip in a
-railway train is at all times a great delight.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. iv. Battle of Tanga. Fig. v. The Northern Railway.]
-
-Headquarters reached Korogwe in the evening of the 3rd November. I
-went to the hospital that had been established there and talked to
-the wounded who had come in from the action at Tanga on the 3rd. One
-of them, Lieutenant Merensky, of the Landwehr, reported to me that on
-the 2nd November, outpost and patrol encounters had taken place near
-Ras-Kasone, and that on the 3rd the enemy, apparently several thousand
-strong, who had landed at Ras-Kasone, had attacked the 17th Company
-east of Tanga. The latter, reinforced by the Europeans and Police
-Askari from Tanga under Lieutenant Auracher, had withstood the attack
-until the first one and a half companies coming from New Moshi joined
-in, rushing at once to attack the left flank of the enemy and driving
-him back. Lieutenant Merensky had the impression that the enemy was
-completely defeated, and that the attack was unlikely to be repeated.
-The telegrams coming in piecemeal during the railway journey had not
-afforded me a clear idea of the situation, when at 3 a.m. on the 4th
-November, Headquarters left the railway four miles west of Tanga,
-where we met Captain Baumstark. He had formed a different estimate of
-the situation, and believed that, owing to the great superiority of
-the enemy, Tanga could not be held against another attack. He had,
-therefore, on the evening of the 3rd November, collected his own two
-companies coming from the north, and the troops who had that day been
-in action at Tanga, at a point four miles west of the town, leaving
-patrols only in the place itself.
-
-Whether Tanga was held by the enemy or not was not certain. Strong
-officers’ patrols were at once pushed forward beyond Tanga towards
-Ras-Kasone. Luckily Headquarters had brought a few bicycles, and so, in
-order to satisfy myself quickly by personal observation, I was able to
-go off at once with Captain von Hammerstein and Volunteer Dr. Dessel
-to the railway station at Tanga, where I found an advanced post of the
-6th Field Company. They, however, could give no accurate information
-about the enemy, and so I rode on through the empty streets of the
-town. It was completely deserted, and the white houses of the Europeans
-reflected the brilliant rays of the moon into the streets which we
-traversed. So we reached the harbour at the further edge of the town.
-Tanga was therefore clear of the enemy. A quarter of a mile out lay the
-transports, a blaze of lights, and full of noise: there was no doubt
-that the landing was about to commence at once. I much regretted that
-our artillery—we had two guns of 1873 pattern—was not yet up. Here,
-in the brilliant moonlight, at such close range, their effect would
-have been annihilating, the hostile cruisers notwithstanding.
-
-We then rode on towards Ras-Kasone, left our bicycles in the German
-Government Hospital, and went on foot to the beach, close to which,
-right in front of us, lay an English cruiser. On the way back, at the
-hospital, we were challenged, apparently by an Indian sentry—we did
-not understand the language—but saw nothing. We got on our cycles
-again and rode back. Day began to break, and on our left we heard
-the first shots. This was the officers’ patrol under 2nd Lieutenant
-Bergmann, of the 6th Field Company, who had met hostile patrols west
-of Ras-Kasone. One of my cyclists now brought Captain Baumstark the
-order to advance at once with all the troops to Tanga Station. For
-the manner in which I proposed to fight the action, which was now to
-be expected with certainty, the nature of the country was one of the
-decisive factors. In the north, the houses of the European town at the
-harbour provided cover from view, and therefore also from the fire of
-the cruisers close by. The town was surrounded by continuous cocoanut
-and rubber plantations, which extended almost to Ras-Kasone, and in
-which, besides the native town, a few native patches of cultivation
-were scattered about. Undergrowth occurred along a few points and the
-ground was absolutely flat. It was probable that the enemy, whether he
-landed at Ras-Kasone only, or simultaneously at several points, such
-as Mwambani, for instance, would press upon our south, or right, wing.
-Here, to the south of Tanga, the ground afforded us also the prospect
-of greater power of manœuvre. I decided to meet the attack, which I
-expected with certainty, on the eastern edge of Tanga, and to echelon
-strong reserves behind our right wing for a counter-attack against the
-enemy’s flank.
-
-In allotting the various duties it was necessary to consider the
-peculiarities of the different units. At that time each company had
-different characteristics, according to its composition and its state
-of training. The good 6th Field Company, which had in time of peace
-received a careful training at Ujiji with both rifle and machine-gun,
-was ordered to hold the eastern edge of Tanga on a broad front. On
-its right rear, outside Tanga, was echeloned Baumstark’s battalion,
-consisting of the 16th and 17th Companies, formed from the Police, and
-several small units amalgamated into one company. To the right rear
-again, on the telegraph-road Tanga-Pangani, I kept three good companies
-at my own disposal, the 7th and 8th Rifle Companies, with three
-machine-guns, composed of Europeans, and the 13th Field Company with
-its four machine-guns. Headquarters remained for the present on the
-Tanga-Pangani road and connected up to the telegraph line there. The
-4th and 9th Field Companies and the two field guns (Captain Hering’s
-Battery) were still on the way, and the time of their arrival was
-uncertain. So the situation remained essentially until the afternoon.
-In the hot sun of the Coast area we suffered not a little from thirst,
-but quenched it with the milk of the young cocoanuts. There were other
-drinks as well in Tanga at that time; we still had wine and soda-water.
-Master-butcher Grabow even brought the troops hot sausages.
-
-The proceedings on board the hostile ships were kept under constant
-close observation. We saw every boat that left them, and its load.
-I estimated the total troops landed up to midday at 6,000. But even
-on this too low estimate I had to ask myself whether I dared risk a
-decisive engagement with my thousand rifles. For various reasons I
-decided that I would do so. It was too important to prevent the enemy
-from gaining a firm footing in Tanga. Otherwise we should abandon to
-him the best base for operations against the Northern territories; in
-his advance the Northern Railway would afford him an admirable line
-of communication, and he would be enabled continually to surprise
-us by bringing up and pushing forward fresh troops and stores. Then
-it was certain that we would be unable to hold the Northern Railway
-any longer and that we would be obliged to abandon our hitherto so
-successful method of warfare. Against these all-important practical
-reasons, limited considerations such as the Governor’s order to avoid a
-bombardment of Tanga under all circumstances could not prevail.
-
-A few circumstances there were that favoured us. For one thing, from
-personal experience in East Asia, I knew the clumsiness with which
-English troops were moved and led in battle, and it was certain that
-in the very close and completely unknown country in which the enemy
-would find himself directly he landed, these difficulties would grow
-to infinity. The slightest disorder was bound to have far-reaching
-consequences. With my troops, of whom the Europeans were well
-acquainted with the country round Tanga, while the Askari were at home
-in the bush, I had a reasonable prospect of taking advantage of the
-enemy’s weak points by skilful and rapid manœuvre.
-
-On the other hand, if the affair miscarried, it would be a bad
-business. Already my method of waging active war had met with
-disapproval. If on top of that we were to suffer a severe defeat the
-confidence of the troops would probably be gone, and it was certain
-that my superiors would place insuperable difficulties in the way of my
-exercising command. My decision was not easy, and as if the military
-situation alone did not render it difficult enough, it was made
-unnecessarily harder by the fact that the regulations did not allow
-sufficient freedom to the responsible commander. But there was nothing
-for it: to gain all we must risk all.
-
-The same morning I personally ordered Captain von Prince to move into
-Tanga with his two companies of Europeans, so that, in case of an
-attack on the Askari Company holding the eastern edge of the place,
-he could intervene rapidly without orders. I had already begun to
-doubt whether the enemy would attack at all on the 4th November, when
-at 3 p.m. an Askari reported to me in his simple, smart way: “Adui
-tayari.” (The enemy is ready.) Those two short words I shall never
-forget. The next moment the rifle fire opened along the whole front,
-and one could only judge of the rapid development and the ebb and
-flow of the action from the direction of the firing. One heard the
-fire draw in from the eastern edge of the town to the middle: so the
-6th Company had been driven back at this point. The enemy, with odds
-twenty to one in his favour, had penetrated close up to the station
-and into the town. Captain von Prince had immediately rushed up his
-two companies of Europeans and at once prevailed upon the brave Askari
-to stand and then to advance once more. The British North Lancashire
-Regiment, consisting only of long-service Europeans, 800 strong, was
-driven back with heavy losses, and the houses captured by the Indian
-Brigade (Kashmir Rifles), who were advancing between that regiment and
-the beach, were re-taken in stubborn street-fighting. But on the south
-side of Tanga Captain Baumstark had also brought his companies into
-action on the front, and after about one hour’s fighting I observed
-the Askari at this point retiring through the palm-trees to the
-Tanga-Pangani road. The European members of Headquarters at once ran
-there and stopped them. To this day I can see the fiery and determined
-Captain von Hammerstein, full of fury, throwing an empty bottle at the
-head of a retreating Askari. After all, they were for the most part
-young companies, only just formed, who were fighting at this point,
-and they had been staggered by the intensity of the enemy’s fire. But
-when we Europeans got in front of them and laughed at them they quickly
-recovered themselves and saw that every bullet did not hit. But on the
-whole the pressure on our front was so strong that I thought I could
-not delay the decision any longer and must start my counter-stroke.
-For this I had now but one company available, but it was the good 13th
-Field Company. The 4th Company, whose arrival I was most anxiously
-awaiting every minute, had not yet arrived.
-
-The course of the action up till now had shown that the enemy’s front,
-of which the flank was unprotected, did not reach further south than
-the right wing of our own. Here, therefore, the counter-stroke must
-prove annihilating, and no witness will forget the moment when the
-machine-guns of the 13th Company opened a continuous fire at this
-point and completely reversed the situation. The whole front jumped up
-and dashed forward with enthusiastic cheers. In the meantime the 4th
-Company had arrived; although, in consequence of a misunderstanding,
-it did not prolong the outer flank of the 13th, but pushed in between
-the latter and our front, still it did take an effective part in the
-battle before dark. In wild disorder the enemy fled in dense masses,
-and our machine-guns, converging on them from front and flanks, mowed
-down whole companies to the last man. Several Askari came in beaming
-with delight with several captured English rifles on their backs and an
-Indian prisoner in each hand. The handcuffs, however, which we found in
-their possession for use with German prisoners, were not used on them
-by any of us.
-
-At this time, in the dense forest, all units, and in many instances
-friend and foe, were mixed up together, everybody was shouting at
-once in all sorts of languages, darkness was rapidly setting in; it
-is only necessary to conjure up this scene in imagination in order to
-understand how it was that the pursuit which I set in motion failed
-completely. I had been stationed on the right wing, and had quickly
-despatched such units as were within reach at the moment to push with
-energy towards Ras-Kasone. Then I had gone to the left wing. There
-I found hardly any of our people at all; it was not till some time
-afterwards, in the night, that I heard the sound of the nailed boots of
-a party of Askari. I was glad at last to have a force in hand, but was
-somewhat disappointed to find it was a detachment of the right wing,
-under 2nd Lieutenant Langen, who had missed the way to Ras-Kasone and
-had thus got on to our left wing. But even these difficulties were not
-all. In some inexplicable way the troops imagined a Headquarter order
-had been issued that they were to return to their old camp west of
-Tanga. Only during the course of the night, at Tanga Railway Station,
-did it become clear to me that nearly all the companies had marched off
-for that destination. Of course they were ordered to return at once.
-But unfortunately this caused so much delay that it was impossible
-to bring Hering’s Battery, which had arrived later, into action by
-moonlight against the ships.
-
-The troops, whose great exhaustion was quite comprehensible, did not
-get back to Tanga until the morning of the 5th November, and occupied
-essentially the same position as the day before. It was not now
-advisable to advance with all our forces against the enemy, who was
-re-embarking at Ras-Kasone, as the country there was entirely open,
-and commanded by the cruisers lying in its immediate vicinity. All the
-same, the strong patrols and individual companies, who advanced towards
-Ras-Kasone, in order to harass the enemy, succeeded in surprising
-him by machine-gun fire directed on various detachments, a few boats,
-and even the decks of the cruiser lying close to the hospital. During
-the day, the impression that the enemy had suffered a tremendous
-defeat grew stronger and stronger. It is true, the full extent of his
-losses did not become known to us all at once; but the many places
-where hundreds and hundreds of dead were piled up in heaps, and the
-smell of putrefaction which the tropical sun brought out all over the
-district, gave us some indication. Very cautiously we estimated the
-killed at about 800, but I believe this number to be far too low. A
-senior English officer, who had accurate knowledge of the details,
-told me later, on the occasion of an action in which he stated the
-English casualties to have been 1,500, that the losses at Tanga had
-been considerably greater. I now think that even 2,000 is too low an
-estimate. Even greater was the enemy’s loss in _moral_. He almost
-began to believe in spirits and spooks; years afterwards I was asked
-by English officers whether we had used trained bees at Tanga, but I
-may now perhaps betray the fact that at the decisive moment all the
-machine-guns of one of our companies were put out of action by these
-same “trained bees,” so that we suffered from this new “training” quite
-as much as the English.
-
-The enemy felt himself completely defeated, and he was. His troops
-had fled in wild confusion and thrown themselves head over heels
-into the lighters. The possibility of renewing the attack was not
-even considered. From prisoners’ statements and captured official
-English documents it was ascertained that the whole Anglo-Indian
-Expeditionary Force of 8,000 men had been thus decisively beaten by
-our force of little more than 1,000 men. Not till the evening did we
-realize the magnitude of this victory, when an English officer, Captain
-Meinertshagen, came under a flag of truce to negotiate with Captain von
-Hammerstein, my representative, for the handing over of the wounded.
-Captain von Hammerstein proceeded to the hospital, which was full of
-severely wounded English officers, and in my name agreed to their being
-removed by the English on giving their word of honour not to fight
-against us again in this war.
-
-The booty in arms enabled us to re-arm more than three companies with
-modern weapons, for which the sixteen machine-guns were particularly
-welcome. The _moral_ of the force and its confidence in its leaders had
-enormously increased, and at one blow I was delivered from a great part
-of the difficulties which so greatly impeded the conduct of operations.
-The continuous fire of the ships’ guns, which the closeness of the
-country had rendered ineffective, had lost its terrors for our brave
-blacks. The quantity of stores captured was also considerable; besides
-600,000 rounds of small-arm ammunition the enemy had left behind
-the whole of his telephone gear and such quantities of clothing and
-equipment that we were able to meet all our requirements, especially in
-warm coats and blankets, for at least a year. Our own losses, painful
-though they were, were numerically insignificant. About fifteen (?)
-Europeans, among them the splendid Captain von Prince, and fifty-four
-(?) Askari and machine-gun carriers, had fallen. The Europeans were
-buried in a worthy warriors’ grave in the shade of a fine Buyu tree,
-where a simple memorial tablet is inscribed with their names. The work
-of clearing up the battlefield and burying the dead meant several
-days of most strenuous work for the whole force, as the streets were
-literally strewn with dead and badly wounded. In unknown tongues they
-begged for help which, with the best will in the world, could not
-always be accorded at once.
-
-At our main dressing station, in Tanga itself, our male and female
-nursing personnel had conscientiously cared for friend and foe even
-under the fire of the heavy guns of the ships. As recently as the
-evening of the 4th November I had been to see the wounded. I little
-thought that Lieutenant Schottstaedt, who was sitting there on a chair
-with a severe wound in the chest, had but a few minutes to live. The
-English Lieutenant Cook, of the 101st Indian Grenadiers, lay there with
-a bad gun-shot wound in the leg. This bright young officer, who had
-fallen into our hands in the hottest part of the fight on the Indian
-left wing, maintained his cheerfulness in spite of his wound. With the
-bulk of the other wounded, he was treated for nine months in the Field
-Hospital at Korogwe by our best surgeon, _Stabsarzt_ Dr. Müller. He
-was already walking about once more, when an unfortunate fall on the
-stairs caused his death.
-
-The fighting at Tanga was the first occasion on which heavy demands
-were made on our arrangements for the care of the wounded. For this
-purpose, hospitals had been established at Korogwe and at various other
-points on the Northern Railway, to which the sick could be taken by
-rail without being transferred from one method of transport to another.
-No special hospital arrangements of a permanent nature had been made
-for transport, but we never had any difficulty in improvising what was
-necessary.
-
-In spite of their undoubted defeat at Tanga it was probable that
-British determination would not accept this decision as final. Even
-after his defeat the enemy was still several times as strong as we
-were, and would not improbably attempt another landing elsewhere. But
-a cycle ride on the 6th November to Mansa Bay, in the North, convinced
-me that the hostile ships had run in there only for the purpose of
-attending to their wounded and burying their dead and had no intention
-of landing. And the ships actually did steam off towards Zanzibar soon
-after. At that time it was interesting to me to visit our Government
-Hospital near Ras-Kasone, which had in the meantime been evacuated by
-the English wounded released on parole. Among others I saw here two
-German officers who had been wounded at Tanga on the 3rd November, and
-others who had been wounded in an earlier action; from the hospital
-they had been able to observe events behind the English front on the
-4th November, the day when the principal fighting took place. With the
-greatest excitement they had watched the landing at Ras-Kasone and the
-advance on Tanga; in the afternoon they had heard the opening of our
-decisive machine-gun fire and the bombardment by the ships’ guns, and
-had then witnessed the wild flight of the enemy close by the hospital.
-The numerous shells that had fallen near the hospital had fortunately
-done no damage. Quite early on the 5th November they had suddenly heard
-guns firing again, this time from the direction of Tanga; they realized
-that they must be German guns. They were in fact our two 1873 pattern
-field-guns, which, though too late to deal with the English transports
-by moonlight, had at least managed to secure a few hits after daybreak.
-A prolonged fire for effect was now unfortunately impossible, as the
-smoke disclosed the positions of the guns at once and drew the fire of
-the ships.
-
-In the meantime it had become evident that the attack at Tanga was
-not an isolated enterprise, but had been intended to form part of a
-simultaneous operation on a large scale. Suddenly in the morning mist,
-on the 3rd November, English troops appeared north-west of Kilima
-Njaro, at Longido Mountain, which was held by Captain Kraut with three
-Companies of Askari and a Mounted Company of Europeans. Just as orders
-reached Longido Mountain by heliograph directing Captain Kraut to move
-off to Moshi, the first shell arrived. The enemy, about 1,000 strong,
-had ascended the great mountain, which lies by itself in the open
-plain, at several points, being guided by Masai, who called out to
-the outposts: “We belong to Captain Kraut’s men.” But our three Field
-Companies deployed rapidly and succeeded in working round the enemy
-detachment in the rocky ground and quickly repelled them. A hostile
-detachment of mounted Europeans who became visible in the plain at the
-foot of the mountain, and apparently intended to ascend it from the
-south, or to act against our communications, was fired upon with effect
-and quickly driven off.
-
-Probably in connection with these events on the Northern Railway,
-hostile enterprises took place on Lake Victoria. At the end of October
-numerous Waganda warriors had penetrated from the North into the Bukoba
-district. To meet this menace, a force of 570 rifles, 4 machine-guns,
-and 2 guns left Muanza on the 31st October on board the small steamer
-_Muanza_, with 2 tugs and 10 dhows (boats). Soon after the landing
-these transports were attacked by English steamers, but got back to
-Muanza without damage. An English attempt to land at Kayense, north of
-Muanza, broke down under the fire of our detachment posted there.
-
-Thus, at the beginning of November we were confronted with a concentric
-attack on our Colony, planned on a large scale. Its failure made
-everyone expect that we would be able to hold our own as long as the
-home country could do so. But such scanty information as we could get
-from there gave us confidence. At the time of the action at Tanga we
-had, indeed, not heard the name of Hindenburg; but on the other hand we
-knew nothing of our reverse on the Marne, and were still buoyed up by
-the impression created by our victorious invasion of France.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER V
-
-AWAITING FURTHER EVENTS
-
-
-THE danger threatening the Kilima Njaro country appeared to me to be
-by itself a sufficient reason for rapidly moving the troops back to
-the vicinity of New Moshi after the decisive success of Tanga, which
-in any event could not be further exploited. The joy of the Northern
-settlers, who, it should be noted, had furnished the bulk of the
-Europeans who fought at Tanga, was indescribable. The first train,
-which carried the European Company, returned to New Moshi bedecked
-with flowers. I myself had still enough to do at Tanga, and did not
-follow the troops to New Moshi for several days, where Headquarters
-was reopened. Shortage of personnel prevented us from having separate
-people for each duty. Officers of Headquarters had sometimes in an
-emergency to act as riflemen or cyclists, the Intendant occasionally
-did duty as an orderly, the clerk went into action with a rifle and
-acted as orderly in battle. The work was greatly facilitated by the
-fact that the railway station, constructed on European lines, afforded
-us accommodation which, in spite of being rather small, enabled us to
-settle most matters affecting the Staff only by word of mouth. We had
-good telephone and telegraph installations, and were situated centrally
-as the telephone and road systems, which we had either made or
-perfected, and which led out in both directions towards Tanga, Taveta,
-East Kilima Njaro, West Kilima Njaro and Longido, as well as to Arusha.
-Sometimes the work would go on for a week at a time almost as in peace,
-although the volume of work to be dealt with was greater. But although
-hardly anybody at Headquarters was either trained or prepared for his
-functions, harmonious and successful co-operation was secured. It was
-based upon the best spirit, devotion to the cause, and the support of
-good comradeship.
-
-I myself went by car—for we had made a motor-road right up to Longido
-Mountain—to the Engare-Nairobi (cold river), a small stream rising on
-the northern slopes of Kilima Njaro, and flowing between it and Longido
-through the prairie in a north-westerly direction. In this country
-a number of Boer families were settled on farms. Kraut’s detachment
-had moved their camp there, as their supplies, if they had remained
-on Longido Mountain, would have had to make a two-days’ march across
-the prairie, where they could not be protected, and were, therefore,
-too uncertain. I satisfied myself that there was at this time no
-opportunity for any enterprises north of Kilima Njaro, and returned
-to New Moshi. The distance from New Moshi, where we collected a large
-proportion of the supplies coming from Usambara and the country further
-south by rail to Taveta, is thirty miles. Although we had available
-only a few motors, namely, three cars and three lorries all told, they
-were in the circumstances a considerable help. The road being well
-made, the three-ton lorries could do the trip out and back in one
-day in dry weather. As carriers took at least four days for the same
-journey a calculation showed that one lorry could do the work of six
-hundred carriers, who required subsistence in addition. The principle,
-later maintained by the English, of replacing carriers and pack-animals
-by mechanical transport, is further supported by the fact that men and
-animals suffered severely from tropical diseases, whereas mosquitos
-are powerless against automobiles. We, however, could not derive full
-benefit from this advantage, since we had so few motors. Even in this
-period, which, as far as transport was concerned, was one of quiet
-and regularity, we had constantly to fall back upon carriers. To this
-day I remember the joy of the Intendant when a column of six hundred
-Wassukuma carriers arrived at New Moshi from about Muanza; they brought
-rice, which was urgently needed, from Lake Victoria, via Kondoa-Irangi
-to Kilima Njaro. If one remembers that this march required at least
-thirty days, that the carrier needs one kg. (two lbs.) of food a day,
-and that his maximum load is twenty-five kg. (fifty-five lbs.), it
-is clear that these marches have to be arranged with great care and
-directed through well populated and fertile districts if this method of
-transport is to be of any value. If, in spite of these disadvantages,
-carrier transport had to be resorted to on a large scale, it only shows
-up the supply-difficulties we had to contend with. The Intendant,
-Captain Feilke, was, however, a past master in handling the men and
-looking after them. The carriers felt that they were well cared for,
-and the word “Kommando,” which some of them took as a personal name,
-became quite common. I myself was able, by means of the motors, to
-carry out many reconnaissances and inspections of the troops. I could
-reach Taveta, to which place some of the troops from Tanga returned, in
-two hours from New Moshi; this would otherwise have taken four days;
-later on I drove in one day from New Moshi to the Engare-Nairobi, round
-the west side of the whole of Meru Mountain, and back to New Moshi, a
-journey which could hardly have been accomplished with carriers in less
-than ten days.
-
-The success at Tanga called forth and revived the determination to
-resist all over the Colony.
-
-At Morogoro, on the 26th November, the Inspector of Lines of
-Communication, Major-General Wahle, succeeded in obtaining the
-Governor’s consent to the defence of Dar-es-Salaam in case of
-attack. As luck would have it, this consent was given just in time.
-On the 28th, two men-of-war, a transport and a tug, appeared off
-Dar-es-Salaam, and demanded to inspect our ships lying in the harbour.
-Among others, there was the _Tabora_, of the German East African Line,
-which had been converted into a hospital-ship. As the English had on a
-previous occasion declared that they did not consider themselves bound
-by any agreement about Dar-es-Salaam, fresh negotiations would have
-been necessary every time we wanted to escape a threatened bombardment.
-Thus an endless screw was created. I now wired that the entry into
-the harbour of a pinnace, demanded by the English, was to be resisted
-by force of arms. Unfortunately, however, it had been conceded by the
-German civil authority, against my opinion, and the Senior Officer
-present at Dar-es-Salaam felt himself bound. The English, however,
-came in, not with the one pinnace which had been agreed to, but with
-several small vessels, and then proceeded to carry out demolitions on
-board the _Tabora_, and even took some of her crew prisoners. This made
-it only too evident, even to those who had hitherto been doubtful, how
-misplaced our previous compliance had been. Captain von Kornatzky was
-just in time to open effective machine-gun fire on the small English
-vessels as they passed out by the narrow English harbour entrance.
-Unfortunately, on this occasion, one of the German prisoners was also
-hit. The necessary defensive measures had simply not been adopted in
-time. This is a small example of the dangers and disadvantages that
-arise when, in time of war, the military commander is constantly
-interfered with in his decisions, and in the execution of operations
-which are in the nature of things inevitable.
-
-And, after all, the subsequent bombardment of Dar-es-Salaam did no harm
-worth mentioning, for the damage done to a few houses can hardly be
-considered as serious.
-
-During the time of comparatively sedentary warfare at New Moshi the
-material side of life was also pleasant. The Europeans, who mostly
-belonged to the settler community of the northern territories, provided
-most of their subsistence themselves; abundant supplies of rice,
-wheat-flour, bananas, pineapples, European fruit, coffee and potatoes,
-came in from the plantations. Sugar was provided by the numerous
-factories, and our principal supply of salt came from the Gottorp salt
-works, on the Central Railway, between Tabora and Lake Tanganyika. Many
-plantations devoted themselves entirely to supplying the troops, and,
-owing to the abundant labour available this change in production caused
-no difficulties. But the transport system had also to work at high
-pressure. The great road leading from Kimamba to Mombo and Korogwe,
-on the Northern Railway, was continuously improved, so as to carry
-the transport of the products from the area of the Tanganyika Railway
-and further South, to the North. On this line alone at least eight
-thousand carriers were continuously employed. It soon proved to be
-practical not to make the carriers do the whole distance of a hundred
-and ninety miles, but to distribute them on different stages. This made
-it possible to quarter them permanently and to look after their health.
-Experts in hygiene travelled up and down the road, and did what was
-humanly possible for the health of the carriers, especially against
-dysentery and typhoid. In this manner we established along this very
-frequented route permanent carrier-camps a day’s march apart, in which
-the men were accommodated at first in extemporized huts, which were
-later properly completed. Camp discipline was strictly regulated. In
-order to provide also for the many Europeans passing through, small
-houses with concrete floors were put up; and individuals were enabled
-to subsist on the supplies held on the line of communication, without
-having to burden themselves with provisions to last for a prolonged
-period, as is customary on journeys in Africa. The work on this line of
-supply was the object of constant attention. Both Europeans and natives
-had still to learn how to ensure the co-operation of such masses of
-men, and to understand the importance of order and discipline in the
-working of the transport for the health of all concerned.
-
-At New Moshi Station both telephone and telegraph were working day
-and night. Where the whole organization had to be improvised friction
-was not altogether unavoidable. All the members of Headquarters were
-extraordinarily hard-worked. But we did have bright intervals during
-the strenuous work. The abundance of creature comforts enjoyed by
-the Europeans in the North was shared by us at Headquarters. We were
-literally spoilt by the number of gifts sent us by private individuals.
-If one of us travelled on the Northern Railway, on which in time of
-peace it was difficult to obtain a little food for love or money, he
-was now cared for by someone at almost every station. I remember when
-Lieut. Freiherr von Schroetter returned to New Moshi, very famished,
-after carrying out some very exhausting patrols in the country north of
-Erok Mountain. After having, according to normal ideas, been thoroughly
-well fed from seven o’clock till eleven, he shyly asked if he might
-have some supper. The next morning he started on fourteen days’ leave
-to his plantation in Usambara, in order to recuperate and attend to
-his business. After breakfast we gave him coffee, bread, butter and
-meat, to take with him in the train, and had warned the various railway
-stations to look after this completely famished patroller. So, after
-half an hour, the station guard at Kahe offered him another breakfast,
-at Lembeni the charming wife of the Station Commandant had baked him
-a cake, and at Lame he was looked after by the commander of the local
-Recruit Depot, Sergt.-Major Reinhardt. At Makanya the guard, Planter
-Baroy, who belonged to the country, brought him home-made chocolate and
-bullocks’ hearts—a fruit the size of a melon—at Buiko the hospitable
-traffic manager of the Northern Railway, Kuehlwein, who had so often
-entertained us in passing through, had prepared him a delicate meal. At
-Mombo, where the supplies from the Usambara Mountains were collected,
-and where we had established most of our workshops, our protégé was met
-by Warrant Officer Meyer, of the Navy, with a sustaining supper. But
-then we got a telegram: “Please do not order any more, I can’t eat any
-more.”
-
-Although this continuous feeding shows a spirit of sympathetic chaff at
-the expense of the starving subaltern, it also proves, better than any
-theoretical dissertations, how intimately all classes of the population
-of the northern districts worked in with the troops, and how they tried
-to anticipate our every wish. This co-operation continued as long as
-the troops remained in the North.
-
-Whenever duty gave us a chance we arranged for change and recuperation.
-On Sundays we often went out together near New Moshi for a cheery day’s
-shooting. Both carriers and Askari soon picked up their business as
-beaters, and drove the game towards us in exemplary order, with loud
-shouts of “Huyu, huyu:” “There he is.” For variety of game the country
-provided more than one would be likely to find anywhere in Europe:
-hare, various dwarf antelopes, guinea-fowl, several relatives of the
-partridge, duck, bush-buck, water-buck, lynx, several kinds of wild
-boar, small kudu, jackal and many other kinds of game abounded. Once, I
-remember, to my astonishment, a lion silently appeared fifteen paces in
-front of me. Unfortunately I had my gun in my hand, and before I could
-put up my rifle, which was on my knees, he had as silently disappeared.
-In the teeming Kilima Njaro country, and even more east of Taveta, our
-shooting expeditions provided a welcome increase to our meat supply.
-But in the main this depended on the cattle which the Masai brought us
-from the Kilima Njaro and Meru country, but which also came from far
-away near Lake Victoria.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VI
-
-FURTHER HEAVY FIGHTING IN THE NORTH-EAST
-
-
-BY the time we kept Christmas in the Mission Church at New Moshi, and
-afterwards in our mess in the Railway Station, the military situation
-north of Tanga had become sufficiently acute to indicate that decisive
-events in this quarter were probable. During the last days of December,
-our patrols, who in that district were on British territory, had been
-gradually pushed back, and had concentrated south of Jassini, on German
-territory. The combined force amounted to two companies and a corps of
-some two hundred Arabs. The enemy had obviously been reinforced, and
-occupied the buildings of the German plantation of Jassini. It looked
-as though he intended to push gradually forward along the coast to
-Tanga, securing the occupied country by a system of block-houses. In
-order to investigate matters on the spot, I travelled early in January
-with Capt. von Hammerstein to Tanga, and thence by car to Capt. Adler’s
-camp at Mwurnoni, using the newly-completed coast road to the north, a
-distance of thirty-eight miles. Lieut. Bleeck, of the Reserve, whose
-numerous successful patrols in that country rendered him particularly
-suitable for the purpose, accompanied me on my reconnaissance, from
-which I learned that the country for miles round Jassini consisted
-principally of a cocoanut plantation belonging to the German East
-African Company, which was also planted with sisal, a species of agave
-with sharp thorns. This sisal, which formed a dense undergrowth among
-the palms, was in many places so interlaced that one could only force
-one’s way through by enduring a quantity of very unpleasant pricks. It
-is, of course, always difficult to make plans for an action in country
-so totally unknown to one without the aid of a map, and relying only
-on the reports of patrols. In this case we got over the difficulty as
-Lieut. Schaefer, of the Reserve, who had been called to the colours,
-had for years held the post of Assistant on this plantation, and could
-therefore furnish exact information. A tolerably accurate sketch was
-prepared, and the battle-names allotted to various localities were
-entered on it. The general situation appeared to be that Jassini
-was an advanced post, and that the main body of the enemy was in
-fortified camps further north. It was to be assumed that an attack
-on the advanced post of Jassini would entice the main body to leave
-its camps and fight in the open (sic!). My plan was to take advantage
-of this possibility. In order to engage the enemy while hurrying
-from his places of assembly to the assistance of the advanced post,
-in favourable tactical conditions, I intended to place my troops in
-readiness on his probable lines of advance, in such a manner that he
-would have to run up against them.
-
-In this closely-settled country supply presented no difficulty, and
-the necessary carriers could be provided by the numerous European
-plantations. So the companies ordered up by telegraph from New Moshi
-had only to be accompanied by their machine-gun and ammunition
-carriers, a considerable advantage in arranging for their railway
-journey. This was accomplished rapidly and without friction, thanks to
-the proved capacity of the Commandant of the Line, Lieutenant Kroeber,
-retired, of the Landwehr, and the understanding and consuming zeal with
-which the whole personnel of the railway bore the unavoidable strain
-without a murmur.
-
-By the 16th January the companies from New Moshi had detrained a couple
-of miles west of Tanga, and at once marched off towards Jassini,
-as well as the troops from Tanga, for the immediate protection of
-which only one company was left behind. On the evening of the 17th
-January the force of nine companies, with two guns, was assembled at
-Totohown plantation, seven miles south of Jassini, and orders for the
-attack were issued for the following morning. Major Kepler, with two
-companies, was directed to attack the village of Jassini, working
-round by the right, and Captain Adler, with two more companies,
-had a similar task on the left. To the north-west, on the road from
-Semanya, was posted the Arab corps. Captain Otto, with the 9th Company,
-advanced frontally by the main road on Jassini, followed immediately
-by Headquarters and the main body, consisting of the European Company,
-three Askari Companies, and two guns. The marches were so arranged that
-the attacks on Jassini should take place simultaneously at daybreak,
-and that all columns should mutually support each other by pushing on
-with energy. Even before daybreak the first shots fell in the vicinity
-of Kepler’s column, a few minutes later firing began in front of us
-with Otto’s column, and then became general. It was impossible in the
-endless dense palm forest to obtain an even approximate idea of what
-was really happening. We were, however, already so close up to the
-hostile position at Jassini, that the enemy seemed to be surprised,
-in spite of his excellent intelligence service. This supposition was
-afterwards, in part at least, confirmed. Of our rapid concentration
-south of Jassini, and our immediate attack with such strong forces, the
-enemy had actually had no idea.
-
-Otto’s column quickly drove back an entrenched post in its front, and
-Headquarters now made a circuit to the left through the forest, where
-first one, and then two more companies, were put in so as to outflank
-Jassini. What seemed curious was that in this move we came under a very
-well-aimed fire at short range, possibly no more than 200 yards; and
-it was not till much later that we learned that the enemy had not only
-a weak post in Jassini, but that four companies of Indians were also
-established there in a strongly constructed and excellently concealed
-fort. Suddenly Captain von Hammerstein, who was walking behind me,
-collapsed; he had been shot in the abdomen. Deeply as this affected me,
-at the moment I had to leave my badly-wounded comrade in the hands of
-the doctor. A few days later the death of this excellent officer tore a
-gap in the ranks of our Staff which was hard to fill.
-
-The fighting had become very hot. Two companies, although their
-commanders, Lieuts. Gerlich and Spalding, had fallen had quickly
-captured the fortified buildings of Jassini by a brilliant charge, and
-had now established themselves close in front of the enemy’s position.
-Soon the intervention of the enemy’s main force made itself felt. From
-the direction of Wanga, in the north-east, strong hostile columns
-arrived and suddenly appeared close in front of our companies, lying
-close to the fortifications of Jassini. The enemy made three strong
-attacks at this point and was each time repulsed. Hostile columns also
-arrived from the north and north-west. Against that from the west the
-Arab corps had done badly; the day before many of them had urgently
-demanded their discharge. Now, when they were to lie in ambush on
-the enemy’s road of advance, the tension became too great for them.
-Instead of surprising the enemy by an annihilating fire, they fired
-blindly into the air and then bolted. But luckily these hostile columns
-then came on Captain Adler’s two companies, and were repulsed with
-slaughter. Up till then the whole action had been in the nature of an
-energetic assault; even the last reserve, the European Company, had, at
-its urgent request, been sent into action. Towards noon the fighting
-had everywhere become stationary before the strong defences of the
-enemy. We had, as a matter of fact, no means of making a sufficient
-impression on them, and even our field-guns, which we placed in
-position at two hundred yards, produced no decisive effect. The heat
-was insupportable, and, as at Tanga, everyone quenched his thirst with
-young cocoanuts. I myself went with Lieut. Bleeck to the right wing, to
-find out how things were going with Major Kepler’s column. At that time
-I had not yet obtained a clear idea of the enemy’s defences, and so, on
-the sands of a clear and open creek, which was then dry, we again came
-under a very well-aimed fire. From a distance of five hundred yards
-the bullets fell close to us, and the spurts of sand they threw up
-made correction easy. The sand was so deep and the heat so great that
-one could only run, or even walk quickly, for a few paces at a time.
-Most of the time we had to walk slowly across the open and bear the
-unpleasant fire as best we could. Fortunately it did no serious harm,
-although one bullet through my hat and another through my arm showed
-that it was well meant. On the way back from the right wing our thirst
-and exhaustion were so great that several gentlemen, who were usually
-by no means on bad terms with each other, had a serious difference of
-opinion about a cocoanut, although it would not have been difficult to
-get more from the countless trees all round us.
-
-Headquarters had now returned to the Totohown-Jassini road. Along this
-ran a light railway for the work of the plantation, the wagons of which
-were now continuously employed in taking wounded back to Totohown,
-where a hospital had been established in the European buildings.
-Ammunition—of which the Askari carried about 150 rounds—began to
-run short, and reports from the firing line that they could not hold
-on longer became more frequent. Slightly wounded who had been tied up
-and a mass of stragglers collected at Headquarters, whole platoons
-had completely lost themselves, or had for other reasons left the
-places assigned to them. All these men were collected and reorganized,
-and thus a fresh reserve was made available. The ammunition in the
-machine-gun belts was to a great extent expended, and fresh supplies
-came up from Totohown by the light railway. The belt-filling machines
-were fixed to the palm-trees and kept incessantly at work. It was
-evident that we had already suffered considerable casualties. A
-few wished to break off the action, as there seemed no prospect of
-capturing the enemy’s defences. But the thought of the unpleasant
-situation of the enemy, shut up in his works, without water, and having
-to carry on all the occupations of daily existence in a confined space,
-in a burning sun and under hostile fire, made it appear that if we only
-held on with determination we might yet achieve success. The afternoon
-and night passed in incessant fighting; as is always the case in such
-critical situations, all sorts of rumours arose. It was said that the
-garrison of the enemy’s works consisted of South African Europeans, who
-were excellent marksmen; some people even declared they had understood
-their speech perfectly. It was indeed still very difficult to form
-a clear idea. My orderly, Ombasha (Lance-Corporal) Rayabu, at once
-volunteered to make a close reconnaissance, crawled close up to the
-enemy’s line, and was killed there. The native, who is at all times
-easily excitable, was doubly so in this critical situation at night,
-and I frequently had to take the men severely to task for firing
-blindly into the air.
-
- * * * * *
-
-Early on the 19th January the fire broke out again with the greatest
-intensity. The enemy, who was surrounded on all sides, made a sortie,
-which failed, and soon after hoisted the white flag. Four Indian
-companies, with European officers and N.C.O.’s, fell into our hands.
-We all remarked the warlike pride with which our Askari regarded the
-enemy; I never thought our black fellows could look so distinguished.
-
-Both friend and foe had been in an unpleasant situation, and were near
-the end of their nervous strength. That is usually the case with any
-soldier who takes his duty seriously. But the Askari now learned that
-one must overcome one’s own feelings in order to obtain the superior
-moral force necessary for victory.
-
-I estimated the enemy’s casualties at 700 at least; the captured
-documents gave a clear indication of his strength, which was more than
-double our own. According to them, General Tighe, commanding the troops
-in British East Africa, who had landed a short time before at Wanga,
-had more than twenty companies assembled at and near Jassini, most of
-whom had come by march route along the coast from the direction of
-Mombasa. They were to push forward towards Tanga.
-
-With the aid of the mechanical transport and the rickshaws, which
-worked between the Field Hospital at Totohown and Tanga, the wounded
-were moved from Jassini to the hospitals on the Northern Railway
-quite easily in a few days. These rickshaws, small spring-carts (like
-dog-carts), drawn by one man, which take the place of cabs at Tanga,
-had been requisitioned for carrying wounded by the Senior Medical
-Officer. The enemy had withdrawn into his fortified camps north of
-the frontier, and a fresh attack on them did not seem to me very
-promising. We immediately commenced patrol operations, as a support to
-which we left a detachment of a few companies at Jassini; the bulk of
-the troops was moved off again to the Kilima Njaro country. On the
-march to the entraining station on the Northern Railway the troops
-passed through Amboni Plantation. There the inhabitants of Tanga had
-voluntarily provided food and refreshments; and after the tremendous
-exertions entailed by the expedition to Jassini, with its continuous
-forced marches, the exhausting heat, and the uninterrupted fighting by
-day and night, the sulphur-laden Sigi stream was soon alive with white
-and black bathers. All our toil was forgotten, and our spirits rose to
-the highest pitch on receiving at this very moment, after a rather long
-interval, another wireless message from home. It indicated that news of
-the fighting at Tanga had probably just reached Germany, and contained
-His Majesty’s appreciation of the success we had gained there.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VII
-
-GUERILLA WARFARE AND FURTHER PREPARATIONS
-
-
-DOCUMENTS which we captured later proved by figures that the enemy
-moved troops from Lake Victoria towards Kilima Njaro. So the battle
-actually did relieve other, far distant theatres. This observation
-bore out the original contention that the best protection of the whole
-territory consisted in taking a firm hold of the enemy at one point.
-Whether the remainder of the Colony was also locally protected with
-energy was not as important. All the same, I was greatly rejoiced when
-in February, 1915, the Governor was persuaded to issue the order that
-the coast towns were to be defended if threatened by the enemy. The
-successes obtained hitherto had demonstrated that this local defence
-was not hopeless, even against the fire of ships’ guns.
-
-Although the attack carried out at Jassini with nine companies had been
-completely successful, it showed that such heavy losses as we also had
-suffered could only be borne in exceptional cases. We had to economize
-our forces in order to last out a long war. Of the regular officers,
-Major Kepler, Lieuts. Spalding and Gerlich, Second-Lieuts. Kaufmann and
-Erdmann were killed; Captain von Hammerstein had died of his wound. The
-loss of these professional soldiers—about one seventh of the regular
-officers present—could not be replaced.
-
-The expenditure of 200,000 rounds also proved that with the means
-at my disposal I could at the most fight three more actions of this
-nature. The need to strike great blows only quite exceptionally, and
-to restrict myself principally to guerilla warfare, was evidently
-imperative.
-
-The guiding principle of constantly operating against the Uganda
-Railway could, however, be resumed, as here it was in any case
-impossible to act with larger forces. For it was necessary to make
-marches of several days’ duration through the great, waterless and
-thinly populated desert, which provided little sustenance beyond
-occasional game. Not only food, but water had to be carried. This
-alone limited the size of the force to be employed. Such expeditions
-through districts providing neither water nor food require a degree of
-experience on the part of the troops which could not possibly exist at
-that stage of the war. A company even was too large a force to send
-across this desert, and if, after several days of marching, it really
-had reached some point on the railway, it would have had to come back
-again, because it could not be supplied. However, these conditions
-improved as the troops became better trained, and as our knowledge of
-the country, which was at first mainly _terra incognita_, increased.
-
-So there was nothing for it but to seek to attain our object by means
-of small detachments, or patrols. To these patrols we afterwards
-attached the greatest importance. Starting from the Engare-Nairobi,
-small detachments of eight to ten men, Europeans and Askaris, rode
-round the rear of the enemy’s camps, which had been pushed up as
-far as the Longido, and attacked their communications. They made
-use of telephones we had captured at Tanga, tapping in on the
-English telephone-lines; then they waited for large or small hostile
-detachments or columns of ox-wagons to pass. From their ambush they
-opened fire on the enemy at thirty yards’ range, captured prisoners
-and booty, and then disappeared again in the boundless desert. Thus,
-at that time, we captured rifles, ammunition, and war material of all
-kinds. One of these patrols had observed near Erok Mountain that the
-enemy sent his riding-horses to water at a certain time. Ten of our
-horsemen at once started out, and, after a two days’ ride through the
-desert, camped close to the enemy. Six men went back with the horses;
-the four others each took a saddle, and crept at a distance of a few
-paces past the enemy’s sentries close up to the watering-place, which
-lay behind the camp. An English soldier was driving the horses, when
-suddenly two men of our patrol confronted him out of the bush and
-covering him with their rifles ordered “Hands up!” In his surprise he
-dropped his clay pipe out of his mouth. At once he was asked: “Where
-are the missing four horses?” for our conscientious patrol had noticed
-that there were only fifty-seven, whereas the day before they had
-counted sixty-one! These four needed light treatment and had been left
-in camp. The leading horse and a few others were quickly saddled,
-mounted, and off they went at a gallop round the enemy’s camp towards
-the German lines. Even in the captured Englishman, who had to take part
-in this _safari_ on a bare horse, without much comfort, the innate
-sporting instinct of his nation came out. With great humour he shouted:
-“I should just like to see my Captain’s face now!” and when the animals
-had arrived safely in the German camp he remarked: “It was a damned
-good piece of work.”
-
-This capture, increased by a number of other horses and mules we had
-picked up, enabled us to form a second mounted company. We now had
-two mounted companies, composed of Askari and Europeans mixed, an
-organization which proved successful. They provided us with the means
-of sweeping the extensive desert north of Kilima Njaro with strong
-patrols who went out for several days at a time; they penetrated even
-as far as the Uganda and Magad Railways, destroyed bridges, surprised
-guards posted on the railways, mined the permanent way and carried out
-raids of all kinds on the land communications between the railways and
-the enemy’s camps. In these enterprises our own people did not get
-off scot free. One patrol had brilliantly surprised two companies of
-Indians by rifle fire, but had then lost their horses, which had been
-left behind in hiding, by the fire of the enemy; they had to make their
-way back across the desert on foot, which took four days, and they had
-no food. Luckily they found milk and cattle in a Masai kraal, and later
-on saved themselves from starvation by killing an elephant. But success
-whetted the spirit of adventure, and the requests to be sent on patrol,
-mounted or on foot, increased.
-
-The patrols that went out from the Kilima Njaro in a more easterly
-direction were of a different character. They had to work on foot
-through the dense bush for days on end. The patrols sent out to destroy
-the railway were mostly weak: one or two Europeans, two to four Askari,
-and five to seven carriers. They had to worm their way through the
-enemy’s pickets and were often betrayed by native scouts. In spite of
-this they mostly reached their objective and were sometimes away for
-more than a fortnight. For such a small party a bit of game or a small
-quantity of booty afforded a considerable reserve of rations. But the
-fatigue and thirst in the burning sun were so great that several men
-died of thirst, and even Europeans drank urine. It was a bad business
-when anyone fell ill or was wounded, with the best will in the world it
-was often impossible to bring him along. To carry a severely wounded
-man from the Uganda Railway right across the desert to the German
-camps, as was occasionally done, is a tremendous performance. Even the
-blacks understood that, and cases did occur in which a wounded Askari,
-well knowing that he was lost without hope, and a prey to the numerous
-lions, did not complain when he had to be left in the bush, but of his
-own accord gave his comrades his rifle and ammunition, so that they at
-least might be saved.
-
-The working of these patrols became more and more perfect. Knowledge
-of the desert improved, and in addition to patrols for destruction
-and intelligence work, we developed a system of fighting patrols.
-The latter, consisting of twenty to thirty Askari, or even more, and
-sometimes equipped with one or two machine-guns, went out to look for
-the enemy and inflict losses upon him. In the thick bush the combatants
-came upon each other at such close quarters and so unexpectedly, that
-our Askari sometimes literally jumped over their prone adversaries and
-so got behind them again. The influence of these expeditions on the
-self-reliance and enterprise of both Europeans and natives was so great
-that it would be difficult to find a force imbued with a better spirit.
-Some disadvantages were, however, unavoidable. In particular, our
-small supply of ammunition did not enable us to attain such a degree
-of marksmanship as to enable us, when we did get the enemy in an
-unfavourable situation, completely to destroy him. In technical matters
-we were also busy. Skilled artificers and armourers were constantly
-engaged with the factory engineers in the manufacture of suitable
-apparatus for blowing up the railways. Some of these appliances fired
-according as they were set, either at once, or after a certain number
-of wheels had passed over them. With the latter arrangement we hoped
-to destroy the engines, even if the English tried to protect them by
-pushing one or two trucks filled with sand in front of them. There was
-abundance of dynamite to be had on the plantations, but the demolition
-charges captured at Tanga were much more effective.
-
-We occasionally got German newspapers, but we had had no private mails
-for a long time. On the 12th February, 1915, I was sitting at dinner
-in the Railway Station at New Moshi, when I got a letter from Germany.
-It was from my sister, who wrote to say she had already repeatedly
-informed me of the death of my brother, who had been killed on the
-Western Front at Libramont on the 22nd August, 1914.
-
-In April, 1915, we were surprised by the news of the arrival of a
-store-ship. When entering Mansa Bay, north of Tanga, she was chased and
-fired at by an English cruiser, and her captain had to run her aground.
-Although during the ensuing weeks we salved almost the whole of the
-valuable cargo, we found that unfortunately the cartridges had suffered
-severely from the sea-water. The powder and caps deteriorated more and
-more, and so the number of miss-fires increased. There was nothing for
-it but to break up the whole of the ammunition, clean the powder, and
-replace some of the caps by new ones. Luckily there were caps in the
-Colony, though of a different pattern; but for months all the Askari
-and carriers we could lay hands on were employed at Moshi from morning
-till night making ammunition. The serviceable cartridges we had left
-were kept exclusively for the machine-guns; of the re-made ammunition,
-that which gave about 20 per cent. of miss-fires was kept for action,
-while that giving a higher percentage was used for practice.
-
-The arrival of the store-ship aroused tremendous enthusiasm, since it
-proved that communication between ourselves and home still existed.
-All of us listened with eagerness to the stories of the Captain,
-Lieutenant Christiansen, when he arrived at my Headquarters at New
-Moshi after his wound was healed. The terrific fighting at home, the
-spirit of self-sacrifice and boundless enterprise which inspired the
-deeds of the German troops, awakened a response in our hearts. Many
-who had been despondent now took courage once more, since they learned
-that what appears impossible can be achieved if effort is sustained by
-determination.
-
-Another means of raising the spirit of the force was by promotion.
-Generally speaking, I could only make promotions to non-commissioned
-rank, and within the commissioned ranks; but the grant of a commission,
-which would in many cases have been well-deserved, was beyond my power.
-Each case was very carefully considered, so as to determine whether
-really good work had been done. In this way unmerited promotions, which
-ruin the spirit of the troops, were avoided. On the whole, however,
-we had to cultivate the moral factors less by rewards than by other
-means. Decorations for war service were practically unknown among
-us. It was not personal ambition to which we appealed; we sought to
-arouse and maintain a real sense of duty dictated by patriotism, and an
-evergrowing feeling of comradeship. Perhaps it was the very fact that
-this lasting and pure motive remained unsoiled by any other purpose
-that inspired Europeans and Askari with that endurance and energy which
-the Protective Force manifested until the end.
-
-In the Kilima Njaro country the English were not inactive. From
-Oldorobo Mountain, seven and a half miles east of Taveta, which was
-held by a German detached post under an officer, an attack by two
-Indian Companies was reported by telephone one morning. Thereupon
-Captain Koehl and the Austrian Lieutenant Freiherr von Unterrichter at
-once marched off from Taveta; the two companies had become immobilized
-on the steep slopes of the mountain, and our people attacked them on
-both flanks with such vigour that they fled, leaving about twenty dead
-behind, while one machine-gun and 70,000 rounds fell into our hands.
-Other hostile expeditions were undertaken along the Tsavo River to the
-north-east side of Kilima Njaro; they were based on Mzima Camp on the
-Tsavo, which was strongly fortified and held by several companies.
-The patrol encounters that took place north-east of Kilima Njaro all
-ended in our favour; even the young Askari of the Rombo Detachment,
-which had a strength of sixty and was named after the mission on
-the Eastern Kilima Njaro, had unbounded faith in their commander,
-Lieutenant-Colonel von Bock, who was over sixty years old. I remember
-a wounded man who came from him to New Moshi, with a report for me,
-and refused to be attended to so as to lose no time in getting back to
-his commanding officer. In several fights, when the enemy occasionally
-amounted to two companies, these young troops were victorious, and it
-is a significant fact that among the English all manner of tales were
-current about these actions. The British Commander-in-Chief sent me a
-written complaint, saying that a German woman was taking part in them,
-and perpetrating inhuman cruelties, an idea which was, of course,
-without any foundation, and merely served to show the degree of nerves
-with which the enemy authorities had become afflicted.
-
-Notwithstanding the great amount of booty taken at Tanga, it was
-evident that, as the war seemed likely to be prolonged, the stocks
-in the Colony would become exhausted. The natives at New Moshi began
-all of a sudden to wear silk: this was by no means a sign of special
-extravagance: the stocks of cotton clothing in the Indian shops
-were simply coming to an end. We had seriously to think of starting
-manufactures ourselves, in order to convert the abundant raw material
-into finished products. A curious existence now developed, reminding
-one of the industry of the Swiss family Robinson. Cotton fields
-existed in plenty. Popular books were hunted up, giving information
-about the forgotten arts of hand spinning and weaving; white and
-black women took to spinning by hand; at the missions and in private
-workshops spinning-wheels and looms were built. In this manner, in
-a short time, the first useful piece of cotton cloth was produced.
-After various trials, the most suitable dye was obtained from the
-root of a tree called Ndaa, which imparted a brownish-yellow colour,
-very inconspicuous both in the grass and in the bush, and therefore
-specially suitable for uniforms. The rubber gathered by the planters
-was vulcanized with sulphur, and we succeeded in producing efficient
-tyres for motors and bicycles. At Morogoro a few planters successfully
-produced a motor-fuel from cocos, known as trebol, which was like
-benzol, and was employed in the automobiles. As in former times,
-candles were made out of tallow and wax, both by private persons and by
-the troops, and also soap. Then again, the numerous factories on the
-plantations in the northern territories and on the Tanganyika Railway
-were adapted to produce various means of subsistence.
-
-A particularly important item was the provision of foot-wear. The raw
-material was obtained from the plentiful skins of cattle and game;
-tanning materials from the mangroves on the coast. In peace time the
-missions had already made good boots; their activity was now further
-developed, while the troops also established tanneries and shoemakers’
-shops on a larger scale. It is true some little time elapsed before
-the authorities complied with the urgent and inevitable demands of the
-troops in an adequate manner, and, in particular, before they placed
-at our disposal the buffalo-hides necessary for making sole-leather.
-So the old historic fight for the cow-hide revived again, _mutatis
-mutandis_, in East Africa. The first boots made in any quantity were
-turned out at Tanga. Although at first their shape needed improving,
-they at any rate protected the feet of our white and black troops when
-marching and patrolling in the thorn bush of the Pori. For the thorns
-that fall to the ground bore into the feet again and again. All the
-small beginnings of food-stuff production that had already existed on
-the plantations in time of peace were galvanized into more extensive
-activity by the war, and by the need of subsisting large masses. On
-several farms in the Kilima Njaro country butter and excellent cheese
-were produced in great quantities, and the slaughter-houses round about
-Wilhelmstal could hardly keep up with the demands for sausages and
-other smoked meats.
-
-It was to be anticipated that quinine, which was so important for the
-health of the Europeans, would soon become exhausted, and that our
-requirements could not be met by capture alone. So it was a matter of
-great importance that we succeeded in producing good quinine tablets at
-the Amani Biological Institute in Usambara out of bark obtained in the
-North.
-
-The provision of proper communications for ox-wagons and motors
-involved the construction of permanent bridges. Engineer Rentell, who
-had been called to the colours, built an arched bridge of stone and
-concrete, with a heavy pier, over the Kikafu torrent, west of New
-Moshi. During the rains, particularly in April, no wooden structure
-would have withstood the masses of water coming down the steep
-river-bed, which was nearly 70 feet deep.
-
-These examples will suffice to show the stimulating influence of the
-war and its requirements on the economic life of the Colony.
-
-The organization of the Force was also constantly improved. By
-transferring Europeans from the Rifle Companies, when they were
-numerous, to the Askari Companies, the losses of Europeans in the
-latter were made good; Askari were enrolled in the European Companies.
-In this way the Field and Rifle Companies became more similar in their
-composition, which during the course of 1915 became identical. At
-Muansa, Kigoma, Bismarckburg, Lindi, Langenburg, and elsewhere, small
-bodies of troops had been formed under various designations, of the
-existence of which in most cases Headquarters only became aware after
-a considerable time. These units were also gradually expanded into
-companies; in this way, during 1915, the number of Field Companies
-gradually rose to 30, that of the Rifle Companies to 10, and that of
-other units of company strength to about 20. The maximum total attained
-was thus about 60 companies. Owing to the limited number of suitable
-Europeans and of reliable Askari N.C.O.’s, it was not advisable still
-further to increase the number of companies: it would only have meant
-the creation of units without cohesion. In order, however, to increase
-the number of combatants the establishment of the companies was raised
-from 160 to 200, and the companies were allowed to enrol supernumerary
-Askari. To some extent the companies trained their own recruits; but
-the great bulk of Askari reinforcements came from the Recruit Depots
-established in the populous districts of Tabora, Muansa and the
-Northern Railway, which also provided for local security and order. But
-owing to the great number of newly-raised companies the depots could
-not furnish enough men to bring them all up to their establishment
-of 200. The maximum strength attained by the end of 1915 was 2,998
-Europeans and 11,300 Askari, including Naval personnel, administrative
-staffs, hospitals and field postal service.
-
-How necessary were all these military preparations was proved by the
-news received at the end of June, 1915, that General Botha was coming
-to the East African theatre from South Africa with 15,000 Boers. That
-this information was highly probably correct had to be assumed from
-the outset. The scanty wireless messages and other communications
-about events in the outside world were yet enough to indicate that our
-affairs in South-West Africa were going badly, and that the British
-troops employed there would probably become available for other
-purposes in the immediate future.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VIII
-
-AWAITING THE GREAT OFFENSIVE. ENERGETIC USE OF THE TIME AVAILABLE
-
-
-AT first, it is true, the anticipated intervention of the South
-Africans did not seem to be materializing; the English were evidently
-trying to subdue us with their own forces, without their assistance.
-In July, 1915, they attacked the Colony at several points. East of
-Lake Victoria large bodies of Masai, organized and led by Englishmen,
-and said to number many thousands, invaded the country of the German
-Wassukuma, which was rich in cattle. However, in the matter of
-cattle-lifting the Wassukuma stood no joking; they gave our weak
-detachments every assistance, defeated the Masai, recaptured the stolen
-cattle, and, as a proof that they had “spoken the truth,” laid out the
-heads of ninety-six Masai in front of our police station.
-
-Against the main body of our force in the Kilima Njaro country the
-enemy advanced in considerable strength. In order, on the one hand,
-to ensure effective protection of the Usambara Railway, and the rich
-plantations through which it passes, and, on the other, to shorten
-the distance the patrols had to go to reach the Uganda Railway, a
-detachment of three companies had been pushed out from Taveta to
-Mbuyuni, a long day’s march east of Taveta. Another day’s march to the
-east was the well-fortified and strongly-held English camp of Makatan,
-on the main road leading from Moshi, by Taveta, Mbuyuni, Makatan,
-and Bura, to Voi, on the Uganda Railway. Vague rumours had led us to
-surmise that an attack on a fairly large scale in the direction of
-Kilima Njaro was to be expected from about Voi. On the 14th July a
-hostile brigade, under General Malleson, appeared in the desert of
-Makatan, which is generally covered with fairly open thorn-bush. The
-fire of a field battery, which opened on the trenches of our Askari,
-was fairly ineffective, but the enemy’s superiority of seven to one was
-so considerable that our position became critical. Hostile European
-horsemen got round the left wing of our own; however, our line was
-held by the 10th Field Company, which had distinguished itself in the
-fighting near Longido Mountain, under Lieutenant Steinhäuser, of the
-Landwehr, and it is a credit to this officer, who was unfortunately
-killed later, that he held on, although our mounted troops fell back
-past his flank. Just at the critical moment, Lieutenant von Lewinsky,
-who was also killed later, immediately marched off to the scene of
-action, arrived with a patrol, and took this dangerous flank attack in
-rear. The English troops, consisting of natives, mixed with Europeans
-and Indians, had very gallantly attacked our front, over ground
-affording very little cover. The failure of the English flank attack,
-however, set the seal on their defeat. At New Moshi Station I was kept
-accurately informed of the progress of the action, and thus, although
-at a distance, I shared in all the excitement from the unfavourable
-period at the beginning until complete success was assured.
-
-This success, together with the considerable booty, still further
-increased the spirit of adventure among both Europeans and Askari.
-The experience and skill that had by now been acquired enabled us
-henceforth to prosecute our plan of sending out a continuous succession
-of fighting and demolition patrols. I do not think I exaggerate in
-assuming that at least twenty English railway trains were destroyed,
-or, at least, considerably damaged. Picked up photographs and our own
-observation confirmed the supposition that a railway was actually
-being built from Voi to Makatan, which, being so easily accessible to
-us, and so important, formed a glorious objective for our patrols.
-The construction of this military line proved that an attack with
-large forces was in preparation, and that it was to be directed on
-this particular part of the Kilima Njaro country. The anticipated
-intervention of the South Africans was therefore imminent. It was
-important to encourage the enemy in this intention, in order that
-the South Africans should really come, and that in the greatest
-strength possible, and thus be diverted from other and more important
-theatres of war. With the greatest energy, therefore, we continued
-our enterprises against the Uganda Railway, which, owing to the
-circumstances, had still to be mainly carried out by patrols, and could
-only exceptionally be undertaken by a force as large as a company.
-
-Closer acquaintance with the desert country between the Uganda Railway
-and the Anglo-German border had revealed the fact, that of the various
-mountain groups rising abruptly out of the plain, the Kasigao was well
-watered and moderately populous. Being only from twelve to twenty
-miles from the Uganda Railway, Kasigao Mountain was bound to afford a
-favourably situated base for patrol work. The patrol of Lieut. Freiherr
-Grote had already made a surprise attack on the small Anglo-Indian camp
-situated half-way up its slopes. The riflemen of Grote’s patrol had
-worked round the camp, which was surrounded by a stone wall, and fired
-into it with effect from the dominating part of the mountain. Very
-soon the white flag appeared, and an English officer and some thirty
-Indians surrendered. A part of the enemy had succeeded in getting away
-to the mountain and fired on the patrol as it marched off. It was then
-we suffered our only casualties, consisting of a few wounded, among
-whom was a German corporal of the Medical Corps. We had also, on one
-occasion, surprised the enemy’s post on Kasigao Mountain by the fire of
-a 2.4-inch gun.
-
-Towards the end of 1915, the enemy having in the meantime shifted his
-camp on Kasigao Mountain, we attacked him once more. During the night a
-German fighting patrol, under Lieutenant von Ruckteschell, had ascended
-the mountain in nine hours, and arrived rather exhausted near the
-enemy’s work. A second patrol, under Lieutenant Freiherr Grote, which
-was co-operating with Ruckteschell’s, had been somewhat delayed by the
-sickness and exhaustion of its commander. Lieutenant von Ruckteschell
-sent a reliable old coloured N.C.O. to the enemy to demand surrender.
-He observed that our Askari was cordially welcomed by the enemy; he had
-found a number of good friends among the English Askari. But, in spite
-of all friendliness, the enemy refused to surrender. Our situation was
-critical, in consequence of exhaustion and want of food. If anything
-was to be done at all, it must be done at once. Fortunately, the enemy
-in their entrenchments did not withstand our machine-gun fire and the
-assault which immediately followed it; they were destroyed, and a
-large number of them were killed in their flight by falling from the
-steep cliffs. The booty included abundant supplies, also clothing and
-valuable camp equipment.
-
-The feeling of comradeship which our Askari had for us Germans, and
-which was tremendously developed by the numerous expeditions undertaken
-together, led on this occasion to a curious incident. After climbing
-Kasigao Mountain by night, among rocks and thorn-bushes, an Askari
-noticed that Lieutenant von Ruckteschell was bleeding from a scratch
-on his face. He at once took his sock, which he had probably not
-changed for six days, and wiped the “Bwana Lieutenant’s” face with it,
-anticipating the somewhat surprised question with the remark: “That is
-a custom of war; one only does it to one’s friends.”
-
-In order to study the situation on the spot and to push on the attacks
-on Kasigao, I had gone by rail to Same, thence by car to Sonya Mission,
-and then either by cycle or on foot in the direction of the mountain
-to the German border, where a company was encamped at a water-hole.
-From there we had fair communication to Kasigao by heliograph, and we
-were thus enabled to make good the success we had gained there. Troops
-were at once pushed up, so that until the arrival of the South Africans
-the mountain was held by several companies. It was, indeed, decidedly
-difficult to keep them supplied; for although the German frontier
-territory west of Kasigao was fertile, it could not permanently support
-a force which with carriers amounted to about one thousand.
-
-I then drove in the car round the South Pare Mountains, on a road
-that had been made in time of peace. The construction of this road had
-been dropped on account of expense, and for years the heaps of metal
-had been lying unused at the roadside. The culverts—consisting of
-pipes passing under the road—were to a great extent in good order.
-But little work was needed to make this road suitable for supply by
-lorry. Supplies were sent from near Buiko on the Northern Railway
-by lorry to Sonya, and thence to Kasigao by carriers. The telephone
-line was already under construction as far as the frontier, and was
-completed in a few days’ time. From then on patrols pushing out from
-Kasigao had several encounters with detachments of the enemy, and did
-some damage to the Uganda Railway. But the ruggedness of the country
-and the dense thorn-bush made movement so difficult that by the time
-the South Africans arrived, we had not derived full benefit from
-Kasigao as a base for patrols. However, the continual menace to the
-railway had, at any rate, obliged the enemy to take extensive measures
-for its protection. Wide clearings had been made along it, of which
-the outer edges had been closed by thick zarebas (abattis of thorns).
-Every couple of miles there were strong block-houses, or entrenchments
-with obstacles, from which the line was constantly patrolled. Mobile
-supports, of the strength of a company or more, were held in readiness,
-so that, whenever the railway was reported to be in danger, they could
-at once go off by special train. In addition, protective detachments
-were pushed out in our direction, who tried to cut off our patrols on
-their way back on receiving reports from spies or from observation
-posts on the high ground. We also identified English camps on the high
-ground south-east of Kasigao, as far as the coast, and also in the
-settled country along the coast. They also received attention from our
-patrols and raiders. Our constant endeavour was to injure the enemy, to
-force him to adopt protective measures, and thus to contain his forces
-here, in the district of the Uganda Railway.
-
-While thus establishing points of support for our fighting patrols
-from the coast to Mbuyuni (on the Taveta-Voi road), we worked in the
-same sense further north. The enemy’s camp at Mzima, on the upper
-Tsavo River, and its communications, which followed that river, were
-frequently the objective of our expeditions, even of fairly large
-detachments. On one occasion Captain Augar, with the 13th Company, was
-surprised south-west of Mzima Camp in thick bush by three European
-companies of the newly-arrived 2nd Rhodesian Regiment. The enemy
-attacked from several directions, but being still inexperienced in bush
-fighting, failed to secure concerted action. So our Askari Company was
-able first to overthrow one part of the enemy’s forces, and then by
-quickness and resolution to defeat the other, which had appeared behind
-it.
-
-Further north, also, there was some fighting in the bush which went in
-our favour; we worked with whole companies and inflicted painful losses
-on the enemy, who was often in greater force. North of the Engare Len
-the 3rd Field Company from Lindi worked with special energy, and sent
-its fighting patrols out as far as the Uganda Railway. The mere fact
-that we were now able to make raids with forces amounting to a company
-and more in the midst of a desert devoid of supplies, and in many
-places waterless, shows the enormous progress the force had made in
-this type of guerilla warfare. The European had learned that a great
-many things that are very desirable when travelling in the Tropics
-simply have to be dispensed with on patrol in war, and that one can at
-a pinch get on for a time with only a single carrier-load. The patrols
-also had to avoid camping in such a way as to betray themselves, and
-as far as possible to carry food ready prepared. But if food had to be
-cooked, this was particularly dangerous in the evening or morning; the
-leader had to select a concealed spot, and invariably shift his camp
-after cooking before going to rest. Complete hygienic protection was
-incompatible with the conditions of patrol duty. A number of cases of
-malaria invariably occurred among the members of a patrol after its
-return. But as, in spite of the continual damage done to the enemy,
-patrol duty only required comparatively few men, only a part of the
-companies had to be kept in the front line. After a few weeks each
-company was withdrawn to rest camps in healthy regions, European and
-Askari were able to recover from their tremendous exertions, and their
-training and discipline could be restored.
-
-Towards the end of 1915 the shortage of water at Mbuyuni Camp had
-become so serious, and supply so difficult, that only a post was left
-there, the detachment itself being withdrawn to the westward to the
-vicinity of Oldorobo Mountain. Meanwhile, the enemy’s camp at Makatan
-grew steadily larger. A frequent train service was maintained to it,
-and one could clearly see a big clearing being made to the west for
-the prolongation of the railway. Our fighting patrols had, indeed,
-many opportunities of inflicting losses on the enemy while at work, or
-protecting his working parties, but the line continued to make progress
-towards the west.
-
-It was necessary to consider the possibility of the country through
-which the Northern Railway passed soon falling into the hands of the
-enemy. Steps had, therefore, to be taken to safeguard the military
-stores in that district in time. Where railways were available this
-was, of course, not difficult; but the further transport by land needed
-much preparation. The bulk of our stocks of ammunition, clothing and
-medical stores was at New Moshi and Mombo. It was evident that we would
-be unable to carry away the factories, or parts of them, by land;
-they must, therefore, be made use of and kept working for as long as
-possible where they were. Assuming the enemy would attack from the
-north, our evacuation would obviously be towards the south, and not
-only the preparations, but the movement itself, must be started without
-loss of time—that is, as early as August, 1915.
-
-The Commandant of the Line, Lieutenant Kroeber, retired, therefore, in
-an able manner, collected light-railway material from the plantations,
-and built a line from Mombo to Handeni, at the rate of about two
-kilometres (one and a quarter miles) per day. The trucks were also
-brought from the plantations, and after mature consideration, man
-draught was decided on in preference to locomotives. Thus our stores
-were moved from the north by rail, complete, and in time, to Handeni.
-From there to Kimamba, on the Central Railway, we principally used
-carriers, except for a few wagons. It was, after all, necessary
-not to hurry the movement unduly, for, in spite of all the visible
-preparations for a hostile attack on the Kilima Njaro country, I still
-thought it possible that the main force of the enemy, or at least a
-considerable proportion of it, would not operate there, but in the
-Bagamoyo-Dar-es-Salaam area.
-
-At the end of 1915 the enemy was pushing his rail-head further and
-further westward, and Major Kraut, who was opposing him, reinforced
-his position on Oldorobo Mountain with three companies and two light
-guns. This mountain rises from the flat thorn desert near the main
-road, seven and a half miles east of Taveta, and dominates the country
-for a great distance all round. Entrenchments and numerous dummy works
-had been made, part being cut out of the rock, and formed an almost
-impregnable fort. The disadvantage of the position was the complete
-lack of water. A planter who had been called to the Colours, Lieutenant
-Matuschka, of the Reserve, was an expert water finder; at Taveta he
-had discovered excellent wells; but on Oldorobo no water was found,
-although at the points he indicated we dug down more than one hundred
-feet. Water had therefore to be taken from Taveta on small donkey-carts
-to Oldorobo, where it was collected in barrels. This carriage of water
-was an extraordinary strain on our transport. Strangely enough, it did
-not occur to the enemy to interfere with it, and thus render Oldorobo
-Mountain untenable. Instead of that, basing himself on his railway,
-he pushed up to within about three miles of the mountain, where he
-established strongly fortified camps. We had been unable to prevent
-this, as, owing to difficulties of water and transport, larger forces
-could only move away from Taveta for short periods. The enemy obtained
-his water supply by means of a long pipe-line, which came from the
-springs in the Bura Mountains. The destruction of the enemy’s reservoir
-by patrols under Lieutenant von S’Antenecai, of the Reserve, only
-caused him temporary inconvenience.
-
-At this time, also, the first hostile aeroplanes appeared, and bombed
-our positions on Oldorobo Mountain, and at Taveta and later even
-New Moshi. On the 27th January one of these airmen, while on his way
-back from Oldorobo, was successfully fired on and brought down by
-our advanced infantry. The English had told the natives that this
-aeroplane was a new “Munga” (God); but now that this new Munga had been
-brought down and captured by us, it rather increased our prestige than
-otherwise.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IX
-
-THE SUBSIDIARY THEATRES OF WAR. GUERILLA WARFARE ASHORE AND AFLOAT
-UNTIL NEW YEAR, 1916
-
-
-WHILE employing the bulk of the Protective Force in the regions on the
-Northern Railway we could not afford entirely to denude the remainder
-of the Colony. In the interior it was essential to remain undisputed
-master of the natives, in order, if necessary, to enforce the growing
-demands for carriers, agriculture, supplies, and all manner of work.
-Accordingly, the 12th Company remained at Mahenge, and the 2nd at
-Iringa. In addition to their other duties both of them acted as large
-depots, serving to fill vacancies at the front, and providing the
-machinery for raising new units.
-
-The commanders of detachments on the frontiers, who were far away from
-Headquarters and beyond the reach of the telegraph, rightly endeavoured
-to anticipate the enemy and to attack him in his own territory. Owing
-to the lack of communications on our side this fighting resolved itself
-into a series of local operations, which were quite independent of
-each other. It was different with the enemy, who clearly endeavoured
-to establish a proper relationship between his main operations and the
-subsidiary enterprises at other points on the frontier.
-
-In October, 1914, before the fighting at Tanga, Captain Zimmer reported
-from Kigoma that there were about 2,000 men on the Belgian frontier;
-and Captain Braunschweig sent word from Muansa that at Kisumu on Lake
-Victoria there were also strong hostile forces, about two companies
-at Kisii, and more troops at Karungu. According to independent native
-reports, Indian troops landed at Mombasa in October and were then
-transported towards Voi. In the Bukoba District English troops crossed
-the Kagera, and the sub-station at Umbulu reported that the enemy was
-invading the Ssonyo country. Obviously these movements were preparatory
-to the operations which were to be co-ordinated with the great attack
-on Tanga in November, 1914.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. vi. Subsidiary Actions up to August, 1916.]
-
-The means of intercommunication in the Colony were not sufficiently
-developed to enable us rapidly to concentrate our main force, first
-against one and then against another of these hostile detachments
-deploying along the frontier. We had, therefore, to adhere to the
-fundamental idea of our plan, of vigorously attacking the enemy
-opposed to us in the area of the Northern Railway and on the Uganda
-Railway, and of thus indirectly relieving the other points where
-operations were in progress. Of necessity, however, these subsidiary
-points had occasionally to be reinforced. Thus, in September, 1914,
-Captains Falkenstein and Aumann, with portions of the 2nd Company,
-had moved from Iringa and Ubena into the Langenburg District. In
-March, 1915, the 26th Field Company was pushed up from Dar-es-Salaam
-via Tabora to Muansa. In April, 1915, hostile concentration in the
-Mara Triangle (east of Lake Victoria) and at Bismarckburg caused us
-to waste much time in moving troops up from Dar-es-Salaam via Muansa
-to the Mara Triangle, and via Kigoma to Bismarckburg. The latter move
-was particularly delayed on Lake Tanganyika owing to the slow progress
-being made on the steamer _Götzen_, which was building at Kigoma.
-
-At first, the enemy’s attacks were principally directed against the
-coast.
-
-At the commencement of the war our light cruiser _Königsberg_ had left
-the harbour of Dar-es-Salaam and had, on the 29th September, surprised
-and destroyed the English cruiser _Pegasus_ at Zanzibar. Then several
-large enemy cruisers had arrived and industriously looked for the
-_Königsberg_. On the 19th October, at Lindi, a pinnace steamed up to
-the steamer _Praesident_, of the East African Line, which was concealed
-in the Lukuledi river. The local Defence Force raised at Lindi, and the
-Reinforcement Company, were at the moment away under Captain Augar,
-to repel a landing expected at Mikindani, so that nothing could be
-undertaken against the pinnace.
-
-It was not till the 29th July, 1915, that several whalers went up the
-Lukuledi and blew up the _Praesident_.
-
-After successful cruises in the Indian Ocean the _Königsberg_ had
-concealed herself in the Rufiji river, but her whereabouts had become
-known to the enemy. The mouth of the river forms an intricate delta,
-the view being obstructed by the dense bush with which the islands
-are overgrown. The various river-mouths were defended by the “Delta”
-Detachment, under Lieutenant-Commander Schoenfeld; this detachment
-consisted of Naval ratings, European reservists, and Askari, and its
-strength was about 150 rifles, a few light guns, and a few machine
-guns. The enemy made many attempts to enter the river-mouths with light
-craft, but was invariably repulsed with severe loss. The _Adjutant_, a
-small steamer which the English had taken as a good prize, and armed,
-was recaptured on one occasion, and was used thenceforward by us as
-an auxiliary man-of-war on Lake Tanganyika. Some English aircraft
-had also come to grief in the Rufiji delta. A blockship, which the
-English had sunk in the most northerly of the river-mouths, did not
-close the fairway. The frequent bombardments by ships’ guns, which he
-had no means of opposing, Lieut.-Commander Schoenfeld defeated by the
-skilful design of his positions, and by shifting them in time. Early in
-July, 1915, the English had brought to the Rufiji two shallow-draught
-gun-boats, armed with heavy guns. On the 6th July they made the first
-attack with four cruisers and other armed vessels, and two river
-gun-boats. The enemy bombarded the _Königsberg_, which was at anchor
-in the river with aeroplane observation. The attack was beaten off,
-but when it was repeated on the 11th July, the _Königsberg_ suffered
-severely. The gun-detachments were put out of action. The severely
-wounded captain had the breech-blocks thrown overboard and the ship
-blown up. The loss of the _Königsberg_, though sad in itself, had at
-least this advantage for the campaign on land, that the whole crew and
-the valuable stores were now at the disposal of the Protective Force.
-
-Lieutenant-Commander Schoenfeld, who was in command on land at the
-Rufiji delta, at once set himself with great forethought to raise the
-parts of the guns that had been thrown overboard. Under his supervision
-the ten guns of the _Königsberg_ were completely salved and got ready
-for action again; five were mounted at Dar-es-Salaam, two each at
-Tanga and Kigoma, and one at Muansa. For their transport he made use
-of several vehicles constructed for heavy loads which were found on a
-neighbouring plantation. In their concealed positions on land these
-guns rendered excellent service, and as far as I know not one of them
-was damaged on this service, although they were often bombarded by the
-enemy’s vessels.
-
-On the 26th September, by night, the steamer _Wami_ was taken out of
-the Rufiji to Dar-es-Salaam.
-
-At the end of August several boats came to Lindi from Mozambique with
-men belonging to the steamer _Ziethen_, in order to join the Force.
-
-On the 10th January, 1915, about 300 Indian and black troops with
-machine guns landed on the island of Mafia. Our police detachment,
-three Europeans, fifteen Askari, and eleven recruits, opposed them
-bravely for six hours, but surrendered when their commander, Lieutenant
-Schiller of the Reserve, was severely wounded, who had been maintaining
-a well-aimed fire on the enemy from a mango tree. The English held
-Mafia with a few hundred men, and also established posts of observation
-on the smaller islands in the vicinity.
-
-It was apparently from here that the work of rousing the natives
-against us was undertaken. On the night of the 29th-30th July, 1915, we
-captured a dhow at Kisija carrying propaganda papers.
-
-The events at Dar-es-Salaam, where, on the 22nd October, the captain of
-an English cruiser declined to be bound by any agreement, have already
-been discussed.
-
-On the outbreak of hostilities an aeroplane, which had been sent to
-Dar-es-Salaam for the Exhibition, was taken into use, but was destroyed
-by an accident at Dar-es-Salaam on the 15th November, when Lieutenant
-Henneberger lost his life.
-
-At Tanga things had been quiet since the big battle of November, 1914.
-On the 13th March, 1915, a ship went ashore on a reef, but got off
-again on the spring-tide. We at once began salving 200 tons of coal
-which had been thrown overboard.
-
-Several rows of mines which had been made on the spot, and could be
-fired from the shore, proved ineffective, and it was found later that
-they had become unserviceable.
-
-On the 15th August, 1915, the _Hyacinth_ and four guard-boats appeared
-off Tanga. Our two 2·4-inch guns were quickly moved from their
-rest-camp at Gombezi to Tanga, and with one light gun from Tanga, took
-an effective part on the 19th August, when the _Hyacinth_ reappeared
-with two gun-boats and six whalers, destroyed the steamer _Markgraf_
-and bombarded Tanga. One gun-boat was hit twice, the whalers, of which
-one steamed away with a list,[3] four times.
-
-Bombardments of the coast towns were constantly taking place. On the
-20th March a man-of-war bombarded Lindi, when its demand for the
-surrender of the troops posted there was refused. Similarly, the
-country south of Pangani was bombarded on the 1st April, the island of
-Kwale on the 12th, and the Rufiji delta on the night of the 23rd-24th.
-
-For some months past hostile patrols had been visiting the Ssonyo
-country, between Kilima Njaro and Lake Victoria, and the natives
-seemed inclined to become truculent. As a result of their treachery,
-Sergeant-Major Bast, who was sent there with a patrol, was ambushed
-on the 17th November, 1914, and lost his life with five Askari. The
-District Commissioner of Arusha, Lieutenant Kaempfe of the Reserve, who
-had been called up, undertook a punitive expedition which reduced the
-Ssonyo people to submission.
-
-It was not until July, 1915, that any further patrol encounters
-took place in this country; in one of them twenty-two hostile armed
-natives were killed. At the end of September and early October, 1915,
-Lieutenant Buechsel’s mounted patrol spent several weeks in Ssonyo and
-in the English territory without meeting the enemy, as an English post,
-which had evidently been warned, had made off.
-
-On Lake Victoria the 7th Company at Bukoba and the 14th Company at
-Muansa could communicate with each other by wireless. The command of
-the Lake was undisputedly in the hands of the English, as they had
-on it at least seven large steamers. But in spite of this our small
-steamer _Muansa_ and other smaller vessels were able to maintain great
-freedom of movement. While the Resident at Bukoba, Major von Stuemer,
-protected the frontier with his police and with auxiliaries furnished
-by friendly sultans, Captain Bock von Wülfingen had marched with
-the main body of the 7th Company from Bukoba to Muansa. From here he
-marched early in September, 1914, with a detachment composed of parts
-of the 7th and 14th Companies, Wassakuma recruits, and auxiliaries,
-along the eastern shore of Lake Victoria to the north, in the direction
-of the Uganda Railway. On the 12th September he drove back a hostile
-detachment at Kisii, beyond the border, but on hearing of the approach
-of other forces of the enemy he withdrew again to the south. After
-that the frontier east of Lake Victoria was only defended by weak
-detachments.
-
-Warfare near Lake Victoria was for us very difficult; there was always
-the danger that the enemy might land at Muansa, or some other place
-on the south shore, seize Usukuma and threaten Tabora, the historic
-capital of the country. If, however, our troops remained near Muansa,
-the country round Bukoba, and therefore also Ruanda, would be in
-danger. The best results in this area were to be expected from active
-operations under a united command. But the execution of this idea was
-not quite easy either, for Major von Stuemer, who was the most obvious
-officer to be entrusted with it, was tied by his work as Resident to
-the Bukoba District, while that of Muansa was the more important of the
-two.
-
-At the end of October, 1914, an attempt to take back part of the troops
-in boats from Muansa to Bukoba had been frustrated by the appearance
-of armed English ships at the former place. Apparently the enemy had
-deciphered our wireless messages and taken steps accordingly. On the
-31st October a force of 570 rifles, 2 guns and 4 machine guns, left
-Muansa for the relief of Bukoba on board the steamer _Muansa_, 2 tugs
-and 10 dhows, but was scattered the same morning by hostile steamers
-which suddenly appeared; they were, however, collected again at Muansa
-without loss soon afterwards. On the same day the English tried to land
-at Kayense, north of Muansa, but were prevented; a few days later, the
-English steamer _Sybil_ was found on shore at Mayita and destroyed.
-
-On the 20th November, in a twelve-hours’ action, Stuemer’s detachment
-repulsed the English troops who had penetrated into German territory,
-north of Bukoba, and defeated them again, on the 7th December,
-at Kifumbiro, after they had crossed the Kagera river. On the 5th
-December, the English bombarded Shirarti from the Lake, without
-success, and Bukoba on the 6th.
-
-Minor encounters between patrols constantly took place east and west of
-Lake Victoria. On the 8th January the enemy attempted a more ambitious
-operation; he bombarded Shirarti from the Lake with six guns and
-with machine guns, and landed two companies of Indians as well as a
-considerable number of mounted Europeans. Lieutenant von Haxthausen,
-who had only 22 rifles, gave way before this superior force after
-fighting 3-1/2 hours. The enemy’s strength was increased during the
-next few days to 300 Europeans and 700 Indians. On the 17th January,
-von Haxthausen defeated 70 Europeans and 150 Askari with 2 machine
-guns on the frontier, and on the 30th January the enemy left Shirarti
-and embarked for Karungu. I believe this withdrawal was a result of
-the severe defeat sustained by the enemy at Jassini on the 18th. He
-considered it desirable to re-concentrate his forces nearer the Uganda
-Railway, where they would be more readily available.
-
-On the west side of the Lake, Captain von Bock surprised a hostile post
-of 40 men north of Kifumbiro and drove it off with a loss of 17 killed.
-
-On the 6th March, 1915, English vessels had attacked the steamer
-_Muansa_ in Rugesi Passage. _Muansa_ had sprung a leak and went
-ashore close to the land. The enemy attempted to tow her off, but was
-prevented by our fire, so that we were able, the next day, to salve
-the steamer and get her away to Muansa, where she was repaired. The
-difficulty of moving troops by water between Muansa and Bukoba rendered
-the continuation of the single command unworkable; the officers
-commanding the two Districts were therefore placed directly under
-Headquarters.
-
-The English attempted to land at Mori Bay on the 4th March, at Ukerewe
-on the 7th, and at Musoma on the 9th; all these attempts were defeated
-by our posts. At the same time, several patrol encounters occurred near
-Shirarti, in which the commander, Lieutenant Recke, was killed, and our
-patrols were dispersed. On the 9th March, Lieutenant von Haxthausen,
-with 100 Europeans and Askari, defeated an enemy many times his
-superior at Maika Mountain; the enemy withdrew after having 17 whites
-and a considerable number of Askari killed. On our side, one European
-and 10 Askari were killed, 2 Europeans and 25 Askari wounded, while one
-wounded European was taken prisoner. Besides the 26th Field Company
-already mentioned, Muansa was reinforced by 100 Askari from Bukoba
-District, who arrived on the 6th April.
-
-Early in April a few places on the eastern shore were again bombarded
-from the Lake; at the same time some Masai made an invasion east
-of the lake, killed a missionary and several natives, and looted
-cattle. In the middle of April, Captain Braunschweig left Muansa with
-110 Europeans, 430 Askari, 2 machine guns, and 2 guns, for the Mara
-Triangle, and reinforced Lieutenant von Haxthausen. Over 500 rifles
-remained at Muansa.
-
-On the 4th May, in Mara Bay, an English steamer was hit three times by
-a ’73 pattern field-gun, which apparently prevented a landing. On the
-12th May 300 men landed at Mayita; but they steamed off again on the
-18th June, towing the wreck of the _Sybil_ with them. By the 20th May
-the enemy, who had 900 men there, had also evacuated the Mara Triangle,
-and entrenched himself on several mountains beyond the frontier.
-Bombardments of the shore took place frequently at that time.
-
-Since early December, 1914, Major von Stuemer had held a very extended
-position on the Kagera. Gradually the enemy, who was estimated at about
-300 men, became more active. He seemed to be collecting material for
-crossing the Kagera, and his ships appeared more frequently in Sango
-Bay.
-
-On the night of the 4th-5th June, on the Shirarti frontier, Becker’s
-post of 10 men was surrounded by 10 Europeans and 50 Indians of the
-98th Regiment. An armed steamer also took part. But the enemy was
-beaten, losing 2 Europeans and 5 Askari killed.
-
-I may here mention that the enemy’s armed scouts used poisoned arrows
-on the Shirarti frontier also.
-
-On the 21st June the English, with a force of 800 Europeans 400
-Askari, 300 Indians, 3 guns and 8 machine guns, and supported by the
-fire of the armed steamers, attacked Bukoba. Our garrison of little
-more than 200 rifles evacuated the place after two days of fighting.
-The enemy plundered it, destroyed the wireless tower, and left again
-on the 24th towards Kissumu. He had suffered severely, admitting 10
-Europeans killed and 22 wounded. The Germans had, however, observed
-that a steamer had left with about 150 dead and wounded on board. On
-our side 2 Europeans, 5 Askari, and 7 auxiliaries had been killed, 4
-Europeans and 30 coloured men wounded, and we also lost the gun.
-
-Of the events of the ensuing period it may be remarked that Bukoba was
-bombarded without result on the 18th July. In Mpororo a great chief
-went over to the English.
-
-On the 12th September one of the _Königsberg’s_ four-inch guns arrived
-at Muansa, where we had in process of time raised five new companies
-among the Wassukuma people.
-
-It seemed as though the enemy were rather holding back at Bukoba, and
-moving troops from there to Kissenyi. On the 29th October the English
-attacked with some one hundred rifles, machine guns, a gun, and a
-trench mortar, but were repulsed, apparently with heavy casualties.
-Hostile attacks on the lower Kagera on the 4th and 5th December were
-also unsuccessful. Several detachments of the enemy invaded the Karagwe
-country. The command at Bukoba was taken over by Captain Gudovius,
-hitherto District Commissioner in Tangarei, who marched off from Tabora
-on the 21st December, and was followed by the newly-raised 7th Reserve
-Company as a reinforcement for Bukoba.
-
-In Ruanda the energetic measures adopted by the President, Captain
-Wintgens, produced good results. On the 24th September he surprised the
-island of Ijvi in Lake Kivu, and captured the Belgian post stationed
-there, and its steel boat. Another steel boat had been captured by
-Lieutenant Wunderlich, of the Navy, who had moved to Lake Kivu with
-some men of the _Moewe_, where he had requisitioned a motor-boat. On
-the 4th October, Wintgens, with his Police Askari, some auxiliaries,
-and a few men of the _Moewe_, drove back several companies of Belgians
-north of Kissenyi, inflicting heavy casualties on them. After some
-minor engagements, Captain Wintgens then inflicted a partial defeat
-on the superior Belgian force of seventeen hundred men and six guns,
-north of Kissenyi, on the 20th and 30th November, and again on the 2nd
-December, 1914. Near Lake Tshahafi he drove out an English post. One
-Englishman and twenty Askari were killed; we had two Askari killed and
-one European severely wounded.
-
-After that, in February, 1915, several minor actions were fought
-near Kissenyi and on the frontier. On the 28th May, Lieutenant Lang,
-commanding the small garrison of Kissenyi, beat off the Belgians, who
-had seven hundred men and two machine guns. The enemy sustained heavy
-losses; we had one European killed.
-
-In June, 1915, it was said that over two thousand Belgian Askari, with
-nine guns, and five hundred English Askari were concentrated near Lake
-Kivu, the fact that the Belgian Commander-in-Chief, Tombeur, went to
-Lake Kivu makes this information appear probable. On the 21st June the
-Belgians attacked Kissenyi with nine hundred men, two machine guns and
-two guns, but were repulsed. On the 5th July they again attacked the
-place by night with four hundred men, and suffered severe losses. On
-the 3rd August Kissenyi was ineffectively bombarded by artillery and
-machine guns. In consequence of the crushing superiority of the enemy,
-the 26th Field Company was transferred from Muansa to Kissenyi.
-
-Immediately after the arrival of this company at Kissenyi, on the
-31st August, Captain Wintgens defeated the Belgian outposts, of whom
-ten Askari were killed. On September 2nd he took by storm a position
-held by one hundred and fifty Askari, with three guns and one machine
-gun. During the next few weeks minor actions were fought every day. On
-the 3rd October an attack on Kissenyi by two hundred and fifty Askari
-with a machine gun was repulsed, and fourteen casualties were observed
-among the enemy. After that, possibly in consequence of the action at
-Luwungi on the 27th September, considerable forces of the enemy were
-discovered to have marched off for the south.
-
-On the 22nd October another Belgian detached post of three hundred
-Askari, with two guns and two machine guns, was surprised, when
-the enemy had ten Askari killed. On the 26th November the Ruanda
-Detachment, with one platoon of the 7th Company, which had arrived
-from Bukoba, in all three hundred and twenty rifles, four machine guns
-and one 1.45-inch gun, drove the enemy, numbering two hundred, out of
-a fortified position, when he lost two Europeans and seventy Askari
-killed, five Askari prisoners, and many wounded. We had one European
-and three Askari killed, four Europeans, five Askari and one auxiliary
-wounded. On the 21st December the enemy once more attacked Kissenyi
-with one thousand Askari, two machine guns and eight guns, including
-four modern 2.75-inch howitzers. He left behind twenty-one dead Askari,
-three were captured, wounded, and many wounded were carried away. Our
-force of three hundred and fifty rifles, four machine guns and two
-guns, had three Askari killed, one European and one Askari severely
-wounded.
-
-On the 12th January, 1916, Captain Wintgens surprised a Belgian
-column north of Kissenyi, killing eleven Belgian Askari. On the 27th
-January Captain Klinghardt, with three companies, beat off an attack
-on the Kissenyi position made by two thousand Belgian Askari with hand
-grenades and twelve guns, inflicting severe casualties on them.
-
- * * * * *
-
-In the Russissi country there were also numerous engagements.
-Successful minor actions between German patrols and Congo troops had
-taken place on the 10th and 13th October, 1914, at Changugu, on the
-21st and 22nd at Chiwitoke, and on the 24th at Kajagga.
-
-On the 12th January, 1915, Captain Schimmer attacked a Belgian camp at
-Luwungi, but the intended surprise was unsuccessful. Captain Zimmer and
-three Askari were killed and five wounded.
-
-Then, on the 16th, 17th and 20th March small patrol skirmishes took
-place, and on the 20th May a Belgian post was surprised. There was thus
-incessant fighting, which continued in June and July. In August the
-enemy seemed to be increasing his forces in that region. The command on
-the Russissi was now taken over by Captain Schulz; the forces we had
-there now consisted of four field companies, part of the crew of the
-_Moewe_, and the Urundi Detachment, which about equalled one company.
-There were also two light guns there. On the 27th September Captain
-Schulz attacked Luwungi, when we were able to establish that the enemy
-lost fifty-four Askari killed, and we also counted seventy-one Askari
-hit. So the enemy’s losses amounted to about two hundred, as confirmed
-by native reports received later. We had four Europeans and twenty
-Askari killed, nine Europeans and thirty-four Askari wounded.
-
-Owing to the nature of the country and the relative strengths, we were
-unable to achieve a decisive success on the Russissi. Only the Urundi
-Detachment and one field company were, therefore, left there; two
-companies left on the 18th and 19th December, 1915, to join Captain
-Wintgens in Ruanda; three others moved to the Central Railway.
-
-On the 19th October the enemy met the 14th Reserve Company, and
-although outnumbering it by two to one, lost twenty Askari, while we
-had three Askari killed and twelve wounded. Although the Belgian main
-camp, which reliable natives reported to contain two thousand Askari,
-was so near, it was possible to reduce the troops on the Russissi in
-favour of other districts, since on both sides the conditions seemed
-unfavourable for an offensive. The Urundi Detachment and the 14th
-Reserve Company remained on the Russissi under Major von Langenn.
-
- * * * * *
-
-On Lake Tanganyika, at the beginning of the war, Captain Zimmer had
-collected about one hundred men of the _Moewe_, and in Usambara, about
-one hundred Askari; in addition, he had a few Europeans who were called
-up in Kigoma, also some one hundred Askari belonging to the posts in
-Urundi and from Ruanda (Wintgens)—all told, about four hundred rifles.
-
-On the 22nd August, 1914, Lieutenant Horn, of the _Moewe_, commanding
-the small armed steamer _Hedwig von Wissmann_, fought a successful
-action against the Belgian steamer _Delcommune_. The captain of the
-_Moewe_, Lieutenant-Commander Zimmer, had gone to Kigoma with his crew,
-after destroying his ship, which had been blown up in August, 1914. The
-steamer _Kingani_, which had also been transported to the same place by
-rail from Dar-es-Salaam, and several smaller craft on Lake Tanganyika,
-were then armed and put in commission by Lieutenant-Commander Zimmer.
-He also mounted a 3·5-inch naval gun on a raft and bombarded a number
-of Belgian stations on the shore. He strongly fortified Kigoma itself,
-and developed it into a base for naval warfare on Lake Tanganyika.
-
-On the 20th November, 1914, the Bismarckburg Detachment (half company),
-co-operating with the small armed steamers _Hedwig von Wissmann_ and
-_Kingani_, drove off a Belgian company in the bay west of Bismarckburg,
-captured four ·43-inch machine guns and over ninety miles of telegraph
-wire, which was used to continue the line Kilossa-Iringa up to New
-Langenburg, a work which was, from a military point of view, extremely
-urgent.
-
-Early in October attempts were made to complete the destruction of the
-Belgian steamer _Delcommune_, which was lying at Baraka, on the Congo
-shore, but without success. After bombarding her once more on the 23rd
-October, Captain Zimmer looked upon her as permanently out of action.
-On the 27th February, 1915, the crew of the _Hedwig von Wissmann_
-surprised a Belgian post at Tombwe, and captured its machine gun.
-One Belgian officer and ten Askari were killed, one severely wounded
-Belgian officer and one Englishman were captured. We had one Askari
-killed, one European mortally wounded, one Askari severely wounded.
-
-In March, 1915, the Belgians made arrests on a large scale in Ubwari,
-the inhabitants of which had shown themselves friendly to us, and
-hanged a number of people.
-
-According to wireless messages which we took in, several Belgian
-whale-boats were got ready on Lake Tanganyika during June, and work
-was being carried on on a new Belgian steamer, the _Baron Dhanis_. On
-our side the steamer _Goetzen_ was completed on the 9th June, 1915,
-and taken over by the Force. She rendered good service in effecting
-movements of troops on Lake Tanganyika.
-
-The Police at Bismarckburg, under Lieutenant Haun of the Reserve,
-the capable administrator of the Baziots, had joined the Protective
-Force. Several skirmishes took place in hostile territory, and in this
-district also the enemy was, on the whole, kept successfully at a
-distance.
-
-It was not till early in February, 1915, that several hundred hostile
-Askari invaded Abercorn, and some of them penetrated to near Mwasge
-Mission, but then retired.
-
-Then, in the middle of March, Lieutenant Haun’s force was surprised in
-camp at Mount Kito by an Anglo-Belgian detachment. The Commander was
-severely wounded and taken prisoner, and several Askari were killed.
-Lieutenant Aumann, with a force subsequently formed into a company,
-was detached from Captain Falkenstein, and covered the German border
-in the neighbourhood of Mbozi, where, in February, 1915, detachments
-several hundred strong had frequently invaded German territory; at the
-end of March an unknown number of Europeans were reported in Karonga,
-while at Fife and other places on the frontier there were some eight
-hundred men. So the enemy appeared to be preparing to attack. He was
-patrolling as far as the country near Itaka, and early in April it was
-reported that Kituta, at the southern end of Lake Tanganyika, had been
-entrenched by the Belgians. Major von Langenn, who, after recovering
-from his severe wound—he had lost an eye—was working on the Russissi
-river, was entrusted with the conduct of operations in the well-known
-Bismarckburg-Langenburg country. Besides the 5th Field Company, which
-he had formerly commanded, and which was stationed at Ipyana and in the
-Mbozi country, he was also given the Bismarckburg Detachment, strength
-about one company, and three companies which were brought up from
-Dar-es-Salaam and Kigoma. During their passage to Bismarckburg on the
-Lake successful actions were fought east of that place by our patrols
-against hostile raiding parties of fifty to two hundred and fifty men.
-
-[Illustration: Native Women.
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-[Illustration: Natives bringing food.
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-By the 7th May, 1915, Major von Langenn had assembled four companies at
-Mwasge; a Belgian detachment stationed in front of him withdrew. On the
-23rd May Lieutenant von Delschitz’s patrol drove off a Belgian company,
-of which two Europeans and six Askari were killed. On the 24th orders
-were sent to Langenn to move with three companies to New Langenburg to
-meet the attack which was reported to be impending in that quarter.
-General Wahle took over the command in the Bismarckburg area. The
-latter arrived at Kigoma on the 6th June, and collected at Bismarckburg
-the Bismarckburg Detachment, now re-formed as the 29th Field Company,
-as well as the 24th Field Company and a half-company of Europeans
-brought up from Dar-es-Salaam.
-
-On the 28th June General Wahle attacked Jericho Farm with two and a
-half companies, but broke off the engagement on realizing that this
-fortified position could not be taken without artillery. We had three
-Europeans and four Askari killed, two Europeans and twenty-two Askari
-wounded. General Wahle was reinforced by two companies from Langenburg.
-
-Since the 25th July, 1915, General Wahle was besieging the enemy,
-who was strongly entrenched at Jericho, with four companies and two
-1873-pattern guns. Relief expeditions from Abercorn were defeated, but
-the siege was raised on the 2nd August, as no effect could be produced
-with the guns available. General Wahle returned to Dar-es-Salaam with
-three companies. The 29th Company remained at Jericho, the two guns at
-Kigoma.
-
-On the 19th June the _Goetzen_ towed off the steamer _Cecil Rhodes_,
-which was lying beached at Kituta, and sank her.
-
-During September and October there were continual skirmishes between
-patrols on the border near Bismarckburg; Belgian reinforcements again
-invaded the country about Abercorn. On the 3rd December it was observed
-that the defences of Jericho had been abandoned and dismantled. A new
-fort, north-east of Abercorn, was bombarded by Lieutenant Franken on
-the 6th December with one hundred rifles and one machine gun; the enemy
-appeared to sustain some casualties.
-
-The English Naval Expedition, the approach of which, by Bukoma and
-Elizabethville, had long been under observation, had reached the
-Lukuga Railway on the 22nd October, 1919. We picked up leaflets which
-stated that a surprise was being prepared for the Germans on Lake
-Tanganyika; this made me think that we might now have to deal with
-specially-built small craft which might possibly be equipped with
-torpedoes. We had, therefore, to meet a very serious menace to our
-command of Lake Tanganyika, which might prove decisive to our whole
-campaign. The simultaneous transfer of hostile troops towards Lake Kivu
-and Abercorn proved that an offensive by land was to be co-ordinated
-with the expedition. In order to defeat the enemy if possible while
-his concentration was still in progress, Captain Schulz attacked the
-Belgians at Luwungi on the 27th September, inflicting heavy loss.
-
-On the night of the 28th October the steamer _Kingani_ surprised a
-Belgian working-party, who were constructing a telegraph line, and
-captured some stores. In the mouth of the Lukuga river a railway
-train was observed on the move. At last, the _Kingani_ did not return
-from a reconnaissance to the mouth of the Lukuga, and, according to
-a Belgian wireless message of the 31st December, she had been lost,
-four Europeans and eight natives were said to have been killed, the
-remainder to have been captured. Evidently, the favourable opportunity
-for interfering with the enemy’s preparations for gaining command of
-the Lake had passed.
-
-Then, on the 9th February, 1916, another of our armed steamers was
-captured by the enemy.
-
-On Lake Nyassa the German steamer _Hermann von Wissmann_, whose captain
-did not know that war had broken out, was surprised and taken by the
-English Government steamer _Gwendolen_ on the 13th August, 1914.
-
-On the 9th September, 1914, Captain von Langenn, with his 5th Field
-Company, which was stationed at Massoko, near New Langenburg, had
-attacked the English station of Karongo. In the action with the
-English, who were holding a fortified position, Captain von Langenn
-himself was severely wounded. The two company officers were also
-severely wounded and taken prisoners. The German non-commissioned
-officers and the Askari fought very gallantly, but were obliged to
-recognize that they could do nothing against the enemy’s entrenchments,
-and, therefore, broke off the hopeless engagement. Over twenty Askari
-had been killed, several machine guns and light guns had been lost.
-Reinforcements from the 2nd Company at once arrived from Iringa and
-Ubena, and several hundred Wahehe auxiliaries were raised. Gradually
-it turned out that the enemy had also suffered severely. He avoided
-expeditions on a large scale against the Langenburg District, and so
-this fertile country, which was so necessary to us as a source of
-supply, remained in our possession for eighteen months.
-
-Later on our company at Langenburg moved its main body nearer the
-border to Ipyana Mission. On the 2nd November an affair of outposts
-occurred on the Lufira river, and the steamer _Gwendolen_ on Lake
-Nyassa was hit several times by our artillery.
-
-Early in December, 1914, some fighting between patrols took place
-north of Karongo, on the Ssongwe river. Lieutenant Dr. Gothein, of
-the Medical Corps, who had been returned to us from captivity by the
-English in May, 1915, told us that in the first action at Karongo, on
-the 9th September, 1914, the enemy had had six Europeans and fifty
-Askari killed, and seven Europeans and more than fifty Askari severely
-wounded. The English spies were very active, especially through the
-agency of the “Vali,” the native administrative official, on the
-Ssongwe.
-
-In May, 1915, we were able to effect several successful surprises
-on the frontier. The rains were late, so that we could consider the
-southern part of Langenburg District as safe from attack until the end
-of June.
-
-In June, 1915, when Major von Langenn had arrived with his
-reinforcements, there were, contrary to our expectations, no
-considerable actions. We made use of the time to dismantle a telegraph
-line in English territory, and to put it up again in our own, in the
-direction of Ubena. In August, the rumours of an intended attack by
-the enemy were again falsified. It was not till the 8th October that
-considerable hostile forces of Europeans and Askari arrived at Fife.
-On this border also there were numerous little skirmishes. Towards the
-end of the year the arrival of fresh reinforcements at Ikawa was also
-established. In that region, on the 23rd December, 1915, Captain Aumann
-repulsed a force of about 60 Europeans with 2 machine guns, who were
-attempting a surprise.
-
-On the shores of Lake Nyassa there were only insignificant encounters.
-
-On the 30th May the English landed 30 Europeans, 200 Askari, 2 guns
-and 2 machine guns at Sphinx Harbour. We had there 13 rifles and one
-machine gun, who inflicted on them, apparently, over 20 casualties,
-whereupon, after destroying the wreck of the _Hermann von Wissmann_,
-they retired.
-
-
-
-
-PART II
-
-THE CONCENTRIC ATTACK BY SUPERIOR FORCES
-
-(From the arrival of the South African troops to the loss of the
-Colony)
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER I
-
-THE ENEMY’S ATTACK AT OLDOROBO MOUNTAIN
-
-
-EAST of Oldorobo the enemy now frequently showed considerable bodies of
-troops, amounting to 1,000 or more men, who deployed in the direction
-of the mountain at great distances, but did not approach it closely.
-These movements, therefore, were exercises, by which the young European
-troops from South Africa were to be trained to move and fight in the
-bush.
-
-Early in February the enemy advanced against Oldorobo from the east
-with several regiments. For us it was desirable that he should take
-so firm a hold there that he could not get away again, so that we
-could defeat him by means of a counter-attack with Captain Schulz’
-Detachment, encamped at Taveta. Other German detachments, of several
-companies each, were stationed west of Taveta on the road to New Moshi,
-and on that to Kaho, at New Steglitz Plantation.
-
-On the 12th February again, European troops, estimated at several
-regiments, advanced to within 300 yards of Oldorobo. Headquarters at
-New Moshi, which was in constant telephonic communication with Major
-Kraut, considered that the favourable opportunity had now presented
-itself, and ordered fire to be opened. The effect of our machine-guns,
-and our two light guns, had been reported to be good, when Headquarters
-left New Moshi by car for the field of battle. Schulz’ Detachment was
-ordered to march from Taveta along the rear of Kraut’s Detachment,
-covered from the fire of the enemy’s heavy artillery, and to make a
-decisive attack on the enemy’s right, or northern, wing. The troops at
-New Steglitz advanced to Taveta, where some fantastic reports came in
-about hostile armoured cars, which were alleged to be moving through
-the thorn-bush desert. The imagination of the natives, to whom these
-armoured cars were something altogether new and surprising, had made
-them see ghosts. On arriving on Oldorobo, Headquarters was informed
-by telephone that the enemy, who had attacked our strongly entrenched
-front, had been repulsed with heavy losses, and that Schulz’ Detachment
-was fully deployed and advancing against his right flank. The numerous
-English howitzer shells which fell in our position on Oldorobo did
-hardly any damage, although they were very well placed. In contrast
-to the great expenditure of ammunition by the hostile artillery, our
-light guns had to restrict themselves to taking advantage of specially
-favourable targets, not only because ammunition was scarce, but also
-because we had no shrapnel. The enemy retreated through the bush in
-disorder. We buried more than 60 Europeans. According to prisoners’
-statements and captured papers, three regiments of the 2nd South
-African Infantry Brigade had been in action. According to the documents
-it appeared that in recruiting the men the prospect of acquiring farms
-and plantations had been used as a bait. The sudden illness of the
-British General Smith-Dorrien, who was already on his way out to take
-over command in East Africa, may not have been altogether inconvenient
-to the English. The transfer of the command to a South African, General
-Smuts, re-acted favourably on recruiting in South Africa. The training
-of these newly raised formations was slight, and the conduct of the
-Europeans, many of whom were very young, proved that many had never yet
-taken part in a serious action. After the action of Oldorobo, however,
-we observed that the enemy sought very thoroughly to make good the
-deficiencies in his training.
-
-In spite of pursuit by Schulz’ Detachment, and repeated fire opened
-on collections of hostile troops, the enemy, owing to the difficult
-and close nature of the country, made good his escape to his fortified
-camps.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. vii. Battle of Yasin (Jassini).]
-
-[Illustration: Fig. viii. Kilima Njaro and Masai Desert.]
-
-[Illustration: Fig. ix. Battle of Reata.]
-
-[Illustration: Fig. x. Battle of Kahe.]
-
-It was interesting to find, in several diaries we picked up, notes to
-the effect that strict orders had been given to take no prisoners. As
-a matter of fact the enemy had taken none, but it seemed advisable
-nevertheless to address an inquiry to the British Commander, in order
-that we might regulate our conduct towards the English prisoners
-accordingly. There is no reason to doubt Brigadier-General Malleson’s
-statement that no such order was given; but this case, and several
-later instances, show what nonsense is to be found in private diaries.
-It was quite wrong on the part of the enemy if he accepted the German
-notes which fell into his hands as true, without detailed investigation.
-
-At this time also the hostile troops on Longido Mountain had been
-considerably reinforced. This mountain had been evacuated by the
-enemy, probably owing to difficulties of supply, but had latterly
-been re-occupied. The rock is covered with dense vegetation, and our
-patrols had several times ascended it and examined the enemy’s camps at
-close quarters. It is at any time difficult correctly to estimate the
-strength of troops, but in bush country, where more than a few men are
-never to be seen at a time, and where the view is constantly changing,
-it is impossible. The reports of the natives were too inaccurate. On
-the whole, however, we could but conclude from the general situation,
-and from the increased quantity of supplies which were being brought
-to Longido from the north, by ox wagon, without interruption, that the
-enemy was being considerably reinforced.
-
-His raids into the Kilima Njaro country had been repulsed with
-slaughter. When a squadron of Indian Lancers moved south, between
-Kilima Njaro and Meru Mountain, it was at once vigorously attacked
-by one of our mounted patrols under Lieutenant Freiherr von Lyncker.
-Our Askari had come to understand the great value of saddle-horses in
-our operations, and charged the enemy, who was mounted, with the cry:
-“Wahindi, kameta frasi!” (“They are Indians, catch the horses!”) The
-Indians were so surprised by the rapidity of our people that they fled
-in confusion, leaving some of their horses behind. Among others the
-gallant European commander had been left dead on the field; he had not
-been able to prevent his men from losing their heads.
-
-I should like to remark generally that during this first period of
-the war the conduct of the British regular officers was invariably
-chivalrous, and that the respect they paid us was fully reciprocated.
-But our Askari also earned the respect of the enemy by their bravery
-in action and their humane conduct. On the 10th March the English
-Lieutenant Barrett was severely wounded and fell into our hands;
-owing to false accounts he thought his last moment had come, and was
-surprised when our Askari, who had no European with them, tied him up
-as well as they could and carried him to a doctor. In his astonishment
-he remarked: “Why, your Askari are gentlemen.” How greatly the English
-soldiers had been misled I learned on the 12th February from a young
-South African captured on Oldorobo, who asked whether he was going to
-be shot. Of course we laughed at him. No doubt, in a long war, cases of
-brutality and inhumanity do occur. But that happens on both sides, and
-one should not generalize from isolated cases, and exploit them for the
-purpose of unworthy agitation, as has been done by the English Press.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER II
-
-FURTHER ADVANCE OF THE ENEMY AND THE ACTION AT REATA
-
-
-AT that time we noticed the first parties of hostile spies, and
-captured some of them. They were “Shensi” (innocent-looking natives),
-who, as a proof of having really reached the objective of their
-mission, had to bring back certain objects, such as parts of the
-permanent way of the Usambara Railway. The general review of the
-situation showed that the enemy was making a detailed reconnaissance
-of the Usambara Railway and the approaches to it. A glance at the
-map shows that a simultaneous advance by the enemy from Oldorobo and
-Longido towards New Moshi was bound to entail the loss of the Kilima
-Njaro country, which was of value to us from the point of view of
-maintenance. If, however, we wanted to retire before a superior enemy
-on our main line of communication, we should be obliged to move our
-main forces along the Usambara Railway, thus making almost an acute
-angle with the direction of an attack coming from Oldorobo. The
-danger of being cut off by the enemy from this, our principal line of
-communication, was for us very great. Should the enemy advance north
-of Lake Jipe, he would be cramped by Kilima Njaro and by the steep
-group of the North Pare Mountains. It is obvious that in that case his
-advance directly on Kahe would be the most inconvenient for us, and if
-successful, would cut the Usambara Railway, our line of communications.
-But it would be even more serious for us if the enemy should pass south
-of Lake Jipe, and press forward by the valley leading between the North
-and Middle Pare, to the Northern Railway, south of Lembeni. Finally,
-he could reach the railway by way of the valley at Same, between the
-Middle and South Pare. In his advance on Lembeni and Same the enemy
-would be able to make a road suitable for motor traffic with rapidity,
-and in places without preparation, across the open plain, and to base
-his operations upon it.
-
-The small forces we had in the Kilima Njaro country—about 4,000
-rifles—rendered it impossible to divide them in order to render
-ourselves secure against all these possibilities. Even for purely
-defensive reasons we must keep our forces concentrated and maintain
-close touch with the enemy, in order to hold him fast where we were,
-and thus keep his movements under observation. It was from the outset
-very doubtful whether we could in succession defeat the two main
-hostile groups, whose advance towards the Kilima Njaro country was to
-be expected from Longido and Makatau, and which were each considerably
-stronger than ourselves. There was no prospect of doing so unless our
-troops could be moved with lightning rapidity, first against one of
-the enemy’s forces and then, just as quickly, against the other. The
-necessary preparations were made, and after personal reconnaissance,
-a number of cross-country tracks in the rugged forest country north
-of the great road which leads from New Moshi to the west were decided
-upon. As it happened, no considerable use was made of these tracks.
-It would not do to be afraid of trying anything ninety-nine times, if
-there was a chance of succeeding at the hundredth. In following this
-principle we did not do badly.
-
-The enemy’s activity increased, and he displayed good training in
-numerous minor encounters. He had also raised a number of new Askari
-formations, largely recruited among the intelligent tribes of the
-Wyassa country. Being only sparsely covered with bush, and therefore
-very open, the desert country lying to the north-west of Kilima Njaro
-did not favour sudden offensive operations by us; for this purpose the
-dense bush district between Kilima Njaro and Meru Mountain itself,
-which the enemy, coming from Longido, would probably have to traverse,
-was more promising. Here we concentrated a detachment of some 1,000
-rifles, composed of five selected Askari Companies. But, owing to the
-limited range of vision, this detachment did not succeed in forcing
-a decisive engagement on any of the numerous hostile columns which
-pushed down to the south in the beginning of March. The enemy, also,
-had great difficulty in finding his way; and we only learned from an
-Indian despatch-rider, who brought a report to us instead of to his own
-people, that the 1st East African Division, under General Stewart, was
-in this district. As these encounters took place in the neighbourhood
-of Gararagua, and south-west of that place, it was too far away for
-our reserves at New Steglitz and Himo to intervene. (It is about two
-marches from Gararagua to New Moshi.) Before the chance of doing so
-arrived the enemy also advanced from the east. The direction taken by
-the enemy’s airmen showed his evident interest in the country one or
-two hours north of Taveta. One was bound to hit on the idea that the
-enemy encamped east of Oldorobo did not intend to get his head broken
-a second time on that mountain, but meant to work round the position
-by the north, and so reach the Lumi River, one hour north of Taveta.
-On the 8th March observers on Oldorobo noticed huge clouds of dust
-moving from the enemy’s camp in that direction. Numerous motors were
-also seen. From East Kitovo, a mountain four miles west of Taveta,
-Headquarters also observed these movements. Our fighting patrols, who
-were able to fire with effect on the hostile columns, and to take a few
-prisoners, established with certainty that the enemy’s main force was
-approaching at this point, and that General Smuts was present.
-
-On the afternoon of the 8th March Headquarters observed strong hostile
-columns near Lake Dsalla, who advanced from there in a widely extended
-line of skirmishers for some distance towards East Kitovo. On this
-occasion, and on many others, our want of artillery obliged us to
-look on quietly while the enemy executed unskilful movements at no
-great distance from our front. But it was evident that this enveloping
-movement of the enemy rendered the Oldorobo position, to which we owed
-many successful engagements during the course of the war, untenable.
-I therefore decided to deploy the troops for a fresh stand on the
-mountains which close the gap between the North Pare Mountains and
-Kilima Njaro to the westward of Taveta. Kraut’s Detachment was ordered
-by telephone to take up a position on the Resta-Latema Mountains, on
-the road leading from Taveta to New Steglitz. North-west of Latema
-Mountain, on the road from Taveta to Himo, Schulz’s Detachment
-occupied the mountains of North Kitovo, and covered the move of
-Kraut’s Detachment. These movements were executed by night, without
-being interfered with by the enemy. On our extreme left wing, on the
-south-eastern slopes of Kilima Njaro, Captain Stemmermann’s Company
-blocked the road leading from Rombo Mission to Himo and New Moshi.
-Rombo Mission was occupied by the enemy. Some of the natives made no
-attempt to conceal the fact that they now adhered to the English. This
-lends colour to the supposition that English espionage and propaganda
-among the natives had for a long time been going on in this district,
-and that the light-signals which had often been seen on the eastern
-slopes of Kilima Njaro had some connection with it.
-
-The mountain position taken up by us was very favourable as regards
-ground, but suffered from the great disadvantage that our few thousand
-Askari were far too few really to fill up the front, which was some
-12 miles in extent. Only a few points in the front line could be
-occupied; the bulk of the force was kept at my disposal at Himo, to
-be brought into action according to how the situation might develop.
-It was a time of great tension. Before us was the greatly superior
-enemy; behind us, advancing to the south from Londigo, another superior
-opponent, while our communications, which also formed our line of
-retreat, were threatened by the enemy in the very unpleasant manner
-already described. But, in view of the ground, which we knew, and the
-apparently not too skilful tactical leading on the part of the enemy,
-I did not think it impossible to give at least one of his detachments
-a thorough beating. The positions on the line Reata-North Kitovo were
-therefore to be prepared for a stubborn defence. From Tanga, one of
-the _Königsberg’s_ guns mounted there was brought up by rail. The
-reader will rightly ask why this had not been done long before. But the
-gun had no wheels, and fired from a fixed pivot, so that it was very
-immobile. It is therefore comprehensible that we delayed bringing it
-into action until there could be no doubt as to the precise spot where
-it would be wanted.
-
-The situation now developed so rapidly that the gun could not be used
-against Taveta. It was therefore mounted near the railway at Kahe,
-on the south bank of the Pangani River, from which position it did
-excellent service later in the actions at Kahe.
-
-On the 10th March the enemy reconnoitred along our whole front. Mounted
-detachments of about 50 men rode up, dismounted, and then advanced in
-a widely extended line, leading their horses, until they were fired
-on. This was their object. The fire disclosed our positions, although
-imperfectly. This method of reconnaissance gave us the opportunity for
-scoring local successes, which cost the enemy a certain number of men,
-and brought us in some score of horses. From North Kitovo Mountain we
-could plainly see how portions of our firing line, taking advantage
-of favourable situations, rapidly advanced and fired upon the enemy’s
-reconnoitring parties from several directions. To me the force employed
-by the enemy in these enterprises appeared too large to be explained
-by the mere intention of reconnaissance; they looked to me more like
-serious but somewhat abortive attacks. It was not yet possible to
-form a clear idea of the direction from which the enemy’s main attack
-would come. The tactical difficulties of enveloping our left (north)
-wing were far less, but this operation would prevent him from exerting
-effective pressure on our communications. The direction from Taveta
-through Reata towards Kahe would be the worst for us, but entailed
-for the enemy a difficult frontal attack on the fortified heights of
-Reata and Latema, which promised but little success even if made in
-greatly superior strength. I, therefore, thought it advisable to move
-Captain Koehl with two companies so close up in rear of Major Kraut’s
-Detachment, which was on the high ground between Reata and Latema, that
-we could intervene rapidly without waiting for orders. For the moment,
-telephonic communication with our detachments was secure. But it was to
-be anticipated that it would become at least very difficult, so soon
-as any detachment moved away from the existing lines. There was no
-material available for rapidly laying a cable that could follow moving
-troops. We were also deficient of light wireless apparatus, by means
-of which later on the English successfully controlled the movements of
-their columns in the bush.
-
-On the 11th March another aeroplane appeared over New Moshi and dropped
-a few bombs. I was just talking to an old Boer about the fight on the
-12th February, and saying that the English were incurring a grave
-responsibility in ruthlessly exposing so many young men, who were quite
-ignorant of the Tropics, to the dangers of our climate and of tropical
-warfare. Major Kraut reported from Reata that strong hostile forces
-were moving up towards his positions from the direction of Taveta. Soon
-after, a powerful attack was made by several thousand men on the three
-companies holding our position. Our three light guns could, of course,
-not engage in a duel with the heavy artillery, and, as at Oldorobo, had
-to restrict themselves to employing their few shells against the denser
-masses of the enemy at favourable moments. Knowing the difficulties
-of the ground, I thought the attack had little prospect of success,
-but the two companies of Captain Koehl held in readiness behind Major
-Kraut’s Detachment were, nevertheless, sent in to attack. Captain
-Koehl, who had originally intended to attack the enemy in flank, which
-would have suited the situation and proved decisive, was obliged to
-recognize that in the unknown and dense bush this was impossible. The
-time and place, and, therefore, the effectiveness of this attack,
-would have become matters of pure chance. He, therefore, quite rightly
-marched up to the immediate support of Major Kraut. From what I could
-observe for myself from North Kitovo, and according to the reports
-that came in, it appeared that the enemy wanted to keep us occupied in
-front from Reata to Kitovo, while his decisive movement was being made
-round our left wing. In the first instance large bodies of horsemen
-were moving in that direction who appeared and disappeared again among
-the heights and gullies of the south-east slopes of Kilima Njaro. The
-11th Company, under Captain Stemmermann, which was on the slopes
-above these horsemen, prevented them from reaching the summit. During
-the course of the afternoon the leading horsemen had worked their way
-through the dense banana-plantations to near Marangu. They appeared
-to be very exhausted. Some of them were seen to be eating the unripe
-bananas.
-
-During the afternoon it became evident that the enemy was making a
-strong frontal attack against Kraut’s Detachment on Reata and Latema
-Mountain. But the telephonic reports were favourable: the enemy was
-obviously suffering heavy casualties; hundreds of stretchers were
-being employed in getting away the wounded. By evening all the enemy’s
-attacks on our front had been repulsed with heavy losses. In the
-darkness Captain Koehl’s two companies had pursued with energy and
-opened machine-gun fire on the enemy when he tried to make a stand.
-In the evening I had gone to Himo, and about 11 p.m. I was engaged
-in issuing orders for an attack to be made early on the 12th on the
-enemy’s horsemen, whose presence had been established at Marangu. Just
-then Lieutenant Sternheim, commanding the guns with Kraut’s Detachment,
-telephoned that the enemy had attacked once more in the night and had
-penetrated into the Reata position in great force. This report made
-it appear probable that this strong hostile force would now press
-forward from Reata in the direction of Kahe, and cut us off from our
-communications. To accept this risk, and still carry out the attack
-on the enemy at Marangu, appeared to be too dangerous. I therefore
-ordered the troops at Kitovo and Himo to fall back during the night
-to the Reata-Kahe road. As a covering force Stemmermann’s Company was
-for the time being to remain at Himo. This march was bound to entail
-the unpleasant consequence that, at the very best, all communication
-between Headquarters and the various units would cease. Anyone who has
-experienced these night marches knows also how easily some parts of the
-force may become entirely detached and cannot be reached for ever and
-a day. Fortunately I had at least some knowledge of the ground, as we
-moved across country to the new road, while we heard continuous heavy
-firing going on on Reata and Latema Mountains. A few stragglers who
-had lost their way in the bush came towards us; when we said we were
-Germans they did not believe us, and disappeared again. On the new road
-we found the dressing station. Here, too, the reports of the numerous
-wounded were so contradictory and obscure that one could only gather
-the impression of very heavy fighting in the bush at close quarters,
-but failed to learn anything of its various phases or results. By and
-by we got through on the telephone to Major Kraut, who, with part
-of his detachment, was on the Kahe-Taveta road, on the south-west
-slope of Reata Mountain. On the heights the fire had gradually died
-down, and his patrols had found no more trace of the enemy on Reata
-Mountain. Early in the morning of the 12th Major Kraut found some of
-his detachment again in their old positions on the hills: the enemy had
-fallen back to Taveta.
-
-When I arrived at Reata Mountain at six in the morning the great
-quantity of booty was being collected. Very great confusion had
-occurred in the close-quarter fighting by night. English dead, who
-were lying in the bush far in rear of the front of Kraut’s Detachment,
-proved that certain detachments of the enemy had got behind our
-line. Individual snipers, hidden away among the rocks, maintained a
-well-aimed fire, and could not be dislodged. It was, however, clear
-that the enemy had been repulsed with heavy casualties. Both our own
-wounded and those of the enemy were got away without a hitch, and so
-were the prisoners. With the detachments that were moving from the
-vicinity of Himo through the dense bush to the Kahe-Reata road we had
-no communication, and could expect to have none for several hours more.
-
-In this situation it was regrettable that I had ordered the troops
-forming our left wing, who had been posted between Kitovo and Himo, to
-withdraw to the Kahe-Reata road. After giving up the high ground held
-by our left wing the Reata position would in time become untenable, the
-more so as it had no supply of water, which had to be brought up from
-a place an hour’s march further back. It was impossible to turn back
-the units of the left wing to reoccupy the Himo-Kitovo area, as we
-were at the moment completely out of touch with them, and, as has been
-mentioned, there was no expectation of regaining it for hours to come.
-I decided to evacuate the Reata position, and after the battlefield was
-cleared I returned with the line that was nearest to the enemy to the
-water south-west of Reata Mountain. In the course of the day the other
-detachments reached the Kahe-Reata road at different points further to
-the rear and encamped.
-
-Headquarters moved to New Steglitz Plantation. The buildings are
-situated half-way between Kahe and Reata, on a slight elevation
-affording a distant view over the forest, which is particularly dense
-along the Kahe-Reata road. On the way I met Captain Schoenfeld, who
-reported that he had mounted his 4-inch gun out of the _Königsberg_
-near Kahe village on the south bank of the Pangani. After our
-withdrawal the enemy occupied Reata Mountain and for a while fired into
-the blue with light guns and rifles.
-
-During the next few days we observed the advance of strong hostile
-forces from the direction of Taveta to Himo, and the pitching of large
-camps at that place. Against the Little Himo, a mountain in front of
-our line which we were not holding, the enemy developed a powerful
-attack from the east, across a perfectly open plain, which, after a
-long and heavy bombardment of the empty hill, ended in its capture.
-Unfortunately, we were unable to move our troops sufficiently rapidly
-to come down upon this attack out of the thick bush. From the Little
-Himo the enemy frequently bombarded the Plantation building of New
-Steglitz with light artillery. Some weeks before, after a successful
-buffalo-hunt, I had enjoyed a hospitable hour in the few rooms of this
-building. The native who had guided us on that occasion had deserted
-to the English. Now it provided decidedly cramped accommodation for
-Headquarters and the telephone exchange. I myself was lucky enough to
-find a fairly comfortable shake-down on the sofa, with the cloth off
-the dining-table. Telephone messages and reports came in day and night
-without ceasing; but they did not prevent us from making the material
-side of our existence tolerably comfortable. We had a roof over our
-heads, and the use of a kitchen equipped in European style, and carried
-on our combined mess as previously at New Moshi. The circumstances
-peculiar to East Africa make it necessary for the European to maintain
-a number of servants which to home ideas seems excessive. Even now,
-on active service, nearly everyone had two “Boys” who took charge
-of the cooking utensils and provisions we carried with us, cooked
-excellently, baked bread, washed, and generally provided us in the bush
-with a good proportion of the comforts which in Europe are only to be
-found in dwelling houses. Even in the heart of the bush I restricted
-these alleviations as little as possible, out of consideration for the
-strength, health and spirit of the Europeans. If, in spite of this,
-Headquarters often preferred to occupy buildings, this was done less
-for the sake of comfort than in order to facilitate the unavoidable
-work of writing and drawing.
-
-While we were at New Steglitz we received the surprising news
-that a second store-ship had reached the Colony, with arms,
-ammunition—including several thousand rounds for the 4-inch
-_Könisgberg_ guns, which were now employed on land—and other warlike
-stores. The ship had run into Ssudi Bay, at the extreme south of our
-coast, and had immediately begun to discharge her cargo. In spite of
-the great distance, and the exclusive use of carriers, the whole of
-it was made available for the troops. This achievement was indeed
-surprising, in view of the large number of hostile ships that were
-blockading and searching our coast-line, and which were aware of the
-arrival of the store-ship. But she probably surprised the English also,
-for after discharging her cargo, she put to sea again, and disappeared,
-much to the astonishment of the enemy. Chaff between the Navy and the
-Army is not unknown even in England, and if the latter is reproached
-for not having been able to finish us off, the former may be silenced
-with the justifiable retort that it should not have allowed us to
-obtain such great supplies of arms and ammunition. The bulk of the
-stores was transported by land to the Central Railway, and was stored
-along, or near it, at the disposal of Headquarters. Owing to our lack
-of suitable artillery it was particularly advantageous that we were
-quickly able to bring up the four field-howitzers and two mountain guns
-which had come in the ship.
-
-The store-ship had also brought out decorations for war service: one
-Iron Cross of the First Class for the Captain of the _Königsberg_,
-and enough of the Second Class to enable half her company to have one
-each. For the Protective Force there were an Iron Cross of the First
-Class, and one of the Second Class, which were for me, and a number of
-decorations for the Askari. As regards the Europeans, we only heard
-in September, 1916, by wireless that the decorations recommended by
-Headquarters had been approved.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER III
-
-RETREAT BEFORE OVERWHELMING HOSTILE PRESSURE
-
-
-IN our rear, Major Fischer, who with five companies had been employed
-between Kilima Njaro and Meru, had evaded the enemy’s superior forces
-by moving on New Moshi, and had been ordered up to Kahe. Captain
-Rothert, who had been acting under his orders with his company and the
-Arusha Detachment (strength about one company), had been energetically
-pursued by the enemy, and had made his way by Arusha towards
-Kondoa-Irangi. We could only expect to get into touch with him by the
-wire which had been put up from Dodome, by Kondoa-Irangi to Umbulu,
-and that only after a considerable time. By abandoning New Moshi we,
-of necessity, left the road Taveta-New Moshi-Arusha open to the enemy.
-The latter was thus also enabled to penetrate into the interior of
-the Colony with his troops from Taveta by Arusha and Kondoa-Irangi,
-and to act there against our communication at an extremely dangerous
-point. From our troops concentrated in the neighbourhood of Kahe and
-New Steglitz he had not much to fear during this operation. Although
-we had brought up all our companies from Tanga, leaving there only the
-troops absolutely indispensable for security, all we could do with our
-four thousand rifles was to let the enemy run up against us on suitable
-ground, and, possibly, to take advantage of any mistakes he might make
-by skilful and rapid action; but the odds against us being seven to
-one we could attempt no more. From an attack on an enemy superior not
-only in numbers, but also in equipment, and holding fortified positions
-into the bargain, I could not possibly hope for success. I could not,
-therefore, accede to the requests of my company commanders that we
-should attack, but this expression of a bold soldierly spirit gave me
-strength and hope in the serious situation in which we were placed.
-Minor enterprises, undertaken against the enemy’s camps by patrols
-and small detachments, produced no results of consequence; but they
-may have helped to make the enemy’s main force take some notice of us
-instead of simply marching on past us. He certainly did push on to
-the west from Himo, and heavy clouds of dust were seen moving to New
-Moshi and further on to the west. But a large part of the enemy coming
-from Himo turned in our direction. For the commander such situations
-are extraordinarily trying; he is not master of the situation, and
-must, of necessity, renounce the initiative. Only the most careful
-reconnaissance may perhaps reveal some weakness of the opponent, and in
-order to utilize this weakness and regain the initiative, not a moment
-must be lost. Fortunately, however, the enemy did expose weak points of
-which we were able to take at least partial advantage.
-
-Owing to the dense bush and high forest in which our camps were hidden,
-aerial reconnaissance can hardly have been any use to the enemy. The
-bombs dropped by the enemy caused only a few casualties at Kahe, and
-did not interfere with us in getting away our stores through that
-place. In order to draw our fire, the well-known English horsemen
-appeared once more north-west of New Steglitz in a widely-extended
-skirmishing line. In front of them, hidden in the bush, were our
-companies, ready to take hold immediately larger bodies should appear.
-A counter-attack of this description was made late in the afternoon on
-the 15th March, and with fair success. In order to become thoroughly
-acquainted with the ground, European patrols were constantly moving
-about, and I also made use of every available minute. Through the bush
-we cut and marked tracks. By this means we could clearly indicate any
-point to which a detachment was required to go.
-
-On the main road leading from Himo to Kahe a strong hostile force
-had also appeared and pushed close up to the front of Stemmermann’s
-Detachment, which occupied a fortified position on this road at Kahe,
-facing north. With considerable skill patrols worked close up to the
-detachment, and so concealed the movements of the enemy. When I arrived
-there in the afternoon of the 20th March, it was not at all clear what
-was really going on in front. It was quite possible that the enemy was
-merely making a demonstration in order to attack at some other, more
-dangerous, spot. Such a manœuvre would have been very menacing to us,
-as the close nature of the bush country would prevent us from detecting
-it until very late, probably too late. I decided to drive the enemy’s
-screen back on his position proper. Earlier in the day it had been
-given out that the companies were to move off to their former positions
-at one a.m.; the machine guns were left in our entrenchments so as not
-to lose them, and as a measure of protection. It was bright moonlight
-when the leading company was fired on, apparently by a hostile outpost,
-or patrol, which moved off. After that we encountered several patrols,
-but then, about three miles north of our own trenches, we came upon a
-stronger opponent with machine guns. The very severe action which now
-developed proved that we had come up against the enemy’s main position;
-to assault it seemed hopeless. Leaving patrols out, I withdrew step
-by step. Our casualties were not inconsiderable, and unfortunately
-included three company commanders, who were difficult to replace; of
-the three, Lieutenant von Stosch and Freiherr Grote died of their
-wounds a few days later, while Captain Augar only became fit for duty
-again after a long time and when provided with an artificial foot.
-
-Our withdrawal, which the enemy probably took to be involuntary,
-apparently led him to believe that he would be able to rout us next day
-by a vigorous attack. The attacks made by powerful hostile forces on
-the front of Stemmermann’s Detachment at Kahe on the 21st March were
-unsuccessful; the enemy, composed mainly of South African infantry, was
-beaten off with heavy loss. Our four-inch _Königsberg_ gun, directed
-from elevated sites affording a good view, fired on the approaching
-enemy, apparently with good effect. It may be assumed that part of
-their severe casualties, which the English stated to have amounted on
-this day to several hundred among the South African Europeans alone,
-were caused by this gun. The enemy realized that he could not advance
-over the field of fire extending for five hundred yards in front of
-our trenches with any hope of success, and endeavoured to envelop our
-right flank. But having previously reconnoitred and determined tracks,
-we were also well prepared to execute a counter-attack, and in the
-afternoon Schulz’s Detachment effectively struck at the enemy’s flank.
-The last part of Schulz’s advance had, indeed, been very arduous owing
-to the thick bush. The Askari could only work through it step by step,
-when they suddenly heard the enemy’s machine guns at work only a few
-paces in front of them.
-
-Unfortunately, however, this counter-attack was not completed owing to
-the events which occurred in the meantime on our left. The activity
-displayed by patrols during the preceding days, and the clouds of
-dust, had shown that strong detachments of the enemy’s horse, coming
-from near New Moshi and keeping to westward of the Kahe-New Moshi
-railway, were trying to work round our front, which faced north, and
-of which the left wing was at Kahe Station. The continuation of this
-movement would have brought them on to the railway in our rear, and
-cut us from our communications while we were engaged with a superior
-opponent with our front to the north. I had, therefore, posted a strong
-reserve of eight companies in readiness at Kahe Station. But as I
-thought it necessary during the action to remain at Kahe village, near
-Stemmermann’s Detachment, I was unable to exercise rapid and direct
-control over the reserves at Kahe. The dense vegetation prevented any
-distant observation. The control of the reserve at Kahe had to be left
-to the initiative of the commander on the spot and his subordinates.
-The latter had observed that hostile troops had advanced through the
-bush and occupied a hill south-west of Kahe Railway Station. One
-company had, on its own initiative, attacked this force, but the
-advance had broken down under shrapnel fire. Thereupon our four-inch
-gun opened fire on these light guns and drove them off.
-
-Late in the afternoon I received an urgent message that strong
-forces of the enemy were advancing in our rear towards the railway
-at Kissangire, and that the event we feared had actually occurred. I
-was, therefore, compelled to issue orders for an immediate withdrawal
-towards Kissangire. The enemy could not yet have reached there
-in strength, and I hoped to defeat him there by rapidly throwing
-all my forces against him. Thus it happened that Captain Schulz’s
-well-directed counter-attack could not be carried through, or produce
-its full effect. The transfer by night of our force across the Pangani,
-which was close behind us, and over which we had previously made a
-number of bridges and crossings, was effected smoothly and without
-interference. Even on the following day the patrols we had left behind
-found its north bank clear of the enemy. Our good four-inch gun, which
-we could not take away owing to its lack of mobility, was blown up.
-After midnight, that is, quite early on the 22nd March, I arrived at
-Kissangire Station, and discovered to my very great astonishment that
-all the reports about strong hostile forces moving on that place were
-erroneous, and that our withdrawal had therefore been unnecessary. This
-incident afforded me a remarkably striking proof of the extraordinary
-difficulty of observing the movements of troops in thick bush, and of
-the great care every commander must exercise in estimating the value
-of such reports. But it also demonstrates how difficult it is for any
-commander to combine his own powers of reasoning and his judgment of
-the situation with the constantly conflicting reports, both of Askari
-and Europeans, in order to base his decision on a foundation that
-even approximately resembles the reality. In the African bush it is
-particularly important, whenever possible, to supplement the reports
-one receives by personal observation.
-
-However, our withdrawal could not now be altered, and the most
-important thing was to re-group our forces. In this operation the
-decisive factor was water-supply. This, and the necessity for
-distribution in depth, caused me to leave only a detachment of a few
-companies on the high ground at Kissangire, from where it observed
-the seven and a half miles of waterless thorn desert extending to
-the Pangani. To the east of this detachment at Kissangire, under
-Major von Boehmken, was Otto’s detachment, pushed up on to the North
-Pare Mountains in order to close the passes leading over them. Major
-Kraut took up a position on Ngulu Pass, between the North Pare and
-Middle Pare ranges. The main body of the force settled down in several
-fortified camps in the fertile Lembeni country.
-
-In spite of the various withdrawals we had recently carried out, the
-spirit of the troops was good, and the Askaris were imbued with a
-justifiable pride in their achievements against an enemy so greatly
-superior. Only a very few individuals deserted, and they were almost
-without exception men whose cattle was in the territory now occupied by
-the enemy, and who were therefore afraid of losing their property.
-
-Almost the entire German civil population had left the Kilima Njaro
-country; most of them had moved to Usambara into the Wilhelmstal
-district. The Arusha country had also been evacuated, and the farmers
-had moved off by ox-wagon by Kondoa-Irangi to Dodoma. The numerous
-Greeks had for the most part remained on their coffee-plantations on
-Kilima Njaro, and the Boers of British nationality had stayed in their
-cattle farms, which extended from the north-west slopes of Kilima
-Njaro northwards round Meru Mountain and along the western slopes of
-the latter to the vicinity of Arusha. At Lembeni the regular course
-of existence had not been interrupted; supply trains rolled right up
-to the station; the companies which were not in the front line worked
-diligently at their training, and Headquarters continued its work in
-the railway station buildings of Lembeni just as it had done previously
-at Moshi. Airmen appeared and dropped bombs, just as before.
-
-The country was carefully prepared to meet various possible battle
-conditions, passages were cut through the dense rhinoceros bush, and
-a field of fire cleared where necessary. Personal reconnaissance took
-up much of my time, and often led me to the companies encamped in
-the thick bush and on the dominating heights. The troops had already
-developed to a tolerable degree in adaptability, and in the art of
-making the material side of their existence as comfortable as possible.
-I remember with pleasure the occasions when, in a comfortably arranged
-grass hut, I was offered a cup of coffee with beautiful rich milk,
-prepared from the ground-down kernel of a ripe cocoanut. The North Pare
-Mountains also were frequently the goal of my expeditions. Up there I
-found a rich and well-watered area of primeval forest, through which
-it was hardly possible to penetrate off the roads. The water-supply of
-the country proved to be far more plentiful than the results of former
-surveys had led us to expect; in this respect also it was shown how the
-necessities of war cause the resources of a country to be opened up,
-and utilized to an extent greatly exceeding previous estimates. The
-natives of North Pare are, like those of Kilima Njaro, masters in the
-art of irrigating their fields by means of the water coming down from
-the mountains.
-
-On the 4th April, one of my reconnaissances took me to Otto’s
-Detachment on the Pare Mountains. From the north-west corner one had
-a clear view of the enemy’s camp, lying down below at Kahe Station.
-The obvious idea of bombarding it with one of our long-range guns—in
-the meantime we had brought to Lembeni one 4-inch _Königsberg_ gun on
-wheels, and one 3·5-inch gun mounted on a ’73 pattern carriage—could
-unfortunately not be carried out. With rather too much zeal the
-troops had thoroughly destroyed the permanent way of the line between
-Lembeni and Kahe. With the means at our disposal it could not be made
-sufficiently fit for traffic to enable us to move one of our guns up
-and down on it with rapidity. All our observations and reports agreed
-that the enemy, who had formerly often sent patrols and even stronger
-forces to the south of Jipe Lake, no longer displayed any interest in
-that district. He had in any case moved his principal forces towards
-Kahe and also beyond New Moshi westward towards Arusha.
-
-After passing a cold night on the damp height at North Pare I descended
-to Lembeni on the 5th April. Here I found a report that on the
-previous day Captain Rothert, who was encamped with the 28th Company
-beside the Lolkisale, a high mountain in the Masai desert, two days’
-march south-west of Arusha, had been attacked by superior forces. The
-heliograph communication with Lolkisale from the south-west had then
-been interrupted. It was not till later that the following facts became
-known. Several mounted companies of the enemy, coming across the desert
-from Arusha, had attacked the 28th Company, who were in position on the
-mountain, from several directions. As our people were in possession of
-the water they could well sustain the fight against the enemy, who had
-none. On the second day of the action the situation became critical
-for the enemy, because of this very absence of water. Unfortunately,
-however, after Captain Rothert was severely wounded, this circumstance
-was not properly appreciated on our side. The situation was thought to
-be so hopeless that the company surrendered with its machine guns and
-ammunition. On this occasion also some of the Askari gave evidence of
-sound military education by refusing to join in the surrender. They,
-together with the wounded, rejoined our forces near Ufiome, without
-being interfered with by the enemy. There they met a new rifle company
-and the Arusha Detachment, of which the former had arrived from the
-Central Railway, the latter from the direction of Arusha.
-
-The road to Kondoa-Irangi and the interior of the Colony was now hardly
-closed to the enemy coming from Arusha. There were three companies
-in the neighbourhood of Lake Kivu, in the north-west corner of the
-Colony, under Captain Klinghardt, retired, who had done so well in the
-actions at Kissenyi; they were moved by march route and on Tanganyika
-steamer to Kigoma, and from there by rail to Saranda. From there again
-they marched up towards Kondoa-Irangi. Captain Klinghardt was also
-given command of the troops already north of Kondoa-Irangi (about two
-companies) and of another company that came by rail from Dar-es-Salaam.
-These movements would take a long time. Consequently, the good and
-well-tried 13th Company, whose peace-station had been Kondoa-Irangi,
-was at once brought by rail to near Buiko, whence it marched through
-the Masai desert to Kondoa-Irangi. The march through this waterless
-and little-known country had to be undertaken before the completion of
-the reconnaissances, which were in progress; and to do so with what
-was, according to African ideas, the large force of one company with
-carriers, in the dry season, and before the heavy rains had set in,
-involved some risk.
-
-But this risk had to be run; for the force facing us at Kahe, after
-its reconnoitring parties had been several times repulsed, was showing
-no signs of advancing against us. At the time, therefore, the enemy
-was evidently directing his principal effort towards Kondoa-Irangi.
-As, for the reasons already set forth, it appeared unsound for us
-to attack from Lembeni towards Kahe, I decided merely to occupy the
-enemy station in the Kilima Njaro country, and to direct my main force
-against the hostile group which had meanwhile pushed forward to near
-Kondoa-Irangi. The execution of this project was not quite easy; much
-time was needed to cover the distance of 125 miles from the detraining
-stations on the Northern Railway to the Central Railway on foot, and
-at any moment a change in the situation might render it necessary for
-Headquarters immediately to make fresh dispositions. All the troops
-must therefore be kept within reach. The various detachments could
-not, as on the march from the Central to the Northern Railway, be set
-in motion on different and widely-separated roads. The march of our
-fifteen field and two mounted companies had to be made on one road. The
-Force was thus confronted with an entirely novel and difficult task.
-There was no time to lose. The detachments of Captain von Kornatzky,
-Captain Otto, Lieutenant-Colonel von Bock and Captain Stemmermann,
-each of four or three companies, were moved by rail at intervals of
-one day, from Lembeni to Mombo and Korogwe. Thence they marched on to
-Kimamba (station west of Morogoro) to the Central Railway. Manifold
-difficulties arose. Hard and fast destinations could not be laid down
-for the detachments for each day, more especially because heavy rains
-set in which in places so softened the black soil that the troops could
-literally hardly get along.
-
-Thus it happened that one detachment made quite short marches, and
-the one behind got jammed on top of it. This, however, was very
-inconvenient, and interfered both with the regular service of supply
-on the line of communication, and with the transport of the company
-baggage, in which the relay-carriers belonging to the line of
-communication had to be called in to assist. The companies now began,
-according to ancient African custom, to help themselves, seized the
-line of communication carriers, regardless of other orders, and simply
-kept them. As the whole service on the communications depended upon
-the regular working of the relay-carriers, it also became seriously
-dislocated.
-
-[Illustration: Masai.
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-[Illustration: European Dinner-time
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IV
-
-THE ENEMY’S ADVANCE IN THE AREA OF THE NORTHERN RAILWAY
-
-
-AFTER the trains had left Lembeni I handed over the command of all
-the troops on the Northern Railway to Major Kraut. An independent
-administrative service was also organized for them. Our railway journey
-to Korogwe proved to us once more how closely the German population
-of the Northern Territories were knit to the Force, and how they
-appreciated its work. At every station the people had assembled,
-sometimes from great distances; every one of them knew that our
-departure from the Northern Territories was final, and that they
-would fall into the enemy’s hands. In spite of this, their spirit was
-gallant. A large part of the few remaining European provisions was
-brought to us. The widow of the former Line-Commandant Kroeber, who had
-recently been buried at Buiko, insisted on offering us the last bottles
-of the stock in her cellar.
-
-Major Kraut and Captain Schoenfeld accompanied me to Buiko, from where
-we were able to view several portions of the ground which I thought
-might become of importance in our future operations. These gentlemen
-remained there in order to make more detailed personal reconnaissances.
-From Korogwe our cars rapidly took us to Handeni, the head of the
-light railway that had been laid from Mombo. On the way we caught up
-our mounted companies, and the exclamation of the Civil Administrator
-of Handeni: “Why, that’s the notorious poacher of Booyen,” showed me
-once more that there were among our mounted troops men accustomed
-to danger and sport, on whom I could rely in the troubles that were
-to come. Handeni was the first collecting station for the stores
-withdrawn from the north; Major von Stuemer, who had left his former
-post at Bukoba in order to take charge of this line of communication,
-which was for the moment the most important one, complained not a
-little of the way in which the troops marching through had interfered
-with the further dispatch of the stores. At Handeni, the seat of the
-Civil Administration, where the supply routes from Morogoro, Korogwe
-and Kondoa-Irangi met at the rail-head of the Mombo-Handeni line,
-the war had called into being a European settlement that had almost
-the appearance of a town. Lieutenant Horn, of the Navy, had built
-cottages in the Norwegian style, which were quite charming to look at,
-although at the moment the rain was rather against them. The interiors,
-consisting for the most part of three rooms, were comfortably arranged
-for the accommodation of Europeans. What was unpleasant was the
-enormous number of rats, which often ran about on one when trying to
-sleep at night. Captain von Kaltenborn, who had arrived in the second
-store-ship which put into Ssudi Bay, reported himself to me here, and
-was able to supplement the home news he had already transmitted in
-writing by verbal accounts.
-
-Proceeding the next day by car, we caught up a number of our
-detachments on the march, and were able to remove at least some of the
-various causes of friction between them. Telephonic communication was
-rarely possible on account of earths caused by the heavy rain, and
-breakages caused by columns of carriers, wagons and giraffes. It was
-all the more important for me to traverse this area of breakdowns,
-which cut me off from the troops and prevented my receiving reports as
-quickly as possible. But that became increasingly difficult.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. xi. Invasion of German East Africa by Belgian and
-British columns, middle of 1916. Fig. xii. Retreat of German Main
-Force, August, 1916.]
-
-The rain came down harder and harder, and the roads became deeper
-and deeper. At first there were only a few bad places, and twenty or
-more carriers managed to get us through them by pulling and pushing.
-The _niempara_ (headmen of carriers) went ahead, dancing and singing.
-The whole crowd joined in with “_Amsigo_,” and “_Kabubi_, _kabubi_,”
-and to the rhythm of these chants the work went on cheerily, and at
-first easily enough. But on passing through Tulieni we found that the
-rains had so swollen an otherwise quite shallow river, that during
-the morning its torrential waters had completely carried away the
-wagon bridge. We felled one of the big trees on the bank, but it was
-not tall enough for its branches to form a firm holdfast on the far
-side. It was three feet thick, but was carried away like a match. The
-Adjutant, Lieutenant Mueller, tried to swim across, but was also swept
-away, and landed again on the near bank. Now Captain Tafel tried, who
-had recovered from his severe wound, and was now in charge of the
-operations section at Headquarters. He reached the far side, and a few
-natives who were good swimmers also succeeded in doing so. But we could
-not manage to get a line across by swimming, and so there we were,
-Captain Tafel without any clothes on the far side, and we on this one.
-The prospect of having to wait for the river to fall was not enticing,
-for I could not afford to waste one minute in reaching the head of
-the marching troops. At last, late in the afternoon, a native said he
-knew of a ford a little lower down. Even there it was not altogether a
-simple matter to wade across, and took at least three-quarters of an
-hour; we had to follow our guide carefully by a very devious route,
-and work cautiously on from one shallow to the next. The water reached
-our shoulders, and the current was so strong that we needed all our
-strength to avoid falling. At last, in the dark, and with our clothes
-thoroughly wet, we reached the far side, where we were met by three
-mules and an escort of Askari sent back by a detachment which we had
-luckily been able to reach by telephone.
-
-We continued our journey the whole night through in pouring rain, and
-had several times to ride for hours at a time with the water up to our
-saddles, or to wade with it up to our necks; but at last, still in
-the night, we reached the great bridge over the Wami, which had been
-put up during the war. That, too, was almost entirely carried away,
-but part was left, so that we were able to clamber across and reach
-the light railway leading to Kimamba Station. This line, like that
-from Mombo to Handeni, had been constructed during the war and was
-worked by man-power. In their endeavour to do the job really well, the
-good people took several curves rather too fast, and the trucks, with
-everything on them—including us—repeatedly flew off into the ditch
-alongside, or beyond it. At any rate, we had had enough and to spare of
-this journey by water by the time we arrived in the early morning at
-Kimamba. Vice-Sergeant-Major[4] Rehfeld, who was stationed there and
-had been called to the Colours, received us most kindly. As there was a
-clothing depot at Kimamba, we were, at any rate, able to obtain Askari
-clothing to change into. When the remainder of Headquarters would turn
-up with our kits it was, of course, impossible to say.
-
-After discussing the situation with the Governor, who had come to
-Kimamba for the purpose, I went next day to Dodoma. On the Central
-Railway, quick working under war conditions, which in the north had
-become everyone’s second nature, had hardly been heard of. Captain von
-Kornatzky’s detachment, which had arrived at Dodoma shortly before us,
-had some difficulty in obtaining supplies, although Dodoma was on the
-railway, and could be supplied quickly. I got in touch by telephone
-with Captain Klinghardt, who had occupied the heights of Burungi, one
-day’s march south of Kondoa-Irangi, and on the next morning, with a few
-officers of Headquarters, I rode off to see him. The road lay through
-uninhabited bush-desert; it had been made during the war, its trace was
-governed by the need for easy construction, and it touched settlements
-but seldom. The Ugogo country is distinguished for its great wealth
-of cattle. The inhabitants belong to the nomad tribes, who copy the
-customs of the Masai, and are, therefore, often called Masai-apes.
-We met many ox-wagons in which German and Boer farmers, with their
-families, were driving from the country around Meru Mountain to Kondoa.
-It was a scene, so well known in South-West Africa, of comfortable
-“trekking,” in these vehicles so eminently suited to the conditions of
-the veld.
-
-The supply service of Klinghardt’s Detachment was not yet in working
-order; we camped that night in the first of the small posts on the
-line of communication. It was evident that the work of transport and
-supply would have to be greatly increased if it was to maintain the
-large number of troops now being pushed forward in the direction of
-Kondoa-Irangi. There was another difficulty: up to date the various
-Field Intendants had not been physically equal to the enormous demands
-which the whole field of the work of maintenance made upon the head
-of the service. Captain Schmid, of the Landwehr, had very soon been
-succeeded by Captain Feilke, of the Landwehr, he again by Captain
-Freiherr von Ledebur, of the Reserve, and this officer by Captain
-Richter, retired, an elderly gentleman. The latter, unfortunately, had
-just now, at the commencement of an important fresh operation, reached
-the limit of his strength. Major Stuemer, retired, who had been working
-on the line of communication at Handeni, had been obliged to take over
-his duties, but had not yet had time to become thoroughly at home in
-them.
-
-By the evening of the following day we had completed our journey of
-four marches, and reached Captain Klinghardt at the Burungi Mountains.
-The detachments coming from the country of the Northern Railway were
-following on behind us, and some days were bound to elapse before
-they would all have arrived; so we had the opportunity of making
-extensive reconnaissances. Here we had the great good fortune to make
-the acquaintance of a perfectly new and excellent map. The District
-Commissioner of Kondoa-Irangi had, when leaving his district, given
-it with other things to a _yumbe_ (chief), who lived on the Burungi
-Mountains, to take care of. It was in his possession that we found this
-valuable property, the secrecy of which had thus remained intact.
-
-Patrols of mounted English Europeans often came near our positions,
-and it was known that stronger mounted forces were behind them. But
-where they were was not known. Some reports stated that they were in
-Kondoa-Irangi; others said south of that place, and others again placed
-them on the road leading from Kondoa-Irangi to Saranda. An important
-factor was that there were considerable native plantations at Burungi,
-so that supplies were plentiful. It was, therefore, not necessary to
-wait until the transport of supplies from Dodoma was in full swing.
-The troops were more independent of the line of communication than
-hitherto, and could draw the bulk of their subsistence from the
-country. As soon as the rear detachments had closed up the advance
-on Kondoa was started. South of that place we met only fairly strong
-mounted protective detachments, who were quickly driven back, and
-at the beginning of May, without any serious fighting, we obtained
-possession of the great heights which lie four miles in front of Kondoa
-village.
-
-We had brought with us two naval guns, one 3·5-inch and one 4-inch,
-on travelling carriages, and at once got them into action. From our
-dominating position they bombarded, apparently with good effect, the
-enemy’s camps south of Kondoa. The tents were at once struck. We
-could see the enemy hard at work entrenching his positions, and his
-vehicles hurrying away towards Kondoa. Several patrol encounters went
-in our favour, and small hostile posts, that had been left out in
-various places, were quickly driven in. From the south—that is, from
-behind us—we saw a mounted patrol riding towards our positions. As
-our mounted patrols were also out, I thought at first that they were
-Germans. But soon the regular carriage of their carbines in the buckets
-proved that they were English. They evidently had no idea of our
-presence. They were allowed to approach quite close, and at the short
-range they lost about half their number. From what we had hitherto
-observed, it seemed probable that the enemy in our front was evacuating
-his positions. On the 9th May, 1916, I decided, if this expectation
-proved correct, immediately to take possession of the low hills now
-held by the enemy. The conditions did not favour an attack, as our
-advance was sure to be observed, and a surprise assault was out of the
-question. But without surprise the attempt to capture the occupied
-position by assault had no hope of success; the enemy was sufficiently
-entrenched on the small hills, and the latter completely commanded the
-ground over which the attack would have to be pushed home, and which
-could only be traversed slowly owing to the low thorn-bush and the
-numerous rocks.
-
-I was with the companies that were following the advanced patrols;
-the latter reported, shortly before dark, that the hills were
-unoccupied. So our companies proceeded, and the commanders ordered up
-the baggage in order to settle down for the night. I myself went to
-the Headquarters Camp, which had remained on the big hills a little
-further back. I tried to relieve my great exhaustion with a cup of
-coffee and a little rum; but, knowing that I had no more orders to
-issue, I soon fell fast asleep. Next to my sleeping place was the
-3·5-inch gun. Towards eleven p.m. I was awakened by remarks made by
-Lieutenant Wunderlich, of the Navy, who was in command of the gun; he
-could not make out the frequent flashes he saw in the direction of the
-enemy. Neither, at first, was I quite certain about them. But soon
-there could be no doubt that these flashes, which became more and more
-frequent, were caused by rifles and machine guns. When the wind shifted
-the sound of the fighting became clearly audible. Contrary to all our
-expectations, therefore, a stiff fight was taking place in our front,
-but owing to the great distance, and the bushy and rocky country that
-would have to be traversed, I did not think I could engage the reserves
-I still had in hand with any prospect of success. It would take hours
-to obtain even the very roughest idea of the situation, and the moon
-would be up for barely an hour more. For well or ill, therefore, I had
-to leave the fight in front to take its course.
-
-Our companies had, indeed, found the high ground, which had been
-examined by the patrols, to be clear of the enemy; but immediately
-in rear of it was another rise, and on this was the enemy, in an
-entrenched position, which our companies ran up against. In the close
-country and the darkness no general survey of the situation was
-possible, and connection between the various units was lost. Our Askari
-established themselves in front of the enemy, and Captain Lincke,
-who had assumed command after Lieutenant-Colonel von Bock had been
-severely wounded and Captain von Kornatzky had been killed, came to the
-conclusion that, although he could remain where he was, he would, after
-daybreak, be obliged to abandon all hope of being able to move, on
-account of the dominating fire of the enemy. As, therefore, no success
-appeared attainable, he cautiously broke off the action while it was
-still dark, and fell back on the position he had started from. The
-enemy, consisting mainly of the 11th South African Infantry Regiment,
-had fought well, and had repeatedly brought effective machine-gun fire
-to bear on our companies. Considering the small number of rifles that
-actually took part in the fight—about four hundred—our casualties,
-amounting to about fifty killed and wounded, must be considered heavy.
-
-During the following days we also proceeded to take possession of the
-high hills lying further to the eastward, and drove off the mounted
-detachments working in the foreground, inflicting quite unpleasant
-casualties on them. It happened several times that out of parties of
-about twenty men, none, or only a few, got away, and in the foreground
-also a whole series of encounters ended in our favour. The heights held
-by us afforded an extensive view, and with good glasses we several
-times observed columns of hostile troops and wagons approaching
-Kondoa from the north, and then turning east and disappearing into
-the mountains. Our patrols, whom we sent far away to the enemy’s
-rear, reported considerable bodies marching from about Arusha in the
-direction of Kondoa-Irangi.
-
-The English had at once taken over the civil administration at Kondoa,
-and had cleverly ordered the _yumbi_ (chiefs) to come to that place and
-given them instructions. Among other things, they imposed on them the
-duty of reporting the movements of German troops. It was, therefore,
-often advantageous for our patrols to pretend to be English while in
-enemy country. The differences in uniform were not great, and the
-prolonged period of active service had further diminished them; uniform
-coats were often not worn at all, but only blouse-like shirts, and the
-little cloth badges which the English wore on their sun-helmets were
-not conspicuous. The difference in armament had often disappeared, as
-some of the Germans carried English rifles.
-
-On the whole, the enemy in Kondoa did not seem to be in great strength
-as yet; but, even if successful, our attack would have to be made
-over open ground against defences which with our few guns we could
-not sufficiently neutralize. The certainty of suffering considerable
-and irreplaceable losses decided me to refrain from a general attack,
-and instead to damage the enemy by continuing the minor enterprises,
-which had hitherto proved so advantageous. Our artillery—the two
-mountain guns and two field howitzers, which had come out in the second
-store-ship, had also arrived—fired upon such favourable targets as
-presented themselves. The buildings of Kondoa-Irangi, where General van
-Deventer had arrived, were also fired at occasionally by our four-inch
-gun. To the west of our main force, on the Saranda-Kondoa-Irangi
-road, our newly-raised 2nd Rifle Company had had several successful
-engagements with portions of the 4th South African Horse, and had
-gradually forced them back to the neighbourhood of Kondoa-Irangi.
-
-The enemy now grew continually stronger. Early in June he also shelled
-us at long range, about thirteen thousand yards, with heavy guns of
-about four-inch and five-inch calibre. His observation and fire-control
-were worthy of all respect; anyhow, on the 13th June his shell soon
-fell with great accuracy in our Headquarters camp. I stopped my work
-which I had commenced under cover of a grass roof, and took cover a
-little to one side behind a slab of rock. No sooner had the orderly
-officer, Lieutenant Boell, also reached the spot, than a shell burst
-close above us, wounded Lieutenant Boell severely in the thigh, and
-myself and a few other Europeans slightly. Otherwise the fire of the
-enemy’s artillery did us hardly any material damage, but it was a
-nuisance, all the same, to have his heavy shell pitching into our camp
-every now and then.
-
-We dispensed with the heavy work which the provision of good protection
-against fire would have entailed, as the whole strength of our people
-was required for patrols and outposts, and for collecting supplies. As
-far as the eye could reach, the whole country was covered by native
-cultivation. The principal crop—which formed the main supply of the
-troops—was _mtema_, a kind of millet, which was just ripening. Most
-of the natives had run away; the supplies from Dodoma had been unable
-to keep up with us, and so our subsistence depended almost entirely on
-the stuff which the foraging-parties of the companies were able to
-bring in. In the hot sun the sheaves quickly dried on the rocks. All
-the companies were busy making flour, either by grinding the threshed
-grain between stones, or by stamping it into meal with poles in vessels
-of hard wood, called _kinos_. The Europeans at that time could still
-get wheat flour, which came up on the line of communication. The bread
-we made before Kondoa out of a mixture of wheat flour and native flour
-was of really excellent quality. Besides _mtema_ and other grains there
-were also sugar-cane, _muhogo_ (a plant with a pleasant-tasting, edible
-root), yams, various kinds of peas, and other native produce, besides
-sufficient cattle. In this extremely rich Kondoa country the troops
-could obtain a variety of food in abundance.
-
-The enemy’s extension from Kondoa to the east drew our attention also
-to this hitherto little-known country. Captain Schulz was sent there
-with several companies, and found it to be an extraordinarily difficult
-and densely-wooded mountain district, interspersed with settlements
-of great fertility. A whole series of actions, in which one or more
-of our companies were engaged, and which resulted in severe loss to
-the enemy, now took place in this district. A strong hostile force
-tried to penetrate between the companies of Schulz’s Detachment and
-ourselves, probably with the intention of cutting off the detachment.
-But this attempt failed completely. Our troops pressed forward against
-this force from both sides and repulsed it. The old _Effendi_ (native
-officer), Yuma Mursal, acted with great skill on this occasion; he
-lay in ambush at a water-place, and fired at the English, who came
-there for water, with good effect; according to his observation, six
-of them were killed. During this period of fighting at Kondoa-Irangi
-the enemy’s battle casualties gradually mounted up to a considerable
-figure. If we add to them his losses by sickness, due to the youth
-of his white troops, who were not used to the Tropics, and were
-extraordinarily careless about precautions against tropical diseases,
-the total losses incurred by him during the Kondoa-Irangi period can
-hardly have been less than one thousand Europeans.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER V
-
-BETWEEN THE NORTHERN AND CENTRAL RAILWAYS
-
-
-I ASK the reader to imagine himself in the position of a Commander,
-with insufficient means, exposed to attack by superior numbers, who has
-continually to ask himself: What must I do in order to retain freedom
-of movement and hope?
-
-At the end of June, 1916, events in the other theatres of war began
-to exercise a decisive influence on our operations at Kondoa. The
-Belgians pushed in from near Lake Kivu and from Russisi, the English
-from the Kagera, west of Lake Victoria, and, since the middle of July,
-from Muansa also, and all these forces were converging on Tabora. Our
-troops stationed in the north-west were all combined under the command
-of General Wahle, who was at Tabora; and he gradually drew in his
-detachments from the frontiers towards that place.
-
-Owing to the difficulties of communication Headquarters had but meagre
-information of these events. Hostile detachments were also pressing
-in from the south-west, from the country between Lakes Tanganyika and
-Nyassa. Before them, our company fighting in the neighbourhood of
-Bismarckburg fell back slowly in a north-easterly direction towards
-Tabora. The two companies left behind to secure the Langenburg district
-gradually retreated on Iringa, followed by General Northey, whose
-division was equipped with all the appliances of modern warfare.
-
-On the Northern Railway, Major Kraut’s patrols, who started out from
-his fortified position at Lembeni, had occasionally scored pleasing
-successes. Several aeroplanes were brought down, or came to grief,
-the passengers being captured and the machines destroyed. When the
-heavy rains had ceased, the enemy commenced his advance from Kahe
-along the Northern Railway, as well as east of it through the Pare
-Mountains, and west of it along the Pangani. Hundreds of automobiles
-and large numbers of mounted troops were observed. In order to avoid
-the danger of being cut off by the greatly superior enemy, Major Kraut
-withdrew his main body by rail to Buiko, leaving small detachments in
-contact with the enemy. In this vicinity, as well as near Mombo, a
-few actions took place, in some of which our companies drove through
-the enemy, who tried to block the line, and fired on him from the
-train. Being in superior force, the enemy was always able, with little
-trouble, to execute outflanking movements with fresh troops, but their
-effectiveness was greatly reduced by the difficulty of the country. It
-seemed, therefore, as though the enemy frequently departed from this
-idea and adopted a sort of tactics of attrition instead. To-day he
-would attack with one portion of his force, then let that rest, and put
-in another the next day, and a different portion again on the third.
-In spite of all his obvious urging, and his favourable conditions of
-supply, his advance was fairly slow. Major Kraut’s troops never got
-into a really difficult situation; on the contrary, they were often
-able to catch the enemy under fire unawares, and to gain partial
-successes, which occasionally caused him very considerable losses, such
-as Captain Freiherr von Bodecker’s rearguard action near Handeni.
-
-In view of this concentric advance from all directions, the question
-arose, what should be done with the main body of the Protective Force
-now before Kondoa? For an attack the situation was altogether too
-unfavourable. The problem, therefore, was, what should be the general
-direction of our retreat? I decided on the Mahenge country. By moving
-there we should avoid being surrounded, it was fertile, and suitable
-for guerilla warfare. From there also it would be possible to withdraw
-further to the south and to continue the war for a long time to come.
-
-Another important consideration was the safeguarding of our stores
-deposited along the Central Railway, particularly in the vicinity
-of Morogoro. These were greatly endangered by the rapid advance of
-General Smuts, who was opposing Major Kraut, and had penetrated far to
-the south beyond Handeni. Although it was to be assumed that General
-Smuts would be delayed by the continually increasing length of his
-communications, he seemed to me to be the most dangerous and important
-of our opponents. I therefore decided to leave in front of the Kondoa
-force only a detachment at Burungi, under Captain Klinghardt, but to
-march my main body back to Dodoma, proceed thence by rail to Morogoro,
-and move up in support of Major Kraut. It turned out afterwards that
-the English were informed of this movement down to the smallest
-details, and that, for instance, they knew all about a railway accident
-that happened to one company during its progress. When our companies
-arrived at Morogoro and the Europeans there saw the splendid bearing
-of the Askari they lost the last traces of their depression; every man
-and woman had comprehended that our situation was indeed difficult, but
-also that there was nothing for it but to go on fighting, and that our
-Force was, from its whole quality and nature, capable of carrying on
-for a long time to come.
-
-Early in July I reached Major Kraut, who was holding a fortified
-position on Kanga Mountain, north-east of Tuliani. I had expected the
-Askari to be depressed by their retreat, but found them in excellent
-spirits and full of confidence. In front of their position they had
-cleared the foreground for 50 to 100 yards and were fully convinced
-that they could beat off an attack.
-
-I employed the time that elapsed before the arrival of the other
-detachments in reconnaissance, and soon formed a mental picture of the
-passes which led across the difficult rock and forest country westward
-of our line of communication.
-
-Owing to the remarkably dense bush an attempt to send a strong
-detachment round the enemy’s camp to attack it in rear was
-unsuccessful. But the enemy did sustain casualties through numerous
-minor enterprises by our patrols, who fired at his transport columns
-and the automobiles working behind his front. In this way also a Staff
-car was once effectively fired on. The enemy’s patrols were also active
-and several of his distant patrols had got behind us. One of them,
-commanded by Lieutenant Wienholt, betrayed its presence by surprising a
-column of our carriers and burning the loads. Among other things these
-contained a quantity of trousers which had come out in the store-ship
-and were anxiously expected. Wienholt, therefore, aroused painful
-interest on the part of everyone. His patrol was discovered in camp in
-the dense bush and surprised. He himself got away, and trusting to the
-fact that it is not easy to find anyone in the African bush, wanted
-to work his way alone through our lines and back to the English. Our
-well-tried men, zan Rongew, Nieuwenhudgu and Trappel, who had effected
-the clever capture of the horses near Longido Mountain, succeeded
-in tracking and capturing him. On my return from a reconnaissance I
-met Wienholt in our camp at Tuliani enjoying a cheery meal with his
-captors. We could none of us help honestly admiring the excellent work
-of his patrol, whose route was accurately marked on the map that was
-captured in his possession. Wienholt was then taken to a prisoners’
-camp in the interior, from which he escaped some months later while
-bathing. In 1917 he did excellent work on patrol round Kilwa and
-Livale, and also later on, in 1918, in Portuguese East Africa. I was
-greatly interested in his description of an attack by a leopard which,
-with great boldness, killed his companion in camp. I presume he has by
-now given friends and acquaintances the benefit of his vivid account,
-of which he unfortunately lost the original later on in a patrol
-encounter.
-
-Weeks now passed, during which the English annoyed us mainly by bombs
-from aircraft. They had evidently found out the exact site of our
-Headquarter camp at Tuliani. I remember one day when four aeroplanes,
-against which we could do nothing, circled over our camp for hours and
-dropped bombs. But we had learned to make ourselves invisible, and
-only the European employed in the telephone hut was so badly hurt that
-he lost his hand. An adjoining hut full of valuable documents was set
-alight by an incendiary bomb.
-
-My cars were then still working, and from Tuliani I was often
-able quickly to reach Kraut’s Detachment in front by the good
-line-of-communication road. Lieutenant-Commander Schoenfeld had there
-made excellent arrangements for directing the fire of the 4-inch and
-3·5-inch naval guns. From his observation posts on the heights of
-Kanga Mountain one had a good view of the English camps. Some weak
-German detachments had not followed Major Kraut from Usambara towards
-Tuliani, but had escaped along the Usambara Railway towards Tanga.
-There, and also near Korogwe, they had minor encounters with the enemy
-and gradually fell back towards the south, on the east side of Kraut’s
-Detachment. They were followed by more considerable portions of the
-enemy. Gradually the force at Tuliani became liable to be circumvented
-on the east, and to lose its communication with the Morogoro country,
-which was so important for the supply of stores, ammunition and
-food. At the same time General van Deventer, whose force had been
-augmented to a division, advanced from Kondoa to the south, and Captain
-Klinghardt retired before him, first to the south, and then towards
-Mpapua.
-
-The closeness and difficulty of the country caused Captain Klinghardt
-to still further subdivide his already small force (five companies)
-in order to watch and block important passes. The enemy followed
-with a large number of automobiles, and occasionally one of them
-was successfully blown up by mines sunk in the roads. Owing to the
-unavoidable dissemination of Captain Klinghardt’s troops, and the
-difficulty of maintaining touch between them, one part often could
-not know what was happening to its neighbours. A large German mounted
-patrol was attempting to connect up from the east with a detachment
-believed to be at Meiameia, on the road from Dodoma to Kondoa-Irangi.
-All unconsciously it rode straight into a hostile camp and was captured
-almost without exception. The retirement of our troops from Kondoa,
-who had not merely to escape, but also to inflict damage on the enemy,
-was a very difficult manœuvre; the right moment to fall back, to halt
-again, to advance for a sudden counter-stroke, and then break off
-again quickly, and in sufficient time, is difficult to gauge. Reliable
-reports were lacking. Owing to the scarcity of means of communication
-the difficulties attending the retirement of several columns through
-unknown country grew infinitely great. The influence of the commander
-was often eliminated, and too much had to be left to chance. On the
-31st July, 1916, the enemy reached the Central Railway at Dodoma.
-Captain Klinghardt slipped off to the east along the railway. In
-the actions which took place west of Mpapua several favourable
-opportunities were not recognized, and neighbouring detachments, whose
-assistance had been relied on, did not arrive in time. Such things
-easily give rise to a feeling of insecurity among the troops and weaken
-confidence and enterprise. The difficulties were accentuated in this
-case by the fact that Captain Klinghardt was taken ill with typhoid and
-became a casualty just at the critical moment. Captain Otto was sent
-from Tuliani to replace him, and succeeded in once more collecting the
-scattered parties and in establishing united control.
-
-The 2nd Rifle Company also, which had been obliged to retire on Saranda
-by the Kondoa-Saranda road, and with which all touch had been lost,
-made a great circuit on the south side of the railway and rejoined
-Otto’s Detachment. Owing to the numerical superiority of the enemy, in
-the actions which now took place, Otto’s Detachment frequently found
-itself exposed to an attack on its front while being enveloped on both
-flanks. The enemy did not always succeed in timing these movements
-correctly. Thus, at Mpapua, the frontal attack got too close to our
-line and suffered severely; and the flank attack, even when directed
-on the rear of our positions, produced no decisive effect. The short
-range of visibility always enabled us either to avoid the danger, or,
-if the opportunity was favourable, to attack the troops outflanking us
-in detail. In any event, these outflanking tactics of the enemy, when
-followed, as in this case, in extraordinarily thick bush, and among
-numerous rocks, demanded great exertions and used up his strength.
-Every day Captain Otto fell back only a couple of miles further to the
-east, and in these operations the railway enabled him to change the
-position of his big gun at will. When Otto’s Detachment approached
-Kilossa it became necessary to move the main body at Tuliani also.
-Headquarters and a part of the force moved to Morogoro, Major Kraut,
-with several companies and a 4-inch gun, to Kilossa. At Tuliani Captain
-Schulz took command.
-
-I now considered that columns pressing on from the north would soon
-reach the country west of Bagamoyo, and that at this place also troops
-would be landed. In order to reconnoitre personally, I travelled to
-Ruwa Station and thence by bicycle over the sandy, undulating road
-to Bagamoyo. One day’s march south of Bagamoyo I came on the camp of
-two Europeans: it was District Commissioner Michels, who wanted to
-remove his threatened District Headquarters from Bagamoyo towards the
-interior. The inhabitants were confiding and were living as in peace.
-So far the universal war had passed them by without a trace. As time
-pressed I had to turn back and Herr Michels’ fast Muscat donkey carried
-me back to Ruwa in a few hours. On the next day, from Kidugallo, I
-reconnoitred the supply depots established there and further to the
-north by cycle and then returned to Morogoro. Other reconnaissances,
-mostly also by cycle, took me to the mountains lying to westward in the
-direction of Kilossa, and along the roads leading round the Uluguru
-Mountains on the west and east. The passes leading from Morogoro up
-the northern slopes of the gigantic Uluguru group, and down again on
-the south side towards Kissaki, had to be examined on foot. Owing
-to the pressure exerted by General van Deventer on Kilossa, and the
-danger that Captain Schulz might also be circumvented at Tuliani, it
-was imperative not to miss the right moment for withdrawing Captain
-Schulz to Morogoro. But in order to retain the power of delivering
-counter-strokes we had to hold on to the Tuliani area as long as
-possible.
-
-Captain Stemmermann’s Detachment, which had been pushed out a short
-day’s march due north of Tuliani, was attacked at Maomondo by a strong
-force of Europeans and Indians. The enemy was very skilful. A machine
-gun of the 6th Company, placed on a rocky slope, was seized by a few
-Indians, who had crept up to it from the front unobserved, and thrown
-down the steep slope, so that it could not be found again. The enemy,
-who had penetrated our lines, was thrown out again with heavy loss by
-a counter-attack by the 21st Company. At close quarters the English
-Major Buller, a son of the well-known General of the South African War
-days, put a bullet through the hat of the Company Commander, Lieutenant
-von Ruckteschell, but was then severely wounded by the latter. Major
-Buller was got away to the German hospital at Dar-es-Salaam and nursed
-back to health by the wife of his opponent, who was working there as
-a nurse. During the actions at Maternondo English horsemen had worked
-round farther to the west, and suddenly appeared in one of the mountain
-passes leading from the west to Tuliani. In the dense bush the 2nd
-Mounted Brigade, which had come from South Africa under General Brits,
-apparently sustained heavy casualties.
-
-With the consent of Headquarters, Captain Schulz now withdrew to
-Derkawa, which is situated in dense bush on the Wami river, on the
-road from Tuliani to Morogoro. Here he occupied a fortified position
-on the south bank, where he was attacked on the 13th August by the
-enemy pursuing from Tuliani, with a force of at least one brigade of
-infantry, and General Brits’ Mounted Brigade, while simultaneously
-another brigade, which had marched up the right bank of the Wami,
-attacked him from the east. During the action continuous telephonic
-communication was maintained with Captain Schulz from Morogoro. The
-enemy’s losses were estimated at several hundred, and were afterwards
-confirmed by the English. The attacks were beaten off, but in the dense
-bush it was so difficult to obtain a clear idea of the situation that
-it did not seem possible to achieve a decisive success. Captain Schulz
-was chary of putting in the one formed company he had left. I approved
-his intention of falling back to Morogoro at the end of the action,
-as the general situation made it desirable for me to concentrate my
-forces. After Major Kraut’s arrival at Kilossa I also brought Captain
-Otto in to Morogoro, with part of his companies. Major Kraut had passed
-behind Otto’s Detachment through Kilossa and after some engagements
-at that place, he took up a position immediately to the south of it,
-on the road to Mahenge. Even after the enemy had moved into Kilossa
-telephonic communication with Kraut’s Detachment had continued to work
-for a few hours through the enemy.
-
-From that time on direct communication with Major Kraut was
-interrupted. Signalling by helio did not work, and the wires which
-led from Kissaki, and later from the Rufiji, to Mahenge, and thence
-to Major Kraut, were not yet completed—in some cases not even begun.
-With General Wahle at Tabora we had also had no communication since the
-second half of July, that is, for over a month. Bagamoyo had fallen
-into the enemy’s hands; and every day we expected to hear of the fall
-of Dar-es-Salaam and to lose touch with that place.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VI
-
-CONTINUOUS FIGHTING NEAR THE RUFIJI
-
-
-IN order to oppose the troops of General Northey, who were advancing
-from the direction of New Langenburg, Captain Braunschweig had
-been dispatched from Dodoma at the end of June. He had taken up
-reinforcements from Kondoa and Dar-es-Salaam to the two German Askari
-companies that had slipped away from the New Langenburg country, and
-had concentrated his own troops, totalling five companies and one field
-howitzer, at Malangali. At that place his force had fought a brave
-action with a superior force of the enemy, but had been obliged to fall
-back towards Mahenge.
-
-As the converging hostile columns were now approaching each other in
-the direction of Morogoro, it became necessary to consider our future
-plan of operations. The enemy expected us to stand and fight a final
-decisive engagement near Morogoro, on the northern slopes of the
-Uluguru Mountains. To me, this idea was never altogether intelligible.
-Being so very much the weaker party, it was surely madness to await
-at this place the junction of the hostile columns, of which each one
-individually was already superior to us in numbers, and then to fight
-with our back to the steep and rocky mountains, of which the passes
-were easy to close, and which deprived us of all freedom of movement
-in our rear. I thought it sounder so to conduct our operations that we
-should only have to deal with a part of the enemy. Knowing that the
-enemy, and General Brits in particular, had a liking for wide turning
-movements, I felt sure that one column would move off from Dakawa,
-where large hostile camps had been identified, or from Kilossa, in
-order to reach our rear by working round the west side of the Uluguru
-Mountains. This possibility was so obvious that I cycled out every day
-to the mountains west of Morogoro, so as to get the reports from the
-patrols in good time, and to supplement them by personal observation
-of the clouds of smoke and dust. The latter soon put it beyond doubt
-that a strong column was moving from near Dakawa towards the railway
-between Morogoro and Kilossa. Patrols identified enemy troops that had
-crossed the railway and were marching further south. The observers on
-the mountains reported the clouds of dust to be moving towards Mlali.
-
-As I meant to let this movement run its full course and then attack
-the isolated detachment with the whole of my forces, I waited until I
-thought it was near Mlali. On the evening of the 23rd August, Captain
-Otto, who was encamped at Morogoro, was ordered to march off for Mlali
-during the night with three companies. He arrived there early on the
-24th, just as English horsemen had taken possession of the depot. When
-I reached Otto’s Detachment the fight was in full swing. The country
-was, however, unsuitable for short decisive strokes, owing to the many
-steep hills which impeded movement. The other troops at Morogoro,
-except Captain Stemmermann’s Detachment, were ordered up by telephone.
-I myself went back again to Morogoro to talk things over. Stemmermann’s
-Detachment, to which, on account of the roads, the 4-inch _Königsberg_
-gun and the howitzer battery were attached, was ordered to fall back
-along the eastern slopes of the Uluguru Mountains, and to delay the
-enemy there. The passes over the mountains themselves were closed by
-weak patrols. When I arrived once more at Mlali in the afternoon, the
-fight was still undecided. At several points the enemy had been driven
-back, and several people thought they had seen him suffer considerably.
-But by nightfall we had got so entangled in the mountains, and every
-movement had become so difficult and took so much time, that we
-halted. We found the night very cold, lying out on the hills without
-the carriers’ loads. Luckily, however, this fertile region had so far
-hardly suffered at all from the war, and a fowl roasted on a spit soon
-appeased our hunger.
-
-The next morning numerous explosions in the German depots, which had
-been surprised by the enemy, indicated that he had moved off and had
-destroyed the 4-inch shells stored there. We surmised that he was
-moving south-west, which eventually turned out to be the case. The
-enemy was probably making a turning movement so as to reach Kissaki
-before us. At the wealthy Administration Office at that place, 600 tons
-of food supplies and the military stores removed from Morogoro had been
-collected. Wild rumours exaggerated the actual facts, and stated that
-strong forces had already reached the roads leading to Kissaki before
-us. Although the wagon road stopped at Mlali, and the remainder of the
-route to Kissaki consisted only of paths broken by many ravines and
-obstacles, the possibility that the enemy might make a rapid march on
-Kissaki had to be taken very seriously, and we had no time to waste. In
-the evening we were most hospitably entertained by the Father at Mgeta
-Mission. The buildings are charmingly situated in the deep ravine of
-the Mgeta river, which in this part comes down very swiftly. The many
-lights on the slope of the hill made one think one was approaching some
-small watering-place in Germany. A few European women from Morogoro
-were also staying there, and bade farewell to the Force for the last
-time. With the exception of a few nurses all women had to stay behind.
-
-The removal of our loads was carried out fairly satisfactorily.
-The Force profited by the fact that owing to the insistence of the
-energetic Captain Feilke, about a thousand native labourers, who had
-until a few days previously been working in the forestry department at
-Morogoro, were placed at its disposal. But the carrier question was
-beginning to be difficult. The natives saw that we were evacuating
-the country; a number of them, who had promised to come, stayed away,
-to the despair of the sensible Chiefs, who would gladly have helped
-us. As only small parties of the enemy appeared in the country round
-Mgeta, it began to seem probable that his principal forces were making
-a turning movement. Leaving a rearguard behind, which only followed us
-slowly, our main body was, during the ensuing days, moved nearer to
-Kissaki. One night an Askari appeared at my bedside, bearing himself
-in a smart military manner: it was the Effendi Yuma Mursal, of the 4th
-Field Company, who had been left behind sick at Morogoro. He reported
-that a force of the enemy, as strong as that at Kahe had been, had
-marched round the west side of the Uluguru Mountains from Morogoro, and
-that a number of German Askari had found the recent fighting too much
-for them. They had deserted, and were now plundering the plantations
-south-west of Morogoro.
-
-A telephone line was laid from Kissaki to us, by means of which Captain
-Tafel kept us continually informed; up to date no enemy had been seen
-at Kissaki. But to the west of us, patrols reported the enemy to be
-marching to the south. I therefore moved to Kissaki, and had to destroy
-some of our stores, which were collected in small depots along our
-route. Unfortunately, in carrying this out, an efficient Ordnance
-N.C.O. was accidentally killed, as had happened before on a similar
-occasion at Morogoro. At Kissaki, several days passed before we came
-seriously into collision with the enemy. It was not advisable to occupy
-the Boma Fort itself; it consisted of a group of buildings surrounded
-by a massive high wall, and was situated in the middle of a completely
-cleared bit of country. The enemy could, therefore, only capture it by
-a costly attack; but he had no need to assault it at all; by means of
-artillery and bombs from aircraft, he could have made it intolerable
-for us to remain in the cramped Boma, and we ourselves should then have
-been forced to make a sortie over the open and to endure the fire which
-the enemy would have been able to pour into us in perfect security. Our
-defences were, therefore, placed a long way outside the Boma, covered
-from the view of aircraft, and so arranged that they could be occupied
-and evacuated unobserved.
-
-It was not until I arrived at Kissaki myself that I obtained a proper
-idea of the abundance of stores and supplies available there. I learned
-that, contrary to my belief, practically nothing was stored further
-south at Behobeho or at Kungulio, on the Rufiji. At Kissaki there
-were large stocks, but notwithstanding the dense native population,
-it was impossible to get them away. The numerous inhabitants, to whom
-the war and the many Askari were something quite new, lost their heads
-and ran away into the bush. The Civil Administration, which enjoyed
-the complete confidence of the people, proved powerless against the
-overwhelming influences now bursting in upon them. Even presents of
-clothing, which were ordinarily so highly valued, failed to hold them.
-It seemed as if all the evil spirits had conspired together to deprive
-us of transport. Our column of several hundred pack-donkeys had been
-driven over the mountains from Morogoro. It arrived at Kissaki late and
-completely exhausted. Our ox-wagons, which had to go round the east
-side of the Uluguru Mountains on account of the state of the roads,
-seemed to be never going to arrive. The head of the Communications
-Service could not find any other means of carrying away the stocks
-which were essential to us for continuing the war. And yet it was
-obvious that we must continue to fall back further south, towards the
-Rufiji, before the superior numbers of the enemy.
-
-One circumstance that brightened the gloom was that our great herds of
-cattle, which had been grazing east of Mpapua, had been brought away
-in good time. Several thousand head, mostly beautiful cattle, arrived
-at Kissaki, and would have formed a most welcome mobile reserve of
-supplies. But, unfortunately, our pleasure at this was diminished by
-the frequent occurrence of the tse-tse fly at some places; if the
-animals got stung by them they lost condition badly, and mostly died
-after a few weeks. The bulk of the cattle was, therefore, driven on
-into the healthy districts on the Rufiji. As for the rest, we simply
-worked with energy at getting away the stores to Behobeho and on to
-Kungulio, using the carriers belonging to the troops, all the people
-we could raise in the district, and our few wagons. In order to effect
-this, we had to gain time, and Captain Stemmermann, who was marching
-round the Uluguru Mountains by the eastern road, could only be allowed
-to fall back quite slowly before the hostile division which was pushing
-after him with all its might.
-
-I waited at Kissaki with the main body, in order to be able quickly
-to recognize and make use of any favourable opportunity. As was to be
-expected, the enemy had, owing to our withdrawal to Kissaki, abandoned
-his concentration on Morogoro; he had sent a few detachments direct
-over the Uluguru Mountains, but his other columns had separated and
-followed us, extending far to the east and west. The hope of being able
-to defeat one or more of these columns separately was fulfilled beyond
-expectation. West of the Uluguru Mountains General Brits had divided
-his division into brigade columns (two mounted and one infantry),
-which had difficulty in keeping touch. Soon large hostile camps were
-discovered a day’s march west of Kissaki, and on the 7th September,
-1916, Captain Otto’s Detachment, which was encamped at a plantation
-near Kissaki, was attacked by a large force of European horse, and
-by native and white infantry. It turned out later that this force
-consisted of General Enslin’s Mounted Brigade, and of portions of the
-infantry brigade of General Brits’s Division. The turning movement
-which the enemy was making round the left wing of Otto’s Detachment
-was allowed to continue until the outflanking detachment had got right
-round in rear of Captain Otto, near the Boma of Kissaki. Evidently the
-enemy did not expect German reserves to be posted under cover still
-further back. These reserves were now loosed upon him. The gallant 11th
-Field Company, under Lieutenant Volkwein of the Reserve, worked through
-the dense bush close up to the outflanking enemy, and immediately
-attacked with the bayonet, cheering. With that the enemy’s beautiful
-plans completely collapsed; our further advance simply rolled him up,
-and he was completely defeated. The almost impenetrable bush made it
-impossible vigorously to push the enemy, or to undertake a pursuit
-on a large scale; but the bulk of his troops was broken up, and the
-small fragments were scattered in the bush in hopeless confusion. The
-led-horses and horse-holders were captured, and about fifteen Europeans
-taken prisoner. Even the next day an English soldier arrived from quite
-another direction; he had lost himself with his led-horses in the dense
-bush and had no idea where to go. The man had plenty of humour; he
-threw his rifle and ammunition across a small stream and said: “It’s
-just luck; I might have taken the right road or the wrong one. I had
-the bad luck to take the wrong one. That’s my fault.”
-
-Tafel’s Detachment, which was encamped north of Kissaki, on the road
-we had come by, had only partially joined in the fight on the evening
-of the 7th. I had kept it back, as I thought that, simultaneously with
-the attack on the 7th from the west, another one would be made from
-the north along the road. And General Brits undoubtedly did hold this
-perfectly sound intention; but the execution failed. General Nussy’s
-Mounted Brigade, without having any idea of the action of the 7th,
-marched along towards Tafel’s Detachment from the north on the 8th. It
-was just as thoroughly beaten as its friends had been the day before.
-In the dense bush it was, on the 8th, even more difficult to survey
-the fighting, and a considerable number of prisoners taken by the 1st
-Company managed to escape.
-
-In the two days we took some thirty European prisoners, and some of
-them were sent back to the enemy, on taking an oath not to fight again
-in this war against the Germans or their allies. The humanity of this
-step, which was, under tropical conditions, in the best interest of the
-prisoners themselves, was not recognized by the English. They suspected
-spying, seized the German envoy who brought back the prisoners, sent
-him far into the bush with his eyes bound, and then let him go where
-good luck might take him. It was a wonder that the man, who was
-exhausted by prolonged wandering about, found his way back. This shows
-how difficult the English made it for us to avoid unnecessary severity
-towards the enemy. At the same time, the English private soldiers
-had faith in the treatment we meted out to our prisoners. While the
-battlefield was being cleared, in which both English and German medical
-officers took part, wounded Englishmen begged to be treated by the
-German doctor. And later on, also, wounded men remarked that they would
-hardly have been cured if they had been treated by English medical
-personnel.
-
-It was my opinion that these satisfactory successes at Kissaki had
-not brought us a final decision against the troops of General Brits,
-and I still believe that in the dense bush and the rugged country an
-energetic pursuit, which alone would have secured the desired result,
-was impossible of execution. My attention was all the more drawn
-towards the force pursuing Stemmermann’s Detachment, as it had already
-come within two days’ march north-east of Kissaki. During the last few
-days the situation there had not been favourable; the broken ground had
-in several instances caused our already weak forces to be disseminated.
-Some portions had been ambushed, the troops were very fatigued, and
-several people were suffering badly from nerves. On the 9th September
-Stemmermann’s Detachment approached the village of Dutumi, which
-was known to me from previous reconnaissance. I thought the enemy
-would press on on the following day, and considered the opportunity
-favourable for achieving a success at Dutumi by rapidly moving my main
-body there from Kissaki. In the evening we marched away from Kissaki
-by the fine broad road, and reached Dutumi that night. Captain Otto
-remained at Kissaki with five companies. On arrival I decided to make
-use of the factor of surprise, and to make an enveloping attack in the
-early morning on the enemy’s left wing, which was identified close
-in front of Stemmermann’s Detachment. I knew that this wing was in
-the plain, while, looking from our side, the enemy’s centre and right
-stretched away to the left up the foot-hills of the Uluguru Mountains.
-It was because of these foot-hills that the chances of attack were less
-favourable on our left.
-
-Early on the 9th September, Schulz’s Detachment attacked from our
-right. Rifle and machine-gun fire soon started, and the enemy’s light
-artillery also opened fire; but the thick high elephant grass, with
-which the plain was covered, made it impossible to form a clear idea of
-things. I thought the attack was going well, and proceeded to the left
-in order to get a view of the situation. The heights there were also
-densely overgrown. It was very fatiguing to get along and difficult to
-find anybody. I was clambering about, fairly exhausted in the heat of a
-tropical noon, when I luckily heard the sound of tin pots, and found
-I was right in concluding that some European was just having lunch. It
-was Captain Goering, who had taken up his post in the bush on a height
-which afforded a good view. Here, towards three p.m., I received the
-unwelcome news that the attack by Schulz’s Detachment on our right had
-not attained its object. It had been simply impossible to get at the
-enemy through the dense elephant grass. If, therefore, any decisive
-action was to be taken on that day at all, it could only be done on our
-left. Even here, owing to the difficult country, success was not very
-probable. The advancing companies got into a very intersected mountain
-tract, in which they shot at the enemy, and were shot at by him without
-any result, and at dusk returned to their original positions.
-
-During the following days the enemy directed his attacks mainly against
-our left, and was frequently driven back by counter-strokes. But, on
-the whole, it was evident that success was only possible if the enemy
-proved very unskilful. On the other hand, our communications, which
-from now on no longer ran to Kissaki, but towards Behobeho in the
-south-east, were in a great degree threatened by the enemy. I therefore
-abandoned Dutumi, and withdrew the main body an hour’s march to the
-south, across the Mgeta river, where the Force occupied an extensive
-fortified camp, which it continued to hold for months. By this move the
-rich fields of Dutumi were unfortunately given up. In the poor country
-of Kiderengwa we had to depend mainly on supplies from the rear, which
-were sent up from the Rufiji. Unfortunately the fatigues of this
-transport work, combined with sickness caused by tse-tse, very soon led
-to the almost complete loss of our pack-donkeys. From Kiderengwa our
-fighting patrols attacked the enemy’s communications, which ran to the
-north-east from Dutumi, as well as the Dutumi-Kissaki road, which soon
-became alive with enemy detachments and transport.
-
-Various observations now concurred in disclosing remarkable movements
-on the part of the enemy. Both east and west of the Uluguru Mountains
-movements of troops in such strength were seen to be taking place
-towards Morogoro, that the natives said: “_Wana hama_” (“They are
-moving elsewhere”). A large number of the South African Europeans, of
-whom, by the way, many had come to the end of their strength, were
-sent home. Other observations disclosed a movement of troops towards
-the east. Generally speaking, a period of rest ensued, which was only
-interrupted by minor expeditions of patrols and occasional artillery
-bombardments.
-
-General Smuts realized that his blow had failed. He sent me a letter
-calling upon me to surrender, by which he showed that, as far as force
-was concerned, he had reached the end of his resources.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VII
-
-HOSTILE ATTACKS IN THE SOUTH-EAST OF THE COLONY
-
-
-MEANWHILE, the situation at Kilwa began to demand increased attention.
-We had there only weak detachments for protecting the coast, which
-consisted mainly of young, newly-enlisted Askari, and had been
-organized as a company. This company was not sufficient, and there
-was a danger that the enemy might march from Kilwa to the Rufiji,
-or to Livale, and get in our rear. No doubt the enemy had some such
-intention, and something had to be done to prevent it. Major von
-Boemken, with three companies, had already marched off from the
-battlefield of Dutumi for Kunguliu on the Rufiji, proceeding thence to
-Utete by route march and on the stern-wheeler _Tomondo_. The _Tomondo_
-was the only shallow-draught steamer on the Rufiji, and carried most
-of the supplies, which came from the lower Rufiji to Kunguliu, whence
-they were carried to the troops at Kiderengwa by donkeys and carriers.
-It now required a certain amount of discussion before the civil
-authorities would place the _Tomondo_ at my disposal for carrying the
-necessary troops. At Kilwa the situation did not develop altogether
-satisfactorily. It is true that a few minor engagements were more or
-less in our favour, but, as so often happened during the war, we did
-not manage to secure united control of our forces. Among other things,
-the enemy succeeded in destroying a supply depot west of Kilwa, which
-was too near the coast. The enemy cleverly incited the natives to
-rebellion, and they rendered him valuable service as spies. Several
-German reconnoitring detachments were ambushed and suffered severely.
-The District Commissioner of Kilwa was taken prisoner. The awkwardness
-of the already difficult situation at Kilwa was increased by the fact
-that the District Commissioner’s Askari were not placed under the
-orders of the military commander.
-
-At the same time, the pressure of hostile forces was felt from the
-direction of Dar-es-Salaam, in the north, towards the lower Rufiji.
-Our weak detachments, which had fallen back from Dar-es-Salaam in a
-southerly direction towards the Rufiji, and consisted principally
-of a young company of Askari and part of the ship’s company of
-the _Königsberg_, were not enough to protect the rich sources of
-subsistence in the lower Rufiji country. But at the time this country
-was what the Force depended on, for the middle Rufiji country was but
-sparsely settled, and could not maintain both troops and carriers for
-any length of time. In view of this necessitous situation, we had at
-once started to grow maize in the fertile lowlands of Logeloge and
-Mpanganya, but the harvest could not be expected before March, 1917. We
-were, therefore, threatened by a great danger when several companies of
-Indians attacked our advanced officers’ post in the Boma of Kissengire.
-The enemy, who assaulted the steep walls without sufficient preparatory
-fire, was driven off with considerable loss. Unfortunately, the
-German commander, Lieutenant Baldamus, of the Reserve, who exposed
-himself too freely to the enemy projectiles, was killed. But his
-resolute and gallant defence secured us in the possession of the
-seat of administration at Kissengire until the arrival of adequate
-reinforcements; it is, therefore, due to this officer that we retained
-control of the rich supply area of the lower Rufiji for months to come.
-
-[Illustration: Askari. A halt.
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-[Illustration: The Banyan Tree.
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-[Illustration: Fig. xiii. Battles of Kissaki and Dutumi.]
-
-[Illustration: Fig. xiv. March of German Main Force, September, 1916,
-to June, 1917.]
-
-It has already been mentioned that a pause in the operations had
-occurred at Kiderengwa; an attack on the enemy, who was entrenched in
-a strong position, promised no success. Headquarters accordingly left
-only eight companies, under Captain Tafel, in the Kissaki-Kiderengwa
-area (and this force was reduced later), moving with the bulk of the
-troops to the lower Rufiji. The road to Kunguliu led past large lakes,
-which, like the Rufiji, were full of hippopotami. Owing to the general
-demand for fat, hippopotamus shooting became a question of existence.
-One has to watch until the animal’s head is clearly visible, so as to
-hit in a spot that will cause instantaneous death. The animal then
-sinks, and comes up again after a little time when it can be drawn to
-the bank by means of a rope, quickly made of bark. There it is cut up,
-and the expert knows exactly where to find the white, appetizing fat.
-The quantity varies: a well-fed beast provides over two bucketfuls. But
-one has to learn, not only how to prepare the fat, but also how to kill
-immediately with the first shot. Some foolish people had been reckless,
-and in many places the dead bodies of wounded animals were to be seen,
-which quickly decompose and become unfit for food. The elephant also
-was now regarded in a new light; ordinarily the elephant hunter gauges
-the length and weight of the tusk before firing; now the pressing
-question was: how much fat will the beast supply? For elephant fat is
-very good, and possibly tastes even better than that of the hippo.
-
-At Kunguliu the herds of cattle we had brought along were driven
-into the river, and swam across. Up till then the troops had crossed
-by ferry, on which Herr Kühlwein, the former traffic manager of our
-lost Northern Railway, now contented himself with the more modest
-post of “Traffic Manager, Kunguliu Ferry.” When we arrived, a bridge,
-three hundred and thirty yards long, had been completed, which was
-also capable of taking vehicles. On the south bank we went into camp
-near Niakisiku Plantation, belonging to Lieutenant Bleeck, of the
-Reserve, who had been called up. The Europeans’ houses had been fitted
-up as hospitals, and were fully occupied. At Logeloge we found the
-Headquarters of the Line of Communication, where a large number of
-roomy grass huts had been put up for the troops. The plantation itself,
-belonging to a company, comprised extensive sisal fields. Food also was
-cultivated in plenty. The country being free of tse-tse, supported a
-large amount of cattle, and the survivors of our pack-donkeys had been
-brought there from the tse-tse country north of the Rufiji. Here the
-families of the Europeans still lived in their solidly-built houses,
-and were thankful that the course of the operations had enabled them
-to continue their home and business life undisturbed for more than two
-years.
-
-At Logeloge, and at the agricultural experimental establishment
-of Mpanganya, which we reached next day, other Europeans of the
-neighbourhood had also collected, and, where the existing buildings
-failed to accommodate them, had built themselves houses with poles and
-cane, or grass. Here an unpleasant symptom also made its appearance.
-While the troops at the front were animated by the best spirit and
-great enterprise, things behind the front were not always the same.
-The people who understood least of the business always knew everything
-better, and fostered a certain amount of discontent. That kind of thing
-is catching, and in the long run undermines right feeling. Fortunately,
-however, many of the troops behind the front had enough soldierly
-pride to shut up the grousers pretty bluntly on occasion. In one of
-the hospitals there someone was becoming rather too free with his
-destructive criticism, and a wounded man answered: “I tell you what,
-the Commandant is the brain of the Force, but you’re its backside!”
-This unvarnished epithet was so apt, that it at once turned the laugh
-on the side of the speaker, and polished away the spot of tarnish that
-threatened to spread.
-
-The question now was, whether we should first turn to the north against
-the force at Kissengire, or against the one at Kilwa. The latter had
-not, as Major von Boemken had feared, moved on towards Livale, but,
-possibly influenced by the movements of our troops, had turned towards
-the north. It thus worked into the Kibata country, which, though rich,
-was very mountainous, and difficult for manœuvre, and as long as it
-remained there I did not think it would be very dangerous. I considered
-it sufficient merely to prevent it from pushing further towards the
-Rufiji, for which a weak force of five companies, under Major Schulz,
-was enough. Major von Boemken, who was anxious about Livale, had, with
-two companies and a 4-inch gun, made his way into the neighbourhood of
-Mpotora, a chance circumstance, from which, as will be seen, we later
-reaped great benefit. I had, therefore, a free hand to move on towards
-Kissengire. That was important, and enabled us to secure the rich
-supply country north of the lower Rufiji, and to get away the valuable
-stocks from thence to the middle Rufiji. Whether there would be an
-opportunity of obtaining a success in the field it was not possible to
-tell; but I thought that the enemy, since he had pushed troops from the
-Uluguru Mountains in an easterly direction to the neighbourhood of
-Kissengire, would exert some pressure from the north. So it was quite
-possible that we might find a favourable opportunity for a fight. We
-crossed the Rufiji at Utete in boats, and in a few days reached Makima,
-one day’s march south of Kissengire. By that time a sufficient garrison
-of two companies had been assembled at Kissengire, where it was
-actively employed in strengthening the position. A little to the north,
-at Maneromango, was a strong force of the enemy, and a European patrol,
-which had started out from Kiderengwa, reported that hostile troops had
-been moved from the west towards the Maneromango-Kissengire area.
-
-A few days after leaving Kiderengwa this patrol had got into a
-waterless country in terrible heat, and the various members had lost
-each other in the dense bush. They made their presence known by firing,
-and had no choice but to surrender to the English. Only the determined
-patrol-leader had managed to escape to a native village, where the
-inhabitants greeted him with apparent friendliness and brought him
-eggs. As he bent down to take them, they fell upon him, and handed him
-over to a patrol of English Askari concealed close by. An Askari with a
-mule, who behaved rather arrogantly, was to escort the German back. On
-the way the German, during conversation, drew his attention to faults
-in his bridle, and succeeded in seizing the mule and riding off on it
-with all speed. In the struggle which took place, he had seized the
-Askari’s rifle and shot him with it.
-
-To the east of Kissengire our patrols also pushed on to the north, and
-quite a number of minor engagements took place in the bush, in which
-the enemy at times suffered very severely. Further to the east, on
-the coast near Kissiju, other hostile detachments were also roaming
-about, and a small English man-of-war was there too. One morning
-Captain von Lieberman, with the 11th Company, surprised this opponent,
-and our Askari went for him with a will, cheering. The man-of-war was
-also fired upon with the field gun, and apparently several hits were
-obtained. After driving the enemy out of Kissiju, Captain von Lieberman
-returned. We also operated against the enemy’s communications, and
-small fights occurred almost daily.
-
-The closely-settled country is of simply fabulous fertility. Besides
-abundant flour, both Europeans and Askari had mangos, paw paws,
-mustapheles, cocoanuts, and other tropical fruits. We were surprised
-to see the large rice-fields, which were here close to the south side
-of Dar-es-Salaam, seeing that in peace-time most of the rice had come
-from India. Of cattle there was but little, but the companies began to
-send out shooting parties into the prairie, which was full of game, and
-extended especially on the western side of our positions. That there
-must be game in the vicinity was proved by the presence of numerous
-lions. Frequently a family of five lions wandered through our camp at
-night, and occasionally killed animals in it.
-
-While Headquarters was at Makima in October, a report came in which
-caused me to suppose that the landing of strong enemy forces at Kilwa,
-and the appearance of hostile detachments which, coming from the west
-towards Livale, had arrived on the Mbaranganda river, formed part of a
-big converging movement by the enemy against Livale. Strong forces of
-Portuguese had crossed the Rovuma, invaded the highlands of Makonde,
-and established themselves in the district of Nevala. The captain
-of the _Königsberg_, Captain Looff, had, after the evacuation of
-Dar-es-Salaam, proceeded by land, first to the _Königsberg’s_ old area
-on the Rufiji, and then to Lindi. He had now taken over command in the
-south. With the three newly-raised companies of Askari, the only troops
-available there at the moment, he had entrenched himself in front of
-the strong positions of the enemy who had landed at Lindi, covered the
-removal of the cargo of the store-ship from Ssudi to the north, and
-inflicted damage on the Portuguese, who had shown themselves on the
-lower Rovuma, by means of minor expeditions. His force was, however,
-rather too weak to enable him to turn against the Portuguese, who were
-advancing in his rear about Nevala, with any prospect of a rapid and
-decisive success.
-
-It was, therefore, very convenient that, as already mentioned, two
-companies and the 4-inch _Königsberg_ gun of von Boemken’s Detachment
-happened to be at Mpotora. To command this detachment, Captain
-Rothe, of the Reserve, was sent from the Rufiji, as he could in
-the circumstances be spared from his duties as Principal Postmaster
-(_Oberpostdirektor_), and had, at his urgent request, been placed at
-the unrestricted disposal of the Protective Force. In a few days he
-arrived from Niakisiku by cycle, took over his detachment, and led it
-towards Nevala. Captain Looff took command of the whole force, the
-Portuguese were thoroughly well hammered by the _Königsberg_ gun,
-and their positions were captured by assault. We took a really very
-considerable amount of booty, including four mountain guns, a number
-of machine guns, several hundred rifles, much ammunition, several
-automobiles, supplies, and all kinds of equipment. During the following
-weeks we continually found quantities of buried stores and ammunition.
-The very secret places were particularly well stocked. The Portuguese
-were driven completely out of German territory, and pursued for some
-distance into their own country. But consideration of the general
-situation prevented me from carrying on the pursuit to the uttermost.
-Rothe’s Detachment was brought back to Mpotora, in order to keep an
-eye on the enemy at Kilwa, who grew continually stronger. Even before
-this movement was executed, I considered it necessary to transfer
-strong forces from the neighbourhood of Kissengire towards Kibata. No
-opportunity had presented itself of fighting a decisive successful
-battle north of the lower Rufiji; as I had expected, I was obliged to
-proceed to a prolonged operation in the mountains of Kibata, which
-offered but little prospect of leading to a decision.
-
-The transfer of the troops towards Kibata took place at the end of
-November, 1916. On the way we encamped at Utete, where roomy hospitals
-had been established in the building of the Civil Government, and where
-an officers’ mess had been established on a _baraza_ (an airy veranda).
-The place was situated on dominating heights, and had been strongly
-fortified with trenches and abatis, and commanded the lower-lying
-and very extensive native town. Almost all night one heard the deep
-grunting of the hippo, and one impudent lion, having failed in his
-attack on a native, tried to kill another man in our camp. Fortunately
-his quarry was taken from him at the last moment by a European, who
-hurried to the spot, and several natives. Continuing, we reached
-the Moboro-Kibata road. Captain Schulz, who had with his detachment
-occupied a strong position two hours north of Kibata, was drawing his
-supplies from the country round Moboro. Several depots on this road
-were filled from the fertile country immediately surrounding them.
-In addition, Captain Schulz sent out parties to buy supplies in the
-districts near his camp, in which the whole wealth of the country is
-revealed.
-
-From a mountain near Mbindia, the camp of Schulz’s Detachment, one
-could see a broad forest track passing over the heights. This was the
-road for a 4-inch _Königsberg_ gun, which was being brought up to its
-position before Kibata by Lieut.-Commander Apel. Chanting in rhythm,
-hundreds of natives dragged the heavy load up and down the steep
-slopes, over which a suitable track had been surveyed and cut through
-the thick bush. Shortly after its arrival at Mbindia, the gun had been
-placed in position on a mountain saddle from which, later on, the
-bombardment was successfully carried out. One of the 4-inch howitzers
-was also got into position further forward in a valley, so as to fire
-over the high ground in front and reach the enemy’s camps. Detailed
-reconnaissances had disclosed the possibility of moving our infantry,
-concealed by the dense bush, into some high ground which commanded
-the country north of Kibata. The weak hostile force holding this high
-ground was surprised by an attack from the rear and quickly driven off.
-Then another height was attacked, situated at a water-hole immediately
-to the north of the solid European buildings. We could soon see our
-Askari climbing up it, and establishing themselves on it about eighty
-yards in front of a hostile position.
-
-By this time the deployment of our artillery was completed; besides the
-4-inch _Königsberg_ gun and the field-howitzer the two mountain guns
-had been brought into action, in line with our infantry. We had delayed
-opening fire on the buildings, where we saw numbers of men and animals
-walking about on the bare hill-top, until everything was ready. One
-company which had got round the enemy’s rear, and established itself
-on his main line of communication, running from Kibata to Kilwa,
-observed that the heavy shells falling near the Boma (Fort) caused a
-frightful panic. Heaps of the enemy’s Askari ran away as fast as they
-could, across the front of the company which was lying in concealment.
-But unfortunately the company allowed itself to be deterred from taking
-advantage of this favourable opportunity. It hoped that the scattered
-parties of Askari would soon be followed by larger bodies, and did
-not want to give away the chance of a surprise prematurely. But the
-expected large bodies did not come, and thus, as unfortunately happened
-often, a good opportunity was lost through waiting for a better. The
-infantry attack on the above-mentioned heights immediately north of
-Kibata had involved the loss of several very efficient Europeans.
-Sergeant-Major Mirow was killed, Vice-Sergeant-Major Jitzmann was
-shot in the leg and sustained a severe and very painful injury to the
-nerve of his leg. He had previously often distinguished himself by his
-untiring and successful raids on the Uganda Railway. Through prolonged
-detention in hospital he was now lost to the Service, and fell into the
-enemy’s hands before he was recovered.
-
-It was very difficult to find one’s way in the extraordinarily rugged
-mountains of Kibata. A number of reconnoitring expeditions were sent
-out and after a few days we felt more or less at home. It was possible
-to obtain a good view of Kibata and of the enemy’s communications, and
-we ascertained that he was reinforcing his troops more and more. As
-a matter of fact he employed at Kibata the main body of the division
-landed at Kilwa. Our observations and the peculiarities of the ground
-led us to expect that the enemy intended to work from Kibeta round our
-right, or western, flank, and thus force us to evacuate the heights
-commanding Kibata and its water-supply from the north. A direct attack
-by the 120th Baluchis had been defeated with great loss to the enemy.
-During the opening days of December we observed at first weak, and then
-stronger detachments, which pushed forward from hill to hill towards
-our right flank, and whose advanced parties soon reached a commanding
-mountain, known to the English as Gold Coast Hill. Our counter-stroke
-against this force was at first favoured by ravines and forests, and
-our Askari surprised even us when they became visible close in front of
-the enemy’s positions. Our guns were ready to fire, but unluckily the
-first shell pitched among our own men, and the infantry attack, which
-could only succeed by rapidity and surprise, failed. However, the fire
-of our two mountain guns at under 1,800 yards, and of our howitzers,
-which were further back, caused quite considerable casualties among
-the Gold Coast Regiment. The enemy was on a narrow hog’s-back, the
-steep slopes of which were for the most part bare. He could, therefore,
-hardly withdraw, and in the hard ground entrenching took a long time.
-We then surrounded the hill with infantry, and poured a converging
-fire on the good targets presented to us. It became impossible for the
-enemy to hold this highly important position any longer. After it was
-evacuated we found a large number of graves, each for many bodies, and
-at this point the enemy must have lost not less than 150 killed.
-
-The advance of the Gold Coast Regiment had nevertheless been of
-advantage to the enemy. My force being so weak—we had, all told, about
-nine companies—I had withdrawn one of the two companies stationed in
-the immediate vicinity of Kibata in order to employ it against Gold
-Coast Hill. After I had returned to camp that night I heard the sound
-of a number of small detonations emanating from the one company left
-alone to face the enemy. It was only after some time that we recognized
-this as a grenade attack, a manœuvre then unknown to us. Several
-companies of the enemy attacked with such rapidity and skill, that they
-penetrated the trenches of our weak company by surprise and drove it
-out. The loss of this position deprived us of the possibility of firing
-at close range from that very suitable height at hostile troops moving
-about, or proceeding to their water-supply. Until then I had done so
-with success, and had even occasionally sent up a light gun to the
-place, withdrawing it again after it had ceased fire.
-
-But the loss of this high ground and the casualties sustained in it
-faded into insignificance beside the success achieved on Gold Coast
-Hill. In spite of our inferiority in numbers, we completely dominated
-the situation. Our patrols and stronger raiding parties worked right
-round the enemy’s rear and pushed on to his communications. Minor
-enterprises on his part produced no results. On the whole, the enemy
-suffered very considerable casualties at Kibata, and I think they
-should be estimated at not less than four hundred men. The operations
-intended by him were also completely wrecked. There can be no doubt
-that he waited to advance from Kilwa on Livale. Our vigorous action at
-Kibata forced him to move from Kilwa against us, and to leave the rest
-of the country and the whole of our supply and transport apparatus in
-peace. Towards the end of December hostile planes appeared, cruising
-about over our positions and dropping bombs. Although they now used
-far more powerful bombs than formerly, they hardly inflicted any
-casualties. On Christmas Day we saw a larger mass than usual falling on
-the Boma of Kibata. We were disappointed in our hope that the enemy was
-bombing his own camp; it was only a large quantity of cigarettes as a
-Christmas present for the troops.
-
-One day, during that period, I received a personal letter from the
-British Commander-in-Chief, General Smuts, in which he informed me
-that I had been awarded the Order Pour le Mérite, and expressed the
-hope that his cordial congratulations would not be unacceptable to
-me. I thanked him equally politely, although I at first believed that
-he was confusing it with the Second Class of the Order of the Crown
-with Swords, which I had received a short time before. I mention this
-letter from General Smuts as a proof of the mutual personal esteem and
-chivalry which existed throughout in spite of the exhausting warfare
-carried on by both sides. On many other occasions also the enemy
-intimated his great appreciation of the achievements of the German
-forces.
-
-At the end of 1916 I regarded the military situation in the Colony as
-remarkably favourable, for I knew that the South African troops were
-for the most part worn out with battle-casualties and sickness, while
-a large proportion of the remainder were returning to South Africa at
-the end of their engagements. Prisoners had repeatedly assured us that
-they had had enough of the “picnic” in East Africa. The Indian troops
-also, who had been in the field in East Africa for some length of time,
-were reduced in numbers, while the late arrivals—we identified Indian
-Pathan Regiments at Kibata—consisted largely of young soldiers. Other
-regiments, like the 129th Baluchis, who had fought in Flanders, were no
-doubt very good, but they might not be expected to stand the fatigues
-of African warfare for a very prolonged period. The enemy’s Askari
-were, generally speaking, new troops, and only a small proportion of
-them had at that time been in the field. So we could continue calmly
-to contemplate the continuation of the war for a considerable time.
-I still believe that we would have succeeded not only in holding our
-own, but even in beating the enemy, if he had not enjoyed the power of
-continually filling up his reduced units and of bringing up fresh ones.
-At the end of 1916 I did not know that this had already been effected
-on an extensive scale. Among other reinforcements a strong brigade of
-black troops had been brought from Nigeria to Dar-es-Salaam, whence it
-had been moved on without delay to Dutumi and Kissaki.
-
-In the early days of January, 1917, the five companies encamped
-there under Captain Otto were attacked by General Smuts with at
-least two brigades. In planning his attack the enemy had provided
-for simultaneous wide turning movements, which, with his greatly
-superior numbers, enabled him to bar the retreat of our troops towards
-Kungulio. More than once our Askari had to clear their way with the
-bayonet, and in the close country some of our companies got into very
-awkward situations. In withdrawing to Behobeho our field howitzer,
-having only a weak escort, was ambushed by a hostile force of several
-companies, and was lost, after the whole detachment had been killed.
-But in the end all portions of the detachment successfully avoided
-being surrounded, and in assembling at Behobeho. At this place very
-heavy fighting immediately took place, in which the enemy also fought
-with great bravery. It was in this action that the old hunter Selous
-was killed, who was well known even among Germans, on account of his
-charming manner and his exciting stories. He had joined as a subaltern.
-With a superior enemy before him and on both flanks, and behind him the
-mighty Rufiji, crossed only by the one frail bridge, Captain Otto yet
-succeeded in reaching the south bank of the river, with all his troops,
-and in destroying the bridge, in accordance with his instructions.
-
-We had also observed a wide turning movement which the enemy was making
-from Kissaki further west towards Mkalinzo on the Rufiji, which now
-became ineffective. The hostile brigade undertaking it did not reach
-the south bank of the Rufiji in time to oppose Captain Otto’s passage,
-and thus render his situation desperate; on the contrary, we gained
-partial successes which were quite considerable. The enemy following
-us from Behobeho came on very vigorously and passed a large part of
-his force over the Rufiji at Kungulio in boats. Captain Otto held his
-detachment in readiness a little to the south of the river, and now
-attacked the enemy, of whom part only had crossed over, and completely
-defeated him with heavy loss. This partial success was favoured by
-the inaction of the hostile column, which, as already mentioned, was
-making the turning movement by Mkalinzo. It consisted principally of
-whites, and a part of the black Nigerian troops. Neither of them were
-equal to the long march involved, and had therefore reached the Rufiji
-exhausted and unfit for further operations. They remained out of action
-for quite a long time, and the unity of General Smuts’ otherwise quite
-well-planned operation was wrecked.
-
-In consequence of the enemy’s advance in force at Kungulio, the danger
-arose that he might gain possession of the middle Rufiji, and of the
-country to the south of it. He might then easily seize the bulk of
-our stores, and our whole system of communications, which for the
-most part ran from the middle Rufiji towards Livale. It was therefore
-necessary for me to meet his movements with our main body, which was
-before Kibeta, and so I marched off with the greater part of it to Lake
-Utungi, where I would be in a position to help Captain Otto, or to
-seize any favourable opportunity that might offer.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VIII
-
-ANXIETIES AND HARDSHIPS DURING OUR STAY IN THE RUFIJI COUNTRY
-
-
-OUR march from Kibata was on the first day carried out according to
-plan. On the following day I rode ahead with a few companions, in
-the expectation that the troops who had several native guides with
-them would not fail to find the way. In the Kissi mountains we came
-upon large numbers of natives who, however, were very timid and often
-deserted their flourishing rice plantations on our approach. Later in
-the day I regretted that I did not appropriate some of this abundant
-produce for our own use. During the midday heat we rested at Pori.
-Some of my companions who knew the country called my attention to the
-acid Mbinji fruit, which we found very refreshing. Unfortunately we
-did not know at that time that the stone of this fruit, when roasted,
-makes an excellent dish, tasting like our hazel-nut. The heat was
-overpowering, but as we were in the neighbourhood of the enemy patrols
-we had to keep a sharp look-out. The springs and water-courses were
-now dried up; after a long search we at last found a small pool of
-dirty water, which, however, we were told was not injurious to health.
-Towards evening we reached the great deserted settlement. Here we
-were fortunate enough to find a negro in the employ of the German
-Government, who informed us that we were at Ungwara, our destination
-for that day. After we had walked through the place, the man showed
-us a pool near which we pitched our camp. My old black cook, the
-bearded Baba, well known to many East Africans, had very nearly kept up
-with our horses, and, following our trail, soon arrived. He had soon
-prepared his _uzeli_ (boiled rice), and was sitting contentedly by the
-fire. We watched him enviously, for we had nothing, and were waiting
-for our baggage and the troops. But no one came and we lay down,
-hungry, to sleep. The friend in need, however, was approaching in the
-shape of a splendid sable-antelope, which in the brilliant moonlight
-was coming down to drink. Almost simultaneously the rifles of two of
-my companions, van Booyen and Nieuwenhuizen, experienced Boer hunters,
-who had become Germans, rang out. We sprang from our blankets as though
-we had received an electric shock, and within a short time the first
-pieces of delicate flesh were roasting on the spit.
-
-On the following day we reached Lake Utungi, where Captain Feilke was
-awaiting us, and we refreshed ourselves with bread, coffee and sausage
-made from antelope flesh. There was still no trace of the troops. They
-had lost us in Pori, and almost all completely lost their bearings. One
-detachment did not get into touch with us until several days later,
-when they came upon our telephone line in the neighbourhood of Utete.
-In view of the difficulty of communication, it had hitherto been
-impossible to get an accurate estimate of the state of our supplies.
-I had expected to find well-filled depots at Mpanganya on Lake Utungi
-and in the neighbourhood of Madaba. This was why I had pressed on out
-of the fertile country north of the lower Rufiji through Mpanganya to
-the line-of-communication area. The question of supplies had developed
-quite differently from my expectations.
-
-In the line-of-communication area, in addition to the large numbers of
-bearers necessary for the transport of war material to the south, a
-numerous _personnel_ was maintained, who were employed on road-making,
-building grass huts and for other purposes. Even in the small depots
-there were always a number of men who, whenever possible, did nothing
-but fetch supplies, which they ate themselves. Often the supplies
-were even fetched by others who, in their turn, had to be fed. In
-many places it was almost the case that a load of supplies collected
-and forwarded by the fighting troops in the north finally landed in
-a small depot, and were devoured by these people who had nothing
-else to do. In view of the difficulties of transport, and the great
-distances, even the energy and thoroughness of Captain Stemmermann,
-who had taken charge of the depots, did not succeed in detecting and
-putting a stop to these abuses. Further, there were too many people in
-Africa whose propensity for diverting valuable energy to non-essentials
-to the prejudice of the really important things that it would take a
-very strong broom to sweep them away. The general result of all these
-obstacles was that thousands and thousands of useless mouths were
-devouring the supplies which had been collected with great effort in
-the region occupied by the fighting forces. The depot did nothing for
-the supplies, but, on the other hand, lived on them, and the most
-serious point was that the moment was at hand when the areas from which
-the supplies were drawn would have to be evacuated by the fighting
-forces. It was a difficult situation. It was necessary to lose no time
-in putting under cultivation the territory we were then occupying—that
-is to say, the country round Madaba and Livale, and in the southern
-parts of the Protectorate, which were likely to be the scene of the
-subsequent operations. But months must elapse before any results could
-be obtained from these measures. During these months we should have to
-remain on the Rufigi and live there. Here, it is true, some hundreds of
-acres of maize were standing, but even these would require months to
-ripen. Until this time came the force could not move south; it would
-have to remain in the unproductive area which it was then occupying.
-
-The accomplishment of this task was difficult. The order had
-at once to be given for the removal of every man who was not
-absolutely indispensable for carrying on the war during the next
-few months. This meant that thousands of bearers and workmen in the
-line-of-communication area were sent home. The most serious drawback
-to this step had to be reckoned with; we were sending over to the
-enemy thousands of men from whom he was bound to gain detailed
-information as to our strength, the condition of our supplies and our
-internal organization. Nor was it enough to cut down the _personnel_
-of our lines of communication. The non-combatant _personnel_ of the
-companies was also reduced. Among other things, it was laid down that
-henceforward no European should have more than five native attendants.
-That sounds a generous allowance to European ears, but under African
-conditions native attendance is really indispensable to the European.
-He requires at least one man or boy to cook for him and attend to
-his personal needs, and, in addition, it must be remembered that all
-baggage, kit, rations, blankets and tent-material, has to be carried
-whenever he moves. When one considers that in peace-time a travelling
-official on a long _safari_ (journey) took with him from eleven to
-thirteen bearers, in addition to two or three personal servants, it
-will be understood how drastic this new order was and what a storm of
-indignation it aroused. Fortunately I was in a position, when appealed
-to on grounds of health and decency, to point to the fact that I myself
-had for months managed with three, or at a pinch two, loads—that is,
-four negroes—and had kept in good health. I am still particularly
-grateful to those regimental officers who, as on so many other
-occasions, saw the necessity of this vexatious regulation and set the
-example. They upheld the tradition of our officer-corps by not claiming
-any special comforts for themselves, and were the first to submit to
-the unavoidable discomfort. I believe that among all the soldiers and
-non-combatants up to the highest civilian official, there is not one
-who still condemns this order, at first so strongly opposed.
-
-But reduction of the number of food-consumers alone was not sufficient
-to solve the problem of existence; the supplies would not go round. It
-was already obvious that the supplies from the area of the fighting
-force, which were, of course, being worked at high pressure, would not
-suffice to feed us until the new harvest at the end of March. After
-close and mature consideration, we found it impossible to avoid the
-necessity of cutting down the rations, a measure which went very much
-against the grain, as even the native, if he is to be relied on, must
-be well fed. This gave rise to a fresh and much stronger outburst of
-indignation. From all sides came telegrams and messages to say that
-it was impossible to get the calories of nourishment necessary for a
-fighting man from the daily cereal ration, fixed at six hundred grammes
-of meal. But the hard fact had to be faced that only a certain quantity
-was available, and we must make the best of it. The reduction of the
-cereal ration could not be avoided. For the rest, each man and each
-company would have to try to make good the shortage by hunting, which
-in this region, where game abounded, could be managed with the exercise
-of a little agility. But logic is apt to go to pieces with many people
-when it comes to a question of daily food, and many did not scruple to
-lay the whole blame for the at times barely sufficient ration at the
-door of the wicked commander-in-chief, and even to do all they could
-to have the daily ration increased to its former amount. This I had to
-bear calmly, and I made my own observations as to who were the men to
-make the best of an unavoidable necessity and who were not.
-
-In carrying out these drastic measures new difficulties were
-encountered. A crowd of Askari women had followed the force, and had
-attached themselves to various camps on the Rufiji, where they were
-very comfortable. I was most anxious to send them south, where the
-question of supplies was less difficult. The necessary transport was
-arranged for, and the women were given rations for the march. After one
-short day’s march, however, the women simply lay down, and declared
-that they could go no further. Their rations, which were intended to
-last a considerable time, were all eaten by the third day, and they
-were crying out for more. Some even went so far as to attack and beat
-the European who was in charge of the transport. Even under a dark
-skin the gentler sex did not always scruple to make full use of their
-prerogatives, which are usually justified.
-
-Finally we got over this difficulty, and a tolerable solution was found
-to the ration problem. The Askari, to whom the position was explained,
-saw the difficulty and were very reasonable. Skilled hunters were sent
-to the different hunting-grounds, and the empty stomachs from time to
-time more generously filled. I remember that with us on Lake Utungi our
-two hundred blacks in one day completely devoured a big buffalo and an
-elephant. It was often found possible to give a piece of antelope to
-the passing caravans of bearers.
-
-In the course of February the stores in our supply dumps, of which I
-took stock every day, ran out. I began to fear that for reasons of
-supply we would not be able to wait for the ripening of the corn on
-the Rufiji. In that case, not only would the harvest be lost, but the
-crops growing further south could not be used to the best advantage.
-There we should have to use the grain that was actually ripe and pass
-on, leaving the unripe portion standing. A lucky chance came to my aid
-in this dilemma. I went one day from Lake Utungi to Mpanganya to see
-Captain Tafel, who was handling the tactical and commissariat problems
-there with admirable efficiency. I spent the night in his camp, and
-he set before me an excellent dish of young maize prepared like
-asparagus. This led us to speak of the maize fields of Mpanganya and
-the neighbourhood. These were full of women and other natives who had
-swarmed over them like a flock of birds, and were living on the young,
-unripe corn. This was as bad economy as well could be, but it gave me
-the idea that in case of need the maize crops could be largely used
-before they were ripe. This need very soon occurred, and an experiment
-with the ears which had ripened most showed that these could be
-artificially dried and a very good meal made from them. After this, the
-ripest ears were gathered daily, and as the whole crop ripened the food
-situation improved from day to day. By 1st March it was found possible
-to increase the ration to seven hundred grammes, or nearly the normal
-allowance.
-
-The increasing severity of the whole campaign called for a more
-intensive and energetic exploitation of our food resources; the slow,
-deliberate supply methods of the civil authorities, which had sufficed
-for the first phase of the campaign, were no longer adequate. Twice, at
-Kissaki and on the Rufiji I had been put in a most difficult position
-with regard to supplies, which had almost made it impossible to carry
-on the operations. A more efficient supply service which would know
-the military needs, look ahead and work more quickly and energetically
-was a vital necessity for the further carrying on of the campaign.
-Fortunately I was able to convince the Governor on this point, and, as
-a result, a new supply detachment was raised from the force, and sent
-ahead to Massassi, via Livale. They established several subsidiary
-detachments, which were attached to the administrative stations in
-the Lindi area, and in this way worked side by side with the civil
-authorities in organizing, and, later, in carrying out, the cultivation
-and storing of food. In this way the desired impregnation of the
-supplies and transport service with the necessary military spirit was
-completely attained.
-
-At this time there was no appreciable shortage of kit, and there was
-also an adequate supply of arms and ammunition.
-
-With a view to the envelopment of the enemy at Mkalinzo, where he
-was reported to be in strong force, Captain Otto had marched his
-detachment south from Kungulio. North of Mawa he covered the fertile
-area of Madaba, and the line of transport and telephone communication
-running from Lake Utungi, via Mawa to Madaba. On 24th January, 1917,
-Captain Otto was attacked north of Mawa by several battalions of the
-Nigerian brigade. The enemy was beaten off with heavy losses and
-pursued several miles through the bush to an entrenched position, where
-he took refuge. The troops under Captain Schulz, who had been left
-behind after our departure from Kibeta, were gradually withdrawn to
-Ungwara. They had been reinforced and relieved from time to time after
-the fighting in the region of the Kibeta-Utete-Kissi mountains. Strong
-enemy forces—identified as an infantry brigade—had followed them. In
-spite of his numerical superiority, the single engagements were very
-costly, and for the most part unfavourable for the enemy. Captains
-von Lieberman, Goering and Koehl, and numerous patrol leaders on many
-occasions completely routed more than twice their number of Indian or
-negro troops, and captured rifles, machine guns and ammunition. The
-long war had produced a large number of capable leaders, and their
-example, as in the case of Lieutenant Kroeger, who was afterwards
-killed, roused unbounded enterprise and daring. Over and over again,
-and without stopping to ask the strength of the opposing force, this
-officer, followed by a handful of men with fixed bayonets and cheering
-loudly, had charged the enemy in the thick of the bush. He had even
-trained the Askari. Several of these distinguished themselves as patrol
-leaders, and when later the brave Effendi, of the 4th Field Company,
-with his patrol, routed an entire Indian company, we owed the success
-to this training at Ungwara.
-
-Our line of communication to the south, passing through Madeba and
-Livale, was in danger from a strong enemy force west of Kibata, and it
-was necessary that we should afford it adequate protection. This meant
-a gradual move south of our forces from the Rufiji, especially as our
-supplies on this part of the river were coming to an end and the rainy
-season was at hand.
-
-It was particularly important that we should not evacuate this part of
-the Rufiji until the rains had set in. This would mean a considerable
-gain in time for us, as, during the actual rainy season and immediately
-after, the operations would, of necessity, come to a standstill, and
-the corn, particularly the _mtema_ (millet), would have time to ripen.
-
-When the migrations of the ants warned us that the rains were at hand,
-orders were given, as a precautionary measure, that the women, children
-and non-combatants should as far as possible be transferred to the
-north bank of the Rufiji, and thence transported to Dar-es-Salaam. This
-step, which the approaching rains and the state of the supplies made
-necessary, aroused much discontent, which I was obliged to treat with
-the same indifference as the previous outbursts of indignation. I am,
-however, still of the opinion that the timely removal of these people
-was much better for them than spending part of the rainy season on the
-drenched ground or in flooded dwellings with insufficient food.
-
-The rains, which set in at the end of March, were particularly heavy
-in 1917. The site of our camp, which was slightly elevated, became an
-island, from which access to the outer world was only possible by boat
-through the Rufiji wood. A number of people were drowned in the wood
-during the rains; others had to take refuge for days in the trees.
-The water rose so high that in Mpanganya it reached the high-lying
-dwellings of the Europeans, and invaded the hospitals and disturbed
-every kind of filth. It was impossible for women and children, sick
-and wounded to remain, and after the withdrawal of the troops they had
-to give themselves up to the English, who took pity on their need, and
-provided them with food and transport.
-
-The majority of the troops marched south out of the flooded districts
-on the Rufiji and Lake Utungi in good time, after using up the
-available crops almost to the last grain. The evacuation was carried
-out gradually and in echelon; the greater part of the troops were
-assembled in Mpotora, which was occupied by Captain Rothe, in a
-fortified camp, with his two companies which had defeated the
-Portuguese at Nevala. Only a few small detachments were left on the
-Rufiji, and these were gradually reduced to the strength of patrols.
-Four days’ march east of Madaba the detachments of Koehl and Goering
-had the opportunity of some successful skirmishes against enemy
-detachments on the western edge of the Matumbi Mountains. Gradually,
-however, all these detachments were brought to Mpotora, and only
-Captain Otto remained in the higher regions of Madaba.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IX
-
-THE END OF THE FRONTIER DEFENCE IN THE SUBSIDIARY THEATRES
-
-
-IN August, 1916, Major Kraut had gradually retired from Kilossa on
-Mahenge, leaving only Schoenfeld’s division at Kidodi, on the Ruaha.
-Captain Braunschweig’s force was embodied in Major Kraut’s command. Of
-these Captain Falkenstein, with the 5th Field Company, had retired,
-at the end of May, 1916, from Ipyana, and Captain Aumann, with his
-company, from the Mbozi region in the direction of Lupembe and Maubire.
-During the retirement there was continual skirmishing. Our weak
-divisions had to make a stand against the pursuing enemy, at least a
-brigade strong.
-
-At the end of June, 1916, Captain Braunschweig, who was then at
-Dodoma, was sent through Iringa, and his force was strengthened to
-five companies by the addition of the Kondoa troops and others brought
-from Dar-es-Salaam, including the two companies from Langenburg. One
-hundred of the crew of the _Königsberg_ from Dar-es-Salaam and a field
-howitzer were added to this force. At Malangali he accepted battle with
-the enemy, and apparently inflicted heavy losses. Then, however, he
-evacuated the position, and abandoned the howitzer, which was difficult
-to move, first making it useless. The difficulties of Braunschweig’s
-position were increased by the action of an important Wahehe chief in
-his rear, who rebelled and went over to the enemy with all his people
-and cattle. Captain Braunschweig then retired on Mahenge, fighting a
-succession of minor rearguard skirmishes, and put himself under the
-orders of Major Kraut.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. xv. March of Major-General Wahle in the West]
-
-After numerous minor engagements Major Kraut’s retiring divisions
-established themselves on the line of the Ruhudje and Ruaha rivers.
-In the fertile region round Mahenge the supplies were excellent, even
-after the evacuation of a large part of the rice-field west of the
-Ruhudje. On this river the enemy had established a strongly fortified
-camp at Mkapira. With our insufficient resources it was impossible to
-take this position by force, but there was a chance that by cutting
-the enemy’s line of communication with Lupembe, we might force him to
-evacuate the camp owing to shortage of food.
-
-Major Kraut crossed the river with five companies and a light field
-gun, and occupied a position in a semi-circle of hills in the enemy’s
-rear and right across his line of communication. In the enemy’s front
-weak forces covered the river bank on the Mahenge side. Unfortunately
-the fortified positions of our companies were so extended that, owing
-to the difficulties of the country, there was no guarantee that support
-could be brought up in time. On the——, before daybreak, the 10th
-Company on the right wing was surprised by a heavy enemy attack. The
-enemy also cleverly took the company’s position in the rear and, after
-inflicting heavy losses, put the machine guns out of action. On the
-left wing Lieutenant von Schroetter’s company was also attacked from
-all sides, and had to cut its way out with the bayonet, losing the
-light field gun and a machine gun. In view of the heavy casualties of
-the enemy, Major Kraut would have been able to remain on the west bank
-of the Ruhudje, in spite of this partial disaster, but fighting could
-be heard from the direction of Lupembe, where the 25th Field Company
-was covering his rear. Major Kraut thought, wrongly, that there,
-too, a sharp attack had been made, and, therefore, retired again to
-the east bank of the Ruhudje. To his astonishment the enemy’s strong
-entrenchments at Mkapira were found to be evacuated a few days later,
-the enemy having withdrawn in the night. Closer inspection showed that
-he had suffered heavy losses in the recent fighting. This, however, was
-not enough to explain his withdrawal; this riddle was not solved until
-later, on the appearance of General Wahle, with whom no communication
-had been established.
-
-In expectation of the opening of the big operations of 1916 the
-reinforcements that had been provisionally sent to Victoria Nyanza,
-Ruanda, the Russissi and the Tanganyika area were brought back and
-embodied into our main forces along the North railway. A single command
-for these minor theatres of war was required, and with this object a
-“western command” was established under Major-General Wahle, who for
-the most part co-ordinated and directed these operations from Tabora.
-In April and May, 1916, when the British main forces in the Kilima
-Njaro area had completed their march, and, after the rainy season,
-were beginning a fresh advance to the south, English and Belgians from
-Muansa, Lake Kiwu, the Russissi and Bismarckburg began to advance
-concentrically on Tabora through these minor theatres of war. Our weak
-divisions retired on this place.
-
-Major von Langenn retired at once from Tschangugu to Issawi, followed
-by Captain Wintgens from Kissenji. Heavy casualties were inflicted on
-the pursuing Belgian brigades in successful rearguard actions. The
-German detachment later continued its retirement on Mariahilf. The
-danger to our district from the strong Belgian forces on our heels
-had been correctly estimated by Captain Gudovius. When in June, 1916,
-strong English forces advanced across the Kagera, he retired south from
-Bukoba with his division. Owing to the difficulties of communication
-and getting information, a part of his force unfortunately ran upon
-strong Belgian forces in Ussuwi district. Captain Gudovius himself was
-wounded in the abdomen and fell into the enemy’s hands. The engagement
-went badly for us and cost us heavy losses. Individual bodies of the
-detachment, however, managed to fight their way through to Muansa and
-Uschirombo.
-
-In the middle of July, 1916, the English succeeded in effecting a
-surprise landing with about a brigade in the neighbourhood of Muansa.
-There, too, there was some skirmishing, favourable to us, and there the
-Commanding Officer, Captain von Chappuis, retired in the direction of
-Tabora. The troops from Muansa and those under Major von Langenn and
-Captain Wintgens established a new front, approximately on the line
-Schinjanga-St. Michael, and repulsed several Belgian attacks. Captain
-Zimmer had sunk the steamer _Goetzen_ at Kigoma and blown up the Wami.
-He then retired slowly along the railway to Tabora. Captain Hering
-von Usumbura followed suit. The fact that the operations were nearing
-Tabora gave General Wahle the opportunity to bring up quickly part of
-the troops from the north of Tabora, to make a dash west by rail and
-retire again at once. In this raid the 8th Field Company completely
-routed a Belgian battalion west of Tabora, and Wintgens’ detachment
-brought off a successful surprise attack west and north of Tabora.
-These minor victories were often considerable, and on several different
-days of skirmishing the enemy losses amounted to hundreds; several
-light howitzers were also captured in these raids.
-
-On 2nd June, 1916, the 29th Field Company was surrounded in its
-fortified position in the Namema mountains. In fighting his way
-through, the brave company commander, Lieutenant Franken, was severely
-wounded and taken prisoner. Lieutenant Hasslacher retired step by step
-on Tabora. In an affair of patrols south of this place he met with a
-hero’s death.
-
-In this way the troops of the western command were actually assembled
-at Tabora, and the moment had come for a systematic retirement to the
-south-east. These last operations and the capture of Tabora were not
-known at Headquarters until long afterwards. There was no means of
-communication with the western command. Major-General Wahle was aware
-that this retirement of our main forces was of first importance for
-the Mahenge area. Accordingly he gave orders for the march. At first
-the railway could be used for supplies and transport. The eastern
-column, under Major von Langenn, marched on Iringa, the centre column,
-under Captain Wintgens, on Madibira, and the western column, under
-Lieutenant Huebener, on Ilembule. Major Wahle accompanied the centre
-column. In this way they came upon the line of communication between
-Neu-Langenburg and Iringa, and the enemy’s dumps along this line.
-Huebener’s detachment lost touch, and surrendered, being enveloped by
-a superior force of the enemy at Ilembule. Langenn’s detachment was
-most unfortunately surprised by a burst of fire while crossing a ford
-near Iringa and lost heavily. The subsequent attack on Iringa was also
-costly and without success.
-
-Wintgens’ detachment surprised enemy dumps and columns near Madibira,
-and also captured a gun and some wireless apparatus. In spite of
-several days of stubborn fighting, they were unable to take Lupembe and
-the surrounding farms. The influence of Wahle’s advance immediately
-made itself felt in the Mahenge district. The apparently strong enemy
-troops, who from their fortified positions at Mkapira had carried out
-the successful raid against Major Kraut, now felt themselves seriously
-threatened in their rear. They evacuated their strong positions and
-retired on Lupembe. General Wahle took over the command of all the
-forces at Mahenge.
-
-At the end of 1916 the troops of General Wahle’s western command were
-grouped round Mahenge. From here he directed the operations extending
-approximately to the line Ssongea—Lupembe—Iringa—Kidodi.
-
-It has been said that all touch with General Wahle had been lost since
-July, 1916, until in October, 1916, his patrols joined up with those of
-Major Kraut south of Iringa.
-
-It was not, therefore, until after the fighting at Mkapira that Major
-Kraut, and through him Headquarters, learned of General Wahle’s
-advance; the development of the situation made a very different
-impression on the enemy. He must have regarded the advance of General
-Wahle’s columns against the English line of communication from Iringa
-to Langenburg, and Major Kraut’s accidentally simultaneous threat to
-Mkapira, as a widely-planned joint operation, which was seriously
-endangering his troops at Mkapira, even after Major Kraut had withdrawn
-to the east bank of the Ruhudje. He avoided this danger by a hasty
-retirement from Mkapira in a westerly direction.
-
-General Wahle’s columns at once concentrated in the Lupembe-Mkapira
-area. No news was received of Huebener’s western column. Its
-capitulation was not known until much later.
-
-Welcome though this reinforcement of the forces in the west was,
-there were difficulties of supplies, and it became necessary to put
-under cultivation a considerable area, stretching almost to Ssongea.
-Major Grawert’s detachment advanced to Likuju on the Ssongea—Liwale
-road, that of Major Kraut to the Mpepo region and Captain Wintgens’
-surrounded an enemy detachment in a fortified camp at Kitenda. The
-enemy quickly marched to the relief of this force, but the relieving
-troops were driven off with heavy losses. At the same time the position
-of Grawert’s detachment took a very unfavourable turn. The enemy had
-succeeded in driving off this force’s live-stock. As other supplies
-in the district were scanty, Major von Grawert, exaggerating the
-difficulties of supply, thought his position hopeless and surrendered
-in January, 1917. A transportable 8.8 air naval gun which had been
-brought to Lihuju with great difficulty fell into the enemy’s hands,
-as well as a number of good machine guns. In reality the position
-of Grawert’s force does not appear to have been so desperate as he
-supposed; at any rate, a strong patrol under Sergeant-Major Winzer, who
-refused to surrender, made its way south without being molested by the
-enemy, and, a few days later, found abundant supplies at small cost in
-the districts west of Tunduru. The conduct of this patrol gave further
-proof that there is almost always a way out, even of an apparently
-hopeless position, if the leader makes up his mind to face the risks.
-
-Meanwhile General Wahle’s supply difficulties were increasing. Whether
-they could have been modified by ruthlessly reducing the number of
-non-combatants, as had been done on the Rufiji, or whether the material
-welfare of the western command could have been substantially improved
-by greater care in procuring and rationing the available resources,
-could not be decided from my position on Lake Utungi. The temporary
-telegraph to Mahenge was very inefficient and often interrupted, and
-it took several days to get a despatch through from General Wahle in
-Mahenge to the troops. This made it difficult for me to get a view of
-the situation from the incomplete information at hand. Suffice it to
-say that the difficulties of supply in Mahenge were regarded as so
-acute that it was not considered possible to keep such strong forces
-concentrated there, and part of them would have to be withdrawn.
-
-Kraut’s and Wintgens’ forces were marched west to Gumbiro, whence
-they were to press on across the Ssongea-Wiedhafen road. It was
-thought that they would find adequate supplies in the mountains south
-of Ssongea. The report of this move reached me too late for me to
-interfere. From Gumbiro Captain Wintgens turned north and, near Lake
-Rukwa, successfully engaged an enemy column which had been following
-him; on nearing Tabora he got typhus and was taken prisoner. Captain
-Naumann led the force on until finally he surrendered to the pursuing
-enemy column near Kilima-Njaro towards the end of 1917. It is to be
-regretted that this operation, carried out with so much initiative and
-determination, became separated so far from the main theatre of war as
-to be of little use.
-
-Major Kraut had separated from Captain Wintgens in Gumbiro, and,
-carrying out General Wahle’s orders, had marched south. There was no
-difficulty about crossing the line of communication Ssongea-Wiedhafen,
-but as the enemy had strongly entrenched and secured his supply
-dumps, no booty was captured. In the open little was to be found in
-March, 1917, the poorest season of the year, a few months before the
-new harvest. After some rearguard actions against English troops a
-success was scored in a surprise attack on the small Portuguese camp at
-Mitomoul, on the Rovuma. Major Kraut then followed the river downstream
-to Tunduru and himself came to Headquarters to report. Two of his
-companies remained at Tunduru to guard the fertile district. The other
-three marched further east and were temporarily taken over by Captain
-Loof at Lindi.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER X
-
-LINDI AND KILWA
-
-
-THE operations of the last few months had narrowed the area from which
-supplies for the troops could be obtained. The productive areas of
-Lupembe, Iringa, Kissaki and the lower Rufiji had been lost, and the
-newly-occupied districts included wide stretches of barren land. The
-productivity of the more fertile areas was for the most part unknown;
-for instance, it was not known until during the subsequent operations
-what yield could be expected south-west of Kilwa and south-west of
-Livale, for example. At that time I only had a general idea that the
-eastern part of the Lindi area was very fertile and known as the
-granary of the colony. But this fertile region, owing to its nearness
-to the coast, was in a very precarious position, and it was already
-necessary to consider what should be done if it were lost.
-
-Our eyes naturally turned to the Portuguese territory across the
-Rovuma, but we had even less information about this than about parts
-of the German colony. Fortunately, however, a number of Portuguese
-chiefs had immigrated into German territory out of hatred for their
-oppressors, and, apart from this, we Germans enjoyed a very good
-reputation among the intelligent natives of Portuguese East Africa,
-many of whom worked on German plantations. Thus we were able to get
-at least an approximate picture of the district east of Lake Nyassa,
-and to take it as probable that south of the steppe-like zone of the
-Rovuma, in the neighbourhood of Mwembe, several days’ march, broad and
-thinly populated, lay a fertile region. An expeditionary force of a few
-hundred rifles under Major von Stuemer, crossed the Rovuma south of
-Tundura, and quickly took possession of Mwembe from where our patrols
-explored the banks of Lake Nyassa as far as the neighbourhood of Fort
-Jackson, and east half-way to Port Amelia.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. xvi. March of Main Force during operations on
-interior lines west of Lindi, June to November, 1917.]
-
-[Illustration: Fig. xvii. Battle of Mahiwa.]
-
-In view of the difficulty of communication—messengers from the
-telegraph station at Livale took about three days to get to Tunduru
-and five from there to Mwembe—it was difficult to get a clear idea
-of the situation at Mwembe. We had no definite news until Lieutenant
-Brucher personally reported at Headquarters in January, 1917. The
-European potatoes he brought with him gave us good hopes that supplies
-could be expected there. He reported that the country was fertile, as
-was also the region round Tunduru, where the war had so far hardly been
-felt. There were still large numbers of eggs and fowls in the richly
-cultivated district. When Brucher slept on the ground in Tunduru, this
-was regarded as a piece of bravado by the inhabitants, so little did
-they know about war. In view of the difficulties of transport and the
-constant movement of the troops, it became increasingly necessary to
-make the force less and less dependent on their inadequate line of
-communication. With this object the forces of Captains Goering and
-von Lieberman were also moved to the region south of Kilwa, where,
-according to the stories of some Europeans in the Kiturika mountains,
-there was plenty of food. In order to relieve the transport of supplies
-from the rear the troops were marched off to Kilwa without waiting for
-further investigation, and it was fortunate that the reports as to the
-fertility of this district were realized. In order to take the enemy,
-who had already moved some small forces half-way to Livale, as far as
-possible from south of his point of debarkation, and at the same time
-to secure the fertile districts south of Kilwa to Mbemkuru, Goering’s
-and von Lieberman’s divisions made a détour from Mpotora southwards and
-pressed forward, Goering’s force following the coast straight to Kilwa,
-and von Lieberman keeping further west and making for the Kilwa-Livale
-road. A weaker force followed this road to Kilwa and served as a
-reserve for the patrols, which several times surprised the enemy in
-his camps and threw him back. Our patrols were soon swarming in the
-neighbourhood of Kilwa. Several enemy dumps were surprised and part of
-the garrisons killed. On one of these occasions brave Sergeant-Major
-Struwe, who was afterwards killed, skilfully forced his way, with a
-large part of the 3rd Field Company, inside a dump, and, taking cover
-behind the sacks of flour, inflicted heavy losses on the enemy, who
-appeared from outside in great force. It was difficult to get much away
-from the dump, so the patrol had to content itself with destroying the
-greater part of the stores. One patrol took a field gun with it—a
-strange weapon for a patrol. After careful reconnaissance this reached
-the coast at Kilwa—Kissiwami, and bombarded some of the transports
-lying there.
-
-[Illustration: Native Types (1).
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-[Illustration: Native Types (2).
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-In May, 1917, Captain von Lieberman, who, with the 11th and 17th
-Companies, was occupying an entrenched position at Ngaula, a day’s
-march south of Kilwa on the Kilwa-Livale road, was attacked by eight
-companies with two guns. Lieutenant Buechsel, with his 17th Company,
-made such a heavy flank attack that he completely routed, one after
-the other, several of the enemy’s Askari companies, who took to
-their heels, followed by the 40th Indian Pathan Regiment. The enemy
-left about seventy dead on the field, and, as the English related
-afterwards, it was only by chance that we did not find his guns, which
-had stuck fast in a river.
-
-On the whole it seemed to us that the enemy’s forces were once
-more getting exhausted. Unless he brought over very considerable
-reinforcements it was obvious that the forces available would before
-long be worn out and his operations end in failure. It was already
-apparent that they were involving a great strain. It had been
-ascertained that a battery from the Indian interior had been brought to
-Kilwa and that a large number of new Askari companies were being raised.
-
-More dangerous than the enemy seemed to me the material position of
-our men. The cargo of wheat from the relief ship was coming to an end,
-and I thought it questionable whether bread could be baked from Mtama
-flour alone, without the addition of wheat flour. At that time I still
-regarded bread as an indispensable necessity for the nourishment of
-Europeans, and therefore I made experiments personally in baking bread
-without wheat flour. Unfortunately the results were unsatisfactory.
-Afterwards, under the stress of necessity, we all produced excellent
-bread without wheat. The methods differed widely. Later we made bread
-not only with mtama, but also with muhogo, sweet potatoes, maize, in
-short, with nearly every kind of meal, and with mixtures of all sorts
-of combinations, and later still improved the quality by the addition
-of boiled rice.
-
-The necessary kit also required attention. A shortage of boots was in
-sight. My experiments showed me that a European can go barefoot where
-there are tolerable paths, but never through the bush. Sandals, which
-anyone can make, given an odd bit of leather, proved helpful, but did
-not take the place of boots. To be ready for any emergency, I had some
-lessons in boot-making, and succeeded, with supervision, in producing
-an object that at a push could be taken for a left boot, though it was
-intended to be a right. It is very convenient for a European who knows
-the simplest rudiments of this craft to be able to kill an antelope and
-make a boot, or at any rate repair one, from his skin a few days later,
-without the help of any of the tools of civilization. A nail must
-serve as an awl, a tent-pole as a last, and the thread he can cut from
-the tough leather of a small antelope. As a matter of fact, however,
-we were never driven to these extremities, as we were always able to
-obtain the necessary kit and equipment from captured stores, and many
-captured saddles were cut up to make soles and heels for boots.
-
-Every European was becoming more and more like a South-African
-“Trekker” and was his own workman. Naturally, not always in person, but
-within the small independent household, consisting of his black cook
-and his black servant, which followed him about. Many had even provided
-themselves with a few hens which they took about with them, and the
-noise of these betrayed the position of German camps even as far as the
-native settlements. An order issued in one force that the crowing of
-cocks before 9 a.m. was forbidden brought no relief.
-
-The important question of salt was very simply solved by the troops
-at Kilwa, by the evaporation of sea-water. In order to secure the
-supply, which was beginning to run short, against the loss of the
-coast, salt-yielding plants were collected and the salt obtained from
-their ashes by lixiviation. We got this idea from the natives of the
-district, who supplied themselves with salt in this way. The salt thus
-obtained was not bad, but was never required to any extent, as we were
-always able to meet our requirements from the captured stores. The
-large numbers of elephants in this district furnished us with fat;
-sugar was replaced by the excellent wild honey which was found in large
-quantities. The troops had made an important step forward as regards
-supplies of grain. They found out how to ripen it artificially, and in
-this way provided against want.
-
-It should be noted here particularly that the Medical Corps, in spite
-of the difficult and constantly changing circumstances of life in the
-field, had succeeded in satisfactorily solving the important questions
-of quinine and material for bandages. It has already been mentioned
-that in the north quinine tablets of better quality than the English
-had been added to the stock of Peruvian bark. After the evacuation of
-the northern area a large consignment of Peruvian bark had been sent
-to Kilossa. Through the efforts of the Deputy Staff Medical Officer,
-Staff-Surgeon Teute, a part of this was transported further south. It
-was of course impossible without the necessary apparatus to manufacture
-tablets, but liquid quinine was produced by boiling Peruvian bark. This
-had an infernal taste and was drunk unwillingly but with beneficial
-results by the patients, among whom it was known as “Lettow-Schnaps.”
-
-The other difficulty was the supply of bandages. To supplement the
-stock of linen, which was beginning to give out, not only was clothing
-of all kinds disinfected and used for this purpose, and then after
-being boiled used again, but quite a good bandage-material was made
-from bark. This idea, too, we got from the methods of the natives,
-who for a long time had made clothing and sacks from Myombo bark.
-The medical service had done everything humanly possible to keep the
-troops alive and well. The great resource of this service and the
-necessary husbanding of the primitive material available deserve
-special recognition, as this service had always been accustomed under
-the special conditions of a tropical climate, and rightly so, to be
-very free with their stocks. The Staff Medical Officer, Staff-Surgeon
-Stolowsky, and later his successor, Staff-Surgeon Teute, showed
-exemplary devotion, energy and foresight.
-
-The surgery was on an equally high level. The hospitals which, during
-the early part of the campaign, had been accommodated for the most
-part in solid buildings, and had worked the whole year round without
-moving their quarters, had now to turn themselves into movable columns,
-which might at any moment be called upon to pack up, with patients
-and baggage, and keep up with the march in various directions of the
-troops. All not absolutely indispensable material had to be eliminated,
-so that the preparations for a surgical operation had always to be more
-or less improvised. The operating-theatre was as a rule a newly-erected
-grass hut. In spite of all this, Staff-Surgeon Müller, Dr. Thierfelder,
-of the Imperial Medical Service, and others successfully performed even
-serious operations, including several for appendicitis.
-
-As has already been mentioned, the confidence even of the enemy in the
-German medical service was fully justified. The successful and devoted
-activity of these men went far to strengthen the mutual confidence
-between white and black. In such ways as this the strong bond was
-formed which united the different elements of our force.
-
-At Lindi the enemy had strengthened himself more and more, and it was
-reported that detachments were being transported by sea to Lindi,
-which hitherto had been posted west of Kilwa. General O’Grady, who had
-commanded a brigade at Kibata, also appeared at Lindi. The obvious idea
-that the enemy would advance from Lindi against our weak forces and our
-main supply area, as had been his intention earlier at Kilwa, appeared
-to be materializing. Several attacks had been beaten off by Captain
-Looff’s force west of Lindi. At the request of the Governor three of
-the companies which had arrived under Major Kraut were not, as had
-been the original intention, used to subjugate quickly and thoroughly
-the rebellious inhabitants of Makonde, in the south-east corner of our
-Protectorate, but were put under the command of Captain Looff. Two of
-them took part in an attack on Sudi, south of Lindi, where the enemy
-was strongly entrenched. The attack on the fortified position was
-bravely launched, but suffered heavy losses, and could not be brought
-to a successful conclusion.
-
-Later, Captain Rothe was ordered to Lindi with reinforcements
-consisting of three companies from Mpotora. But the rains spoiled our
-plans. The crossing of the Matendu had already become difficult. All
-the rain that had fallen in Donde district collected ultimately in
-the valley of the Matendu, which in the dry season is simply a series
-of pools. It had become a strong, rushing torrent, like the Fulda in
-spate at Cassel, and tore up great trees in its course. By making use
-of some islands, tree-trunks were got into position under the direction
-of skilled engineers and a bridge to take transport was built; but
-a sudden rise in the stream repeatedly swept it away, several men
-being drowned. A footbridge further downstream met with the same
-fate; a narrow suspension-bridge of ropes made from twisted bark was
-only of slight service and was somewhat uncertain as, in view of the
-alternation of strong sunlight and wet, there was always a danger of
-the ropes rotting and giving way.
-
-At Nahungu, on the Mbemkuru, similar conditions hindered Captain
-Rothe’s march. The stream was so strong that the first attempt to
-cross by the few ferry-boats available failed. Driven out of Nahungu
-by scarcity of supplies, Captain Rothe marched into the fertile region
-to the north-east, in this way seriously compromising the plans of
-Headquarters. It was necessary that this fertile country north-east of
-Nahungu should be spared to serve as a reserve for the forces south of
-Kilwa and to provide for a strong reinforcement of these troops should
-tactical reasons make this necessary. The time that was lost before a
-message could be got through to Captain Rothe was very vexatious, but
-finally his division was diverted towards Lindi again in time to take
-part in some of the fighting.
-
-In view of the need for reinforcement of our troops at Lindi owing
-to increased tension of the military situation and the projected
-transference of fresh troops to that area, General Wahle had been
-withdrawn from Mahenge and had taken over the command of the Lindi
-front; Captain Tafel succeeded him at Mahenge. In the middle of June,
-1917, General Wahle had, after several engagements which had brought
-to light a considerable increase in the enemy’s strength, retired so
-far up the Lukuledi river that the enemy seemed to be incautiously
-exposing his north flank.
-
-I decided to make use of this advantage without, indeed, knowing
-exactly how it was to be done. So much was clear: that only a surprise
-attack promised success. I therefore advanced, with four companies and
-the mountain-battery consisting of two guns, through Nahungu, along
-the main road leading via Lutende to Lindi. At Lutende were encamped
-Captain von Chappuis’ company and Lieutenant Wunder’s company, and
-the rest were further back. I went on ahead to reconnoitre, with my
-able companion Nieuwenhuizen, who had played the chief part in the
-horse-drive on Erok mountain. From the height on which Chappuis’
-company lay, there was an extensive view: one could see the different
-farmhouses round Lindi and the Lukuledi river with the steamer
-_President_, which had taken refuge there and been rendered useless. It
-was, perhaps, fortunate that no wild pigs or bush deer had come within
-range of our guns in this otherwise gameless district, for not far from
-Chappuis’ camp we crossed the trail of a strong enemy patrol which must
-only just have passed. The talk of the natives, too, led us to suppose
-that they had recently seen something interesting. When we questioned
-them they would tell us nothing. Making a wide détour, we arrived in
-the evening, after dark, at the camp of Wunder’s company. We reported
-our observations to the company commander and the capable guide
-Inkermann, who died a hero’s death a few days later, warning them to
-keep a sharp look-out. Orders were also given that this camp, situated
-as it was in an open plain and exposed to fire from the surrounding
-bush, should be moved. After a cup of tea we returned to our main force
-about a quarter of an hour’s march to the rear.
-
-On the morning of 30th June we heard increasing rifle-fire from the
-direction of Wunder’s company. Assuming that the enemy had taken
-advantage of the lie of the ground and was firing on the camp from
-the surrounding bush, I immediately advanced with the three companies
-to the right through the bush, so as to strike the road further south
-and so take the enemy in the rear. Soon, however, we met some Askari,
-who told us that a strong force of the enemy had forced its way into
-the camp, taking the company by surprise and driving it out. A young
-Askari complained to an old “Betschausch” (sergeant) of the third
-company that the enemy had taken everything from them. “Niemaza we,
-tutawafukuza” (shut your mouth, we’ll soon have ’em out), was the
-defiant answer which at once shamed the excited youth into silence. The
-sergeant’s answer indeed hit off the position. The enemy, consisting
-of the 5th Indian Regiment and a few natives, had thought to find only
-a weak German outpost. He had rashly penetrated into our badly-placed
-entrenchments and was now in his turn exposed on all sides to a
-concentrated fire from the bush.
-
-The position was so clear that it called for the quickest possible
-independent action by the subordinate leaders, and Captain von Chappuis
-also attacked at once. Staff-Surgeon Mohn (afterwards killed), who had
-remained in Wunder’s camp and had temporarily fallen into the enemy’s
-hands, described the very harassing effect of our concentrated fire
-at short range and the panic it caused among the enemy. Nevertheless,
-the cover afforded by a few ravines and the undergrowth enabled some
-of the enemy to get away. These fled wildly. A number so entirely lost
-themselves that they were picked up in the bush days afterwards by our
-patrols in a half-starved condition. We inflicted about 120 casualties.
-In addition to recovering our own ammunition, which had fallen
-temporarily into the enemy’s hands, we captured the enemy’s ammunition
-which he had just brought into the camp, about a hundred rifles and
-some machine guns. Among the severely wounded whom we took to the
-English camp at Naitiwi, and there handed over, was the commanding
-officer of the English regiment. He afterwards died of his wound.
-
-We stayed a few weeks longer in the fertile district of Lutende and
-tried with our patrols to inflict losses on the enemy, whose fortified
-camps at, and south of, Naitiwi offered no prospect of successful
-attack. Far to the south we often heard the explosion of air-bombs
-and of the heavy guns which were bombarding Wahle’s division. Von
-Chappuis’ company was marched to reinforce Wahle’s force. Apart from
-some skirmishing our success at Lindi was followed by a lull in the
-operations.
-
-That this was only the prelude to new efforts on the enemy’s part was
-borne out not only by the reports of the transport of strong forces to
-Kilwa, and also by the fact that at the end of May General Hoskins,
-who had taken over command from General Smuts, had been relieved by
-General van Deventer. Once more a Boer was in command, and the rumours
-that fresh European troops were being brought from South Africa seemed
-to be confirmed. South of Kilwa the enemy attacked our nine companies
-with three brigades, but Captain von Lieberman, who had taken over
-from Captain Goering, the latter being seriously ill, succeeded with
-extraordinary skill in beating off the superior forces of the enemy. On
-July 6th, at least a brigade made a frontal attack on Captain Lieberman
-at Unindi and was repulsed with heavy losses. The bold charge of our
-companies cost us heavily too; among the casualties was Lieutenant
-Bleeck, who received a mortal wound in the stomach while leading his
-company. This brave and upright personality had done excellent service
-both as a fearless patrol-leader and on the Headquarters Staff, and I
-knew him intimately. Von Lieberman’s right flank was covered against
-another enemy brigade by Captain Spangenberg with two of the nine
-companies. He carried out his task and attacked the enemy brigade so
-energetically with his two companies that, as we heard later, the
-English reports spoke of an attack by very strong enemy forces.
-
-In spite of this success at Unindi, the great superiority of the enemy
-and the danger from enveloping movements to our supplies in the rear,
-induced Captain von Lieberman to withdraw gradually south, fighting all
-the time. I thought the moment had come to make a rapid counter-march
-with the available companies at Lutende, and the mountain-battery come
-unexpectedly to the aid of Captain von Lieberman and perhaps seize a
-favourable opportunity to inflict a decisive defeat upon the enemy.
-We moved due north from Lutende by forced marches and crossed the
-Mbemkuru, now once more an insignificant stream, without difficulty,
-two days’ march below Nahungu. The only opposition we encountered was
-from swarms of wild bees which forced us to make a slight détour. North
-of Mbemkuru we continued our march north into the Ruawa hills.
-
-I made use of the two days required to muster the force again to
-reconnoitre thoroughly the surrounding country, and on the 28th July,
-to my astonishment, I learned accidentally from some natives that a
-road through the mountains led almost in a straight line from our camp
-to Captain Lieberman’s camp at the Narungomba water-hole, about six
-hours’ march. A patrol of Europeans was sent at once to reconnoitre
-this road. In the morning of the 29th July I heard from my camp at
-Ruawa some explosions from the direction of Lieberman’s force. I did
-not think this could denote serious fighting, as the sounds ceased and,
-further, the patrol which I had sent to Lieberman’s force, and which
-had returned that morning, reported that everything was quiet there. I
-had, however, to change my mind when at noon van Rooyen, who was very
-reliable, returned from a hunting expedition and reported that he had
-certainly heard continuous machine-gun fire. The reader will, perhaps,
-wonder that I had not already begun the march to Lieberman’s camp,
-but it must be remembered that there was no water on the way, and my
-men were very exhausted, while some had only just reached Ruawa. By
-nightfall I was just three hours’ march nearer the scene of action, but
-it was not until the night was well advanced that my companies had all
-come up. A continuance of the march through the bush in pitch darkness
-was hopeless; it was bound to lead to a good deal of misunderstanding
-and would have meant a useless waste of the men’s strength, which had
-already been severely tried.
-
-At 3 a.m. the march was continued and soon after a report came from
-the advance officer patrol that Captain von Lieberman had certainly
-defeated the enemy, but, owing to shortage of ammunition, had marched
-to Mihambia during the night. The rearguard had evacuated the springs
-and at the time of the report was following the rest. My order to
-hold the springs at all costs until my arrival at 6 a.m. to join in
-the battle had, therefore, been disregarded owing to pressure of
-circumstances. I now thought that the enemy, who was stronger than we,
-would have strongly entrenched the springs position, as was his habit,
-and that I should have to carry out any attack with thirsty troops.
-That seemed to offer little prospect of success. Later, when I learned
-the enemy’s real position, I inclined to the opposite view. In spite
-of his superiority the enemy had suffered a severe defeat. His 7th
-South African and 8th European regiments were almost broken up. Again
-and again his infantry had hurled themselves in deep waves against the
-front of our Askari regiments, and each time they had been driven back
-by counter-attacks. A forest fire had broken out and spread among his
-ranks. Finally the main body of his troops had broken away and fled
-in wild disorder through the bush. Machine guns, masses of rifles and
-hundreds of cases of ammunition had been left on the field. In this
-condition, my attack, even after the withdrawal of Lieberman’s force,
-would perhaps have sealed the doom of the enemy’s main body. It is
-much to be regretted that at that time large numbers of the troops did
-not show sufficient initiative to make good the shortage of German
-ammunition during the battle itself, by using the enemy rifles and
-cartridges which were lying about in quantities. We had been within
-reach of a most important success which was snatched from our grasp by
-accident. We must, however, be grateful for the feat of arms which the
-7th Askari Company performed under the doubtless brilliant leadership
-of Captain von Lieberman, against overwhelming odds.
-
-I did not get a clear report of this action, however, until later. For
-the moment I thought it right to march to Mihambia in order, by joining
-with Lieberman’s detachment, to secure unity of command, to supply it
-with sufficient ammunition to carry on and, if necessary, to raise
-its _moral_ after the severe battle by a visible reinforcement. This
-last turned out to be unnecessary; when I arrived I found Lieberman’s
-detachment in excellent spirits, all the companies being proud to have
-dealt such a heavy blow to the superior enemy. For me the operation
-at Narungombe was a further proof how difficult it is in the unknown
-African bush and in face of the uncertainty of communication, even
-if other circumstances are favourable, to carry through an operation
-in which several columns are taking part, so as to secure the
-necessary unity of action on the battlefield. At Narungombe, where
-all the conditions were as favourable as could have been hoped, the
-decision was finally thwarted by slight mischances, and my belief was
-strengthened that if I wanted to use different bodies of troops in one
-operation it was necessary to secure the closest connection first.
-
-The engagement at Narungombe brought the enemy at Kilwa to a standstill
-for a considerable time, and the fighting was confined to patrols, who
-inflicted losses on the enemy’s lines of communication, firing out
-of the bush on his detachments and motor transport and attacked at
-close quarters when a favourable opportunity offered. In order, for
-one thing, to put this patrol work on a broader basis, but also to
-counter the moving of enemy troops westward, and finally for reasons
-of supply, I deployed the force laterally on the line Mihambia-Ndessa.
-A large number of aircraft appeared over the fertile Ndessa district
-against whose bombs we were defenceless, and some severe wounds
-resulted; from this air-reconnaissance we could infer the enemy’s keen
-interest in the district and soon it was reported that he was moving
-still further west. Our patrols did such good work that from time
-to time whole companies of the enemy were put to flight with heavy
-losses. But the enemy continued his efforts to obtain information. He
-hardly took the trouble to hide his intention when sending flags of
-truce. I remember one occasion when the party bearing the white flag
-arrived at our camp out of the bush; they had, therefore, not only
-avoided the roads leading to it but had deliberately crossed them. The
-closer proximity of the enemy made it more difficult for us to get up
-our supplies, which were gradually running out. It was unavoidable
-that the position of our requisitioning and hunting-parties should
-become known to the enemy and that they should be surprised. The
-influence of the enemy on the natives was shown by the fact that south
-of Mihambia several villages had been suddenly deserted. I had long
-regarded this phenomenon as a sign of the enemy’s intention to advance
-in that direction. The state of our supplies made it impossible for
-us to maintain so strong a force in the Mihambia-Ndessa area. As in
-any case the evacuation of this area could not long be delayed, and
-as the enemy west of Lindi was at the same time developing increased
-activity in strong force on General Wahle’s front, I decided to join
-General Wahle with some of the companies from Ndessa and perhaps bring
-off the operation that had failed at Narungombe; a decisive success
-by an unexpected reinforcement. On the 3rd August General O’Grady’s
-forces had certainly suffered a serious defeat. An Indian regiment,
-which had advanced through the gap between two strongly fortified
-German outposts, was attacked by our reserves, held ready for such
-a contingency, and almost annihilated. In the pursuit much valuable
-material fell into our hands. The enemy, however, had renewed the
-attack a few days later, and in face of the enveloping movement of his
-strong detachments, General Wahle had fallen back on Narunyu and a
-mountain of equal height south of the Lukuledi river.
-
-Captain Koehl, with six companies and a battery, remained behind at
-Ndessa; I crossed the river Mbemkuru below Nahungu with four companies
-and two mountain-guns, and then marched diagonally across the Muera
-plateau to the mission-station at Namupa. The prefect in charge
-entertained us, among other things, with muhogo (a species of corn
-with edible roots), prepared like fried potatoes, and supplemented the
-scanty provisions of our Europeans with bananas and other fruit out of
-his extensive gardens.
-
-In the camp at Njangao the receipt of part of a German wireless message
-directed to me, expressing his Majesty’s acknowledgments on the
-occasion of the third anniversary of the outbreak of war, delighted us
-all.
-
-We pitched our camp with the first company at Njengedi, on the main
-road between Njangao and Lindi, in the rear of Wahle’s division, in
-unpleasant, rainy weather. I immediately set out for Narunyu to inform
-General Wahle of our arrival. Here, in an almost impenetrable country
-broken by numerous ravines, at the bottom of which lay deep swamps,
-friend and foe faced one another in close proximity. Our men were
-working at dug-outs covered by branches cut from the trees. Only five
-of General Wahle’s seven companies were at Narunyu, the two others
-being on Ruho Mountain on the south bank of the Lukuledi river. In
-view of the danger of a surprise attack on our weak forces at Narunyu
-I ordered them to be reinforced by the companies on Ruho Mountain and
-marched two of those that had come with me to take their place. The
-enemy attack on Narunyu occurred the following day. Captain Lieberman’s
-Company from Ruho Mountain and the two companies I had brought with
-me all took part in the engagement. The third company had literally
-started their forced march to Karungu immediately after their arrival
-at Njengedi. I can still see the Askari coming up just before dawn and
-hear their shouts of delight at the thought of once more routing the
-enemy.
-
-Our attempt to envelop the enemy’s right wing, however, only served to
-press it back; the bush was too thick for an offensive movement which
-had to be developed at short range under a continuous machine-gun
-and rifle fire. The darkness made it still more difficult to direct
-the operations, and there is no doubt that in the confusion of the
-two fronts in this broken country our detachments often fired on one
-another: it was almost impossible to recognize friend or foe. For
-instance, hearing loud sounds of shouting in front of me, in the
-complete darkness of the bush, I thought this came from our enveloping
-attack driving back the enemy. It was not discovered till some time
-afterwards that this was the enemy and soon we heard him working at his
-trenches. The exact location of his trenches gave us the advantage of
-being able to get the range for the 10·5 cm. gun of the _Königsberg_,
-which was with Wahle’s force. This was done with good results; at any
-rate the enemy evacuated his trenches on the following day and retired.
-
-The complete victory desired had not been attained and, in view of the
-difficulties of the ground, could not be expected, as we had discovered
-our strength to the enemy in the fighting of the 18th, and lost the
-advantage of a surprise. Once more I had to content myself with delay.
-In this fertile country there was no difficulty about holding our
-ground from the point of view of supplies. The force has rarely been
-so well fed as in the Lindi area. Great fields of sweet-potatoes
-and muhogo stretched as far as the eye could see, and there was an
-abundant supply of sugar-cane. The numerous Arab plantations indicated
-the fertility and the ancient civilization of the country. We made
-ourselves at home, and though rifle bullets often whistled through our
-camp and aircraft dropped bombs on us, not much harm was done. On one
-occasion the dentist, who had set up his surgery in a European house
-and was giving us the attention we had long needed, was attending to a
-patient when a bomb fell into the room. It was discovered later, when
-the place was examined, that the planter kept his store of dynamite
-in this very room. Fortunately the bomb did not touch this or both
-patients and dentist would have been permanently freed from toothache.
-
-It was no easy matter to decide what to do with the German women and
-children, some of whom had fled from Lindi and did not know what to
-do. A number of them had taken refuge in the planters’ houses, which
-were within range of the enemy’s guns. In view of the restriction of
-supplies and the difficulties of transport and accommodation, it was
-desirable that these women and children should be sent back to Lindi.
-Some were intelligent enough to see this. By means of a parley their
-transference behind the British lines was duly arranged, and they were
-able to leave for Lindi. For reasons unknown to me the English then
-refused to keep to the arrangement, and the women and children, as well
-as male non-combatants, gradually collected in the Catholic mission at
-Ndanda. A military convalescent home had been quartered there for some
-time and had developed into an important hospital. All the people who
-were brought here found good food and accommodation in the spacious
-buildings of the mission with its extensive gardens.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XI
-
-IN THE SOUTH-EAST CORNER OF THE COLONY
-
-
-WHILE at Narunyu there was a lull in the fighting for several weeks,
-the enemy had shown considerable activity in the section of Portuguese
-territory occupied by Stuemer’s force. Several English columns from the
-south-west and south had concentrated on Mwembe, and Major von Stuemer,
-not thinking himself strong enough to resist, had evacuated Mwembe.
-The different companies had then gradually retired on the Rovuma.
-North of this river Lieutenant-Commander Jantzen, who had been sent
-from Headquarters to Tunduru, and under whom the various companies of
-Stuemer’s force had re-formed, had taken over the command. Enemy forces
-were also advancing on Tunduru from Ssongea.
-
-It was difficult to obtain detailed information about the enemy. My
-impression was that he wanted to bring our main force to a halt, invade
-our supply-area in the Tunduru-Massassi-Ruponda district with strong
-forces, and carry off our supplies. I did not then think it out of
-the question that we might score a success, and I, therefore, marched
-on the 10th September, 1917, with five companies, from our camps at
-Narunyu towards Massassi. From there Captain Goering immediately
-marched with three companies towards Tunduru; Jantzen’s division
-stood north-east of this place. I reconnoitred the road to Tunduru on
-a bicycle and feared that the difficulties of supply would be very
-serious. These fears were unfortunately realized. Supplies from the
-land could not be brought up and there was no time for a prolonged
-operation that would allow of additional supplies being obtained from
-Massassi.
-
-The small English and Portuguese patrols which attacked our supplies
-and transport from across the Rovuma to the south did not cause us to
-hurry our movements. But the enemy from Kilwa, whom Captain Koehl’s
-heavy attack from Mbeo-Chini and a number of lesser encounters had not
-been able to stop, reached the neighbourhood of Nahungu. His flying
-columns, for the most part mounted, outflanked Koehl’s force, and
-pressed forward up the Mbemkuru river to Nangano. Communication with
-Captain Koehl by means of the telephone-line from Nahungu to Nangano
-was first interrupted for a few days, and then broken off completely.
-The supply dumps fell into the enemy’s hands and were destroyed. To
-provide against the interruption of the exposed telephone-line a new
-line had been laid from Ruponda, running north-east, but connection by
-messenger between this line and Koehl’s division took several days.
-
-In view of the slow means of communication with Koehl’s detachment, it
-was not possible to get an accurate view of the situation in time, and
-as the intended success at Tunduru could not in any case be attained,
-I marched the five companies from Massassi to Ruponda at the beginning
-of October, and then further north-east, joining forces with Koehl’s
-force at Likangara. On receiving the report that enemy detachments
-were approaching Ruponda, I ordered the removal of the sick and the
-stores from Ruponda to Lukuledi and Mnacho. On 9th October, 1917,
-an enemy patrol was beaten off with some losses at Ruponda. On 10th
-October a considerable force of the enemy—the 25th Indian Cavalry
-Regiment was identified—assaulted Ruponda from several sides. The
-withdrawal of our companies had, therefore, unfortunately been rather
-premature; otherwise the enemy might have encountered some of our
-passing companies at Ruponda and perhaps suffered a serious defeat. As
-it was, there were no troops in Ruponda except a few of our patrols;
-most of the sick fell into the enemy’s hands, and also some 90,000 kg.
-of supplies. At Likangara there was no fighting worthy of notice. Some
-enemy patrols and weak detachments did appear, but our fighting-force,
-which was attacking the enemy’s main line of communication along
-the Mbemkuru river, firing on and destroying motor-transport, and
-capturing mails and supplies, led me to suppose that the strongest part
-of the Kilwa force was recuperating further west in the direction of
-Ruponda.
-
-The increased enemy activity a few days’ march east of Likangara, where
-he established requisitioning stations, as well as the stories of the
-natives, made it seem probable that considerable enemy forces were
-marching from Nahungu towards the south, and therefore against General
-Wahle. Captured mails revealed the fact that in spite of his extensive
-intelligence and spy systems the enemy was groping in the dark. He did
-not know, for instance, where I was, although he seemed to place the
-greatest importance upon knowing. The knowledge of my Headquarters
-would tell him the probable position of our main force. While one
-letter thought that I was in the neighbourhood of Lukuledi, another
-professed to know that I was at Tunduru, and according to a third I was
-at Mahenge. The talkativeness of these Europeans, who, in spite of all
-warnings, cannot refrain from communicating to one another in their
-private letters their knowledge and their conjectures about the war
-situation, had in this case done good: there was so much gossip, the
-rumours were so contradictory, and even the most improbable things were
-so indiscriminately believed, that anything at all could be read into
-the German correspondence. In spite of this unintentional misleading
-of the enemy, it is difficult to understand how intelligent people can
-entrust to the post important matters, the knowledge of which must be
-kept from the enemy, knowing how unreliable the post is, and that the
-letters often fall into the enemy’s hands.
-
-It was clear to me that the enemy’s obvious uncertainty about the
-situation would give me a great opportunity if it could be used quickly
-and decisively. I ventured to hope that the intended decisive blow
-might now be struck for which I had tried twice near Lindi and once at
-Tunduru, and the success of which at Narungombe had hung on a hair. The
-development of the situation on Wahle’s front seemed favourable for
-this attempt. His forces had gradually withdrawn from the Mtua district
-to Mahiwa. The enemy’s whole handling of the campaign suggested that
-his various columns would press forward with all their weight and
-try to crush us by a concentration from all sides. The enemy’s Lindi
-Division was advancing energetically with the rest. General Wahle’s
-nine companies, fighting stubbornly, had retired before them to Mahiwa.
-I had a fair personal knowledge of the country at Mahiwa. It was very
-probable that my march in that direction would not be observed by the
-enemy in time.
-
-On the 10th October, 1917, trusting in the fortune of war, I crossed
-the Linkangara mountains to Mnacho with five companies and two mountain
-guns. I arrived there at dark and left again at daybreak on the 15th.
-On the narrow mountain paths the force got very scattered. The guns
-were left far behind, and the pack-animals gave trouble. Askari and
-bearers came to the rescue, and again and again Sergeant-Major Sabath
-rose superior to the difficulties and brought his guns forward. It
-surprised me that we were unable to get any information from Mahiwa,
-but the rifle and machine-gun fire indicated that fighting was in
-progress. Before dark I reached Lieutenant Methner’s company, which was
-in reserve behind Wahle’s left wing. The enemy seemed to be attacking
-this company with a view to enveloping it. His fire had the unfortunate
-effect of causing the disappearance of my bearer, with my dispatch-box,
-containing most important dispatches and maps: he did not return for
-two days. The first two companies to come up were immediately thrown
-against the enemy’s enveloping movement, and the enemy was thrown back.
-The companies then dug themselves in. On the morning of the 16th I went
-to reconnoitre, and found that the enemy had also entrenched himself
-immediately in front, at a distance of sixty to a hundred metres. When
-Lieutenant von Ruckteschell offered me a cup of coffee, care had to
-be taken, as the enemy was keeping a fairly sharp look-out, and shot
-with tolerable accuracy. I thought the opportunity favourable for a
-determined surprise attack. It was decided to launch the attack at
-noon, on the left (north) wing, and try to turn the enemy’s flank.
-Goering’s detachment was to lead the attack.
-
-After we had eaten our midday meal undisturbed, I went at once to
-the left wing, where Captain Goering had just begun his advance with
-his two companies. When he had crossed a wide depression in the
-ground, to my surprise he changed direction still further to the
-left. The companies were soon in action. Only gradually I realized
-the significance of this surprising move. Captain Goering had come
-unexpectedly upon a new enemy who had come from Nahungu and was now
-attacking from the north. The force consisted of several battalions
-and two guns of the Nigerian Brigade who knew nothing of our arrival
-at Mahiwa and were expecting to smash General Wahle’s force by an
-attack on his left flank and rear, while his front, facing east, was
-vigorously attacked by a division. The Nigerian Brigade was as much
-taken by surprise as Captain Goering and was not so quick to adapt
-itself to the new situation. Captain Goering, closely supported by
-the reserves, threw himself so vigorously against the enemy in the
-bush that he ran through some of his detachments, threw them into
-confusion, and finally put them to flight. An enemy officer in command
-of an ammunition column took our men for his own, with the result that
-we captured about 150,000 rounds of ammunition. A gun with ammunition
-was taken by assault, and the killed did not consist wholly of
-Nigerian Askari. On Captain Goering’s right, where two companies under
-Lieutenant von Ruckteschell and Lieutenant Brucker, wounded in this
-action, were fighting, the enemy was also thrown back some way into the
-bush.
-
-While this fighting was going on on the flank, and on the following
-day also, the enemy attacked Wahle’s force with all his strength.
-Here the enemy was in great superiority; wave after wave of fresh
-troops were thrown against our front. There was a danger that General
-Wahle’s front would give way, and the fighting was very severe. There
-was also serious danger that our enveloping movement, in the very
-difficult swampy ground of the bush, would be held up so long by weak
-enemy forces that a defeat would be inflicted upon our front before it
-could make itself felt. In that case the battle was lost. I thought it
-expedient to increase the disadvantages that the enemy was bringing
-upon himself by his costly frontal attack and used all my available
-strength in such a way that the enemy by the increasing fierceness of
-his frontal attack was bleeding himself to death.
-
-The original intention of enveloping the enemy’s left wing was not
-developed further on the following days, but, on the contrary, every
-available company was withdrawn from the left wing to stiffen General
-Wahle’s front. In this way we not only succeeded in holding our
-ground, but, by immediately taking advantage of the enemy’s moments
-of weakness to make heavy counter-attacks with our reserves, we were
-able to inflict a real defeat. My, perhaps surprising, tactics were
-prompted by the personality of the enemy commander. I had learned in
-the engagement at Reata (11th March, 1916) that General Beves threw his
-men into action regardless of loss of life and did not hesitate to try
-for a success, not by skilful handling and small losses, but rather by
-repeated frontal attacks which, if the defence held its ground and had
-anything like adequate forces, led to severe losses for the attack. I
-guessed that here at Mahiwa he was carrying out the same tactics. I
-think it was by taking advantage of the enemy leader’s mistaken tactics
-in this way that we were able to win this splendid victory. Until the
-18th October, for four days therefore, wave after wave of the attack
-broke on our front, but my own observation told me that the weight of
-the attack here on the right wing was diminishing and that the enemy’s
-defeat was absolute.
-
-On the evening of the 18th October we had, with some 1,500 men,
-completely defeated a whole enemy detachment at least 4,000, and
-probably not less than 6,000, strong. With the exception of Tanga, it
-was the most serious defeat he had suffered.
-
-According to a high English officer the enemy lost 1,500 men; but
-I have reason to believe that this estimate is much too low. Our
-casualties were: 14 Europeans and 81 Askari killed, 55 Europeans and
-367 Askari wounded, 1 European and 1 Askari missing. Considering the
-smallness of our forces these losses were for us very considerable, and
-were felt all the more seriously because they could not be replaced.
-We captured a gun, six heavy and three light machine guns, and 200,000
-rounds of ammunition.
-
-The situation, unfortunately, did not allow us to take full advantage
-of our victory; in our rear was the enemy who had occupied Ruponda
-on the 10th October, advanced in strong force further south and on
-18th October attacked Major Kraut at Lukuledi. It must be remarked in
-passing that our troops which had fought under Lieutenant-Commander
-Jantzen near Tunduru had gradually retired north-east to the upper
-Mbenkuru and had reached Headquarters above Ruponda before the
-occupation of that place by the enemy on the 10th October. Two of these
-companies had reinforced the company which was guarding our supplies
-near Lukuledi, and it was these three companies, under the command of
-Major Kraut, which were attacked by a superior enemy from the north on
-the 18th October.
-
-The enemy, believed to be six companies of the Gold Coast Regiment, was
-driven off, but in order to protect our supplies and material lying at
-Chigugu and Chiwata, Major Kraut retired to the first of these places.
-As well as Chigugu and Chiwata, Ndanda, where we had large stores of
-war material, was also threatened by the enemy, who had doubtless, in
-my opinion, been reinforced at Lukuledi. The enemy from Lukuledi might
-at any moment attack our lines of communication, capture our stores and
-supplies, and so put us out of action. We had no means of protecting
-our lines of communication locally, for the few thousand men we had
-were required for fighting. As, however, the force had to be kept
-alive, the danger had to be overcome in some other way.
-
-There was only one way: to beat the enemy decisively at Lukuledi. It
-was necessary therefore to lose no time at Mahiwa, and, hard though
-it was, I had to abandon the idea of an annihilating pursuit. When,
-early on the 19th October, a few scattered detachments of the enemy
-were seen and fired on, I had already begun my march with six companies
-and two guns. On the next day at two o’clock we entered Lukuledi from
-the east, and on 21st of October at dawn we attacked the enemy, who
-was apparently taken completely by surprise. North of Lukuledi, on
-the Ruponda road, Major Kraut’s column surprised the camp of the 25th
-Indian Cavalry Regiment, which, with transport harnessed, stood ready
-for the march on Massassi; the camp was taken by storm and the regiment
-lost almost the whole of its transport horses, altogether 350. Whilst I
-was engaged with the detachments of Koehl and Ruckteschell in a fairly
-serious action against the enemy entrenched at Lukuledi, I waited in
-vain for the intervention of Kraut’s force. An attack on the camp
-without the advantage of surprise had little hope of success. When the
-force began to come under the fire of the enemy’s mine-throwers on
-the flank, I withdrew the greater part from the zone of the effective
-cross-fire, after beating off a strong enemy attack, in order to avoid
-unnecessary losses. A fresh enemy, in the shape of a company of King’s
-African Rifles (English East African Askari), who appeared unexpectedly
-from the bush, was quickly driven off. In this engagement Lieutenant
-Kroeger fell at the head of his company. The action was then broken
-off. No news came of Major Kraut until night; thinking he could no
-longer attack successfully at Lukuledi, and hearing no sounds of
-fighting, he had made a détour and then approached Lukuledi from the
-south.
-
-Owing to unfavourable circumstances we had not succeeded in inflicting
-a decisive defeat on the enemy at Lukuledi, and the operation had
-only in part gained its objective, but the enemy’s losses must be
-regarded as serious. The impression made on him was even greater than
-I had supposed. At any rate, it was reported that he had evacuated
-Lukuledi and withdrawn to the north. Among our casualties were three
-company-commanders killed. I can still see Lieutenant Volkwein,
-severely wounded in the leg, limping through the bush at the head of
-his company. I had also spoken with Lieutenant Batzner and Lieutenant
-Kroeger shortly before they fell. Sergeant-Major Klein also fell, who
-had so often led his patrol on the Uganda railway. He was a capable
-machine gun leader. But our losses were not in vain. Our patrols
-pursued the enemy and fired on his camp near Ruponda and also his lines
-of communication. The impossibility of maintaining large bodies of
-troops in the neighbourhood of Ruponda—our supplies collected there
-had fallen into the enemy’s hands—forced me to give up all idea of
-pursuing the enemy.
-
-At that time I thought it possible that the enemy’s withdrawal from
-Lukuledi might have been due to the movements of Captain Tafel’s force,
-which was marching from Mahenge to join us. We had lost touch with
-him since the beginning of October. He had received orders to retire
-gradually before the strong enemy columns which were advancing on
-Mahenge from the north (Ifakara), west and south-west (Likuju, Mponda),
-and to try to get into touch with the main force under my command. I
-thought it quite possible that he had already arrived in the district
-of Nangano, or west of that place, and that the enemy had turned about
-again out of anxiety for his lines of communication.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XII
-
-THE LAST WEEKS IN GERMAN TERRITORY
-
-
-ON 24th October, the Governor of Chiwata, which had become the
-centre of the Administration, arrived at my camp east of Lukuledi
-for a conference. I firmly stated my opinion that, in spite of all
-difficulties of supply which must shortly arise in German East Africa,
-the war could and must be carried on. One possibility that offered was
-to base the operations on Portuguese territory. This could only be done
-by evacuating German East Africa and invading Portuguese East Africa.
-
-The question of supplies was becoming very serious; we had in our
-stores only about 500,000 kg. of supplies. That would last us about
-six weeks. But it had been found that these figures were deceptive.
-The piled-up sacks had to a great extent lost weight and the grain had
-been eaten by insects. The new harvest could not be expected until
-March at the earliest. If the operations were to be continued it was
-necessary from this point of view alone to move south. I was still
-reckoning with the possibility that Captain Tafel’s force might arrive
-in the neighbourhood of Massassi and Chiwata, in which case I should
-hand over to him the supplies at Chiwata, while I crossed the Makonda
-hills in the direction of Lindi with part of the Chiwata force and
-attacked the enemy’s main line of communication on the Lukuledi river.
-In whichever way the situation might develop, the Chiwata district was,
-on account of its fertility, of the greatest importance to us. Chiwata
-was, however, not protected and was further threatened by the fact that
-enemy operations were taking place in the north against Mnacho, and
-enemy mounted forces had been seen on the Lukuledi-Lindi road in the
-neighbourhood of Ndanda. Also enemy aircraft were paying our camp at
-Chiwata increasing attention.
-
-These were my reasons for withdrawing from Lukuledi at the end of
-October with the main part of my forces. It could not be foreseen
-whether another opportunity would offer of making another attack from
-Chiwata on one of the enemy columns that would be passing before long.
-For the next few weeks the enemy’s pressure was again directed against
-Wahle. Quite fresh troops were appearing there, among them the Cape
-Corps of South African half-castes. This corps had been stationed along
-the Central railway and had been brought up to reinforce General Beves’
-troops, apparently via Dar-es-Salaam and Lindi. Fortunately General
-Beves had not waited for this reinforcement before his defeat at Mahiwa.
-
-General Wahle was retiring step by step up the Lukuledi river. I was,
-unfortunately, not able to send him any support, but even had to draw
-on his forces to have troops in hand ready for a favourable opportunity
-for an attack and to protect the supplies. In the almost daily
-bush-fighting of General Wahle’s force heavy losses were apparently
-inflicted on the enemy, and he was held severely in check. There was,
-however, no defeat and no considerable capture of booty, and meanwhile
-our supplies were getting lower and lower. On 6th November, I rode
-from Chiwata to Nangoo, near Ndanda, where, close behind Wahle’s
-force, I found a suitable point of attack for the Chiwata troops. On
-7th November I rode back from Nangoo to Chiwata, making a détour south
-across the Makonde hills. On the same day enemy troops were again
-reported at Lukuledi, and on 9th November an affair of patrols took
-place at Chigugu, just west of Chiwata.
-
-At this critical time, when the heads of the enemy columns were nearing
-Chiwata, it was urgently necessary for us to throw all our strength
-against one of these columns as soon as possible before the others
-could intervene. The first essential to make this blow effective
-was to bring the whole strength of our all too weak forces to bear
-simultaneously. This depended chiefly on the supply of ammunition.
-Our whole supply had dwindled to about 400,000 rounds, a very scanty
-allowance for our 25,000 rifles and 50 machine guns in a serious
-engagement, after which it would only be possible to continue the
-struggle if ammunition were captured. For this the nature of the ground
-was unfavourable. In the thick bush there was a tendency for each
-individual to fire many rounds and make few hits, so that the supply of
-cartridges was quickly used up without producing the decisive results
-we needed. What made a satisfactory solution of the ammunition question
-still more impossible was that the cartridges were for the most part
-the smoky ’71 type, whereas only about one-third of the troops were
-armed with ’71 rifles; the other two-thirds had modern German, English
-or Portuguese rifles, and for these the supply of cartridges was very
-small. What there were were required for our most important weapon, the
-machine gun. It was a difficult position. There was nothing else for it
-but to make the attack with only those troops who were armed with the
-’71 rifle and to hold in reserve the rest, who had only twenty rounds
-of ammunition suitable for their modern rifles, the rest being the
-smoky ’71 type. The two forces would then be interchanged so that the
-first, armed with the ’71 rifles, could hand them over to the relieving
-force, taking the modern weapons in exchange. This meant that at the
-best only one-third of the available strength could be in action at
-the same time and even then would have to be very sparing with their
-ammunition.
-
-Our artillery ammunition had already been exhausted with the exception
-of a few rounds for the two mountain guns and some Portuguese
-ammunition. Our last field-howitzer, as well as the English gun
-captured at Mahiwa, had burst. The last two 10·5 cm. guns from the
-_Königsberg_ had been destroyed a few days before. On the day after a
-German mountain gun had been destroyed and sunk at Kitangari. We were
-thus left with one German and one Portuguese mountain gun. During the
-last few months the lack of artillery ammunition had been so serious
-that we had rarely more than three hundred rounds all told. That was
-about the allowance per engagement for one of the numerous English guns.
-
-Under such circumstances an attack could only promise success if the
-situation was exceptionally favourable. This was never the case. The
-patrols were kept active, and the enemy harassed as much as possible,
-but otherwise there was nothing left but for General Wahle’s force and
-the 11th Field Company, which had been left at Mnacho to bring away the
-supplies, gradually to give way before the pressure of the enemy and
-retire to Chiwata. On 10th November the Ndanda mission, immediately in
-the rear of General Wahle, who was at Nangoo, was surprised by a strong
-enemy force and captured. The field-hospital quartered there, and part
-of our stores, fell into the enemy’s hands. Lieberman’s force, south of
-Ndanda, ensured the retreat of General Wahle’s force, which ascended to
-the Makonda plateau, by the road south-east of Nangoo, the road I had
-reconnoitred on 7th November, and, by crossing the plateau diagonally
-to Chiwata, escaped from the enemy’s trap. The 11th Company also found
-its way to Chiwata from Mnacho, so that, with the exception of Captain
-Tafel’s Detachment and some small bodies of troops further south, the
-whole force was concentrated at Chiwata. The gradual transport of our
-supplies from Chiwata east to Nambindinga had begun, and with that
-our march to Kitangari. Meanwhile I kept an anxious look-out for a
-vulnerable point in one of the enemy columns. On the 14th November I
-thought I had discovered one.
-
-A strong enemy column, to which belonged the 10th South African
-Mounted Infantry, had passed close to our position while marching from
-Lukuledi via Massassi, and had attacked Mwiti, two hours’ march south
-of Chiwata. In this place, which until then had been only weakly held,
-Lieberman’s force (three companies) had arrived the day before. In
-spite of the shortage of ammunition there was, I thought, a chance that
-by unexpectedly throwing into the fight Koehl’s force from Chiwata,
-this enemy might be defeated separately. I was, however, very busy with
-the preparations for the withdrawal to Nambindinga and unfortunately
-let the opportunity at Mwiti pass without taking advantage of it.
-
-There was nothing for it, then, but to retire gradually to Nambindinga.
-
-Through the evacuation of Chiwata the European prisoners, as well as
-the Indians, who had been carried to the hospital, and the hospital
-itself, full for the most part of seriously wounded, fell into
-the enemy’s hands. The march to Nambindinga was carried out under
-continuous fighting between the 15th and 17th November. I wanted to
-make the enemy complete the concentric march of his columns, advancing
-north-west and south, so as to effect a junction; then, when the
-enemy’s masses were helplessly crowded on a narrow area, I could march
-where I liked. On November 17th I had to take a fateful decision at
-Nambindinga. The continual bush-fighting was threatening to consume all
-our ammunition. It would have been madness to go on with this fighting,
-which could not bring about a favourable decision. We had therefore to
-withdraw.
-
-The supply question pointed the same way. Only by a drastic reduction
-of strength could we carry on with the stores in hand. Our supply area
-had been narrowed, fresh requisitioning had been interfered with by the
-enemy, and the produce of the land exhausted. The supply of quinine
-would last the Europeans a month longer. After the consumption of this
-the Europeans would certainly fall victims to malaria and its attendant
-evils; they would no longer be able to contend with the rigours of
-a tropical campaign. Only by reducing the number of Europeans to a
-minimum could enough quinine be ensured for each man to enable us to
-carry on the operations for months.
-
-At the same time we had to reduce our total strength. Our large force
-with little ammunition was of less value in the field than a smaller
-number of picked men with plenty of ammunition. It amounted to the
-reduction of our strength to about 2,000 rifles, including not more
-than 2,000 Europeans. All above this number had to be left behind.
-It could not be helped that among the several hundred Europeans and
-600 Askari that we were compelled to leave behind in the hospital at
-Nambindinga, there were men who would have liked to go on fighting
-and were physically fit to do so. Unfortunately, it must be admitted
-that among those who were left behind at Nambindinga, even among the
-Europeans, there were many who were not unwilling to lay down their
-arms. It is, however, worthy of mention that not only the majority
-of the Europeans, but also many Askari, were bitterly disappointed
-at having to remain. We had repeatedly to refuse the request of a
-brave Askari that he might come and fight for us. But when, two days
-later, Lieutenant Grundmann, though severely wounded and scarcely
-able to walk, reported himself, saying that he could not, in spite
-of orders, bring himself to surrender, I have seldom been so pleased
-as at this breach of discipline. It may be mentioned here that in
-general the enemy, as far as I am in a position to judge, treated our
-prisoners with humanity, but it seems to me that he was anxious to
-convict us of cruelty to English prisoners, perhaps in order to justify
-reprisals, perhaps for other reasons. Lieutenant Cutsch had been left
-sick in Nandanda, and fell into the enemy’s hands. On the totally
-unfounded and unproved evidence of a negro that Lieutenant Cutsch had
-on one occasion, when commanding a patrol, burned to death a wounded
-Englishman, he was put in irons and sent by sea to Dar-es-Salaam,
-being imprisoned during the voyage just outside the ship’s roundhouse.
-At Dar-es-Salaam he was locked up for several weeks in the prison
-without a trial. When at last he was tried, it came out that the
-charge of senseless cruelty rested purely on the lying evidence of
-the negro. Again, General Deventer informed me that Captain Naumann,
-who had surrendered near Kilima Njaro, had been tried for murder. He,
-too, as I heard later, was kept imprisoned for a long time without a
-hearing, until his innocence was finally established. I find it all the
-more difficult to understand this mockery of justice, as the English
-prisoners were always humanely treated by us, and were often better
-cared for materially than our own people.[5]
-
-These decisions placed the conduct of the war on an entirely different
-basis. Hitherto we had stored the supplies in dumps and for the most
-part had been able to satisfy our demands from these; the ammunition
-also had been maintained from stores. This system had laid us more
-open to attack and offered the enemy points of attack which we could
-not protect. But by the methods adopted hitherto it had been possible
-to keep the troops in the field at great strength, considering our
-position, and to employ a great part of them on a small area for a
-considerable period. It had further been possible to give a permanent
-character, at any rate to some of our hospitals, where sick and wounded
-could recuperate in peace, and in this way we could fill the gaps in
-our front with refreshed and experienced men. This system had made
-our operations dependent to a great extent on the situation of the
-supplies and reinforcements, and had hindered freedom of movement.
-The advantage, however, in our position of being able to employ
-strong troops and with them successfully to engage, and often defeat
-decisively, superior enemy forces was so great that I held to this
-system as long as it was at all possible.
-
-It was now no longer possible, and the advantages I have mentioned
-had to be sacrificed under the pressure of necessity. It was
-certainly questionable whether the reduced force could be maintained
-without supply dumps, and without reinforcements the prospect of
-remaining, after twelve days in the plains, with five thousand hungry
-negroes and without supplies was not attractive. Should we succeed
-in satisfying those requirements of the force which could not be
-obtained on the spot, especially ammunition and arms, by means of
-capture from the enemy—for the only possibility of renewing our
-supplies lay in capturing the enemy’s—in sufficient quantities to
-make the continuation of the war possible? That was the all-important
-question. If we succeeded, however, in maintaining the force on the
-new territory the increased independence and mobility, used with
-determination against the less mobile enemy, would give us a local
-superiority in spite of the great numerical superiority of the enemy.
-In the unlimited territory at our disposal it would be possible to
-withdraw from unfavourable positions. The enemy would be compelled to
-keep an enormous amount of men and material continually on the move,
-and to exhaust his strength to a greater extent proportionately than
-ourselves. There was also the prospect of tying down strong enemy
-forces and protracting the operations indefinitely if—my forecast
-proved correct. This was at that time doubtful, but the risk had to be
-taken.
-
-We did not stay long at Nambindinga; this place situated on the
-plateau had no water and the springs in the valley were within range
-of the enemy’s guns and machine guns. Under the protection of patrols,
-which held back the enemy at Nambindinga, Headquarters and the main
-part of the forces arrived at Kitangari on 18th November. The enemy
-did not follow, probably he could not. As had been foreseen, he had
-strained every nerve to strike the so long hoped-for knockout blow at
-Chiwata and had to re-form before undertaking further operations. At
-Kitangari the old experience was repeated of finding that the supplies
-stored there had been estimated much too highly. The supplies at all
-serviceable would, all told, only feed the force for about ten days; we
-could reckon on no appreciable addition to these stores from the region
-south of Kitangari. The question in which direction the march should be
-continued focussed itself in the main on the prospect of again finding
-the means of adequately feeding the force. There was no time to be lost.
-
-I knew that in the area along the Rovuma the English and Portuguese had
-systematically destroyed our supplies. Our small dumps, requisitioning
-stations and supply columns had been attacked and the supplies
-destroyed. The natives had been influenced against us. The north
-and south banks of the middle Rovuma were only thinly populated; at
-Tunduru, further up the Rovuma, strong forces of both sides had been
-engaged and the supplies there were probably exhausted. I could get
-no reliable information about the Mafia plateau south of the lower
-Rovuma. Even if, as many reported, this had been a richly-cultivated
-district before the war it was very doubtful whether now, after strong
-Portuguese forces had been billeted there for years, there would be
-any food left. The most probable place for finding supplies seemed to
-me at that time to be the district where Major Stuemer’s operations
-had taken place: the corner between the Rovuma and the Ludjenda rivers
-and further south in the region of Nangware and Mwembe. Even this was
-doubtful, for here, too, war had interfered with the agriculture of the
-natives. Meanwhile, of the various improbabilities this last seemed to
-me the least improbable, and I decided to march at once up the Rovuma.
-
-A determining factor in the choice of this direction was my wish to
-equip my force for a prolonged period of action by a large capture of
-ammunition and other war material. Previous observation and the reports
-of the natives led me to believe that somewhere near the Rovuma the
-enemy still possessed large stores. On 20th November we reached Nevale,
-where we were joined by the patrols which had secured our southern
-flank, and the reorganization of the force was finally carried through.
-At Nevale the last men unfit for marching were left behind, and on
-21st November we marched south to the Rovuma with 300 Europeans, 1,700
-Askari, and 3,000 bearers and other natives. Every man was loaded to
-his full capacity. In general, as the supplies were consumed, the
-bearers no longer required were left behind, so as to keep the number
-of consumers as low as possible. In many cases we had to refuse the
-urgent requests of our good old bearers to remain with us, a large
-number offering to carry on without pay, some even without either pay
-or rations; these were ready to provide their own rations from what
-we threw away and Pori fruit. The quartermaster at that time, Naval
-Lieutenant Besch, reorganized the supplies and transport service very
-efficiently. He deserves the chief credit for the force’s ability to
-carry on.
-
-As was to be expected, only small detachments of the enemy were
-reported in the neighbourhood of the Rovuma. On 21st November we
-arrived at Mpili, on the bank of the river, and were about to pitch
-our camp when several shots passed close to a hunting party. On
-reconnoitring we found in front of us a large pond, on the opposite
-side of which horses were being watered. Behind rose a rocky mountain.
-Soon afterwards a native, apparently a spy, appeared, bringing a
-written message: “We are English cavalry, and we want to get into touch
-with Portuguese infantry regiments.” Whether this was a ruse could not
-be ascertained. It was clear that for the moment we had only to do
-with a small squadron of cavalry. By a sharp attack the enemy was soon
-routed and in the pursuit sustained several casualties: five European
-prisoners belonging to the 10th South African Mounted Infantry were,
-for reasons of supply, sent back to the enemy. The captured horses were
-welcome as chargers and as a possible addition to our rations.
-
-[Illustration: Native Types (3).
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-[Illustration: Native Types (4).
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-The rest of the march up the Rovuma progressed very slowly. A great
-part of the force were unaccustomed to long route-marches. The columns
-straggled endlessly. The Askari women followed singly, several hundred
-yards apart. It was some time before they learned to keep to a regular
-marching order. Incidentally it became obvious that in some companies
-the Askari who had come with us had not been selected from the most
-suitable point of view. In the reorganization of the companies which
-had had to be carried out during the fighting, many good and reliable
-men had been left behind, and replaced by others, stronger perhaps,
-but less reliable. Many went into battle with their children on their
-shoulders; it would have been better to choose an equally reliable man
-who was not burdened by having to drag about a wife and family.
-
-But it was too late now to alter anything.
-
-Apparently we had quite got outside the enemy’s range of observation.
-The aircraft which usually followed our marches were absent and no
-bombs fell on our camps. Once an enemy supply column crossed the Rovuma
-right into our camp. It was a welcome capture. Of grain we found
-practically none in this district, but on the other hand, we shot
-plenty of game. Several buffaloes and quite a number of antelopes,
-particularly Wasserbok, fell to our guns. But we dared not delay; our
-shrinking supplies urged us continually forward. Fortunately I had with
-me a few Europeans who knew the country, and who, shortly before, had
-been working near the confluence of the Ludjenda and the Rovuma. In
-peace time a Portuguese station had been situated there, and even in
-war a more or less strong garrison had been reported there. It might
-be assumed that even now we should find some traces of the enemy. The
-few natives we came across even spoke of a stronger garrison, amounting
-to two thousand English or Portuguese. The natives’ figures could not,
-of course, be relied on, but they strengthened my belief that in the
-neighbourhood of Ngomano something might be done.
-
-
-
-
- PART III
-
- FIGHTING ON FOREIGN SOIL
-
- (From the Crossing into Portuguese East Africa to the Armistice)
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER I
-
-ACROSS THE ROVUMA
-
-
-EARLY in the morning of November 25th, 1917, our advance guard waded
-across the Rovuma, a little above the Ludjenda confluence; the main
-force of nine companies followed in the course of the forenoon, the
-rearguard about two days’ march in the rear. Captain Goering with three
-companies had crossed much further downstream to surprise a Portuguese
-camp reported there. We had no news of Captain Tafel, and I thought it
-probable that he would strike the Rovuma much further west.
-
-The feeling that we were cut off from all support, as well as the
-absolute uncertainty as to the fate before us, had produced what is
-popularly known as “_allgemeine Wurschtigkeit_” (absolute callousness).
-Undisturbed by the tactical situation, our hunting parties went on with
-their work, and their shots were, as afterwards transpired, distinctly
-heard by the enemy.
-
-While crossing the river, many took a careful bath in full view of
-the enemy; in many cases it required some effort to make clear the
-requirements of the state of war.
-
-On the south bank we soon came under fire. The company acting as
-advance guard came upon enemy scouts, several of whom were killed. I
-employed the next few hours, while the troops gradually came up and
-covered the crossing of the rest, to reconnoitre. Not far from our
-front, on the far bank of the Ludjenda river, signals could be heard
-and men could be seen. We came close to the enemy camp and saw men
-in white suits moving about, a few hundred yards away. Others were
-building earthworks and a transport column was also observed. The
-troops were certainly in great force.
-
-While I was still considering whether, and in what way, a prospect
-of attack offered, a column of Askari in khaki advanced from the
-camp towards our troops. About a company of the enemy left the camp.
-Guessing that the enemy was wisely about to attack our troops with all
-his force while they were still occupied in crossing the river, I ran
-back quickly and ordered those of our companies who had crossed first
-to put themselves in a defensive position. The favourable opportunity
-I had hoped for did not, however, materialize: the enemy did not come.
-Thus I was again faced with the question what to do. I was doubtful
-whether, in view of our large numbers of bearers, it would not be more
-expedient to march past the enemy stationed here at Ngomano and advance
-further up the Ludjenda river. Either the enemy would not hinder us,
-or, if he did, he would have to emerge from his entrenched positions
-and make up his mind for a difficult attack.
-
-On the other hand, it was not unlikely that an attack by us on
-the enemy camp would be successful, for its defences were not yet
-especially strong. Reconnaissance had established that on the far bank
-of the Ludjenda river a belt of thick wood led right up to the camp and
-offered the opportunity of surprising the enemy here in strength, and
-bringing off a decisive attack. I had not yet fully made up my mind
-when Captain Müller decided me to take that one of the two decisions
-which, though very risky, offered a prospect of the long awaited
-decisive success and the capture of ammunition and war material which
-had become an urgent necessity. No time was to be lost.
-
-The attack was, therefore, made while part of the force was still
-crossing the river. While our light mountain-gun fired on the enemy’s
-entrenchments from the west, and while at the same time several
-companies engaged the enemy on this side as also from the north,
-Captain Koehl’s detachment crossed the Ludjenda half a mile above
-Ngomano, marched through the high wood on that bank and made a
-determined attack on the enemy’s camp from the south. I took up my
-position on a little hill west of the camp, near our guns. Immediately
-behind me the last company of General Wahle’s force to cross the river
-was advancing along a valley. In front I had a fairly good view of
-the enemy’s entrenched positions. The enemy’s machine guns were not
-shooting badly, and their fire was at times directed upon our little
-sand hill, from which I had to send into cover a number of Europeans
-and Askari, who had collected there immediately and were visible to
-the enemy. The clear ring of the enemy rifles, which we had heard
-before, and the absence of trench-mortars, made it probable that the
-enemy were Portuguese. We had already learned to distinguish clearly
-between the dull, full detonation of our ’71, the sharp crack of our
-S-rifle, the double report of the English rifle and the clear ring of
-the Portuguese rifle of a little over 6 mm. calibre. Even our Askari
-had noticed at once that in short skirmishes the speed with which the
-enemy trench-mortars always got the range of our positions had been
-very harassing.
-
-Our ’71 rifles threw up so much smoke that it was impossible to guard
-against this. To-day, however, there were no mine-throwers, and the
-treacherous smoke of our good old rifles was not so bad. On the other
-hand, when they did hit their target they made a very considerable
-hole. Our Askari soon realized that to-day they were able to bring
-their soldierly superiority to bear without being handicapped by
-inferior weapons. “To-day is the day of the old rifles!” they shouted
-to the German leaders, and from my hill I soon saw the firing line of
-Koehl’s detachment storm the enemy’s entrenchments at the double and
-capture them.
-
-This was the signal for attack on the other fronts also. From all sides
-they charged the enemy, who was badly shaken by the concentrated fire.
-Scarcely more than 200 of the enemy force, about 1,000 strong, can
-have survived. Again and again our Askari troops, in search of booty,
-threw themselves ruthlessly upon the enemy, who was still firing; in
-addition, a crowd of bearers and boys, grasping the situation, had
-quickly run up and were taking their choice of the pots of lard and
-other supplies, opening cases of jam and throwing them away again
-when they thought they had found something more attractive in other
-cases. It was a fearful _mêlée_. Even the Portuguese Askari already
-taken prisoner, joined in the plunder of their own stores. There was
-no alternative but to intervene vigorously. I became very eloquent,
-and, to make an example, dashed at least seven times at one bearer I
-knew, but each time he got away and immediately joined in the looting
-somewhere else. At last I succeeded in restoring discipline.
-
-We buried about 200 enemy dead, and about 150 European prisoners
-were released after taking an oath not to fight again during this
-war against Germany or her Allies; several hundred Askari were taken
-prisoner. Valuable medical stores, so necessary to us, and, as a result
-of the Portuguese experience of centuries of colonial campaigning, of
-excellent quality, were captured, as well as several thousand kilos of
-European supplies, large numbers of rifles, six machine-guns and about
-thirty horses. Unfortunately we captured no native supplies. Almost
-half of our force was re-armed this time with Portuguese rifles; and a
-plentiful supply of ammunition was served out. A quarter of a million
-rounds of ammunition were captured, and this number was increased in
-the course of December to nearly a million. From captured dispatches we
-learned that the Portuguese-European companies had only reached Ngomano
-a few days before, in order to carry out the impossible English order
-to prevent a German crossing of the Rovuma. It was really a perfect
-miracle that these troops should have arrived so opportunely as to make
-the capture of the place so profitable to us. With one blow we had
-freed ourselves of a great part of our difficulties.
-
-But yet another serious difficulty arose, which drove us remorselessly
-on. This was the necessity of procuring food for our large numbers of
-natives. Accordingly we advanced up the Ludjenda river. Day after day
-our patrols searched for native guides and supplies. During the next
-few days, however, they had little success. The natives, never numerous
-in this district, had fled before the advance of the Portuguese,
-fearing their ruthlessness and cruelty, and had hidden what stores they
-possessed. One after another, mules and horses found their way into our
-stew-pots. Fortunately this district is very rich in game, and the
-hunter can always shoot one of the numerous antelopes or guinea-fowl.
-
-Though at first our marching columns were too long and straggling, here
-again practice made perfect. Bearers, boys, women and children, soon
-learned to keep pace and distance as exactly as the Askari. Regularly
-and in good order, the expedition wound along the narrow native paths,
-and even through the thick bush, into the unknown land. Half an hour’s
-halt was called after every two hours’ march; the rule was six hours’
-march a day, _i.e._, about fifteen to twenty miles, and this was often
-exceeded. The force was for the most part divided into detachments of
-three companies, each with one supply train and one field hospital.
-The advance detachment was a day’s march ahead of the main body, the
-last a day’s march behind. At the head of each detachment marched the
-fighting companies with their machine guns; they had with them only the
-necessary ammunition and medical stores, and each European was allowed
-one load of necessities. The Askari marched gaily forward, straight
-as lances, and with their guns reversed over their shoulders, as has
-always been the custom in the rifle regiments. Lively conversation
-was kept up, and after the plundering of an enemy camp, which often
-yielded rich booty, cigarette smoke rose on all sides. The little
-signal recruits strode bravely forward, half-grown youths in Askari
-uniform for the most part, carrying all their worldly goods in a bundle
-on their heads. The Askari would call out their friendly, “Jambo Bwana
-Obao,” or “Jambo Bwana Generals” (“Good-day, Colonel”), or a little
-signalman would express his hope of coming some day to Uleia (Europe)
-and Berlin. “Then the Kaiser will say to me, ‘Good-day, my son,’ and I
-shall give him an exhibition of signalling. Then he will give me roast
-meat and present me to the Empress. The Empress will say, ‘Good-day, my
-child,’ and will give me cakes and show me the shop-windows.” During
-all their talk the Askari kept a sharp look-out, and no movement in the
-thick bush escaped their lynx eyes.
-
-The head of the column investigated every trail, and from it gave the
-number and the distance of the enemy. Equally soldierly were the
-machine-gun bearers, mostly strapping Waniamwezi and Wazukuma. The
-companies and detachments were followed by bearers with the loads of
-supplies, baggage, camp-kit and stretcher cases. The loads, about 25
-kg., were carried alternately on the head and shoulders. The endurance
-of these men is enormous. They became more and more attached to the
-troops. If ever the supplies were short and the hunting parties
-unsuccessful, they would say, “Haiswu’b (it doesn’t matter), we wait,
-get some another time.” Many marched barefoot and often got thorns in
-their feet. Often one would promptly take his knife and calmly cut out
-a piece of flesh from the wounded foot. Then he would start off again.
-The bearers were followed by the women and the Bibi. Many Askari had
-their wives and children with them in the field, and many children were
-born during the march. Each woman carried her own Mali (property), as
-well as that of her lord, on her head. Often they carried on their
-backs a small child, his woolly head peeping out of the cloth in which
-he was wound. The women were kept in order and protected by a European
-or a trustworthy old non-commissioned officer, assisted by a few
-Askari. They all liked gay colours, and after an important capture,
-the whole convoy stretching several miles would look like a carnival
-procession.
-
-Even during the march the obtaining of supplies had to be attended to.
-Hunting patrols marched ahead of the column or on the flanks in the
-bush. Often they would remain behind near the old camping sites, where
-game or traces of game had been observed. Other patrols followed human
-tracks leading to settlements to requisition supplies. On arriving at
-the camping-ground, four Askari and my boy Serubiti would cut down
-branches and erect a frame for the tent sections or for a grass-hut.
-Sometimes a raised bivouac of branches was arranged and covered with
-grass. Soon afterwards the bearded Baba, my cook, would arrive and give
-careful directions for the arrangement of the kitchen. The bearers
-would come and fetch water, cut grass and firewood with their bush
-knives. The hunting patrols brought in what they had shot, and soon the
-smell of cooking rose from the camp-fires on all sides. Meanwhile,
-parties of bearers had been threshing in the villages, and brought
-back corn. In the Kinos (thick wooden vessels) the corn was crushed by
-beating it with thick clubs, the dull thuds sounding far into the bush.
-Messages, reconnaissance reports, and captured dispatches were brought
-in; a box in a shady spot served as a desk. During the longer halts
-a table was built of branches. The evening meal was eaten in company
-with friends round the camp fire, the boys bringing cases to sit on.
-The more lordly had deck-chairs. Then to bed under the mosquito-nets,
-and in the early morning once more into the unknown. Should we find
-supplies, and could we make what we had last out until we did? These
-uncertainties cropped up every day afresh, and haunted us week after
-week and month after month. The eternal marching was, as will be
-understood, no mere pleasure. At—— I heard some remarks about myself,
-such as: “Still further? The fellow must come from a family of country
-postmen!”
-
-When we reached the confluence of the Chiulezi, difficulties of
-supplies had become so serious, and the district hitherto regarded as
-fertile had so greatly altered, that I dropped my original intention of
-keeping the force together. For the moment it seemed impossible, from
-the tactical point of view also. From the English, who were probably
-following us, we need not expect any strong pressure, owing to the
-daily lengthening of their line of communication and the consequent
-difficulty of bringing up supplies.
-
-A written message from the British Commander-in-Chief, General van
-Deventer, in which he summoned me to surrender, was brought under
-protection of the white flag, and strengthened me in my belief that our
-escape had taken him by surprise, and that our invasion of Portuguese
-territory had put him at a loss. Neither he nor General Smuts had
-ever thought of sending a summons to surrender when the situation
-was favourable to the English. Why should they do so in a situation
-like the present, or that of September, 1916, at Kissaki, which was
-undoubtedly favourable to us? Only because they were at their wits’
-end. That was indeed not difficult to see through. The time before the
-setting in of the rainy season, at the end of December, was too short
-to prepare for a fresh operation, and after the rains had begun the
-enemy transport of supplies, which depended largely on motors, would be
-faced with new difficulties.
-
-We had, therefore, plenty of time, and could divide ourselves into
-several columns without hesitation. We had nothing to fear from
-temporary loss of touch one with the other. Accordingly General Wahle’s
-detachment was separated from the rest, and marched through the Mkula
-mountains, while I marched further up the Ludjenda.
-
-The surrender of Captain Tafel, which I learned from General van
-Deventer’s message, came as a severe and unexpected blow.
-
-Captain Tafel had taken over the command at Mahenge from General Wahle,
-when the latter left to take over the forces on the Lindi front. He
-secured the fertile region of Mahenge to the north, with Commander
-Schoenfeldt’s detachment of a few companies. The latter succeeded in
-holding his ground with his weak force by skilful use of his 10·5 gun
-from the _Königsberg_, and put his force in a very favourable position
-materially by the cultivation of gardens and fields.
-
-On the middle Ruhudje was a weak detachment under Captain Aumann,
-and north-east of Ssongea Captain Lincke’s detachment near Likuju.
-The latter engaged the enemy repeatedly, and in the barren district
-suffered from lack of supplies. They therefore gradually retired north
-to Mponda. There they were reinforced by two companies and one gun
-from the main force. Captain Otto took over the command. In August,
-1917, strong English and Belgian forces converged on Mahenge; Captain
-Tafel had foreseen this, and withdrawn his supplies out of the Mahenge
-district to Mgangira. On September 11th, Mahenge was evacuated.
-Even though the individual engagements were often successful, the
-superiority of the enemy made itself seriously felt, and the shortage
-of ammunition handicapped more and more the Askari companies, mostly
-armed with the smoky ’71 rifle.
-
-I learned later through Captain Otto, who had fought his way through
-to me with one of Captain Tafel’s patrols and joined me at——, that
-Captain Tafel, from west of Livale, had marched south in three columns,
-and on the upper Mbemkuru had fought several partially successful
-actions, capturing large quantities of ammunition. He had then marched
-further south to the Bangala river, and turned east when he thought he
-was near Massassi. South of this place he heard from the natives that
-the Germans had not been fighting north of Rovuma for several days.
-Captain Tafel turned towards the Rovuma and crossed near the Nangala
-confluence, hoping to find supplies on the south bank. His own were
-literally exhausted. He found nothing and had no idea that about a
-day’s march from him Goering’s detachment of my force had captured the
-Portuguese camp and found enough food on the prosperous farms to enable
-them to live well for fourteen days. Captain Tafel therefore returned
-to the north bank of the Rovuma and surrendered to the enemy.
-
-The news of Captain Tafel’s surrender strengthened my reluctance to
-detach another part of my force, though, in view of my proximity, the
-junction at which we were both aiming had as nearly as possible been
-effected. I was straightway put upon the rack by the cessation of news
-from Goering’s detachment with which, while it was at Ngomano, we had
-kept touch by means of patrols. During the march up the Ludjenda, when
-we had to keep the different detachments and companies further apart,
-in order to facilitate the search for food, it was necessary to impress
-upon subordinate leaders the importance of keeping the whole force in
-touch. It was, however, not to be expected that these officers, who
-later performed such excellent work as leaders of detachments, and
-worked so successfully in co-operation with the rest, should possess
-the necessary training from the beginning. The Governor had remained
-with the force even after leaving the Protectorate, in accordance
-with the regulation (certainly not intended to provide for war with
-a European power) that he was the military head of the Protectorate.
-He had interpreted this authority in such a way as to interfere
-most seriously with that of the Commander-in-Chief, and had often
-encroached upon my sphere of activity. I had been powerless to prevent
-this, and now that we were outside the Protectorate I attached the
-greatest importance to the fact that now, at any rate, I had a free
-hand. Even if I did not yield to the Governor’s claims, it must be
-understood that in the unprecedented military situation there were
-enough differences of opinion to overburden the Commander-in-Chief,
-who, whatever happens, is held actually, if not morally, responsible.
-
-It was perhaps natural that at this time I was not always very gentle
-and considerate to those around me. So it happened that those very
-officers of my Staff who were working with the greatest devotion to
-the cause and deserved the most recognition, were the objects of
-much unjustified reproach. For not taking offence or allowing this
-to prejudice the cheerful continuation of their work, they deserve
-particular gratitude. It is largely to the work of these officers,
-often carried out under adverse circumstances, that are due the
-successes which the public is so generously inclined to place wholly to
-my credit. For me, who have always delighted in the good comradeship
-characteristic of our officer corps, this general atmosphere of
-snarling and fault-finding was naturally not ideal. Fortunately,
-however, it was only a passing phase.
-
-Our position was now such that in case of an encounter with the
-enemy we could not investigate his strength. We had no time for
-prolonged reconnaissance. Perhaps this conviction, together with the
-determination with which we attacked the Portuguese forces whenever
-we met them, accounts for the fact that, during December, three more
-Portuguese fortified positions were taken in quick succession. Of
-decisive importance in these enterprises was the personality of the
-officer in command who first engaged the enemy. He must lose no time,
-and so could not wait for orders. On the 2nd November, Lieutenant
-Kempner, commanding the 11th Company, which was acting as advance-guard
-in the march up the Ludjenda, came upon a fortified Portuguese camp
-at Nangwale. Like most Portuguese camps, it lay on a bare hill, with
-a wide range of fire. The brave 11th Company at once deployed along
-the edge of the bush, and advanced to the attack across three hundred
-metres of open ground exposed to the enemy’s fire. The Askari, who
-were carrying full marching kit, could not keep up with the company
-commander and his Effendi (black officer). Lieutenant Kempner and
-the Effendi leapt upon the enemy’s breastwork, and from there into
-the enemy’s entrenchments, and so for a time found themselves alone
-among the enemy garrison, consisting of a platoon. The latter were
-so dumbfounded that, hearing the cheers of the oncoming Askari, they
-at once obeyed the order to lay down their arms. In addition, a
-considerable ammunition dump fell into our hands, as well as enough
-rations to feed our whole force for several days. When the Portuguese
-officer invited Lieutenant Kempner to a glass of special brandy and
-found the bottle empty, its owner had further reason for being taken
-aback, but with the difference this time that his enemy was taken aback
-equally. An Ombascha (black lance-corporal) had the best of the joke.
-
-I was filled with grave anxiety about the fate of Captain Goering, of
-whom I had received no news. From General Wahle’s force, which had
-marched up the Chiulezi river, we heard subsequently that they had
-attacked and annihilated a force of several Portuguese companies in
-a strongly entrenched position in the Mkula mountains. The repeated
-attempts to establish communication with Wahle’s force by means
-of the heliograph did not succeed, although the Portuguese in the
-Mkula mountains had clearly observed our signals from Nangwale. The
-Portuguese Europeans captured by our detachment had refused to give
-their word not to fight against us again in this war. They had been
-sent north to the Rovuma by General Wahle owing to the difficulty of
-feeding them.
-
-Captain Stemmermann succeeded, after several days’ siege, in capturing
-another very strongly held and vigorously defended fortified position.
-As the storming of this offered no prospects of success, the enemy’s
-water supply was cut off, which made his position in the trenches
-untenable, and forced him to surrender. Among our casualties,
-unfortunately, were a number of very good native non-commissioned
-officers. I was not present at the fighting at Nangwale, as I was
-occupied in dealing with delays in the rear companies and arranging
-that the march should be kept up to the intended standard. By a double
-day’s march I easily made up for the delay this had caused me, and
-arrived in Nangwale in time to superintend the division of the captured
-stores. In the most favourable circumstances we were only living from
-hand to mouth. At Nangwale, where six months before our troops had
-found such a rich neighbourhood, the position was now quite different.
-Apart from the captured stores there was absolutely nothing; even the
-game in a considerable area round Nangwale had been shot or frightened
-away. This was a disappointment, for I had hoped at this place to be
-freed from the more ordinary difficulties of supplies. The force had,
-therefore, to be split up. From the information of the prisoners and
-captured documents it appeared that the garrison in Nangwale had been
-fed by columns of bearers from the distant neighbourhood of Mwalis.
-There must, then, be something to be found there.
-
-On 5th December Captain Koehl, with five companies, a gun and an
-ammunition column, left Nangwale to march to the Mwalia—Medo district.
-I myself continued the march up the Ludjenda. Fortunately the assurance
-of Lieutenant von Scherbening and other Europeans, who had already
-patrolled this district, that we should soon come into a region rich in
-supplies was confirmed. These supplies, however, were not excessive,
-and we were very glad that they could be largely supplemented by
-hunting. The enormous numbers of hippopotami which lived in the river
-above Nangwale, often in large herds of from fifteen to twenty, had
-become quite a staple dish. I myself could not resist having a shot at
-a huge bull; the animal sank at once, the water above it swirling as
-over a sinking ship. After a time it came to the surface again, feet
-uppermost, and made little further movement. The animal was then drawn
-to the bank with a rope. The numerous crocodiles made us cautious,
-and many a good prize had to be left from fear of these. The flesh
-of the hippopotamus tastes like coarse beef; the tongue, however,
-is particularly delicate. The most valuable product, however, is
-the excellent lard which the men had very quickly learnt to prepare.
-Its snow-white, appetizing appearance now was quite different from
-the dirty yellow of the first attempts on the Rufiji. On my many
-reconnoitring and hunting expeditions into the bush the Askari,
-who came with me and the bearers to carry the spoils of the chase,
-gradually revealed some of the secrets of the bush. We had long ago
-learned to make excellent spinach from different foliage plants (called
-Mlenda); now they showed me many different kinds of excellent wild
-fruit. We also learnt that the kernel of the Mbinji-fruit, the pulp of
-which I already knew contains prussic acid, is quite free from acid,
-and when roasted makes an exceptionally delicate dish, tasting like our
-hazel-nut.
-
-On the 17th December, 1917, Headquarters arrived at Chirumba (Mtarika).
-Lieutenant von Ruckteschell, with his company, had gone on ahead and
-had soon driven off the weak Portuguese outposts. This was a station of
-the Portuguese Nyassa company; this merchant company also administered
-the northern part of the colony. Further south, too, the administration
-is in the hands of other private companies. The Portuguese official
-in Chirumba, called Fernandez, seems to have been very capable. The
-massive buildings of his station, situated at the top of a bare
-eminence, were spotlessly clean. A trench ensured it against surprise.
-Beautiful gardens with fruit and vegetables stretched along the bank
-of the adjacent Ludjenda river. Avenues of mulberry and mango trees
-fringed the carefully laid-out roads. Many species of this mango fruit,
-known to the natives as Emben, were to be found in the station and
-the neighbouring native villages. It was already beginning to ripen
-and was so plentiful that it was found worth while to have the fruit
-systematically gathered. The waste to which the natives are generally
-prone was prevented as far as possible. The beautiful, sweet fruit was
-enjoyed by all the Europeans and a great part of the natives, and, in
-view of the shortage of sugar, for weeks provided a really valuable
-addition to the supplies. When, on my arrival at Chirumba, I stepped
-on to the veranda of the European house, Lieutenant Ruckteschell set
-before me some hog’s lard, which I had not seen for a long time. Here,
-as at many other Portuguese stations, there had been European pigs.
-
-We remained here for several weeks. One detachment moved further
-upstream and took possession of the small station of Luambala.
-At the same time General Wahle marched to the prosperous station
-of Mwemba, already known to us. The richly-cultivated triangle
-Chirumba-Luambala-Mwemba and beyond the frontier was patrolled by our
-requisitioning and reconnaissance patrols. The natives of this district
-showed themselves for the most part intelligent and friendly; they
-already knew that they had nothing to fear from the German troops. In
-spite of that they had hidden their stores of food in the bush and
-would let us have little or nothing. Our men had, however, long since
-learned to examine closely, for example, a suspicious-looking tree
-stump, and often found that it had been put together by hand and was
-the hiding place for stocks of food. Others would drive their sticks
-into the hollow ground of a freshly laid-out garden and found stores
-of grain buried there. In short, many such hiding-places were found,
-and when, at Christmas, we sat down to dinner in a large grass-hut,
-we were relieved of the most pressing shortage of food. According to
-the descriptions of our men the Ludjenda river was, during several
-months of the year, so full of fish that they could be pulled out in
-basketfuls. Oddly enough, on this occasion only very few were caught.
-Most of them were sheat-fish, about eighteen inches long, and smaller
-fish which were best fried crisp. These, too, contributed their modest
-share towards the improvement of the rations.
-
-Touch was kept with Koehl’s detachment in the neighbourhood of Medo
-by means of a system of relays. I thought it probable that the enemy,
-following his usual tactics, was preparing a great concentric movement
-against us which would not be ready for at least a month. We could
-thus rely on there being no considerable enemy activity until after
-the rains, which would end at the end of February. About this time I
-intended to concentrate my forces in the neighbourhood of Nanungu.
-Until then we must husband our supplies in this area and live as
-far as possible on what could be obtained in the outer fringe of our
-present locality. At first there was not much game shot at Chirumba,
-but the bag increased when we found considerable herds of antelopes
-on the east bank of the Ludjenda, and particularly further upstream.
-During the remainder of the dry season, while the river was low,
-caravans of bearers were continually crossing the river by several
-fords, carrying their loads to the dumps on the east bank. As well
-as the fords, canoes made from hollowed tree-trunks were used for
-crossing. Patrols were sent out for weeks at a time to collect supplies
-and reconnoitre. Lieutenant von Scherbening, with his patrol, made an
-expedition lasting months, marching from Chirumba via Mtenda, Mahua
-and finally south, via the Lurio river, then up the Malema, where
-they surprised the Portuguese Boma Malema. An Italian, who had been
-hunting elephants on the Ludjenda and had joined us in a ragged,
-starving condition, accompanied Lieutenant von Scherbening’s patrol.
-The man’s health was, however, so undermined by lingering malaria and
-his spleen so terribly swollen that he had to be carried from Mahua to
-a plantation near Malacotera.
-
-At the beginning of January, 1918, the English began to move. From the
-south-east corner of Lake Nyassa two battalions—the 1st and 2nd King’s
-African Rifles—began to advance towards Captain Goering’s detachment,
-which had joined up with us and occupied the acute angle between the
-Luhambala and Ludjenda rivers. He was covering the supply stores
-further up the Ludjenda. On 9th January, in the forenoon, a detachment
-of the enemy, attacking unsupported, was defeated. When, in the
-afternoon, the enemy returned to the attack after the arrival of his
-reinforcements, and at the same time an enemy force pressed forward in
-a northerly direction toward the supply dumps on the east bank, Captain
-Goering crossed to the east bank with the main part of his force. Only
-a strong patrol was left in the old camp on the west bank, and they
-held the enemy in check. At the same time an enemy force—the 2nd Cape
-Corps of South African half-breeds was identified—was advancing on
-Mwembe.
-
-Then began innumerable small skirmishes and patrol actions, which
-often put us in an awkward position, owing to our inability to protect
-the bearers bringing up supplies. The English cleverly took advantage
-of these difficulties to try to undermine the loyalty of our Askari.
-Many were very war-weary. Added to this, there was in many cases the
-feeling of uncertainty as to where the campaign was going to lead
-them. The great majority of black men cling to their homes and their
-relations. They said to themselves: “If we go further we shall come
-into country we don’t know. We can find our way back from where we are
-now, but soon we shan’t be able to.” The English propaganda, by word
-of mouth and pamphlets, fell in many cases on fruitful ground, and,
-as a result, a number of good Askari and even older non-commissioned
-officers deserted. Small annoyances, such as are bound to arise—the
-persuasion of the women and so on—all contributed to their decision
-to desert. One old _sol_ (native sergeant-major) suddenly disappeared,
-who had led a brilliant independent patrol and had brought a strong
-detachment of bearers with their loads right through the enemy lines,
-and for his good service had been promoted to “Effendi.” He, too, had
-deserted. The impulsiveness of the black makes him very sensitive
-to insinuation. But even if the English Colonel can boast of having
-lowered the _moral_ of certain elements, this was only a passing phase.
-The old lust of battle and the old loyalty returned, even among those
-who had begun to hang their heads. The example of the faithful Askari,
-who simply laughed at the mountains of gold the English promised them
-if they would desert, won the day. In so long and trying a campaign
-the _moral_ was bound to be low from time to time. It was no use to be
-astonished and discouraged, the important thing was to fight against it
-firmly, and for this the loyal elements, of which there were many, both
-among Europeans, Askari and bearers, had firmly made up their minds.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER II
-
-EAST OF THE LUDJENDA
-
-
-THE patrol of Captain Otto, who had been sent from Captain Tafel to
-me after the latter’s surrender, and gave me details about the events
-leading up to it, had arrived at Chirumba. Captain Otto, with two
-additional companies, now marched to Luambala and took over the command
-also of Goering’s detachment (three companies). As was expected,
-the main pressure of the enemy was felt at Luambala, as also on the
-east bank of the Ludjenda. It was clear that if the enemy advanced
-downstream my position at Chirumba on the west bank of the river, in a
-district where the supplies were being gradually exhausted, and with
-the river swollen by the rains in my rear, was extremely unfavourable.
-
-It was necessary to evacuate this position and to move my force,
-while there was time, to the east bank of the Ludjenda. Unfortunately
-the fords were impassable, owing to the height of the river, so that
-the whole crossing had to be effected by means of the three canoes
-available.
-
-Gradually, and without interference, the companies were transferred
-to the east bank. The supply question was beginning to become very
-serious. Fortunately Captain Koehl, who, in the neighbourhood of Medo
-and Namunu, had kept the very intelligent natives to the cultivation
-of the quickly ripening grain, reported that a good harvest could be
-relied on as early as the middle of February. But that was not for
-another month, so we should have to try by every possible means to hold
-out a bit longer at Chirumba. Welcome as the manna to the children of
-Israel, the fungi which shoot up at this season helped to keep us from
-starvation. I had already in Germany interested myself in mycology,
-and soon found fungi closely related to our German species of mushrooms
-and yellow boleta and others, in the African bush. I had often gathered
-basketfuls in a very short time, and even though an excessive diet
-of mushrooms is indigestible and not very sustaining, they were a
-considerable help.
-
-In torrential rain we marched east. The usually dry ravines had become
-raging torrents. Trees, felled in such a way as to fall over the
-stream, formed bridges, a hand-rail being improvised from poles or
-bark lashed together. The mule I was riding on account of fever—I am
-apparently very sensitive to malaria, from which I suffered a great
-deal—as well as the few other riding animals that had not found their
-way into the cooking-pot swam across. When we arrived at the camping
-ground my men soon built me, on account of the damp, a raised shelter
-of branches over which both my tent-cloths were laid as a roof.
-Veterinary Surgeon Huber, who was responsible for the material welfare
-of the staff, and under him our capable black cook, old bearded Baba,
-at once got to work and, no matter how wet the wood, we were always
-able in a short time to sit down to our meal beside the camp-fire.
-Dr. Huber often managed even to have a grass roof erected for our
-protection.
-
-On sunny days tobacco was eagerly dried and cut. The efficient
-Quartermaster-Lieutenant Besch, who was full of resource where the
-comfort of the men was concerned, had thought of this and had collected
-very good tobacco from the natives. But in spite of everything the
-deprivations were very great and the insidious whisperings of the
-enemy, that every native who deserted should be free to go home and
-there live in comfort on his own land, did not always fall on deaf
-ears. Even the faithful boy of one of our officers, whom he had served
-for years, had one morning disappeared; probably his Bibi (wife) had
-had enough of campaigning.
-
-Captain Otto’s detachment marched from Uambala due east to Mahua, and
-there, on the Lurio river, found a district rich in supplies. Goering’s
-detachment, marching from Luambala across country to Mtende, found
-considerable supplies on the way. In this district the harvest was
-very much earlier than in German East Africa; the maize was beginning
-to ripen and could to a large extent already be eaten. Headquarters
-next moved from Chirumba to Mtende and, some days later, on to Nanungu.
-Wahle’s detachment, which had followed us from Chirumba to Mtende, was
-here cut off by several enemy companies which appeared unexpectedly
-on a height on their rear and interrupted the messenger service and
-the transport. General Wahle extricated himself by a détour from this
-uncomfortable position and advanced nearer to Headquarters at Nanungu.
-
-At Nanungu we found abundant supplies and we thought it expedient, as
-before, to establish requisitioning stations and supply dumps in the
-district between Nanungu and Namunu and further south. There was good
-shooting, and the natives readily brought garden produce and honey
-to exchange for meat or, preferably, clothing. Very welcome was a
-delicate sweet, cherry-like Pori fruit, which ripened in millions in
-the neighbourhood of Nanungu. I preferred to have it made into jam. We
-also occasionally obtained other dainties, particularly pig-nuts, and
-the crowing of cocks proclaimed far and wide that there were fowls and
-eggs in the camps and among the natives.
-
-The setting in of the rainy season did not quite coincide with the
-forecasts of the natives. There were some sharp downpours, but in the
-undulating country the water quickly ran off and collected in the main
-artery of that region, the Msalu river, which was soon swollen so
-as to form a strong obstacle. Over the Msalu river the post-service
-official, Hartmann, who had joined the force as a Sergeant-Major, had
-built a pontoon bridge which connected us with General Wahle’s force,
-which was still on the west bank. The floating supports of the bridge
-were boats made from bark. The necessity in this well-watered country
-of being able to cross the swollen rivers without difficulty had drawn
-my attention to this question. Hitherto our sole provision for such
-contingencies consisted of a few hollowed canoes. Their continued
-transport, however, was too difficult and their capacity too limited.
-A planter named Gerth, who had joined us as a volunteer, interested
-himself particularly in this matter and had himself instructed by the
-natives of the district in the building of boats from bark. The ensuing
-experiments soon produced good results, after which the building of
-these boats, which took barely two hours to put together, for crossing
-rivers was enthusiastically taken up by every company. Most of these
-boats were not used, but they gave us a feeling of security that, if
-necessary, even a full stream would not be impassable for our unwieldy
-caravans and baggage.
-
-When we became better acquainted with the neighbourhood, we found
-fords over the Msalu which could be used even when the river was in
-flood. Our patrols, in charge of Sergeant Valett and others, left our
-fortified camp at Nanungu, crossed the river which formed the boundary
-of our camp on the west, and went to look for the enemy in his camps at
-Mtenda. One of these patrols, which was particularly strong and armed
-with two machine guns, succeeded in surprising an enemy column west of
-Mtenda. Our men, however, did not get away quickly enough to escape the
-enemy’s covering force and, attacked from all sides, found themselves
-in a difficult position. Both machine guns were lost and the Europeans
-working them fell. Gradually the Askari all returned to Nanungu, but
-the patrol leader, Sergeant-Major Musslin, who had got away from the
-rest during the march, had fallen into the enemy’s hands. Another
-patrol, with which Captain Müller crossed the Msalu to the north,
-quickly drove off an English outpost at Lusinje. In the neighbourhood
-of Lusinje, also the camp of the English, Lieutenant Wienholt, who, as
-has already been mentioned, escaped from arrest and became one of the
-best English patrol leaders, was captured. The natives were thoroughly
-exploited by the English patrols and acted as spies for the enemy in
-return for articles of clothing. The volunteer, Gerth, who has been
-mentioned in connection with boat-building, was attacked and killed by
-an English patrol while in the house of a native chief.
-
-In the second half of March, 1918, our spirits were greatly raised
-by the news, received by our wireless, of the powerful German March
-offensive on the Western front. I laid a wager with the Staff Medical
-Officer, Staff-Surgeon Taute, that Amiens would soon fall. I used
-the period of rest that now set in for several weeks during the lull
-in our operations to have my foot attended to. It had been bitten by
-a sand-fly, and for the last six months had caused me inconvenience.
-These sand-flies, which infested many of the camps, bore their way
-into the flesh, round the edge of the toe-nails, causing painful
-inflammation. If care is not taken they attack the flesh round them
-and, according to medical opinion, the maiming of the feet frequent
-among the natives is very often to be traced to the sand-fly. I,
-too, was suffering from this inconvenience, and on the march the
-inflammation constantly recurred. Fortunately Staff-Surgeon Taute,
-using a local anæsthetic, was able to extract the nail.
-
-I was also inconvenienced in another way. On a reconnoitring expedition
-a blade of the tall grass, which grows above a man’s height, had
-pierced my right eye. During the subsequent treatment it was feared
-that the use of the lens might be affected by atropia; the result was
-that I could not see properly with my right eye and was unable to
-read hand-writing or sketch-maps. This was very awkward, as my left
-eye had been so seriously injured by a shot wound received during the
-Hottentot rebellion in South-West Africa, that I could only see through
-it with the help of spectacles. Suitable spectacles could not, however,
-be obtained, and so I was compelled to carry out various enterprises
-without being able to see properly.
-
-The patrols of Koehl’s detachment in the Medo-Nanungu district had
-meanwhile reached the coast, after taking Portuguese fortresses on, and
-far south of, the lower Lurio river, and carrying off a few guns and,
-what was more important, rifles, ammunition and considerable supplies.
-The natives showed themselves very friendly towards our men, whom they
-regarded as their deliverers from Portuguese oppression. Patrols from
-Otto’s detachment from Mahua had also reconnoitred as far as the region
-south of the Lurio. Lieutenant Methner, so experienced in the ways
-of the natives, and first _referant_ of our government, praised the
-capacity and cleverness of the Portuguese natives and the intelligence
-and far-sightedness of their local chiefs.
-
-Lieutenant von Scherbening, who with his patrol had taken the Boma
-Malema, reported that this neighbourhood was very productive. As a
-specimen he sent us a captured pig to Nanungu. As it refused to walk it
-was carried the 500 km. Unfortunately it turned out eventually not to
-be a European pig at all, but a Pori pig, like those we frequently shot
-in the bush.
-
-Once more a time had come when it was difficult to obtain news of the
-enemy, but a good deal could be conjectured from the incomplete maps at
-our disposal. I could have no doubt that the imminent enemy operations
-would be launched from the neighbourhood of Port Amelia with their main
-force from the coast. The appearance of strong enemy forces at Mtende,
-as well as the report, unconfirmed it is true, that troops were on the
-march from the south-west towards Mahua, showed me that other troops
-from the west were going to co-operate with the approaching attack of
-the enemy main force. A situation seemed to be developing in which
-I could make use of my inner line to attack one part of the enemy
-singly. The enemy’s position with regard to reserves and supplies made
-it obvious that the columns marching from the west could not be over
-strong. This seemed to be the chance I had so long been awaiting. I,
-therefore, remained with my main force at Nanungu and also recalled
-Captain Otto’s detachment from Lurio. With these forces I intended to
-assume the offensive in a westerly direction. Captain Koehl, whose
-detachment was assembled at Medo, was charged with the duty of holding
-up the enemy’s main force advancing from Port Amelia and retiring
-gradually on my force.
-
-Captain Müller, who, after years of work at Headquarters, had taken
-over an independent detachment of two companies, was sent on from
-the neighbourhood of Nanungu to Mahua to harass the enemy as far as
-possible. He passed round Mahua and surprised, south-west of this
-place, the fortified supply depot of Kanene. The defending English
-European troops saw that all the stores were lost. To prevent this, at
-least to some extent, they fell upon the stores of liquor in the camp
-and were captured in a thoroughly intoxicated condition.
-
-For myself, I, likewise, advanced in the middle of April in the
-direction of Mahua, and during the march could hear from afar heavy
-sounds of firing. At Koriwa, north-east of Mahua, Captain Müller had
-attacked an enemy battalion under Colonel Barton, which had been making
-a reconnoitring expedition and was at once attacked by our troops on
-the march. In spite of the fact that on our side scarcely 70 rifles
-took part in the action, our troops succeeded in enveloping the enemy’s
-right wing, and from a large ant-hill poured upon him such a vigorous
-and effective machine-gun fire that he fled wildly. He lost over 40
-men in this action. Lieutenant-Commander Wunderlich, who had received
-a severe wound through the abdomen, had to be taken to the hospital at
-Nanungu, two days’ march distant, and died shortly afterwards.
-
-The blow which I had intended to strike with the main force had already
-been successfully carried through by Müller’s weak detachment. I,
-therefore, turned with my main force to the district west of Nanungu. A
-large force of the enemy had arrived meanwhile on the Msalu river and
-had crossed it with several patrols. My calculation that I should be
-able to surprise a strong body of the enemy immediately after crossing
-the river was not fulfilled: the reports received had been incorrect.
-However, in a whole series of minor engagements on the Msalu river and
-further west our fighting patrols inflicted, gradually, severe losses
-on the enemy and his patrols soon evacuated the east bank of the Msalu.
-On 3rd May our supply patrols, whose duty it was to obtain further
-supplies from the direction of Mahua, surprised, in the neighbourhood
-of Saidi, strong enemy detachments which were seriously threatening our
-field hospital and supply depots at Makoti.
-
-Part of our stores had been brought to Makoti in readiness for the
-operations planned to be carried out further west. Our fighting
-patrols, which were sent out immediately, had several encounters with
-the enemy near the Kireka mountain at Makoti. I thought at first that
-these were only enemy patrols, so sent Captain Schulz there with a
-strong patrol as a reinforcement, and myself marched on the 4th of May,
-with the main body, to the Nanungu-Mahua road. From here I expected to
-be able to carry out a swift attack on the enemy forces, which were
-trying to surprise us somewhere in this neighbourhood. The general
-situation was made clear when it was known that patrols had, in the
-course of the day, encountered a new enemy near the Kireka mountain. An
-enemy detachment had been thrown back and it was probable that strong
-forces were in entrenched positions in the rear. In the morning of the
-5th May I marched from my camp to Makoti. During the march I hoped
-sincerely that the enemy would spare us the necessity of making the
-attack on his fortified positions and that, as in view of the general
-situation was not improbable, he would emerge from his entrenchments
-and offer battle in the open. If this happened, and we succeeded
-in attacking with our main force before the enemy was aware of our
-arrival, a considerable success was probable.
-
-At eleven o’clock in the forenoon I arrived at the Kireka mountain
-and went on ahead to see Captain Schulz who, with his patrol, had
-occupied some rocky grottos in the copse. As soon as I had arrived a
-_sol_ (native Sergeant-Major), who had just returned from a patrol
-expedition, reported that the enemy was advancing in great force
-and must soon appear at close quarters. I passed on this report to
-Lieutenant Boell, who had just brought up his company in the rear
-of Schulz’s detachment, and instructed him to go up at once in case
-of an enemy attack. I then went back and ordered the advance of our
-companies which were gradually arriving. Meanwhile the fighting in
-front began. The enemy, advancing in close order, had quickly thrown
-back our patrols out of the grottos, but had then been completely taken
-by surprise by the effective machine-gun fire of Boell’s company and
-partially driven back. Goering’s detachment, coming up at that moment,
-began an enveloping movement on the right, completely surprising the
-enemy, who was rapidly driven back with very heavy losses.
-
-After several miles of hot pursuit we reached the enemy’s
-entrenchments. On our left wing, where two more companies had been sent
-into action, the fight wavered, and it was difficult for me in the
-thick bush to distinguish friend and foe. It was, therefore, some time
-before I could get a clear idea of the situation on the left wing, and
-it was not until I received a report from Major Kraut, whom I had sent
-to investigate, that I realized that, in advancing, our left wing had
-come under a withering enemy fire in a clearing which had brought it
-to a standstill. A counter-attack by the enemy, which had brought him
-very near to the position of our Headquarters, looked very dangerous.
-Fortunately for us, however, just at this moment Lieutenant Buechsel,
-whose company had been detached from the main force and so arrived
-late, came upon the scene of action and was able to avert the danger.
-
-Meanwhile, on the right wing, Captain Goering had realized that a
-frontal attack on the enemy entrenchment offered no prospect of
-success. He had, therefore, sent Lieutenant Meier with a strong patrol
-round the enemy’s position to fire on the enemy mine-thrower from the
-rear and if possible to capture it. This capture was not brought off,
-for the enemy had at his disposal unexpected reserves which were able
-to keep Meier’s patrol at a distance.
-
-The action thus came to a standstill. When it had grown quite dark we
-were close in front of the enemy. Shots were still being exchanged from
-both sides, but only occasionally. The clerical work—even in Africa
-there was writing to be done, though not as much as is usually the
-case—was postponed during the fighting. A number of charges and other
-tiresome details had to be written up. I was able from time to time
-to talk personally with the company leaders, and called them together
-for this purpose. I changed my own position as little as possible to
-avoid difficulties and annoying delays in the dispatch and receipt of
-messages. A meal was cooked further in the rear, where the dressing
-station had also been established. We at Headquarters had our meal
-prepared as usual by our black servants, who brought it up to the
-firing-line.
-
-In order to get the force in hand ready for further action, some parts
-of it were withdrawn from the front line and mustered. I came to the
-conclusion that it would be expedient to remain where we were for the
-night, to be in readiness to renew the action on the following day, and
-especially to cut the enemy off from his water-supply, which must be
-somewhere outside the camp.
-
-About midnight it was reported that one of our patrols had encountered
-a strong enemy force on the Nanungu-Mahua road. I was afraid that this
-force, which I took to be strong in view of its independent movement,
-would advance further on Nanungu and capture our company’s stores
-(ammunition, medical stores, supplies, etc.), which were on this road
-as well as the depot at Nanungu. I therefore withdrew during the night
-with the greater part of my force, via Makoti, to the Nanungu-Mahua
-road. Only strong patrols remained in front of the enemy, but these
-did not notice that the enemy, too, evacuated his position during the
-night and withdrew towards Mahua. On 6th May it became apparent that
-the report of strong enemy forces on the Nanungu-Mahua road, which had
-caused my retirement, was incorrect. There was no enemy there. Captain
-Müller, hearing the firing of the English trench-mortars, had, with
-admirable initiative, immediately begun a forced march from his camp
-north-east of Mahua, towards the sound and had apparently been taken
-for the enemy.
-
-When he arrived on the battlefield he found that the enemy had retired.
-The enemy, consisting of four companies and a machine-gun company,
-and to judge from his fortifications a thousand strong, had been
-completely defeated by our force of little more than 200 rifles—we
-were 62 Europeans and 342 Askari. He had lost 14 Europeans and 91
-Askari killed, 3 Europeans and 3 Askari taken prisoner. In addition,
-his hospital with about 100 wounded had fallen into our hands, and
-according to the natives he had taken other wounded with him. Our
-casualties were: 6 Europeans, 24 Askari, 5 other natives killed; 10
-Europeans, 67 Askari and 28 other natives wounded.
-
-While this gratifying success against the enemy’s western columns was
-being attained, Koehl’s detachment had been engaged in continuous
-fighting, often on a considerable scale, against the enemy divisions
-which were advancing on Nanungu from Port Amelia. At Medo the enemy,
-according to his own statement, suffered heavy losses in one
-engagement west of Medo. Captain Spangenberg, with his two companies,
-had succeeded in getting round the enemy, falling on and capturing
-from the rear his light field howitzer battery. Nearly all the men and
-horses of this battery were killed. Unfortunately it was not possible
-to remove the guns and ammunition. They were rendered useless. But in
-spite of this individual success, Koehl’s detachment had to retire.
-The moment was approaching when the timely intervention of my main
-force with Koehl’s detachment might bring about a decisive success
-against General Edwards. Once more, however, the question of supplies
-dragged our movements. The crops of the district had all been consumed,
-except the Mtama, which ripens much earlier in this country than
-in German East Africa. But it was not yet ripe. In order to avoid
-having to withdraw simply for reasons of supply, we ripened the Mtama
-artificially by drying it. This made the grain quite edible, and as
-there was plenty of it in the district everyone got as much as he
-wanted, and there was no want.
-
-The condition of the crops prompted me to march with the main body of
-the force further south-west, in the direction of Mahua, and pitch my
-camp beside the Koroma mountain, not far from the Timbani mountain.
-I intended, if necessary, to march further south, to avail myself of
-the abundant crops in the fertile districts near the confluence of
-the Malma and Lurio rivers. West of the Timbani mountain the country
-was favourable for a decisive action against General Edwards, who was
-following Captain Koehl’s detachment south-west from Nanungu. The
-extraordinarily rocky and broken country near the mountain, and four
-miles north-east of it, as far as the place to which Koehl’s detachment
-had retired, was not favourable for the decisive attack I had in view.
-On 21st May smoke indicated fresh enemy camps west of the positions of
-Koehl’s detachment. I guessed that this new enemy would march on 22nd
-May to take Koehl’s detachment in the rear from the west. Unfortunately
-I omitted to give Koehl’s detachment definite orders to withdraw their
-main force immediately from the unfavourable country to the south-west
-of the Timbani mountain. Instead of a positive order I gave him
-instructions which left him too much freedom of action.
-
-Thus it came about that Koehl’s detachment did not get their bearers
-with the ammunition and baggage on the march until the forenoon of the
-22nd of May. Even then all would have been well if the Governor, who
-had attached himself to Koehl’s division, had not marched at their
-head. Not understanding the seriousness of the situation, he made a
-considerable halt in the middle of this unfavourable country, where he
-was exposed to a surprise attack from the enemy at any moment, without
-being able to put up an effective defence. The bearers of Koehl’s
-detachment, in spite of Captain Koehl’s orders, allowed themselves to
-halt likewise. During the morning of this day, I once more personally
-reconnoitred the very favourable country south-west of the Timbani
-mountain, and met, among others, Lieutenant Kempner, who had been
-wounded the day before with Koehl’s detachment and carried to the rear.
-From Koehl’s detachment itself, where, since the morning, several
-enemy attacks had been beaten off, sounds of distant fighting were
-to be heard. There was telephonic communication with Captain Koehl,
-and I returned about 11 a.m. to the Koroma camp without having any
-idea of the situation of his transport. At noon I had just entered
-the camp when suddenly there was a loud sound of firing, from a very
-short distance, of trench-mortars, beyond doubt between us and Koehl’s
-detachment. Immediately afterwards telephonic communication in that
-direction was broken off. There was no alternative but to march my
-whole force immediately from the Koroma camp against this new enemy.
-I secretly hoped that, in spite of the unfavourable country, we
-might perhaps succeed in taking him by surprise, and in inflicting a
-decisive defeat. Barely an hour later we reached the Timbani mountain
-and quickly threw back the advanced detachment of the enemy. A few
-scattered men reported that the Governor and Captain Koehl’s transport
-had been surprised by the enemy and all the baggage lost. The Governor
-himself had only just managed to get away; others said he had been
-taken prisoner. The enemy had opened a fairly lively fire with several
-mine-throwers, and was attacked by our companies from several sides. He
-had, however, taken up a good position, in which he entrenched himself
-and had hidden part of the captured baggage. Unfortunately we only
-recaptured a small quantity. But the enemy position was surrounded and
-subjected to a concentrated and gruelling fire. According to a dispatch
-captured later, the 1st King’s African Rifles alone lost about two
-hundred men.
-
-[Illustration: Native Types (5).
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-[Illustration: Native Types (6).
-
-(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)]
-
-[Illustration: Fig. xviii. The Action at the Kireka Mts.]
-
-Several companies and patrols of Captain Koehl’s detachment took part
-in this envelopment of the enemy. Captain Koehl himself had turned his
-main force against the new enemy, attacking his rear, and hoped to be
-able to defeat him while a strong patrol facing north-east held his
-former enemy in check. This patrol, however, was much too weak. It was
-pressed back, and had again to be reinforced with troops from Captain
-Koehl’s detachment. Even though the enemy had without doubt suffered
-on the whole considerable losses, a decisive success was unattainable.
-The fighting was broken off at dark, and we withdrew to the favourable
-country I had reconnoitred between the Timbani and Koroma mountains.
-
-Meanwhile the Governor had found his way to the camp by the Koroma
-mountain. He had lost all his belongings in the adventure, and was
-looked after by Heder, a non-commissioned officer, and the trustworthy
-and cautious leader of the supply column. I, too, came up to help the
-Governor in his adversity, and honoured him with a pair of blue socks,
-which his wife had made me at the beginning of the war, but which
-unfortunately had faded.
-
-Apart from the serious loss of about 70,000 rounds of ammunition,
-we had also lost a considerable amount of notes—I believe it was
-30,000 rupees. My desire to give requisition notes in preference to
-bank notes, and so save a lot of transport of securities and avoid
-unnecessary losses, had not been acceded. Millions of rupee notes
-had been printed, the dragging about of which, in the present war
-situation, was particularly burdensome. In order, at least, to avoid
-similar losses in the future, the Quartermaster, on my instructions,
-destroyed a great part of the notes which had been obtained with so
-much trouble.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER III
-
-IN THE REGION OF THE LURIO AND LIKUNGO RIVERS
-
-
-ON May 23rd the rest of our transport and the main body of the troops
-were started off from Coroma camp on a track right through the bush
-to Koriwa. The bulk of our carrier columns and the sick had gone on
-ahead. The rearguard under Captain Otto remained a few days longer on
-the Koroma Mountain and there successfully repulsed several hostile
-attacks. It looked as if our enemy had once again collected the bulk of
-his troops at Timbani, after the conclusion of a concentric operation,
-and needed some time to reorganize his supply before resuming
-his march. Returning patrols reported heavy motor traffic on the
-Nanungu-Timbani Mountain road. Other patrols informed us that hostile
-forces from the east were approaching the northern bank of the Lurio
-river.
-
-Unmolested by the enemy, I now made for the fertile district of
-Kwiri, south of Mahua, and from thence on to the Lurio. It turned
-out, however, that some of our seriously wounded and sick would not
-be able to endure several days of such marches in their “Maschille”
-(litters). Nor was it easy to ensure medical attention. We had too few
-attendants to be able to leave the sick behind individually. So there
-was nothing for it but to collect our invalids from time to time, turn
-them into a complete Field Hospital, under a single medical officer,
-and take our leave of them finally. Even the senior medical officer of
-the Protective Force, Dr. Meixner, was left behind at Kwiri with one
-such hospital. On that occasion I said farewell to Lieutenant Schaefer
-who had rendered us such exemplary service in the preparations for the
-action at Jassini, and was now stricken with black-water fever. This
-experienced “African” was fully aware of his situation, but was as
-cheerful as ever and faced his inevitable end, which was approaching
-fast, with composure.
-
-I did not wish to linger long north of the Lurio, for I thought that
-this river, which had been very high only a short time before, would
-be a serious obstacle. For that reason I proposed to cross it with our
-large quantity of transport quickly and without let or hindrance. When
-we actually reached the Lurio it appeared that at this time of the year
-there were plenty of fords which offered a comfortable crossing. We
-left some of our troops on the northern bank without anxiety as to the
-drawbacks involved, and established a camp for the main body on the
-southern bank. The country was very fertile and the inhabitants trusted
-in us; good relations had been established by the earlier visits of the
-patrols and raiding parties. One of my orderlies had a hearty reception
-from some old acquaintances.
-
-I was pretty sure that the English would attack us here and be
-compelled to bring up ever more troops. If I only withdrew slowly
-enough, the strong enemy forces would, I believed, probably follow,
-but in view of their immense supply difficulties, it would be in vain.
-In this way I might achieve my main purpose of gaining enough time to
-raid the weaker hostile camps and posts further south. Captain Müller’s
-detachment, which had been sent south, discovered one such camp at
-Malema, the same place where our troops had won heartening successes
-before.
-
-After fighting for several days Captain Müller captured the Boma
-Malema. It had been occupied by an English half-battalion which retired
-south at night. Simultaneously a Portuguese patrol had gone north from
-the Boma Malema and returned. Captain Müller took the latter for the
-retreating English, attacked them on the march and was very astonished
-to find that the killed were Portuguese.
-
-After the action Captain Müller shifted his camp. In the move,
-Lieutenant von Schroetter, who was ill with malaria, was left behind
-for a short time and taken prisoner by an English patrol which suddenly
-appeared upon the scene. When this patrol marched off to the Boma
-Inagu he managed to escape, and rejoined us at length, quite exhausted.
-But he lost all his belongings, and had nothing on his head—a very
-serious matter under a tropical sun.
-
-From the reports of the natives and our own patrols there was no longer
-room for doubt that strong enemy forces, which had disembarked at
-Mozambique, were marching west on the Boma Malema, and were already
-only a few days’ march from that place. Simultaneous reports were
-received that troops were also marching towards the Boma Malema from
-the west, the direction of Malacotera. A few days later the enemy
-following us from the north reached the Lurio, so we evacuated its
-northern bank. From captured documents and the fighting that took place
-on the northern bank, we judged that this hostile force was stronger
-than I had suspected. Thanks to its light motor transport columns it
-had been able to follow us up quickly with all its supply as well as a
-body which I estimated at about three or four battalions with auxiliary
-arms.
-
-The country along the river Malema in which we had our camp was quite
-extraordinarily fertile. The _mtama_ was perfectly ripe, and there was
-an abundance of tomatoes, bananas, sweet potatoes (_batatas_) and other
-fruits. The food was also very varied. Game and fish were plentiful.
-The natives knew the German troops from previous acquaintance, and
-were very friendly. When I rode from one detachment to another the
-women came running out of their houses to see the “Njama” (animal,
-game, flesh), a creature quite unknown to them. I was riding a horse,
-of course! The fertile country was so extensive that we could not
-even approximately exploit or protect it. We could not prevent it
-supplying the necessities of life to the large number of Askari and
-non-combatants with our enemies, as well as ourselves. We could not
-deprive the enemy of the possibility of also making this prolific
-region in a large measure into a new base and shortening his line
-of supply. From our point of view the country was, if anything, too
-fertile and we were not in a position, as on earlier occasions, to
-exploit it to such an extent before we left that it was insufficient
-to support the enemy masses. But at any rate it had the result that
-for the moment we were very mobile as, thanks to our sojourn of several
-weeks, our wounded and sick were so far recovered that all, even the
-inmates of the field hospitals, were quite fit for marching.
-
-This advantage would have been lost once more by any considerable
-actions. I decided gradually to evacuate the region, in spite of its
-extraordinary fertility, and slip through the ring in which the enemy
-columns were enclosing me in the fertile district of the Malema river.
-My idea was that a small part of my troops should hold off these enemy
-columns and keep them so busy that they would think they were involved
-in a serious affair, and attack my rearguard properly. In coming to
-this decision, good service was done me by the orders of the English
-commander which had fallen into our hands. He had no intention of
-being “foxed” by us a second time, as he had been at Koriwa, and had
-therefore arranged that whenever contact was established with us at any
-point, several detachments should immediately execute a flank march
-round us at a distance of five or six English miles. I told General
-Edwards about this later on, and he was extraordinarily amused that
-this had given me an intimation of his intentions, and enabled me to
-take my counter-measures against them. It was obvious that if I only
-echeloned my troops deeply enough the enemy’s enveloping detachments
-would be placed in the greatest peril. They would find themselves
-sandwiched between my detachments and in this way could be taken by
-surprise in the flank or rear by my troops echeloned further back.
-Unfortunately the execution of this plan was only imperfect. In the
-very thick bush, however carefully one watched camp fires and the
-dust, there were too few indications to follow a column properly and
-it was very difficult for a column to keep its direction. In addition
-there were a number of factors that threw out one’s calculations,
-factors such as dense bush, marshes and water-courses. In spite of all
-these obstacles, we succeeded every now and then in taking one of the
-hostile enveloping columns by surprise and bringing it under fire.
-The inevitable difficulties of moving separate columns in the thick
-bush were even greater on the English side than on the German. When a
-collision occurred there was often a complete mix-up in which neither
-friend nor foe knew whom he had before him. On one occasion Lieutenant
-von Ruckteschell’s detachment, which had been nearest to the enemy,
-fell back on some of our troops which had been echeloned further back.
-In so doing it came across a reconnoitring party in the bush, at a
-distance of about thirty paces. This patrol was recognized as an enemy.
-The machine guns were brought into position under the nose of the enemy
-and without any interference on his part, and the patrol, which had
-taken our men for English, was fired on lustily at point-blank range
-and put to flight in a second.
-
-In the same way our own patrols continually found themselves in the
-middle of enemy troops. On one such occasion _Vizefeldwebel_ Schaffrath
-made his patrol lie down in the high grass and then opened an effective
-fire on the head of approaching enemy columns. Then he took cover
-again. In this way he succeeded in the course of a few hours in
-inflicting sensible losses on the enemy several times and capturing
-some material.
-
-I wanted to gain time by these holding actions, so that I could get
-my main body into the country further south, which was supposed to be
-fertile, according to report, and fall upon and drive away the smallish
-hostile garrisons we expected to find there. The first objective
-of this nature was the Portuguese _Boma_ Alto-Moloque. A captured
-map showed that this had been the seat of a higher administrative
-authority in peace time and the military station of a force exceeding
-a company. Both natives and food must certainly be there. Between us
-and Alto-Moloque lay the high range of Inagu. An English battalion in
-its entrenched camp at Inagu barred the road which led from the Boma
-Malema round the west side of the Inagu Mountains to Alto-Moloque.
-It was therefore probable that our advance by that road would be
-contested, and that would have been unpleasant in view of the length
-of our carrier columns. In any case we should have been delayed and
-our intended surprise attack on Alto-Moloque would have been spoilt.
-But surprise I regarded as absolutely essential, as we suspected the
-presence of ammunition and arms at Alto-Moloque.
-
-Accordingly we left the enemy in peace in his entrenchments at Inagu
-and marched round the east side of the Inagu Mountains on Alto-Moloque.
-The strategic situation was somewhat remarkable, and well described in
-the words of an old Boer, words that were not quite pure High German:
-“Is das eine Komische Orlog; ons lopt achter de Portugies an, und de
-Englanders lopt achter ons an” (_This is a funny war. We chase the
-Portuguese, and the English chase us_).
-
-We marched by native tracks or straight through the bush. Several
-considerable streams had to be negotiated on the way. This district,
-too, was fertile, and we soon came across unmistakable human tracks
-leading towards Alto-Moloque, not to mention kraals, the first I had
-ever seen. They were grass huts, very thick and carefully built. Ashes
-were smouldering in places and the heads of hens which were lying about
-were still fresh. We exchanged shots with some Portuguese patrols and a
-few rifles with ammunition were captured.
-
-No time must be lost, so Müller’s detachment, made specially mobile
-by being relieved of all its transport, went on ahead and found in
-Alto-Moloque only a few Portuguese officers and non-commissioned
-officers who were just drinking coffee on the verandah of the very fine
-European house. These were taken prisoner.
-
-I now followed slowly with the main body. Our rearguard, under
-Captain Koehl, had quite a series of little collisions, which in
-bulk caused the enemy not inconsiderable losses. One of our Askari
-patrols had been surprised and captured by a stronger enemy patrol
-when engaged in foraging for food. These Askari subsequently looked on
-while this English patrol fought quite a bloody action with another
-English detachment in the thick bush and the occurrence gave them
-their opportunity of escaping. The lack of caution which many of our
-Europeans continually showed, in spite of all warnings, caused us many
-unnecessary losses. There was one Askari, a particularly reliable and
-intelligent man, whose father, the old Effendi Plantan, had already
-been with Von Wissmann’s Zulu Askari, whom I had been only too glad to
-take with me on patrol. He never came back from some quite unnecessary
-mission on which he was sent, and was probably taken prisoner. It was a
-phenomenon common to both sides that a large part of the losses in the
-war in East Africa were unnecessary and due solely to thoughtlessness.
-
-Koehl’s detachment gradually came up with the main body, which had
-reached the Alto-Moloque-Inagu road at a European plantation which
-was well stocked with provisions. From this place it had rung up
-Alto-Moloque on the enemy’s telephone and received a reply, first from
-a Portuguese, then from Captain Müller. Müller reported that only a
-small amount of ammunition had been captured, and that the bulk must
-have been got away to the south-east just in time by several carrier
-parties. Strong patrols were immediately sent out after them.
-
-When the main body entered Alto-Moloque on June 16th we found some very
-fine and massive European houses. They were charmingly situated on a
-little hill, and had a view for miles over the neighbouring forests to
-the mighty rugged mountains in the distance. There were thousands of
-orange trees in full bloom and our coloured men immediately christened
-it the “Boma ja machungwa” (Orange _boma_).
-
-The numerous maps and documents of all kinds which were found at
-the station gave us a tolerably clear idea of the country towards
-Quelimane. We could see that there was a telegraph wire from
-Alto-Moloque to Quelimane via Ili. A large company, the Lugella
-Company, had its headquarters at the confluence of the Lugella with the
-Likungo. There were great plantations and factories and large supplies
-of food. Above all, it looked as if preparations were in progress to
-make this station a main supply depot for food and ammunition for
-considerable bodies of troops.
-
-If we wished to exploit the opportunity that this situation presented,
-our subordinate commanders would have to act very promptly and must not
-be hampered by too rigid instructions. The impression that I formed in
-my mind rested in many respects on unproved assumptions. Our pursuing
-patrols must be able to act according to circumstances independently
-and rapidly if that original impression was not confirmed subsequently.
-Time must not be lost, or the enemy would be able to get his supplies
-away in time. He would have the advantage of a railway which began not
-far south of the Lugella Company’s station and led south to the river
-Namacurra, as well as the steamer which plied on that stream.
-
-As so often happens, our pursuing patrols and companies were
-occasionally found wanting in some respects. Yet it must not be
-forgotten that besides many other qualities a very mature tactical
-judgment is required to give an independent decision on the question
-when the very exhausting pursuit of a fleeing foe is to be continued
-at top pressure or should be broken off. To exploit the promising
-situation to the greatest possible extent, on the very day of my
-arrival at Alto-Moloque I had sent in pursuit the whole of Müller’s
-detachment, which I had hitherto kept by me. In the course of various
-patrols and raids in the neighbourhood we caught individual Portuguese
-Askari who in many cases had set up off their own bats as little
-tyrants in the villages of the district. The natives reported their
-presence to us.
-
-The region of Alto-Moloque turned out to be very fertile, as we
-anticipated. We were therefore in a position to give Müller’s
-detachment a greater start in following up the enemy. One of the
-patrols of this detachment had captured a hostile supply depot near
-Ili. An enemy carrier column, turned off by an Anglo-Portuguese
-detachment which was now several days’ march east of Alto-Moloque, and
-trying to pass through Alto-Moloque in ignorance of our presence, was
-a welcome acquisition to our Intendant, who needed it to carry the
-supplies captured at Ili. Unfortunately this intended removal succeeded
-only partially, for a fresh English detachment appeared at Ili,
-apparently from the direction of Inagu, and drove off our patrols.
-
-The advance of our main body on Ili was contested by considerable
-hostile patrols which were approaching the Alto-Moloque-Ili road from
-the north. One of these patrols was immediately pursued energetically
-and attacked in its camp, but I gained the impression that larger enemy
-forces were advancing on us from the north of Ili and Alto-Moloque.
-I had no intention of delaying, but wished rather to join up as
-soon as possible with Müller’s detachment, which was on its way to
-Lugella. Accordingly I marched south, skirting Ili and occupied the
-Portuguese post of Nampepo. In this district, at about a day’s march
-from each other, the Portuguese companies had established a number of
-clean, well-arranged stations around which lay the fields, which they
-cultivated. A whole series of these posts and their field-depots fell
-into our hands during the march. Nampepo was one of them, only larger
-than usual, and the centre of an extraordinarily fertile district. A
-special feature of the Nampepo camp was our chase after domestic pigs.
-Large numbers of these were running loose in the bush, so that we had
-excellent sausages to eat, as well as roast pork and brawn. A German
-planter named Hauter, from the district of Morogoro, who had delivered
-large supplies of sausages to Morogoro during the war, had acquired
-expert skill in preparing them, and this now came in very useful. He
-now had the insides of pigs to practise on instead of the insides of
-cows, and our enjoyment of this unwonted luxury was so great that we
-did not allow ourselves to be disturbed even by the shots that fell
-into our camp.
-
-For as a matter of fact a considerable enemy column from the north
-was approaching the station of Nampepo, which was held by Captain
-Spangenberg with our outposts. From the commanding ground the approach
-of a large enemy column could be noted quite easily. As a particularly
-favourable opportunity for attacking it presented itself we did not
-disturb the enemy in his approach. However, contrary to expectation, he
-did not attack us. Pillars of smoke arising from the bush about 1,500
-yards away showed us that he had encamped there. Our patrols which went
-round the enemy crawled up to his camp at night and fired into it.
-Koehl’s detachment had come up meanwhile and I marched off with the
-main body to follow Müller’s detachment in the direction of Lugella.
-Captain Spangenberg remained with our rearguard in touch with the
-enemy, and then followed us at a distance of a day’s march.
-
-Meanwhile Captain Müller’s detachment had succeeded in crossing the
-Likungo river, near the confluence of the Lugella, at a ford. It
-had been able to give an apparently severe drubbing to a Portuguese
-battalion which had rushed up from the south to protect it. Several
-machine guns were captured. The great depot of the Lugella Company fell
-into our hands. It was possible to distribute a large amount of food
-and clothing. The buildings themselves, which had been adapted for
-defence, and about 300,000 kilograms of food were burnt.
-
-As no other remunerative objective presented itself Captain Müller
-considered he had fulfilled his mission for the time being, retired to
-the southern bank of the Likungo and there awaited my arrival.
-
-I was afraid that our wonderful captures of the last few weeks would
-tempt some of our Europeans to help themselves to things improperly,
-and I took advantage of the occasion to point out the evils of such
-behaviour. It must not be forgotten that war booty belongs to the
-State, and that the individual soldier has to notify to his superiors
-if he happens to want any particular object he has captured. An
-estimate is then made of the value of the object and he has to pay the
-amount. It was important for me to maintain the _moral_ of our troops
-unconditionally if I was to be able to appeal to their sense of honour
-and make calls on their endurance.
-
-A certain amount of ammunition was captured here and there, and,
-further, a small Portuguese gun had fallen into our hands, but the
-great haul of cartridges for which we had hoped and striven had not
-materialized. I thought it extremely doubtful whether there ever had
-been such large stocks at Alto-Moloque and Ili, and suspected that the
-whole thing was a case of exaggeration of the approved native type.
-That did not imply evil intentions on the part of those concerned. On
-the contrary, the natives were well-disposed towards us. For example,
-they brought back of their own accord one of our captured Portuguese
-officers who had escaped. They also brought us some German black boys
-who had been enjoying themselves looting, and had been caught and well
-beaten by the natives, excusing themselves on the ground that they had
-taken them for Portuguese!
-
-It is an extremely difficult matter even for a European to estimate,
-for example, the numerical strength of a detachment on the march. The
-native finds it much more difficult, especially when it comes to larger
-numbers. The words he so frequently uses, _mingi_ (much) or _kama
-majani_ (as thick as grass) can mean 50 just as well as 5,000.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IV
-
-ON TO THE SOUTH
-
-
-HOWEVER, wherever these large ammunition depots might be, they had
-certainly not fallen into our hands. We had to start out on the search
-again. The whole strategic situation, as well as the documents we
-captured, showed that they _must_ be somewhere in this region. There
-was a high degree of probability that the more considerable stocks,
-whose existence we suspected, were further south, either because they
-had been there from the start or because they had been moved there as a
-result of our approach. It seemed likely that before long they would be
-transported to the coast and transferred to ships, in case of emergency.
-
-During our march considerable patrols had reconnoitred the region
-within a radius of a day’s march, and captured a few small enemy food
-depots, but no arms or ammunition. Müller’s detachment, with which
-we had joined up at Mujeba on June 27th, marched further south again
-the same day. The natives told us of a large _boma_ at Origa, which
-was said to be somewhere further south, near the coast, and to have
-large ammunition supplies. Müller’s party was to find this _boma_. Our
-directions were thoroughly inaccurate, as usual. I was quite certain
-that on the march other and conflicting reports would infallibly
-arrive. Unfortunately we had not a long time in which to test the
-intelligence that came in. All we could do was to trust that it
-contained at least an element of truth.
-
-As the situation demanded, Captain Müller was given the greatest
-freedom of action. If any promising objective presented itself during
-his march, he was to decide without hesitation what his best course
-was. I would bring up our main body and intervene unconditionally
-in his support, and, in any case, I would accept the situation he
-had created. The main thing was that he should not wait for special
-orders and instructions. I realized that in acting thus I was in a
-large measure placing the conduct of our operations in the hands of a
-subordinate commander. It was only possible because that subordinate
-commander possessed a very sound, tactical judgment and great
-initiative.
-
-Our leading troops, with their three weak companies, had to perform the
-double function of cavalry sent out far and wide to reconnoitre, and
-that of an advance guard led with the greatest energy. In any other
-circumstances I should have been with the advance guard myself, in
-view of its important task, so that I could have a surer hold on the
-course of operations. Experience had taught me, however, that in view
-of the distance between our columns, my presence with the main body was
-indispensable, both to overcome obstacles quickly and to be able to
-act in face of some unforeseen change in the situation. It must not be
-forgotten that our whole advance was based on combination, and that, as
-actually happened often enough, the unsuspected appearance of hostile
-detachments from some other direction transformed the situation at a
-blow and made fresh dispositions necessary.
-
-Accordingly we marched by small native tracks or right through the
-bush in single file. Owing to the great length of our columns, on a
-day’s march of nineteen miles or so the head had to start off in the
-dark—about 5 a.m.—if the tail was to reach the camp appointed the
-same day, that is, late in the evening and just before darkness fell.
-It was inevitable, because camping material had to be procured, wood
-to be chopped, grass to be cut and shelters to be built, in case of
-need, for the sick. For that reason our whole force could not march
-concentrated. It was much too extended. Müller’s detachment, forming
-the advance guard, marched one or two days’ march ahead. The rearguard,
-Spangenberg’s detachment, followed the main body at a distance of about
-a day’s march. Communication was maintained by means of runners.
-
-In the reports which reached us by the runners of Müller’s detachment,
-the name “Kokosani” was now perpetually recurring. Considerable enemy
-depots, strongly protected by hostile troops, were to be found there,
-so it was said. But where was this Kokosani? The word could not be
-found on our maps. It gradually came to light that Kokosani was the
-same place that figured on Portuguese maps as Namacurra. In any case,
-all our previous intelligence, as well as a glance at the situation on
-the map, showed that Kokosani must be our most promising objective. We
-had no means of knowing whether it would be possible to capture this
-place, probably very strongly fortified, with our relatively limited
-resources. Only the attempt itself could enlighten us on that point.
-Captain Müller had turned west towards the place independently. On the
-way it became clear that, as the natives had told us, there actually
-was a ford over the river Likungo.
-
-I now marched on quickly with our main body, in order to join up,
-and gave orders to the same effect to our rearguard under Captain
-Spangenberg. In the afternoon of July 1st, the main force reached the
-Likungo and immediately crossed it. The water of this great river, more
-than four hundred yards wide, came up to our necks at the deepest parts
-of the ford. It took each man about an hour to cross. When the troops
-had successfully reached the western bank, we bivouacked, and next
-morning continued our march in the tracks of Müller’s detachment ahead.
-
-On the way some thirty natives met us. They had worked in Kokosani,
-and told us that a large number of Portuguese and Askari were
-encamped there, and that a number of chests had arrived. We had to
-employ interpreters in our talk with these men, as they did not know
-Kisuaheli. Several of our Askari were masters of the local tongue or
-related dialects.
-
-Before long we received an important report from the advance guard. On
-the previous day Captain Müller had completely surprised the enemy at
-Kokosani by an encircling move. Marching on the factory buildings from
-the north in broad daylight, through a field of knee-high agaves and
-without any cover, he had succeeded in getting into the Portuguese
-entrenchments and, in several hours of very severe hand-to-hand
-fighting, defeating the three Portuguese companies holding them, with
-very heavy losses to the enemy. In the course of the action a number of
-rifles, as well as two field guns with their ammunition, were captured.
-
-I myself went on a little ahead of our main body, and in the morning
-came across several extensive and well-arranged plantations. Next
-I followed the track of a field railway, which ran along the main
-road right through the fields, and after a short time joined up with
-a standard-gauge line. As was to appear later, the latter led from
-the river Namacurra northwards to the neighbourhood of Lugella. When
-Captain Müller struck this standard-gauge line the day before, he held
-up a train which had just come from Lugella. It is easy to realize the
-mutual amazement when there descended from the train several Portuguese
-non-commissioned officers whom Müller had captured at Lugella and
-released again.
-
-When I reached the factory buildings, Captain Müller came limping up to
-me, pretty lame. He expressed his astonishment that I had brought my
-detachment direct to Kokosani by the main road and without opposition,
-for he thought that there must be quite two English companies somewhere
-in the neighbourhood. He had not yet been able to ascertain their
-whereabouts, but documents which Captain Müller had captured pointed
-conclusively to their presence in the district. Müller also told
-me that he had not yet found the considerable quantity of infantry
-cartridges. All his people were still busy trying to find them and
-anything similar.
-
-When I considered the matter more closely, it seemed to me more
-probable that the ammunition stores we were hunting for would not
-be near the factory, but must be somewhere directly on the railway,
-and, indeed, at its southern terminus. That was the place for a large
-ammunition depot, for it must be the unloading point where the stuff
-was transferred to rail from ships on the Namacurra. We had to find out
-whether these deductions were sound. I went back immediately and met
-the leading files of our main body among the plantations. The leading
-companies were anything but pleased to have to retrace their steps in
-order to follow the standard-gauge railway southwards. After the long,
-tiring march a few complimentary remarks about my arrangements were
-comprehensible enough. Fortunately for me, I did not hear them.
-
-It was in a rather bad humour that the men at the head of the column
-arrived in the neighbourhood of the railway-station. They did not
-seriously believe in the possibility of a fight. It was upon them
-suddenly, however, and several Askari were struck by hostile bullets
-at quite short range and fell. The rest of our main force, which was
-near at hand and ready for action, was brought up. When I arrived, the
-situation was not at all clear; the enemy was obviously entrenched and
-closer reconnaissance was in progress. An indecisive exchange of shots
-now developed. It began to rain and was unpleasantly cold, so that
-everyone felt thoroughly uncomfortable. I myself went to Lieutenant von
-Ruckteschell’s company, which was lying opposite to and about ninety
-yards from the corrugated-iron buildings of the station and directing
-a well-aimed rifle and machine-gun fire from some high ant-hills every
-time anything showed.
-
-I considered that the situation at the moment was unfavourable to
-storming the station. We would have been compelled to rush at the
-enemy’s position through the thick bush, which was commanded by a most
-effective hostile fire. That offered but little prospect of success. A
-number of our men would probably not have joined in the rush at all,
-and those who did and got close to the enemy’s fortress would probably
-have been held up and found themselves unable to get on. We should,
-therefore, achieve nothing.
-
-On the other hand, my reconnaissance had brought the idea to my mind
-that on targets, some of which were very visible, artillery fire would
-be effective, especially from two sides. It would frighten the enemy’s
-Askari and make them run away. That would be a favourable moment for
-good machine-gun fire. But the day was already too far advanced, and
-our gun was smashed, so that nothing definite could be ventured on for
-that day. The larger portion of the troops retired to our camp, and
-only three companies of Captain Poppe’s detachment remained in close
-contact with the enemy.
-
-The next day, July 3rd, we got our gun into working order again, after
-strenuous efforts. As luck would have it, it was of the same model
-as the guns Captain Müller had captured, and so, by interchanging
-the individual serviceable parts of these three guns, we produced a
-field-piece fit for use. There was thus a prospect of putting to good
-use the two hundred rounds we had captured two days before. In the
-afternoon the gun was to be brought up to within a few hundred yards
-of the station, and open fire upon it. Another smaller, 4-cm., gun was
-ready in the foremost infantry line—and therefore about a hundred and
-twenty-five yards off—to start a cross fire. All our machine guns were
-held ready. In the morning I had been to the factory buildings again
-for a conference, and had told the civilian personnel there they need
-not get frightened if they heard the sound of firing in the afternoon.
-The white women and children had been very frightened by the fighting,
-and some of them had fled into the bush.
-
-I had gone back to our camp, extremely tired, when the sound of
-fighting at the station suddenly made itself heard. We received a
-telephone report that loud yells and cries of “hurrah” could be
-heard coming from the station. By degrees the following facts were
-established: the enemy was apparently tired of the well-aimed,
-concentric fire which had been directed at them since the afternoon.
-They were now being subjected to artillery fire from two sides at once,
-and the moment there was the slightest movement machine guns opened on
-them. Their young troops could not stand it, and were very restless.
-Our companies recognized that this was their weak moment and used it
-immediately, showing splendid initiative. They leaped up with loud
-hurrahs, and the next minute were in the enemy’s position. The enemy
-began to run away. The English maintained that they had been infected
-by the example of the Portuguese. However that may be, they ran away
-and our companies immediately went after them as hard as they could.
-Our flying foes reached the river Namacurra, which ran immediately
-behind their position, quickly pulled off their boots and dashed into
-the water. Here most of the hostile troops were drowned, including
-their commander, Major Gore-Brown.
-
-Between July 1st and 3rd the enemy had 5 Europeans and 100 Askari
-killed, 4 Europeans and about 100 Askari drowned, while 421 Askari
-were taken prisoner. Of the Europeans (5 English and 117 Portuguese)
-who also fell into our hands, 55 Portuguese escaped and 46 sick and
-wounded Portuguese were left behind in the hospital at Kokosani. We had
-8 Askari and 1 machine-gun carrier killed, 3 Europeans, 11 Askari and
-2 machine-gun carriers wounded. At first it was quite impossible to
-estimate, even approximately, what amount of ammunition and food we had
-captured at the station. Seven heavy, 3 light machine guns and 2 guns
-had fallen into our hands, but these 2 guns had been rendered useless.
-
-More and more cases of captured ammunition were brought into our camp.
-The Intendant, Lieutenant Besch (retired naval officer), was in despair
-because he did not know where he was going to get enough carriers to
-remove such vast stores. They included more than 300,000 kilograms of
-food and the stocks from the Kokosani sugar factory. The amount of
-booty enabled all our coloured men to receive as much clothing material
-as they wanted, and my boy, Serubili, said to me: “This is a very
-different matter to Tanga; we’re all getting as much sugar as we want
-now.”
-
-It is a fact that the whole camp was littered with sugar. Each of the
-blacks was so well-off for food and clothing of all kinds that they
-stopped stealing, as if by word of command. Everyone knows what that
-means where blacks are concerned.
-
-The booty included large quantities of European food and preserves.
-Every European found himself well provided for for months ahead.
-Unfortunately it was not possible for us to get away the whole stock
-of excellent wine we had captured. After a sufficient quantity had
-been set aside as a restorative for the sick, the rest had mainly to
-be drunk on the spot. The risk of a wholesale “jollification” _that_
-involved was gladly taken, and everyone was allowed to let himself go
-for once, after his long abstinence.
-
-In addition there was some fine schnapps in a large number of casks in
-the Kokosani factory. These were being stored ready for the English
-troops. With the best will in the world it was impossible to drink it
-all, so we had to empty a large number of the casks into the Namacurra.
-
-Column after column of carriers arrived in the camp with booty, and
-the Intendant became more and more desperate. Affairs reached a climax
-when a telephone message came from the station that a river-steamer
-had arrived. An English medical officer, all unsuspecting of what had
-happened at Namacurra, disembarked from it and closer examination
-of the boat revealed the presence of a considerable consignment of
-cartridges, exceeding three hundred cases.
-
-In all we had captured about three hundred and fifty modern English and
-Portuguese rifles, a welcome addition to our resources, which brought
-our armament once more up to requirements. We were able to discard our
-’71 pattern rifle almost entirely.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER V
-
-BACK NORTH TO THE NAMACURRA RIVER
-
-
-IN face of the enemy’s orders we had captured I had to anticipate
-that within a short time comparatively strong hostile forces would be
-coming from Quelimane to attack us. The country between the Namacurra
-and the Zambesi, however, offered a large number of river barriers,
-so that a march to the Zambesi would be full of difficulties for us
-and hinder our freedom of movement to an extraordinary degree. Equally
-unfavourable for campaigning, from our point of view, was the country
-south and south-west of our present halting-place. In the last resort
-we should find ourselves cooped up on the Zambesi without being in a
-position to effect a crossing of that mighty river which was commanded
-by the enemy’s gun-boats.
-
-I thought it better to abandon our previous march direction. Yet in
-view of the total absence of news it was very difficult to say where
-I ought to make for. Only one thing appeared to be clear—that the
-enemy was not directly on our heels. At any rate our rearguard and the
-patrols they had sent out behind them were not being pressed at all by
-the enemy. It seemed probable that if hostile bodies were following
-us at all they were engaged in trying to overhaul us on some route
-parallel to that we had taken. If I were right in that view—and it
-seemed to be confirmed by such reports as the natives brought in—we
-could assume that the enemy was insufficiently informed of our presence
-at Namacurra and further that the Portuguese soldiers among our
-prisoners whom we had turned off could give him no clear or trustworthy
-information.
-
-We had, therefore, to devote all our efforts to making those fellows
-believe we intended to fortify and put up a stiff defence of Namacurra
-and, further, that we had our eye on Quelimane.
-
-The unexpected disaster at Namacurra was bound to speed the steps of
-the pursuing enemy. It was probable that his columns, advancing on a
-parallel line to us, would overshoot the mark, especially as they must
-be anxious about the important port of Quelimane. I therefore decided
-to wait at Namacurra until the pursuing enemy columns had actually
-shot ahead of me and then turn about to the north-east. What chiefly
-influenced me in this decision was that a march in this direction,
-leading towards Mozambique, on the main line of communication, would
-cause the enemy anxiety, and as soon as he became aware of it he would
-at once turn about to protect the neighbourhood of Mozambique with
-its wealth of stores. If he did not do so we should have a free hand
-at Mozambique. As the position would then develop the enemy would be
-forced to undertake marches that would exhaust his troops, while we
-gained time to recuperate our strength and allow our sick and wounded
-to recover.
-
-It was difficult to decide on the most favourable moment for our change
-of direction north-east; we should have to rely to some extent on the
-fortune of war. Even if I made the movement too soon and encountered
-one of the enemy columns there was always a chance of defeating it when
-cut off from the rest. The first thing, however, was to get safely
-across the Likungo river again. The available information as to the
-fords was very unreliable. In order not to use the same fords as before
-I marched with my main body on the evening of 4th July to a crossing
-further to the south. Lieutenant Ott, however, ascertained by personal
-reconnaissance that no ford existed at the place of which we had been
-informed. On the other hand, it was apparent from native information as
-well as from tracks discovered that on the same day an English patrol
-had halted in this neighbourhood. The position might become awkward. In
-order to lose no time in investigation I marched along the west bank
-of the Likungo to our previous ford. Unfortunately I had withdrawn the
-covering force that had hitherto been left there and I did not know
-whether it was free. I was therefore very relieved when on 5th July the
-crossing was effected without further interference. Koehl’s detachment
-was still at Namacurra and followed as rearguard.
-
-When we were again marching as a single column through the bush,
-the great length of the column was unwieldy and, in the event of an
-encounter with the enemy, would be a source of danger. We therefore
-tried to shorten the column and to march in two, and later in several
-parallel columns through the bush. The disadvantage of this arrangement
-was that instead of one head of a column having to cut a way through
-the bush this had now to be done by several. But the advantages of the
-shorter length outweighed this disadvantage.
-
-Information from our patrols and from the natives indicated that the
-march of the enemy columns to the south-west had not been pressed so
-far as I had anticipated. Enemy troops were reported both between
-the Moniga and the lower Likungo and also at Mujebain; in some cases
-they were ascertained to be marching south-west. This brought about
-the extraordinary situation that the enemy troops were marching in
-several columns south-west while we were passing between these columns
-in the contrary direction, north-east. This fact could not long
-remain hidden from the enemy, especially as the patrols soon began
-to come in contact, and the enemy troops, marching along the line
-of telephone communication from Mulevalla to Murubella, crossed our
-track. We continued our march to Oriva, threw back a weak Portuguese
-detachment west of this place, and occupied Oriva itself on 14th
-July. Unfortunately the abundant stores of supplies and ammunition
-that we had expected to find at this station were not forthcoming;
-apparently either the numerous enemy troops had drawn heavily on the
-resources of the neighbourhood or the stores that had been originally
-left here had already been removed. A small patrol, sent out to
-Muatama under Sergeant-Major Hüttich, succeeded in surprising a small
-mixed detachment of English and Portuguese; as it was unfortunately
-impossible to get away the supplies found in this station the stores
-had to be burned.
-
-Meanwhile our attempts to get information from the natives as to the
-whereabouts of supplies met with no success; it was impossible to wait
-for the reports of other patrols dispatched to Murua in search of
-supplies. Various patrol actions showed us that the enemy had meanwhile
-become aware of the change in the situation and had accordingly turned
-his columns about. Want of supplies forced us to continue our march,
-and the attack of a mixed Portuguese-English column on our rearguard
-under Captain Koehl could not be developed into a complete success
-as our main force was already on the march. We halted for a few days
-in the tolerably fertile territory between Oriva and Murua. Captured
-papers showed us that an English patrol had closely observed our
-movements.
-
-It was interesting to notice that the English prisoners whom we
-took with us, for the most part, accepted as a matter of course the
-hardships of the long marches, the constant crossing of rivers and the
-countless difficulties connected with supplies and transport; they
-realized that we Germans had exactly the same hardships to endure as
-themselves and were in addition burdened with a number of further
-duties such as patrol expeditions, fighting, carrying of supplies
-and watch-keeping. They bore everything with a certain humour and
-it was obviously interesting to them to see the war from the German
-point of view. It was quite otherwise with the Portuguese officers.
-It is true they were in an unenviable position: for the most part
-they were infected with syphilis and were carefully avoided by the
-English prisoners. In addition they were not real campaigners. They
-had received a generous share of the booty captured at Namacurra, but
-had not learned how to make the best of it. They had at once consumed
-the precious oil with rice and it was too much to expect that the
-Germans should now share with them their own meagre ration. Marching
-was a burden to them, their boots were torn to pieces—in short,
-their spokesman, the general staff officer captured at Namacurra, was
-continually complaining to me of the inconveniences which with the best
-will in the world I could not help. He was continually asking to be
-released. I should have been only too glad to consent if he would have
-given his parole not to fight against us, but this he would not do. I
-could not be expected to release people without any obligation and so
-put them in a position to attack us again immediately.
-
-Considerations of supply drove us on. After the failure of the Oriva
-neighbourhood to come up to our expectations in this respect, I planned
-to reach the territory east of the Ligonja, which was marked on the
-map as thickly populated and well cultivated. On the way the advance
-guard, under Captain Müller, quickly took Boma Tipa, where several
-days’ supplies, particularly pig-nuts, fell into our hands. The weak
-Portuguese garrison offered only slight resistance and then fled at
-once; the leader, a Portuguese sergeant, was the only prisoner captured.
-
-We had reached a high degree of efficiency in the rapid and systematic
-distribution of booty; the main force hardly lost a day’s march and I
-can still see the approving smile of one of the English prisoners who
-seemed to have entirely forgotten that the Portuguese were his allies.
-Apparently it amused them to see with what little ceremony we took from
-them their depots one after the other, together with their supplies.
-The captured enemy papers repeatedly gave us valuable information.
-Two days’ march from Tipa lay another _boma_ called Namirrue, where
-the Portuguese garrison had been strengthened by an English company.
-Apparently considerable stores lay here. At any rate, according to
-information, supply columns had been sent to replenish at Namirrue.
-The English troops there probably belonged to an enemy force newly
-appeared from the direction of Mozambique. It was impossible for the
-enemy force to which we had hitherto been opposed, and which had taken
-part in the general march south-west north-east, to have established
-such a lead on us. Accordingly the advance guard with our gun at once
-marched on Namirrue (the smaller gun had been put out of action at
-Namacurra and left behind after firing its few cartridges). Captain
-Müller was instructed to reconnoitre the position at Namirrue and act
-independently as might be required. For the time being the main force
-remained at Tipa, on the east bank of the Moloque. It was to obtain
-supplies and hold up the enemy advancing from the south-west long
-enough to allow Captain Müller the necessary time at Namirrue. It was
-not long before small enemy reconnoitring forces appeared at Tipa, or
-the west bank of the Ligonja, which at this point offers no obstacle
-worth mentioning. There was a series of unimportant patrol engagements
-on the east bank also. The rearguard, under Captain Koehl, carried out
-a number of delaying actions at places along the Tipa-Namirrue road
-which for the most part have already been mentioned. As I was not clear
-whether the main force would find the best opportunity to attack in
-Koehl’s position or at Namirrue I began by following cautiously with
-him Müller’s detachment. The report then came in from Captain Müller
-that an enemy force of some two companies was entrenched on the heights
-at Namirrue and that he could not get at them even with his gun. On
-the other hand, he reported that in all probability English troops
-would come to the support of the enemy from the north or north-west.
-There was a favourable opportunity for us to defeat these troops in
-the open. I therefore marched the main force to Namirrue and on the
-22nd July crossed the Namirrue river, about three miles above the rocky
-hill occupied by the enemy. Camp was pitched on the east bank and
-immediately there were patrol engagements. I myself, with Lieutenant
-Besch, made a detour of the hill to join Captain Müller, who was
-encamped immediately south-east of it. The enemy position had been
-encircled with patrols and machine guns. On the heights above several
-horses could be seen and, here and there, men too. Wherever a target
-offered the enemy was fired on to prevent him from sending down men to
-fetch water. It appeared, however, that the enemy must have been able
-to keep himself supplied with water from a source unknown to us.
-
-After drinking a cup of coffee with Captain Müller we went further
-round the hill and came upon Lieutenant Kempner and other patrols,
-keenly engaged on reconnoitring work. In order to keep under cover we
-had to work our way partly through the thick bush and came on large
-quantities of cow-itch: contact with this plant produces an intolerable
-irritation of the skin. We were just in the middle of a thicket of
-this plant when we heard lively firing from the camp of our main
-force. At the same time the enemy in the hill fired several salvoes,
-apparently as a signal to their friends. I was immediately convinced
-that a not very strong enemy detachment was approaching which was
-unaware of the arrival of our main force. I was seized with the desire
-to use this rare opportunity at once with my full strength. I tried
-with all haste to get to the main force, but the cow-itch hampered my
-progress and the irritation was maddening. Eventually we reached the
-camp before dark. My second in command, Major Kraut, had begun the
-attack with small forces. In the bright moonlight I could still hope
-to use the approaching night for a successful battle. All available
-forces, with the exception of a company left to protect the camp, were
-at once prepared for action. On the left wing, Captain Goering, who
-was to undertake an enveloping movement, took his force round to a
-position in the rear of the enemy. There he heard the barking of a dog,
-ran forward at once and found the English commanding officer, Colonel
-Dickinson, with his adjutant and a medical officer, telephoning in a
-ravine and took them prisoner. Captain Goering at once attacked and the
-detachments of Captains Spangenberg and Poppe, in front and on the left
-wing, did the same. In a very short time the enemy, consisting of one
-battalion, was completely overwhelmed and routed. All the detachments
-engaged in a hot pursuit, but in the darkness and the thick bush touch
-was lost with the enemy.
-
-It turned out later that the enemy’s troops marching parallel with us
-had crossed the Namirrue at the same time a little further upstream.
-In view of the constantly changing situation, due to the continuous
-movement of the forces and the impenetrable screen of the bush which
-made it impossible to see far in any direction, and also owing to the
-large number of his marching columns, it was quite impossible for the
-enemy, in spite of the unremitting labours of his wireless service,
-to obtain a clear picture of the situation as a whole and to keep
-his subordinate leaders informed in time of all the changes of the
-situation. In this case a column had become detached and had run upon
-us with only a part of its strength: only one battalion had crossed the
-river. In an exposed and very dangerous position this battalion had
-been badly handled by our main force.
-
-A company detailed for the further pursuit of the retreating enemy
-returned the following day without having achieved anything more; here,
-again, after such a favourable action the subordinate leaders and the
-troops themselves could only with difficulty be persuaded to throw
-themselves in to the last ounce to wring every possible advantage from
-their success. Lieutenant Schroetter, who then for several days carried
-on the pursuit in a manner in keeping with the situation, was unable
-to effect more than a few patrol skirmishes. The enemy had, in the
-meantime, gained too great a start. No information was obtained except
-as to the very hurried flight of the enemy.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. xix. The Action at Namirruë, July 23, 1918.]
-
-I, with the main part of my forces, stood my ground. The full
-exploitation of the success lay less in the pursuit of the beaten enemy
-than in the chances offered by the situation of the enemy we were
-surrounding on the hill, now that the help intended was for the moment
-unavailable.
-
-For the first time in this campaign we had captured a trench-mortar
-with ammunition. The various parts were collected on the field of
-action and the seventeen rounds of ammunition made ready for firing.
-Experiments made with practice ammunition gave satisfactory results,
-and we were able to arrange for the bombardment of the enemy among the
-rocks at four o’clock in the afternoon. The command of this attack
-was entrusted to Captain Müller, whose detachment had not taken part
-in the fighting on the previous day and had known nothing about it.
-To this detachment was added Lieutenant von Ruckteschell’s, which had
-remained in the camp. The trench-mortar was placed in position on one
-side of the hill, the gun on the other; our machine-guns were disposed
-round the hill in readiness for the attack. At 3.45 Lieutenant von
-Ruckteschell took leave of the English Colonel Dickinson, who had been
-placed in his charge, saying that he expected to be back in an hour. At
-4 o’clock the first round from our trench-mortar burst in the centre of
-the enemy’s position. The enemy commander was just considering whether
-he should make a sortie during the night. In a moment the hill burst
-into life: everywhere men could be seen running up and down the rocks.
-They were brought under the fire of our gun and machine guns. Very soon
-the enemy showed the white flag, but continued to fire.
-
-Lieutenant von Ruckteschell returned to his guest as he had promised,
-an hour later, but unfortunately with a shattered leg. His orderly who,
-when he was wounded, had tried to carry him out of the fight, was shot
-down under him. Meanwhile Captain Müller had climbed the hill from
-the other side and stormed the camp. It was occupied by a squadron of
-mounted infantry of the Gold Coast Regiment of whom hardly one came
-out alive. Even the horses were killed almost without exception. On
-our side brave Lieutenant Selke was killed by an enemy bullet shortly
-before the storming of the camp. He was buried on the battlefield. The
-_matériel_ captured was small, but the two days of fighting had cost
-the enemy heavy losses in men. His detachments, which were numerically
-hardly less strong than our own, were literally annihilated. Here, as
-at Namacurra, it turned out that the English had conscripted black
-troops from German East Africa into their fighting force, including a
-considerable number of old German Askari.
-
-Our thorough work at Namirrue had been made possible by Koehl’s
-detachment, consisting only of three companies, which had kept us free
-from interference. This detachment had fallen back gradually from
-Tipa on Namirrue, daily fighting rearguard actions with the enemy who
-was pressing on with all his strength. They were now within half a
-day’s march of Namirrue and I ordered them across to the east bank
-of the Namirrue river. Patrols sent out to reconnoitre had meanwhile
-learned from the natives that there was an enemy depot with a garrison
-at Pekera. This seemed to me very probable, as Pekera lies in the
-thickly populated area east of the Ligonja river, said to be a fertile
-district. Our expectations were realized when after two days’ march
-we arrived at Pekera. The mounted squadron of the Gold Coast Regiment
-stationed there was at once destroyed and several motors were captured.
-In the same way we quickly took possession of the Boma of Chalau and
-a number of other stations where the Portuguese had stored large
-quantities of supplies, particularly pig-nuts. Our patrols advanced as
-far as Angoche and in a very short time we were masters of the wide
-and exceptionally fertile district. One night some of the Portuguese
-officer prisoners escaped and succeeded in joining the enemy troops at
-Angoche. Apparently there were among these gentlemen some who knew the
-country well by reason of their occupations in peace.
-
-The period of rest during our stay in the Chalau district made it
-possible for our sick and wounded, who had been brought with us on the
-long marches, to recover; the fit, too, benefited by the respite. All
-had suffered more or less from the uninterrupted marching and exertions
-they had just gone through. It was noteworthy how the recent successes
-brought out the warlike spirit of the bearers, who were for the most
-part a very sound and reliable lot of men. A large number offered their
-services as Askari. Even my old cook was not disinclined to take up
-arms.
-
-On 5th of August supplies began to run short and there remained as
-our chief article of diet only the still bitter _muhogo_. Several
-enemy patrols approaching us from the north-east showed me that the
-enemy columns following us from the south-west had actually overtaken
-us during our halt and were concentrating for an attack at Wamaka,
-north-east of our camp.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VI
-
-BACK TO THE LURIO RIVER
-
-
-IN order to confirm the enemy in his mistake as to our objective I
-marched on 7th August along the road to Wamaka and pitched my camp
-three hours’ march north-east of Chalau, in a good supply area. Several
-enemy patrols were driven off. From Wamaka an enemy officer appeared
-with a flag of truce to announce that the English Commander-in-Chief
-would like to arrange for an exchange of medical prisoners. He was also
-instructed to inform me as to when and where equipment for the English
-prisoners could be handed over to us. These very transparent proposals
-showed me that the enemy had something serious in hand from the north
-and was trying to make his task easier by enticing me into a trap.
-Various enemy spies were captured and confirmed my belief. Their report
-that the enemy intended to attack in three columns was in accordance
-with the usual plan of such undertakings.
-
-When several patrol and outpost actions on 10th and 11th August
-indicated that a strong enemy column was advancing along the
-Wamaka-Chalau road, I assumed that at least one other column would
-be marching parallel with this further south; their objective was
-obviously Chalau. I decided to engage this southern enemy column by
-itself. The prospect of the success of my plan was certainly not great,
-as the enemy was marching for the most part through the bush, avoiding
-the paths. To meet such a development of the situation I had had a
-path reconnoitred and marked. In spite of this our march, begun in
-the evening of 11th August, lasted through the whole night. Not until
-daybreak did we arrive east of Chalau at the place I had selected.
-Strong patrols, among them a whole company under Captain Koehl, were
-still on the march.
-
-My general idea was a march west to enable me to turn either to the
-Blantyre district or east of Lake Nyassa. Without any hindrance from
-the enemy we crossed the Ligonja at Metil and the Tipa-Namirrue road.
-There the grave of an officer of the 1st battalion 2nd King’s African
-Rifles proved that the enemy column, which had first followed us
-from Tipa to Namirrue, had gone round us to the north to Wamaka: for
-this 1st battalion 2nd King’s African Rifles belonged to the force
-which was now approaching from Wamaka. On the further march to Ili
-we passed through the camps of the enemy forces which had come from
-the south-west and had continued their march in the direction of
-Alto-Moloque. They too had made a wide détour and had accomplished
-correspondingly long marches. It was strange that all these enemy
-columns should suddenly display such a high degree of mobility; they
-had changed their supply system and, partially at any rate, left
-their lines of communication. According to the reports of prisoners
-they sent requisitioning parties on ahead to commandeer supplies
-from the natives, which were then distributed among the troops. This
-requisitioning of supplies seems to have been carried out with great
-ruthlessness. The confidence which the natives had shown during our
-recent stay in the Ili district had vanished. They now saw an enemy in
-every Askari and individual men who were left behind were on several
-occasions attacked by the natives.
-
-When we came to Ili, the English telegraphic station situated there
-was quickly captured. The papers found there gave useful information
-as to the movements of the enemy troops. According to this there were
-considerable stores at Numarroe and Regone; strong forces were to try
-to overtake us from Alto-Moloque and Mukubi, while one column followed
-immediately on our track. The enemy, who up to a short time back had
-been groping in the dark, had apparently received, a few days before,
-reliable information as to our movements. It was very difficult to find
-the road to Regone, as no guides could be raised. From Ili, however,
-a newly erected telephone line of copper wire led to Numarroe. If we
-followed this line we were sure to come upon something useful. As a
-matter of fact parts of the enemy columns were near us when we left
-Ili. The patrols we had left behind even met some Askari whom they took
-to be friends: they exchanged cigarettes and lights with these and did
-not realize until afterwards that they were enemies.
-
-During these days I was much occupied with a domestic question. The
-supply of bread for the European prisoners became difficult in view of
-the prolonged marches. The men were unskilled and not in a position to
-help themselves. At last I succeeded in getting over the difficulty,
-and had considerable quantities of flour prepared by other methods.
-Captain Krüger, who had charge of the prisoners of war and died soon
-afterwards, was already very ill and exhausted by hardships; with the
-best intentions he had not always managed to find the ways and means of
-meeting the wishes of the prisoners, which were often very exacting.
-
-In the morning of 24th August we crossed the Likungo river, and
-continued our march towards Numarroe. We could already see, several
-miles in breadth, the hill and the buildings of Boma Numarroe.
-During a halt we lunched in the congenial company of Lieutenant Ott,
-Sergeant-Major Nordenholz and the other officers of the advance guard.
-We had long grown accustomed during the halts to bring out, without
-ceremony, a piece of bread and a box of lard or hippopotamus fat. Naval
-Lieutenant Freund even still possessed some butter from Namacurra.
-Even the Askari and bearers, who formerly used to wait for their meal
-until camp was pitched, adopted more and more the “desturi” (manners,
-customs) of the Europeans. As soon as a halt was called every black
-would bring out his lunch. It was very jolly when the whole force
-bivouacked in this way in the forest, in the best of spirits, and
-refreshed themselves for fresh exertions, fresh marches and fresh
-fighting.
-
-We were still two hours east of Numarroe when the advance guard was
-fired on. An enemy company had camped on our line of march and was
-slowly and cleverly retreating before us from kopje to kopje in the
-direction of Numarroe. Lieutenant Ott, who was shot through the chest,
-was in a very serious condition. With the main body led by Goering’s
-detachment, I made a detour, and, passing the enemy to the south, made
-straight for the Boma of Numarroe. Before dark our gun was brought into
-position and fire opened on the Boma and its entrenchments. Goering’s
-detachment, without loss of time, made a still wider detour to the
-south in order, by using a ravine, to come close up to the Boma in the
-rear. The advance guard (Müller’s detachment), which was out of sound
-of the fighting, was also quickly brought up. The enemy shooting was
-not bad, and in spite of the distance the rifle bullets of the infantry
-came very close whenever one of us exposed himself.
-
-It soon grew dark; the firing increased and died down again, until
-suddenly heavy firing was heard from the direction of Goering’s
-detachment. Then there was silence. Goering’s detachment had surprised
-the enemy in the rear and stormed some stubbornly defended trenches.
-The retreating enemy was, however, not recognized as the enemy by
-another German detachment and got away. The night was unpleasantly
-cold; it was pouring with rain and our baggage had not yet come up.
-On the following day 3 enemy Europeans and 41 Askari were buried by
-us; 1 European and 6 Askari wounded, 1 European, 7 Askari and 28 other
-blacks unwounded were taken prisoner. Among the prisoners was the enemy
-Commander, Major Garrod, who commanded the half of the 2nd battalion
-4th King’s African Rifles here. On our side, Sergeant-Major Nordenholz
-was shot through the head; 6 Askari and 1 machine-gun bearer were
-killed; 3 Europeans, 18 Askari and 4 machine-gun bearers were wounded;
-40,000 rounds of ammunition and two light machine guns, in addition to
-hand-grenades, medical stores and large quantities of supplies, were
-captured. Among our wounded left behind in the clean, massively built
-houses was Lieutenant Ott, cheerful as ever. Fortunately, his wound was
-not so serious as was feared at first, but it was not possible to take
-him with us.
-
-On August 25th I wanted at all costs to reach the camp of Regone.
-From captured papers I knew that valuable stores had been taken to
-Regone to be safe from us, including trench-mortar ammunition. Regone
-was probably, for the moment, still weakly garrisoned. In view of the
-proximity of the enemy columns it might, however, be assumed that
-August 26th would already be too late for a _coup de main_. The path
-led through a pass in the steep rocky hills. During the march our
-advance guard soon came upon the enemy and engaged him, while I, with
-the main force, passed round this enemy and marched direct on Regone.
-During the climb over the hilly country, where it was only possible
-to see a short distance ahead, two German detachments, mistaking each
-other for the enemy, nearly became engaged. The machine guns were
-already in position when the mistake was fortunately discovered.
-
-We then advanced further over the hills, while below us, already
-considerably in the rear, could be heard the machine-gun fire of our
-advance guard. The march was so difficult, and as we could only cross
-the hills in single file, our column was so long that Regone, my
-objective for that day, was not nearly reached. As a matter of fact we
-had no exact idea where Regone was. Only the fact that we could see in
-the distance the converging of several paths led us to conclude that
-Regone must lie there. Half way to Regone we saw a large encampment
-of tents which I took to be the other half of the battalion which had
-marched from Regone to the support of Numarroe.
-
-In pouring rain we had to pitch our camp in the bush. On the next day
-the camp we had observed had been struck. The Boma of Regone was held
-in considerable strength. An attack on this place over the bare hills
-offered no prospect of success, and we confined ourselves to skirmishes
-with patrols and single detachments. As I had seen from his papers,
-the enemy had given orders that we should be allowed to strike at
-Regone unhindered and then attacked in the flank or rear by the strong
-reserves which lay outside. It was therefore necessary to exercise
-particular caution, and the impetuosity with which Lieutenant Boell’s
-company, in spite of all these considerations, advanced on the Boma
-might have had serious consequences. Several enemy camps and columns
-outside the entrenchments were surprised by our fire and some supplies
-captured. The captured papers informed us of the approach of strong
-enemy columns from the south and south-east towards Regone. But there
-were also troops to the north; whether these were in the neighbourhood
-of Lioma-Malacotera or at Malema could not be ascertained. It was,
-however, certain that they were at hand and it was probable that they
-were approaching Regone, and that from the north.
-
-As a _coup de main_ against Regone offered no prospect of success, and
-a prolonged enterprise, in view of the intervention to be expected from
-outside, could not be relied on, I determined to resume the march.
-On account of the obstacles formed by the rivers and swamps south of
-Lake Nyassa, the line of march I had formerly decided on to the west
-appeared ill-advised, especially as the enemy could, with the help of
-steamers and railways, easily concentrate and maintain a force there.
-A further march north seemed to me more practicable, passing the
-lake on the east; it seemed probable that our return to German East
-Africa would be a complete surprise to the enemy, who would take our
-objective to be the natural capital of this district, Tabora. Under
-this impression he might be expected, in order to save his main force
-the difficult overland march to Tabora, to withdraw to the Portuguese
-coast, take ship from there to Dar-es-Salaam, and proceed by rail to
-Tabora. These calculations were to a large extent realized. It was
-natural that, having reached the north end of Lake Nyassa, I should
-continue my march, not to Tabora but in another direction, probably
-west. In any case, the first thing was to reach the north end of the
-lake. This could not be done in less than a month and meanwhile the
-situation might alter considerably.
-
-At Regone we observed the concentration of strong enemy forces, who
-examined our camps immediately after our departure but followed us
-only slowly. The country, with its numerous ravines and water-courses,
-was particularly favourable to us. On the way to Lioma a considerable
-enemy supply dump was captured, including a large quantity of
-tobacco. Müller’s detachment, which had gone on ahead to Lioma, soon
-reported the enemy occupation of this place, but could not obtain
-any exact information as to his strength. I reached this advance
-detachment on 30th August with the main force. The position of the
-enemy entrenchments in the thick bush had not yet been located with
-any exactness. Apparently he had only just arrived and had not yet
-completed his works. I therefore attacked immediately. The detachments
-of Müller and Goering marched round the enemy to take him from the
-north. Meanwhile the main force gradually closed in along several
-ravines in the forest.
-
-In view of the lack of information I could get no clear picture of the
-situation. Suddenly lively firing was heard from the rear, where our
-carrier columns were still on the march. A strong enemy patrol had
-unexpectedly opened fire on our bearers. A great part of our baggage
-was lost. Captain Poppe, who with two companies was standing by in case
-I required him, was sent to attack. He could no longer find the patrol,
-but followed their line of retreat and came upon an entrenched camp
-which he immediately stormed. Sergeant-Major Schaffrath was severely
-wounded. These events were personally reported to me by Captain Poppe,
-who was brought back severely wounded in the chest. He reported that
-the enemy had been completely defeated, and that large captures of arms
-and ammunition had been made. The companies of Poppe’s detachment had
-pursued the fleeing enemy and come upon a fresh and larger camp. This
-same camp was also attacked from the north by Goering’s detachment,
-so that the enemy was taken under an effective cross fire. Meanwhile,
-a new enemy, advancing from the north-east, was held up by Müller’s
-detachment.
-
-I did not get anything like a clear view of these different events
-until I personally reconnoitred the position long after dark. On one of
-these reconnaissances an enemy rifle-bullet, of which many were being
-fired, passed through the trousers of one of my companions (Hauter, of
-the Landsturm), struck my other companion, Lieutenant Besch, in the
-thigh and severed the artery. Fortunately we were near the dressing
-station. I was thus able to take leave of this officer, who had
-hitherto acted as Quartermaster and at the same time had undertaken the
-duties of orderly officer, with the knowledge that he would recover.
-His few possessions he gave to his companions together with his wishes
-for good luck for the future. I, too, was honoured with a handful
-of cigarettes. It was my habit to smoke continuously during serious
-fighting.
-
-In the middle of the bush I met Lieutenant Von Ruckteschell with some
-bearers, on his stretcher which he was forced to use temporarily
-because of his wounded leg, which had not yet healed; he had kept the
-column together as far as possible during the long march and now, rifle
-in hand, was beaming with joy at the possibility of taking part in the
-engagement with the enemy patrol which appeared on the flank and in our
-rear. Part of our columns had lost their way in the thick bush and only
-found us some hours later. After nightfall the dressing station in a
-ravine had been filled with wounded. It was reported that Lieutenant
-Schroetter and Naval Lieutenant Freund had fallen. In a further
-patrol-attack, Sergeant-Majors Bolles and Hüttig accidentally came
-close to the enemy positions and were fired on suddenly; Bolles fell,
-Hüttig was captured, severely wounded. Sergeant-Major Thurmann had come
-within five yards of the enemy trenches, and being an excellent shot he
-repeatedly picked off from an ant-hill any of the enemy inside the camp
-who exposed himself, until he, too, received a mortal wound.
-
-Captain Goering, regarding it as hopeless to storm the camp, did not
-attempt this and, after dark, withdrew the force, leaving only patrols
-in front of the enemy. The main force was thus collected in several
-groups north of the enemy camp, and I decided to evacuate the scene of
-action on the following day and march on.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. xx. Through Portuguese East Africa.]
-
-By force of necessity we had to leave behind part of our sick and
-wounded, as well as the sick prisoners, in charge of an English medical
-officer, and at nine o’clock in the morning we began our march north
-in several columns. We had no guides; the country was quite unknown to
-us and I could only give the Commander of the advance guard general
-instructions that I intended to pass round one of the hills that lay
-before us to the north. Soon firing could be heard from the advance
-guard. It gradually became clear in the bush that our advance guard had
-turned against an enemy who had attacked in the rear from the left.
-The shooting was at close range, and from Headquarters, which was with
-the main body, seemed to come from a considerable force.
-
-I sent back an Askari to lead the head of the main force to the place
-where I was. The position certainly invited us to catch the enemy
-between our advance guard and our main force, and overwhelm him. I
-waited, but our main force did not arrive. At last I ran back and saw
-from the tracks that the main force had been wrongly guided and had
-marched past us a long way to the side. On the other hand, I saw the
-head of Stemmermann’s detachment, to which the greater part of our
-columns and our sick belonged, in the very act of marching unwittingly
-straight into the enemy. There was just time to head off this
-detachment. I myself now joined the advance detachments of Müller and
-Goering, who had meanwhile continued their march further north. They
-were following a road which led up the hill and was then completely
-lost. I paid no further attention to the firing which I heard from time
-to time further to the rear. In the late afternoon I was astonished to
-notice that the rest of the troops had not followed the detachments of
-Müller and Goering, but were marching along the valley to our right.
-I had no idea that our column had meanwhile been fired on again by a
-new enemy from the east and that a great part of a field hospital had
-fallen into the enemy’s hands.
-
-In order to bring the force together, I tried to descend from my
-hill. The descent, however, proved impossible; the rocks were steep,
-almost perpendicular. We continued along a native path, and evening
-was falling when Captain Müller reported that this path, too, ended
-abruptly in a precipice. Fortunately there was another small bypath.
-This we followed and succeeded in climbing down. Even here it was very
-steep in places, but the bare feet of the carriers gave them a good
-foothold and I, too, after taking off my boots, managed the descent.
-It was pitch dark and we had no water. At last, however, we found
-some, and a load fell from my heart when we came upon the rest of the
-force which, under General Wahle, had, on their side, been trying to
-join us. On the 30th and 31st of August, we had lost 6 Europeans,
-23 Askari killed; 11 Europeans, 16 Askari wounded; 5 Europeans, 29
-Askari missing; 5 Askari taken prisoner; 48,000 rounds of ammunition,
-important medical and surgical stores, a considerable number of rifle
-parts and the whole transport of Müller’s detachment had been lost. The
-enemy losses were also severe, as appeared from a casualty list of the
-1st battalion 1st King’s African Rifles which was captured later. In
-addition to this battalion part of the 3rd battalion of this regiment
-and the 2nd King’s African Rifles had taken part in the fighting
-against us.
-
-Our men fought brilliantly; some of the carriers, it is true, had
-been somewhat unnerved by the unexpected fire and more than 200 were
-missing. There was no news of Koehl’s detachment, but our leaders had
-become so experienced and skilled in bush warfare that there was no
-need for me to be anxious. On the next day, on arrival at our camp, we
-surprised an English supply column.
-
-We then crossed the Cutea-Malema road on which enemy troops also
-appeared, and then crossed the Lurio river at Mtetere. An English
-requisitioning force fled and some supplies were captured. Here Koehl’s
-detachment rejoined the main force. They had followed the enemy who
-was following us and had ascertained that he was several battalions
-strong. We then marched down the Lurio to the fertile district of
-Mpuera. Here Sol (Sergeant-Major) Salim, who, during an earlier patrol
-expedition, had married a wife who had followed him faithfully, left
-her behind with her father, the local Jumbo, in view of her approaching
-confinement.
-
-As there was plenty of food in this district, I gave our troops,
-who had been very exhausted by recent events, a day’s rest. It was
-necessary, anyhow, in the interests of our numerous invalids. Captain
-Koehl had been left behind with his company without transport so that
-he could do the enemy as much damage as possible. He reported that
-strong bodies of enemy troops had arrived in the neighbourhood and
-east of Mtetere. It was clear that for the time being the enemy was
-devoting his whole energies to pursuing us, and for that purpose had
-concentrated all his forces. On that account I did not think the
-moment favourable for some partial success, because it could not be
-exploited, and an action would have cost us wounded whom we could not
-take away with us. As my idea was to forage the district north of
-Luambala for food, I was unwilling to postpone the march thither any
-longer.
-
-The day of rest, September 5th, was employed in completing our food
-supplies from the fertile region of Mpuera, and early on the 6th we
-continued our march in a northerly direction. It was to be assumed that
-the enemy would march downstream, and therefore in a north-easterly
-direction, in several columns. Our troops advanced in order of echelon
-through the bush, and I expected any moment to come across the most
-northerly of the enemy columns, but we crossed its probable course
-without discovering its tracks. About midday we were approaching our
-objective, a water-hole on Mount Hulua. Here our advance guard was shot
-at and before long a lively action was in progress. Captain Müller, in
-command of the advance guard, had stumbled on the rear of a hostile
-column which was marching north-east on a course making an acute angle
-with ours. He had immediately attacked the 2nd battalion 2nd King’s
-African Rifles, which was at the end of the column, and put it to
-flight, capturing the enemy’s field-hospital and his mule train.
-
-I deployed Goering’s detachment on the right of Müller’s detachment,
-and it quickly threw back part of the opposing forces, but did not
-press on as the enemy deployed larger bodies—the 1st battalion of the
-2nd King’s African Rifles and apparently parts of the 3rd battalion as
-well.
-
-Our left wing, which had arrived in rolling, open country in its
-advance, and also collided with fresh hostile troops, had retired a
-few hundred yards and occupied a slight eminence, giving a field of
-fire of several hundred yards. I was not able to get a clear picture
-of the situation until I went from the right wing, where I had joined
-Goering’s detachment, back to the left.
-
-The action was pretty violent and at length came to a standstill. We
-now heard the sound of trench-mortar fire coming from the rearguard,
-under Captain Spangenberg, whose arrival I was awaiting. The rearguard
-had beaten off the attack of another enemy column at Mpuera and
-driven part of it away in disorderly flight. In accordance with its
-instructions it had followed the main body at seven o’clock in the
-morning. It arrived on the battlefield about five in the afternoon, and
-I considered whether I ought not to throw in all my reserves to inflict
-a decisive defeat on the 2nd King’s African Rifles there and then on
-Mount Hulua. I gave up the idea, however. Time was very short, for
-there was only an hour to darkness, and I felt perfectly certain that
-very early next morning fresh hostile forces would appear on the scene.
-If we were to achieve a decisive victory it would certainly cost us
-appreciable losses, and I was anxious to avoid such losses in view of
-the small numbers—176 Europeans and 1,487 Askari—which our strength
-return of September 1, 1918, revealed. Lieutenant Wenig (Navy), who had
-been employed with his gun in Goering’s detachment, told me that he
-had taken over the command of that detachment, because all the other
-officers were incapacitated. Before long, Captain Goering, with a
-severe wound in the breast, and Lieutenant Boell, with one in the head,
-were brought to the dressing station.
-
-Accordingly I would not commit our reserves to the confusion and
-uncertainty of a night battle in the bush, and determined to slip away
-from the battlefield in a north-westerly direction. It was soon quite
-dark and our progress was very slow in the thick, high grass. After
-going three miles we bivouacked. Our losses in the action of September
-6th had been 5 Askari, 4 machine-gunners killed; 13 Europeans, 49
-Askari, and 15 other natives wounded; 3 Europeans, 13 Askari, and 12
-carriers missing; 3 Askari and 3 bearers captured. The enemy were seen
-to have some 10 Europeans and 30 Askari hit, while 8 Europeans and 45
-Askari were captured; those of the prisoners who were sick or wounded,
-and our own more severely wounded, were left on the battlefield under
-the charge of English R.A.M.C. Documents captured later on at Mwembe
-showed that “Karturol” (abbreviation for “Column of the 2nd King’s
-African Rifles”) had heavy losses on the 6th September and was put out
-of action for a time.
-
-The enemy did not molest our further progress. Captain Koehl had
-remained behind with his company to the west of Mpuera, in order to
-operate from the rear against the enemy and his communications. He
-followed our trail, having slight encounters at Milweberg with the
-1st battalion of the 4th King’s African Rifles, which arrived at that
-point from the south on the 8th September. We moved in several columns
-right through the bush, a region rich in game. We even killed several
-buffaloes on the march. At Kanene we crossed the road that ran from
-Lake Amaramba to Mahua. The enemy had burnt down the store at Kanene,
-but we found ample supplies in the country itself, and the material
-condition of the troops would have been good, if only the influenza
-epidemic had not made such strides. About half had bronchial catarrh,
-and from three to six men in each company had inflammation of the
-lungs; as it was only possible for some eighty sick to be carried in
-the whole force, about twenty men suffering with slight inflammation
-of the lungs had to march at times. No satisfactory solution of the
-problem of transport of sick was to be found, short of abandoning the
-campaign; we could not simply leave the sick to die in the bush. This
-difficult position inevitably placed the greatest possible strain
-on the nerves of Surgeon-Major Taute, our splendid senior medical
-officer. It was the greatest good fortune that this officer, singularly
-gifted both in medicine and in organization, proved equal to his grave
-responsibility. We owe it to the measures adopted by him, as well as
-to the change of district and climate forced upon us by circumstances,
-that the epidemic soon abated. A number of Askari and other natives not
-in a fit state for heavy work followed the force slowly; many of them
-lost courage when they continually found our camping-places empty. A
-large number, however, caught up with us, especially when the force did
-one of its short marches, or was able (a rare occurrence enough) to
-take a day’s rest.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VII
-
-ON GERMAN SOIL ONCE MORE
-
-
-BUT we could not afford many halts. The military position imperatively
-demanded that we should pass quickly through the districts to the east
-of the centre of Lake Nyassa, which were not fertile and had been
-largely stripped in the latest period of the war. Rapidity was all
-the more essential as it was possible for the enemy to move troops by
-sea to the north end of the lake and thus anticipate us by strongly
-occupying the district there. As we approached the river Lujenda, the
-ground became more mountainous and was scored with many water-courses
-and ravines. We could not simply march by the compass, but had to have
-regard to the watershed and keep along the mountain ridge. Fortunately,
-the leader of the advance guard, Captain Spangenberg, found some
-natives who acted as pathfinders and made it much easier to discover
-a good route. But a certain amount of doubling was unavoidable, and
-that retarded our progress, while the enemy were in a position to
-move troops and supplies swiftly from Malacotera along a good road to
-Luambala.
-
-I was somewhat anxious to know whether the water of the river Ludjenda
-would have fallen sufficiently to enable us to use the fords. It would
-no doubt have been easy to construct bark boats, but the transport
-of the whole force could hardly have gone smoothly forward, having
-regard to the violence of the current. In any case, I thought it most
-important that there should be no enemy opposition, and that again
-made haste essential. Fortunately patrols which we sent ahead found
-a ford below Luambala, where the wading of the river presented no
-difficulty. Several slaughtered hippopotami enabled us to prepare
-some fat again, and in the neighbourhood of Mwembe, which we reached
-on the 17th September, we were able to replenish our supplies once
-more. At this point we took our first day’s rest for a long time. It
-was here at Mwembe that the lung epidemic reached its crisis. Since
-the middle of August, 7 Europeans and about 200 natives had been
-attacked, of whom 2 Europeans and 17 natives had died. The stores at
-Mwembe had been destroyed by the weak enemy posts, but there were still
-ample supplies to be had in the district. The question of carriers
-began to cause anxieties. The men had been severely tested by the
-continual marching, by the epidemic, and by the carriage of the sick;
-and we were approaching their home districts. It was probable that
-the Wangoni carriers would desert the moment they reached their home,
-which lay to the north of the Rovuma. In the district of Mwembe and the
-well-cultivated valleys of the river Luscheringo, several patrols of
-the enemy “Intelligence Department” were encountered; true, they were
-easily driven off, but their presence showed that the enemy was in the
-main aware of our movements.
-
-We sent long-distance patrols towards Mitomoni and Makalogi. To the
-south of the Rovuma, after leaving the Luscheringo valley, the steppe
-through which our march led us was amazingly rich in game, as was the
-Rovuma itself, which we reached on the 28th September. But the big
-game had its drawbacks, for once again a sentry was killed by lions.
-We came on to German soil again, and stayed two days at Nagwamira;
-we surprised several enemy depots and columns, which had had no news
-of our appearance. The country was amazingly fertile, and the troops
-were able to get thoroughly fit again. Our patrols sent out towards
-Mitomoni reported a camp somewhat strongly held and the arrival of
-reinforcements coming from the west. Ssongea, too, was occupied by
-the enemy, but in what strength could not be ascertained. Various
-reports, as well as the geographical position, made it likely that
-reinforcements were also on their way to Ssongea from Lake Nyassa.
-
-We continued our march, moving in the direction of Ssongea, and
-southwards of this place came into thickly settled country. The
-enemy wireless disclosed that enemy troops were present in Ssongea,
-and that another column had arrived in the neighbourhood, in all
-probability from Mitomoni. On the 4th October I passed Ssongea on the
-west and continued to the north. When the advance guard under Captain
-Spangenberg reached the high road from Ssongea to Wiedhafen, it was
-attacked with trench-mortars by three enemy companies, which had come
-from the west. The enemy was forced back a little. On account of the
-hilly and ravine-scored nature of the ground and the advanced hour, it
-was improbable that we could achieve a really effective success on this
-day. By the morrow, however, there would be further enemy troops on the
-spot. I accordingly carried the attack no further, and marched by to
-the west of the enemy into a camp at the Peramiho mission station.
-
-As we passed through the Wangoni territory, a large number of our
-carriers deserted, as we had feared would happen. It would after all
-have been asking too much of human nature, to expect that these men,
-who had not seen their people for years, should now march straight
-through their native district. The nigger’s love of home is too
-strong. Even Samarunga, one of my own carriers and a very devoted and
-trustworthy fellow, asked for leave to visit his village, which lay
-near by. He came back faithfully enough and brought his brother with
-him. The two then marched on with us, and Samarunga stayed on even when
-his brother left. To revive his depression, I gave him some of my meat
-ration, but on the next morning he proved to have disappeared after
-all, having first put all my things in order.
-
-To the north of Ssongea a few enemy reconnoitring patrols were again
-met with. Day after day we moved through territory formerly fertile
-and well settled. Thousands of farmers could settle there in a healthy
-and beautiful climate. On the 14th October, we reached Pangire
-(Jacobi), a pleasantly situated mission station, in which, before the
-war, the missionary Gröschel had entertained me on my last tour. The
-missionary’s family had been removed, but the natives, who were of
-the Wabena tribe, had remained, and received us as in peace time, in
-a most friendly manner. Several old Askari, also, who had left the
-force for one reason or another, now reported again. Here, too, some
-patrols were met with and driven off. In the Wabena country, which is
-well stocked with cattle, our very scanty stocks were replenished, and
-a mobile food-reserve thus constituted, which helped greatly to lighten
-our transport. After we had quitted Pangire, a patrol that we had left
-there was fired on by an enemy detachment. Near Ubena our rearguard,
-under Captain Müller, was attacked by several enemy companies arriving
-from the south. A fairly strong enemy column was thus following our
-track. The free open steppes of Ubena were not favourable ground for us
-to fight on, as they were commanded from long range by rifle and gun
-fire. Several reports were also received of the advance on Ubena of
-strong enemy forces from Mwakete; these reports proved to be in part
-incorrect, and led to a short fight between two German patrols.
-
-It was highly probable, and later it proved to be the case, that enemy
-troops would be moved by water to the northern end of Lake Nyassa and
-march from there on Ubena or further to the north. If I desired to give
-up the march towards Tabora, and to move instead between Lakes Nyassa
-and Rukwa, and later between Lakes Nyassa and Tanganyika, to Rhodesia,
-the time for the change of direction was now approaching and there was
-not a day to lose; this was all the more so as our freedom of movement
-was severely restricted by the steep slopes of Mount Livingstone
-and the hills round Mbeja. In settling our line of march we had to
-bear in mind that our stocks of provisions had dwindled considerably
-and required replenishing. Native information pointed to this being
-possible in the region of Kidugala and Sombowano, while famine was said
-to be raging in Ussangu, and especially round New Utengule.
-
-On the 17th October, I quitted Ubena with the main body, leaving behind
-there, sick or wounded, General Wahle, two other Europeans, and some
-Askari. I reached Kidugala on this day. Koehl’s detachment followed on
-the 18th October. On the same day, the Boma Ubena was occupied by some
-100 enemy Askari, while 200 to 300 advanced northwards to the Iringa
-road. We learnt from captured newspapers that Cambrai had fallen on
-the 29th September and that the Belgians had advanced 3 kilometres west
-of Roubaix. We read, too, of the cessation of hostilities in Bulgaria,
-of the retirement of Count Hertling, and of the capture of St. Quentin
-and Armentières. But positions could be given up for so many different
-reasons that I did not attribute any decisive importance to this news.
-
-Our further march past Ngombowano and Brandt led us through a district
-well stocked with cattle. Missions and schools had been deserted,
-but we were very glad to find garden fruits, especially mulberries
-and peaches. In the bush we also found great quantities of wild figs
-and other sweet and tasty fruits. Small patrol encounters indicated
-that enemy troops were moving direct from Lake Nyassa northwards into
-the Brandt district. In Ruiwa we found large English depots, and we
-had to destroy a whole warehouse full of leather. We went on to the
-mission of Old Utengule, also well known to me from peace time, and now
-lying deserted. We then reached Mbozi mission, where the English had
-assembled the men from the district, examined them, and sent them to
-New Langenburg, probably in order to turn them into Askari there. At
-Mbozi there was a large English depot, containing, among other things,
-75 loads of salt and 47 loads of coffee.
-
-It was difficult to feel our way through the district. In the main it
-was but little known to us, and for years the enemy had been altering
-it by building storehouses and transport roads. To have reconnoitred in
-advance would have made too great a demand on our time and strength,
-besides depriving us of the advantage of surprise. The inhabitants
-were very hostile to the English and rendered us valuable service,
-but their information was too often very vague. While we rested a day
-in Mbozi and replenished our stores, our patrols were far afield, one
-towards Galula (St. Moritz’ mission), another towards Itaka, one in
-the direction of New Langenburg, and one in that of Fife. Some of them
-would be away for weeks, and we could not wait for their reports.
-
-This much, however, became clear, that a main communication road of
-the enemy ran past Mbozi from Fife via Rwiba to New Langenburg. On
-this road we captured a lot of stores and several supply columns on the
-march. The existence of this road showed that a large English depot
-must lie in the neighbourhood of Fife. It would probably be possible
-to capture this by swift action, before stronger enemy forces arrived
-there. On the morning of 31st October a fighting patrol was dispatched
-against Fife. On the evening of the same day natives and patrols
-reported the advance of strong enemy forces on the New Langenburg-Rwiba
-road. In the early morning of the 1st November I moved off with the
-whole force, advancing in the first instance towards Mount Rwiba. There
-the track showed that a strong enemy column had passed the Rwiba hill
-shortly before us, in the direction of Fife. This enemy force had not
-been observed by a German fighting patrol that had been sent out to
-Mount Rwiba.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VIII
-
-THE ADVANCE INTO BRITISH RHODESIA
-
-
-THE second patrol dispatched by us on the 31st October towards Fife
-had halted at Mount Rwiba. I had now to advance with the whole force
-towards Fife, in order to reach it before the enemy, or to attack if
-our first patrol should prove to be engaged there. The ten-hour march
-(actual marching time) from Mbozi to Fife was a tremendous strain on
-the force, but the reports of our patrols, the track of the enemy, and
-his notes found on the trees, proved beyond a doubt that the enemy
-was doing everything possible to reach Fife on the same day, the 1st
-November. The great distance which they, too, had to march justified
-us in assuming that our patrol, which I expected would reach Fife on
-the 31st October, or at the latest on the 1st November, would be equal
-to preventing the enemy occupying the depot at Fife on the 1st. In the
-course of the afternoon we fired on several patrols, without halting
-in our advance. Late in the afternoon weak enemy detachments in the
-hills near Fife were quickly thrown back. I myself, with Spangenberg’s
-detachment, which had moved off the road to the right, advanced along a
-mountain ridge on to a point where we judged that Fife would lie.
-
-The ground was becoming more open, being mainly covered with knee-high
-bush and grass, when a few hundred yards before us we observed men
-moving about and tents pitched close together. The men were moving
-about in such unconcerned fashion that I almost took them for our own
-patrol, but at 200 yards we were received with violent and at first
-very well directed rifle and machine-gun fire. It was fortunate that
-our men did not answer it, for I had happened to get in advance and
-was between the two parties. After a time the enemy, who had apparently
-become very excited, began to fire high. It started to grow darker, so
-that my patrol was able to get back to our line. We had, at any rate,
-reached certainty. We knew that the enemy with a strength of several
-companies was lying before us in an entrenched position with a good
-field of fire. His advanced detachments had been thrown back. His
-depots lay in part outside the trenches, and later fell into our hands.
-I did not want to undertake the storming of the position, which would
-have been costly, but the opportunity seemed favourable to bombard the
-enemy, massed as he was in the position, with our trench-mortar, and
-also from a height with our gun, as well as with rifle and machine-gun
-fire if he should show himself. Our machine guns were accordingly
-moved forward in the night close to his position and entrenched.
-Reconnaissance for a good gun position was postponed to the next day.
-
-It was probable that the opening of our trench-mortar and gun-fire
-would lead the enemy advancing from New Langenburg to attack us. Such
-an attack against our heights would have been very difficult. But
-in spite of the bombardment on the 2nd November, which was observed
-to cause some losses, no new enemy appeared. The definite success
-for which we hoped against the camp was not achieved, since our
-trench-mortar was destroyed at one of the first shots by a prematurely
-bursting shell. Flat trajectory fire alone could do nothing against
-the well-protected enemy. In the afternoon, therefore, our main body,
-with its herds of cattle more than 400 strong, marched off, between
-Fife and the Mwenzo mission towards Rhodesia. When we had reached
-camp, we saw heavy columns of smoke rising from the depots at Fife,
-to which Müller’s detachment had set fire after our departure. From
-the direction of the Mwenzo mission we heard short bursts of fire on
-several occasions.
-
-Reports came in gradually from that direction. In addition to our
-fighting patrols dispatched from Mbozi, other patrols of ours had
-arrived, and had fought with English patrols, and also with each other.
-One report stated that one enemy patrol had been observed with quite
-dark uniforms, hitherto unknown, and that it must be some recently
-arrived body. After many inquiries I finally ascertained that one of
-our own patrols, whose equipment was certainly no longer quite in
-accord with regulations, had been continually mistaken for the enemy.
-In the Mwenzo mission itself there was a stationary enemy hospital,
-from which we were able to replenish our medical stores. Our quinine
-stocks were brought up to over fourteen kilos, supplies thus being
-insured until June, 1919.
-
-[Illustration: Fig. xxi. The March into Rhodesia.]
-
-Various reports and statements of prisoners showed that enemy transport
-was moving from the Broken Hill district to Kasama, and from there
-onwards to Fife, with motor-cars and ox-wagons. Kasama itself seemed to
-be a large place and an important road centre. In any case, we could
-expect enemy depots on the way from Fife to Kasama, and Kasama itself
-would be a valuable objective. So far as one could tell from the map,
-the position also seemed to be such that we should be able there to
-decide to go further southwards round Lake Bangweolo and reach the
-Zambesi-Congo watershed, or to march further westwards between Lakes
-Bangweolo and Moero. The information was certainly very uncertain,
-resting almost exclusively on several Askari, who as children had been
-employed in trade caravans in the neighbourhood of Lake Moero.
-
-The important question of the nature of the rivers, and in particular
-of the Luapala, which flowed from Lake Bangweolo into Lake Moero, was
-for the time quite unsolved. We did not clear up these points until
-we captured some maps and notes. About this time, according to these,
-the Luapala was a mighty barrier; deep and in many places very broad;
-it is enclosed by extended marshes. In the rainy season that was just
-approaching, any attempt to cross the river in canoes would meet with
-difficulties, since on our approach the canoes would certainly be
-removed to the opposite bank or concealed. I devoted every minute to
-the study of maps and travel-descriptions, burying myself in them at
-every halt in the march. There was great danger that in ignorance of
-our position we might run into an _impasse_ in this region of great
-rivers and lakes.
-
-The first thing was to sweep rapidly along the communication road
-Fife-Kajambi mission-Kasama. Mobile detachments were sent on by forced
-marches, capturing several small depots, taking their guards prisoner,
-and also securing a few ox-wagon teams. Captain Spangenberg followed
-immediately with three companies, and then the main body, at a distance
-of about one day’s march.
-
-The heavy marches and the deviation to the south-west, into quite new
-and unknown territory, was too much for a number of carriers. On one
-single day there deserted from the staff 20 Wafiri, who had their homes
-in the region of Bismarckburg, and 13 carriers from other districts.
-
-The main body arrived at Kajambi on the 6th November. The Catholic
-mission station there consists of wonderful, spacious and massive
-buildings. The missionaries had fled, quite unnecessarily. In the nuns’
-house there was a letter for me from a Catholic nun. She was a native
-of Westphalia, and as a fellow-countrywoman appealed to my humanity.
-She would certainly have spared herself many discomforts if both she
-herself and the other people attached to the mission had remained
-quietly at their posts. We should have done as little to them as we had
-done earlier to the old English missionary at Peramiho, near Ssongea.
-The soil was extraordinarily fertile; in the mission garden magnificent
-strawberries were growing. At midday we heard rifle fire from the
-rearguard, which was encamped two hours’ march north-east of Kajambi;
-Captain Koehl had remained there to gather supplies, and his Europeans
-and Askari had largely been distributed into separate supply patrols.
-In this situation he was attacked by an enemy patrol. Captain Koehl
-extricated himself from this unpleasant position and on the next day
-established his front by Kajambi mission, and we had the opportunity,
-which we used with great success, to take the enemy under our fire
-by surprise. On the 7th November our main body resumed its march on
-Kasama. The enemy were not observed to be following up. If, however,
-they were to press on behind us, it was to be assumed that questions of
-supply would prevent their doing so in really great strength. We had
-the prospect of swiftly seizing Kasama, and then of making this place
-our base and giving battle under favourable conditions.
-
-But these were hopes of the future; the first thing was to take Kasama
-itself quickly; according to our information it was not strongly held,
-but was well fortified. Captain Spangenberg with the advance guard
-kept increasing his distance from the main body by longer and longer
-marches. I followed with the main body; ample supplies were found, and
-we also met with confirmation of the descriptions given in various
-books to the effect that the forest is well stocked with tasty bush
-fruits.
-
-On the 8th November Spangenberg’s detachment had several patrol fights
-to the north of Kasama, and on the 9th it took Kasama, whose garrison,
-in the strength of half a company, retired to the southward. Only a
-little ammunition was captured and there was little else of value
-in the armoury. There was a large repair shop for motor and other
-vehicles, and more than a score of Boer wagons were taken. There was
-considerable booty in food supplies for Europeans. It was noteworthy
-that an English company in Kasama—I think it was the African Lakes
-Corporation—had given written instructions for the destruction of
-its depots by the natives. These came in large numbers to loot, and
-Spangenberg’s detachment found buildings and their contents largely
-destroyed by looting natives. It is due to his action that among other
-things the house of the British Commissioner, which was built and
-furnished with great taste, was preserved.
-
-During our advance from Fife it had appeared that the further we went
-the fuller were the enemy depots. We gained the impression that we were
-working up a line of communications which started around Broken Hill
-or somewhat to the north of it, and was only just being established.
-We had grounds for hoping that if we moved rapidly forward, we should
-find depots even more plentifully stocked; and the documents taken,
-besides information from natives, seemed to confirm this. Three days’
-march further along the telephone line, large stores were said to be
-lying at the Chambezi ferry, which had in part been brought thither by
-boat. I myself on the 11th November cycled to Kasama and met Captain
-Spangenberg there, and he immediately resumed his march, with two
-companies, southwards, in the direction of the Chambezi ferry.
-
-On the 12th November the main body reached Kasama. Towards evening
-rifle and machine-gun fire was heard from the direction of our march.
-Our rearguard had been attacked in its camp, two hours to the north
-of Kasama. The enemy who had fought at Kajambi had not followed us
-directly, but had taken a parallel course. In the evening Koehl’s
-detachment arrived in Kasama. I had now formed the opinion that the
-attempt on the Chambezi depot was the more promising and important
-undertaking, especially as the whole position made it probable that the
-pursuing enemy would continue to follow and thus again afford us an
-opportunity to give battle.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IX
-
-THE ARMISTICE AND OUR RETURN HOME
-
-
-ACCORDINGLY only Koehl’s detachment remained at Kasama, with
-instructions to follow us a day’s march behind. Early on November 13th
-I followed Spangenberg’s detachment with our main body. I had gone on
-ahead on a bicycle, selected the site for our camp and was waiting for
-the troops to come up when Captain Müller appeared before me, also on
-his bicycle, and reported that an armistice had been concluded. An
-English motor-cyclist who was to have brought the news to the British
-troops had apparently passed through Kasama and been captured there by
-Koehl’s detachment. Thanks to the English telephone line, along which
-we were marching, we were soon able to understand each other, and thus
-did we get the news of the armistice.
-
-The telegram of the motor-cyclist ran as follows:
-
- * * * * *
-
-“12. 11. 18. To be fwded via M.B. cable and despatch rider.
-
-“Send following to Colonel von Lettow Vorbeck under white flag. The
-Prime Minister of England has announced that an armistice was signed
-at 5 hours on Nov. 11th, and that hostilities on all fronts cease at
-11 hours on Nov. 11th. I am ordering my troops to cease hostilities
-forthwith unless attacked, and of course I conclude that you will do
-the same. Conditions of armistice will be forwarded you immediately
-I receive them. Meanwhile I suggest that you should remain in your
-present vicinity in order to facilitate communication.—General van
-Deventer. As message is also being sent to Livingstone, it is important
-Karwunfor receives this same time as enemy; every effort must be made
-to get message to him to-day.”
-
-Our feelings were very mixed. Personally, as I had no knowledge of the
-real state of affairs in Germany, I felt convinced that the conclusion
-of hostilities must have been favourable, or at least not unfavourable
-to Germany.
-
-Spangenberg’s detachment, which was on ahead, had to be told as soon as
-possible, and I immediately set out on my bicycle after it, taking with
-me Haouter, a Landsturm soldier, as my sole companion. About half-way,
-Reissmann’s cyclist patrol of Spangenberg’s detachment met me and
-reported that Captain Spangenberg had arrived at the Chambezi. Although
-I had no doubts about the correctness of the English news, our position
-was very uncomfortable. We were in a district where there was little
-food, and were therefore compelled to move on from place to place. This
-circumstance had already compelled us to reconnoitre and secure for
-ourselves the crossings of the Chambezi. If hostilities were resumed we
-must be certain of a safe crossing. This was a burning question, as the
-rainy season, meaning a great rise of this river, was near at hand. We
-had already encountered heavy storms. I had, therefore, much to discuss
-with Captain Spangenberg and the English officer who would presumably
-be on the far bank of the river. In any case we must continue to
-devote our energies to buying or getting food. Full of that idea, I
-sent my companion back and cycled myself with Reissmann’s patrol to
-Spangenberg’s detachment.
-
-We arrived about eight o’clock, when it was quite dark. Captain
-Spangenberg was away on a reconnaissance, but Assistant-Paymaster
-Dohmen and other Europeans looked after me well as soon as they learnt
-of my arrival. I was able to convince myself that the supply depot of
-Kasama really existed. I tasted jam and other good things which had
-been unknown to me hitherto.
-
-When Captain Spangenberg came back he told me that he had already heard
-of the armistice through the English. After I had gone to bed in his
-tent, he brought me about midnight a telegram from General Deventer
-which had been brought in by the English. It had come from Salisbury.
-It stated that Germany had accepted the unconditional handing-over of
-all troops operating in East Africa. Deventer added that he demanded
-the immediate surrender of all our English prisoners of war, and that
-we should march to Abercorn. All our arms and ammunition were to be
-given up at Abercorn, but our Europeans were to be allowed to keep
-their weapons.
-
-The full text of the telegram ran as follows:
-
- * * * * *
-
-“13. 11. 18. To Norforce. Karwunfor via Fife.
-
-“Send following to Colonel von Lettow Vorbeck under white flag: War
-Office London telegraphs that clause seventeen of the armistice signed
-by the German Govt. provides for unconditional surrender of all German
-forces operating in East Africa within one month from Nov. 11th.
-
-“My conditions are. First: hand over all allied prisoners in your
-hands, Europeans and natives to the nearest body of British troops
-forthwith. Second: that you bring your forces to Abercorn without
-delay, as Abercorn is the nearest place at which I can supply you
-with food. Third: that you hand over all arms and ammunition to my
-representative at Abercorn. I will, however, allow you and your
-officers and European ranks to retain their personal weapons for the
-present in consideration of the gallant fight you have made, provided
-that you bring your force to Abercorn without delay. Arrangements will
-be made at Abercorn to send all Germans to Morogoro and to repatriate
-German Askari. Kindly send an early answer, giving probable date of
-arrival at Abercorn and numbers of German officers and men, Askari and
-followers.”
-
- * * * * *
-
-This was news enough if it were confirmed, and showed the desperate
-situation of the Fatherland. Nothing else could account for the
-surrender of a force still maintaining itself proudly and victoriously
-in the field.
-
-Without being in a position to examine the ground in detail, I had to
-tell myself that the conditions imposed upon us were inevitable, and
-must be loyally carried out. I met the British Commissioner, who had
-come from Kasama to the Chambezi rubber factory, at the river at eight
-o’clock on the morning of the 14th. There I handed to him a telegram
-to His Majesty, in which I reported what had happened and added that I
-would act accordingly. The Commissioner told me that the German fleet
-had revolted, and that a revolution had also broken out in Germany;
-further, if he was to accept a report which was official but had not
-yet been confirmed, the Kaiser had abdicated on November 10th. All this
-news seemed to me very improbable, and I did not believe it until it
-was confirmed on my way home months later.
-
-All our troops, native as well as Europeans, had always held the
-conviction that Germany could not be beaten in this war, and were
-resolved to fight on to the last. Of course it was doubtful whether
-our resources would last out if the war lasted several years more, but
-we faced all possibilities tranquilly for at least another year. The
-men were well armed, equipped and fed, and the strategic situation at
-the moment was more favourable than it had been for a long time. The
-Askari, it is true, saw that our numbers were dwindling—we were still
-155 Europeans, comprising 30 officers, medical officers and higher
-officials, 1,168 Askari, and about 3,000 other natives—but whenever I
-discussed this topic with one of my orderlies he always assured me: “I
-will always stick by you and fight on till I fall.” Many others spoke
-to the same effect, and I am convinced that it was not merely a case of
-empty words.
-
-In the afternoon of the 14th November, I cycled back to our main body
-and told the Europeans what I had learned at the Chambezi, and that it
-was my intention to carry out the conditions which had been officially
-communicated to me, conditions the accuracy of which I did not doubt.
-
-Before the prisoners were released Colonel Dickinson, the most senior
-of them, came to look for me to say good-bye. He said that his period
-of captivity (it had been more than three months) had given him an
-interesting insight into our camp life, our marching methods, and
-the way in which we conducted our actions. He was full of praise for
-the simplicity of our arrangements and the absence of friction which
-distinguished our operations. There is no doubt he had been using his
-eyes.
-
-Our Askari were now informed of the turn of affairs. It was to be
-anticipated that there would be difficulties when it came to settling
-up with them for their pay, which was years overdue, and the same
-applied to the carriers. Yet it was a matter of honour for us to see
-that these people, who had fought and worked for us with such devotion,
-should receive their rights. The sum involved—about one and a half
-million rupees—was relatively small, and so Lieutenant Kempner was
-sent out on a bicycle to get this sum from the English, or induce them
-to procure it as quickly as possible. Our repeated efforts were without
-result. We were told at different times and places that the matter
-was “under consideration” by the War Office, and there it remained. I
-never even received a reply to my telegram to the German Government
-in Berlin. There was nothing for it but to draw up lists of all the
-back pay that was due, and give the individual carriers and Askari
-certificates against it.
-
-We then marched by short stages through Kasama to Abercorn. The British
-gave us further details about the armistice conditions. It appeared
-that not “unconditional surrender” (as General van Deventer had said
-originally) but “unconditional evacuation” was what was required.
-I made several protests against the interpretation of the British
-War Office, which made the word “evacuation” include surrender and
-disarming, but I received no answer either from the Governments of the
-allied countries and the United States, or from the German Government.
-In view of the doubtful interpretation of the word “evacuation,” I
-considered whether I should not cut short negotiations and march to
-join the Belgians or somewhere else. But in comparison to the whole
-series of peace conditions which affected the Protective Force, this
-seemed a small point, and in the end I decided to go to Dar-es-Salaam,
-as General van Deventer required, though certainly in the expectation
-that in accordance with the terms the English would immediately send us
-back from there to Germany. As will appear later that expectation was
-not fulfilled.
-
-Not far north of Kasama we came up with the enemy with whom we had
-fought our last engagement. They were the 1st battalion of the 4th
-King’s African Rifles. I had to refuse the invitation of Colonel
-Hawkins (their estimable commander, who was barely thirty years old),
-communicated to me on the march by Colonel Dickinson, to bring all the
-German officers to lunch, much though I appreciated such an expression
-of chivalry. Yet Colonel Dickinson did not neglect to pay me his
-promised visit on one of the following days, and we had a very pleasant
-hour over a cup of coffee. I must record that the officers of this
-battalion, even in the somewhat difficult circumstances in which they
-were placed, behaved with great tact and with that regard which is due
-to an honourable foe. Hawkins told me that for reasons of supply he
-would not have been able to follow us any further, and in fact we had
-to help him out with cattle, of which we had an ample stock.
-
-Lieutenant Kempner had gone on to Abercorn on his bicycle. When he came
-back I went there myself in a car which General Edwards had sent for
-me. My reception by General Edwards, as well as his Staff, was very
-kind. I put forward my point of view to General Edwards that I did not
-recognize any duty to surrender of our arms, but was ready to do so if
-I was thereby conferring some advantage, not on ourselves individually,
-but on the German Government. I was then informed that the arms we
-surrendered would form part of the quantity which Germany had to hand
-over to the Allied Governments in accordance with the terms of the
-armistice. Further, the surrender of our arms should not have the
-character of a laying-down of arms.
-
-As regards the Askari and carriers, I was informed that the English
-would take them to an internment camp at Tabora, until the question
-of their pay had been settled and their repatriation arranged. The
-Europeans were to be interned at Dar-es-Salaam until their ship left,
-presumably, therefore, for a few days. Not only the Askari but the
-Europeans at Dar-es-Salaam were kept behind barbed wire for a month and
-a half and more.
-
-The troops arrived at Abercorn on the 25th November. The English flag
-was waving on the parade-ground where the handing-over of arms took
-place, and this shows that the character of a surrender of our arms was
-not altogether avoided. What we handed over was as follows:
-
-1 Portuguese gun, 37 machine guns (7 German, 16 heavy and 14 light
-English), 1,071 English and Portuguese rifles, 208,000 rounds,
-40 rounds of artillery ammunition. The English were mighty quick
-at getting away the surrendered material. There was not a single
-modern German rifle among it! The strength of our troops was: the
-Governor, 20 officers, 5 medical officers, a doctor of the Voluntary
-Medical Detachment, a senior veterinary officer, a senior chemist, a
-field-telegraph officer, 125 European other ranks, 1,156 Askari and
-1,598 carriers. The arrival of individual detachments was delayed for
-hours by heavy rain.
-
-The camp for the Askari was surrounded by a thick thorn hedge, and
-was much too small. This led to a good deal of bad feeling among our
-Askari, which vented itself in frequent demonstrations against the
-English Askari. But at length our people resigned themselves to the
-uncomfortable conditions, and even General Edwards realized that the
-treatment provided an opportunity for unnecessary friction. We were
-not ordinary prisoners of war, whose escape he had to fear, but had
-given ourselves into his hands voluntarily in the performance of an
-unpleasant duty. He took precautions against similar occurrences during
-our march to Bismarckburg, and we went there with Hawkins’ battalion
-and without the slightest friction. On November 28th we bivouacked by
-the mighty waterfall of the river Kalambo, three hours’ march from
-Bismarckburg. Here we remained several days, as the departure of the
-steamer from that place was being continually delayed. Many of my
-officers continually badgered me to know whether we could not fight
-on. These suggestions were far from comfortable, as I had already
-quite enough to do to consider how we should get out of so unpleasant
-a situation. But putting aside the difficulties involved, I could only
-feel glad and proud of such a revelation of true soldierly spirit, a
-spirit which did not shrink, even after we had handed over all our
-arms, from storming an enemy camp and once more procuring for ourselves
-the means to continue the war.
-
-On December 3rd I received a telegram, dated the 2nd December, from
-General van Deventer. It ran as follows:
-
- * * * * *
-
-“I beg to acknowledge receipt of your telegram setting forth your
-formal protest against your troops being treated as prisoners of war.
-This will duly be forwarded to the War Office. Meanwhile I am sure you
-will recognise that pending the receipt through the War Office of a
-communication on the subject of the German Govt. I have had no choice
-but to act in accordance with the orders of the War Office, and treat
-your force as prisoners of war.”
-
- * * * * *
-
-The same day the first lot of troops for transport went on board four
-ships. One of them, the _St. George_, had, in addition to its crew of
-English bluejackets and an escort officer, only the Governor and the
-officers of our force with their black servants. For food the English
-gave us corned beef, dates and biscuits, and Dr. Huber, the veterinary
-officer, looked after our bodily welfare here on board as carefully as
-he had done for so many years in the bush. The British commander, the
-escort officer and the whole crew were extraordinarily kind. After a
-short stop on the evening of the 3rd, at the Belgian station of Vua, a
-violent storm arose in the night. It tore away the awning and, among
-other things, carried off Dr. Huber’s coat. The English sailors did all
-they possibly could for the Germans, who were quite wet through.
-
-On December 5th we arrived at Kigoma. The place was under Belgian
-control, and the Belgians received us with a hospitality which could
-not have been anticipated. They displayed a tactful reserve to us which
-had never been shown before. Tables covered with cloths had been set
-out for all the Europeans, a sight we had not seen for years. Some red
-wine was produced. The Belgian Governor had sent his orderly officer,
-who spoke German fluently, to receive us officially, and I was glad
-to take the opportunity, before we started on our railway journey,
-to thank the Belgian commandant for the _camaraderie_ shown us,
-_camaraderie_ which always exists among soldiers, even between enemies,
-when they have a mutual regard for each other.
-
-Among the English, too, examples of discourtesy on the part of
-individual officers, who apparently had not been brought up in the
-South, were absolutely exceptional. The senior men immediately adopted
-a tactful attitude, whereas one or two juniors did otherwise—for
-example, they were inconsiderate enough to want to keep a German
-invalid out of the compartment. We Europeans were very well looked
-after on the train, and it was like peace time to get a good night’s
-rest by letting down the bunks and using a leather pillow.
-
-There was quite a crowd of Germans on the station at Tabora. They
-complained of many cases of theft on the part of the Belgians and
-English. It is undoubtedly true that such outrages had taken place. We
-stopped for the night at Dodoma and next morning had an opportunity of
-fetching water and having a bath.
-
-The news of the approach of our train had reached Morogoro, and when
-we arrived there in the afternoon we once more found the German women
-whom we had left behind us in and about Morogoro two years before. They
-had tea and coffee waiting for us. They had arranged tables and baked
-plenty of rolls and cakes. In addition they had got the finest fruit
-for us. The English were almost as much interested as the Germans.
-Besides a very amiable elderly medical officer I have a particularly
-lively recollection of a tall, lanky corporal who had apparently drunk
-a whole series of glasses to our health before our train arrived. I
-managed to slip away from him at last.
-
-We reached Dar-es-Salaam at seven o’clock on the morning of December
-8th. The Europeans were well housed in tents in a camp within a
-barbed-wire fence. Food was good and plentiful, and we were able
-to buy necessaries of all kinds cheaply from the English canteen.
-Governor Schnee and I were received by the Chief of Staff of the
-British commander, General Sheppard, and conducted to our very pretty
-house outside the camp. General van Deventer had very kindly sent a
-luncheon there as a welcome to us. Major Kraut, Captain Spangenberg,
-and Dr. Huber were all quartered here. We found General Wahle, who had
-been left behind sick at Ubene and fallen into the enemy’s hands a
-few months back. He had quite recovered. We had a common mess and our
-freedom of movement out of the house was only limited to the extent
-that we had always to be accompanied by a British officer as escort.
-At the start these gentlemen were very unpunctual, but gradually
-quite tolerable relations were established between us, and I had an
-opportunity of visiting acquaintances in Dar-es-Salaam and arranging my
-personal affairs. A car was also usually placed at my disposal. Major
-Hosken, the Commandant of the prison camp, who had previously shown
-himself extremely considerate to the captured German women and children
-in Tanga, now again devoted himself to preserve us from unnecessary
-annoyance.
-
-On our railway journey we had already been surprised to find almost
-more English Europeans at every station than we had in the whole of the
-Protective Force. Dar-es-Salaam itself literally swarmed with white
-troops. I estimated their number at not less than five thousand, and
-hundreds and hundreds of motor lorries and cars were awaiting repairs
-in the motor transport park.
-
-This close concentration of human beings revealed its dangers when
-Spanish influenza made its appearance. Escort officers told me that
-frequently five or seven English officers had died of this disease
-at Dar-es-Salaam. We soon came across its traces among ourselves.
-Infection had probably taken place while we were on the ship on Lake
-Tanganyika, and subsequently on the train. It spread from man to man in
-the concentration camps in Dar-es-Salaam. Captain Spangenberg was going
-about with me in the town shortly after his arrival at Dar-es-Salaam.
-Then he felt ill, and though his iron constitution had successfully
-overcome all the hardships of the campaign, he died in hospital on
-December 18th of influenza and inflammation of the lungs.
-
-Almost all the Europeans in our camp were attacked by it, and it was
-very sad that in addition to Captain Spangenberg, nine other Europeans,
-in all, therefore, ten per cent. of our strength, succumbed. Numbers of
-our Askari interned at Tabora also died.
-
-My comings and goings often took me to the Administration Staff
-(corresponding more or less to our Commandant on the Lines of
-Communication). After much questioning I had found it in my old house
-which I had occupied before the war. Among intelligent Englishmen I
-found the view prevailing that Germany must have colonies on economic
-grounds, as well as on account of her over-populousness. England was
-considered to have too many colonies. For the time being, at any rate,
-she had not sufficient suitable personnel to manage them.
-
-If the English, when telling us of the armistice, insisted on our
-coming to Dar-es-Salaam at once, in order that we should be transported
-punctually—that is, by the 12th December—they showed no haste
-on their own part to carry out the terms of that armistice. Our
-embarkation was continually postponed, and, finally, it did not take
-place until the 17th January, 1919, five years to the day after I had
-landed at Dar-es-Salaam.
-
- * * * * *
-
-To describe my return home in detail would furnish material for a whole
-book and could hardly be excelled for tragi-comic events. In addition
-to 114 German soldiers, we had 107 women and 87 children on board, and
-an escort of 200 British soldiers.
-
-Voyaging by Cape Town, we reached Rotterdam at the end of February. The
-large crowd of Germans who turned up to meet us at the quay showed me,
-to my surprise, that our East African war had been watched very closely
-in the homeland. Many Dutch also gave us proofs of goodwill.
-
-In cold truth our small band, which at the most comprised some 300
-Europeans and about 11,000 Askari, had occupied a very superior enemy
-force for the whole war. According to what English officers told me,
-137 Generals had been in the field, and in all about 300,000 men had
-been employed against us. The enemy’s losses in dead would not be put
-too high at 60,000, for an English Press notice stated that about
-20,000 Europeans and Indians alone had died or been killed, and to that
-must be added the large number of black soldiers who fell. The enemy
-had left 140,000 horses and mules behind in the battle area. Yet in
-spite of the enormously superior numbers at the disposal of the enemy,
-our small force, the rifle strength of which was only about 1,400 at
-the time of the armistice, had remained in the field always ready for
-action and possessed of the highest determination.
-
-I believe it was the transparency of our aims, the love of our
-Fatherland, the strong sense of duty and the spirit of self-sacrifice
-which animated each of our few Europeans and communicated themselves,
-consciously or unconsciously, to our brave black soldiers that gave our
-operations that impetus which they possessed to the end. In addition
-there was a soldierly pride, a feeling of firm mutual co-operation and
-a spirit of enterprise without which military success is impossible in
-the long run. We East Africans know only too well that our achievements
-cannot be compared with the military deeds and devotion of those in the
-homeland. No people in history has ever done more.
-
-If we East Africans received so kindly a reception in the homeland it
-was because everyone seemed to think that we had preserved some part of
-Germany’s soldierly traditions, had come back home unsullied, and that
-the Teutonic sense of loyalty peculiar to us Germans had kept its head
-high even under the conditions of war in the tropics.
-
-It is true that that feeling has suffered eclipse in many of our people
-under the impression of the present tribulations of our Fatherland.
-But it is part of the flesh and blood of us all, and it is just that
-enthusiastic welcome which hundreds of thousands of our countrymen gave
-us that strengthens our conviction that, in spite of the momentary
-distractions and perplexities, the healthy spirit of our German people
-will prevail again and once more tread the upward path.
-
-
-
-
- INDEX
-
-
- A
-
- _Adjutant_ (steamer), 85.
-
- Adler, Captain, 35, 56.
-
- Aeroplanes:
- first appearance, 80;
- brought down, 86.
-
- Alto Moloque:
- surprise, 263;
- Portuguese officers taken prisoner, 263;
- large supplies of food, 265.
-
- Amaramba, Lake, 302.
-
- Amboni plantation, 62.
-
- Armistice, first news of, 13 Nov., 315.
-
- Arrival of first store-ship, 67;
- second ditto, 117.
-
- Artillery, 38, 46.
-
- Arusha:
- cattle extensive, 11;
- potentiality of the district, 11, 29.
-
- Askari:
- native soldiers, 27;
- training, 8;
- old, well-to-do, 10;
- back pay, 319;
- women follow our force, 177.
-
- _Astræa_, English cruiser, 27.
-
- Attendants reduced, 176.
-
- Augar, Captain, 35.
-
- Aumann, Captain, 84, 96, 100.
-
- Auracher, District Commissioner, 35, 38.
-
-
- B
-
- Bagamoyo:
- bombarded, 31;
- reconnoitre, 146;
- falls into enemy hands, 148.
-
- Bangweolo, Lake, 311.
-
- _Baron Dhanis_, steamer (Belgian), 95.
-
- Barrett, Lieutenant (English), 107.
-
- Barton, Colonel (English), 251.
-
- Bast, Sergt.-Major, killed, 87.
-
- Batzner, Lieutenant, 214.
-
- Baudouinville (Congo):
- White Fathers, 14;
- French missionaries, 14;
- native industry, 14.
-
- Baumstark, Captain, 33, 36, 38.
-
- Baziots, The, Administrator, 96.
-
- Becker’s post, 90.
-
- Before the war, re-arming companies, 13.
-
- Behobeho:
- field howitzer lost, 171;
- heavy fighting and Selous killed, 171.
-
- Belgian steamer _Delcommune_ shot to pieces, 29.
-
- Belgian Commander-in-Chief at Lake Kivu, 92.
-
- Bergmann, Lieutenant, 39.
-
- Besch, Lieutenant, 224, 246.
-
- Beves, General (English), 212.
-
- Bismarckburg-Langenburg operations, 96.
-
- Bleeck, Lieutenant, 56, 162, 200.
-
- Bock, Lieut.-Colonel von, 8.
-
- Bock, Captain von, 89, 136.
-
- Boell, Lieutenant, 138;
- wounded, 301.
-
- Boemken, Major von, 159.
-
- Bolles, Sergt.-Major, killed, 296.
-
- Boot-making experiments, 194.
-
- Botha, General, reported coming, 72.
-
- Braunschweig, Captain, 82, 149, 182.
-
- Bread without wheat flour, 193.
-
- Bridge building, 71.
-
- British North Lancashire Regiment, 42.
-
- British Regular officers chivalrous, 107.
-
- British treatment of German prisoners, 221.
-
- Brits, General, 147, 149.
-
- Brucher, Lieutenant, 192.
-
- Bueschel, Lieutenant, 87.
-
- Buffaloes, best in East Africa, 12.
-
- Buiko, 141.
-
- Bukoba, 88, 91.
-
- Buller, Major (English), wounded, 147.
-
- Burungi Mountains, 134;
- supplies plentiful, 134.
-
-
- C
-
- _Camaraderie_ of escort, 322.
-
- Carriers, numbers of, 22, 24.
-
- _Cecil Rhodes_, steamer, sunk, 97.
-
- Chalau taken, 287.
-
- Chambesi depot, 314.
-
- Chappuis, Lieutenant von, 31, 185.
-
- Chirumba station, 241.
-
- Chiulezi, 235.
-
- Chiwata, position, 217;
- ammunition shortage, 218.
-
- Christiansen, Lieutenant, 68.
-
- Cloth-making at Kilima Njaro, 70.
-
- Coast towns defence, 63.
-
- Command of Lake Tanganyika, 29.
-
- Communications cut off, 34.
-
- Concentration at Pugu, 21.
-
- Congo Act, against England, 19.
-
- Containing the enemy on Uganda, 77.
-
- Cook, Lieutenant, 101st Grenadier Guards, 45.
-
- Cotton spinning, 69.
-
- Cutsch, Lieutenant, 221.
-
- Cutting down rations, 176.
-
-
- D
-
- Dar-es-Salaam:
- first action, artillery fire, 27;
- negotiations for surrender, 28;
- English ships appear, 52;
- English Consul King, 20;
- internment at, 323;
- embarkation, 325.
-
- _Delcommune_, Belgian steamer, destroyed, 29.
-
- Delschitz, Lieutenant von, 97.
-
- Dessel, Dr., 38.
-
- Destructiveness of termites, 30.
-
- Deventer, General van:
- arrives, 138;
- at Kondoa, 144;
- at Kilossa, 146;
- at Kilwa, 200;
- calls for surrender, 235;
- telegram of Armistice, 315;
- conditions of Armistice, 317.
-
- Dickinson, Colonel (English), 284, 318.
-
- Discontent at Logeloge, 163.
-
- District Commissioner, 6.
-
- Dodoma, enemy reach, 145.
-
- Dsalla, Lake, 110.
-
- Dürr, Father, 10.
-
- Dutumi action, 156;
- abandoned, 157.
-
-
- E
-
- Edwards, General (English), 255, 262, 320.
-
- Embarkation, January 17th, 1919, 325.
-
- Enemy, The:
- vital point, 4;
-
- Enemy, The:
- propaganda captured, 86;
- scouts use poisoned arrows, 90;
- advances north-west and south-west, 140;
- take a rest, 158.
-
- Engare Len, 78.
-
- England among our enemies, 18.
-
- English Consul King, 20;
- naval expedition, 97;
- plans discovered, 290;
- recruits make good, 104;
- spies active, 99.
-
- Enslin, General, 154.
-
- Erdmann, Second Lieutenant, killed, 63.
-
- Erok Mountain ambush, 64.
-
- Europeans and natives interned, 320.
-
-
- F
-
- Falkenstein, Captain, 84.
-
- Fate of German possessions, 3.
-
- Feilke, Captain, 31, 51, 134, 174.
-
- Field companies increased, 71.
-
- Fife, enemy depots captured, 310.
-
- First action, Dar-es-Salaam, 27.
-
- First journey of inspection, 4.
-
- First Masai:
- pure Hamites, 10;
- original Jews, 10;
- characteristics, 10.
-
- Fischer, Major, 119.
-
- Franken, Lieutenant, 97, 186.
-
- French missionary propaganda, 14.
-
- Freund, Lieutenant, 291, 296.
-
-
- G
-
- Galula, 307.
-
- Gararagua encounters, 110.
-
- Garrod, Major (English), captured, 292.
-
- Gerlich, Lieutenant, killed, 63.
-
- German Fleet revolt, 318;
- patrol rides into enemy camp, 144;
- possessions, fate of, 3.
-
- German prisoners, British treatment of, 221;
- Reservists mobilized, 22;
- Revolution, 318;
- settlers source of military power, 7.
-
- Goering, Captain, 210;
- wounded, 301.
-
- _Goetzen_, steamer:
- building, 84;
- completed, 96;
- sunk, 186.
-
- Gold Coast Hill, enemy grenade attack, 169.
-
- Gore-Brown, Major (English), drowned, 276.
-
- Gothein, Lieutenant Dr., 99.
-
- Grabow, Master Butcher, 40.
-
- Grawert, Major von, surrenders, 188.
-
- Grote, Lieutenant, 75;
- died, 121.
-
- Gudovius, wounded and prisoner, 185.
-
- Guerilla warfare imperative, 63;
- commenced, 64.
-
- _Gwendoline_, steamer, 99.
-
-
- H
-
- Hammerstein, Captain von, 18 31, 38, 42, 44, 56, 58;
- died of wounds, 63.
-
- Handeni, collecting station, 130.
-
- Hasslacher, Lieutenant, killed, 186.
-
- Haun, Lieutenant, 96.
-
- Haxthausen, Lieutenant von, 89.
-
- _Hedwig von Wissmann_, steamer, 14;
- captured, 28, 100.
-
- Henneberger, Lieutenant, 86.
-
- Hering’s battery, 43.
-
- Hiffmeister, Veterinary Officer, 12.
-
- Himo, 32.
-
- Hindenburg’s name not heard of, 48.
-
- Horn, Lieutenant, 28, 94;
- builds cottages, 130.
-
- Hoskins, Major (English), 200.
-
- Huber, Dr., 323.
-
- Huebner, Lieutenant, surrenders, 186.
-
- Hulua Mountain, 300.
-
- Hüttich, Sergt.-Major, 280.
-
- _Hyacinth_, The, off Tanga, 86.
-
-
- I
-
- Ili, 266;
- return to, 290;
- English plans discovered, 290.
-
- Imminence of universal war, 3.
-
- Inagu, von Schroetter’s escape, 261.
-
- Indian Brigade, 42;
- Expeditionary Force, 25, 44.
-
- Influenza epidemic, 302, 324.
-
- Insufficient interest of authorities, 10.
-
- Internment of Europeans and natives, 320.
-
- Iringa, 15.
-
- Irangi:
- enemy shell headquarters, 138;
- food in abundance, 139;
- series of actions, 139;
- enemy casualties heavy, 139;
- general view of position, 140.
-
-
- J
-
- Jantzen, Lieutenant, 207.
-
- Jassini. _See_ YASIN.
-
- Jericho, 97.
-
- Jews, first Masai the original, 10.
-
- Jipe, Lake, 108, 125.
-
- Johannes, Lieut.-Colonel, 10.
-
-
- K
-
- Kaempfe, Lieutenant, 87.
-
- Kahe, 121;
- our retreat, 123.
-
- Kaiser’s, The, abdication, 318.
-
- Kajambi Catholic Mission, 312.
-
- Kaltenborn, Captain von, 130.
-
- Kanene, 250, 302.
-
- Kanga Mountain encounters, 142.
-
- Karongo, 98.
-
- Kasama captured, 313.
-
- Kasigao Mountain action, 75.
-
- Kauffman, Second Lieutenant, killed, 63.
-
- Kayense, 47.
-
- Kempner, Lieutenant, 319.
-
- Kepler, Major, 57;
- killed, 63.
-
- Kibata:
- occupied, 167;
- guns brought up, 167;
- congratulations of General Smuts, 170.
-
- Kidodi heliograph station, 18.
-
- Kifumbiro, 89.
-
- Kigoma (Tanganyika), 13;
- as naval base, 95.
-
- Kilima Njaro:
- supply depot, 32;
- activities at, 68;
- cotton shortage, 69;
- making cloth, tyres, motor fuel and boots, 70;
- bridge building, 70.
-
- Kilimatinde, best buffaloes in East Africa, 12.
-
- Kilossa, 145.
-
- Kilwa:
- demands attention, 159;
- Commissioner taken prisoner, 159;
- enemy dumps surprised, 192;
- bombarding enemy transports, 193;
- enemy’s strong forces, 200.
-
- Kimamba depot, 133.
-
- King, English Consul, 7, 20.
-
- _Kingani_, steamer, 95;
- lost, 98.
-
- Kirnamba, 31.
-
- Kissaki:
- stores destroyed, 152;
- enemy defeated, 153, 155;
- prisoners taken, 155.
-
- Kissangire Station, 123;
- minor engagements, 164.
-
- Kissenyi fighting, 92.
-
- Kissi Mountains, 173.
-
- Kissija:
- capture of enemy propaganda, 86;
- enemy driven out, 164.
-
- Kitangari, 223.
-
- Kitendu, enemy division surrounded, 188.
-
- Kituta, 96.
-
- Kivu, Lake, 91, 98, 126, 140, 185.
-
- Klein, Sergt.-Major, killed, 214.
-
- Klinghardt, Captain, 93, 126, 134, 142, 144, 145.
-
- Koehl, Captain, 68, 112, 179, 204;
- transport surprised, 256.
-
- Kokosani (Namacurra), 272;
- Portuguese heavy losses, 273;
- search for ammunition, 273;
- large supplies captured, 276.
-
- Kondoa:
- occupied, 135;
- fight in the dark, 137;
- English civil administration, 137.
-
- Kondoa-Irangi:
- enemy shell Headquarters, 138;
- food in abundance, 139;
- series of actions, 139;
- enemy heavy losses, 139;
- general view of position, 140.
-
- Konduchi, 27.
-
- _Königsberg_, The, 19;
- puts to sea, 28;
- destroys English cruiser _Pegasus_, 84;
- concealed in Rufiji delta, 84;
- blown up, 85;
- ten guns salved, 85;
- Adjutant recaptured, 85.
-
- Koriwa, Wunderlich wounded, 251.
-
- Kornatzki, Captain von, 33, 52.
-
- Korogwe, 31, 33, 36.
-
- Kraut, Major, 29, 182, 184, 323.
-
- Kraut, Captain, 32, 47.
-
- Kröber, Railway Commissary, 36, 57, 79.
-
- Kroeger, Lieutenant, killed, 214.
-
- Krüger, Secretary, 30.
-
- Kühlwein, Herr, 162.
-
- Kungulio:
- Enemy defeat, 172;
- hippo shooting, 160.
-
- Kurungu, our envelopment fails, 205.
-
- Kwiri, field hospital left behind, 259.
-
-
- L
-
- Lake Amaramba, 302.
-
- ” Bangweolo, 311.
-
- ” Dsalla, 110.
-
- ” Jipe, 108, 125.
-
- ” Kivu, 91, 98, 126, 140, 185.
-
- ” Moero, 322.
-
- ” Nyassa, 98, 306.
-
- ” Rukwa, 189, 306.
-
- ” Tanganyika, 29, 52.
-
- ” Tshahafi, 92.
-
- ” Utungi, 174, 177, 179, 188.
-
- ” Victoria, 47, 88.
-
- Lang, Lieutenant, 92.
-
- Langenburg:
- fertility and native industries, 15;
- ours for eighteen months, 99.
-
- Langenn, Major von, 96, 98, 185, 186;
- division loses heavily, 187.
-
- Ledebur, Freiherr von, 8.
-
- Lembeni country, 124;
- aeroplanes brought down, 140.
-
- “Lettow Schnapps,” 195.
-
- Liebermann, Captain von, 164, 200, 202.
-
- Ligonja, 282.
-
- Lincke, Captain, 136.
-
- Lindi, 196.
-
- Lioma:
- retirement after heavy fighting, 296;
- transport detachment lost, 299;
- severe enemy losses, 299.
-
- Logeloge discontent, 163.
-
- Lolkisale Mountain:
- 28th Company surrender, 126;
- Captain Rothert wounded, 126.
-
- Longido Mountain:
- English attack, 67;
- enemy reinforced, 106.
-
- Low level of musketry training, 9.
-
- Luambala, 242, 303.
-
- Lugella:
- depot captured, 268;
- no ammunition found, 270.
-
- Lukuledi, 213;
- conference on aspects, 216.
-
- Lupembe, enemy retire, 187.
-
- Luscheringe River, 304.
-
- Lusinje, Captain Wienholt captured, 248.
-
- Lutende:
- enemy surprised and routed, 199;
- English commanding officer wounded, 199.
-
- Luwungi, 92, 98.
-
- Lyncker, Lieutenant von, 106.
-
-
- M
-
- Mafia Island, English take, 86.
-
- Magad Railway, 65.
-
- Mahenge country, 141.
-
- Mahiwa:
- flank surprise, 211;
- severe fighting, 211;
- enemy defeat absolute, 211;
- guns and ammunition captured, 213.
-
- Mahua, 246, 250.
-
- Makatan, English defeat, 74.
-
- Makima headquarters, 165.
-
- Makoti, enemy retire with heavy losses, 254.
-
- Malangali action, 149, 182;
- Wahehe chief rebels, 182.
-
- Malaria, native immunity against, 24.
-
- Malema:
- fertility of, 261;
- enemy advance, 262;
- difficulties of bush tactics, 262;
- Boma captured, 260.
-
- Malleson, General (English), 74, 106.
-
- Mara Bay, 90.
-
- Marangu, 105.
-
- Masai, first, 10.
-
- Massako, 98.
-
- Matendu floods, 197.
-
- Matuschka, Lieutenant, 80.
-
- Mawa action, 179.
-
- Maximum strength, 72.
-
- Mayita, 90.
-
- Mbinji fruit, 241.
-
- Mbizi depot, 307.
-
- Mbosi Mission, 15;
- reports of English intentions, June, 1914, 15;
- country, 96.
-
- Mbuyuni, 73, 79.
-
- Mechanical transport, 50.
-
- Meda, 245.
-
- Medical supplies, 195.
-
- Meinhertshagen, Captain (English), 44.
-
- Meixner, Dr., 259.
-
- Merensky, Lieutenant, 36, 38.
-
- Merker, M., and the Masai, 10.
-
- Michels, District Commissioner, 146.
-
- Mihambia, bombs dropped, 203.
-
- Mirow, Sergt.-Major, killed, 168.
-
- Mkulu Mountain, 239.
-
- Mlali, enemy advance, 150.
-
- Mletere, 299.
-
- Mobilization, August, 1914-18, not extended to overseas, 18;
- Reservists, 22.
-
- Moero, Lake, 312.
-
- _Moewe_, steamer, 19, 28, 91, 94.
-
- Mori Bay, 89.
-
- Morogoro as base, 142;
- headquarters, 146;
- enemy converge on, 149.
-
- Moshi, 52.
-
- Mosquito, The, 25.
-
- Moving forces to Northern Railway, 29.
-
- Mpapua action, 145.
-
- Mpili, 224.
-
- Mpoororo, 91.
-
- Mpotora base, 181.
-
- Msalu river, 247.
-
- Mtende, 246, 248.
-
- _Muanza_, steamer, 47, 87, 88, 89.
-
- Mujeba, 270.
-
- Mujebain, 280.
-
- Müller, Staff Surgeon, 46, 196.
-
- Musketry training low level, 9.
-
- Musslin, Major-General, 248.
-
- Musoma, 89.
-
- Mwasge Mission, 96.
-
- Mwembe, 191, 242, 304.
-
- Mwenzo Mission, 311.
-
- Mwurnoni, 56.
-
- My early experiences, 16.
-
- Mzima Camp, 69.
-
-
- N
-
- Nagawamira, 304.
-
- Namacurra. _See_ KOKOSANI.
-
- Nambindinga, 220;
- reducing the strength, 220.
-
- Namirrue:
- enemy routed, 283;
- Colonel Dickinson captured, 284;
- Lieut. Ruckteschell wounded, 286;
- Lieutenant Silke killed, 286;
- enemy annihilated, 286.
-
- Nampepo, roast pork and brawn, 267.
-
- Namunu, 245.
-
- Nangwale, 238.
-
- Nanungu concentration, 242.
-
- Narungombe:
- enemy flee in disorder, 202;
- Liebermann’s great success, 202.
-
- Narunyu, enemy attack, 205.
-
- Native carrier difficulty, 24;
- interchange of communications, 13;
- method of warfare, 9;
- immunity against malaria, 24;
- industries, 15.
-
- Naumann, Captain, 189, 221.
-
- Naval guns salved from the Königsberg, 85.
-
- Ndanda Catholic Mission, 206.
-
- Nevale, 224.
-
- New Moshi, 32, 33, 36;
- headquarters, 49;
- pleasant times at, 59;
- aeroplane drops bombs, 113;
- abandoned, 119.
-
- New Steglitz headquarters, 116.
-
- New supply detachment raised, 179.
-
- News:
- from home, 67;
- of German Fleet revolt, 318;
- German Revolution, Kaiser’s abdication, 318.
-
- Ngaula, enemy routed, 193.
-
- Ngomano action, 230.
-
- Niemeyer, Commander, 7.
-
- Njango Camp, 204;
- telegram from His Majesty, 204.
-
- Nordenholz, Sergt.-Major, 291.
-
- Northey, General, 140, 149.
-
- North Pare Mountains, 125.
-
- Numarroe, 291.
-
- Nyanza hostile enterprises, 47.
-
- Nyassa, Lake, 98.
-
-
- O
-
- Old Askari, 10.
-
- Old 1871 rifle, 8.
-
- Oldorobo Mountain, 80;
- enemy retreat in disorder, 104;
- English recruiting bait, 104;
- English orders, “Take no prisoners,” 104.
-
- Old Utengule Mission, 307.
-
- Oriva occupied, 280.
-
- Ott, Lieutenant, wounded, 292.
-
- Otto, Captain, 58, 145, 172, 179.
-
- Our movements from North-West to Central, 127.
-
- Our departure from North final, 129.
-
-
- P
-
- Pangire Mission, 305.
-
- Pare Mountains, 125.
-
- _Pegasus_, English cruiser, 27, 84.
-
- Pekera captured, 287.
-
- Peramiho Mission, 305.
-
- Poisoned arrows used by enemy, 90.
-
- Police Askari, 6.
-
- Poppe, Captain, wounded, 295.
-
- Pori (bush) difficulties, 12;
- not easy to disappear in, 13.
-
- Portuguese:
- invade Makonde, 165;
- driven into their territory, 166;
- territory entered, 190.
-
- _President_, steamer, 84, 198.
-
- Prince, Captain von, 4, 32, 41, 45.
-
- Protective Force, 6;
- strength of, 19.
-
- Pugu, concentration of troops, 21.
-
-
- Q
-
- Quelimane, 265.
-
- Quinine production, 71.
-
-
- R
-
- Ras-Kasone, 36, 39.
-
- Rations cut down, 176.
-
- Reata-Kahe:
- our withdrawal by night, 114;
- evacuated, 116;
- enemy occupy, 116.
-
- Reata-Latima Mountain repulse, 114.
-
- Reata-North defences, 111.
-
- Recke, Lieutenant, killed, 89.
-
- Regone, 293.
-
- Rentell, Engineer, 71.
-
- Reservists mobilized, 22.
-
- Revolt of German Fleet, 318.
-
- Revolution in Germany, 318.
-
- Rifle, old 1871, 8.
-
- Rothe, Director of Postal Service, 30.
-
- Rothert, Captain, 119, 125.
-
- Rotterdam welcome, 325.
-
- Ruckteschell, Lieutenant von, 75, 147, 286.
-
- Rufiji, Delta, 84;
- loss of the Königsberg, 85;
- enemy advance on, 160;
- evacuated at rainy season, 180.
-
- Rugesi Passage, 89.
-
- Ruhudje, fighting on the, 184.
-
- Rukwa, Lake, 306.
-
- Ruponda, we lose supplies, 208.
-
- Russissi minor actions, 93.
-
- Rwiba Mount, 308.
-
-
- S
-
- Saidi, 251.
-
- Salt supplies, 194.
-
- Schaefer, Lieutenant, 57.
-
- Schaefner, Lieutenant, 259.
-
- Schimmer, Captain, 93.
-
- Schleuntz, Colonel von, 8.
-
- Schnee, Dr., 27.
-
- Schmid, Captain, 31.
-
- Schoenfeld, Lieut.-Commander, 7, 85, 144.
-
- Schottstaedt, Lieutenant, 45.
-
- Schroetter, Lieutenant von, 51, 260, 296.
-
- Schulz, Captain, 33, 94, 98, 130, 146, 163, 167.
-
- Second store-ship arrives, 117.
-
- Selke, Lieutenant, killed, 286.
-
- Selous killed, 171.
-
- “Shensi” spies, 108.
-
- Shirarti, 89.
-
- Singida stud farms, 11.
-
- Sisal plant, 56.
-
- Smith-Dorrien, General, 104.
-
- Smuts, General:
- takes over command from Smith-Dorrien, 104;
- at Kitovo, 110;
- at Handeni, 142;
- calls for surrender at Uluguru Mountains, 158;
- congratulates Von Lettow on decoration, 170;
- operations wrecked on Rufiji, 172;
- relieved by General Hoskins, 200.
-
- South Pare Mountains, 76.
-
- Spalding, Lieutenant, killed, 63.
-
- Spangenberg, Captain, 323;
- died, 324.
-
- Sphinx Harbour, 100.
-
- Ssongea, enemy at, 304.
-
- Ssonyo treachery, 87.
-
- Stemmermann, Captain, 113, 146, 153.
-
- Sternheim, Lieutenant, 114.
-
- Stewart, General (English), 110.
-
- Stolowsky, Staff Surgeon, 195.
-
- Store-ships arrive, 67, 117.
-
- Strength of Protective Force, 19.
-
- Struwe, Sergt.-Major, 192.
-
- Stud farms at Singida, 11.
-
- Stuemer, Major von, 87, 130, 134, 190, 207.
-
- Supplies devoured at depots, 174.
-
- Supply system, 23.
-
- Supreme military power, 21.
-
- Surgery under difficulties, 196.
-
- Surrender:
- Smuts calls for, 158;
- Deventer calls for, 235.
-
- Swahili, 15.
-
- _Sybil_, steamer (English), 88, 90.
-
-
- T
-
- _Tabora_, hospital ship, 51.
-
- Tabora retirement, 186.
-
- Tafel, Captain, 22, 28, 33, 132, 178.
-
- Tafeli surrender, 236.
-
- “Take no prisoners,” English order, 104.
-
- Tanga:
- hostile cruisers off, 35.
- plans for defence, 36;
- enemy attack, 41;
- British North Lancashire Regiment defeat, 42;
- enemy mowed down, 42;
- transfer of wounded, 44.
-
- Tanganyika, Lake, command of, 29.
-
- ” Railway, 52.
-
- Taveta, 29, 33.
-
- Termites, 30.
-
- Thierfelder, Dr., 195.
-
- Thurmann, Sergt.-Major, killed, 296.
-
- Timbani Mountain, 256;
- Koehl’s transport surprised, 256.
-
- Tipa, Boma, 282.
-
- Tombeur, Belgian commander at Kivu, 92.
-
- Tombwe post captured, 95.
-
- _Tomondo_, steamer, 159.
-
- Treachery of Ssonyo, 87.
-
- Trench mortar captured, 286.
-
- Tse-tse fly, 11;
- plague, 26.
-
- Tshahafi, Lake, 92.
-
- Tuliani headquarters bombed, 143.
-
- Tunduru district, 192.
-
- Tunga:
- enormous booty, 45;
- our losses insignificant, 45.
-
-
- U
-
- Ubena, 306.
-
- Uganda Railway, containing the enemy on, 4, 77.
-
- Ukerewe, 89.
-
- Unconditional “surrender” or “evacuation,” 319.
-
- Unindi, enemy repulsed, 200.
-
- Universal war imminent, 3.
-
- Unprepared for war, 10.
-
- Unterrichter, Lieutenant von, 68.
-
- Usambara country, 4;
- volunteer rifle corps, 4.
-
- Utengule (Old) Mission, 307.
-
- Utungi, Lake, 172, 174, 177, 179, 188.
-
-
- V
-
- Victoria, Lake, 47, 88;
- in English hands, 87.
-
- Volunteer Rifle Corps at Usambara, 4.
-
- Vorbeck, General von Lettow-:
- landing at Dar-es-Salaam, 3;
- tour of inspection, 4;
- buffalo hunting, 13;
- water on the knee, 13;
- a raw hand, 16;
- early experiences, 16;
- had malaria ten times, 25;
- slightly wounded, 138;
- congratulated by Smuts, 170;
- experiments in bread-making, 193;
- wireless from Kaiser, 204;
- Deventer calls for surrender, 235;
- hippo shooting, 240;
- receives news of German offensive, Western Front, 248;
- operation on toe, 249;
- injury to eye, 249;
- Deventer’s telegram of Armistice, 315;
- and conditions of surrender, 317;
- sends telegram to Kaiser, 317;
- no reply from German Government, 319;
- declines Colonel Hawkins’ invitation, 319;
- Deventer’s reply to protest, 321;
- at Kigoma, 322;
- at Tabora and at Morogoro, 323;
- at Dar-es-Salaam, December 8th, 1918. Embarked January 17th, 1919,
- 325;
- reached Rotterdam, 325.
-
-
- W
-
- Waganda Warriors, 47.
-
- Wahehe tribe, 32.
-
- Wahle, Major-General, 23, 31, 51, 97, 140, 184 _et seq._, 323.
-
- _Waimi_, steamer, 86;
- blown up, 186.
-
- Wajagga tribe, 24, 32.
-
- Wamaka, 288.
-
- Wangoni desertions, 305.
-
- Wassukuma people, 91.
-
- Water-finding, 80.
-
- Welcome at Rotterdam, 325.
-
- White Fathers, 14.
-
- Wienholt, Lieutenant, capture and escape, 143.
-
- Wienholt, Captain, captured, 248.
-
- Wilhelmstal native police, 6.
-
- Wintgens, Captain, 91, 185, 186;
- division captures gun, 187;
- taken prisoner, 189.
-
- Winzer, Sergt.-Major, gets through, 188.
-
- Wülfingen, Captain Bock von, 87.
-
- Wunderlich, Lieut.-Commander, wounded, 251.
-
-
- Y
-
- Yasin. _See_ JASSINI:
- enemy advance, 30;
- country, 34;
- English concentration, 56;
- our attack, 58;
- enemy surrender, 61.
-
-
- Z
-
- Zambesi Ferry, 314.
-
- Zelewski’s expedition, 15.
-
- _Ziethen_, steamer, 86.
-
- Zimmer, Captain, 28, 82, 93, 94.
-
-_Printed at The Chapel River Press, Kingston, Surrey._
-
-
-
-
- FOOTNOTES:
-
-[1] M. Merker, “Die Masai,” Berlin, 1904 (2nd Edition, 1910).
-
-[2] Askari are “soldiers,” not a distinct tribe.
-
-[3] Seitenschlag.
-
-[4] We have no corresponding rank. He is a reservist who has served as
-a “One-year Volunteer,” but has not yet done enough reserve training to
-qualify as an Officer in the Reserve.
-
-[5] The English Government issued to us articles of food for the
-English prisoners which we could not get for ourselves.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of My Reminiscences of East Africa, by
-General von Lettow-Vorbeck
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK MY REMINISCENCES OF EAST AFRICA ***
-
-***** This file should be named 51746-0.txt or 51746-0.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/1/7/4/51746/
-
-Produced by Giovanni Fini, Brian Coe and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive/Canadian Libraries)
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org
-
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
diff --git a/old/51746-0.zip b/old/51746-0.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 92abc4b..0000000
--- a/old/51746-0.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h.zip b/old/51746-h.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index c8d80f2..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/51746-h.htm b/old/51746-h/51746-h.htm
deleted file mode 100644
index c5df276..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/51746-h.htm
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,14664 +0,0 @@
-<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
- "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
-<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
- <head>
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=utf-8" />
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" />
- <title>
- The Project Gutenberg eBook of My Reminiscences of East Africa, by General von Lettow-Vorbeck.
- </title>
- <link rel="coverpage" href="images/cover.jpg" />
- <style type="text/css">
-
-body {margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%;}
-div.limit {max-width: 35em; margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto;}
-div.chapter {page-break-before: always;}
-.vh {visibility: hidden;}
-.wn {font-weight: normal; font-size: 80%;}
-.wn2 {font-weight: normal; font-size: 90%;}
-
- h1,h2 {text-align: center; clear: both;}
-
-.ln1 {position: absolute; text-align: right; top: auto; margin-left: -1em;}
-
-p {margin-top: 0.2em; text-align: justify; margin-bottom: 0em; text-indent: 1.5em;}
-.pi6 {text-indent: 0em; padding-left: 6em;}
-.pc {text-align: center; text-indent: 0em;}
-.pc1 {margin-top: 1em; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em;}
-.pc2 {margin-top: 2em; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em;}
-.pc4 {margin-top: 4em; text-align: center; text-indent: 0em;}
-.pbq {line-height: 1em; text-indent: 1.2em; font-size: 90%; margin-left: 5%; margin-right: 5%;}
-.pni {margin-top: 0.5em; font-size: 90%; text-align: left; margin-left: 5%; text-indent: -1em;}
-.pnii {margin-top: 0em; font-size: 90%; text-align: left; margin-left: 10%; text-indent: -1em;}
-.pfn4 {margin-top: 1em; font-size: 90%; text-indent: 0em; margin-left: 4em; margin-right: 1em;}
-.ptn {margin-top: 0.3em; text-indent: -1em; margin-left: 2%;}
-
-.p1 {margin-top: 1em;}
-.p2 {margin-top: 2em;}
-.p4 {margin-top: 4em;}
-
-.small {font-size: 75%;}
-.reduct {font-size: 90%;}
-.lmid {font-size: 110%;}
-.mid {font-size: 125%;}
-.large {font-size: 150%;}
-.elarge {font-size: 175%;}
-.xlarge {font-size: 200%;}
-
-hr {width: 33%; margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 2em; margin-left: 33.5%; margin-right: 33.5%; clear: both; color: black;}
-hr.chap {width: 65%; margin-left: 17.5%; margin-right: 17.5%;}
-hr.d1 {width: 95%; margin-left: 2.5%; margin-right: 2.5%; margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 0.2em; border: solid 3px;}
-hr.d2 {width: 95%; margin-left: 2.5%; margin-right: 2.5%; margin-top: 0.2em; margin-bottom: 4em;}
-
-table {margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto;}
- .tch {text-align: center; width: 4em;}
- .ti1 {text-align: justify; font-size: 130%; vertical-align: top; padding-top: 0.8em; padding-left: 2em; text-indent: -2em;}
- .ti2 {text-align: justify; vertical-align: top; padding-left: 4em; text-indent: 1.5em;}
- .ti3 {text-align: justify; vertical-align: top; padding-top: 0.2em; padding-left: 2em; text-indent: -2em;}
- .tdr1 {text-align: right; vertical-align: bottom; padding-left: 0.5em; width: 1em;}
-
-#toc1, #toc2, #toc3 {width: 95%; font-size: 90%; line-height: 1em; margin-top: 1em;}
-#tom {width: 75%; line-height: 1em; margin-top: 1em;}
-#toi {width: 60%; line-height: 1em; margin-top: 1em;}
-
-.pagenum { /* visibility: hidden; */ position: absolute; left: 94%; color: gray;
- font-size: smaller; text-align: right; text-indent: 0em; font-style: normal; font-weight: normal;}
-
-.smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
-.caption {font-weight: bold;}
-
-.figcenter {margin: auto; text-align: center; margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 2em;}
-
-.pc400 {margin-top: 0em; width: 25.5em; margin-left: auto; margin-right: auto; text-align: center; margin-bottom: 0.5em; text-indent: 0em;}
-
-.footnotes {border: dashed 1px; padding: 1em;}
-.label {position: absolute; right: 84%; text-align: right;}
-.fnanchor {vertical-align: super; font-size: .8em; text-decoration: none; font-style: normal; font-weight: normal;}
-
-p.drop-cap00 {padding-top: 2em; text-indent: 0em;}
-p.drop-cap04 {padding-top: 2em; text-indent: -0.4em;}
-p.drop-cap06 {padding-top: 2em; text-indent: -0.6em;}
-p.drop-cap08 {padding-top: 2em; text-indent: -0.8em;}
-p.drop-cap10 {padding-top: 2em; text-indent: -1em;}
-p.drop-cap16 {padding-top: 2em; text-indent: -1.6em;}
-p.drop-cap18 {padding-top: 2em; text-indent: -1.8em;}
-
-p.drop-cap00:first-letter,
-p.drop-cap04:first-letter,
-p.drop-cap06:first-letter,
-p.drop-cap08:first-letter,
-p.drop-cap10:first-letter,
-p.drop-cap16:first-letter,
-p.drop-cap18:first-letter
- {float: left; margin: 0.07em 0.1em 0em 0em; font-size: 480%; line-height:0.85em;}
-
-@media handheld {p.drop-cap00:first-letter,
- p.drop-cap04:first-letter,
- p.drop-cap06:first-letter,
- p.drop-cap08:first-letter,
- p.drop-cap10:first-letter,
- p.drop-cap16:first-letter,
- p.drop-cap18:first-letter
- {float: none; margin: 0; font-size: 100%;}
-}
-
-.transnote {background-color: #E6E6FA; color: black; font-size:smaller; padding:0.5em; margin-bottom:5em; font-family:sans-serif, serif; }
- </style>
- </head>
-<body>
-
-
-<pre>
-
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of My Reminiscences of East Africa, by
-General von Lettow-Vorbeck
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-Title: My Reminiscences of East Africa
-
-Author: General von Lettow-Vorbeck
-
-Release Date: April 12, 2016 [EBook #51746]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK MY REMINISCENCES OF EAST AFRICA ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Giovanni Fini, Brian Coe and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive/Canadian Libraries)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
-<div class="limit">
-
-<div class="chapter">
-<div class="transnote p4">
-<p class="pc large">TRANSCRIBER’S NOTES:</p>
-<p class="ptn">&mdash;Obvious print and punctuation errors were corrected.</p>
-<p class="ptn">&mdash;The transcriber of this project created the book cover
-image using the title page of the original book. The image
-is placed in the public domain.</p>
-</div>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_i" id="Page_i">[i]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<p class="pc4 xlarge"><i>My Reminiscences of East Africa</i></p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_ii" id="Page_ii">[ii]</a></span></p>
-<p>&nbsp;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_iii" id="Page_iii">[iii]</a></span></p>
-<p>&nbsp;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_iv" id="Page_iv">[iv]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/fr.jpg" width="400" height="571" id="fr"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc">General von Lettow-Vorbeck.</p>
-</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_v" id="Page_v">[v]</a></span></p>
-
-<h1 class="p2"><i><span class="smcap large">My Reminiscences<br />
-of East Africa</span></i></h1>
-
-<p class="pc elarge"><i>By General von Lettow-Vorbeck</i></p>
-
-<hr class="d1" />
-<hr class="d2" />
-
-
-<p class="pc4 lmid"><i>With Portrait, 22 Maps and Sketch-Maps,<br />
-∷<span class="vh">&mdash;&mdash;</span>∷<span class="vh">&mdash;&mdash;</span>and 13 Drawings<span class="vh">&mdash;&mdash;</span>∷<span class="vh">&mdash;&mdash;</span>∷<br />
-By General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant</i></p>
-
-<p class="pc4 mid"><i>LONDON: HURST AND BLACKETT, LTD.<br />
-PATERNOSTER HOUSE, E.C.</i></p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_vi" id="Page_vi">[vi]</a></span></p>
-<p>&nbsp;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_vii" id="Page_vii">[vii]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">PREFACE</h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">IN all the German colonies, though but a few decades old, a life
-full of promise was discernible. We were beginning to understand
-the national value of our colonial possessions; settlers and
-capital were venturing in; industries and factories were beginning
-to flourish. Compared with that of other nations, the colonizing
-process of Germany had progressed peacefully and steadily, and the
-inhabitants had confidence in the justice of German administration.
-This development had barely commenced when it was destroyed by
-the world war. In spite of all tangible proofs to the contrary, an
-unjustifiable campaign of falsehood is being conducted in order to
-make the world believe that the Germans lacked colonizing talent
-and were cruel to the natives.</p>
-
-<p>A small force, mainly composed of these very natives, opposed this
-development. Almost without any external means of coercion, even
-without immediate payment, this force, with its numerous native
-followers, faithfully followed its German leaders throughout the whole
-of the prolonged war against a more than hundredfold superiority.
-When the armistice came it was still fit to fight, and imbued with the
-best soldierly spirit. That is a fact which cannot be controverted,
-and is in itself a sufficient answer to the hostile mis-statements.</p>
-
-<p>It has not been possible for me to give an exhaustive account of the
-operations of the German East African Protective Force. The
-existing material is insufficient, much has been lost, and even now I
-am unacquainted with various events, the actors in which have not
-yet returned home. My own records have for the most part been lost,
-and I had not the leisure to prepare a detailed description of the campaign
-in East Africa in addition to my other duties. My account is
-therefore necessarily incomplete. In the main I must rely upon my
-memory and on my personal experiences. Errors in detail are unavoidable.</p>
-
-<p>But in spite of this, the following account may not be without value,
-nor perhaps without interest, since it shows how what is up to the
-present the greatest drama in our colonial history was enacted in the
-head of him who was destined to conduct the military side of it. I
-have endeavoured to set down my recollections of East Africa as they
-actually are, and thus at least to present what is subjectively correct.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_viii" id="Page_viii">[viii]</a></span></p>
-<p>&nbsp;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_ix" id="Page_ix">[ix]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CONTENTS</h2>
-
-<p class="pc2 mid">PART I</p>
-<p class="pc1 lmid"><span class="smcap">Events previous to the Arrival of the<br />
-South Africans</span></p>
-
-<table id="toc1" summary="cont1">
-
- <tr>
- <td> </td>
- <td class="tdr1"><span class="small">PAGE</span></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER I.: <span class="smcap">Before the Outbreak of War</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_3">3</a></td>
- </tr>
-
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Reflections on the duties and purpose of the Protective Force.
-Details of the defensive capacity of the Colony. Distribution,
-armament and training of the Force. Military employment and
-mental attitude of the natives. Economic value of the country, and
-furtherance of the economic power of the natives. Horse-breeding
-and hunting. Several tours of inspection. National propaganda
-on the part of subsequently hostile Missions in the neighbouring
-territories.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER II.: <span class="smcap">The Beginning of the War</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_18">18</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Arrival of news of mobilization. Participation in the war or
-neutrality? The strength of the Protective Force and the English
-casualties. The English Consul and his activity. The Governor of
-the Colony, the supreme military authority, and the defence of the
-coastal towns. Preparations for mobilization. Lines of communication,
-maintenance and supplies. Sanitation. Malaria.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER III.: <span class="smcap">The First Actions</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_27">27</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Bombardment of the wireless tower at Dar-es-Salaam. Negotiations
-for capitulation by the civil authorities. The <i>Königsberg</i>
-and the <i>Möve</i>. Capture of Taveta. Transfer of the main body
-to the Northern Railway. New telegraphic communications. Bombardment
-of Bagamoyo. Attack on the British Uganda Railway.
-Attacks on British Karunga on Lake Nyassa. Guerilla warfare in
-the North.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER IV.: <span class="smcap">The November Actions at Tanga</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_35">35</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Reconnaissances at Tanga. Appearance of an English landing
-corps. Concentration of all available troops. First combats at
-Ras-Kasone. Reconnaissance in abandoned Tanga. The surroundings
-of the probable field of battle. Disposition of the companies.
-The hostile landing. The attack. Unfavourable situation
-of the defenders. Counter-attack by the reinforcements.
-Headlong flight of the enemy. Failure of the pursuit. Harassing
-the enemy at the landing-place. Enormous English losses.
-The trained bees. Negotiations for release of the wounded.
-Great booty. Our own losses. In the hospitals. Simultaneous
-events at Longido Mountain.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER V.: <span class="smcap">Awaiting Further Events</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_49">49</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Withdrawal of the troops to New Moshi. Work at Headquarters.
-Motor transport <i>versus</i> carriers. Reconnaissances
-by motor. Supply and transport. Roads on the lines of communication.
-The burden of work and the joy of work. Abundant
-supplies. The starving Lieutenant. The joys of Sunday sport.
-Meat supply for the troops.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER VI.: <span class="smcap">Further Heavy Fighting in the North-East</span>
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_x" id="Page_x"><span class="small">[x]</span></a></span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_56">56</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Advance of hostile forces at Jassini. Reconnaissance in view
-of a possible battle. Advance of the German Companies against
-the English positions. Surprise and surrounding of the entrenched
-enemy. Bad fighting of the Arab Corps. Gallant defence by the
-enemy. Difficult situation of the attackers. The enemy hoists the
-white flag.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER VII.: <span class="smcap">Guerilla Warfare and Further
-Preparations</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_63">63</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Necessity for economizing men and stores. Care of the wounded.
-A wireless message from home. Raids in the Longido district.
-“A damned good piece of work.” Despatch of patrols to destroy
-the railway. Suffering and death in the steppe. Arrival of a relief
-ship. Feverish manufacture of ammunition. An advance near
-Oldorobo Mountain. Abundance of raw material and lack of
-finished articles. New industries to supply our needs. Roadmaking.
-Increase in numbers and fighting value of the troops.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER VIII.: <span class="smcap">Awaiting the Great Offensive.
-Energetic Use of the Time available</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_73">73</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER IX.: <span class="smcap">The Subsidiary Theatres of War.
-Guerilla Warfare Ashore and Afloat until New
-Year, 1916</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_82">82</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Hostile Masai attack on Lake Victoria. The <i>Königsberg</i> on the
-Rufiji. Her glorious end. Another success near Kilimandjaro.
-Determined attacks on the English railway. Attack and occupation
-of the English Camp on Kasigao Mountain. The enemy’s
-measures for protecting the railway. Fighting in the bush. Consideration
-of the possibility of resisting an attack by large hostile
-forces. Preparations for retiring to the South. Removal of stores.
-Determined defence of the position on Oldorobo Mountain. The
-new <i>Mungu</i>.</td>
- </tr>
-
-</table>
-
-<p class="pc2 mid">PART II</p>
-<p class="pc1 lmid"><span class="smcap">The Concentric Attack by Superior Forces</span><br />
-(From the arrival of the South African Troops to the loss of the
-Colony)</p>
-
-<table id="toc2" summary="cont2">
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER I.: <span class="smcap">The Enemy’s Attack at Oldorobo Mountain</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_103">103</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Several advances by the enemy. The fantastic armoured cars.
-The artillery combat. The South African troops. Alleged cruel
-orders by the enemy. Reinforcement of the enemy near Mount
-Longido. Fight with an Indian patrol. Chivalry of the white
-officers. Our brave Askari and the misleading of the English.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER II.: <span class="smcap">Further Advance of the Enemy and the
-Action at Reata</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_108">108</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Spies at work. The routes of the enemy’s advance. Possibilities
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_xi" id="Page_xi">[xi]</a></span>of defence. The enemy attacks at Kitovo Mountain. The strong
-position on the line Reata-Kitovo. The <i>Königsberg’s</i> gun.
-Reconnaissance by hostile cavalry. The enemy’s attack and
-attempt to surround us. Occupation of new defensive positions.
-The enemy’s withdrawal to Taveta. After the battle. Renewed
-forward movement by the enemy. Headquarters at Neusteglitz.
-A second relief ship.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER III.: <span class="smcap">Retreat before overwhelming Hostile
-Pressure</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_119">119</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Plans and considerations. Active attempts at reconnaissance by
-the enemy. Preparations for fighting. An attack on the hostile
-screen of patrols. Heavy losses. Fresh heavy attacks by the
-enemy (21st March). Failure of the counter-attack. An alarmist
-report: the enemy behind us. Retreat to Kissangire. The
-alarmist report proves to be false. Good spirits of the troops.
-Condition of the civilian population. Combat and surrender of the
-28th Company at Lokisale (5th April). Bringing up auxiliaries.
-Concentration of the troops on the Central Railway.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER IV.: <span class="smcap">The Enemy’s Advance in the Area of the
-Northern Railway</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_129">129</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Departure for Korogwe. At Handeni. News from Germany.
-Obstacles on the road. The swollen river. On horseback and by
-light railway to Kimamba. Reconnaissance south of Kondoa.
-Lines of communication and commissariat. In touch with the
-enemy. In position. The enemy seems to be evacuating his
-positions. An unexpected fight in the night. Our heavy losses.
-Successful patrols. Artillery duels. Obtaining supplies from the
-country. Failure of an attack by the enemy.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER V.: <span class="smcap">Between the Northern and Central
-Railways</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_140">140</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">The enemy advances on the whole northern front. Simultaneous
-attacks from the South. Slipping away and outflanking the
-enemy. Looking for the enemy’s weakest point. The smart
-patrol leader. The enemy’s aerial activity increases. Further
-advance to the South by General van Deventer. Weak German
-forces resist on a long line. Fighting near the Central Railway.
-Reconnaissances. Heavy fighting with the advancing enemy.
-On the Wami River.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER VI.: <span class="smcap">Continuous Fighting near the Rufiji</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_149">149</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Hostile attacks from the south-west. What will the enemy do?
-An attempt to surround us. The action at Mlali. Retreat to
-Kissaki. The moral effect of our retreat. The Boma of Kissaki.
-Securing our cattle supply. Defeat of the enemy on the 7th September.
-Annihilation of another hostile detachment. German
-humanity&mdash;English gratitude. A surprise attack at Dutumi (9th
-September). Dutumi must be abandoned.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER VII.: <span class="smcap">Hostile Attacks in the South-East of
-the Colony</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_159">159</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Our unfavourable position at Kilwa. Futile attacks by the
-enemy at Kissangire. Fat obtained from hippo and elephants.
-At Mpaganya. A pessimist sent about his business. Advance
-on Kissangire. The lost patrol. Successes at Kissangire. The
-Portuguese defeated at Newala. In Utete Camp. In a strong
-position at Kibata. Artillery preparations. Effect of heavy
-shell. An unsuccessful infantry attack. The military situation
-at the end of 1916. Powerful enemy attacks at Dutumi and
-Kissaki. The enemy fails to get behind us.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER VIII.: <span class="smcap">Anxieties and Hardships during our
-stay in the Rufiji Country</span>
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_xii" id="Page_xii"><span class="small">[xii]</span></a></span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_173">173</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">The march through the Pori. Camp at Ungwara. The troops
-lose their way. Useless mouths. Steps to remedy the threatening
-shortage of food. Reduction in the number of carriers. Reduction
-of rations. Obstruction. The Askari women. Maize our
-help in trouble. A supply branch of the commissariat. Minor
-actions in the bush at Ungwara. The commencement of the rains.
-Measures for the protection of women and children. The troops
-continue their march to the South.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER IX.: <span class="smcap">The End of the Frontier Defence in the
-Subsidiary Theatres</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_182">182</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">On the Ruhuje and Ruaha Rivers. A hostile attack and its
-sudden cessation. The enemy’s mistake. Surrender of Major
-Grabert. Division of General Wahle’s force. The march to
-Tabora. Back to Kilima Njaro. Major Kraut’s march to the
-Rovuma. Supply difficulties and plans for the future. In the rich
-Portuguese territory. Patrols towards Kilva. A heavy defeat
-of the enemy. Experiments with bread-substitute. Primitive
-boots. The crowing cocks. Salt, fat and sugar. The medical
-service. “Lettow-Schnaps.” Bandages. Operations with
-primitive appliances.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER X.: <span class="smcap">Lindi and Kilwa</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_190">190</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Hostile reinforcements from the direction of Lindi. Flood of the
-Mbemkuru. German advance on Lindi. The enemy penetrates
-into the German camp at Lutende. A smart counter-attack.
-Further minor actions near Ulindi. We march off to the North.
-At Narungombe. Another victory. Too late! Enemy spies
-under the white flag. An Imperial greeting from home. The
-attack at Narunyu. The bomb in the dentist’s study. Removal
-of women and children to Lindi.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER XI.: <span class="smcap">In the South-East Corner of the Colony</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_207">207</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Concentric advance of the enemy. At Ruponda and Likangara.
-The enemy’s uncertainty. Rumours. Action at Mahiva. A
-brilliant victory. Changing the plan of attack. The tactics of the
-enemy commander. The end of the battle. Losses and booty.
-Another action at Lukuledi. Guerilla warfare.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER XII.: <span class="smcap">The Last Weeks in German Territory</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_216">216</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Consultation with the Governor. Considerations. Departure
-from Lukuledi. Minor actions in the bush. Shortage of ammunition
-and its consequences. Continuous advance of the enemy
-to Chivata. We avoid the blow by moving to Nambindinga.
-Schemes for voluntarily restricting the strength of the troops.
-On the Makonde Plateau. Shortage of water and food. Whither?
-Reorganization of the Force at Newala. The hostile patrol and its
-letter. At them! Out of sight of the enemy.</td>
- </tr>
-
-</table>
-
-<p class="pc2 mid">PART III</p>
-<p class="pc1 lmid"><span class="smcap">Fighting on Foreign Soil</span><br />
-(From the Crossing into Portuguese East Africa to the Armistice)</p>
-
-<table id="toc3" summary="cont3">
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER I.: <span class="smcap">Across the Rovuma</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_229">229</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Crossing the river. The enemy’s camp at Ngomano. Assault
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_xiii" id="Page_xiii">[xiii]</a></span>on the Portuguese defences. The “Day of the old guns.” Rich
-booty. Continuing the march up the Lujenda. Looking for
-supplies. A transparent offer by the enemy. News of the surrender
-of Captain Tafel. Partition of the Force. Difficulties and
-unpleasantness. Capture of several Portuguese camps. Heroic
-action of Lieutenant Kempner. At Nangvare. Buffalo fat and
-forest fruits. Abundant supplies at Chirumba. Patrols.
-Approach of the enemy. Skirmishes. Enemy propaganda.
-Fresh courage and confidence.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER II.: <span class="smcap">East of the Ludjenda</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_245">245</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Supply questions. In the rain. Tobacco. At Nanungu.
-Building pontoons. Patrols across the Msalu River. News of
-events in Europe. A pause in the fighting. Patrols to the coast.
-The precious Pori-pig. A new hostile deployment. The patriotic
-English. Defeat of the enemy at Mahue. Continual skirmishes.
-Against the enemy at Kireka Mountain. An action in the bush.
-A wrong report and its consequences. Casualties on both sides in
-the last actions. Captain Koehl’s successes. Continuation of
-the march to Koroma Mountain. A surprise. The Governor in
-danger. Unpleasant losses.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER III.: <span class="smcap">In the Region of the Lurio and Likungo
-Rivers</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_259">259</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">On the road to Keriva. The sick and wounded. Camp on the
-Lurio. Müller’s detachment captures the Boma of Malema.
-Hostile forces approach from various sides. In a rich country.
-General Edwards’ precautions. Fighting in the bush. The
-march continued to Alto Moloque. The Orange-Boma. Continuous
-fighting by patrols. Nampepo Station and other settlements.
-On the Likunga River. Rich booty. The natives’
-powers of estimation.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER IV.: <span class="smcap">On to the South</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_270">270</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Where is the enemy’s ammunition dump? Looking for it.
-Awkwardness of long columns. Kokosani-Namekurra. Across
-the Lukungo. A success. At Namekurra. The fortified railway
-station. Artillery preparations and assault. Flight of
-enemy across the Namacurra River. The casualties on both sides.
-Extraordinary quantities of supplies and ammunition captured.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER V.: <span class="smcap">Back North to the Namacurra River</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_278">278</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Obstacles in the way of continuing the march to the South.
-The enemy’s operations and our own plans. Back across the
-Likungo. Marching in several parallel columns. A remarkable
-military situation. Looking for booty. At Ociva. The
-English and Portuguese prisoners. Capture of the Boma of Tipa.
-March to Namirrue. Reconnaissance of enemy’s position on the
-rocky mountain. Another enemy appears. Victorious battle
-with him at night. Confusion of the enemy’s columns. Fruitless
-pursuit of the fleeing enemy. The trench mortar and its effect.
-Assault of the rocky mountain. We march away to Pekera.
-Rest in the camp at Chalau.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER VI.: <span class="smcap">Back to the Lurio River</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_289">289</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">At Chalau. An English flag of truce. Approach of the enemy.
-Withdrawal across the Ligonja. At Ili. March to Numarroe.
-Preparing bread for the prisoners. A breakfast in the bush.
-Boma of Numarroe. Success of Goering’s detachment. Capture
-of the Boma. Casualties on both sides. On over the mountains
-to Rigona. Skirmishes. What next? Heavy fighting at
-<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_xiv" id="Page_xiv">[xiv]</a></span>Lioma. Heavy losses. No prospect of greater success. On to the
-North. Confusion of the detachments. A difficult march through
-the mountains. On the Lurio. Bad health of the troops. Heavy
-casualties on both sides. The influenza epidemic.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER VII.: <span class="smcap">On German Soil once more</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_303">303</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">Rapid march to the North. Across the Lujenda. A rest-day
-at Mwemba. Hostile spies. Distant reconnaissance by patrols.
-To Ssongea. Homesickness of the Samarunga. Pangire Mission
-Station. Change of direction. Grave news from Europe. At
-Mbozi Mission Station. Patrol reports.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER VIII.: <span class="smcap">The Advance into British Rhodesia</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_309">309</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">On the march to Fife. The enemy in a fortified position.
-Fruitless bombardment and continuation of the march. Patrol
-fighting. Abundant supply of quinine captured. Studying the
-map. By forced marches into Rhodesia. Kajambi Mission
-Station and its frightened inhabitants. Capture of Kasawa.
-Natives pillaging by order of the English. On towards the
-Zambesi.</td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti1">CHAPTER IX.: <span class="smcap">The Armistice and our Return Home</span></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#Page_315">315</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti2">The lost English motor-cyclist. Armistice. By cycle to the
-Chambezi ferry. Conditions of the Armistice. Conference with
-the British Commissioner. Situation in Germany. The Armistice
-and the situation of our troops. Release of the prisoners. Difficulties
-in paying off the Askari. March to Abercorn. “Surrender”
-and “Evacuation.” With General Edwards. Handing
-over arms. Fruitless opposition to English interpretation of agreement.
-By ship to Kigoma. Belgian hospitality. By rail to Dar-es-Salaam.
-Internment. Influenza and its victims. The loyal
-Askari. Endeavours to protect private property. Embarkation
-for home. At Rotterdam and at home. Retrospect and a glance
-at the future.</td>
- </tr>
-
-</table>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_xv" id="Page_xv">[xv]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="pc4">LIST OF MAPS</h2>
-
-<table id="tom" summary="maps">
-
- <tr>
- <td> </td>
- <td class="tdr1"><span class="small">PAGE</span></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Figs. i. and iii. Kilima Njaro</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m5">5</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. ii. German East Africa. The Central Railway</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m5">5</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. iv. Battle of Tanga</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m37">37</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. v. The Northern Railway</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m37">37</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. vi. Subsidiary Actions up to August, 1916</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m83">83</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. vii. Battle of Yasin (Jassini)</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m105">105</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. viii. Kilima Njaro and Masai Desert</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m105">105</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. ix. Battle of Reata</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m105">105</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. x. Battle of Kahe</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m105">105</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. xi. Invasion of German East Africa by Belgian and British
-columns, middle of 1916</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m131">131</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. xii. Retreat of German Main Force, August, 1916</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m131">131</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. xiii. Battles of Kissaki and Dutumi</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m161">161</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. xiv. March of German Main Force, September, 1916, to
-June, 1917</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m161">161</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. xv. March of Major-General Wahle in the West</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m183">183</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. xvi. March of Main Force during operations on interior
-lines west of Lindi, June to November, 1917</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m191">191</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. xvii. Battle of Mahiwa</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m191">191</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. xviii. The Action at the Kireka Mountains</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m257">257</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. xix. The Action at Namirrue, July 23rd, 1918</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m285">285</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. xx. Through Portuguese East Africa</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m297">297</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Fig. xxi. The March into Rhodesia</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#m311">311</a></td>
- </tr>
-
-</table>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_xvi" id="Page_xvi">[xvi]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS</h2>
-
-<table id="toi" summary="illus">
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">General von Lettow-Vorbeck</td>
- <td colspan="2" class="tdr1"><span class="reduct"><a href="#fr"><i>Frontispiece</i></a></span></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">General Map</td>
- <td class="tch reduct"><i>Facing p.</i></td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i32">32</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">The Fallen</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i33">33</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Native Women</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i96">96</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Natives Bringing Food</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i97">97</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Masai</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i128">128</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">European Dinner-time</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i129">129</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Askari. A Halt</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i160">160</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">The Banyan Tree</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i161">161</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Native Types (1)</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i192">192</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Native Types (2)</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i193">193</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Native Types (3)</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i224">224</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Native Types (4)</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i225">225</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Native Types (5)</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i256">256</a></td>
- </tr>
-
- <tr>
- <td class="ti3">Native Types (6)</td>
- <td class="tch reduct">”</td>
- <td class="tdr1"><a href="#i257">257</a></td>
- </tr>
-
-</table>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_1" id="Page_1">[1]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<p class="pc4 xlarge"><b>PART I</b></p>
-
-<p class="pc1 large">EVENTS PREVIOUS TO THE ARRIVAL OF THE
-SOUTH AFRICANS</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_2" id="Page_2">[2]</a></span></p>
-<p>&nbsp;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_3" id="Page_3">[3]</a></span></p>
-
-<p class="pc4 large"><b>My Reminiscences of East Africa</b></p>
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER I<br />
-<span class="wn">BEFORE THE OUTBREAK OF WAR</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">WHEN I landed at Dar-es-Salaam in January, 1914, I hardly
-suspected the nature of the task that was to confront
-me in a few months’ time. But during the past ten years the
-universal war had more than once seemed so imminent that I
-was obliged seriously to consider whether the force under my
-command would be called upon to take any part in that conflict,
-and, if so, what its task might be. Owing to the position
-of the Colony and the weakness of the existing forces&mdash;the peace
-establishment was but little more than two thousand&mdash;we could
-only play a subsidiary part. I knew that the fate of the colonies,
-as of all other German possessions, would only be decided on the
-battlefields of Europe. To this decision every German, regardless
-of where he might be at the moment, must contribute his
-share. In the Colony also it was our duty, in case of universal
-war, to do all in our power for our country. The question was
-whether it was possible for us in our subsidiary theatre of war
-to exercise any influence on the great decision at home. Could
-we, with our small forces, prevent considerable numbers of the
-enemy from intervening in Europe, or in other more important
-theatres, or inflict on our enemies any loss of personnel or war
-material worth mentioning? At that time I answered this
-question in the affirmative. It is true, however, that I did not
-succeed in interesting all authorities in this idea to such an<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_4" id="Page_4">[4]</a></span>
-extent as to cause all preparations which a war of this kind
-rendered desirable to be carried out.</p>
-
-<p>It was to be considered that hostile troops would allow themselves
-to be held only if we attacked, or at least threatened, the
-enemy at some really sensitive point. It was further to be
-remembered that, with the means available, protection of the
-Colony could not be ensured even by purely defensive tactics,
-since the total length of land frontier and coast-line was about
-equal to that of Germany. From these considerations it followed
-that it was necessary, not to split up our small available forces
-in local defence, but, on the contrary, to keep them together,
-to grip the enemy by the throat and force him to employ his
-forces for self-defence. If this idea could be successfully carried
-out, we should at the same time protect our coast and our infinitely
-long land frontier in the most effective manner.</p>
-
-<p>In examining the question where to find a point so vital to the
-enemy as to afford us the prospect of a successful attack, or, at
-any rate, of a threat of such an attack, one thought at once of
-the frontier between German and British East Africa. Parallel
-with it, at a distance of a few marches, runs the main artery of
-the British territory, the Uganda Railway, an object which, with
-a length of quite 440 miles, was extremely difficult for the enemy
-to protect, and would, therefore, if effectively threatened, require
-a large part of his troops for the purpose.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_5" id="Page_5">[5]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-005.jpg" width="400" height="533" id="m5"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pi6">Fig i. and iii. Kilima Njaro.<br />
-Fig. ii. German East Africa. The Central Railway.</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>On my first journey of reconnaissance and inspection, commenced
-in January, 1914, I went by sea from Dar-es-Salaam
-to Tanga, thence to Usambara, and then on into the country
-round Kilima Njaro and Meru Mountain. At Usambara I met
-an old friend whom I had known well since our military college
-days (<i>Kriegschule</i>), Captain von Prince (retired). He was an
-enthusiastic supporter of the idea that, in case of a war with
-England, we East Africans should not remain idle spectators,
-but should take a hand if there should be even a trace of a
-prospect of relieving the pressure in Europe. At the same
-time, he was in a position to inform me that in the Usambara
-country, round Kilima Njaro, and near Meru Mountain, Volunteer
-Rifle Corps were being formed, which in a short time would
-probably include all the Germans capable of bearing arms in
-these northern territories. In view of the density of the settlements
-in those parts, this was a fact of great importance. The
-main contingent of the three thousand Europeans whom we<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_6" id="Page_6">[6]</a></span>
-were able to enrol in the Protective Force during the course
-of the war was furnished from these very territories lying along
-the Usambara Railway. It was, indeed, difficult to introduce
-a workable military organization among these voluntary associations,
-and to make effective use of their abundant good will.
-Still, it was, on the whole, successfully arranged that all, even
-those not legally obliged to do so, should be ready in case of war
-to act under the orders of the Protective Force. The District
-Commissioners also manifested the greatest sympathy; but
-they also expressed the, unfortunately well-founded, doubt
-whether, in a universal war which could certainly cut us off
-completely from the home country and leave us to our own
-resources, such voluntary organizations would possess the
-requisite cohesion. The armament was also in a bad way;
-although almost every European possessed a useful sporting
-rifle, the variety of patterns and the consequent difficulty of
-ammunition supply had not yet been remedied. The proposals
-for arming these rifle clubs with a uniform military weapon
-were still pending, and remained undecided until the outbreak
-of war.</p>
-
-<p>At Wilhelmstal I found a detachment of native police under
-an efficient sergeant-major, who came from Ditmarschen.
-Whereas the Protective Force proper was under the Commandant,
-the various police detachments were under the civil authorities,
-and so each District Commissioner had under his orders a detachment
-of one hundred to two hundred men, for the purpose of
-collecting taxes and supporting his authority. There prevailed
-a constant tendency to increase this police force more and more,
-to the detriment of the Protective Force. In this manner,
-alongside of the latter, a second force of the same strength had
-come into being which was in its very nature a travesty of a
-military organization, and could hardly be anything better.
-The District Commissioner, a civil official, often understood
-little of military matters, and handed over the training and
-command of his Police-Askari to a sergeant-major of police.
-The latter often worked zealously, with the old non-commissioned
-officer’s usual devotion to duty; but he seldom received any<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_7" id="Page_7">[7]</a></span>
-guidance from a military superior, since the police inspector, an
-officer, could only visit each district from time to time. So the
-Police-Askari often became slack, and lacked the strict discipline
-necessary to keep them fit for their duties, which demanded
-reliability. To this was added a further defect which ought to
-have been avoided. The police were partly recruited from the
-native N.C.O.’s of the Protective Force. The latter was thereby
-deprived of its best elements, who, after joining the police, lost
-their good military qualities. This, of course, did not obtain
-in all cases. But, generally speaking, it was the case that,
-in order to obtain a police force of inferior military value which
-in the circumstances could never be of any real use, the quality
-of the Protective Force was steadily impaired.</p>
-
-<p>From New Moshi, the terminus of the Usambara Railway,
-I proceeded via Marangu, where an English planter lived and
-where I met the English Consul King, of Dar-es-Salaam, to the
-Kilima Njaro country, and thence to Arusha. Several German
-planters, some of them former officers, whom I visited at their
-estates during the march, assured me that the German settlers
-in those parts formed a valuable source of military power.</p>
-
-<p>At that time I made the acquaintance of the charming estate
-of Commander Niemeyer (retired), whose wife entertained us
-with excellent home-grown coffee. Later on she rather hindered
-us on one occasion: when, during the war, her husband
-was in Engara-Nairobi Camp, north-west of Kilima Njaro, we
-had temporarily lent her a telephone, so that she could call
-up her husband. Immediately afterwards the whole telephone
-service stopped, and after a long, long search, we at last discovered
-that our kind former hostess had not switched off her
-instrument and displayed no intention of doing so.</p>
-
-<p>Close by was the plantation of Lieutenant-Commander Schoenfeld
-(retired), who hospitably offered us a glass of very fine
-Moselle wine, and did so with a military tone like a word of
-command which even then characterized him as the energetic
-leader who was later to defend the mouth of the Rufiji River
-against a superior enemy with such stubbornness. Just short
-of Arusha we came to the coffee-plantation of my old brother-cadet<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_8" id="Page_8">[8]</a></span>
-Freiherr von Ledebur, where at table I met the charming
-old retired Lieutenant-Colonel Freiherr von Bock. We talked
-about the Volunteer Rifle Corps which were being formed near
-Meru Mountain, and I did not dream that a few months later this
-old gentleman of over sixty would be one of our toughest patrol
-leaders on the east side of Kilima Njaro, and would often with
-his few men, who were mostly recruits, successfully engage
-several companies of the enemy. His true chivalry and fatherly
-care soon won him the hearts of his black comrades, to such a
-degree that he was in their eyes the bravest of all Germans, and
-they clung to him with touching loyalty.</p>
-
-<p>At Arusha the first inspection of a company of Askari was
-held. The spirit and discipline of the black unit revealed the
-admirable education they had received at the hands of my
-predecessor, Colonel Freiherr von Schleuntz; but, in accordance
-with the hitherto accepted principles of their employment, their
-training for fighting against an enemy with modern armament
-had been developed to a lesser degree. Like the majority
-of the Askari companies, this company was still armed with the
-old 1871 pattern rifle, using smoky powder. The opinion was
-widely held that for black troops this was more suitable than a
-modern rifle with smokeless powder, for they had hitherto never
-been employed against an opponent with modern armament,
-but only in native warfare, where the larger calibre is an advantage,
-while the disadvantage of smoke is of no consequence.
-After the outbreak of war, indeed, the enthusiastic supporters
-of the 1871 rifle changed their minds. Against an enemy provided
-with modern smokeless equipment the smoky rifle was,
-not only at the long ranges obtaining in the open plain, but also
-in bush-fighting, where the combatants are often but a few paces
-apart, decidedly inferior. The man using smokeless powder
-remains invisible, while the cloud of smoke betrays the enemy
-with rapidity and certainty, not only to the sharp eye of the native
-Askari, but even to the European accustomed to office work.
-Thus, at the beginning of the war, the greatest reward which
-could be earned by an Askari was to give him a modern captured
-rifle in place of his old smoky one.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_9" id="Page_9">[9]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>In distributing the force by companies throughout the country
-it had been necessary to accept the disadvantage that in many
-cases it was impossible to employ them in large formations, or
-to train the senior officers in this respect. It was evident that
-in war the movement and leading in battle of forces greater than
-a company would be attended with great difficulty and friction.
-According to my view, the force had the double duty of preparing
-to meet an enemy from outside with modern armament, as well
-as a native enemy within our borders; their training for battle
-had therefore to take account of two distinct sets of conditions.
-The exercises in native warfare presented a spectacle which
-differed widely from our European inspections. At Arusha,
-on this occasion, the company marched through thick bush,
-the “Pori,” and was in native fashion surprised on the march.
-The enemy was represented by Meru warriors, who, arrayed in
-full war-dress, with spears and head-dress of ostrich feathers,
-remained concealed, and then at only a few paces distance fell
-upon the Safari, the column of route, with loud war cries. A
-fight at such close quarters, like the one in which Zelewski’s
-expedition had been overwhelmed in 1891 at Iringa, is decided
-at short range and in a very few minutes. The troops quickly
-rally round their leaders and rush the enemy. In accordance
-with this whole character of native warfare, careful and thorough
-musketry training in the modern sense had hitherto been unnecessary.
-It was, indeed, at a pretty low level, and it may interest
-the soldier to hear that in some companies the average at two
-hundred yards standing without rest barely attained Ring 3,
-and that only a few companies got beyond Ring 5. Neither
-did the nature of native warfare provide a sufficient inducement
-for thorough training with the machine gun. Fortunately,
-however, I soon discovered among all Europeans of the force
-a complete understanding of the importance of this arm, in
-particular in modern battle. In spite of this not particularly
-high standard of training, the results of field-firing, even at long
-ranges, were not unsatisfactory, and in this the Askari profited
-in a high degree by his sharp eyesight, which enabled him to
-observe his fire and correct his aim accordingly.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_10" id="Page_10">[10]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The journey was continued via Ufiome Mission, where the
-excellent Father Dürr was settled, to Kondoa-Irangi, Kilimatinde
-and back to Dar-es-Salaam. The impression left by this first
-inspection was that from a military point of view there was still
-a great deal to be done if we wished to be properly prepared
-in case the English should make war on us. Unfortunately I
-did not succeed in arousing sufficient interest in the matter on
-the part of the authorities. The ruling opinion was that we
-were on exceptionally good terms with the English, and that
-a war, if it came at all, was still in the distant future. Thus it
-happened that when war actually did break out but a few months
-later we were unprepared.</p>
-
-<p>For me, a new-comer in East Africa, the journey had not only
-been of military interest. At Boma la Ngombe, a place between
-Moshi and Arusha, a number of old Askari had been settled by
-the late Lieutenant-Colonel Johannes; they were mainly engaged
-in cattle-dealing, and had become well-to-do. The news of my
-coming had preceded me, and the people appeared in full strength
-to greet me on my arrival. I had the impression that this was
-not a mere show of loyalty; the people not only told me enthusiastically
-of Germans under whom they had previously served,
-but after the outbreak of war, unasked and without the slightest
-pressure, they placed a large sum of money at our disposal to
-help the force. In that district I also saw the first Masai, who,
-in contrast to the majority of the East African tribes, are pure
-Hamites, and live in a special reservation. It may be mentioned
-that Merker, the best authority on the Masai,<a name="FNanchor_1_1" id="FNanchor_1_1"></a><a href="#Footnote_1_1" class="fnanchor">[1]</a> considers them to
-be the original Jews. They possess to a marked degree the
-characteristics of the pure inhabitant of the prairie. Occasionally,
-one of these tall, slim, and very swift men acted as my guide on
-hunting expeditions; their vision and skill as trackers are
-astonishing. In addition, the Masai is intelligent, and, at any
-rate towards strangers, an extraordinary liar. He lives in
-closed villages of mud huts, and, like all nomads, wanders with
-his herds over the prairie. He seldom enlists in the force.
-In agriculture the Masai engages hardly at all, whereas among<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_11" id="Page_11">[11]</a></span>
-the other tribes this forms the chief occupation and is a necessary
-condition for close settlement. Thus the banana districts
-on the eastern slopes of Kilima Njaro support a native Wajagga
-population of some twenty-five thousand souls, and this number
-could easily be increased. The great wealth of cattle in the
-neighbourhood of Arusha, on the Masai prairie, and near Kondoa-Irangi,
-showed me that the tse-tse fly, the principal enemy of
-African cattle, is comparatively rare in those parts. As a comparison,
-I may state that the cattle in the single district of Arusha
-are estimated to be more numerous than in the whole of South-West
-Africa. At Kondoa-Irangi and Singida the people had
-come from a great distance, and had lined the road to greet me.
-No traveller who visits these countries can fail to observe that
-in the fertile, elevated interior there is room for the settlement of
-hundreds of thousands of Europeans. Here I would like to
-record an impression which I only obtained later, during the
-war. At times we passed through fertile districts which were
-completely forsaken by the inhabitants, but which were known
-not to have been occupied even in the previous year. They had
-simply moved away, had settled somewhere else in the abundantly
-available, empty and fertile country, and had there begun
-to cultivate fresh fields. If the country capable of cultivation
-were fully utilized, it would probably be possible to support
-in German East Africa, which has hitherto been inhabited by
-about eight millions only, a population barely less than that of
-Germany. An Englishman captured during the war at Mahenge
-remarked that it would be possible to make East Africa into a
-second India, and I think he was right. My experience in the
-war has confirmed my opinion that there exist many possibilities
-of economic development, of which we had hardly an inkling
-before the war.</p>
-
-<p>At Singida I saw one of the stud-farms of the country. For
-breeding purposes there were two horse stallions, no mares, a
-few Muscat donkey stallions, and mainly country-bred donkey
-mares. Of the objects it was sought to attain I could get no
-clear idea; in any case, the crossing of horse stallions and
-donkey mares had produced no results. But the district is<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_12" id="Page_12">[12]</a></span>
-extraordinarily suitable for horse-breeding, and the Government
-Veterinary Officer Hiffmeister, who was stationed there,
-was very inclined to settle in the country as a private farmer and
-horse-breeder. Similar stud-farms existed at Kilimatinde,
-Iringa and Ubena. From Singida to Kilimatinde I followed
-the Mpondi River; the sportsman will be interested to know
-that this is the district in which the best buffaloes in East Africa
-are said to be found. A few days before I had successfully hunted
-buffalo, but I had not succeeded in getting a shot at a powerful
-bull, and so, as far as time permitted, I was out for buffalo.
-Besides a native boy, I had as trackers two excellent Askari
-of the Konda Company. As soon as I arrived in camp at the
-end of a march and dismounted from my mule, I would ask
-Kadunda, one of these Askari, who had done the march on foot,
-whether he was ready to hunt. He always agreed with the
-greatest enthusiasm, and away we went through the bush,
-which was sometimes so dense that one had to crawl under the
-branches in order to get through at all. For the European not yet
-accustomed to the African climate it is extraordinarily fatiguing
-to follow a trail through dense bush and high grass reaching over
-one’s head for hours on end in the blazing sun. The wounded
-buffalo is considered to be the most dangerous game in East
-Africa; he often charges at once with great determination.
-At Mpondi, a short time before, a wounded buffalo had attacked
-a hunter so suddenly that the latter did indeed find himself
-seated on its neck, but would hardly have escaped with his life
-unless at the critical moment his sun-helmet had fallen off. The
-animal then proceeded to attack the helmet, and the man
-managed to get a shot at its heart. From this and similar tales
-it will be understood that as the trail gets warmer and warmer,
-one’s excitement becomes intense and one’s senses more acute.
-But although I often heard the buffalo breathing only a few paces
-from me, the bush was so thick that I could not get a shot. I
-had already abandoned all hope of success and had marched off
-with my caravan for good and all, when at seven in the morning
-we crossed a perfectly fresh buffalo trail. At this point the forest
-was clearer, and the guides seemed keen to follow the tracks.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_13" id="Page_13">[13]</a></span>
-So we let the caravan go on, and after four hours of exhausting
-tracking got a sight of the buffalo. In a clearing, at one
-hundred yards, I raised my rifle, but Kadunda would not allow
-it, and insisted on our stalking the quarry, which was passing
-us in quite open wood without undergrowth, up to within thirty
-yards. Luckily the bullet cut the main artery; the buffalo fell at
-once, and so any further possible developments of the episode
-were cut short. As often happens, we discovered in the animal’s
-body a bullet from a native gun. Besides this buffalo I had got
-a large number of antelope and gazelle of various kinds; lions
-we often heard, but never caught sight of.</p>
-
-<p>On this march through the “Pori” I learned, to my astonishment,
-that even in the interior of Africa it is no easy matter to
-disappear without a trace. I had marched off without leaving
-word what road I intended to take. Suddenly, in the heart of
-the bush, a native met us on the march, and handed me the
-oversea mail. The fact is that in their interchange of information
-the inhabitants tell each other everything that happens
-in their vicinity. Calls, fire signals, and the signal drums serve
-to exchange and quickly spread all news. The incredible way
-in which the innumerable rumours spread abroad, with which
-I became acquainted later on, is mainly due to this communicativeness.</p>
-
-<p>After returning to Dar-es-Salaam from the first journey of
-inspection, I immediately made arrangements for re-arming
-three more companies; up to date only three companies had
-been equipped with modern rifles. It subsequently became a
-factor of the greatest importance that, at any rate, these arms,
-with the necessary ammunition, reached the Colony just in time
-for the outbreak of war.</p>
-
-<p>During a tour of inspection in April to Lindi, where I saw the
-Third Field Company, I fell into a rocky hole and got water on
-the knee so that I could not start my next long journey till
-the end of May. Although the Central Railway was open for
-public traffic only as far as Tabora, the construction had proceeded
-so far that I could reach Kigoma (on Lake Tanganyika)
-by rail, and was thus already enabled to acquire a superficial<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_14" id="Page_14">[14]</a></span>
-knowledge of this important means of communication which
-connected our coast directly with the Lake and the rich countries
-bordering on it, and indirectly with the Congo basin. At Kigoma
-the steamer <i>Coetzen</i> was still building, and to reach Bismarckburg
-I made use of the small steamer <i>Hedwig von Wissman</i>. At Baudouinville,
-in the Congo Territory, I paid a short visit to the
-Bishop of the White Fathers, without suspecting how soon we
-would be at war with that country. The wonderful church
-would be an ornament to any of our towns. It had been built
-by the Fathers themselves and the interior was decorated with
-rich carvings. Extensive, splendid orchards surround the
-station. The plague of lions must, however, be very great;
-the Fathers told me that a short time before a lion had one night
-jumped the wall into the court and killed an ox.</p>
-
-<p>Our reception was very friendly, and we were made welcome
-with a glass of fine Algerian wine. We were also well received
-at Mwasyl Mission Station in German territory, where there
-were also White Fathers, mostly Belgians. During the war,
-however, we captured correspondence which proved that the
-French missionaries, who also lived at stations in the Tanganyika
-country, by no means confined themselves to spreading
-Christianity but intentionally carried on a national propaganda
-as well. One missionary’s letter defines the difference between
-a <i>missionnaire catholique</i> and a <i>missionnaire français</i>, remarking
-that the latter is bound, in addition to spreading the Christian
-faith, to carry on French national propaganda. It is well known
-that this national propaganda is a work from which the German
-missionaries generally refrained.</p>
-
-<p>These missions, which are naturally to be found in the densely
-populated and well-cultivated countries, exercise a remarkable
-influence on the education of the natives. The missionary is
-mostly the only permanently settled white man; he becomes
-well acquainted with the country and people, and wins their
-confidence. The missions have deserved extremely well by
-introducing European handicrafts; everywhere one finds carpenters’
-shops, shoemakers’ shops and brickworks.</p>
-
-<p>My later tours disclosed that the extremely fertile country<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_15" id="Page_15">[15]</a></span>
-around Langenburg and Ssonga, where there are many wheatfields
-(the density of population is indicated even on the map
-by the numerous mission stations), was protected by only
-one company, which was not even connected by a direct wire.
-A telegram could only reach Langenburg from Dar-es-Salaam
-by the English line through South Africa. The communication
-by heliograph from Iringa to Langenburg was too unreliable
-to be considered an efficient substitute. It may be mentioned
-that in that country the natives have not only been educated up
-to agriculture by the Missions and by the German Administration,
-but that considerable native industries have been indigenous
-there for a long time past. Where iron occurs one finds numerous
-forges, the bellows being made in the primitive manner out of
-hides and perforated branches. Very beautiful are the native
-weavers’ products; basket-work is also done here as almost
-everywhere else in the Colony, and the work not only shows
-good taste, but is so close that the natives use wickerwork cups
-for drinking. The large herds owned by a few European
-farmers suffered, owing to the poorly developed communications,
-from the difficulty of reaching a market; this is
-especially the case with Mbeya Farm, between Lake Nyassa
-and Tanganyika.</p>
-
-<p>I camped at Mbosi Mission, and the local missionary, Bachmann,
-who had known the country and the people intimately for many
-years past, told me that a striking change was taking place in
-the views of the natives. Foreign Arabs and Swahili were
-appearing in the country, and were telling the people that the
-Germans would soon be going, and that the English would take
-possession of the land; that was in June, 1914.</p>
-
-<p>The continuation of my journey to Iringa brought me to the
-places where the great chief Kwawa had defied the Germans
-in the early days, and at Rugeno some of the many assembled
-natives were able to relate to me what they had witnessed of the
-annihilation of Zelewski’s expedition on the spot.</p>
-
-<p>In the short period of peace-work that was vouchsafed to me,
-my endeavours to obtain a thorough grip of all my duties in East
-Africa could not produce results sufficient to secure me great<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_16" id="Page_16">[16]</a></span>
-personal authority among Africans of long standing. I was still
-considered a raw hand. All the same, my career in the service
-had prepared me to some extent for the work that Fate had in
-store for me.</p>
-
-<p>It was probably about the time when, as a cadet who had been
-transplanted at an early age from my home in Pomerania, I was
-studying Cæsar’s Gallic War, that the German Fatherland
-was presented by Bismarck with its first colonies. In the year
-1899-1900, when employed on the General Staff, I studied our
-own colonies as well as many foreign ones. During the troubles
-in China (1900-1901) I made the acquaintance, both officially
-and socially, of all the contingents engaged with us in East
-Asia, particularly the English. The Herero and Hottentot
-Rebellion in South-West Africa (1904-1906) introduced me to
-the peculiarities of bush warfare. At that time I gained abundant
-personal experience, not only of natives, but also of Boers,
-both on the Staff of General von Botha and as an independent
-Company and Detachment Commander. The excellent qualities
-of this Low German race, that had for generations made its home
-on the African veld, commanded my respect. That the Boers
-would later take a decisive&mdash;and in a sense tragic&mdash;part in
-anglicizing the German part of Africa I never dreamt.</p>
-
-<p>In 1906, in South-West Africa, I was wounded. This brought
-me to Cape Town, so that I also acquired a superficial knowledge
-of Cape Colony. On my return journey I also touched at
-the future scene of my work, German East Africa, for the first
-time.</p>
-
-<p>Later, my position as Commander of the Marine Battalion at
-Wilhelmshaven afforded me an insight into the inner life of our
-thriving and growing navy, which was so closely connected with
-German work overseas. I took part in exercises and cruises
-on large and small ships, in naval manœuvres, and in a visit by
-the Fleet to Norway, during which new views of general and
-military life continually presented themselves.</p>
-
-<p>Even after my return to the Army the alternation between
-regimental and staff employment afforded me much inducement
-and opportunity for comparison. In this manner my<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_17" id="Page_17">[17]</a></span>
-development had rendered me capable of rapidly accommodating
-myself to new conditions. Grateful as I was for every expansion
-of my horizon, I owe the best of all to the Army at home, in which
-I had the privilege, under the guidance of admirable commanders,
-of learning to know the spirit of military life and true
-discipline, a spirit which was then properly understood.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_18" id="Page_18">[18]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER II<br />
-<span class="wn">THE BEGINNING OF THE WAR</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap06">EARLY in August, 1914, when on my way via the heliograph
-station of Kidodi towards Kilossa, a special
-messenger brought me a telegram from the Governor, to say I
-was to return immediately to Dar-es-Salaam; and on the following
-day I received the news that His Majesty had ordered
-mobilization, but that the state of war did not extend to the
-overseas possessions. A telegram from the Secretary of State
-of the Imperial Colonial Office called upon us to reassure the
-settlers.</p>
-
-<p>In contrast to this a wireless message from the Admiralty
-Staff mentioned England also among our probable enemies.</p>
-
-<p>At Kilossa I managed to catch a goods train, and so arrived
-at Dar-es-Salaam on the 3rd August. Here everyone was busy:
-the declaration of war had arrived in the middle of the preparations
-for a big exhibition, in the programme of which was included
-the ceremonial opening of the Tanganyika Railway;
-numerous Germans had come on a visit to Dar-es-Salaam and
-were now unable to get away. In order to assist in the preparations
-for the exhibition, Captain von Hammerstein, commanding
-the 6th Field Company in Ujiru, had also arrived there,
-and it was very fortunate that I was able at once to employ
-this energetic officer, who not only shared my views, but to
-whom I was also cordially attached, for the work of mobilization.</p>
-
-<p>The question which immediately forced itself upon us was
-whether, in the now obviously imminent universal war in which
-England would almost certainly join, the Colony would remain
-neutral or not. As I have already explained, I considered it
-to be our military object to detain enemy, that is English<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_19" id="Page_19">[19]</a></span>
-forces if it could by any means be accomplished. This, however,
-was impossible if we remained neutral. In that case the
-situation would be that we, who did not command the sea, would
-have to remain inactive, with a force which, though small at
-the moment, had behind it a loyal, very efficient population of
-eight millions suitable for military service. England, on the
-other hand, would have no need to employ a single man in East
-Africa on our account; it would be able to take away the very
-last fit Askari, after providing for internal security, for employment
-in other theatres more important than East Africa. It
-would, therefore, obviously have been an advantage for England
-if any agreement had existed which condemned us to neutrality.
-But this was not the case: the Congo Act, which deals with the
-Equatorial territories, only says that in case of conflict between
-two of the Powers concerned, a third Power may offer its good
-services as a mediator. But as far as I know this step was not
-taken by any Power. We were therefore not obliged to restrict
-our operations out of regard for any agreement. From a military
-point of view it was a disadvantage, not for us, but for England,
-if war occurred in East Africa. The fact that we were not
-obliged to remain neutral enabled us to make use of our favourable
-coast as a base and refuge for the German cruiser operations
-in the Indian Ocean. But, above all, we were able, with our
-few thousand men, to contain throughout the whole duration
-of the war an enormously superior force of the enemy.</p>
-
-<p>At the outbreak of war the Protective Force consisted of
-216 Europeans (from whom a part must be deducted as on leave)
-and 2,540 Askari; there were, further, in the Police Force, 45
-Europeans and 2,154 Askari; these were later increased by the
-ships’ company of the <i>Königsberg</i> (which had put to sea), 322 men,
-and of the <i>Möve</i>, 102 men. The total numbers enrolled in the
-Force during the war were about 3,000 Europeans and 11,000
-Askari.</p>
-
-<p>These figures include all non-combatants, such as those
-employed on police duty, medical personnel, supply and maintenance
-services, etc. How many milliards it cost to try and
-crush our diminutive force the English themselves will presumably<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_20" id="Page_20">[20]</a></span>
-some day tell us. We, on the other hand, could
-probably have continued the war for years to come.</p>
-
-<p>For the hostile strengths no authentic figures are at my disposal;
-I quote from the statements of English officers and
-Press reports, and they must bear the responsibility for them.
-According to them over 130 Generals took the field against us,
-the total strength of the hostile troops was about 300,000, the
-losses in European and Indian dead amounted to 20,000; horses
-and mules, 140,000. These numbers, especially those of the
-General Officers, seem even to me rather exaggerated; I can
-therefore only repeat that they are taken from English sources.
-In any event, however, their losses were very considerable; and
-considering that the number of black soldiers who were killed
-or died is not given, the total number of enemy dead can hardly
-be under 60,000.</p>
-
-<p>We should have been compelled, if a cruiser had sought
-shelter in our harbours, to refuse to admit her, by reason of our
-neutrality, whereas the favourable position and coastal development
-of East Africa made it the natural hiding-place in cruiser
-warfare in the Indian Ocean. As regards the agreements laid
-down in the Congo Act, it should be borne in mind what it
-would have meant for our Navy if our colonies had been declared
-neutral.</p>
-
-<p>At Dar-es-Salaam it was very interesting during those days
-of tension to watch the proceedings of the English Consul King.
-He was to be seen everywhere, either in the Officers’ Club at a
-game of bridge, or at the Post Office where our telegrams were
-handed in. The standing orders of the English Expeditionary
-Force, which were subsequently captured at Tanga, and which
-were mainly based on King’s reports, showed how active this
-man had been in the time before the war, and how excellently
-he was informed as to the internal conditions in our Colony.
-His judgment on relevant matters extended so far that he even
-compared the relative fighting value of the Europeans in different
-districts, and credited those of Dar-es-Salaam with little
-“stomach for fighting.” To be honest, it must be admitted
-that in the case of a large number of the Germans in that place<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_21" id="Page_21">[21]</a></span>
-(and even of the local Government authorities) it actually did
-take some time before they were imbued with that warlike
-spirit without which the fulfilment of our task was simply
-impossible.</p>
-
-<p>Very difficult was the position of the coast towns, which were
-inhabited by numerous Europeans (among them many women
-and children), and which were of course exposed to bombardment
-by English men-of-war at any minute. The Governor
-maintained that such a bombardment must be avoided under
-all circumstances. According to an ordinance, which certainly
-did not contemplate the case of foreign war, the supreme
-military power in the Colony was in the hands of the Governor,
-and communication with home having ceased, it was anyhow
-physically impossible to get this altered. So I was obliged to
-make the best of this, from a military point of view, very serious
-difficulty and to reckon with the possibility that, if the Governor’s
-instructions were faithfully executed, Dar-es-Salaam and Tanga
-for instance, the termini of our railways and the obvious bases
-for hostile operations from the coast towards the interior, would
-fall into the enemy’s hands without a struggle.</p>
-
-<p>My view was that we would best protect our colony by
-threatening the enemy in his own territory. We could very
-effectively tackle him at a sensitive point, the Uganda Railway,
-and one might almost say that the numerous German settlers
-in the country traversed by our Northern Railway (Tanga-Moshi)
-were already deployed for this object. The Governor, however,
-did not agree with the proposal I had already previously put
-forward in case of war, namely, to concentrate our forces in
-the North near Kilima Njaro. But, in order to act at all, it
-was obviously necessary to collect our troops, who were scattered
-all over the country. As this could not be effected in the Kilima
-Njaro country, as I wished, the concentration took place on
-the heights of Pugu, a day’s march west of Dar-es-Salaam. At
-this place the Dar-es-Salaam Company met those from Kilimatinde,
-Tabora, Ujiji, Usambara and Kissendji, which came
-partly by march routes and partly by rail. The Police, who, in
-accordance with the scanty preparations already made, were to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_22" id="Page_22">[22]</a></span>
-join the Protective Force immediately, were in part, at any
-rate, placed at my disposal, a number of old Askari were called
-up, and in this way four new companies (No.’s 15 to 18) were
-at once formed. The German Reservists were mobilized as
-required, and each company was brought up to an establishment
-of about 16 Europeans, 160 Askari and 2 machine guns.</p>
-
-<p>In some cases difficulties occurred in calling the Europeans
-to the colours. By mistake, the crews of a few ships of the
-East African Line, lying in the harbour of Dar-es-Salaam, were
-informed, in response to their application, by the Officer in
-Command at the Railway Station, that there was no room for
-them in the Protective Force. Then, at the suggestion of the
-Governor’s representative, a declaration was submitted to them,
-according to which they were to engage in writing to remain
-neutral during the war. Later on the men saw that this constituted
-an offence against the law relating to liability for service,
-and their own sound feeling was opposed to it. They
-appealed to me, setting forth the circumstances; I had had no
-inkling of these proceedings, and fortunately, as the declaration
-had not yet fallen into the hands of the enemy, the intended
-decision could be reserved.</p>
-
-<p>The number of carriers allotted to each company varied, and
-may have averaged about 250. The stores of arms, ammunition
-and other war-material, which were lying unprotected in
-the harbour of Dar-es-Salaam, were distributed among various
-places in the interior along the railway, where depots were established.
-The training of the troops was at once vigorously proceeded
-with, and even then we realized the value of rendering
-our head-dress unrecognizable by means of grass and leaves,
-a measure proposed by a practical Company Commander, Captain
-Tafel. The question of course was whether we, with our Askari,
-would be able to fight modern troops; it was denied by many
-an experienced hand. But from what I had seen during the
-revolt in South-West Africa, from 1904 to 1906, I believed that
-courage and military efficiency could be awakened in the East
-African native also, who belongs to that same great family,
-the Bantu, as the Herero. That certainly was a proof; but the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_23" id="Page_23">[23]</a></span>
-matter was greatly simplified by the fact that there was no
-possible alternative.</p>
-
-<p>All questions of organization, which are usually carefully
-prepared and considered in time of peace, had now to be dealt
-with and decided on the spur of the moment. One of them was
-the extraordinarily important one of establishing a service of
-subsistence and a complete system of supply from the rear.
-The main point was to consider, in the first place, the main roads,
-which were also important in a military sense. Which roads
-might these be? It was immediately found how disadvantageous
-was the absence of railway communication between the Central
-and Usambara Railways. In time of peace, communication
-had been effected by sea between Dar-es-Salaam and Tanga;
-this was now impossible. Obviously the importance of a military
-use of the lines had not been thought of. As a substitute, we had
-to develop a road between Morogoro and Korogwe, on the
-Northern Railway. The second road ran past the western side
-of the Masai Reservation, from Dodoma via Kondoa-Irangi,
-and Ufiome to Arusha, and the third from the rich district of
-Tabora, the capital of the Wanyamwesi country, to Muansa,
-on Lake Victoria, into the country of the Wassukume, who
-were recognized even by Consul King as the most important
-of our tribes. This road was also valuable because by it we
-could draw on the rice crops of Lake Victoria as well as on the
-abundant stocks of cattle. Other roads connected Kilossa with
-the rich territory of Mahenge, Iringa, and even Langenburg,
-which last provided us with a large part of our requirements
-in wheat flour.</p>
-
-<p>The provisional organization of the supply system having
-been fixed in broad and general outline, it was not possible for
-the details of its development to be worked out at Headquarters.
-Someone had to be found whose past military career rendered
-him capable of working the system, not only from the administrative
-point of view, but also in accordance with the sometimes
-very urgent military requirements, and of adapting it to them.
-Major-General Wahle, a retired officer, who happened to have
-arrived on the 2nd August, on a visit to his son, and to see the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_24" id="Page_24">[24]</a></span>
-Dar-es-Salaam Exhibition, at once placed himself at the disposal
-of the Force, and at my request took charge of the Lines of
-Communication. His task was particularly difficult, because
-where there were no railways, the bulk of the work had to be
-performed by native carriers. I have at my disposal no figures
-showing the total number of carriers employed for the service
-of the troops, and it is very difficult to arrive at it at all
-definitely. It included men who only carried the loads from
-one place to another before the permanent carriers took them
-over, but I am sure I do not exaggerate in saying that, on the
-whole, hundreds of thousands of carriers worked for the troops;
-and all of them had to be fed and medically looked after.</p>
-
-<p>Of our many other difficulties one of a special nature may
-here be mentioned. The peace-time existence of the Europeans
-in tropical colonies had, even for reasons of health, accustomed
-them to a certain degree of comfort. When on <i>safari</i> (a journey)
-in East Africa, it is generally impossible to buy European food;
-but few Europeans had learnt to live on the vegetable products
-supplied by the natives or by Nature. Shelter is rarely to be
-had. Against mosquitos it is, however, imperative to protect
-oneself. So the white official or soldier seldom travelled with
-less than eleven carriers, who, besides his tent, camp-bed and
-clothing, also carried a considerable quantity of food. Such
-large numbers of carriers were, however, impossible for a force
-which was to be mobile. Another difficulty was that nearly
-every Askari had a boy. With these simple people, whose
-predilection for their ancient traditions and customs is further
-confirmed by Islam, and who are besides very proud and vain,
-it is particularly difficult to interfere with such Dusturis (customs).
-In individual cases it was not always easy for a Company Commander
-to find the happy mean.</p>
-
-<p>In the tropical warfare which was before us medical care is
-one of the most important factors. Generally speaking, the
-native is in a great measure immune against malaria, and it
-does not often happen that an Askari gets really ill with it;
-some tribes, however, like the Wajagga, on Kilima Njaro, who
-inhabit elevated, non-malarial districts, and are therefore not<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_25" id="Page_25">[25]</a></span>
-immune from early youth, suffer severely from malaria as soon
-as they come down to the plains. From the evening until well
-into the morning mechanical protection against the malaria
-mosquito (anopheles), by means of a mosquito net, was strictly
-enforced for every European. For many months I slept on the
-ground, and even then the mosquito-net afforded me a high
-degree of protection; even so I had malaria ten times, for in
-the field it is not always possible to employ preventive measures
-to the extent that is desirable from a hygienic point of view.
-In our endeavour to attach a medical officer to every company
-we received most welcome assistance from the fact that there
-was a considerable number of them on Lake Tanganyika, and
-in the Southern territories on the Rovuma, who had come out
-to study and combat sleeping-sickness.</p>
-
-<p>The work entailed by all this business of mobilization not
-only kept us going day and night, but also the native telephonist
-at Pugu, and it was extraordinary to see the skill with which
-the black man worked his instrument, both there and elsewhere.
-His great technical talent proved of the greatest value to us.
-Of difficulties there was, of course, an infinity. During the
-early days it happened that cattle coming from the country
-north of Tabora for the civilian population at Dar-es-Salaam
-met other cattle going in the opposite direction to feed the
-troops. To this day I feel something of a physical shock when
-I think of a collision at Pugu, between a train laden with the
-finest show cattle going at full speed, and another one, which
-nearly produced a serious reduction in the personnel required
-for working out our mobilization scheme.</p>
-
-<p>Our place of concentration at Pugu is some twelve miles
-inland from Dar-es-Salaam. Our camp was situated on the
-slopes of the Pugu Mountains. The forest is extremely thick,
-and the country densely covered by plantations of natives and
-Europeans. In spite of its somewhat elevated position, Pugu
-is quite in the hot coastal area, and although in August we were
-still in the cold season, the temperature was still what we
-describe as “tropical;” it is that oppressive, somewhat damp
-heat, which makes long marches so exhausting for the European.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_26" id="Page_26">[26]</a></span>
-At that time we had tents for the Europeans and a camp-bed
-with the inevitable mosquito net for everyone, so that in this
-respect there were no difficulties. In case of sickness we had
-established a provisional field hospital in the neighbouring
-Wichmann Plantations. Our horses did not suffer unduly.
-But one after another all our animals went down with tse-tse.
-In camp it was not possible to provide them, as we could at
-Dar-es-Salaam, with tse-tse proof stables, fitted with wire
-gauze similar to fly-proof windows.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_27" id="Page_27">[27]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER III<br />
-<span class="wn">THE FIRST ACTIONS</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">IN this Manner We Were Fully Employed in the Camp at Pugu,
-when, on the morning of the 8th August, we heard heavy
-artillery fire from the direction of Dar-es-Salaam. According
-to reports which soon reached us, it emanated from two English
-light cruisers, <i>Astræa</i> and <i>Pegasus</i>, who were aiming at the wireless
-tower. This tower had been erected in this exposed position
-because on the coast it could reach further out to sea; it was
-of importance to us because the high-power station at Tabora
-was not yet finished, and the two smaller ones at Muansa and
-Bukoba were of only local use. The tower was not hit by the
-English, but blown up by us, from a rather excessive fear of its
-falling into the enemy’s hands. A short time later an observation
-officer reported that the enemy was apparently preparing
-to land at Konduchi, a day’s march north of Dar-es-Salaam.
-The formation of the coast rendered it not unlikely. I therefore
-immediately ordered the seven companies of Askari<a name="FNanchor_2_2" id="FNanchor_2_2"></a><a href="#Footnote_2_2" class="fnanchor">[2]</a> available
-to march off, so as to seize the favourable opportunity of surprising
-the enemy in the act of landing.</p>
-
-<p>Before they marched off I had a conversation at Pugu Station
-with the Governor, Dr. Schnee, who was passing through by
-train to Morogoro. He seemed quite surprised by the English
-hostilities, and entirely agreed with my proposal to attack them
-at Konduchi. On the way there I met two gentlemen belonging
-to the Government at Dar-es-Salaam, who showed me a document
-dealing with negotiations for surrendering Dar-es-Salaam
-to the English. As the Governor had said nothing to me about
-it, and I was also rather in a hurry, I only glanced superficially<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_28" id="Page_28">[28]</a></span>
-at it. It did not occur to me that this might be any kind of
-agreement drawn up with the consent of the Governor. But
-when, during the night, the force had reached a mountain ten
-miles north of Dar-es-Salaam, and on the next morning we
-obtained a view of the harbour and the English cruisers lying
-off it, it became clear that the report of an attempted landing
-at Konduchi was a mistake. We were able to establish the fact
-that the English ships had communicated with the shore, and
-now it did appear to me probable that negotiations with the
-enemy had taken place. I now advanced on the town, and,
-as I could not but fear that in the confusion of the moment a
-disadvantageous agreement might be concluded at Dar-es-Salaam,
-I sent Captain Tafel on ahead. He was to announce
-that I was taking over the executive power, and that negotiations
-with the enemy must be conducted through me alone. It
-was only from Captain Tafel that I learned that by order of the
-Governor negotiations for surrender had actually taken place.
-My intervention was not approved by the Governor, in whose
-hands, according to a Protective Force Ordinance intended to
-meet quite different conditions, supreme military power was
-actually placed. For the moment this had no practical consequences.
-Only a few English Marines had landed, and had
-already gone on board again. But for a soldier it was not
-inspiring to find that here, under the very eyes of a thousand
-good troops, an agreement had been concluded which forbade us
-to undertake any hostile act in Dar-es-Salaam, while the enemy
-was not so bound, and that we had received no information of a
-step of such great military importance.</p>
-
-<p>The <i>Königsberg</i> had already put to sea from Dar-es-Salaam
-several days before, and the surveying vessel <i>Möve</i>, which was
-in harbour, had been blown up by us on the 9th August. This
-brought the land forces a valuable military increase, as the
-captain of the <i>Möve</i>, Lieut.-Commander Zimmer, now came under
-my orders. Lieutenant Horn at once proceeded with a few
-seamen to Kigoma, where he manned and armed the small
-steamer <i>Hedwig von Wissmann</i>. On Lake Tanganyika he chased
-the Belgian steamer <i>Delcommune</i>, which he surprised and shot<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_29" id="Page_29">[29]</a></span>
-to pieces after a few days, thereby securing to us the extremely
-important command of the lake. The ability rapidly to transfer
-troops from the Central Railway towards Bismarckburg or
-Usambara depended entirely upon unimpeded transport on
-Tanganyika, and played a part in the later course of the
-operations.</p>
-
-<p>In the north of the Colony, the 1st Company at Arusha had
-been reinforced by the 13th Company, coming by rapid marches
-from Kondoa, and by another company formed at Moshi from
-Police Askari. Further, a large part of the Europeans of the
-northern districts had combined to form a detachment under
-Captain von Prince. Most of those troops were in the neighbourhood
-of Moshi. Taveta, which lies to the eastward, in
-English territory, was held by the enemy, who thereby secured
-a valuable sally-port against our European settlements in the
-north; it was, therefore, an urgent matter for us to capture this
-important point without delay. It took considerable time
-before we were able to set the force in motion for this purpose.
-Many people believed that on the strength of the Congo Act
-we were bound to remain neutral, and naturally had little confidence
-in the instructions they received from the new Commandant.
-It was not until the 15th August that the weakly-held
-place was taken. The course of the fight proved that the
-force still required much further training to render it fit to
-carry out combined operations in unison in the dense bush. In
-this area the command was assumed by Major Kraut, who happened
-to be in the north-eastern frontier district for the purpose
-of frontier delimitations. During the next few days the holder
-of the supreme military power was successfully persuaded to
-agree to moving the bulk of our forces to the Northern Railway.
-Simple as was this movement in itself, under the conditions
-then existing, it required considerable preparations. There
-were few Germans to be found who were so well acquainted with
-the whole country between Dar-es-Salaam and Morogoro on one
-side, and Tanga and Mombo on the other, that they could give
-reliable information about roads and conditions of subsistence.
-It was necessary to send out reconnaissance officers in order to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_30" id="Page_30">[30]</a></span>
-determine the roads on which a suitable quantity of supplies
-could be found. But we could not afford to await the results of
-all these reconnaissances; the marches had to be begun. According
-to European ideas the country was sparsely populated;
-and on the existing maps the only notes as to water and food
-showed whether the supplies available would suffice for bodies
-of a strength equal to a company at most. Without preparation
-one could therefore hardly put more than one company on
-each road without distribution in depth; the training and skill
-in the collection of supplies which the force had acquired by
-the end of the war were at that time non-existent. Taking it
-all round, it came to this, that the march and supply of a single
-company in the conditions there prevailing required about the
-same consideration as would a division in Germany. It was also
-necessary in this move to take into account the risk arising from
-the fact that companies would for a prolonged period be out of
-reach of orders. The only telegraphic communication between
-the Central Railway and the north ran close along the coast, and
-could therefore be interrupted whenever the enemy intended
-to do so.</p>
-
-<p>However, the Director of the Postal Service, Rothe, and
-Secretary Krüger displayed such adaptability in meeting the
-wishes of the troops, and such energy in starting work on the
-new line Morogoro-Handeni-Korogwe, and, under the pressure
-of circumstances, temporarily overcame the normal torpor of the
-Tropics with such success, that the line was completed in only a
-few weeks. Owing to the destructiveness of the termites (white
-ants) it is the rule in time of peace to employ iron telegraph
-poles, which, owing to the prevalence of giraffe in this particular
-district, have to be very tall and carry very heavy conductors.
-In the first instance, however, the construction in this case had
-to be of a provisional nature, and this, and the use of cable, caused
-continual breakdowns and repairs.</p>
-
-<p>In the meantime I received reports of the advance of small
-hostile detachments at Jassini, two marches north of Tanga, and
-this confirmed me in the belief that the enemy intended to land
-in that district, and would then rapidly advance into the interior<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_31" id="Page_31">[31]</a></span>
-along the Northern Railway. Consequently, the various companies
-had marched off from different points on the line Dar-es-Salaam-Mpapua,
-and were for the most part converging on
-Handeni, while some were directed on other points on the line
-Tanga-Korogwe, when I was called up on the telephone at
-Pugu on the afternoon of August 23rd, by Lieutenant von
-Chappuis, who was encamped at Bagamoyo with the 17th Field
-Company. He reported that an English light cruiser was lying
-off Bagamoyo, and had called upon the local Civil Administrator
-to destroy the telegraph station, threatening to bombard the
-place in case of refusal. I ordered him to assume control of the
-executive and to prevent a hostile landing by force of arms. A
-boat from the man-of-war that attempted to land under the
-white flag was therefore sent back, and the place was bombarded
-in consequence, to the great amusement of the company and
-the native inhabitants, since the enemy scored practically no
-hits.</p>
-
-<p>At the end of August, Headquarters moved by rail to Kirnamba,
-near Morogoro. On the way, General von Wahle, who was directing
-the service on the Lines of Communication from Morogoro,
-wished me the best of luck in the decisive action which we
-expected in the neighbourhood of Handeni, and to which his
-son was also proceeding. From there Headquarters travelled
-on towards Handeni in two requisitioned motors. After about
-twenty miles we had to leave them, as the improvement of this
-road had not been completed beyond that point. Captain von
-Hammerstein and I went on on bicycles, and gradually caught
-up the companies on the march. The anticipated landing of
-the enemy did not take place, and early in September we reached
-Korogwe. In the meantime an English cruiser had appeared at
-Tanga and towed away some lighters lying there.</p>
-
-<p>Our next duty was to organize the supply and transport
-services in the north. Captain Schmid, who had until then
-directed them as Field Intendant, had become sick, and it was
-difficult to find a suitable successor. Fortunately we discovered
-one in Captain Feilke, of the Landwehr, who had for
-many years directed the Prince Albrecht Plantations in Usambara,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_32" id="Page_32">[32]</a></span>
-a man of great experience. He was at the time in the
-vicinity of Tanga, and had placed himself at the disposal of the
-force. He had formerly been Adjutant of the 8th Jäger Battalion,
-was fifty-two years of age, a man of much knowledge of
-the world and a skilful officer; he thus combined in the happiest
-manner the military knowledge and business talent necessary
-for the difficult post of Intendant. He came immediately,
-and we drove to New Moshi together. There I met Captain Kraut.
-On Kilima Njaro preparations had been made for guerilla warfare
-by establishing supply depots, our patrols were pushing
-beyond Taveta towards the British Uganda Railway, and
-numerous minor encounters had already taken place. At that
-time, however, the force lacked the experience necessary for
-carrying out distant patrols like those which at a later stage
-led so successfully to interruptions of the line. The first patrols
-had arrived at the Uganda Railway in a half-starved condition
-and had been captured. From New Moshi I went to Himo Camp,
-where Captain von Prince was holding a fortified position. He
-accompanied me to Taveta, which was held by an advanced
-post under an officer. Now we could discuss on the spot the
-problem of transferring the main body of the Northern Force to
-Taveta. The local native population was very numerous and
-placed entire confidence in the European administrators
-appointed by the force: they continued to sell their products
-in the market, and our mutual relationship was completely
-satisfactory.</p>
-
-<p>Directly war broke out the fear of a native rising had been
-expressed in many quarters. Along the Central Railway there
-were wild rumours about a revolt of the Wahehe&mdash;the warlike
-tribe who had so long defied German authority in the Iringa
-country&mdash;and around Kilima Njaro a rising of the Wajagga was
-feared. The authorities also thought that the large number of
-black labourers on the European settlements in the north were
-unreliable on account of difficulties of subsistence. But none of
-these fears turned out to be justified. Later, a very intelligent
-captured Belgian Askari told me outright: “You know quite
-well that the natives always side with the stronger party,” and
-an English Masai admitted frankly: “It is all the same to us
-whether the English or the Germans are our masters.”</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-032.jpg" width="400" height="486" id="i32"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc400">General Map of the Campaign in East Africa.<br />
-<span class="wn2">&mdash;&mdash; Track of the German Main Force. 1916-1918.</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-033.jpg" width="400" height="662" id="i33"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc400">The Fallen.<br />
-<span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_33" id="Page_33">[33]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>It was not till later, after the enemy had penetrated the
-country, that the native became a real danger to us: and then
-it was, indeed, very great. The native has a fine sense of the
-transfer of real power from one hand to the other.</p>
-
-<p>After returning for a short time to Korogwe, Headquarters
-moved to New Moshi, and shortly afterwards to Taveta. Three
-companies who had reached the Northern Railway from the
-Central Railway were concentrated at Tanga, the remaining five
-were moved into the Kilima Njaro country. At Dar-es-Salaam
-there remained for the moment only Captain von Kornatzki
-with the newly-formed 18th Field Company.</p>
-
-<p>During the following period several enterprises were carried
-out by flying columns, of the strength of one company each, the
-intention being to drive away the hostile detachments who were
-reported to be guarding the watering-places in the adjoining
-English territory, to inflict losses upon them, and so to open the
-way for our patrols to operate against the Uganda and Magad
-Railway. Thus, at the end of September, Captain Schulz had
-marched with his company from Kilima Njaro down the Tsavo
-River to the Uganda Railway, where he had met an enemy
-detachment of several companies, who had probably been concentrated
-by means of the railway. North of Kilima Njaro
-Captain Tafel had with his company and a detachment of fifty
-Europeans pursued a column of English Horse, but had then
-been attacked by the latter in his camp in the dense bush on
-Engito Mountain. This was the first serious engagement fought
-by our Askari in the north. Although the enemy consisted of
-English and Boer farmers, who were therefore good horsemen
-and good shots, our Askari attacked them with the bayonet
-with such dash, that out of a strength of eighty Europeans some
-twenty dead were left behind, and their total casualties may
-therefore be estimated at half their number.</p>
-
-<p>In the same way the expeditions undertaken by Captain
-Baumstark, who commanded the three companies at Tanga,
-led to fighting in the frontier districts between Jassini and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_34" id="Page_34">[34]</a></span>
-Mombasa. An equally important object of all these enterprises
-was to secure the most indispensable information about
-this theatre of operations, as it had not been reconnoitred in
-time of peace, and the conditions as to water-supply and cultivation
-were unknown to us. In this manner we gradually obtained
-a clear idea of the country and its inhabitants. Along the coast
-the English frontier district was well settled and highly cultivated.
-Further inland it is a dry desert covered with thorn
-scrub and partly with thick bush. Out of the desert rise a number
-of mountain ranges, which often attain the character of steep
-masses of rock. The troops were quartered in several fortified
-camps east of Kilima Njaro, but, owing to the difficulty of communication
-from Taveta, Headquarters were moved back to
-Moshi. Later, when the Director of the Field Postal Service
-arrived, and I asked him what he thought of the line between
-Moshi and Taveta, he could only describe it as “pretty.” The
-insulators were made from knocked off bottle-necks, fastened to
-poles or branches of trees, the wire had been taken from the
-fences of the plantations. But the breakdowns really were
-so frequent that the great volume of reports and information in
-connection with the working of Headquarters could not have
-been carried on this line for a prolonged period.</p>
-
-<p>Since the outbreak of war our communication with the outside
-world had been to all intents and purposes cut off; at first,
-indeed, we did pick up wireless messages from Kamina (in Togo),
-and then occasionally, under favourable weather conditions,
-from Nauen (Germany); but otherwise we had to depend for
-fresh news on picking up enemy wireless messages, or on obtaining
-possession of enemy mails or other papers.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_35" id="Page_35">[35]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER IV<br />
-<span class="wn">THE NOVEMBER ACTIONS AT TANGA</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap06">CAPTURED English newspapers stated that it would be
-particularly painful to Germany to lose her beloved
-colonies, its “little chicks,” and that German East Africa was
-the most valuable mouthful. Captured mails spoke of an impending
-attack by an Indian expeditionary force of 10,000
-men, and, as I had from general considerations always expected
-a hostile attack on a large scale in the neighbourhood of Tanga,
-I went there at the end of October, drove all over the country
-in a car I had brought with me, and discussed the matter on
-the spot with Captain Adler, commanding the 17th Company,
-and with District Commissioner Auracher. I was pleased to
-find that the latter was of my opinion that, in the event of
-Tanga being seriously threatened, the prime necessity would
-be unity of action, and I assured him that I would, of course,
-undertake the responsibility for any consequences that might
-ensue. This was particularly important for the reason that,
-according to the Governor’s instructions, a bombardment of
-Tanga was to be avoided under all circumstances. Opinions
-as to what should be done or left undone in any given case might
-therefore differ very widely.</p>
-
-<p>On the 2nd November, a few days after my return to New
-Moshi, a wire from Tanga informed me that fourteen hostile transports
-and two cruisers had appeared off the place. They demanded
-unconditional surrender of the town; the negotiations
-were protracted, as District Commissioner Auracher, who had
-gone on board, pointed out that he must obtain special instructions,
-and prevented the threatened bombardment by remarking
-that Tanga was an open and undefended place. Captain Baumstark,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_36" id="Page_36">[36]</a></span>
-who was with two companies in the frontier district north
-of Tanga, was at once moved off towards Tanga. Similarly
-the two companies of Europeans and the Askari companies were
-moved by forced marches from near Taveta and Kilima Njaro
-to New Moshi. Two lorries which were employed on supply
-work between New Moshi and Taveta rendered valuable service
-in this move. My intention to collect all available troops as
-rapidly as possible, to meet the obviously impending landing at
-Tanga, could only be executed, in spite of the long marches
-expected of the troops, if the Northern Railway exerted its capacity
-to the utmost limit, and this, with only eight locomotives,
-was asking a great deal. The railway is a narrow gauge line of
-190 miles, on which, in a fully-loaded train of 24 to 32 axles,
-only one company could be carried with complete baggage,
-or two companies without either baggage or carriers. That
-the transport of the troops could be carried out at all is entirely
-due to the willingness of all those connected with it&mdash;I specially
-mention Railway Commissary Kröber, who had been called up to
-the Force as a 2nd Lieutenant, and the traffic director Kühlwein&mdash;who
-at Tanga conducted the trains up on to the actual battlefield
-under fire. As early as the 2nd November the troops
-actually at New Moshi, one and a half companies, were pushed
-off by train, followed on the morning of the 3rd by Headquarters
-and another company. Three other companies followed
-later. Similarly, all the smaller detachments employed on
-railway protection duty were moved to Tanga. The spirit of the
-departing troops was magnificent, but this may have been due,
-not so much to the fact that the Askari clearly understood
-the gravity of the situation, as that for him a trip in a railway
-train is at all times a great delight.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_37" id="Page_37">[37]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-037.jpg" width="400" height="607" id="m37"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pc">Fig. iv. Battle of Tanga. Fig. v. The Northern Railway.</p>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_38" id="Page_38">[38]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Headquarters reached Korogwe in the evening of the 3rd
-November. I went to the hospital that had been established
-there and talked to the wounded who had come in from the
-action at Tanga on the 3rd. One of them, Lieutenant Merensky,
-of the Landwehr, reported to me that on the 2nd November,
-outpost and patrol encounters had taken place near Ras-Kasone,
-and that on the 3rd the enemy, apparently several thousand
-strong, who had landed at Ras-Kasone, had attacked the 17th
-Company east of Tanga. The latter, reinforced by the Europeans
-and Police Askari from Tanga under Lieutenant Auracher,
-had withstood the attack until the first one and a half companies
-coming from New Moshi joined in, rushing at once to attack the
-left flank of the enemy and driving him back. Lieutenant
-Merensky had the impression that the enemy was completely defeated,
-and that the attack was unlikely to be repeated. The telegrams
-coming in piecemeal during the railway journey had not
-afforded me a clear idea of the situation, when at 3 a.m. on the 4th
-November, Headquarters left the railway four miles west of Tanga,
-where we met Captain Baumstark. He had formed a different
-estimate of the situation, and believed that, owing to the great
-superiority of the enemy, Tanga could not be held against another
-attack. He had, therefore, on the evening of the 3rd November,
-collected his own two companies coming from the north, and
-the troops who had that day been in action at Tanga, at a point
-four miles west of the town, leaving patrols only in the place itself.</p>
-
-<p>Whether Tanga was held by the enemy or not was not certain.
-Strong officers’ patrols were at once pushed forward beyond
-Tanga towards Ras-Kasone. Luckily Headquarters had brought
-a few bicycles, and so, in order to satisfy myself quickly by personal
-observation, I was able to go off at once with Captain von
-Hammerstein and Volunteer Dr. Dessel to the railway station
-at Tanga, where I found an advanced post of the 6th Field
-Company. They, however, could give no accurate information
-about the enemy, and so I rode on through the empty streets
-of the town. It was completely deserted, and the white houses
-of the Europeans reflected the brilliant rays of the moon into
-the streets which we traversed. So we reached the harbour
-at the further edge of the town. Tanga was therefore clear of
-the enemy. A quarter of a mile out lay the transports, a blaze
-of lights, and full of noise: there was no doubt that the landing
-was about to commence at once. I much regretted that our
-artillery&mdash;we had two guns of 1873 pattern&mdash;was not yet up.
-Here, in the brilliant moonlight, at such close range, their effect
-would have been annihilating, the hostile cruisers notwithstanding.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_39" id="Page_39">[39]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>We then rode on towards Ras-Kasone, left our bicycles in the
-German Government Hospital, and went on foot to the beach,
-close to which, right in front of us, lay an English cruiser. On
-the way back, at the hospital, we were challenged, apparently
-by an Indian sentry&mdash;we did not understand the language&mdash;but
-saw nothing. We got on our cycles again and rode back.
-Day began to break, and on our left we heard the first shots.
-This was the officers’ patrol under 2nd Lieutenant Bergmann,
-of the 6th Field Company, who had met hostile patrols west of
-Ras-Kasone. One of my cyclists now brought Captain Baumstark
-the order to advance at once with all the troops to Tanga
-Station. For the manner in which I proposed to fight the
-action, which was now to be expected with certainty, the nature
-of the country was one of the decisive factors. In the north,
-the houses of the European town at the harbour provided
-cover from view, and therefore also from the fire of the cruisers
-close by. The town was surrounded by continuous cocoanut
-and rubber plantations, which extended almost to Ras-Kasone,
-and in which, besides the native town, a few native patches of
-cultivation were scattered about. Undergrowth occurred along
-a few points and the ground was absolutely flat. It was probable
-that the enemy, whether he landed at Ras-Kasone only, or simultaneously
-at several points, such as Mwambani, for instance,
-would press upon our south, or right, wing. Here, to the south
-of Tanga, the ground afforded us also the prospect of greater
-power of manœuvre. I decided to meet the attack, which I
-expected with certainty, on the eastern edge of Tanga, and to
-echelon strong reserves behind our right wing for a counter-attack
-against the enemy’s flank.</p>
-
-<p>In allotting the various duties it was necessary to consider
-the peculiarities of the different units. At that time each
-company had different characteristics, according to its composition
-and its state of training. The good 6th Field Company,
-which had in time of peace received a careful training at Ujiji
-with both rifle and machine-gun, was ordered to hold the eastern
-edge of Tanga on a broad front. On its right rear, outside Tanga,
-was echeloned Baumstark’s battalion, consisting of the 16th<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_40" id="Page_40">[40]</a></span>
-and 17th Companies, formed from the Police, and several small
-units amalgamated into one company. To the right rear again,
-on the telegraph-road Tanga-Pangani, I kept three good companies
-at my own disposal, the 7th and 8th Rifle Companies, with
-three machine-guns, composed of Europeans, and the 13th Field
-Company with its four machine-guns. Headquarters remained
-for the present on the Tanga-Pangani road and connected up
-to the telegraph line there. The 4th and 9th Field Companies
-and the two field guns (Captain Hering’s Battery) were still on
-the way, and the time of their arrival was uncertain. So the
-situation remained essentially until the afternoon. In the hot
-sun of the Coast area we suffered not a little from thirst, but
-quenched it with the milk of the young cocoanuts. There were
-other drinks as well in Tanga at that time; we still had wine and
-soda-water. Master-butcher Grabow even brought the troops
-hot sausages.</p>
-
-<p>The proceedings on board the hostile ships were kept under
-constant close observation. We saw every boat that left them,
-and its load. I estimated the total troops landed up to midday
-at 6,000. But even on this too low estimate I had to ask myself
-whether I dared risk a decisive engagement with my thousand
-rifles. For various reasons I decided that I would do so. It was
-too important to prevent the enemy from gaining a firm footing
-in Tanga. Otherwise we should abandon to him the best base
-for operations against the Northern territories; in his advance
-the Northern Railway would afford him an admirable line of
-communication, and he would be enabled continually to surprise
-us by bringing up and pushing forward fresh troops and stores.
-Then it was certain that we would be unable to hold the Northern
-Railway any longer and that we would be obliged to abandon
-our hitherto so successful method of warfare. Against these all-important
-practical reasons, limited considerations such as the
-Governor’s order to avoid a bombardment of Tanga under all
-circumstances could not prevail.</p>
-
-<p>A few circumstances there were that favoured us. For one
-thing, from personal experience in East Asia, I knew the
-clumsiness with which English troops were moved and led in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_41" id="Page_41">[41]</a></span>
-battle, and it was certain that in the very close and completely
-unknown country in which the enemy would find himself directly
-he landed, these difficulties would grow to infinity. The slightest
-disorder was bound to have far-reaching consequences. With my
-troops, of whom the Europeans were well acquainted with the
-country round Tanga, while the Askari were at home in the
-bush, I had a reasonable prospect of taking advantage of the
-enemy’s weak points by skilful and rapid manœuvre.</p>
-
-<p>On the other hand, if the affair miscarried, it would be a bad
-business. Already my method of waging active war had met with
-disapproval. If on top of that we were to suffer a severe defeat
-the confidence of the troops would probably be gone, and it was
-certain that my superiors would place insuperable difficulties
-in the way of my exercising command. My decision was not
-easy, and as if the military situation alone did not render it
-difficult enough, it was made unnecessarily harder by the fact
-that the regulations did not allow sufficient freedom to the
-responsible commander. But there was nothing for it: to gain
-all we must risk all.</p>
-
-<p>The same morning I personally ordered Captain von Prince
-to move into Tanga with his two companies of Europeans, so
-that, in case of an attack on the Askari Company holding the
-eastern edge of the place, he could intervene rapidly without
-orders. I had already begun to doubt whether the enemy
-would attack at all on the 4th November, when at 3 p.m. an
-Askari reported to me in his simple, smart way: “Adui tayari.”
-(The enemy is ready.) Those two short words I shall never
-forget. The next moment the rifle fire opened along the whole
-front, and one could only judge of the rapid development and
-the ebb and flow of the action from the direction of the firing.
-One heard the fire draw in from the eastern edge of the town
-to the middle: so the 6th Company had been driven back at
-this point. The enemy, with odds twenty to one in his favour,
-had penetrated close up to the station and into the town. Captain
-von Prince had immediately rushed up his two companies
-of Europeans and at once prevailed upon the brave Askari to
-stand and then to advance once more. The British North<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_42" id="Page_42">[42]</a></span>
-Lancashire Regiment, consisting only of long-service Europeans,
-800 strong, was driven back with heavy losses, and the houses
-captured by the Indian Brigade (Kashmir Rifles), who were
-advancing between that regiment and the beach, were re-taken
-in stubborn street-fighting. But on the south side of Tanga
-Captain Baumstark had also brought his companies into action
-on the front, and after about one hour’s fighting I observed the
-Askari at this point retiring through the palm-trees to the
-Tanga-Pangani road. The European members of Headquarters
-at once ran there and stopped them. To this day I can see the
-fiery and determined Captain von Hammerstein, full of fury,
-throwing an empty bottle at the head of a retreating Askari.
-After all, they were for the most part young companies, only
-just formed, who were fighting at this point, and they had been
-staggered by the intensity of the enemy’s fire. But when we
-Europeans got in front of them and laughed at them they quickly
-recovered themselves and saw that every bullet did not hit.
-But on the whole the pressure on our front was so strong that I
-thought I could not delay the decision any longer and must
-start my counter-stroke. For this I had now but one company
-available, but it was the good 13th Field Company. The 4th
-Company, whose arrival I was most anxiously awaiting every
-minute, had not yet arrived.</p>
-
-<p>The course of the action up till now had shown that the
-enemy’s front, of which the flank was unprotected, did not reach
-further south than the right wing of our own. Here, therefore,
-the counter-stroke must prove annihilating, and no witness will
-forget the moment when the machine-guns of the 13th Company
-opened a continuous fire at this point and completely reversed
-the situation. The whole front jumped up and dashed forward
-with enthusiastic cheers. In the meantime the 4th Company
-had arrived; although, in consequence of a misunderstanding,
-it did not prolong the outer flank of the 13th, but pushed in
-between the latter and our front, still it did take an effective
-part in the battle before dark. In wild disorder the enemy
-fled in dense masses, and our machine-guns, converging on them
-from front and flanks, mowed down whole companies to the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_43" id="Page_43">[43]</a></span>
-last man. Several Askari came in beaming with delight with
-several captured English rifles on their backs and an Indian
-prisoner in each hand. The handcuffs, however, which we
-found in their possession for use with German prisoners, were
-not used on them by any of us.</p>
-
-<p>At this time, in the dense forest, all units, and in many instances
-friend and foe, were mixed up together, everybody was
-shouting at once in all sorts of languages, darkness was rapidly
-setting in; it is only necessary to conjure up this scene in imagination
-in order to understand how it was that the pursuit which I
-set in motion failed completely. I had been stationed on the
-right wing, and had quickly despatched such units as were
-within reach at the moment to push with energy towards Ras-Kasone.
-Then I had gone to the left wing. There I found hardly
-any of our people at all; it was not till some time afterwards,
-in the night, that I heard the sound of the nailed boots of a party
-of Askari. I was glad at last to have a force in hand, but was
-somewhat disappointed to find it was a detachment of the
-right wing, under 2nd Lieutenant Langen, who had missed the
-way to Ras-Kasone and had thus got on to our left wing. But
-even these difficulties were not all. In some inexplicable way
-the troops imagined a Headquarter order had been issued that
-they were to return to their old camp west of Tanga. Only
-during the course of the night, at Tanga Railway Station, did it
-become clear to me that nearly all the companies had marched
-off for that destination. Of course they were ordered to return
-at once. But unfortunately this caused so much delay that it
-was impossible to bring Hering’s Battery, which had arrived
-later, into action by moonlight against the ships.</p>
-
-<p>The troops, whose great exhaustion was quite comprehensible,
-did not get back to Tanga until the morning of the 5th November,
-and occupied essentially the same position as the day before.
-It was not now advisable to advance with all our forces against
-the enemy, who was re-embarking at Ras-Kasone, as the country
-there was entirely open, and commanded by the cruisers lying in
-its immediate vicinity. All the same, the strong patrols and
-individual companies, who advanced towards Ras-Kasone, in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_44" id="Page_44">[44]</a></span>
-order to harass the enemy, succeeded in surprising him
-by machine-gun fire directed on various detachments, a few boats,
-and even the decks of the cruiser lying close to the hospital.
-During the day, the impression that the enemy had suffered a
-tremendous defeat grew stronger and stronger. It is true, the
-full extent of his losses did not become known to us all at once;
-but the many places where hundreds and hundreds of dead were
-piled up in heaps, and the smell of putrefaction which the tropical
-sun brought out all over the district, gave us some indication.
-Very cautiously we estimated the killed at about 800, but I believe
-this number to be far too low. A senior English officer, who
-had accurate knowledge of the details, told me later, on the occasion
-of an action in which he stated the English casualties to have
-been 1,500, that the losses at Tanga had been considerably
-greater. I now think that even 2,000 is too low an estimate.
-Even greater was the enemy’s loss in <i>moral</i>. He almost began
-to believe in spirits and spooks; years afterwards I was asked
-by English officers whether we had used trained bees at Tanga,
-but I may now perhaps betray the fact that at the decisive
-moment all the machine-guns of one of our companies were put
-out of action by these same “trained bees,” so that we suffered
-from this new “training” quite as much as the English.</p>
-
-<p>The enemy felt himself completely defeated, and he was.
-His troops had fled in wild confusion and thrown themselves
-head over heels into the lighters. The possibility of renewing
-the attack was not even considered. From prisoners’ statements
-and captured official English documents it was ascertained that
-the whole Anglo-Indian Expeditionary Force of 8,000 men had
-been thus decisively beaten by our force of little more than 1,000
-men. Not till the evening did we realize the magnitude of this
-victory, when an English officer, Captain Meinertshagen, came
-under a flag of truce to negotiate with Captain von Hammerstein,
-my representative, for the handing over of the wounded. Captain
-von Hammerstein proceeded to the hospital, which was full
-of severely wounded English officers, and in my name agreed
-to their being removed by the English on giving their word
-of honour not to fight against us again in this war.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_45" id="Page_45">[45]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The booty in arms enabled us to re-arm more than three
-companies with modern weapons, for which the sixteen machine-guns
-were particularly welcome. The <i>moral</i> of the force and its
-confidence in its leaders had enormously increased, and at one
-blow I was delivered from a great part of the difficulties which
-so greatly impeded the conduct of operations. The continuous
-fire of the ships’ guns, which the closeness of the country had
-rendered ineffective, had lost its terrors for our brave blacks.
-The quantity of stores captured was also considerable; besides
-600,000 rounds of small-arm ammunition the enemy had left
-behind the whole of his telephone gear and such quantities of
-clothing and equipment that we were able to meet all our requirements,
-especially in warm coats and blankets, for at least
-a year. Our own losses, painful though they were, were numerically
-insignificant. About fifteen (?) Europeans, among them the
-splendid Captain von Prince, and fifty-four (?) Askari and
-machine-gun carriers, had fallen. The Europeans were buried
-in a worthy warriors’ grave in the shade of a fine Buyu tree,
-where a simple memorial tablet is inscribed with their names.
-The work of clearing up the battlefield and burying the dead
-meant several days of most strenuous work for the whole force,
-as the streets were literally strewn with dead and badly wounded.
-In unknown tongues they begged for help which, with the best
-will in the world, could not always be accorded at once.</p>
-
-<p>At our main dressing station, in Tanga itself, our male and
-female nursing personnel had conscientiously cared for friend and
-foe even under the fire of the heavy guns of the ships. As recently
-as the evening of the 4th November I had been to see the
-wounded. I little thought that Lieutenant Schottstaedt, who
-was sitting there on a chair with a severe wound in the chest,
-had but a few minutes to live. The English Lieutenant Cook,
-of the 101st Indian Grenadiers, lay there with a bad gun-shot
-wound in the leg. This bright young officer, who had fallen into
-our hands in the hottest part of the fight on the Indian left wing,
-maintained his cheerfulness in spite of his wound. With the
-bulk of the other wounded, he was treated for nine months in
-the Field Hospital at Korogwe by our best surgeon, <i>Stabsarzt</i><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_46" id="Page_46">[46]</a></span>
-Dr. Müller. He was already walking about once more, when
-an unfortunate fall on the stairs caused his death.</p>
-
-<p>The fighting at Tanga was the first occasion on which heavy
-demands were made on our arrangements for the care of the
-wounded. For this purpose, hospitals had been established at
-Korogwe and at various other points on the Northern Railway,
-to which the sick could be taken by rail without being transferred
-from one method of transport to another. No special
-hospital arrangements of a permanent nature had been made for
-transport, but we never had any difficulty in improvising what
-was necessary.</p>
-
-<p>In spite of their undoubted defeat at Tanga it was probable
-that British determination would not accept this decision as
-final. Even after his defeat the enemy was still several times
-as strong as we were, and would not improbably attempt another
-landing elsewhere. But a cycle ride on the 6th November to
-Mansa Bay, in the North, convinced me that the hostile ships had
-run in there only for the purpose of attending to their wounded
-and burying their dead and had no intention of landing. And
-the ships actually did steam off towards Zanzibar soon after.
-At that time it was interesting to me to visit our Government
-Hospital near Ras-Kasone, which had in the meantime been
-evacuated by the English wounded released on parole. Among
-others I saw here two German officers who had been wounded
-at Tanga on the 3rd November, and others who had been wounded
-in an earlier action; from the hospital they had been able to
-observe events behind the English front on the 4th November,
-the day when the principal fighting took place. With the greatest
-excitement they had watched the landing at Ras-Kasone and the
-advance on Tanga; in the afternoon they had heard the opening
-of our decisive machine-gun fire and the bombardment by the
-ships’ guns, and had then witnessed the wild flight of the enemy
-close by the hospital. The numerous shells that had fallen
-near the hospital had fortunately done no damage. Quite
-early on the 5th November they had suddenly heard guns firing
-again, this time from the direction of Tanga; they realized
-that they must be German guns. They were in fact our two<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_47" id="Page_47">[47]</a></span>
-1873 pattern field-guns, which, though too late to deal with the
-English transports by moonlight, had at least managed to secure
-a few hits after daybreak. A prolonged fire for effect was now
-unfortunately impossible, as the smoke disclosed the positions
-of the guns at once and drew the fire of the ships.</p>
-
-<p>In the meantime it had become evident that the attack at
-Tanga was not an isolated enterprise, but had been intended to
-form part of a simultaneous operation on a large scale. Suddenly
-in the morning mist, on the 3rd November, English troops appeared
-north-west of Kilima Njaro, at Longido Mountain, which was
-held by Captain Kraut with three Companies of Askari and a
-Mounted Company of Europeans. Just as orders reached
-Longido Mountain by heliograph directing Captain Kraut to
-move off to Moshi, the first shell arrived. The enemy, about
-1,000 strong, had ascended the great mountain, which lies by
-itself in the open plain, at several points, being guided by Masai,
-who called out to the outposts: “We belong to Captain Kraut’s
-men.” But our three Field Companies deployed rapidly and
-succeeded in working round the enemy detachment in the rocky
-ground and quickly repelled them. A hostile detachment of
-mounted Europeans who became visible in the plain at the foot
-of the mountain, and apparently intended to ascend it from the
-south, or to act against our communications, was fired upon
-with effect and quickly driven off.</p>
-
-<p>Probably in connection with these events on the Northern
-Railway, hostile enterprises took place on Lake Victoria. At
-the end of October numerous Waganda warriors had penetrated
-from the North into the Bukoba district. To meet this menace,
-a force of 570 rifles, 4 machine-guns, and 2 guns left Muanza
-on the 31st October on board the small steamer <i>Muanza</i>, with
-2 tugs and 10 dhows (boats). Soon after the landing these
-transports were attacked by English steamers, but got back
-to Muanza without damage. An English attempt to land at
-Kayense, north of Muanza, broke down under the fire of our
-detachment posted there.</p>
-
-<p>Thus, at the beginning of November we were confronted with
-a concentric attack on our Colony, planned on a large scale.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_48" id="Page_48">[48]</a></span>
-Its failure made everyone expect that we would be able to hold
-our own as long as the home country could do so. But such
-scanty information as we could get from there gave us confidence.
-At the time of the action at Tanga we had, indeed, not heard
-the name of Hindenburg; but on the other hand we knew nothing
-of our reverse on the Marne, and were still buoyed up by the impression
-created by our victorious invasion of France.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_49" id="Page_49">[49]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER V<br />
-<span class="wn">AWAITING FURTHER EVENTS</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">THE danger threatening the Kilima Njaro country appeared
-to me to be by itself a sufficient reason for rapidly moving
-the troops back to the vicinity of New Moshi after the decisive
-success of Tanga, which in any event could not be further exploited.
-The joy of the Northern settlers, who, it should be
-noted, had furnished the bulk of the Europeans who fought at
-Tanga, was indescribable. The first train, which carried the
-European Company, returned to New Moshi bedecked with flowers.
-I myself had still enough to do at Tanga, and did not follow the
-troops to New Moshi for several days, where Headquarters was
-reopened. Shortage of personnel prevented us from having
-separate people for each duty. Officers of Headquarters had
-sometimes in an emergency to act as riflemen or cyclists, the
-Intendant occasionally did duty as an orderly, the clerk went
-into action with a rifle and acted as orderly in battle. The work
-was greatly facilitated by the fact that the railway station,
-constructed on European lines, afforded us accommodation which,
-in spite of being rather small, enabled us to settle most matters
-affecting the Staff only by word of mouth. We had good telephone
-and telegraph installations, and were situated centrally
-as the telephone and road systems, which we had either made or
-perfected, and which led out in both directions towards Tanga,
-Taveta, East Kilima Njaro, West Kilima Njaro and Longido,
-as well as to Arusha. Sometimes the work would go on for a
-week at a time almost as in peace, although the volume of work
-to be dealt with was greater. But although hardly anybody
-at Headquarters was either trained or prepared for his functions,
-harmonious and successful co-operation was secured. It was<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_50" id="Page_50">[50]</a></span>
-based upon the best spirit, devotion to the cause, and the support
-of good comradeship.</p>
-
-<p>I myself went by car&mdash;for we had made a motor-road right up
-to Longido Mountain&mdash;to the Engare-Nairobi (cold river), a
-small stream rising on the northern slopes of Kilima Njaro,
-and flowing between it and Longido through the prairie in a
-north-westerly direction. In this country a number of Boer
-families were settled on farms. Kraut’s detachment had moved
-their camp there, as their supplies, if they had remained on
-Longido Mountain, would have had to make a two-days’ march
-across the prairie, where they could not be protected, and were,
-therefore, too uncertain. I satisfied myself that there was at
-this time no opportunity for any enterprises north of Kilima
-Njaro, and returned to New Moshi. The distance from New
-Moshi, where we collected a large proportion of the supplies
-coming from Usambara and the country further south by rail
-to Taveta, is thirty miles. Although we had available only a
-few motors, namely, three cars and three lorries all told, they
-were in the circumstances a considerable help. The road being
-well made, the three-ton lorries could do the trip out and back
-in one day in dry weather. As carriers took at least four days
-for the same journey a calculation showed that one lorry could
-do the work of six hundred carriers, who required subsistence in
-addition. The principle, later maintained by the English, of
-replacing carriers and pack-animals by mechanical transport,
-is further supported by the fact that men and animals suffered
-severely from tropical diseases, whereas mosquitos are powerless
-against automobiles. We, however, could not derive full
-benefit from this advantage, since we had so few motors. Even
-in this period, which, as far as transport was concerned, was one
-of quiet and regularity, we had constantly to fall back upon
-carriers. To this day I remember the joy of the Intendant
-when a column of six hundred Wassukuma carriers arrived at
-New Moshi from about Muanza; they brought rice, which was
-urgently needed, from Lake Victoria, via Kondoa-Irangi to
-Kilima Njaro. If one remembers that this march required at
-least thirty days, that the carrier needs one kg. (two lbs.)<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_51" id="Page_51">[51]</a></span>
-of food a day, and that his maximum load is twenty-five
-kg. (fifty-five lbs.), it is clear that these marches have to be
-arranged with great care and directed through well populated
-and fertile districts if this method of transport is to be of any
-value. If, in spite of these disadvantages, carrier transport
-had to be resorted to on a large scale, it only shows up the supply-difficulties
-we had to contend with. The Intendant, Captain
-Feilke, was, however, a past master in handling the men and
-looking after them. The carriers felt that they were well cared
-for, and the word “Kommando,” which some of them took as
-a personal name, became quite common. I myself was able,
-by means of the motors, to carry out many reconnaissances
-and inspections of the troops. I could reach Taveta, to which
-place some of the troops from Tanga returned, in two hours from
-New Moshi; this would otherwise have taken four days; later
-on I drove in one day from New Moshi to the Engare-Nairobi,
-round the west side of the whole of Meru Mountain, and back
-to New Moshi, a journey which could hardly have been accomplished
-with carriers in less than ten days.</p>
-
-<p>The success at Tanga called forth and revived the determination
-to resist all over the Colony.</p>
-
-<p>At Morogoro, on the 26th November, the Inspector of Lines
-of Communication, Major-General Wahle, succeeded in obtaining
-the Governor’s consent to the defence of Dar-es-Salaam in case
-of attack. As luck would have it, this consent was given just
-in time. On the 28th, two men-of-war, a transport and a tug,
-appeared off Dar-es-Salaam, and demanded to inspect our ships
-lying in the harbour. Among others, there was the <i>Tabora</i>,
-of the German East African Line, which had been converted
-into a hospital-ship. As the English had on a previous occasion
-declared that they did not consider themselves bound by any
-agreement about Dar-es-Salaam, fresh negotiations would have
-been necessary every time we wanted to escape a threatened
-bombardment. Thus an endless screw was created. I now
-wired that the entry into the harbour of a pinnace, demanded
-by the English, was to be resisted by force of arms. Unfortunately,
-however, it had been conceded by the German civil<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_52" id="Page_52">[52]</a></span>
-authority, against my opinion, and the Senior Officer present at
-Dar-es-Salaam felt himself bound. The English, however,
-came in, not with the one pinnace which had been agreed to,
-but with several small vessels, and then proceeded to carry
-out demolitions on board the <i>Tabora</i>, and even took some of
-her crew prisoners. This made it only too evident, even to those
-who had hitherto been doubtful, how misplaced our previous
-compliance had been. Captain von Kornatzky was just in time
-to open effective machine-gun fire on the small English vessels as
-they passed out by the narrow English harbour entrance. Unfortunately,
-on this occasion, one of the German prisoners was
-also hit. The necessary defensive measures had simply not been
-adopted in time. This is a small example of the dangers and
-disadvantages that arise when, in time of war, the military commander
-is constantly interfered with in his decisions, and in
-the execution of operations which are in the nature of things
-inevitable.</p>
-
-<p>And, after all, the subsequent bombardment of Dar-es-Salaam
-did no harm worth mentioning, for the damage done to a few
-houses can hardly be considered as serious.</p>
-
-<p>During the time of comparatively sedentary warfare at New
-Moshi the material side of life was also pleasant. The Europeans,
-who mostly belonged to the settler community of the
-northern territories, provided most of their subsistence themselves;
-abundant supplies of rice, wheat-flour, bananas, pineapples,
-European fruit, coffee and potatoes, came in from the
-plantations. Sugar was provided by the numerous factories,
-and our principal supply of salt came from the Gottorp salt works,
-on the Central Railway, between Tabora and Lake Tanganyika.
-Many plantations devoted themselves entirely to supplying
-the troops, and, owing to the abundant labour available
-this change in production caused no difficulties. But the transport
-system had also to work at high pressure. The great road
-leading from Kimamba to Mombo and Korogwe, on the Northern
-Railway, was continuously improved, so as to carry the transport
-of the products from the area of the Tanganyika Railway and
-further South, to the North. On this line alone at least eight<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_53" id="Page_53">[53]</a></span>
-thousand carriers were continuously employed. It soon proved
-to be practical not to make the carriers do the whole distance of
-a hundred and ninety miles, but to distribute them on different
-stages. This made it possible to quarter them permanently
-and to look after their health. Experts in hygiene travelled up
-and down the road, and did what was humanly possible for the
-health of the carriers, especially against dysentery and typhoid.
-In this manner we established along this very frequented route
-permanent carrier-camps a day’s march apart, in which the
-men were accommodated at first in extemporized huts, which
-were later properly completed. Camp discipline was strictly
-regulated. In order to provide also for the many Europeans
-passing through, small houses with concrete floors were put
-up; and individuals were enabled to subsist on the supplies
-held on the line of communication, without having to burden
-themselves with provisions to last for a prolonged period, as is
-customary on journeys in Africa. The work on this line of
-supply was the object of constant attention. Both Europeans
-and natives had still to learn how to ensure the co-operation of
-such masses of men, and to understand the importance of order
-and discipline in the working of the transport for the health of
-all concerned.</p>
-
-<p>At New Moshi Station both telephone and telegraph were
-working day and night. Where the whole organization had to
-be improvised friction was not altogether unavoidable. All
-the members of Headquarters were extraordinarily hard-worked.
-But we did have bright intervals during the strenuous work.
-The abundance of creature comforts enjoyed by the Europeans
-in the North was shared by us at Headquarters. We were
-literally spoilt by the number of gifts sent us by private individuals.
-If one of us travelled on the Northern Railway,
-on which in time of peace it was difficult to obtain a little food
-for love or money, he was now cared for by someone at almost
-every station. I remember when Lieut. Freiherr von Schroetter
-returned to New Moshi, very famished, after carrying out some
-very exhausting patrols in the country north of Erok Mountain.
-After having, according to normal ideas, been thoroughly well<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_54" id="Page_54">[54]</a></span>
-fed from seven o’clock till eleven, he shyly asked if he might
-have some supper. The next morning he started on fourteen
-days’ leave to his plantation in Usambara, in order to recuperate
-and attend to his business. After breakfast we gave him coffee,
-bread, butter and meat, to take with him in the train, and had
-warned the various railway stations to look after this completely
-famished patroller. So, after half an hour, the station guard
-at Kahe offered him another breakfast, at Lembeni the charming
-wife of the Station Commandant had baked him a cake, and at
-Lame he was looked after by the commander of the local Recruit
-Depot, Sergt.-Major Reinhardt. At Makanya the guard, Planter
-Baroy, who belonged to the country, brought him home-made
-chocolate and bullocks’ hearts&mdash;a fruit the size of a melon&mdash;at
-Buiko the hospitable traffic manager of the Northern Railway,
-Kuehlwein, who had so often entertained us in passing
-through, had prepared him a delicate meal. At Mombo, where
-the supplies from the Usambara Mountains were collected, and
-where we had established most of our workshops, our protégé
-was met by Warrant Officer Meyer, of the Navy, with a sustaining
-supper. But then we got a telegram: “Please do not
-order any more, I can’t eat any more.”</p>
-
-<p>Although this continuous feeding shows a spirit of sympathetic
-chaff at the expense of the starving subaltern, it also
-proves, better than any theoretical dissertations, how intimately
-all classes of the population of the northern districts worked in
-with the troops, and how they tried to anticipate our every
-wish. This co-operation continued as long as the troops remained
-in the North.</p>
-
-<p>Whenever duty gave us a chance we arranged for change and
-recuperation. On Sundays we often went out together near
-New Moshi for a cheery day’s shooting. Both carriers and
-Askari soon picked up their business as beaters, and drove the
-game towards us in exemplary order, with loud shouts of
-“Huyu, huyu:” “There he is.” For variety of game the
-country provided more than one would be likely to find anywhere
-in Europe: hare, various dwarf antelopes, guinea-fowl,
-several relatives of the partridge, duck, bush-buck, water-buck,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_55" id="Page_55">[55]</a></span>
-lynx, several kinds of wild boar, small kudu, jackal and many
-other kinds of game abounded. Once, I remember, to my
-astonishment, a lion silently appeared fifteen paces in front of
-me. Unfortunately I had my gun in my hand, and before I
-could put up my rifle, which was on my knees, he had as silently
-disappeared. In the teeming Kilima Njaro country, and even
-more east of Taveta, our shooting expeditions provided a welcome
-increase to our meat supply. But in the main this depended
-on the cattle which the Masai brought us from the Kilima Njaro
-and Meru country, but which also came from far away near
-Lake Victoria.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_56" id="Page_56">[56]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER VI<br />
-FURTHER HEAVY FIGHTING IN THE NORTH-EAST</h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap10">BY the time we kept Christmas in the Mission Church at
-New Moshi, and afterwards in our mess in the Railway
-Station, the military situation north of Tanga had become
-sufficiently acute to indicate that decisive events in this quarter
-were probable. During the last days of December, our patrols,
-who in that district were on British territory, had been gradually
-pushed back, and had concentrated south of Jassini, on German
-territory. The combined force amounted to two companies and
-a corps of some two hundred Arabs. The enemy had obviously
-been reinforced, and occupied the buildings of the German
-plantation of Jassini. It looked as though he intended to push
-gradually forward along the coast to Tanga, securing the occupied
-country by a system of block-houses. In order to investigate
-matters on the spot, I travelled early in January with Capt.
-von Hammerstein to Tanga, and thence by car to Capt. Adler’s
-camp at Mwurnoni, using the newly-completed coast road to
-the north, a distance of thirty-eight miles. Lieut. Bleeck, of
-the Reserve, whose numerous successful patrols in that country
-rendered him particularly suitable for the purpose, accompanied
-me on my reconnaissance, from which I learned that the country
-for miles round Jassini consisted principally of a cocoanut
-plantation belonging to the German East African Company,
-which was also planted with sisal, a species of agave with sharp
-thorns. This sisal, which formed a dense undergrowth among
-the palms, was in many places so interlaced that one could only
-force one’s way through by enduring a quantity of very unpleasant
-pricks. It is, of course, always difficult to make plans
-for an action in country so totally unknown to one without<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_57" id="Page_57">[57]</a></span>
-the aid of a map, and relying only on the reports of patrols.
-In this case we got over the difficulty as Lieut. Schaefer, of the
-Reserve, who had been called to the colours, had for years held
-the post of Assistant on this plantation, and could therefore
-furnish exact information. A tolerably accurate sketch was
-prepared, and the battle-names allotted to various localities
-were entered on it. The general situation appeared to be that
-Jassini was an advanced post, and that the main body of the
-enemy was in fortified camps further north. It was to be
-assumed that an attack on the advanced post of Jassini would
-entice the main body to leave its camps and fight in the open
-(sic!). My plan was to take advantage of this possibility. In
-order to engage the enemy while hurrying from his places of
-assembly to the assistance of the advanced post, in favourable
-tactical conditions, I intended to place my troops in readiness
-on his probable lines of advance, in such a manner that he would
-have to run up against them.</p>
-
-<p>In this closely-settled country supply presented no difficulty,
-and the necessary carriers could be provided by the numerous
-European plantations. So the companies ordered up by telegraph
-from New Moshi had only to be accompanied by their
-machine-gun and ammunition carriers, a considerable advantage
-in arranging for their railway journey. This was accomplished
-rapidly and without friction, thanks to the proved
-capacity of the Commandant of the Line, Lieutenant Kroeber,
-retired, of the Landwehr, and the understanding and consuming
-zeal with which the whole personnel of the railway bore the unavoidable
-strain without a murmur.</p>
-
-<p>By the 16th January the companies from New Moshi had detrained
-a couple of miles west of Tanga, and at once marched off
-towards Jassini, as well as the troops from Tanga, for the immediate
-protection of which only one company was left behind.
-On the evening of the 17th January the force of nine companies,
-with two guns, was assembled at Totohown plantation, seven
-miles south of Jassini, and orders for the attack were issued for
-the following morning. Major Kepler, with two companies, was
-directed to attack the village of Jassini, working round by the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_58" id="Page_58">[58]</a></span>
-right, and Captain Adler, with two more companies, had a
-similar task on the left. To the north-west, on the road from
-Semanya, was posted the Arab corps. Captain Otto, with the
-9th Company, advanced frontally by the main road on Jassini,
-followed immediately by Headquarters and the main body,
-consisting of the European Company, three Askari Companies,
-and two guns. The marches were so arranged that the attacks
-on Jassini should take place simultaneously at daybreak, and
-that all columns should mutually support each other by pushing
-on with energy. Even before daybreak the first shots fell in the
-vicinity of Kepler’s column, a few minutes later firing began in
-front of us with Otto’s column, and then became general. It
-was impossible in the endless dense palm forest to obtain an
-even approximate idea of what was really happening. We were,
-however, already so close up to the hostile position at Jassini,
-that the enemy seemed to be surprised, in spite of his excellent
-intelligence service. This supposition was afterwards, in part
-at least, confirmed. Of our rapid concentration south of Jassini,
-and our immediate attack with such strong forces, the enemy
-had actually had no idea.</p>
-
-<p>Otto’s column quickly drove back an entrenched post in its
-front, and Headquarters now made a circuit to the left through
-the forest, where first one, and then two more companies, were
-put in so as to outflank Jassini. What seemed curious was
-that in this move we came under a very well-aimed fire at short
-range, possibly no more than 200 yards; and it was not till much
-later that we learned that the enemy had not only a weak post
-in Jassini, but that four companies of Indians were also established
-there in a strongly constructed and excellently concealed
-fort. Suddenly Captain von Hammerstein, who was walking
-behind me, collapsed; he had been shot in the abdomen.
-Deeply as this affected me, at the moment I had to leave my
-badly-wounded comrade in the hands of the doctor. A few days
-later the death of this excellent officer tore a gap in the ranks of
-our Staff which was hard to fill.</p>
-
-<p>The fighting had become very hot. Two companies, although
-their commanders, Lieuts. Gerlich and Spalding, had fallen<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_59" id="Page_59">[59]</a></span>
-had quickly captured the fortified buildings of Jassini by a
-brilliant charge, and had now established themselves close in
-front of the enemy’s position. Soon the intervention of the
-enemy’s main force made itself felt. From the direction of
-Wanga, in the north-east, strong hostile columns arrived and
-suddenly appeared close in front of our companies, lying close
-to the fortifications of Jassini. The enemy made three strong
-attacks at this point and was each time repulsed. Hostile
-columns also arrived from the north and north-west. Against
-that from the west the Arab corps had done badly; the day
-before many of them had urgently demanded their discharge.
-Now, when they were to lie in ambush on the enemy’s road of
-advance, the tension became too great for them. Instead of
-surprising the enemy by an annihilating fire, they fired blindly
-into the air and then bolted. But luckily these hostile columns
-then came on Captain Adler’s two companies, and were repulsed
-with slaughter. Up till then the whole action had been in the
-nature of an energetic assault; even the last reserve, the
-European Company, had, at its urgent request, been sent into
-action. Towards noon the fighting had everywhere become
-stationary before the strong defences of the enemy. We had, as
-a matter of fact, no means of making a sufficient impression on
-them, and even our field-guns, which we placed in position at
-two hundred yards, produced no decisive effect. The heat was
-insupportable, and, as at Tanga, everyone quenched his thirst
-with young cocoanuts. I myself went with Lieut. Bleeck to
-the right wing, to find out how things were going with Major
-Kepler’s column. At that time I had not yet obtained a clear
-idea of the enemy’s defences, and so, on the sands of a clear and
-open creek, which was then dry, we again came under a very
-well-aimed fire. From a distance of five hundred yards the
-bullets fell close to us, and the spurts of sand they threw up
-made correction easy. The sand was so deep and the heat so
-great that one could only run, or even walk quickly, for a few
-paces at a time. Most of the time we had to walk slowly across
-the open and bear the unpleasant fire as best we could. Fortunately
-it did no serious harm, although one bullet through my<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_60" id="Page_60">[60]</a></span>
-hat and another through my arm showed that it was well meant.
-On the way back from the right wing our thirst and exhaustion
-were so great that several gentlemen, who were usually by no
-means on bad terms with each other, had a serious difference of
-opinion about a cocoanut, although it would not have been
-difficult to get more from the countless trees all round us.</p>
-
-<p>Headquarters had now returned to the Totohown-Jassini
-road. Along this ran a light railway for the work of the plantation,
-the wagons of which were now continuously employed
-in taking wounded back to Totohown, where a hospital had been
-established in the European buildings. Ammunition&mdash;of which
-the Askari carried about 150 rounds&mdash;began to run short, and
-reports from the firing line that they could not hold on longer
-became more frequent. Slightly wounded who had been tied
-up and a mass of stragglers collected at Headquarters, whole
-platoons had completely lost themselves, or had for other reasons
-left the places assigned to them. All these men were collected
-and reorganized, and thus a fresh reserve was made available.
-The ammunition in the machine-gun belts was to a great extent
-expended, and fresh supplies came up from Totohown by the
-light railway. The belt-filling machines were fixed to the palm-trees
-and kept incessantly at work. It was evident that we had
-already suffered considerable casualties. A few wished to
-break off the action, as there seemed no prospect of capturing
-the enemy’s defences. But the thought of the unpleasant
-situation of the enemy, shut up in his works, without water, and
-having to carry on all the occupations of daily existence in a
-confined space, in a burning sun and under hostile fire, made it
-appear that if we only held on with determination we might
-yet achieve success. The afternoon and night passed in incessant
-fighting; as is always the case in such critical situations, all
-sorts of rumours arose. It was said that the garrison of the
-enemy’s works consisted of South African Europeans, who were
-excellent marksmen; some people even declared they had understood
-their speech perfectly. It was indeed still very difficult
-to form a clear idea. My orderly, Ombasha (Lance-Corporal)
-Rayabu, at once volunteered to make a close reconnaissance,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_61" id="Page_61">[61]</a></span>
-crawled close up to the enemy’s line, and was killed there. The
-native, who is at all times easily excitable, was doubly so in this
-critical situation at night, and I frequently had to take the men
-severely to task for firing blindly into the air.</p>
-
-<p class="p2">Early on the 19th January the fire broke out again with the
-greatest intensity. The enemy, who was surrounded on all sides,
-made a sortie, which failed, and soon after hoisted the white flag.
-Four Indian companies, with European officers and N.C.O.’s,
-fell into our hands. We all remarked the warlike pride with
-which our Askari regarded the enemy; I never thought our
-black fellows could look so distinguished.</p>
-
-<p>Both friend and foe had been in an unpleasant situation, and
-were near the end of their nervous strength. That is usually
-the case with any soldier who takes his duty seriously. But the
-Askari now learned that one must overcome one’s own feelings
-in order to obtain the superior moral force necessary for victory.</p>
-
-<p>I estimated the enemy’s casualties at 700 at least; the captured
-documents gave a clear indication of his strength, which was
-more than double our own. According to them, General Tighe,
-commanding the troops in British East Africa, who had landed a
-short time before at Wanga, had more than twenty companies
-assembled at and near Jassini, most of whom had come by
-march route along the coast from the direction of Mombasa.
-They were to push forward towards Tanga.</p>
-
-<p>With the aid of the mechanical transport and the rickshaws,
-which worked between the Field Hospital at Totohown and
-Tanga, the wounded were moved from Jassini to the hospitals
-on the Northern Railway quite easily in a few days. These
-rickshaws, small spring-carts (like dog-carts), drawn by one
-man, which take the place of cabs at Tanga, had been requisitioned
-for carrying wounded by the Senior Medical Officer. The
-enemy had withdrawn into his fortified camps north of the
-frontier, and a fresh attack on them did not seem to me very
-promising. We immediately commenced patrol operations, as
-a support to which we left a detachment of a few companies at
-Jassini; the bulk of the troops was moved off again to the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_62" id="Page_62">[62]</a></span>
-Kilima Njaro country. On the march to the entraining station
-on the Northern Railway the troops passed through Amboni
-Plantation. There the inhabitants of Tanga had voluntarily
-provided food and refreshments; and after the tremendous
-exertions entailed by the expedition to Jassini, with its continuous
-forced marches, the exhausting heat, and the uninterrupted
-fighting by day and night, the sulphur-laden Sigi
-stream was soon alive with white and black bathers. All our
-toil was forgotten, and our spirits rose to the highest pitch on
-receiving at this very moment, after a rather long interval,
-another wireless message from home. It indicated that news
-of the fighting at Tanga had probably just reached Germany,
-and contained His Majesty’s appreciation of the success we had
-gained there.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_63" id="Page_63">[63]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER VII<br />
-<span class="wn">GUERILLA WARFARE AND FURTHER PREPARATIONS</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap08">DOCUMENTS which we captured later proved by figures
-that the enemy moved troops from Lake Victoria towards
-Kilima Njaro. So the battle actually did relieve other, far
-distant theatres. This observation bore out the original contention
-that the best protection of the whole territory consisted
-in taking a firm hold of the enemy at one point. Whether the
-remainder of the Colony was also locally protected with energy
-was not as important. All the same, I was greatly rejoiced when
-in February, 1915, the Governor was persuaded to issue the order
-that the coast towns were to be defended if threatened by the
-enemy. The successes obtained hitherto had demonstrated that
-this local defence was not hopeless, even against the fire of ships’
-guns.</p>
-
-<p>Although the attack carried out at Jassini with nine companies
-had been completely successful, it showed that such heavy losses
-as we also had suffered could only be borne in exceptional cases.
-We had to economize our forces in order to last out a long war.
-Of the regular officers, Major Kepler, Lieuts. Spalding and
-Gerlich, Second-Lieuts. Kaufmann and Erdmann were killed;
-Captain von Hammerstein had died of his wound. The loss of
-these professional soldiers&mdash;about one seventh of the regular
-officers present&mdash;could not be replaced.</p>
-
-<p>The expenditure of 200,000 rounds also proved that with the
-means at my disposal I could at the most fight three more actions
-of this nature. The need to strike great blows only quite exceptionally,
-and to restrict myself principally to guerilla warfare,
-was evidently imperative.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_64" id="Page_64">[64]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The guiding principle of constantly operating against the
-Uganda Railway could, however, be resumed, as here it was in
-any case impossible to act with larger forces. For it was necessary
-to make marches of several days’ duration through the
-great, waterless and thinly populated desert, which provided
-little sustenance beyond occasional game. Not only food, but
-water had to be carried. This alone limited the size of the
-force to be employed. Such expeditions through districts providing
-neither water nor food require a degree of experience on
-the part of the troops which could not possibly exist at that stage
-of the war. A company even was too large a force to send across
-this desert, and if, after several days of marching, it really had
-reached some point on the railway, it would have had to come back
-again, because it could not be supplied. However, these conditions
-improved as the troops became better trained, and as our
-knowledge of the country, which was at first mainly <i>terra incognita</i>,
-increased.</p>
-
-<p>So there was nothing for it but to seek to attain our object
-by means of small detachments, or patrols. To these patrols
-we afterwards attached the greatest importance. Starting from
-the Engare-Nairobi, small detachments of eight to ten men,
-Europeans and Askaris, rode round the rear of the enemy’s camps,
-which had been pushed up as far as the Longido, and attacked
-their communications. They made use of telephones we had
-captured at Tanga, tapping in on the English telephone-lines;
-then they waited for large or small hostile detachments or columns
-of ox-wagons to pass. From their ambush they opened fire on
-the enemy at thirty yards’ range, captured prisoners and booty,
-and then disappeared again in the boundless desert. Thus, at
-that time, we captured rifles, ammunition, and war material of
-all kinds. One of these patrols had observed near Erok Mountain
-that the enemy sent his riding-horses to water at a certain
-time. Ten of our horsemen at once started out, and, after a
-two days’ ride through the desert, camped close to the enemy.
-Six men went back with the horses; the four others each took a
-saddle, and crept at a distance of a few paces past the enemy’s
-sentries close up to the watering-place, which lay behind the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_65" id="Page_65">[65]</a></span>
-camp. An English soldier was driving the horses, when suddenly
-two men of our patrol confronted him out of the bush and
-covering him with their rifles ordered “Hands up!” In his
-surprise he dropped his clay pipe out of his mouth. At once he
-was asked: “Where are the missing four horses?” for our
-conscientious patrol had noticed that there were only fifty-seven,
-whereas the day before they had counted sixty-one! These
-four needed light treatment and had been left in camp. The
-leading horse and a few others were quickly saddled, mounted,
-and off they went at a gallop round the enemy’s camp towards
-the German lines. Even in the captured Englishman, who had
-to take part in this <i>safari</i> on a bare horse, without much comfort,
-the innate sporting instinct of his nation came out. With great
-humour he shouted: “I should just like to see my Captain’s
-face now!” and when the animals had arrived safely in the
-German camp he remarked: “It was a damned good piece of
-work.”</p>
-
-<p>This capture, increased by a number of other horses and
-mules we had picked up, enabled us to form a second mounted
-company. We now had two mounted companies, composed of
-Askari and Europeans mixed, an organization which proved
-successful. They provided us with the means of sweeping the
-extensive desert north of Kilima Njaro with strong patrols who
-went out for several days at a time; they penetrated even as far
-as the Uganda and Magad Railways, destroyed bridges, surprised
-guards posted on the railways, mined the permanent way and
-carried out raids of all kinds on the land communications between
-the railways and the enemy’s camps. In these enterprises our
-own people did not get off scot free. One patrol had brilliantly
-surprised two companies of Indians by rifle fire, but had then
-lost their horses, which had been left behind in hiding, by the fire
-of the enemy; they had to make their way back across the
-desert on foot, which took four days, and they had no food.
-Luckily they found milk and cattle in a Masai kraal, and later on
-saved themselves from starvation by killing an elephant. But
-success whetted the spirit of adventure, and the requests to be
-sent on patrol, mounted or on foot, increased.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_66" id="Page_66">[66]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The patrols that went out from the Kilima Njaro in a more
-easterly direction were of a different character. They had to
-work on foot through the dense bush for days on end. The
-patrols sent out to destroy the railway were mostly weak: one
-or two Europeans, two to four Askari, and five to seven carriers.
-They had to worm their way through the enemy’s pickets and
-were often betrayed by native scouts. In spite of this they
-mostly reached their objective and were sometimes away for
-more than a fortnight. For such a small party a bit of game
-or a small quantity of booty afforded a considerable reserve of
-rations. But the fatigue and thirst in the burning sun were so
-great that several men died of thirst, and even Europeans drank
-urine. It was a bad business when anyone fell ill or was wounded,
-with the best will in the world it was often impossible to bring
-him along. To carry a severely wounded man from the Uganda
-Railway right across the desert to the German camps, as was
-occasionally done, is a tremendous performance. Even the
-blacks understood that, and cases did occur in which a wounded
-Askari, well knowing that he was lost without hope, and a prey
-to the numerous lions, did not complain when he had to be left
-in the bush, but of his own accord gave his comrades his rifle and
-ammunition, so that they at least might be saved.</p>
-
-<p>The working of these patrols became more and more perfect.
-Knowledge of the desert improved, and in addition to patrols
-for destruction and intelligence work, we developed a system of
-fighting patrols. The latter, consisting of twenty to thirty
-Askari, or even more, and sometimes equipped with one or two
-machine-guns, went out to look for the enemy and inflict losses
-upon him. In the thick bush the combatants came upon each
-other at such close quarters and so unexpectedly, that our
-Askari sometimes literally jumped over their prone adversaries
-and so got behind them again. The influence of these expeditions
-on the self-reliance and enterprise of both Europeans and natives
-was so great that it would be difficult to find a force imbued with
-a better spirit. Some disadvantages were, however, unavoidable.
-In particular, our small supply of ammunition did not
-enable us to attain such a degree of marksmanship as to enable<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_67" id="Page_67">[67]</a></span>
-us, when we did get the enemy in an unfavourable situation,
-completely to destroy him. In technical matters we were also
-busy. Skilled artificers and armourers were constantly engaged
-with the factory engineers in the manufacture of suitable apparatus
-for blowing up the railways. Some of these appliances fired
-according as they were set, either at once, or after a certain number
-of wheels had passed over them. With the latter arrangement
-we hoped to destroy the engines, even if the English tried to protect
-them by pushing one or two trucks filled with sand in front
-of them. There was abundance of dynamite to be had on the
-plantations, but the demolition charges captured at Tanga were
-much more effective.</p>
-
-<p>We occasionally got German newspapers, but we had had no
-private mails for a long time. On the 12th February, 1915, I
-was sitting at dinner in the Railway Station at New Moshi, when
-I got a letter from Germany. It was from my sister, who wrote
-to say she had already repeatedly informed me of the death
-of my brother, who had been killed on the Western Front at
-Libramont on the 22nd August, 1914.</p>
-
-<p>In April, 1915, we were surprised by the news of the arrival
-of a store-ship. When entering Mansa Bay, north of Tanga,
-she was chased and fired at by an English cruiser, and her captain
-had to run her aground. Although during the ensuing weeks
-we salved almost the whole of the valuable cargo, we found
-that unfortunately the cartridges had suffered severely from
-the sea-water. The powder and caps deteriorated more and
-more, and so the number of miss-fires increased. There was
-nothing for it but to break up the whole of the ammunition,
-clean the powder, and replace some of the caps by new ones.
-Luckily there were caps in the Colony, though of a different
-pattern; but for months all the Askari and carriers we could
-lay hands on were employed at Moshi from morning till night
-making ammunition. The serviceable cartridges we had left
-were kept exclusively for the machine-guns; of the re-made
-ammunition, that which gave about 20 per cent. of miss-fires
-was kept for action, while that giving a higher percentage was
-used for practice.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_68" id="Page_68">[68]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The arrival of the store-ship aroused tremendous enthusiasm,
-since it proved that communication between ourselves and
-home still existed. All of us listened with eagerness to the
-stories of the Captain, Lieutenant Christiansen, when he arrived
-at my Headquarters at New Moshi after his wound was healed.
-The terrific fighting at home, the spirit of self-sacrifice and
-boundless enterprise which inspired the deeds of the German
-troops, awakened a response in our hearts. Many who had
-been despondent now took courage once more, since they learned
-that what appears impossible can be achieved if effort is sustained
-by determination.</p>
-
-<p>Another means of raising the spirit of the force was by promotion.
-Generally speaking, I could only make promotions
-to non-commissioned rank, and within the commissioned ranks;
-but the grant of a commission, which would in many cases
-have been well-deserved, was beyond my power. Each case
-was very carefully considered, so as to determine whether
-really good work had been done. In this way unmerited promotions,
-which ruin the spirit of the troops, were avoided. On
-the whole, however, we had to cultivate the moral factors less
-by rewards than by other means. Decorations for war service
-were practically unknown among us. It was not personal
-ambition to which we appealed; we sought to arouse and maintain
-a real sense of duty dictated by patriotism, and an evergrowing
-feeling of comradeship. Perhaps it was the very fact
-that this lasting and pure motive remained unsoiled by any
-other purpose that inspired Europeans and Askari with that
-endurance and energy which the Protective Force manifested until
-the end.</p>
-
-<p>In the Kilima Njaro country the English were not inactive.
-From Oldorobo Mountain, seven and a half miles east of Taveta,
-which was held by a German detached post under an officer,
-an attack by two Indian Companies was reported by telephone
-one morning. Thereupon Captain Koehl and the Austrian
-Lieutenant Freiherr von Unterrichter at once marched off from
-Taveta; the two companies had become immobilized on the
-steep slopes of the mountain, and our people attacked them<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_69" id="Page_69">[69]</a></span>
-on both flanks with such vigour that they fled, leaving about
-twenty dead behind, while one machine-gun and 70,000 rounds
-fell into our hands. Other hostile expeditions were undertaken
-along the Tsavo River to the north-east side of Kilima Njaro;
-they were based on Mzima Camp on the Tsavo, which was strongly
-fortified and held by several companies. The patrol encounters
-that took place north-east of Kilima Njaro all ended in our
-favour; even the young Askari of the Rombo Detachment,
-which had a strength of sixty and was named after the mission
-on the Eastern Kilima Njaro, had unbounded faith in their
-commander, Lieutenant-Colonel von Bock, who was over sixty
-years old. I remember a wounded man who came from him
-to New Moshi, with a report for me, and refused to be attended
-to so as to lose no time in getting back to his commanding officer.
-In several fights, when the enemy occasionally amounted to
-two companies, these young troops were victorious, and it is a
-significant fact that among the English all manner of tales
-were current about these actions. The British Commander-in-Chief
-sent me a written complaint, saying that a German woman
-was taking part in them, and perpetrating inhuman cruelties,
-an idea which was, of course, without any foundation, and merely
-served to show the degree of nerves with which the enemy
-authorities had become afflicted.</p>
-
-<p>Notwithstanding the great amount of booty taken at Tanga,
-it was evident that, as the war seemed likely to be prolonged,
-the stocks in the Colony would become exhausted. The natives
-at New Moshi began all of a sudden to wear silk: this was by
-no means a sign of special extravagance: the stocks of cotton
-clothing in the Indian shops were simply coming to an end. We
-had seriously to think of starting manufactures ourselves, in order
-to convert the abundant raw material into finished products.
-A curious existence now developed, reminding one of the industry
-of the Swiss family Robinson. Cotton fields existed in plenty.
-Popular books were hunted up, giving information about the forgotten
-arts of hand spinning and weaving; white and black
-women took to spinning by hand; at the missions and in private
-workshops spinning-wheels and looms were built. In this<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_70" id="Page_70">[70]</a></span>
-manner, in a short time, the first useful piece of cotton cloth was
-produced. After various trials, the most suitable dye was obtained
-from the root of a tree called Ndaa, which imparted a
-brownish-yellow colour, very inconspicuous both in the grass
-and in the bush, and therefore specially suitable for uniforms.
-The rubber gathered by the planters was vulcanized with sulphur,
-and we succeeded in producing efficient tyres for motors and
-bicycles. At Morogoro a few planters successfully produced a
-motor-fuel from cocos, known as trebol, which was like benzol,
-and was employed in the automobiles. As in former times,
-candles were made out of tallow and wax, both by private persons
-and by the troops, and also soap. Then again, the numerous
-factories on the plantations in the northern territories and on the
-Tanganyika Railway were adapted to produce various means of
-subsistence.</p>
-
-<p>A particularly important item was the provision of foot-wear.
-The raw material was obtained from the plentiful skins of cattle
-and game; tanning materials from the mangroves on the coast.
-In peace time the missions had already made good boots; their
-activity was now further developed, while the troops also established
-tanneries and shoemakers’ shops on a larger scale. It is
-true some little time elapsed before the authorities complied with
-the urgent and inevitable demands of the troops in an adequate
-manner, and, in particular, before they placed at our disposal
-the buffalo-hides necessary for making sole-leather. So the old
-historic fight for the cow-hide revived again, <i>mutatis mutandis</i>, in
-East Africa. The first boots made in any quantity were turned
-out at Tanga. Although at first their shape needed improving,
-they at any rate protected the feet of our white and black troops
-when marching and patrolling in the thorn bush of the Pori.
-For the thorns that fall to the ground bore into the feet again
-and again. All the small beginnings of food-stuff production
-that had already existed on the plantations in time of peace
-were galvanized into more extensive activity by the war, and
-by the need of subsisting large masses. On several farms in the
-Kilima Njaro country butter and excellent cheese were produced in
-great quantities, and the slaughter-houses round about Wilhelmstal<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_71" id="Page_71">[71]</a></span>
-could hardly keep up with the demands for sausages and other
-smoked meats.</p>
-
-<p>It was to be anticipated that quinine, which was so important
-for the health of the Europeans, would soon become exhausted,
-and that our requirements could not be met by capture alone.
-So it was a matter of great importance that we succeeded in
-producing good quinine tablets at the Amani Biological Institute
-in Usambara out of bark obtained in the North.</p>
-
-<p>The provision of proper communications for ox-wagons and
-motors involved the construction of permanent bridges. Engineer
-Rentell, who had been called to the colours, built an
-arched bridge of stone and concrete, with a heavy pier, over the
-Kikafu torrent, west of New Moshi. During the rains, particularly
-in April, no wooden structure would have withstood
-the masses of water coming down the steep river-bed, which was
-nearly 70 feet deep.</p>
-
-<p>These examples will suffice to show the stimulating influence
-of the war and its requirements on the economic life of the Colony.</p>
-
-<p>The organization of the Force was also constantly improved.
-By transferring Europeans from the Rifle Companies, when they
-were numerous, to the Askari Companies, the losses of Europeans
-in the latter were made good; Askari were enrolled in the European
-Companies. In this way the Field and Rifle Companies
-became more similar in their composition, which during the
-course of 1915 became identical. At Muansa, Kigoma, Bismarckburg,
-Lindi, Langenburg, and elsewhere, small bodies of
-troops had been formed under various designations, of the existence
-of which in most cases Headquarters only became aware
-after a considerable time. These units were also gradually
-expanded into companies; in this way, during 1915, the number
-of Field Companies gradually rose to 30, that of the Rifle Companies
-to 10, and that of other units of company strength to about
-20. The maximum total attained was thus about 60 companies.
-Owing to the limited number of suitable Europeans and of reliable
-Askari N.C.O.’s, it was not advisable still further to increase
-the number of companies: it would only have meant the creation
-of units without cohesion. In order, however, to increase the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_72" id="Page_72">[72]</a></span>
-number of combatants the establishment of the companies
-was raised from 160 to 200, and the companies were allowed
-to enrol supernumerary Askari. To some extent the companies
-trained their own recruits; but the great bulk of Askari reinforcements
-came from the Recruit Depots established in the
-populous districts of Tabora, Muansa and the Northern Railway,
-which also provided for local security and order. But owing
-to the great number of newly-raised companies the depots
-could not furnish enough men to bring them all up to their
-establishment of 200. The maximum strength attained by the
-end of 1915 was 2,998 Europeans and 11,300 Askari, including
-Naval personnel, administrative staffs, hospitals and field postal
-service.</p>
-
-<p>How necessary were all these military preparations was proved
-by the news received at the end of June, 1915, that General
-Botha was coming to the East African theatre from South Africa
-with 15,000 Boers. That this information was highly probably
-correct had to be assumed from the outset. The scanty wireless
-messages and other communications about events in the outside
-world were yet enough to indicate that our affairs in South-West
-Africa were going badly, and that the British troops employed
-there would probably become available for other purposes
-in the immediate future.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_73" id="Page_73">[73]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER VIII<br />
-<span class="wn">AWAITING THE GREAT OFFENSIVE. ENERGETIC USE OF THE
-TIME AVAILABLE</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap18">AT first, it is true, the anticipated intervention of the South
-Africans did not seem to be materializing; the English were
-evidently trying to subdue us with their own forces, without
-their assistance. In July, 1915, they attacked the Colony at
-several points. East of Lake Victoria large bodies of Masai,
-organized and led by Englishmen, and said to number many
-thousands, invaded the country of the German Wassukuma,
-which was rich in cattle. However, in the matter of cattle-lifting
-the Wassukuma stood no joking; they gave our weak
-detachments every assistance, defeated the Masai, recaptured
-the stolen cattle, and, as a proof that they had “spoken
-the truth,” laid out the heads of ninety-six Masai in front of
-our police station.</p>
-
-<p>Against the main body of our force in the Kilima Njaro
-country the enemy advanced in considerable strength. In order,
-on the one hand, to ensure effective protection of the Usambara
-Railway, and the rich plantations through which it passes, and,
-on the other, to shorten the distance the patrols had to go to
-reach the Uganda Railway, a detachment of three companies
-had been pushed out from Taveta to Mbuyuni, a long day’s
-march east of Taveta. Another day’s march to the east was
-the well-fortified and strongly-held English camp of Makatan,
-on the main road leading from Moshi, by Taveta, Mbuyuni,
-Makatan, and Bura, to Voi, on the Uganda Railway. Vague
-rumours had led us to surmise that an attack on a fairly large
-scale in the direction of Kilima Njaro was to be expected from<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_74" id="Page_74">[74]</a></span>
-about Voi. On the 14th July a hostile brigade, under General
-Malleson, appeared in the desert of Makatan, which is generally
-covered with fairly open thorn-bush. The fire of a field battery,
-which opened on the trenches of our Askari, was fairly ineffective,
-but the enemy’s superiority of seven to one was so considerable
-that our position became critical. Hostile European
-horsemen got round the left wing of our own; however, our
-line was held by the 10th Field Company, which had distinguished
-itself in the fighting near Longido Mountain, under
-Lieutenant Steinhäuser, of the Landwehr, and it is a credit to
-this officer, who was unfortunately killed later, that he held
-on, although our mounted troops fell back past his flank. Just
-at the critical moment, Lieutenant von Lewinsky, who was
-also killed later, immediately marched off to the scene of action,
-arrived with a patrol, and took this dangerous flank attack in
-rear. The English troops, consisting of natives, mixed with
-Europeans and Indians, had very gallantly attacked our front,
-over ground affording very little cover. The failure of the
-English flank attack, however, set the seal on their defeat.
-At New Moshi Station I was kept accurately informed of the
-progress of the action, and thus, although at a distance, I shared
-in all the excitement from the unfavourable period at the beginning
-until complete success was assured.</p>
-
-<p>This success, together with the considerable booty, still
-further increased the spirit of adventure among both Europeans
-and Askari. The experience and skill that had by now been
-acquired enabled us henceforth to prosecute our plan of sending
-out a continuous succession of fighting and demolition patrols.
-I do not think I exaggerate in assuming that at least twenty
-English railway trains were destroyed, or, at least, considerably
-damaged. Picked up photographs and our own observation
-confirmed the supposition that a railway was actually being
-built from Voi to Makatan, which, being so easily accessible
-to us, and so important, formed a glorious objective for our
-patrols. The construction of this military line proved that an
-attack with large forces was in preparation, and that it was to
-be directed on this particular part of the Kilima Njaro country.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_75" id="Page_75">[75]</a></span>
-The anticipated intervention of the South Africans was therefore
-imminent. It was important to encourage the enemy in this
-intention, in order that the South Africans should really come,
-and that in the greatest strength possible, and thus be diverted
-from other and more important theatres of war. With the
-greatest energy, therefore, we continued our enterprises against
-the Uganda Railway, which, owing to the circumstances, had
-still to be mainly carried out by patrols, and could only exceptionally
-be undertaken by a force as large as a company.</p>
-
-<p>Closer acquaintance with the desert country between the
-Uganda Railway and the Anglo-German border had revealed
-the fact, that of the various mountain groups rising abruptly
-out of the plain, the Kasigao was well watered and moderately
-populous. Being only from twelve to twenty miles from the
-Uganda Railway, Kasigao Mountain was bound to afford a
-favourably situated base for patrol work. The patrol of Lieut.
-Freiherr Grote had already made a surprise attack on the small
-Anglo-Indian camp situated half-way up its slopes. The riflemen
-of Grote’s patrol had worked round the camp, which was
-surrounded by a stone wall, and fired into it with effect from
-the dominating part of the mountain. Very soon the white
-flag appeared, and an English officer and some thirty Indians
-surrendered. A part of the enemy had succeeded in getting
-away to the mountain and fired on the patrol as it marched off.
-It was then we suffered our only casualties, consisting of a few
-wounded, among whom was a German corporal of the Medical
-Corps. We had also, on one occasion, surprised the enemy’s
-post on Kasigao Mountain by the fire of a 2.4-inch gun.</p>
-
-<p>Towards the end of 1915, the enemy having in the meantime
-shifted his camp on Kasigao Mountain, we attacked him once
-more. During the night a German fighting patrol, under
-Lieutenant von Ruckteschell, had ascended the mountain in
-nine hours, and arrived rather exhausted near the enemy’s work.
-A second patrol, under Lieutenant Freiherr Grote, which was
-co-operating with Ruckteschell’s, had been somewhat delayed
-by the sickness and exhaustion of its commander. Lieutenant
-von Ruckteschell sent a reliable old coloured N.C.O. to the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_76" id="Page_76">[76]</a></span>
-enemy to demand surrender. He observed that our Askari was
-cordially welcomed by the enemy; he had found a number of
-good friends among the English Askari. But, in spite of all
-friendliness, the enemy refused to surrender. Our situation was
-critical, in consequence of exhaustion and want of food. If
-anything was to be done at all, it must be done at once. Fortunately,
-the enemy in their entrenchments did not withstand our
-machine-gun fire and the assault which immediately followed
-it; they were destroyed, and a large number of them were
-killed in their flight by falling from the steep cliffs. The booty
-included abundant supplies, also clothing and valuable camp
-equipment.</p>
-
-<p>The feeling of comradeship which our Askari had for us
-Germans, and which was tremendously developed by the
-numerous expeditions undertaken together, led on this occasion
-to a curious incident. After climbing Kasigao Mountain by
-night, among rocks and thorn-bushes, an Askari noticed that
-Lieutenant von Ruckteschell was bleeding from a scratch on
-his face. He at once took his sock, which he had probably not
-changed for six days, and wiped the “Bwana Lieutenant’s”
-face with it, anticipating the somewhat surprised question with
-the remark: “That is a custom of war; one only does it to
-one’s friends.”</p>
-
-<p>In order to study the situation on the spot and to push on
-the attacks on Kasigao, I had gone by rail to Same, thence by
-car to Sonya Mission, and then either by cycle or on foot in the
-direction of the mountain to the German border, where a company
-was encamped at a water-hole. From there we had fair
-communication to Kasigao by heliograph, and we were thus
-enabled to make good the success we had gained there. Troops
-were at once pushed up, so that until the arrival of the South
-Africans the mountain was held by several companies. It was,
-indeed, decidedly difficult to keep them supplied; for although
-the German frontier territory west of Kasigao was fertile, it
-could not permanently support a force which with carriers
-amounted to about one thousand.</p>
-
-<p>I then drove in the car round the South Pare Mountains, on<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_77" id="Page_77">[77]</a></span>
-a road that had been made in time of peace. The construction
-of this road had been dropped on account of expense, and for
-years the heaps of metal had been lying unused at the roadside.
-The culverts&mdash;consisting of pipes passing under the road&mdash;were
-to a great extent in good order. But little work was needed
-to make this road suitable for supply by lorry. Supplies were
-sent from near Buiko on the Northern Railway by lorry to
-Sonya, and thence to Kasigao by carriers. The telephone line
-was already under construction as far as the frontier, and was
-completed in a few days’ time. From then on patrols pushing
-out from Kasigao had several encounters with detachments of
-the enemy, and did some damage to the Uganda Railway. But
-the ruggedness of the country and the dense thorn-bush made
-movement so difficult that by the time the South Africans
-arrived, we had not derived full benefit from Kasigao as a base
-for patrols. However, the continual menace to the railway had,
-at any rate, obliged the enemy to take extensive measures for
-its protection. Wide clearings had been made along it, of
-which the outer edges had been closed by thick zarebas (abattis
-of thorns). Every couple of miles there were strong block-houses,
-or entrenchments with obstacles, from which the line
-was constantly patrolled. Mobile supports, of the strength of
-a company or more, were held in readiness, so that, whenever
-the railway was reported to be in danger, they could at once go
-off by special train. In addition, protective detachments were
-pushed out in our direction, who tried to cut off our patrols
-on their way back on receiving reports from spies or from
-observation posts on the high ground. We also identified
-English camps on the high ground south-east of Kasigao, as far
-as the coast, and also in the settled country along the coast.
-They also received attention from our patrols and raiders. Our
-constant endeavour was to injure the enemy, to force him to
-adopt protective measures, and thus to contain his forces here,
-in the district of the Uganda Railway.</p>
-
-<p>While thus establishing points of support for our fighting
-patrols from the coast to Mbuyuni (on the Taveta-Voi road),
-we worked in the same sense further north. The enemy’s camp<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_78" id="Page_78">[78]</a></span>
-at Mzima, on the upper Tsavo River, and its communications,
-which followed that river, were frequently the objective of our
-expeditions, even of fairly large detachments. On one occasion
-Captain Augar, with the 13th Company, was surprised south-west
-of Mzima Camp in thick bush by three European companies
-of the newly-arrived 2nd Rhodesian Regiment. The
-enemy attacked from several directions, but being still inexperienced
-in bush fighting, failed to secure concerted action.
-So our Askari Company was able first to overthrow one part of
-the enemy’s forces, and then by quickness and resolution to
-defeat the other, which had appeared behind it.</p>
-
-<p>Further north, also, there was some fighting in the bush
-which went in our favour; we worked with whole companies
-and inflicted painful losses on the enemy, who was often in
-greater force. North of the Engare Len the 3rd Field Company
-from Lindi worked with special energy, and sent its fighting
-patrols out as far as the Uganda Railway. The mere fact that
-we were now able to make raids with forces amounting to a
-company and more in the midst of a desert devoid of supplies,
-and in many places waterless, shows the enormous progress the
-force had made in this type of guerilla warfare. The European
-had learned that a great many things that are very desirable
-when travelling in the Tropics simply have to be dispensed with
-on patrol in war, and that one can at a pinch get on for a time
-with only a single carrier-load. The patrols also had to avoid
-camping in such a way as to betray themselves, and as far as
-possible to carry food ready prepared. But if food had to be
-cooked, this was particularly dangerous in the evening or
-morning; the leader had to select a concealed spot, and invariably
-shift his camp after cooking before going to rest.
-Complete hygienic protection was incompatible with the conditions
-of patrol duty. A number of cases of malaria invariably
-occurred among the members of a patrol after its return. But
-as, in spite of the continual damage done to the enemy, patrol
-duty only required comparatively few men, only a part of the
-companies had to be kept in the front line. After a few weeks
-each company was withdrawn to rest camps in healthy regions,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_79" id="Page_79">[79]</a></span>
-European and Askari were able to recover from their tremendous
-exertions, and their training and discipline could be
-restored.</p>
-
-<p>Towards the end of 1915 the shortage of water at Mbuyuni
-Camp had become so serious, and supply so difficult, that only
-a post was left there, the detachment itself being withdrawn to
-the westward to the vicinity of Oldorobo Mountain. Meanwhile,
-the enemy’s camp at Makatan grew steadily larger. A
-frequent train service was maintained to it, and one could
-clearly see a big clearing being made to the west for the prolongation
-of the railway. Our fighting patrols had, indeed,
-many opportunities of inflicting losses on the enemy while at
-work, or protecting his working parties, but the line continued
-to make progress towards the west.</p>
-
-<p>It was necessary to consider the possibility of the country
-through which the Northern Railway passed soon falling
-into the hands of the enemy. Steps had, therefore, to be taken
-to safeguard the military stores in that district in time. Where
-railways were available this was, of course, not difficult; but
-the further transport by land needed much preparation. The
-bulk of our stocks of ammunition, clothing and medical stores
-was at New Moshi and Mombo. It was evident that we would
-be unable to carry away the factories, or parts of them, by land;
-they must, therefore, be made use of and kept working for as
-long as possible where they were. Assuming the enemy would
-attack from the north, our evacuation would obviously be towards
-the south, and not only the preparations, but the movement
-itself, must be started without loss of time&mdash;that is, as early as
-August, 1915.</p>
-
-<p>The Commandant of the Line, Lieutenant Kroeber, retired,
-therefore, in an able manner, collected light-railway material
-from the plantations, and built a line from Mombo to Handeni,
-at the rate of about two kilometres (one and a quarter miles)
-per day. The trucks were also brought from the plantations,
-and after mature consideration, man draught was decided on
-in preference to locomotives. Thus our stores were moved from
-the north by rail, complete, and in time, to Handeni. From there<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_80" id="Page_80">[80]</a></span>
-to Kimamba, on the Central Railway, we principally used
-carriers, except for a few wagons. It was, after all, necessary
-not to hurry the movement unduly, for, in spite of all the visible
-preparations for a hostile attack on the Kilima Njaro country,
-I still thought it possible that the main force of the enemy,
-or at least a considerable proportion of it, would not operate
-there, but in the Bagamoyo-Dar-es-Salaam area.</p>
-
-<p>At the end of 1915 the enemy was pushing his rail-head further
-and further westward, and Major Kraut, who was opposing him,
-reinforced his position on Oldorobo Mountain with three companies
-and two light guns. This mountain rises from the flat
-thorn desert near the main road, seven and a half miles east of
-Taveta, and dominates the country for a great distance all
-round. Entrenchments and numerous dummy works had
-been made, part being cut out of the rock, and formed an almost
-impregnable fort. The disadvantage of the position was the
-complete lack of water. A planter who had been called to the
-Colours, Lieutenant Matuschka, of the Reserve, was an expert
-water finder; at Taveta he had discovered excellent wells;
-but on Oldorobo no water was found, although at the points he
-indicated we dug down more than one hundred feet. Water
-had therefore to be taken from Taveta on small donkey-carts
-to Oldorobo, where it was collected in barrels. This carriage
-of water was an extraordinary strain on our transport. Strangely
-enough, it did not occur to the enemy to interfere with it, and
-thus render Oldorobo Mountain untenable. Instead of that,
-basing himself on his railway, he pushed up to within about
-three miles of the mountain, where he established strongly
-fortified camps. We had been unable to prevent this, as, owing
-to difficulties of water and transport, larger forces could only
-move away from Taveta for short periods. The enemy obtained
-his water supply by means of a long pipe-line, which came from
-the springs in the Bura Mountains. The destruction of the
-enemy’s reservoir by patrols under Lieutenant von S’Antenecai,
-of the Reserve, only caused him temporary inconvenience.</p>
-
-<p>At this time, also, the first hostile aeroplanes appeared, and
-bombed our positions on Oldorobo Mountain, and at Taveta<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_81" id="Page_81">[81]</a></span>
-and later even New Moshi. On the 27th January one of
-these airmen, while on his way back from Oldorobo, was successfully
-fired on and brought down by our advanced infantry.
-The English had told the natives that this aeroplane was a new
-“Munga” (God); but now that this new Munga had been
-brought down and captured by us, it rather increased our
-prestige than otherwise.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_82" id="Page_82">[82]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER IX<br />
-THE SUBSIDIARY THEATRES OF WAR. GUERILLA WARFARE ASHORE
-AND AFLOAT UNTIL NEW YEAR, 1916</h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">WHILE employing the bulk of the Protective Force in the
-regions on the Northern Railway we could not afford
-entirely to denude the remainder of the Colony. In the interior
-it was essential to remain undisputed master of the natives,
-in order, if necessary, to enforce the growing demands for carriers,
-agriculture, supplies, and all manner of work. Accordingly,
-the 12th Company remained at Mahenge, and the 2nd at Iringa.
-In addition to their other duties both of them acted as large
-depots, serving to fill vacancies at the front, and providing
-the machinery for raising new units.</p>
-
-<p>The commanders of detachments on the frontiers, who were
-far away from Headquarters and beyond the reach of the telegraph,
-rightly endeavoured to anticipate the enemy and to attack
-him in his own territory. Owing to the lack of communications
-on our side this fighting resolved itself into a series of local
-operations, which were quite independent of each other. It was
-different with the enemy, who clearly endeavoured to establish
-a proper relationship between his main operations and the subsidiary
-enterprises at other points on the frontier.</p>
-
-<p>In October, 1914, before the fighting at Tanga, Captain Zimmer
-reported from Kigoma that there were about 2,000 men on the
-Belgian frontier; and Captain Braunschweig sent word from
-Muansa that at Kisumu on Lake Victoria there were also strong
-hostile forces, about two companies at Kisii, and more troops
-at Karungu. According to independent native reports, Indian
-troops landed at Mombasa in October and were then transported
-towards Voi. In the Bukoba District English troops crossed the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_83" id="Page_83">[83]</a></span>
-Kagera, and the sub-station at Umbulu reported that the
-enemy was invading the Ssonyo country. Obviously these movements
-were preparatory to the operations which were to be co-ordinated
-with the great attack on Tanga in November, 1914.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-083.jpg" width="400" height="437" id="m83"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pc">Fig. vi. Subsidiary Actions up to August, 1916.</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>The means of intercommunication in the Colony were not
-sufficiently developed to enable us rapidly to concentrate our
-main force, first against one and then against another of these
-hostile detachments deploying along the frontier. We had,
-therefore, to adhere to the fundamental idea of our plan, of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_84" id="Page_84">[84]</a></span>
-vigorously attacking the enemy opposed to us in the area of the
-Northern Railway and on the Uganda Railway, and of thus indirectly
-relieving the other points where operations were in
-progress. Of necessity, however, these subsidiary points had
-occasionally to be reinforced. Thus, in September, 1914,
-Captains Falkenstein and Aumann, with portions of the 2nd
-Company, had moved from Iringa and Ubena into the Langenburg
-District. In March, 1915, the 26th Field Company
-was pushed up from Dar-es-Salaam via Tabora to Muansa.
-In April, 1915, hostile concentration in the Mara Triangle
-(east of Lake Victoria) and at Bismarckburg caused us to
-waste much time in moving troops up from Dar-es-Salaam via
-Muansa to the Mara Triangle, and via Kigoma to Bismarckburg.
-The latter move was particularly delayed on Lake Tanganyika
-owing to the slow progress being made on the steamer <i>Götzen</i>,
-which was building at Kigoma.</p>
-
-<p>At first, the enemy’s attacks were principally directed against
-the coast.</p>
-
-<p>At the commencement of the war our light cruiser <i>Königsberg</i>
-had left the harbour of Dar-es-Salaam and had, on the 29th
-September, surprised and destroyed the English cruiser <i>Pegasus</i>
-at Zanzibar. Then several large enemy cruisers had arrived
-and industriously looked for the <i>Königsberg</i>. On the 19th October,
-at Lindi, a pinnace steamed up to the steamer <i>Praesident</i>,
-of the East African Line, which was concealed in the Lukuledi
-river. The local Defence Force raised at Lindi, and the Reinforcement
-Company, were at the moment away under Captain
-Augar, to repel a landing expected at Mikindani, so that nothing
-could be undertaken against the pinnace.</p>
-
-<p>It was not till the 29th July, 1915, that several whalers went
-up the Lukuledi and blew up the <i>Praesident</i>.</p>
-
-<p>After successful cruises in the Indian Ocean the <i>Königsberg</i>
-had concealed herself in the Rufiji river, but her whereabouts
-had become known to the enemy. The mouth of the river forms
-an intricate delta, the view being obstructed by the dense bush
-with which the islands are overgrown. The various river-mouths
-were defended by the “Delta” Detachment, under Lieutenant-Commander<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_85" id="Page_85">[85]</a></span>
-Schoenfeld; this detachment consisted of Naval
-ratings, European reservists, and Askari, and its strength was
-about 150 rifles, a few light guns, and a few machine guns. The
-enemy made many attempts to enter the river-mouths with
-light craft, but was invariably repulsed with severe loss. The
-<i>Adjutant</i>, a small steamer which the English had taken as a
-good prize, and armed, was recaptured on one occasion, and was
-used thenceforward by us as an auxiliary man-of-war on Lake
-Tanganyika. Some English aircraft had also come to grief in
-the Rufiji delta. A blockship, which the English had sunk
-in the most northerly of the river-mouths, did not close the fairway.
-The frequent bombardments by ships’ guns, which he had
-no means of opposing, Lieut.-Commander Schoenfeld defeated
-by the skilful design of his positions, and by shifting them in time.
-Early in July, 1915, the English had brought to the Rufiji
-two shallow-draught gun-boats, armed with heavy guns. On
-the 6th July they made the first attack with four cruisers and
-other armed vessels, and two river gun-boats. The enemy
-bombarded the <i>Königsberg</i>, which was at anchor in the river
-with aeroplane observation. The attack was beaten off, but when
-it was repeated on the 11th July, the <i>Königsberg</i> suffered severely.
-The gun-detachments were put out of action. The severely
-wounded captain had the breech-blocks thrown overboard and
-the ship blown up. The loss of the <i>Königsberg</i>, though sad in
-itself, had at least this advantage for the campaign on land,
-that the whole crew and the valuable stores were now at the disposal
-of the Protective Force.</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant-Commander Schoenfeld, who was in command on
-land at the Rufiji delta, at once set himself with great forethought
-to raise the parts of the guns that had been thrown overboard.
-Under his supervision the ten guns of the <i>Königsberg</i> were completely
-salved and got ready for action again; five were mounted
-at Dar-es-Salaam, two each at Tanga and Kigoma, and one at
-Muansa. For their transport he made use of several vehicles
-constructed for heavy loads which were found on a neighbouring
-plantation. In their concealed positions on land these guns
-rendered excellent service, and as far as I know not one of them<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_86" id="Page_86">[86]</a></span>
-was damaged on this service, although they were often bombarded
-by the enemy’s vessels.</p>
-
-<p>On the 26th September, by night, the steamer <i>Wami</i> was taken
-out of the Rufiji to Dar-es-Salaam.</p>
-
-<p>At the end of August several boats came to Lindi from Mozambique
-with men belonging to the steamer <i>Ziethen</i>, in order to join
-the Force.</p>
-
-<p>On the 10th January, 1915, about 300 Indian and black troops
-with machine guns landed on the island of Mafia. Our police
-detachment, three Europeans, fifteen Askari, and eleven recruits,
-opposed them bravely for six hours, but surrendered when their
-commander, Lieutenant Schiller of the Reserve, was severely
-wounded, who had been maintaining a well-aimed fire on the
-enemy from a mango tree. The English held Mafia with a few
-hundred men, and also established posts of observation on the
-smaller islands in the vicinity.</p>
-
-<p>It was apparently from here that the work of rousing the
-natives against us was undertaken. On the night of the 29th-30th
-July, 1915, we captured a dhow at Kisija carrying propaganda
-papers.</p>
-
-<p>The events at Dar-es-Salaam, where, on the 22nd October,
-the captain of an English cruiser declined to be bound by any
-agreement, have already been discussed.</p>
-
-<p>On the outbreak of hostilities an aeroplane, which had been
-sent to Dar-es-Salaam for the Exhibition, was taken into use,
-but was destroyed by an accident at Dar-es-Salaam on the 15th
-November, when Lieutenant Henneberger lost his life.</p>
-
-<p>At Tanga things had been quiet since the big battle of November,
-1914. On the 13th March, 1915, a ship went ashore on a
-reef, but got off again on the spring-tide. We at once began salving
-200 tons of coal which had been thrown overboard.</p>
-
-<p>Several rows of mines which had been made on the spot, and
-could be fired from the shore, proved ineffective, and it was
-found later that they had become unserviceable.</p>
-
-<p>On the 15th August, 1915, the <i>Hyacinth</i> and four guard-boats
-appeared off Tanga. Our two 2·4-inch guns were quickly moved
-from their rest-camp at Gombezi to Tanga, and with one light<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_87" id="Page_87">[87]</a></span>
-gun from Tanga, took an effective part on the 19th August, when
-the <i>Hyacinth</i> reappeared with two gun-boats and six whalers,
-destroyed the steamer <i>Markgraf</i> and bombarded Tanga. One
-gun-boat was hit twice, the whalers, of which one steamed away
-with a list,<a name="FNanchor_3_3" id="FNanchor_3_3"></a><a href="#Footnote_3_3" class="fnanchor">[3]</a> four times.</p>
-
-<p>Bombardments of the coast towns were constantly taking place.
-On the 20th March a man-of-war bombarded Lindi, when its
-demand for the surrender of the troops posted there was refused.
-Similarly, the country south of Pangani was bombarded on the
-1st April, the island of Kwale on the 12th, and the Rufiji delta
-on the night of the 23rd-24th.</p>
-
-<p>For some months past hostile patrols had been visiting the
-Ssonyo country, between Kilima Njaro and Lake Victoria, and
-the natives seemed inclined to become truculent. As a result
-of their treachery, Sergeant-Major Bast, who was sent there
-with a patrol, was ambushed on the 17th November, 1914, and
-lost his life with five Askari. The District Commissioner of
-Arusha, Lieutenant Kaempfe of the Reserve, who had been called
-up, undertook a punitive expedition which reduced the Ssonyo
-people to submission.</p>
-
-<p>It was not until July, 1915, that any further patrol encounters
-took place in this country; in one of them twenty-two hostile
-armed natives were killed. At the end of September and early
-October, 1915, Lieutenant Buechsel’s mounted patrol spent several
-weeks in Ssonyo and in the English territory without meeting
-the enemy, as an English post, which had evidently been warned,
-had made off.</p>
-
-<p>On Lake Victoria the 7th Company at Bukoba and the 14th
-Company at Muansa could communicate with each other by wireless.
-The command of the Lake was undisputedly in the hands
-of the English, as they had on it at least seven large steamers.
-But in spite of this our small steamer <i>Muansa</i> and other smaller
-vessels were able to maintain great freedom of movement.
-While the Resident at Bukoba, Major von Stuemer, protected
-the frontier with his police and with auxiliaries furnished by
-friendly sultans, Captain Bock von Wülfingen had marched with<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_88" id="Page_88">[88]</a></span>
-the main body of the 7th Company from Bukoba to Muansa.
-From here he marched early in September, 1914, with a detachment
-composed of parts of the 7th and 14th Companies, Wassakuma
-recruits, and auxiliaries, along the eastern shore of Lake
-Victoria to the north, in the direction of the Uganda Railway.
-On the 12th September he drove back a hostile detachment at
-Kisii, beyond the border, but on hearing of the approach of other
-forces of the enemy he withdrew again to the south. After that
-the frontier east of Lake Victoria was only defended by weak
-detachments.</p>
-
-<p>Warfare near Lake Victoria was for us very difficult; there was
-always the danger that the enemy might land at Muansa, or some
-other place on the south shore, seize Usukuma and threaten
-Tabora, the historic capital of the country. If, however, our troops
-remained near Muansa, the country round Bukoba, and therefore
-also Ruanda, would be in danger. The best results in this area
-were to be expected from active operations under a united command.
-But the execution of this idea was not quite easy either,
-for Major von Stuemer, who was the most obvious officer to be
-entrusted with it, was tied by his work as Resident to the Bukoba
-District, while that of Muansa was the more important of the two.</p>
-
-<p>At the end of October, 1914, an attempt to take back part of
-the troops in boats from Muansa to Bukoba had been frustrated
-by the appearance of armed English ships at the former place.
-Apparently the enemy had deciphered our wireless messages
-and taken steps accordingly. On the 31st October a force of
-570 rifles, 2 guns and 4 machine guns, left Muansa for the relief
-of Bukoba on board the steamer <i>Muansa</i>, 2 tugs and 10 dhows,
-but was scattered the same morning by hostile steamers which
-suddenly appeared; they were, however, collected again at
-Muansa without loss soon afterwards. On the same day the
-English tried to land at Kayense, north of Muansa, but were prevented;
-a few days later, the English steamer <i>Sybil</i> was found on
-shore at Mayita and destroyed.</p>
-
-<p>On the 20th November, in a twelve-hours’ action, Stuemer’s
-detachment repulsed the English troops who had penetrated
-into German territory, north of Bukoba, and defeated them again,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_89" id="Page_89">[89]</a></span>
-on the 7th December, at Kifumbiro, after they had crossed the
-Kagera river. On the 5th December, the English bombarded
-Shirarti from the Lake, without success, and Bukoba on the 6th.</p>
-
-<p>Minor encounters between patrols constantly took place east
-and west of Lake Victoria. On the 8th January the enemy
-attempted a more ambitious operation; he bombarded Shirarti
-from the Lake with six guns and with machine guns, and landed
-two companies of Indians as well as a considerable number
-of mounted Europeans. Lieutenant von Haxthausen, who
-had only 22 rifles, gave way before this superior force after
-fighting 3-1/2 hours. The enemy’s strength was increased during
-the next few days to 300 Europeans and 700 Indians. On
-the 17th January, von Haxthausen defeated 70 Europeans
-and 150 Askari with 2 machine guns on the frontier, and on
-the 30th January the enemy left Shirarti and embarked for
-Karungu. I believe this withdrawal was a result of the severe
-defeat sustained by the enemy at Jassini on the 18th. He
-considered it desirable to re-concentrate his forces nearer the
-Uganda Railway, where they would be more readily available.</p>
-
-<p>On the west side of the Lake, Captain von Bock surprised a
-hostile post of 40 men north of Kifumbiro and drove it off with
-a loss of 17 killed.</p>
-
-<p>On the 6th March, 1915, English vessels had attacked the
-steamer <i>Muansa</i> in Rugesi Passage. <i>Muansa</i> had sprung a leak
-and went ashore close to the land. The enemy attempted to
-tow her off, but was prevented by our fire, so that we were able,
-the next day, to salve the steamer and get her away to Muansa,
-where she was repaired. The difficulty of moving troops by water
-between Muansa and Bukoba rendered the continuation of the
-single command unworkable; the officers commanding the two
-Districts were therefore placed directly under Headquarters.</p>
-
-<p>The English attempted to land at Mori Bay on the 4th March,
-at Ukerewe on the 7th, and at Musoma on the 9th; all these
-attempts were defeated by our posts. At the same time, several
-patrol encounters occurred near Shirarti, in which the commander,
-Lieutenant Recke, was killed, and our patrols were dispersed.
-On the 9th March, Lieutenant von Haxthausen, with 100 Europeans<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_90" id="Page_90">[90]</a></span>
-and Askari, defeated an enemy many times his superior
-at Maika Mountain; the enemy withdrew after having 17 whites
-and a considerable number of Askari killed. On our side, one
-European and 10 Askari were killed, 2 Europeans and 25
-Askari wounded, while one wounded European was taken
-prisoner. Besides the 26th Field Company already mentioned,
-Muansa was reinforced by 100 Askari from Bukoba District,
-who arrived on the 6th April.</p>
-
-<p>Early in April a few places on the eastern shore were again
-bombarded from the Lake; at the same time some Masai made
-an invasion east of the lake, killed a missionary and several
-natives, and looted cattle. In the middle of April, Captain
-Braunschweig left Muansa with 110 Europeans, 430 Askari,
-2 machine guns, and 2 guns, for the Mara Triangle, and reinforced
-Lieutenant von Haxthausen. Over 500 rifles remained
-at Muansa.</p>
-
-<p>On the 4th May, in Mara Bay, an English steamer was hit
-three times by a ’73 pattern field-gun, which apparently prevented
-a landing. On the 12th May 300 men landed at Mayita; but
-they steamed off again on the 18th June, towing the wreck of
-the <i>Sybil</i> with them. By the 20th May the enemy, who had 900
-men there, had also evacuated the Mara Triangle, and entrenched
-himself on several mountains beyond the frontier. Bombardments
-of the shore took place frequently at that time.</p>
-
-<p>Since early December, 1914, Major von Stuemer had held a
-very extended position on the Kagera. Gradually the enemy,
-who was estimated at about 300 men, became more active.
-He seemed to be collecting material for crossing the Kagera,
-and his ships appeared more frequently in Sango Bay.</p>
-
-<p>On the night of the 4th-5th June, on the Shirarti frontier,
-Becker’s post of 10 men was surrounded by 10 Europeans and 50
-Indians of the 98th Regiment. An armed steamer also took part.
-But the enemy was beaten, losing 2 Europeans and 5 Askari
-killed.</p>
-
-<p>I may here mention that the enemy’s armed scouts used
-poisoned arrows on the Shirarti frontier also.</p>
-
-<p>On the 21st June the English, with a force of 800 Europeans<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_91" id="Page_91">[91]</a></span>
-400 Askari, 300 Indians, 3 guns and 8 machine guns, and
-supported by the fire of the armed steamers, attacked Bukoba.
-Our garrison of little more than 200 rifles evacuated the place after
-two days of fighting. The enemy plundered it, destroyed the
-wireless tower, and left again on the 24th towards Kissumu.
-He had suffered severely, admitting 10 Europeans killed and 22
-wounded. The Germans had, however, observed that a steamer
-had left with about 150 dead and wounded on board. On our
-side 2 Europeans, 5 Askari, and 7 auxiliaries had been killed,
-4 Europeans and 30 coloured men wounded, and we also lost
-the gun.</p>
-
-<p>Of the events of the ensuing period it may be remarked that
-Bukoba was bombarded without result on the 18th July. In
-Mpororo a great chief went over to the English.</p>
-
-<p>On the 12th September one of the <i>Königsberg’s</i> four-inch guns
-arrived at Muansa, where we had in process of time raised five
-new companies among the Wassukuma people.</p>
-
-<p>It seemed as though the enemy were rather holding back at
-Bukoba, and moving troops from there to Kissenyi. On the
-29th October the English attacked with some one hundred rifles,
-machine guns, a gun, and a trench mortar, but were repulsed,
-apparently with heavy casualties. Hostile attacks on the lower
-Kagera on the 4th and 5th December were also unsuccessful.
-Several detachments of the enemy invaded the Karagwe country.
-The command at Bukoba was taken over by Captain Gudovius,
-hitherto District Commissioner in Tangarei, who marched off
-from Tabora on the 21st December, and was followed by the
-newly-raised 7th Reserve Company as a reinforcement for
-Bukoba.</p>
-
-<p>In Ruanda the energetic measures adopted by the President,
-Captain Wintgens, produced good results. On the 24th September
-he surprised the island of Ijvi in Lake Kivu, and captured
-the Belgian post stationed there, and its steel boat. Another
-steel boat had been captured by Lieutenant Wunderlich, of the
-Navy, who had moved to Lake Kivu with some men of the
-<i>Moewe</i>, where he had requisitioned a motor-boat. On the
-4th October, Wintgens, with his Police Askari, some auxiliaries,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_92" id="Page_92">[92]</a></span>
-and a few men of the <i>Moewe</i>, drove back several companies
-of Belgians north of Kissenyi, inflicting heavy casualties on
-them. After some minor engagements, Captain Wintgens then
-inflicted a partial defeat on the superior Belgian force of seventeen
-hundred men and six guns, north of Kissenyi, on the 20th
-and 30th November, and again on the 2nd December, 1914.
-Near Lake Tshahafi he drove out an English post. One Englishman
-and twenty Askari were killed; we had two Askari killed
-and one European severely wounded.</p>
-
-<p>After that, in February, 1915, several minor actions were
-fought near Kissenyi and on the frontier. On the 28th May,
-Lieutenant Lang, commanding the small garrison of Kissenyi,
-beat off the Belgians, who had seven hundred men and two
-machine guns. The enemy sustained heavy losses; we had one
-European killed.</p>
-
-<p>In June, 1915, it was said that over two thousand Belgian
-Askari, with nine guns, and five hundred English Askari were
-concentrated near Lake Kivu, the fact that the Belgian Commander-in-Chief,
-Tombeur, went to Lake Kivu makes this
-information appear probable. On the 21st June the Belgians
-attacked Kissenyi with nine hundred men, two machine guns
-and two guns, but were repulsed. On the 5th July they again
-attacked the place by night with four hundred men, and suffered
-severe losses. On the 3rd August Kissenyi was ineffectively
-bombarded by artillery and machine guns. In consequence of
-the crushing superiority of the enemy, the 26th Field Company
-was transferred from Muansa to Kissenyi.</p>
-
-<p>Immediately after the arrival of this company at Kissenyi,
-on the 31st August, Captain Wintgens defeated the Belgian
-outposts, of whom ten Askari were killed. On September 2nd
-he took by storm a position held by one hundred and fifty Askari,
-with three guns and one machine gun. During the next few
-weeks minor actions were fought every day. On the 3rd October
-an attack on Kissenyi by two hundred and fifty Askari with a
-machine gun was repulsed, and fourteen casualties were observed
-among the enemy. After that, possibly in consequence of the
-action at Luwungi on the 27th September, considerable forces<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_93" id="Page_93">[93]</a></span>
-of the enemy were discovered to have marched off for the
-south.</p>
-
-<p>On the 22nd October another Belgian detached post of three
-hundred Askari, with two guns and two machine guns, was surprised,
-when the enemy had ten Askari killed. On the 26th
-November the Ruanda Detachment, with one platoon of the
-7th Company, which had arrived from Bukoba, in all three
-hundred and twenty rifles, four machine guns and one 1.45-inch
-gun, drove the enemy, numbering two hundred, out of a fortified
-position, when he lost two Europeans and seventy Askari
-killed, five Askari prisoners, and many wounded. We had
-one European and three Askari killed, four Europeans, five
-Askari and one auxiliary wounded. On the 21st December
-the enemy once more attacked Kissenyi with one thousand
-Askari, two machine guns and eight guns, including four
-modern 2.75-inch howitzers. He left behind twenty-one dead
-Askari, three were captured, wounded, and many wounded
-were carried away. Our force of three hundred and fifty rifles,
-four machine guns and two guns, had three Askari killed, one
-European and one Askari severely wounded.</p>
-
-<p>On the 12th January, 1916, Captain Wintgens surprised a
-Belgian column north of Kissenyi, killing eleven Belgian Askari.
-On the 27th January Captain Klinghardt, with three companies,
-beat off an attack on the Kissenyi position made by two thousand
-Belgian Askari with hand grenades and twelve guns, inflicting
-severe casualties on them.</p>
-
-<p class="p2">In the Russissi country there were also numerous engagements.
-Successful minor actions between German patrols and Congo
-troops had taken place on the 10th and 13th October, 1914, at
-Changugu, on the 21st and 22nd at Chiwitoke, and on the 24th
-at Kajagga.</p>
-
-<p>On the 12th January, 1915, Captain Schimmer attacked a
-Belgian camp at Luwungi, but the intended surprise was unsuccessful.
-Captain Zimmer and three Askari were killed and five
-wounded.</p>
-
-<p>Then, on the 16th, 17th and 20th March small patrol skirmishes<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_94" id="Page_94">[94]</a></span>
-took place, and on the 20th May a Belgian post was surprised.
-There was thus incessant fighting, which continued in June and
-July. In August the enemy seemed to be increasing his forces
-in that region. The command on the Russissi was now taken
-over by Captain Schulz; the forces we had there now consisted
-of four field companies, part of the crew of the <i>Moewe</i>, and the
-Urundi Detachment, which about equalled one company. There
-were also two light guns there. On the 27th September Captain
-Schulz attacked Luwungi, when we were able to establish that
-the enemy lost fifty-four Askari killed, and we also counted
-seventy-one Askari hit. So the enemy’s losses amounted to
-about two hundred, as confirmed by native reports received
-later. We had four Europeans and twenty Askari killed, nine
-Europeans and thirty-four Askari wounded.</p>
-
-<p>Owing to the nature of the country and the relative strengths,
-we were unable to achieve a decisive success on the Russissi.
-Only the Urundi Detachment and one field company were,
-therefore, left there; two companies left on the 18th and 19th
-December, 1915, to join Captain Wintgens in Ruanda; three
-others moved to the Central Railway.</p>
-
-<p>On the 19th October the enemy met the 14th Reserve Company,
-and although outnumbering it by two to one, lost twenty
-Askari, while we had three Askari killed and twelve wounded.
-Although the Belgian main camp, which reliable natives reported
-to contain two thousand Askari, was so near, it was possible
-to reduce the troops on the Russissi in favour of other districts,
-since on both sides the conditions seemed unfavourable for an
-offensive. The Urundi Detachment and the 14th Reserve Company
-remained on the Russissi under Major von Langenn.</p>
-
-<p class="p2">On Lake Tanganyika, at the beginning of the war, Captain
-Zimmer had collected about one hundred men of the <i>Moewe</i>,
-and in Usambara, about one hundred Askari; in addition, he
-had a few Europeans who were called up in Kigoma, also some
-one hundred Askari belonging to the posts in Urundi and from
-Ruanda (Wintgens)&mdash;all told, about four hundred rifles.</p>
-
-<p>On the 22nd August, 1914, Lieutenant Horn, of the <i>Moewe</i>,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_95" id="Page_95">[95]</a></span>
-commanding the small armed steamer <i>Hedwig von Wissmann</i>,
-fought a successful action against the Belgian steamer <i>Delcommune</i>.
-The captain of the <i>Moewe</i>, Lieutenant-Commander
-Zimmer, had gone to Kigoma with his crew, after destroying his
-ship, which had been blown up in August, 1914. The steamer
-<i>Kingani</i>, which had also been transported to the same place by
-rail from Dar-es-Salaam, and several smaller craft on Lake Tanganyika,
-were then armed and put in commission by Lieutenant-Commander
-Zimmer. He also mounted a 3·5-inch naval gun
-on a raft and bombarded a number of Belgian stations on the
-shore. He strongly fortified Kigoma itself, and developed it
-into a base for naval warfare on Lake Tanganyika.</p>
-
-<p>On the 20th November, 1914, the Bismarckburg Detachment
-(half company), co-operating with the small armed steamers
-<i>Hedwig von Wissmann</i> and <i>Kingani</i>, drove off a Belgian company
-in the bay west of Bismarckburg, captured four ·43-inch
-machine guns and over ninety miles of telegraph wire, which was
-used to continue the line Kilossa-Iringa up to New Langenburg, a
-work which was, from a military point of view, extremely urgent.</p>
-
-<p>Early in October attempts were made to complete the destruction
-of the Belgian steamer <i>Delcommune</i>, which was lying at
-Baraka, on the Congo shore, but without success. After bombarding
-her once more on the 23rd October, Captain Zimmer
-looked upon her as permanently out of action. On the 27th
-February, 1915, the crew of the <i>Hedwig von Wissmann</i> surprised
-a Belgian post at Tombwe, and captured its machine gun.
-One Belgian officer and ten Askari were killed, one severely
-wounded Belgian officer and one Englishman were captured.
-We had one Askari killed, one European mortally wounded, one
-Askari severely wounded.</p>
-
-<p>In March, 1915, the Belgians made arrests on a large scale in
-Ubwari, the inhabitants of which had shown themselves friendly
-to us, and hanged a number of people.</p>
-
-<p>According to wireless messages which we took in, several
-Belgian whale-boats were got ready on Lake Tanganyika during
-June, and work was being carried on on a new Belgian steamer,
-the <i>Baron Dhanis</i>. On our side the steamer <i>Goetzen</i> was completed<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_96" id="Page_96">[96]</a></span>
-on the 9th June, 1915, and taken over by the Force. She
-rendered good service in effecting movements of troops on Lake
-Tanganyika.</p>
-
-<p>The Police at Bismarckburg, under Lieutenant Haun of the
-Reserve, the capable administrator of the Baziots, had joined
-the Protective Force. Several skirmishes took place in hostile
-territory, and in this district also the enemy was, on the whole,
-kept successfully at a distance.</p>
-
-<p>It was not till early in February, 1915, that several hundred
-hostile Askari invaded Abercorn, and some of them penetrated
-to near Mwasge Mission, but then retired.</p>
-
-<p>Then, in the middle of March, Lieutenant Haun’s force was
-surprised in camp at Mount Kito by an Anglo-Belgian detachment.
-The Commander was severely wounded and taken
-prisoner, and several Askari were killed. Lieutenant Aumann,
-with a force subsequently formed into a company, was detached
-from Captain Falkenstein, and covered the German border
-in the neighbourhood of Mbozi, where, in February, 1915,
-detachments several hundred strong had frequently invaded
-German territory; at the end of March an unknown number
-of Europeans were reported in Karonga, while at Fife and other
-places on the frontier there were some eight hundred men. So
-the enemy appeared to be preparing to attack. He was patrolling
-as far as the country near Itaka, and early in April it was
-reported that Kituta, at the southern end of Lake Tanganyika,
-had been entrenched by the Belgians. Major von Langenn,
-who, after recovering from his severe wound&mdash;he had lost an eye&mdash;was
-working on the Russissi river, was entrusted with the
-conduct of operations in the well-known Bismarckburg-Langenburg
-country. Besides the 5th Field Company, which he had
-formerly commanded, and which was stationed at Ipyana and
-in the Mbozi country, he was also given the Bismarckburg Detachment,
-strength about one company, and three companies which
-were brought up from Dar-es-Salaam and Kigoma. During
-their passage to Bismarckburg on the Lake successful actions
-were fought east of that place by our patrols against hostile
-raiding parties of fifty to two hundred and fifty men.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-096.jpg" width="400" height="581" id="i96"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc">Native Women.<br />
-<span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-097.jpg" width="400" height="583" id="i97"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc">Natives bringing food.<br />
-<span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_97" id="Page_97">[97]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>By the 7th May, 1915, Major von Langenn had assembled
-four companies at Mwasge; a Belgian detachment stationed
-in front of him withdrew. On the 23rd May Lieutenant von
-Delschitz’s patrol drove off a Belgian company, of which two
-Europeans and six Askari were killed. On the 24th orders were
-sent to Langenn to move with three companies to New Langenburg
-to meet the attack which was reported to be impending
-in that quarter. General Wahle took over the command in
-the Bismarckburg area. The latter arrived at Kigoma on the
-6th June, and collected at Bismarckburg the Bismarckburg
-Detachment, now re-formed as the 29th Field Company, as well
-as the 24th Field Company and a half-company of Europeans
-brought up from Dar-es-Salaam.</p>
-
-<p>On the 28th June General Wahle attacked Jericho Farm with
-two and a half companies, but broke off the engagement on
-realizing that this fortified position could not be taken without
-artillery. We had three Europeans and four Askari killed, two
-Europeans and twenty-two Askari wounded. General Wahle
-was reinforced by two companies from Langenburg.</p>
-
-<p>Since the 25th July, 1915, General Wahle was besieging the
-enemy, who was strongly entrenched at Jericho, with four
-companies and two 1873-pattern guns. Relief expeditions from
-Abercorn were defeated, but the siege was raised on the 2nd
-August, as no effect could be produced with the guns available.
-General Wahle returned to Dar-es-Salaam with three companies.
-The 29th Company remained at Jericho, the two guns at Kigoma.</p>
-
-<p>On the 19th June the <i>Goetzen</i> towed off the steamer <i>Cecil
-Rhodes</i>, which was lying beached at Kituta, and sank her.</p>
-
-<p>During September and October there were continual skirmishes
-between patrols on the border near Bismarckburg;
-Belgian reinforcements again invaded the country about Abercorn.
-On the 3rd December it was observed that the defences
-of Jericho had been abandoned and dismantled. A new fort,
-north-east of Abercorn, was bombarded by Lieutenant Franken
-on the 6th December with one hundred rifles and one machine
-gun; the enemy appeared to sustain some casualties.</p>
-
-<p>The English Naval Expedition, the approach of which, by<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_98" id="Page_98">[98]</a></span>
-Bukoma and Elizabethville, had long been under observation,
-had reached the Lukuga Railway on the 22nd October, 1919.
-We picked up leaflets which stated that a surprise was being
-prepared for the Germans on Lake Tanganyika; this made me
-think that we might now have to deal with specially-built small
-craft which might possibly be equipped with torpedoes. We
-had, therefore, to meet a very serious menace to our command
-of Lake Tanganyika, which might prove decisive to our whole
-campaign. The simultaneous transfer of hostile troops towards
-Lake Kivu and Abercorn proved that an offensive by land
-was to be co-ordinated with the expedition. In order to defeat
-the enemy if possible while his concentration was still in progress,
-Captain Schulz attacked the Belgians at Luwungi on the
-27th September, inflicting heavy loss.</p>
-
-<p>On the night of the 28th October the steamer <i>Kingani</i> surprised
-a Belgian working-party, who were constructing a telegraph
-line, and captured some stores. In the mouth of the Lukuga
-river a railway train was observed on the move. At last, the
-<i>Kingani</i> did not return from a reconnaissance to the mouth of
-the Lukuga, and, according to a Belgian wireless message of the
-31st December, she had been lost, four Europeans and eight
-natives were said to have been killed, the remainder to have been
-captured. Evidently, the favourable opportunity for interfering
-with the enemy’s preparations for gaining command of the
-Lake had passed.</p>
-
-<p>Then, on the 9th February, 1916, another of our armed
-steamers was captured by the enemy.</p>
-
-<p>On Lake Nyassa the German steamer <i>Hermann von Wissmann</i>,
-whose captain did not know that war had broken out, was surprised
-and taken by the English Government steamer <i>Gwendolen</i>
-on the 13th August, 1914.</p>
-
-<p>On the 9th September, 1914, Captain von Langenn, with his
-5th Field Company, which was stationed at Massoko, near
-New Langenburg, had attacked the English station of Karongo.
-In the action with the English, who were holding a fortified
-position, Captain von Langenn himself was severely wounded.
-The two company officers were also severely wounded and taken<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_99" id="Page_99">[99]</a></span>
-prisoners. The German non-commissioned officers and the
-Askari fought very gallantly, but were obliged to recognize
-that they could do nothing against the enemy’s entrenchments,
-and, therefore, broke off the hopeless engagement. Over twenty
-Askari had been killed, several machine guns and light guns
-had been lost. Reinforcements from the 2nd Company at once
-arrived from Iringa and Ubena, and several hundred Wahehe
-auxiliaries were raised. Gradually it turned out that the enemy
-had also suffered severely. He avoided expeditions on a large
-scale against the Langenburg District, and so this fertile country,
-which was so necessary to us as a source of supply, remained in
-our possession for eighteen months.</p>
-
-<p>Later on our company at Langenburg moved its main body
-nearer the border to Ipyana Mission. On the 2nd November
-an affair of outposts occurred on the Lufira river, and the
-steamer <i>Gwendolen</i> on Lake Nyassa was hit several times by
-our artillery.</p>
-
-<p>Early in December, 1914, some fighting between patrols took
-place north of Karongo, on the Ssongwe river. Lieutenant
-Dr. Gothein, of the Medical Corps, who had been returned to us
-from captivity by the English in May, 1915, told us that in the
-first action at Karongo, on the 9th September, 1914, the enemy
-had had six Europeans and fifty Askari killed, and seven Europeans
-and more than fifty Askari severely wounded. The
-English spies were very active, especially through the agency of
-the “Vali,” the native administrative official, on the Ssongwe.</p>
-
-<p>In May, 1915, we were able to effect several successful surprises
-on the frontier. The rains were late, so that we could
-consider the southern part of Langenburg District as safe from
-attack until the end of June.</p>
-
-<p>In June, 1915, when Major von Langenn had arrived with his
-reinforcements, there were, contrary to our expectations, no
-considerable actions. We made use of the time to dismantle
-a telegraph line in English territory, and to put it up again in
-our own, in the direction of Ubena. In August, the rumours of
-an intended attack by the enemy were again falsified. It was
-not till the 8th October that considerable hostile forces of Europeans<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_100" id="Page_100">[100]</a></span>
-and Askari arrived at Fife. On this border also there
-were numerous little skirmishes. Towards the end of the year
-the arrival of fresh reinforcements at Ikawa was also established.
-In that region, on the 23rd December, 1915, Captain Aumann
-repulsed a force of about 60 Europeans with 2 machine guns,
-who were attempting a surprise.</p>
-
-<p>On the shores of Lake Nyassa there were only insignificant
-encounters.</p>
-
-<p>On the 30th May the English landed 30 Europeans, 200 Askari,
-2 guns and 2 machine guns at Sphinx Harbour. We had there
-13 rifles and one machine gun, who inflicted on them, apparently,
-over 20 casualties, whereupon, after destroying the wreck
-of the <i>Hermann von Wissmann</i>, they retired.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_101" id="Page_101">[101]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<p class="pc4 xlarge"><b>PART II</b></p>
-
-<p class="pc1 mid">THE CONCENTRIC ATTACK BY SUPERIOR FORCES<br />
-<span class="reduct">(From the arrival of the South African troops to the loss of the
-Colony)</span></p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_102" id="Page_102">[102]</a></span></p>
-<p>&nbsp;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_103" id="Page_103">[103]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER I<br />
-<span class="wn">THE ENEMY’S ATTACK AT OLDOROBO MOUNTAIN</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap06">EAST of Oldorobo the enemy now frequently showed considerable
-bodies of troops, amounting to 1,000 or more
-men, who deployed in the direction of the mountain at great
-distances, but did not approach it closely. These movements,
-therefore, were exercises, by which the young European troops
-from South Africa were to be trained to move and fight in the
-bush.</p>
-
-<p>Early in February the enemy advanced against Oldorobo from
-the east with several regiments. For us it was desirable that he
-should take so firm a hold there that he could not get away
-again, so that we could defeat him by means of a counter-attack
-with Captain Schulz’ Detachment, encamped at Taveta. Other
-German detachments, of several companies each, were stationed
-west of Taveta on the road to New Moshi, and on that to Kaho,
-at New Steglitz Plantation.</p>
-
-<p>On the 12th February again, European troops, estimated at
-several regiments, advanced to within 300 yards of Oldorobo.
-Headquarters at New Moshi, which was in constant telephonic
-communication with Major Kraut, considered that the favourable
-opportunity had now presented itself, and ordered fire to be
-opened. The effect of our machine-guns, and our two light guns,
-had been reported to be good, when Headquarters left New
-Moshi by car for the field of battle. Schulz’ Detachment was
-ordered to march from Taveta along the rear of Kraut’s Detachment,
-covered from the fire of the enemy’s heavy artillery, and
-to make a decisive attack on the enemy’s right, or northern,
-wing. The troops at New Steglitz advanced to Taveta, where
-some fantastic reports came in about hostile armoured cars,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_104" id="Page_104">[104]</a></span>
-which were alleged to be moving through the thorn-bush desert.
-The imagination of the natives, to whom these armoured cars
-were something altogether new and surprising, had made them
-see ghosts. On arriving on Oldorobo, Headquarters was informed
-by telephone that the enemy, who had attacked our strongly
-entrenched front, had been repulsed with heavy losses, and that
-Schulz’ Detachment was fully deployed and advancing against
-his right flank. The numerous English howitzer shells which
-fell in our position on Oldorobo did hardly any damage, although
-they were very well placed. In contrast to the great expenditure
-of ammunition by the hostile artillery, our light guns had to
-restrict themselves to taking advantage of specially favourable
-targets, not only because ammunition was scarce, but also because
-we had no shrapnel. The enemy retreated through the bush
-in disorder. We buried more than 60 Europeans. According
-to prisoners’ statements and captured papers, three regiments
-of the 2nd South African Infantry Brigade had been in action.
-According to the documents it appeared that in recruiting the
-men the prospect of acquiring farms and plantations had been
-used as a bait. The sudden illness of the British General Smith-Dorrien,
-who was already on his way out to take over command
-in East Africa, may not have been altogether inconvenient to the
-English. The transfer of the command to a South African,
-General Smuts, re-acted favourably on recruiting in South Africa.
-The training of these newly raised formations was slight, and the
-conduct of the Europeans, many of whom were very young,
-proved that many had never yet taken part in a serious action.
-After the action of Oldorobo, however, we observed that the
-enemy sought very thoroughly to make good the deficiencies in
-his training.</p>
-
-<p>In spite of pursuit by Schulz’ Detachment, and repeated fire
-opened on collections of hostile troops, the enemy, owing to the
-difficult and close nature of the country, made good his escape to
-his fortified camps.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_105" id="Page_105">[105]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-105.jpg" width="400" height="549" id="m105"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pc">Fig. vii. Battle of Yasin (Jassini). Fig. viii. Kilima Njaro and Masai Desert.<br />
-Fig. ix. Battle of Reata. Fig. x. Battle of Kahe.</p>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_106" id="Page_106">[106]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>It was interesting to find, in several diaries we picked up,
-notes to the effect that strict orders had been given to take no
-prisoners. As a matter of fact the enemy had taken none,
-but it seemed advisable nevertheless to address an inquiry to the
-British Commander, in order that we might regulate our conduct
-towards the English prisoners accordingly. There is no reason
-to doubt Brigadier-General Malleson’s statement that no such
-order was given; but this case, and several later instances, show
-what nonsense is to be found in private diaries. It was quite
-wrong on the part of the enemy if he accepted the German
-notes which fell into his hands as true, without detailed investigation.</p>
-
-<p>At this time also the hostile troops on Longido Mountain had
-been considerably reinforced. This mountain had been evacuated
-by the enemy, probably owing to difficulties of supply, but had
-latterly been re-occupied. The rock is covered with dense vegetation,
-and our patrols had several times ascended it and examined
-the enemy’s camps at close quarters. It is at any time difficult
-correctly to estimate the strength of troops, but in bush country,
-where more than a few men are never to be seen at a time, and
-where the view is constantly changing, it is impossible. The
-reports of the natives were too inaccurate. On the whole, however,
-we could but conclude from the general situation, and from
-the increased quantity of supplies which were being brought to
-Longido from the north, by ox wagon, without interruption, that
-the enemy was being considerably reinforced.</p>
-
-<p>His raids into the Kilima Njaro country had been repulsed with
-slaughter. When a squadron of Indian Lancers moved south,
-between Kilima Njaro and Meru Mountain, it was at once
-vigorously attacked by one of our mounted patrols under Lieutenant
-Freiherr von Lyncker. Our Askari had come to understand
-the great value of saddle-horses in our operations, and
-charged the enemy, who was mounted, with the cry: “Wahindi,
-kameta frasi!” (“They are Indians, catch the horses!”)
-The Indians were so surprised by the rapidity of our people that
-they fled in confusion, leaving some of their horses behind.
-Among others the gallant European commander had been left
-dead on the field; he had not been able to prevent his men from
-losing their heads.</p>
-
-<p>I should like to remark generally that during this first period<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_107" id="Page_107">[107]</a></span>
-of the war the conduct of the British regular officers was invariably
-chivalrous, and that the respect they paid us was fully reciprocated.
-But our Askari also earned the respect of the enemy by
-their bravery in action and their humane conduct. On the 10th
-March the English Lieutenant Barrett was severely wounded
-and fell into our hands; owing to false accounts he thought his
-last moment had come, and was surprised when our Askari,
-who had no European with them, tied him up as well as they
-could and carried him to a doctor. In his astonishment he
-remarked: “Why, your Askari are gentlemen.” How greatly
-the English soldiers had been misled I learned on the 12th February
-from a young South African captured on Oldorobo, who
-asked whether he was going to be shot. Of course we laughed at
-him. No doubt, in a long war, cases of brutality and inhumanity
-do occur. But that happens on both sides, and one
-should not generalize from isolated cases, and exploit them for the
-purpose of unworthy agitation, as has been done by the English
-Press.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_108" id="Page_108">[108]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER II<br />
-<span class="wn">FURTHER ADVANCE OF THE ENEMY AND THE ACTION AT REATA</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap18">AT that time we noticed the first parties of hostile spies, and
-captured some of them. They were “Shensi” (innocent-looking
-natives), who, as a proof of having really reached the
-objective of their mission, had to bring back certain objects,
-such as parts of the permanent way of the Usambara Railway.
-The general review of the situation showed that the enemy was
-making a detailed reconnaissance of the Usambara Railway
-and the approaches to it. A glance at the map shows that a
-simultaneous advance by the enemy from Oldorobo and Longido
-towards New Moshi was bound to entail the loss of the Kilima
-Njaro country, which was of value to us from the point of view of
-maintenance. If, however, we wanted to retire before a superior
-enemy on our main line of communication, we should be obliged
-to move our main forces along the Usambara Railway, thus
-making almost an acute angle with the direction of an attack
-coming from Oldorobo. The danger of being cut off by the enemy
-from this, our principal line of communication, was for us very
-great. Should the enemy advance north of Lake Jipe, he would
-be cramped by Kilima Njaro and by the steep group of the
-North Pare Mountains. It is obvious that in that case his advance
-directly on Kahe would be the most inconvenient for us, and if
-successful, would cut the Usambara Railway, our line of communications.
-But it would be even more serious for us if the enemy
-should pass south of Lake Jipe, and press forward by the valley
-leading between the North and Middle Pare, to the Northern
-Railway, south of Lembeni. Finally, he could reach the railway
-by way of the valley at Same, between the Middle and South
-Pare. In his advance on Lembeni and Same the enemy would be<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_109" id="Page_109">[109]</a></span>
-able to make a road suitable for motor traffic with rapidity, and
-in places without preparation, across the open plain, and to base
-his operations upon it.</p>
-
-<p>The small forces we had in the Kilima Njaro country&mdash;about
-4,000 rifles&mdash;rendered it impossible to divide them in order to
-render ourselves secure against all these possibilities. Even
-for purely defensive reasons we must keep our forces concentrated
-and maintain close touch with the enemy, in order to hold him
-fast where we were, and thus keep his movements under observation.
-It was from the outset very doubtful whether we could
-in succession defeat the two main hostile groups, whose advance
-towards the Kilima Njaro country was to be expected from
-Longido and Makatau, and which were each considerably stronger
-than ourselves. There was no prospect of doing so unless our
-troops could be moved with lightning rapidity, first against one
-of the enemy’s forces and then, just as quickly, against the other.
-The necessary preparations were made, and after personal reconnaissance,
-a number of cross-country tracks in the rugged forest
-country north of the great road which leads from New Moshi
-to the west were decided upon. As it happened, no considerable
-use was made of these tracks. It would not do to be afraid of
-trying anything ninety-nine times, if there was a chance of succeeding
-at the hundredth. In following this principle we did not
-do badly.</p>
-
-<p>The enemy’s activity increased, and he displayed good training
-in numerous minor encounters. He had also raised a number of
-new Askari formations, largely recruited among the intelligent
-tribes of the Wyassa country. Being only sparsely covered with
-bush, and therefore very open, the desert country lying to the
-north-west of Kilima Njaro did not favour sudden offensive
-operations by us; for this purpose the dense bush district
-between Kilima Njaro and Meru Mountain itself, which the
-enemy, coming from Longido, would probably have to traverse,
-was more promising. Here we concentrated a detachment of
-some 1,000 rifles, composed of five selected Askari Companies.
-But, owing to the limited range of vision, this detachment did
-not succeed in forcing a decisive engagement on any of the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_110" id="Page_110">[110]</a></span>
-numerous hostile columns which pushed down to the south in
-the beginning of March. The enemy, also, had great difficulty in
-finding his way; and we only learned from an Indian despatch-rider,
-who brought a report to us instead of to his own people,
-that the 1st East African Division, under General Stewart, was
-in this district. As these encounters took place in the neighbourhood
-of Gararagua, and south-west of that place, it was too
-far away for our reserves at New Steglitz and Himo to intervene.
-(It is about two marches from Gararagua to New Moshi.)
-Before the chance of doing so arrived the enemy also advanced
-from the east. The direction taken by the enemy’s airmen
-showed his evident interest in the country one or two hours north
-of Taveta. One was bound to hit on the idea that the enemy
-encamped east of Oldorobo did not intend to get his head broken
-a second time on that mountain, but meant to work round the
-position by the north, and so reach the Lumi River, one hour
-north of Taveta. On the 8th March observers on Oldorobo
-noticed huge clouds of dust moving from the enemy’s camp in
-that direction. Numerous motors were also seen. From East
-Kitovo, a mountain four miles west of Taveta, Headquarters
-also observed these movements. Our fighting patrols, who were
-able to fire with effect on the hostile columns, and to take a few
-prisoners, established with certainty that the enemy’s main force
-was approaching at this point, and that General Smuts was
-present.</p>
-
-<p>On the afternoon of the 8th March Headquarters observed
-strong hostile columns near Lake Dsalla, who advanced from there
-in a widely extended line of skirmishers for some distance towards
-East Kitovo. On this occasion, and on many others, our want of
-artillery obliged us to look on quietly while the enemy executed
-unskilful movements at no great distance from our front. But
-it was evident that this enveloping movement of the enemy
-rendered the Oldorobo position, to which we owed many successful
-engagements during the course of the war, untenable. I therefore
-decided to deploy the troops for a fresh stand on the mountains
-which close the gap between the North Pare Mountains
-and Kilima Njaro to the westward of Taveta. Kraut’s Detachment<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_111" id="Page_111">[111]</a></span>
-was ordered by telephone to take up a position on the
-Resta-Latema Mountains, on the road leading from Taveta to
-New Steglitz. North-west of Latema Mountain, on the road
-from Taveta to Himo, Schulz’s Detachment occupied the mountains
-of North Kitovo, and covered the move of Kraut’s Detachment.
-These movements were executed by night, without being
-interfered with by the enemy. On our extreme left wing, on the
-south-eastern slopes of Kilima Njaro, Captain Stemmermann’s
-Company blocked the road leading from Rombo Mission to Himo
-and New Moshi. Rombo Mission was occupied by the enemy.
-Some of the natives made no attempt to conceal the fact that they
-now adhered to the English. This lends colour to the supposition
-that English espionage and propaganda among the natives
-had for a long time been going on in this district, and that the
-light-signals which had often been seen on the eastern slopes of
-Kilima Njaro had some connection with it.</p>
-
-<p>The mountain position taken up by us was very favourable
-as regards ground, but suffered from the great disadvantage that
-our few thousand Askari were far too few really to fill up the
-front, which was some 12 miles in extent. Only a few points
-in the front line could be occupied; the bulk of the force was kept
-at my disposal at Himo, to be brought into action according to
-how the situation might develop. It was a time of great tension.
-Before us was the greatly superior enemy; behind us, advancing
-to the south from Londigo, another superior opponent, while
-our communications, which also formed our line of retreat, were
-threatened by the enemy in the very unpleasant manner already
-described. But, in view of the ground, which we knew, and the
-apparently not too skilful tactical leading on the part of the
-enemy, I did not think it impossible to give at least one of his
-detachments a thorough beating. The positions on the line
-Reata-North Kitovo were therefore to be prepared for a stubborn
-defence. From Tanga, one of the <i>Königsberg’s</i> guns mounted
-there was brought up by rail. The reader will rightly ask why
-this had not been done long before. But the gun had no wheels,
-and fired from a fixed pivot, so that it was very immobile. It is
-therefore comprehensible that we delayed bringing it into action<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_112" id="Page_112">[112]</a></span>
-until there could be no doubt as to the precise spot where it would
-be wanted.</p>
-
-<p>The situation now developed so rapidly that the gun could not
-be used against Taveta. It was therefore mounted near the
-railway at Kahe, on the south bank of the Pangani River, from
-which position it did excellent service later in the actions at
-Kahe.</p>
-
-<p>On the 10th March the enemy reconnoitred along our whole
-front. Mounted detachments of about 50 men rode up, dismounted,
-and then advanced in a widely extended line, leading
-their horses, until they were fired on. This was their object.
-The fire disclosed our positions, although imperfectly. This
-method of reconnaissance gave us the opportunity for scoring
-local successes, which cost the enemy a certain number of men,
-and brought us in some score of horses. From North Kitovo
-Mountain we could plainly see how portions of our firing line,
-taking advantage of favourable situations, rapidly advanced
-and fired upon the enemy’s reconnoitring parties from several
-directions. To me the force employed by the enemy in these
-enterprises appeared too large to be explained by the mere
-intention of reconnaissance; they looked to me more like serious
-but somewhat abortive attacks. It was not yet possible to
-form a clear idea of the direction from which the enemy’s main
-attack would come. The tactical difficulties of enveloping
-our left (north) wing were far less, but this operation would
-prevent him from exerting effective pressure on our communications.
-The direction from Taveta through Reata towards
-Kahe would be the worst for us, but entailed for the enemy a
-difficult frontal attack on the fortified heights of Reata and
-Latema, which promised but little success even if made in greatly
-superior strength. I, therefore, thought it advisable to move
-Captain Koehl with two companies so close up in rear of Major
-Kraut’s Detachment, which was on the high ground between
-Reata and Latema, that we could intervene rapidly without
-waiting for orders. For the moment, telephonic communication
-with our detachments was secure. But it was to be anticipated
-that it would become at least very difficult, so soon as<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_113" id="Page_113">[113]</a></span>
-any detachment moved away from the existing lines. There
-was no material available for rapidly laying a cable that could
-follow moving troops. We were also deficient of light wireless
-apparatus, by means of which later on the English successfully
-controlled the movements of their columns in the bush.</p>
-
-<p>On the 11th March another aeroplane appeared over New
-Moshi and dropped a few bombs. I was just talking to an old
-Boer about the fight on the 12th February, and saying that the
-English were incurring a grave responsibility in ruthlessly exposing
-so many young men, who were quite ignorant of the
-Tropics, to the dangers of our climate and of tropical warfare.
-Major Kraut reported from Reata that strong hostile forces were
-moving up towards his positions from the direction of Taveta.
-Soon after, a powerful attack was made by several thousand
-men on the three companies holding our position. Our three
-light guns could, of course, not engage in a duel with the heavy
-artillery, and, as at Oldorobo, had to restrict themselves to
-employing their few shells against the denser masses of the enemy
-at favourable moments. Knowing the difficulties of the ground,
-I thought the attack had little prospect of success, but the two
-companies of Captain Koehl held in readiness behind Major
-Kraut’s Detachment were, nevertheless, sent in to attack. Captain
-Koehl, who had originally intended to attack the enemy in
-flank, which would have suited the situation and proved decisive,
-was obliged to recognize that in the unknown and dense
-bush this was impossible. The time and place, and, therefore,
-the effectiveness of this attack, would have become matters of
-pure chance. He, therefore, quite rightly marched up to the
-immediate support of Major Kraut. From what I could observe
-for myself from North Kitovo, and according to the reports
-that came in, it appeared that the enemy wanted to keep us
-occupied in front from Reata to Kitovo, while his decisive
-movement was being made round our left wing. In the first
-instance large bodies of horsemen were moving in that direction
-who appeared and disappeared again among the heights and
-gullies of the south-east slopes of Kilima Njaro. The 11th
-Company, under Captain Stemmermann, which was on the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_114" id="Page_114">[114]</a></span>
-slopes above these horsemen, prevented them from reaching the
-summit. During the course of the afternoon the leading horsemen
-had worked their way through the dense banana-plantations
-to near Marangu. They appeared to be very exhausted. Some
-of them were seen to be eating the unripe bananas.</p>
-
-<p>During the afternoon it became evident that the enemy was
-making a strong frontal attack against Kraut’s Detachment
-on Reata and Latema Mountain. But the telephonic reports
-were favourable: the enemy was obviously suffering heavy
-casualties; hundreds of stretchers were being employed in
-getting away the wounded. By evening all the enemy’s attacks
-on our front had been repulsed with heavy losses. In the darkness
-Captain Koehl’s two companies had pursued with energy
-and opened machine-gun fire on the enemy when he tried to make
-a stand. In the evening I had gone to Himo, and about 11 p.m.
-I was engaged in issuing orders for an attack to be made early
-on the 12th on the enemy’s horsemen, whose presence had been
-established at Marangu. Just then Lieutenant Sternheim,
-commanding the guns with Kraut’s Detachment, telephoned
-that the enemy had attacked once more in the night and had
-penetrated into the Reata position in great force. This report
-made it appear probable that this strong hostile force would
-now press forward from Reata in the direction of Kahe, and cut
-us off from our communications. To accept this risk, and still
-carry out the attack on the enemy at Marangu, appeared to be
-too dangerous. I therefore ordered the troops at Kitovo and
-Himo to fall back during the night to the Reata-Kahe road.
-As a covering force Stemmermann’s Company was for the time
-being to remain at Himo. This march was bound to entail
-the unpleasant consequence that, at the very best, all communication
-between Headquarters and the various units would
-cease. Anyone who has experienced these night marches knows
-also how easily some parts of the force may become entirely
-detached and cannot be reached for ever and a day. Fortunately
-I had at least some knowledge of the ground, as we moved across
-country to the new road, while we heard continuous heavy
-firing going on on Reata and Latema Mountains. A few<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_115" id="Page_115">[115]</a></span>
-stragglers who had lost their way in the bush came towards us;
-when we said we were Germans they did not believe us, and
-disappeared again. On the new road we found the dressing
-station. Here, too, the reports of the numerous wounded were so
-contradictory and obscure that one could only gather the impression
-of very heavy fighting in the bush at close quarters,
-but failed to learn anything of its various phases or results. By
-and by we got through on the telephone to Major Kraut, who,
-with part of his detachment, was on the Kahe-Taveta road, on
-the south-west slope of Reata Mountain. On the heights the
-fire had gradually died down, and his patrols had found no more
-trace of the enemy on Reata Mountain. Early in the morning
-of the 12th Major Kraut found some of his detachment again
-in their old positions on the hills: the enemy had fallen back
-to Taveta.</p>
-
-<p>When I arrived at Reata Mountain at six in the morning
-the great quantity of booty was being collected. Very great
-confusion had occurred in the close-quarter fighting by night.
-English dead, who were lying in the bush far in rear of the front
-of Kraut’s Detachment, proved that certain detachments of the
-enemy had got behind our line. Individual snipers, hidden
-away among the rocks, maintained a well-aimed fire, and could
-not be dislodged. It was, however, clear that the enemy had been
-repulsed with heavy casualties. Both our own wounded and
-those of the enemy were got away without a hitch, and so were
-the prisoners. With the detachments that were moving from
-the vicinity of Himo through the dense bush to the Kahe-Reata
-road we had no communication, and could expect to have none
-for several hours more.</p>
-
-<p>In this situation it was regrettable that I had ordered the
-troops forming our left wing, who had been posted between
-Kitovo and Himo, to withdraw to the Kahe-Reata road. After
-giving up the high ground held by our left wing the Reata position
-would in time become untenable, the more so as it had no
-supply of water, which had to be brought up from a place an
-hour’s march further back. It was impossible to turn back
-the units of the left wing to reoccupy the Himo-Kitovo area,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_116" id="Page_116">[116]</a></span>
-as we were at the moment completely out of touch with them,
-and, as has been mentioned, there was no expectation of regaining
-it for hours to come. I decided to evacuate the Reata position,
-and after the battlefield was cleared I returned with the line
-that was nearest to the enemy to the water south-west of Reata
-Mountain. In the course of the day the other detachments
-reached the Kahe-Reata road at different points further to the
-rear and encamped.</p>
-
-<p>Headquarters moved to New Steglitz Plantation. The buildings
-are situated half-way between Kahe and Reata, on a slight
-elevation affording a distant view over the forest, which is particularly
-dense along the Kahe-Reata road. On the way I met
-Captain Schoenfeld, who reported that he had mounted his
-4-inch gun out of the <i>Königsberg</i> near Kahe village on the south
-bank of the Pangani. After our withdrawal the enemy occupied
-Reata Mountain and for a while fired into the blue with light
-guns and rifles.</p>
-
-<p>During the next few days we observed the advance of strong
-hostile forces from the direction of Taveta to Himo, and the
-pitching of large camps at that place. Against the Little Himo,
-a mountain in front of our line which we were not holding, the
-enemy developed a powerful attack from the east, across a
-perfectly open plain, which, after a long and heavy bombardment
-of the empty hill, ended in its capture. Unfortunately, we
-were unable to move our troops sufficiently rapidly to come
-down upon this attack out of the thick bush. From the Little
-Himo the enemy frequently bombarded the Plantation building
-of New Steglitz with light artillery. Some weeks before,
-after a successful buffalo-hunt, I had enjoyed a hospitable hour
-in the few rooms of this building. The native who had guided
-us on that occasion had deserted to the English. Now it provided
-decidedly cramped accommodation for Headquarters and
-the telephone exchange. I myself was lucky enough to find
-a fairly comfortable shake-down on the sofa, with the cloth
-off the dining-table. Telephone messages and reports came in
-day and night without ceasing; but they did not prevent us from
-making the material side of our existence tolerably comfortable.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_117" id="Page_117">[117]</a></span>
-We had a roof over our heads, and the use of a kitchen equipped
-in European style, and carried on our combined mess as previously
-at New Moshi. The circumstances peculiar to East
-Africa make it necessary for the European to maintain a number
-of servants which to home ideas seems excessive. Even now,
-on active service, nearly everyone had two “Boys” who took
-charge of the cooking utensils and provisions we carried with us,
-cooked excellently, baked bread, washed, and generally provided
-us in the bush with a good proportion of the comforts which
-in Europe are only to be found in dwelling houses. Even in the
-heart of the bush I restricted these alleviations as little as possible,
-out of consideration for the strength, health and spirit of the
-Europeans. If, in spite of this, Headquarters often preferred
-to occupy buildings, this was done less for the sake of comfort
-than in order to facilitate the unavoidable work of writing and
-drawing.</p>
-
-<p>While we were at New Steglitz we received the surprising news
-that a second store-ship had reached the Colony, with arms,
-ammunition&mdash;including several thousand rounds for the 4-inch
-<i>Könisgberg</i> guns, which were now employed on land&mdash;and other
-warlike stores. The ship had run into Ssudi Bay, at the extreme
-south of our coast, and had immediately begun to discharge
-her cargo. In spite of the great distance, and the exclusive
-use of carriers, the whole of it was made available for the troops.
-This achievement was indeed surprising, in view of the large
-number of hostile ships that were blockading and searching our
-coast-line, and which were aware of the arrival of the store-ship.
-But she probably surprised the English also, for after discharging
-her cargo, she put to sea again, and disappeared, much
-to the astonishment of the enemy. Chaff between the Navy
-and the Army is not unknown even in England, and if the latter
-is reproached for not having been able to finish us off, the former
-may be silenced with the justifiable retort that it should not
-have allowed us to obtain such great supplies of arms and ammunition.
-The bulk of the stores was transported by land to the
-Central Railway, and was stored along, or near it, at the disposal
-of Headquarters. Owing to our lack of suitable artillery it was<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_118" id="Page_118">[118]</a></span>
-particularly advantageous that we were quickly able to bring
-up the four field-howitzers and two mountain guns which had
-come in the ship.</p>
-
-<p>The store-ship had also brought out decorations for war service:
-one Iron Cross of the First Class for the Captain of the
-<i>Königsberg</i>, and enough of the Second Class to enable half her
-company to have one each. For the Protective Force there were
-an Iron Cross of the First Class, and one of the Second Class,
-which were for me, and a number of decorations for the Askari.
-As regards the Europeans, we only heard in September, 1916,
-by wireless that the decorations recommended by Headquarters
-had been approved.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_119" id="Page_119">[119]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER III<br />
-<span class="wn">RETREAT BEFORE OVERWHELMING HOSTILE PRESSURE</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">IN our rear, Major Fischer, who with five companies had
-been employed between Kilima Njaro and Meru, had
-evaded the enemy’s superior forces by moving on New Moshi,
-and had been ordered up to Kahe. Captain Rothert, who had
-been acting under his orders with his company and the Arusha
-Detachment (strength about one company), had been energetically
-pursued by the enemy, and had made his way by Arusha
-towards Kondoa-Irangi. We could only expect to get into
-touch with him by the wire which had been put up from Dodome,
-by Kondoa-Irangi to Umbulu, and that only after a considerable
-time. By abandoning New Moshi we, of necessity, left the
-road Taveta-New Moshi-Arusha open to the enemy. The latter
-was thus also enabled to penetrate into the interior of the
-Colony with his troops from Taveta by Arusha and Kondoa-Irangi,
-and to act there against our communication at an
-extremely dangerous point. From our troops concentrated
-in the neighbourhood of Kahe and New Steglitz he had not
-much to fear during this operation. Although we had brought
-up all our companies from Tanga, leaving there only the troops
-absolutely indispensable for security, all we could do with our
-four thousand rifles was to let the enemy run up against us on
-suitable ground, and, possibly, to take advantage of any mistakes
-he might make by skilful and rapid action; but the odds
-against us being seven to one we could attempt no more. From
-an attack on an enemy superior not only in numbers, but also
-in equipment, and holding fortified positions into the bargain,
-I could not possibly hope for success. I could not, therefore,
-accede to the requests of my company commanders that we<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_120" id="Page_120">[120]</a></span>
-should attack, but this expression of a bold soldierly spirit gave
-me strength and hope in the serious situation in which we were
-placed. Minor enterprises, undertaken against the enemy’s
-camps by patrols and small detachments, produced no results
-of consequence; but they may have helped to make the enemy’s
-main force take some notice of us instead of simply marching
-on past us. He certainly did push on to the west from Himo,
-and heavy clouds of dust were seen moving to New Moshi and
-further on to the west. But a large part of the enemy coming
-from Himo turned in our direction. For the commander such
-situations are extraordinarily trying; he is not master of the
-situation, and must, of necessity, renounce the initiative. Only
-the most careful reconnaissance may perhaps reveal some weakness
-of the opponent, and in order to utilize this weakness and
-regain the initiative, not a moment must be lost. Fortunately,
-however, the enemy did expose weak points of which we were
-able to take at least partial advantage.</p>
-
-<p>Owing to the dense bush and high forest in which our camps
-were hidden, aerial reconnaissance can hardly have been any
-use to the enemy. The bombs dropped by the enemy caused
-only a few casualties at Kahe, and did not interfere with us
-in getting away our stores through that place. In order to
-draw our fire, the well-known English horsemen appeared once
-more north-west of New Steglitz in a widely-extended skirmishing
-line. In front of them, hidden in the bush, were our companies,
-ready to take hold immediately larger bodies should
-appear. A counter-attack of this description was made late
-in the afternoon on the 15th March, and with fair success. In
-order to become thoroughly acquainted with the ground,
-European patrols were constantly moving about, and I also made
-use of every available minute. Through the bush we cut and
-marked tracks. By this means we could clearly indicate any
-point to which a detachment was required to go.</p>
-
-<p>On the main road leading from Himo to Kahe a strong hostile
-force had also appeared and pushed close up to the front of
-Stemmermann’s Detachment, which occupied a fortified position
-on this road at Kahe, facing north. With considerable skill<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_121" id="Page_121">[121]</a></span>
-patrols worked close up to the detachment, and so concealed
-the movements of the enemy. When I arrived there in the
-afternoon of the 20th March, it was not at all clear what was
-really going on in front. It was quite possible that the enemy
-was merely making a demonstration in order to attack at some
-other, more dangerous, spot. Such a manœuvre would have
-been very menacing to us, as the close nature of the bush country
-would prevent us from detecting it until very late, probably too
-late. I decided to drive the enemy’s screen back on his position
-proper. Earlier in the day it had been given out that the
-companies were to move off to their former positions at one a.m.;
-the machine guns were left in our entrenchments so as not to
-lose them, and as a measure of protection. It was bright moonlight
-when the leading company was fired on, apparently by a
-hostile outpost, or patrol, which moved off. After that we
-encountered several patrols, but then, about three miles north
-of our own trenches, we came upon a stronger opponent with
-machine guns. The very severe action which now developed
-proved that we had come up against the enemy’s main position;
-to assault it seemed hopeless. Leaving patrols out, I withdrew
-step by step. Our casualties were not inconsiderable, and
-unfortunately included three company commanders, who were
-difficult to replace; of the three, Lieutenant von Stosch and
-Freiherr Grote died of their wounds a few days later, while
-Captain Augar only became fit for duty again after a long time
-and when provided with an artificial foot.</p>
-
-<p>Our withdrawal, which the enemy probably took to be involuntary,
-apparently led him to believe that he would be able
-to rout us next day by a vigorous attack. The attacks made
-by powerful hostile forces on the front of Stemmermann’s
-Detachment at Kahe on the 21st March were unsuccessful;
-the enemy, composed mainly of South African infantry, was
-beaten off with heavy loss. Our four-inch <i>Königsberg</i> gun,
-directed from elevated sites affording a good view, fired on the
-approaching enemy, apparently with good effect. It may be
-assumed that part of their severe casualties, which the English
-stated to have amounted on this day to several hundred among<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_122" id="Page_122">[122]</a></span>
-the South African Europeans alone, were caused by this gun.
-The enemy realized that he could not advance over the field of
-fire extending for five hundred yards in front of our trenches
-with any hope of success, and endeavoured to envelop our
-right flank. But having previously reconnoitred and determined
-tracks, we were also well prepared to execute a counter-attack,
-and in the afternoon Schulz’s Detachment effectively
-struck at the enemy’s flank. The last part of Schulz’s advance
-had, indeed, been very arduous owing to the thick bush. The
-Askari could only work through it step by step, when they
-suddenly heard the enemy’s machine guns at work only a few
-paces in front of them.</p>
-
-<p>Unfortunately, however, this counter-attack was not completed
-owing to the events which occurred in the meantime on
-our left. The activity displayed by patrols during the preceding
-days, and the clouds of dust, had shown that strong detachments
-of the enemy’s horse, coming from near New Moshi and keeping
-to westward of the Kahe-New Moshi railway, were trying to
-work round our front, which faced north, and of which the left
-wing was at Kahe Station. The continuation of this movement
-would have brought them on to the railway in our rear,
-and cut us from our communications while we were engaged
-with a superior opponent with our front to the north. I had,
-therefore, posted a strong reserve of eight companies in readiness
-at Kahe Station. But as I thought it necessary during the
-action to remain at Kahe village, near Stemmermann’s Detachment,
-I was unable to exercise rapid and direct control over the
-reserves at Kahe. The dense vegetation prevented any distant
-observation. The control of the reserve at Kahe had to be left
-to the initiative of the commander on the spot and his subordinates.
-The latter had observed that hostile troops had
-advanced through the bush and occupied a hill south-west of
-Kahe Railway Station. One company had, on its own initiative,
-attacked this force, but the advance had broken down under
-shrapnel fire. Thereupon our four-inch gun opened fire on
-these light guns and drove them off.</p>
-
-<p>Late in the afternoon I received an urgent message that<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_123" id="Page_123">[123]</a></span>
-strong forces of the enemy were advancing in our rear towards
-the railway at Kissangire, and that the event we feared had
-actually occurred. I was, therefore, compelled to issue orders
-for an immediate withdrawal towards Kissangire. The enemy
-could not yet have reached there in strength, and I hoped to
-defeat him there by rapidly throwing all my forces against him.
-Thus it happened that Captain Schulz’s well-directed counter-attack
-could not be carried through, or produce its full effect.
-The transfer by night of our force across the Pangani, which
-was close behind us, and over which we had previously made
-a number of bridges and crossings, was effected smoothly and
-without interference. Even on the following day the patrols
-we had left behind found its north bank clear of the enemy.
-Our good four-inch gun, which we could not take away owing
-to its lack of mobility, was blown up. After midnight, that is,
-quite early on the 22nd March, I arrived at Kissangire Station,
-and discovered to my very great astonishment that all the
-reports about strong hostile forces moving on that place were
-erroneous, and that our withdrawal had therefore been unnecessary.
-This incident afforded me a remarkably striking proof of
-the extraordinary difficulty of observing the movements of troops
-in thick bush, and of the great care every commander must
-exercise in estimating the value of such reports. But it also
-demonstrates how difficult it is for any commander to combine
-his own powers of reasoning and his judgment of the situation
-with the constantly conflicting reports, both of Askari and
-Europeans, in order to base his decision on a foundation that
-even approximately resembles the reality. In the African bush
-it is particularly important, whenever possible, to supplement
-the reports one receives by personal observation.</p>
-
-<p>However, our withdrawal could not now be altered, and the
-most important thing was to re-group our forces. In this
-operation the decisive factor was water-supply. This, and the
-necessity for distribution in depth, caused me to leave only a
-detachment of a few companies on the high ground at Kissangire,
-from where it observed the seven and a half miles of waterless
-thorn desert extending to the Pangani. To the east of this<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_124" id="Page_124">[124]</a></span>
-detachment at Kissangire, under Major von Boehmken, was
-Otto’s detachment, pushed up on to the North Pare Mountains
-in order to close the passes leading over them. Major Kraut
-took up a position on Ngulu Pass, between the North Pare and
-Middle Pare ranges. The main body of the force settled down
-in several fortified camps in the fertile Lembeni country.</p>
-
-<p>In spite of the various withdrawals we had recently carried out,
-the spirit of the troops was good, and the Askaris were imbued
-with a justifiable pride in their achievements against an enemy
-so greatly superior. Only a very few individuals deserted, and
-they were almost without exception men whose cattle was in
-the territory now occupied by the enemy, and who were therefore
-afraid of losing their property.</p>
-
-<p>Almost the entire German civil population had left the Kilima
-Njaro country; most of them had moved to Usambara into the
-Wilhelmstal district. The Arusha country had also been
-evacuated, and the farmers had moved off by ox-wagon by
-Kondoa-Irangi to Dodoma. The numerous Greeks had for the
-most part remained on their coffee-plantations on Kilima Njaro,
-and the Boers of British nationality had stayed in their cattle
-farms, which extended from the north-west slopes of Kilima Njaro
-northwards round Meru Mountain and along the western slopes
-of the latter to the vicinity of Arusha. At Lembeni the regular
-course of existence had not been interrupted; supply trains
-rolled right up to the station; the companies which were not in
-the front line worked diligently at their training, and Headquarters
-continued its work in the railway station buildings of
-Lembeni just as it had done previously at Moshi. Airmen
-appeared and dropped bombs, just as before.</p>
-
-<p>The country was carefully prepared to meet various possible
-battle conditions, passages were cut through the dense rhinoceros
-bush, and a field of fire cleared where necessary. Personal
-reconnaissance took up much of my time, and often led me to the
-companies encamped in the thick bush and on the dominating
-heights. The troops had already developed to a tolerable degree
-in adaptability, and in the art of making the material side of
-their existence as comfortable as possible. I remember with<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_125" id="Page_125">[125]</a></span>
-pleasure the occasions when, in a comfortably arranged grass
-hut, I was offered a cup of coffee with beautiful rich milk, prepared
-from the ground-down kernel of a ripe cocoanut. The
-North Pare Mountains also were frequently the goal of my expeditions.
-Up there I found a rich and well-watered area of primeval
-forest, through which it was hardly possible to penetrate off the
-roads. The water-supply of the country proved to be far more
-plentiful than the results of former surveys had led us to expect;
-in this respect also it was shown how the necessities of war cause
-the resources of a country to be opened up, and utilized to an
-extent greatly exceeding previous estimates. The natives of
-North Pare are, like those of Kilima Njaro, masters in the art of
-irrigating their fields by means of the water coming down from
-the mountains.</p>
-
-<p>On the 4th April, one of my reconnaissances took me to Otto’s
-Detachment on the Pare Mountains. From the north-west
-corner one had a clear view of the enemy’s camp, lying down
-below at Kahe Station. The obvious idea of bombarding it
-with one of our long-range guns&mdash;in the meantime we had brought
-to Lembeni one 4-inch <i>Königsberg</i> gun on wheels, and one 3·5-inch
-gun mounted on a ’73 pattern carriage&mdash;could unfortunately not
-be carried out. With rather too much zeal the troops had
-thoroughly destroyed the permanent way of the line between
-Lembeni and Kahe. With the means at our disposal it could not
-be made sufficiently fit for traffic to enable us to move one of our
-guns up and down on it with rapidity. All our observations and
-reports agreed that the enemy, who had formerly often sent
-patrols and even stronger forces to the south of Jipe Lake, no
-longer displayed any interest in that district. He had in any case
-moved his principal forces towards Kahe and also beyond New
-Moshi westward towards Arusha.</p>
-
-<p>After passing a cold night on the damp height at North Pare
-I descended to Lembeni on the 5th April. Here I found a report
-that on the previous day Captain Rothert, who was encamped with
-the 28th Company beside the Lolkisale, a high mountain in the
-Masai desert, two days’ march south-west of Arusha, had been
-attacked by superior forces. The heliograph communication<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_126" id="Page_126">[126]</a></span>
-with Lolkisale from the south-west had then been interrupted.
-It was not till later that the following facts became known.
-Several mounted companies of the enemy, coming across the
-desert from Arusha, had attacked the 28th Company, who were
-in position on the mountain, from several directions. As our
-people were in possession of the water they could well sustain the
-fight against the enemy, who had none. On the second day of
-the action the situation became critical for the enemy, because
-of this very absence of water. Unfortunately, however, after
-Captain Rothert was severely wounded, this circumstance was
-not properly appreciated on our side. The situation was thought
-to be so hopeless that the company surrendered with its machine
-guns and ammunition. On this occasion also some of the Askari
-gave evidence of sound military education by refusing to join
-in the surrender. They, together with the wounded, rejoined
-our forces near Ufiome, without being interfered with by the
-enemy. There they met a new rifle company and the Arusha
-Detachment, of which the former had arrived from the Central
-Railway, the latter from the direction of Arusha.</p>
-
-<p>The road to Kondoa-Irangi and the interior of the Colony was
-now hardly closed to the enemy coming from Arusha. There
-were three companies in the neighbourhood of Lake Kivu,
-in the north-west corner of the Colony, under Captain Klinghardt,
-retired, who had done so well in the actions at Kissenyi; they
-were moved by march route and on Tanganyika steamer to
-Kigoma, and from there by rail to Saranda. From there again
-they marched up towards Kondoa-Irangi. Captain Klinghardt
-was also given command of the troops already north of Kondoa-Irangi
-(about two companies) and of another company that came
-by rail from Dar-es-Salaam. These movements would take a
-long time. Consequently, the good and well-tried 13th Company,
-whose peace-station had been Kondoa-Irangi, was at once
-brought by rail to near Buiko, whence it marched through the
-Masai desert to Kondoa-Irangi. The march through this waterless
-and little-known country had to be undertaken before the
-completion of the reconnaissances, which were in progress; and
-to do so with what was, according to African ideas, the large<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_127" id="Page_127">[127]</a></span>
-force of one company with carriers, in the dry season, and before
-the heavy rains had set in, involved some risk.</p>
-
-<p>But this risk had to be run; for the force facing us at Kahe,
-after its reconnoitring parties had been several times repulsed,
-was showing no signs of advancing against us. At the time,
-therefore, the enemy was evidently directing his principal effort
-towards Kondoa-Irangi. As, for the reasons already set forth,
-it appeared unsound for us to attack from Lembeni towards
-Kahe, I decided merely to occupy the enemy station in the Kilima
-Njaro country, and to direct my main force against the hostile
-group which had meanwhile pushed forward to near Kondoa-Irangi.
-The execution of this project was not quite easy; much
-time was needed to cover the distance of 125 miles from the
-detraining stations on the Northern Railway to the Central Railway
-on foot, and at any moment a change in the situation might
-render it necessary for Headquarters immediately to make fresh
-dispositions. All the troops must therefore be kept within reach.
-The various detachments could not, as on the march from the
-Central to the Northern Railway, be set in motion on different
-and widely-separated roads. The march of our fifteen field and
-two mounted companies had to be made on one road. The
-Force was thus confronted with an entirely novel and difficult
-task. There was no time to lose. The detachments of Captain
-von Kornatzky, Captain Otto, Lieutenant-Colonel von Bock and
-Captain Stemmermann, each of four or three companies, were
-moved by rail at intervals of one day, from Lembeni to Mombo
-and Korogwe. Thence they marched on to Kimamba (station
-west of Morogoro) to the Central Railway. Manifold difficulties
-arose. Hard and fast destinations could not be laid down for the
-detachments for each day, more especially because heavy rains
-set in which in places so softened the black soil that the troops
-could literally hardly get along.</p>
-
-<p>Thus it happened that one detachment made quite short
-marches, and the one behind got jammed on top of it. This,
-however, was very inconvenient, and interfered both with the
-regular service of supply on the line of communication, and with
-the transport of the company baggage, in which the relay-carriers<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_128" id="Page_128">[128]</a></span>
-belonging to the line of communication had to be called in to
-assist. The companies now began, according to ancient African
-custom, to help themselves, seized the line of communication
-carriers, regardless of other orders, and simply kept them. As
-the whole service on the communications depended upon the
-regular working of the relay-carriers, it also became seriously
-dislocated.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-128.jpg" width="400" height="605" id="i128"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc">Masai.
-<br /><span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-129.jpg" width="400" height="597" id="i129"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc">European Dinner-time.
-<br /><span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_129" id="Page_129">[129]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER IV<br />
-<span class="wn">THE ENEMY’S ADVANCE IN THE AREA OF THE NORTHERN RAILWAY</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap16">AFTER the trains had left Lembeni I handed over the
-command of all the troops on the Northern Railway to
-Major Kraut. An independent administrative service was
-also organized for them. Our railway journey to Korogwe
-proved to us once more how closely the German population of
-the Northern Territories were knit to the Force, and how they
-appreciated its work. At every station the people had assembled,
-sometimes from great distances; every one of them knew that
-our departure from the Northern Territories was final, and
-that they would fall into the enemy’s hands. In spite of this,
-their spirit was gallant. A large part of the few remaining
-European provisions was brought to us. The widow of the
-former Line-Commandant Kroeber, who had recently been
-buried at Buiko, insisted on offering us the last bottles of the
-stock in her cellar.</p>
-
-<p>Major Kraut and Captain Schoenfeld accompanied me to
-Buiko, from where we were able to view several portions of the
-ground which I thought might become of importance in our
-future operations. These gentlemen remained there in order
-to make more detailed personal reconnaissances. From Korogwe
-our cars rapidly took us to Handeni, the head of the light railway
-that had been laid from Mombo. On the way we caught
-up our mounted companies, and the exclamation of the Civil
-Administrator of Handeni: “Why, that’s the notorious poacher
-of Booyen,” showed me once more that there were among our
-mounted troops men accustomed to danger and sport, on whom
-I could rely in the troubles that were to come. Handeni was<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_130" id="Page_130">[130]</a></span>
-the first collecting station for the stores withdrawn from the
-north; Major von Stuemer, who had left his former post at
-Bukoba in order to take charge of this line of communication,
-which was for the moment the most important one, complained
-not a little of the way in which the troops marching through
-had interfered with the further dispatch of the stores. At
-Handeni, the seat of the Civil Administration, where the supply
-routes from Morogoro, Korogwe and Kondoa-Irangi met at
-the rail-head of the Mombo-Handeni line, the war had called
-into being a European settlement that had almost the appearance
-of a town. Lieutenant Horn, of the Navy, had built
-cottages in the Norwegian style, which were quite charming
-to look at, although at the moment the rain was rather against
-them. The interiors, consisting for the most part of three
-rooms, were comfortably arranged for the accommodation of
-Europeans. What was unpleasant was the enormous number
-of rats, which often ran about on one when trying to sleep at
-night. Captain von Kaltenborn, who had arrived in the second
-store-ship which put into Ssudi Bay, reported himself to me
-here, and was able to supplement the home news he had already
-transmitted in writing by verbal accounts.</p>
-
-<p>Proceeding the next day by car, we caught up a number of our
-detachments on the march, and were able to remove at least
-some of the various causes of friction between them. Telephonic
-communication was rarely possible on account of earths caused
-by the heavy rain, and breakages caused by columns of carriers,
-wagons and giraffes. It was all the more important for me to
-traverse this area of breakdowns, which cut me off from the
-troops and prevented my receiving reports as quickly as possible.
-But that became increasingly difficult.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_131" id="Page_131">[131]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-131.jpg" width="400" height="523" id="m131"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pc400">Fig. xi. Invasion of German East Africa by Belgian and British columns, middle
-of 1916. Fig. xii. Retreat of German Main Force, August, 1916.</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>The rain came down harder and harder, and the roads became
-deeper and deeper. At first there were only a few bad places,
-and twenty or more carriers managed to get us through them
-by pulling and pushing. The <i>niempara</i> (headmen of carriers)
-went ahead, dancing and singing. The whole crowd joined in
-with “<i>Amsigo</i>,” and “<i>Kabubi</i>, <i>kabubi</i>,” and to the rhythm of
-these chants the work went on cheerily, and at first easily
-enough. But on passing through Tulieni we found that the
-rains had so swollen an otherwise quite shallow river, that during
-the morning its torrential waters had completely carried away
-the wagon bridge. We felled one of the big trees on the bank,
-but it was not tall enough for its branches to form a firm holdfast<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_132" id="Page_132">[132]</a></span>
-on the far side. It was three feet thick, but was carried away
-like a match. The Adjutant, Lieutenant Mueller, tried to swim
-across, but was also swept away, and landed again on the near
-bank. Now Captain Tafel tried, who had recovered from his
-severe wound, and was now in charge of the operations section
-at Headquarters. He reached the far side, and a few natives
-who were good swimmers also succeeded in doing so. But we
-could not manage to get a line across by swimming, and so
-there we were, Captain Tafel without any clothes on the far
-side, and we on this one. The prospect of having to wait for
-the river to fall was not enticing, for I could not afford to waste
-one minute in reaching the head of the marching troops. At last,
-late in the afternoon, a native said he knew of a ford a little
-lower down. Even there it was not altogether a simple matter
-to wade across, and took at least three-quarters of an hour;
-we had to follow our guide carefully by a very devious route,
-and work cautiously on from one shallow to the next. The
-water reached our shoulders, and the current was so strong that
-we needed all our strength to avoid falling. At last, in the
-dark, and with our clothes thoroughly wet, we reached the far
-side, where we were met by three mules and an escort of Askari
-sent back by a detachment which we had luckily been able to
-reach by telephone.</p>
-
-<p>We continued our journey the whole night through in pouring
-rain, and had several times to ride for hours at a time with the
-water up to our saddles, or to wade with it up to our necks;
-but at last, still in the night, we reached the great bridge over
-the Wami, which had been put up during the war. That, too,
-was almost entirely carried away, but part was left, so that we
-were able to clamber across and reach the light railway leading
-to Kimamba Station. This line, like that from Mombo to
-Handeni, had been constructed during the war and was worked
-by man-power. In their endeavour to do the job really well,
-the good people took several curves rather too fast, and the
-trucks, with everything on them&mdash;including us&mdash;repeatedly
-flew off into the ditch alongside, or beyond it. At any rate, we
-had had enough and to spare of this journey by water by the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_133" id="Page_133">[133]</a></span>
-time we arrived in the early morning at Kimamba. Vice-Sergeant-Major<a name="FNanchor_4_4" id="FNanchor_4_4"></a><a href="#Footnote_4_4" class="fnanchor">[4]</a>
-Rehfeld, who was stationed there and had
-been called to the Colours, received us most kindly. As there
-was a clothing depot at Kimamba, we were, at any rate, able to
-obtain Askari clothing to change into. When the remainder
-of Headquarters would turn up with our kits it was, of course,
-impossible to say.</p>
-
-<p>After discussing the situation with the Governor, who had
-come to Kimamba for the purpose, I went next day to Dodoma.
-On the Central Railway, quick working under war conditions,
-which in the north had become everyone’s second nature, had
-hardly been heard of. Captain von Kornatzky’s detachment,
-which had arrived at Dodoma shortly before us, had some difficulty
-in obtaining supplies, although Dodoma was on the railway,
-and could be supplied quickly. I got in touch by telephone
-with Captain Klinghardt, who had occupied the heights of
-Burungi, one day’s march south of Kondoa-Irangi, and on the
-next morning, with a few officers of Headquarters, I rode off to
-see him. The road lay through uninhabited bush-desert; it
-had been made during the war, its trace was governed by the
-need for easy construction, and it touched settlements but
-seldom. The Ugogo country is distinguished for its great
-wealth of cattle. The inhabitants belong to the nomad tribes,
-who copy the customs of the Masai, and are, therefore, often
-called Masai-apes. We met many ox-wagons in which German
-and Boer farmers, with their families, were driving from the
-country around Meru Mountain to Kondoa. It was a scene,
-so well known in South-West Africa, of comfortable “trekking,”
-in these vehicles so eminently suited to the conditions of the veld.</p>
-
-<p>The supply service of Klinghardt’s Detachment was not yet
-in working order; we camped that night in the first of the small
-posts on the line of communication. It was evident that the
-work of transport and supply would have to be greatly increased
-if it was to maintain the large number of troops now being<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_134" id="Page_134">[134]</a></span>
-pushed forward in the direction of Kondoa-Irangi. There was
-another difficulty: up to date the various Field Intendants
-had not been physically equal to the enormous demands which
-the whole field of the work of maintenance made upon the head
-of the service. Captain Schmid, of the Landwehr, had very soon
-been succeeded by Captain Feilke, of the Landwehr, he again
-by Captain Freiherr von Ledebur, of the Reserve, and this
-officer by Captain Richter, retired, an elderly gentleman. The
-latter, unfortunately, had just now, at the commencement of
-an important fresh operation, reached the limit of his strength.
-Major Stuemer, retired, who had been working on the line of
-communication at Handeni, had been obliged to take over his
-duties, but had not yet had time to become thoroughly at home
-in them.</p>
-
-<p>By the evening of the following day we had completed our
-journey of four marches, and reached Captain Klinghardt at
-the Burungi Mountains. The detachments coming from the
-country of the Northern Railway were following on behind us,
-and some days were bound to elapse before they would all have
-arrived; so we had the opportunity of making extensive reconnaissances.
-Here we had the great good fortune to make the
-acquaintance of a perfectly new and excellent map. The District
-Commissioner of Kondoa-Irangi had, when leaving his
-district, given it with other things to a <i>yumbe</i> (chief), who lived
-on the Burungi Mountains, to take care of. It was in his possession
-that we found this valuable property, the secrecy of which
-had thus remained intact.</p>
-
-<p>Patrols of mounted English Europeans often came near our
-positions, and it was known that stronger mounted forces were
-behind them. But where they were was not known. Some
-reports stated that they were in Kondoa-Irangi; others said
-south of that place, and others again placed them on the road
-leading from Kondoa-Irangi to Saranda. An important factor
-was that there were considerable native plantations at Burungi,
-so that supplies were plentiful. It was, therefore, not necessary
-to wait until the transport of supplies from Dodoma was in full
-swing. The troops were more independent of the line of communication<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_135" id="Page_135">[135]</a></span>
-than hitherto, and could draw the bulk of their
-subsistence from the country. As soon as the rear detachments
-had closed up the advance on Kondoa was started. South of
-that place we met only fairly strong mounted protective detachments,
-who were quickly driven back, and at the beginning of
-May, without any serious fighting, we obtained possession of the
-great heights which lie four miles in front of Kondoa village.</p>
-
-<p>We had brought with us two naval guns, one 3·5-inch and
-one 4-inch, on travelling carriages, and at once got them into
-action. From our dominating position they bombarded, apparently
-with good effect, the enemy’s camps south of Kondoa.
-The tents were at once struck. We could see the enemy hard
-at work entrenching his positions, and his vehicles hurrying
-away towards Kondoa. Several patrol encounters went in our
-favour, and small hostile posts, that had been left out in various
-places, were quickly driven in. From the south&mdash;that is, from
-behind us&mdash;we saw a mounted patrol riding towards our positions.
-As our mounted patrols were also out, I thought at
-first that they were Germans. But soon the regular carriage of
-their carbines in the buckets proved that they were English.
-They evidently had no idea of our presence. They were
-allowed to approach quite close, and at the short range they lost
-about half their number. From what we had hitherto observed,
-it seemed probable that the enemy in our front was evacuating
-his positions. On the 9th May, 1916, I decided, if this expectation
-proved correct, immediately to take possession of the low
-hills now held by the enemy. The conditions did not favour
-an attack, as our advance was sure to be observed, and a surprise
-assault was out of the question. But without surprise the
-attempt to capture the occupied position by assault had no
-hope of success; the enemy was sufficiently entrenched on the
-small hills, and the latter completely commanded the ground
-over which the attack would have to be pushed home, and
-which could only be traversed slowly owing to the low thorn-bush
-and the numerous rocks.</p>
-
-<p>I was with the companies that were following the advanced
-patrols; the latter reported, shortly before dark, that the hills<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_136" id="Page_136">[136]</a></span>
-were unoccupied. So our companies proceeded, and the commanders
-ordered up the baggage in order to settle down for
-the night. I myself went to the Headquarters Camp, which
-had remained on the big hills a little further back. I tried to
-relieve my great exhaustion with a cup of coffee and a little
-rum; but, knowing that I had no more orders to issue, I soon
-fell fast asleep. Next to my sleeping place was the 3·5-inch gun.
-Towards eleven p.m. I was awakened by remarks made by
-Lieutenant Wunderlich, of the Navy, who was in command of the
-gun; he could not make out the frequent flashes he saw in
-the direction of the enemy. Neither, at first, was I quite
-certain about them. But soon there could be no doubt that
-these flashes, which became more and more frequent, were caused
-by rifles and machine guns. When the wind shifted the sound
-of the fighting became clearly audible. Contrary to all our
-expectations, therefore, a stiff fight was taking place in our front,
-but owing to the great distance, and the bushy and rocky country
-that would have to be traversed, I did not think I could engage
-the reserves I still had in hand with any prospect of success.
-It would take hours to obtain even the very roughest idea of
-the situation, and the moon would be up for barely an hour
-more. For well or ill, therefore, I had to leave the fight in front
-to take its course.</p>
-
-<p>Our companies had, indeed, found the high ground, which had
-been examined by the patrols, to be clear of the enemy; but
-immediately in rear of it was another rise, and on this was the
-enemy, in an entrenched position, which our companies ran up
-against. In the close country and the darkness no general survey
-of the situation was possible, and connection between the
-various units was lost. Our Askari established themselves in
-front of the enemy, and Captain Lincke, who had assumed
-command after Lieutenant-Colonel von Bock had been severely
-wounded and Captain von Kornatzky had been killed, came
-to the conclusion that, although he could remain where he was,
-he would, after daybreak, be obliged to abandon all hope of
-being able to move, on account of the dominating fire of the
-enemy. As, therefore, no success appeared attainable, he<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_137" id="Page_137">[137]</a></span>
-cautiously broke off the action while it was still dark, and fell
-back on the position he had started from. The enemy, consisting
-mainly of the 11th South African Infantry Regiment,
-had fought well, and had repeatedly brought effective machine-gun
-fire to bear on our companies. Considering the small
-number of rifles that actually took part in the fight&mdash;about four
-hundred&mdash;our casualties, amounting to about fifty killed and
-wounded, must be considered heavy.</p>
-
-<p>During the following days we also proceeded to take possession
-of the high hills lying further to the eastward, and drove
-off the mounted detachments working in the foreground, inflicting
-quite unpleasant casualties on them. It happened several
-times that out of parties of about twenty men, none, or only
-a few, got away, and in the foreground also a whole series of
-encounters ended in our favour. The heights held by us afforded
-an extensive view, and with good glasses we several times observed
-columns of hostile troops and wagons approaching Kondoa from
-the north, and then turning east and disappearing into the
-mountains. Our patrols, whom we sent far away to the enemy’s
-rear, reported considerable bodies marching from about Arusha
-in the direction of Kondoa-Irangi.</p>
-
-<p>The English had at once taken over the civil administration
-at Kondoa, and had cleverly ordered the <i>yumbi</i> (chiefs) to come
-to that place and given them instructions. Among other things,
-they imposed on them the duty of reporting the movements of
-German troops. It was, therefore, often advantageous for our
-patrols to pretend to be English while in enemy country. The
-differences in uniform were not great, and the prolonged period
-of active service had further diminished them; uniform coats
-were often not worn at all, but only blouse-like shirts, and the
-little cloth badges which the English wore on their sun-helmets
-were not conspicuous. The difference in armament had often
-disappeared, as some of the Germans carried English rifles.</p>
-
-<p>On the whole, the enemy in Kondoa did not seem to be in
-great strength as yet; but, even if successful, our attack would
-have to be made over open ground against defences which with
-our few guns we could not sufficiently neutralize. The certainty<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_138" id="Page_138">[138]</a></span>
-of suffering considerable and irreplaceable losses decided me to
-refrain from a general attack, and instead to damage the enemy
-by continuing the minor enterprises, which had hitherto proved
-so advantageous. Our artillery&mdash;the two mountain guns and
-two field howitzers, which had come out in the second store-ship,
-had also arrived&mdash;fired upon such favourable targets as presented
-themselves. The buildings of Kondoa-Irangi, where
-General van Deventer had arrived, were also fired at occasionally
-by our four-inch gun. To the west of our main force, on
-the Saranda-Kondoa-Irangi road, our newly-raised 2nd Rifle
-Company had had several successful engagements with portions
-of the 4th South African Horse, and had gradually forced them
-back to the neighbourhood of Kondoa-Irangi.</p>
-
-<p>The enemy now grew continually stronger. Early in June
-he also shelled us at long range, about thirteen thousand yards,
-with heavy guns of about four-inch and five-inch calibre. His
-observation and fire-control were worthy of all respect; anyhow,
-on the 13th June his shell soon fell with great accuracy in our
-Headquarters camp. I stopped my work which I had commenced
-under cover of a grass roof, and took cover a little to
-one side behind a slab of rock. No sooner had the orderly
-officer, Lieutenant Boell, also reached the spot, than a shell
-burst close above us, wounded Lieutenant Boell severely in the
-thigh, and myself and a few other Europeans slightly. Otherwise
-the fire of the enemy’s artillery did us hardly any material
-damage, but it was a nuisance, all the same, to have his heavy
-shell pitching into our camp every now and then.</p>
-
-<p>We dispensed with the heavy work which the provision of
-good protection against fire would have entailed, as the whole
-strength of our people was required for patrols and outposts,
-and for collecting supplies. As far as the eye could reach,
-the whole country was covered by native cultivation. The
-principal crop&mdash;which formed the main supply of the troops&mdash;was
-<i>mtema</i>, a kind of millet, which was just ripening. Most
-of the natives had run away; the supplies from Dodoma had
-been unable to keep up with us, and so our subsistence depended
-almost entirely on the stuff which the foraging-parties of the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_139" id="Page_139">[139]</a></span>
-companies were able to bring in. In the hot sun the sheaves
-quickly dried on the rocks. All the companies were busy making
-flour, either by grinding the threshed grain between stones, or
-by stamping it into meal with poles in vessels of hard wood,
-called <i>kinos</i>. The Europeans at that time could still get wheat
-flour, which came up on the line of communication. The bread
-we made before Kondoa out of a mixture of wheat flour and
-native flour was of really excellent quality. Besides <i>mtema</i> and
-other grains there were also sugar-cane, <i>muhogo</i> (a plant with a
-pleasant-tasting, edible root), yams, various kinds of peas, and
-other native produce, besides sufficient cattle. In this extremely
-rich Kondoa country the troops could obtain a variety of food
-in abundance.</p>
-
-<p>The enemy’s extension from Kondoa to the east drew our attention
-also to this hitherto little-known country. Captain Schulz
-was sent there with several companies, and found it to be an
-extraordinarily difficult and densely-wooded mountain district,
-interspersed with settlements of great fertility. A whole series
-of actions, in which one or more of our companies were engaged,
-and which resulted in severe loss to the enemy, now took place
-in this district. A strong hostile force tried to penetrate between
-the companies of Schulz’s Detachment and ourselves, probably
-with the intention of cutting off the detachment. But this
-attempt failed completely. Our troops pressed forward against
-this force from both sides and repulsed it. The old <i>Effendi</i>
-(native officer), Yuma Mursal, acted with great skill on this
-occasion; he lay in ambush at a water-place, and fired at the
-English, who came there for water, with good effect; according
-to his observation, six of them were killed. During this period
-of fighting at Kondoa-Irangi the enemy’s battle casualties
-gradually mounted up to a considerable figure. If we add to
-them his losses by sickness, due to the youth of his white troops,
-who were not used to the Tropics, and were extraordinarily
-careless about precautions against tropical diseases, the total
-losses incurred by him during the Kondoa-Irangi period can
-hardly have been less than one thousand Europeans.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_140" id="Page_140">[140]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER V<br />
-<span class="wn">BETWEEN THE NORTHERN AND CENTRAL RAILWAYS</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap00">I ASK the reader to imagine himself in the position of a Commander,
-with insufficient means, exposed to attack by
-superior numbers, who has continually to ask himself: What
-must I do in order to retain freedom of movement and hope?</p>
-
-<p>At the end of June, 1916, events in the other theatres of war
-began to exercise a decisive influence on our operations at Kondoa.
-The Belgians pushed in from near Lake Kivu and from Russisi,
-the English from the Kagera, west of Lake Victoria, and, since
-the middle of July, from Muansa also, and all these forces were
-converging on Tabora. Our troops stationed in the north-west
-were all combined under the command of General Wahle,
-who was at Tabora; and he gradually drew in his detachments
-from the frontiers towards that place.</p>
-
-<p>Owing to the difficulties of communication Headquarters had
-but meagre information of these events. Hostile detachments
-were also pressing in from the south-west, from the country
-between Lakes Tanganyika and Nyassa. Before them, our
-company fighting in the neighbourhood of Bismarckburg fell
-back slowly in a north-easterly direction towards Tabora. The
-two companies left behind to secure the Langenburg district
-gradually retreated on Iringa, followed by General Northey,
-whose division was equipped with all the appliances of modern
-warfare.</p>
-
-<p>On the Northern Railway, Major Kraut’s patrols, who started
-out from his fortified position at Lembeni, had occasionally
-scored pleasing successes. Several aeroplanes were brought
-down, or came to grief, the passengers being captured and the
-machines destroyed. When the heavy rains had ceased, the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_141" id="Page_141">[141]</a></span>
-enemy commenced his advance from Kahe along the Northern
-Railway, as well as east of it through the Pare Mountains, and
-west of it along the Pangani. Hundreds of automobiles and
-large numbers of mounted troops were observed. In order to
-avoid the danger of being cut off by the greatly superior enemy,
-Major Kraut withdrew his main body by rail to Buiko, leaving
-small detachments in contact with the enemy. In this vicinity,
-as well as near Mombo, a few actions took place, in some of which
-our companies drove through the enemy, who tried to block the
-line, and fired on him from the train. Being in superior force,
-the enemy was always able, with little trouble, to execute outflanking
-movements with fresh troops, but their effectiveness was
-greatly reduced by the difficulty of the country. It seemed,
-therefore, as though the enemy frequently departed from this
-idea and adopted a sort of tactics of attrition instead. To-day
-he would attack with one portion of his force, then let that rest,
-and put in another the next day, and a different portion again
-on the third. In spite of all his obvious urging, and his favourable
-conditions of supply, his advance was fairly slow. Major Kraut’s
-troops never got into a really difficult situation; on the contrary,
-they were often able to catch the enemy under fire unawares,
-and to gain partial successes, which occasionally caused
-him very considerable losses, such as Captain Freiherr von
-Bodecker’s rearguard action near Handeni.</p>
-
-<p>In view of this concentric advance from all directions, the
-question arose, what should be done with the main body
-of the Protective Force now before Kondoa? For an attack
-the situation was altogether too unfavourable. The problem,
-therefore, was, what should be the general direction of our
-retreat? I decided on the Mahenge country. By moving
-there we should avoid being surrounded, it was fertile, and
-suitable for guerilla warfare. From there also it would be
-possible to withdraw further to the south and to continue the
-war for a long time to come.</p>
-
-<p>Another important consideration was the safeguarding of
-our stores deposited along the Central Railway, particularly
-in the vicinity of Morogoro. These were greatly endangered<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_142" id="Page_142">[142]</a></span>
-by the rapid advance of General Smuts, who was opposing Major
-Kraut, and had penetrated far to the south beyond Handeni.
-Although it was to be assumed that General Smuts would be
-delayed by the continually increasing length of his communications,
-he seemed to me to be the most dangerous and important
-of our opponents. I therefore decided to leave in front of the
-Kondoa force only a detachment at Burungi, under Captain
-Klinghardt, but to march my main body back to Dodoma, proceed
-thence by rail to Morogoro, and move up in support of Major
-Kraut. It turned out afterwards that the English were informed
-of this movement down to the smallest details, and that,
-for instance, they knew all about a railway accident that happened
-to one company during its progress. When our companies
-arrived at Morogoro and the Europeans there saw the
-splendid bearing of the Askari they lost the last traces of their
-depression; every man and woman had comprehended that
-our situation was indeed difficult, but also that there was nothing
-for it but to go on fighting, and that our Force was, from its
-whole quality and nature, capable of carrying on for a long time
-to come.</p>
-
-<p>Early in July I reached Major Kraut, who was holding a fortified
-position on Kanga Mountain, north-east of Tuliani. I had
-expected the Askari to be depressed by their retreat, but found
-them in excellent spirits and full of confidence. In front of
-their position they had cleared the foreground for 50 to 100
-yards and were fully convinced that they could beat off an attack.</p>
-
-<p>I employed the time that elapsed before the arrival of the
-other detachments in reconnaissance, and soon formed a mental
-picture of the passes which led across the difficult rock and forest
-country westward of our line of communication.</p>
-
-<p>Owing to the remarkably dense bush an attempt to send a
-strong detachment round the enemy’s camp to attack it in
-rear was unsuccessful. But the enemy did sustain casualties
-through numerous minor enterprises by our patrols, who fired
-at his transport columns and the automobiles working behind
-his front. In this way also a Staff car was once effectively
-fired on. The enemy’s patrols were also active and several of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_143" id="Page_143">[143]</a></span>
-his distant patrols had got behind us. One of them, commanded
-by Lieutenant Wienholt, betrayed its presence by surprising
-a column of our carriers and burning the loads. Among other
-things these contained a quantity of trousers which had come
-out in the store-ship and were anxiously expected. Wienholt,
-therefore, aroused painful interest on the part of everyone. His
-patrol was discovered in camp in the dense bush and surprised.
-He himself got away, and trusting to the fact that it is not easy
-to find anyone in the African bush, wanted to work his way
-alone through our lines and back to the English. Our well-tried
-men, zan Rongew, Nieuwenhudgu and Trappel, who had
-effected the clever capture of the horses near Longido Mountain,
-succeeded in tracking and capturing him. On my return from
-a reconnaissance I met Wienholt in our camp at Tuliani enjoying
-a cheery meal with his captors. We could none of us help
-honestly admiring the excellent work of his patrol, whose route
-was accurately marked on the map that was captured in his
-possession. Wienholt was then taken to a prisoners’ camp in
-the interior, from which he escaped some months later while
-bathing. In 1917 he did excellent work on patrol round Kilwa
-and Livale, and also later on, in 1918, in Portuguese East Africa.
-I was greatly interested in his description of an attack by a leopard
-which, with great boldness, killed his companion in camp. I
-presume he has by now given friends and acquaintances the
-benefit of his vivid account, of which he unfortunately lost the
-original later on in a patrol encounter.</p>
-
-<p>Weeks now passed, during which the English annoyed us mainly
-by bombs from aircraft. They had evidently found out the exact
-site of our Headquarter camp at Tuliani. I remember one day
-when four aeroplanes, against which we could do nothing, circled
-over our camp for hours and dropped bombs. But we had learned
-to make ourselves invisible, and only the European employed
-in the telephone hut was so badly hurt that he lost his hand.
-An adjoining hut full of valuable documents was set alight
-by an incendiary bomb.</p>
-
-<p>My cars were then still working, and from Tuliani I was often
-able quickly to reach Kraut’s Detachment in front by the good<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_144" id="Page_144">[144]</a></span>
-line-of-communication road. Lieutenant-Commander Schoenfeld
-had there made excellent arrangements for directing the fire of
-the 4-inch and 3·5-inch naval guns. From his observation posts
-on the heights of Kanga Mountain one had a good view of the
-English camps. Some weak German detachments had not
-followed Major Kraut from Usambara towards Tuliani, but had
-escaped along the Usambara Railway towards Tanga. There,
-and also near Korogwe, they had minor encounters with the
-enemy and gradually fell back towards the south, on the east
-side of Kraut’s Detachment. They were followed by more
-considerable portions of the enemy. Gradually the force at
-Tuliani became liable to be circumvented on the east, and to
-lose its communication with the Morogoro country, which was
-so important for the supply of stores, ammunition and food.
-At the same time General van Deventer, whose force had been
-augmented to a division, advanced from Kondoa to the south,
-and Captain Klinghardt retired before him, first to the south,
-and then towards Mpapua.</p>
-
-<p>The closeness and difficulty of the country caused Captain
-Klinghardt to still further subdivide his already small force (five
-companies) in order to watch and block important passes. The
-enemy followed with a large number of automobiles, and occasionally
-one of them was successfully blown up by mines sunk
-in the roads. Owing to the unavoidable dissemination of Captain
-Klinghardt’s troops, and the difficulty of maintaining touch
-between them, one part often could not know what was happening
-to its neighbours. A large German mounted patrol
-was attempting to connect up from the east with a detachment
-believed to be at Meiameia, on the road from Dodoma to Kondoa-Irangi.
-All unconsciously it rode straight into a hostile camp
-and was captured almost without exception. The retirement
-of our troops from Kondoa, who had not merely to escape, but
-also to inflict damage on the enemy, was a very difficult manœuvre;
-the right moment to fall back, to halt again, to advance for a
-sudden counter-stroke, and then break off again quickly, and in
-sufficient time, is difficult to gauge. Reliable reports were
-lacking. Owing to the scarcity of means of communication<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_145" id="Page_145">[145]</a></span>
-the difficulties attending the retirement of several columns
-through unknown country grew infinitely great. The influence
-of the commander was often eliminated, and too much had
-to be left to chance. On the 31st July, 1916, the enemy reached
-the Central Railway at Dodoma. Captain Klinghardt slipped off
-to the east along the railway. In the actions which took place
-west of Mpapua several favourable opportunities were not
-recognized, and neighbouring detachments, whose assistance
-had been relied on, did not arrive in time. Such things easily
-give rise to a feeling of insecurity among the troops and weaken
-confidence and enterprise. The difficulties were accentuated
-in this case by the fact that Captain Klinghardt was taken ill
-with typhoid and became a casualty just at the critical moment.
-Captain Otto was sent from Tuliani to replace him, and succeeded
-in once more collecting the scattered parties and in establishing
-united control.</p>
-
-<p>The 2nd Rifle Company also, which had been obliged to retire
-on Saranda by the Kondoa-Saranda road, and with which all
-touch had been lost, made a great circuit on the south side of
-the railway and rejoined Otto’s Detachment. Owing to the
-numerical superiority of the enemy, in the actions which now
-took place, Otto’s Detachment frequently found itself exposed
-to an attack on its front while being enveloped on both flanks.
-The enemy did not always succeed in timing these movements
-correctly. Thus, at Mpapua, the frontal attack got too close to
-our line and suffered severely; and the flank attack, even when
-directed on the rear of our positions, produced no decisive effect.
-The short range of visibility always enabled us either to avoid
-the danger, or, if the opportunity was favourable, to attack the
-troops outflanking us in detail. In any event, these outflanking
-tactics of the enemy, when followed, as in this case, in extraordinarily
-thick bush, and among numerous rocks, demanded
-great exertions and used up his strength. Every day Captain
-Otto fell back only a couple of miles further to the east, and in
-these operations the railway enabled him to change the position
-of his big gun at will. When Otto’s Detachment approached
-Kilossa it became necessary to move the main body at Tuliani<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_146" id="Page_146">[146]</a></span>
-also. Headquarters and a part of the force moved to Morogoro,
-Major Kraut, with several companies and a 4-inch gun, to Kilossa.
-At Tuliani Captain Schulz took command.</p>
-
-<p>I now considered that columns pressing on from the north
-would soon reach the country west of Bagamoyo, and that at
-this place also troops would be landed. In order to reconnoitre
-personally, I travelled to Ruwa Station and thence by bicycle
-over the sandy, undulating road to Bagamoyo. One day’s
-march south of Bagamoyo I came on the camp of two Europeans:
-it was District Commissioner Michels, who wanted to remove his
-threatened District Headquarters from Bagamoyo towards the
-interior. The inhabitants were confiding and were living as in
-peace. So far the universal war had passed them by without
-a trace. As time pressed I had to turn back and Herr Michels’
-fast Muscat donkey carried me back to Ruwa in a few hours.
-On the next day, from Kidugallo, I reconnoitred the supply
-depots established there and further to the north by cycle
-and then returned to Morogoro. Other reconnaissances, mostly
-also by cycle, took me to the mountains lying to westward in
-the direction of Kilossa, and along the roads leading round the
-Uluguru Mountains on the west and east. The passes leading
-from Morogoro up the northern slopes of the gigantic Uluguru
-group, and down again on the south side towards Kissaki, had
-to be examined on foot. Owing to the pressure exerted by
-General van Deventer on Kilossa, and the danger that Captain
-Schulz might also be circumvented at Tuliani, it was imperative
-not to miss the right moment for withdrawing Captain Schulz
-to Morogoro. But in order to retain the power of delivering
-counter-strokes we had to hold on to the Tuliani area as long as
-possible.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Stemmermann’s Detachment, which had been pushed
-out a short day’s march due north of Tuliani, was attacked
-at Maomondo by a strong force of Europeans and Indians.
-The enemy was very skilful. A machine gun of the 6th Company,
-placed on a rocky slope, was seized by a few Indians, who had
-crept up to it from the front unobserved, and thrown down
-the steep slope, so that it could not be found again. The enemy,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_147" id="Page_147">[147]</a></span>
-who had penetrated our lines, was thrown out again with heavy
-loss by a counter-attack by the 21st Company. At close quarters
-the English Major Buller, a son of the well-known General of
-the South African War days, put a bullet through the hat of the
-Company Commander, Lieutenant von Ruckteschell, but was
-then severely wounded by the latter. Major Buller was got
-away to the German hospital at Dar-es-Salaam and nursed back
-to health by the wife of his opponent, who was working there
-as a nurse. During the actions at Maternondo English horsemen
-had worked round farther to the west, and suddenly appeared
-in one of the mountain passes leading from the west to Tuliani.
-In the dense bush the 2nd Mounted Brigade, which had come
-from South Africa under General Brits, apparently sustained
-heavy casualties.</p>
-
-<p>With the consent of Headquarters, Captain Schulz now withdrew
-to Derkawa, which is situated in dense bush on the Wami
-river, on the road from Tuliani to Morogoro. Here he occupied
-a fortified position on the south bank, where he was attacked
-on the 13th August by the enemy pursuing from Tuliani, with a
-force of at least one brigade of infantry, and General Brits’
-Mounted Brigade, while simultaneously another brigade, which
-had marched up the right bank of the Wami, attacked him from
-the east. During the action continuous telephonic communication
-was maintained with Captain Schulz from Morogoro. The
-enemy’s losses were estimated at several hundred, and were
-afterwards confirmed by the English. The attacks were beaten
-off, but in the dense bush it was so difficult to obtain a clear
-idea of the situation that it did not seem possible to achieve a
-decisive success. Captain Schulz was chary of putting in the one
-formed company he had left. I approved his intention of falling
-back to Morogoro at the end of the action, as the general situation
-made it desirable for me to concentrate my forces. After Major
-Kraut’s arrival at Kilossa I also brought Captain Otto in to
-Morogoro, with part of his companies. Major Kraut had passed
-behind Otto’s Detachment through Kilossa and after some
-engagements at that place, he took up a position immediately
-to the south of it, on the road to Mahenge. Even after the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_148" id="Page_148">[148]</a></span>
-enemy had moved into Kilossa telephonic communication with
-Kraut’s Detachment had continued to work for a few hours
-through the enemy.</p>
-
-<p>From that time on direct communication with Major Kraut
-was interrupted. Signalling by helio did not work, and the wires
-which led from Kissaki, and later from the Rufiji, to Mahenge,
-and thence to Major Kraut, were not yet completed&mdash;in some cases
-not even begun. With General Wahle at Tabora we had also
-had no communication since the second half of July, that is,
-for over a month. Bagamoyo had fallen into the enemy’s hands;
-and every day we expected to hear of the fall of Dar-es-Salaam
-and to lose touch with that place.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_149" id="Page_149">[149]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER VI<br />
-<span class="wn">CONTINUOUS FIGHTING NEAR THE RUFIJI</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">IN order to oppose the troops of General Northey, who were
-advancing from the direction of New Langenburg, Captain
-Braunschweig had been dispatched from Dodoma at the end of
-June. He had taken up reinforcements from Kondoa and
-Dar-es-Salaam to the two German Askari companies that had
-slipped away from the New Langenburg country, and had concentrated
-his own troops, totalling five companies and one field
-howitzer, at Malangali. At that place his force had fought a
-brave action with a superior force of the enemy, but had been
-obliged to fall back towards Mahenge.</p>
-
-<p>As the converging hostile columns were now approaching
-each other in the direction of Morogoro, it became necessary to
-consider our future plan of operations. The enemy expected us
-to stand and fight a final decisive engagement near Morogoro,
-on the northern slopes of the Uluguru Mountains. To me, this
-idea was never altogether intelligible. Being so very much the
-weaker party, it was surely madness to await at this place the
-junction of the hostile columns, of which each one individually
-was already superior to us in numbers, and then to fight with
-our back to the steep and rocky mountains, of which the passes
-were easy to close, and which deprived us of all freedom of movement
-in our rear. I thought it sounder so to conduct our operations
-that we should only have to deal with a part of the enemy.
-Knowing that the enemy, and General Brits in particular, had
-a liking for wide turning movements, I felt sure that one column
-would move off from Dakawa, where large hostile camps had
-been identified, or from Kilossa, in order to reach our rear by
-working round the west side of the Uluguru Mountains. This<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_150" id="Page_150">[150]</a></span>
-possibility was so obvious that I cycled out every day to the
-mountains west of Morogoro, so as to get the reports from the
-patrols in good time, and to supplement them by personal
-observation of the clouds of smoke and dust. The latter soon
-put it beyond doubt that a strong column was moving from
-near Dakawa towards the railway between Morogoro and
-Kilossa. Patrols identified enemy troops that had crossed the
-railway and were marching further south. The observers on
-the mountains reported the clouds of dust to be moving towards
-Mlali.</p>
-
-<p>As I meant to let this movement run its full course and then
-attack the isolated detachment with the whole of my forces, I
-waited until I thought it was near Mlali. On the evening of
-the 23rd August, Captain Otto, who was encamped at Morogoro,
-was ordered to march off for Mlali during the night with three
-companies. He arrived there early on the 24th, just as English
-horsemen had taken possession of the depot. When I reached
-Otto’s Detachment the fight was in full swing. The country
-was, however, unsuitable for short decisive strokes, owing to
-the many steep hills which impeded movement. The other
-troops at Morogoro, except Captain Stemmermann’s Detachment,
-were ordered up by telephone. I myself went back again
-to Morogoro to talk things over. Stemmermann’s Detachment,
-to which, on account of the roads, the 4-inch <i>Königsberg</i> gun
-and the howitzer battery were attached, was ordered to fall
-back along the eastern slopes of the Uluguru Mountains, and to
-delay the enemy there. The passes over the mountains themselves
-were closed by weak patrols. When I arrived once more
-at Mlali in the afternoon, the fight was still undecided. At
-several points the enemy had been driven back, and several
-people thought they had seen him suffer considerably. But by
-nightfall we had got so entangled in the mountains, and every
-movement had become so difficult and took so much time, that
-we halted. We found the night very cold, lying out on the hills
-without the carriers’ loads. Luckily, however, this fertile
-region had so far hardly suffered at all from the war, and a fowl
-roasted on a spit soon appeased our hunger.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_151" id="Page_151">[151]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The next morning numerous explosions in the German depots,
-which had been surprised by the enemy, indicated that he had
-moved off and had destroyed the 4-inch shells stored there.
-We surmised that he was moving south-west, which eventually
-turned out to be the case. The enemy was probably making a
-turning movement so as to reach Kissaki before us. At the
-wealthy Administration Office at that place, 600 tons of food
-supplies and the military stores removed from Morogoro had
-been collected. Wild rumours exaggerated the actual facts,
-and stated that strong forces had already reached the roads
-leading to Kissaki before us. Although the wagon road stopped
-at Mlali, and the remainder of the route to Kissaki consisted
-only of paths broken by many ravines and obstacles, the possibility
-that the enemy might make a rapid march on Kissaki
-had to be taken very seriously, and we had no time to waste.
-In the evening we were most hospitably entertained by the
-Father at Mgeta Mission. The buildings are charmingly situated
-in the deep ravine of the Mgeta river, which in this part comes
-down very swiftly. The many lights on the slope of the hill
-made one think one was approaching some small watering-place
-in Germany. A few European women from Morogoro were
-also staying there, and bade farewell to the Force for the last
-time. With the exception of a few nurses all women had to
-stay behind.</p>
-
-<p>The removal of our loads was carried out fairly satisfactorily.
-The Force profited by the fact that owing to the insistence of
-the energetic Captain Feilke, about a thousand native labourers,
-who had until a few days previously been working in the forestry
-department at Morogoro, were placed at its disposal. But the
-carrier question was beginning to be difficult. The natives
-saw that we were evacuating the country; a number of them,
-who had promised to come, stayed away, to the despair of the
-sensible Chiefs, who would gladly have helped us. As only
-small parties of the enemy appeared in the country round Mgeta,
-it began to seem probable that his principal forces were making
-a turning movement. Leaving a rearguard behind, which only
-followed us slowly, our main body was, during the ensuing days,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_152" id="Page_152">[152]</a></span>
-moved nearer to Kissaki. One night an Askari appeared at
-my bedside, bearing himself in a smart military manner: it was
-the Effendi Yuma Mursal, of the 4th Field Company, who had
-been left behind sick at Morogoro. He reported that a force
-of the enemy, as strong as that at Kahe had been, had marched
-round the west side of the Uluguru Mountains from Morogoro,
-and that a number of German Askari had found the recent
-fighting too much for them. They had deserted, and were now
-plundering the plantations south-west of Morogoro.</p>
-
-<p>A telephone line was laid from Kissaki to us, by means of
-which Captain Tafel kept us continually informed; up to date
-no enemy had been seen at Kissaki. But to the west of us,
-patrols reported the enemy to be marching to the south. I
-therefore moved to Kissaki, and had to destroy some of our
-stores, which were collected in small depots along our route.
-Unfortunately, in carrying this out, an efficient Ordnance N.C.O.
-was accidentally killed, as had happened before on a similar
-occasion at Morogoro. At Kissaki, several days passed before
-we came seriously into collision with the enemy. It was not
-advisable to occupy the Boma Fort itself; it consisted of a
-group of buildings surrounded by a massive high wall, and was
-situated in the middle of a completely cleared bit of country.
-The enemy could, therefore, only capture it by a costly attack;
-but he had no need to assault it at all; by means of artillery
-and bombs from aircraft, he could have made it intolerable for
-us to remain in the cramped Boma, and we ourselves should
-then have been forced to make a sortie over the open and to
-endure the fire which the enemy would have been able to pour
-into us in perfect security. Our defences were, therefore,
-placed a long way outside the Boma, covered from the view of
-aircraft, and so arranged that they could be occupied and
-evacuated unobserved.</p>
-
-<p>It was not until I arrived at Kissaki myself that I obtained
-a proper idea of the abundance of stores and supplies available
-there. I learned that, contrary to my belief, practically nothing
-was stored further south at Behobeho or at Kungulio, on the
-Rufiji. At Kissaki there were large stocks, but notwithstanding<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_153" id="Page_153">[153]</a></span>
-the dense native population, it was impossible to get them away.
-The numerous inhabitants, to whom the war and the many
-Askari were something quite new, lost their heads and ran
-away into the bush. The Civil Administration, which enjoyed
-the complete confidence of the people, proved powerless against
-the overwhelming influences now bursting in upon them. Even
-presents of clothing, which were ordinarily so highly valued,
-failed to hold them. It seemed as if all the evil spirits had
-conspired together to deprive us of transport. Our column
-of several hundred pack-donkeys had been driven over the mountains
-from Morogoro. It arrived at Kissaki late and completely
-exhausted. Our ox-wagons, which had to go round the east
-side of the Uluguru Mountains on account of the state of the
-roads, seemed to be never going to arrive. The head of the
-Communications Service could not find any other means of
-carrying away the stocks which were essential to us for continuing
-the war. And yet it was obvious that we must continue
-to fall back further south, towards the Rufiji, before the superior
-numbers of the enemy.</p>
-
-<p>One circumstance that brightened the gloom was that our
-great herds of cattle, which had been grazing east of Mpapua,
-had been brought away in good time. Several thousand head,
-mostly beautiful cattle, arrived at Kissaki, and would have
-formed a most welcome mobile reserve of supplies. But, unfortunately,
-our pleasure at this was diminished by the frequent
-occurrence of the tse-tse fly at some places; if the animals
-got stung by them they lost condition badly, and mostly died
-after a few weeks. The bulk of the cattle was, therefore, driven
-on into the healthy districts on the Rufiji. As for the rest, we
-simply worked with energy at getting away the stores to Behobeho
-and on to Kungulio, using the carriers belonging to the
-troops, all the people we could raise in the district, and our few
-wagons. In order to effect this, we had to gain time, and
-Captain Stemmermann, who was marching round the Uluguru
-Mountains by the eastern road, could only be allowed to fall
-back quite slowly before the hostile division which was pushing
-after him with all its might.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_154" id="Page_154">[154]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>I waited at Kissaki with the main body, in order to be able
-quickly to recognize and make use of any favourable opportunity.
-As was to be expected, the enemy had, owing to our
-withdrawal to Kissaki, abandoned his concentration on Morogoro;
-he had sent a few detachments direct over the Uluguru
-Mountains, but his other columns had separated and followed
-us, extending far to the east and west. The hope of being able
-to defeat one or more of these columns separately was fulfilled
-beyond expectation. West of the Uluguru Mountains General
-Brits had divided his division into brigade columns (two mounted
-and one infantry), which had difficulty in keeping touch. Soon
-large hostile camps were discovered a day’s march west of
-Kissaki, and on the 7th September, 1916, Captain Otto’s Detachment,
-which was encamped at a plantation near Kissaki, was
-attacked by a large force of European horse, and by native
-and white infantry. It turned out later that this force consisted
-of General Enslin’s Mounted Brigade, and of portions
-of the infantry brigade of General Brits’s Division. The turning
-movement which the enemy was making round the left wing of
-Otto’s Detachment was allowed to continue until the outflanking
-detachment had got right round in rear of Captain
-Otto, near the Boma of Kissaki. Evidently the enemy did not
-expect German reserves to be posted under cover still further
-back. These reserves were now loosed upon him. The gallant
-11th Field Company, under Lieutenant Volkwein of the Reserve,
-worked through the dense bush close up to the outflanking
-enemy, and immediately attacked with the bayonet, cheering.
-With that the enemy’s beautiful plans completely collapsed;
-our further advance simply rolled him up, and he was completely
-defeated. The almost impenetrable bush made it impossible
-vigorously to push the enemy, or to undertake a pursuit
-on a large scale; but the bulk of his troops was broken up, and
-the small fragments were scattered in the bush in hopeless confusion.
-The led-horses and horse-holders were captured, and
-about fifteen Europeans taken prisoner. Even the next day
-an English soldier arrived from quite another direction; he had
-lost himself with his led-horses in the dense bush and had no<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_155" id="Page_155">[155]</a></span>
-idea where to go. The man had plenty of humour; he threw
-his rifle and ammunition across a small stream and said: “It’s
-just luck; I might have taken the right road or the wrong one.
-I had the bad luck to take the wrong one. That’s my fault.”</p>
-
-<p>Tafel’s Detachment, which was encamped north of Kissaki,
-on the road we had come by, had only partially joined in the
-fight on the evening of the 7th. I had kept it back, as I thought
-that, simultaneously with the attack on the 7th from the west,
-another one would be made from the north along the road.
-And General Brits undoubtedly did hold this perfectly sound
-intention; but the execution failed. General Nussy’s Mounted
-Brigade, without having any idea of the action of the 7th,
-marched along towards Tafel’s Detachment from the north on
-the 8th. It was just as thoroughly beaten as its friends had
-been the day before. In the dense bush it was, on the 8th, even
-more difficult to survey the fighting, and a considerable number
-of prisoners taken by the 1st Company managed to escape.</p>
-
-<p>In the two days we took some thirty European prisoners, and
-some of them were sent back to the enemy, on taking an oath
-not to fight again in this war against the Germans or their
-allies. The humanity of this step, which was, under tropical
-conditions, in the best interest of the prisoners themselves, was
-not recognized by the English. They suspected spying, seized
-the German envoy who brought back the prisoners, sent him
-far into the bush with his eyes bound, and then let him go
-where good luck might take him. It was a wonder that the
-man, who was exhausted by prolonged wandering about, found
-his way back. This shows how difficult the English made it
-for us to avoid unnecessary severity towards the enemy. At
-the same time, the English private soldiers had faith in the
-treatment we meted out to our prisoners. While the battlefield
-was being cleared, in which both English and German
-medical officers took part, wounded Englishmen begged to be
-treated by the German doctor. And later on, also, wounded
-men remarked that they would hardly have been cured if they
-had been treated by English medical personnel.</p>
-
-<p>It was my opinion that these satisfactory successes at Kissaki<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_156" id="Page_156">[156]</a></span>
-had not brought us a final decision against the troops of General
-Brits, and I still believe that in the dense bush and the rugged
-country an energetic pursuit, which alone would have secured
-the desired result, was impossible of execution. My attention
-was all the more drawn towards the force pursuing Stemmermann’s
-Detachment, as it had already come within two days’
-march north-east of Kissaki. During the last few days the
-situation there had not been favourable; the broken ground
-had in several instances caused our already weak forces to be
-disseminated. Some portions had been ambushed, the troops
-were very fatigued, and several people were suffering badly
-from nerves. On the 9th September Stemmermann’s Detachment
-approached the village of Dutumi, which was known to
-me from previous reconnaissance. I thought the enemy would
-press on on the following day, and considered the opportunity
-favourable for achieving a success at Dutumi by rapidly moving
-my main body there from Kissaki. In the evening we marched
-away from Kissaki by the fine broad road, and reached Dutumi
-that night. Captain Otto remained at Kissaki with five companies.
-On arrival I decided to make use of the factor of surprise,
-and to make an enveloping attack in the early morning
-on the enemy’s left wing, which was identified close in front of
-Stemmermann’s Detachment. I knew that this wing was in
-the plain, while, looking from our side, the enemy’s centre and
-right stretched away to the left up the foot-hills of the Uluguru
-Mountains. It was because of these foot-hills that the chances
-of attack were less favourable on our left.</p>
-
-<p>Early on the 9th September, Schulz’s Detachment attacked
-from our right. Rifle and machine-gun fire soon started, and
-the enemy’s light artillery also opened fire; but the thick high
-elephant grass, with which the plain was covered, made it
-impossible to form a clear idea of things. I thought the attack
-was going well, and proceeded to the left in order to get a view
-of the situation. The heights there were also densely overgrown.
-It was very fatiguing to get along and difficult to find
-anybody. I was clambering about, fairly exhausted in the heat
-of a tropical noon, when I luckily heard the sound of tin pots,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_157" id="Page_157">[157]</a></span>
-and found I was right in concluding that some European was
-just having lunch. It was Captain Goering, who had taken
-up his post in the bush on a height which afforded a good view.
-Here, towards three p.m., I received the unwelcome news that
-the attack by Schulz’s Detachment on our right had not attained
-its object. It had been simply impossible to get at the enemy
-through the dense elephant grass. If, therefore, any decisive
-action was to be taken on that day at all, it could only be done
-on our left. Even here, owing to the difficult country, success
-was not very probable. The advancing companies got into a
-very intersected mountain tract, in which they shot at the
-enemy, and were shot at by him without any result, and at dusk
-returned to their original positions.</p>
-
-<p>During the following days the enemy directed his attacks
-mainly against our left, and was frequently driven back by
-counter-strokes. But, on the whole, it was evident that success
-was only possible if the enemy proved very unskilful. On the
-other hand, our communications, which from now on no longer
-ran to Kissaki, but towards Behobeho in the south-east, were
-in a great degree threatened by the enemy. I therefore abandoned
-Dutumi, and withdrew the main body an hour’s march
-to the south, across the Mgeta river, where the Force occupied
-an extensive fortified camp, which it continued to hold for
-months. By this move the rich fields of Dutumi were unfortunately
-given up. In the poor country of Kiderengwa we had
-to depend mainly on supplies from the rear, which were sent up
-from the Rufiji. Unfortunately the fatigues of this transport
-work, combined with sickness caused by tse-tse, very soon led
-to the almost complete loss of our pack-donkeys. From Kiderengwa
-our fighting patrols attacked the enemy’s communications,
-which ran to the north-east from Dutumi, as well as the
-Dutumi-Kissaki road, which soon became alive with enemy
-detachments and transport.</p>
-
-<p>Various observations now concurred in disclosing remarkable
-movements on the part of the enemy. Both east and west of
-the Uluguru Mountains movements of troops in such strength
-were seen to be taking place towards Morogoro, that the natives<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_158" id="Page_158">[158]</a></span>
-said: “<i>Wana hama</i>” (“They are moving elsewhere”). A large
-number of the South African Europeans, of whom, by the way,
-many had come to the end of their strength, were sent home.
-Other observations disclosed a movement of troops towards
-the east. Generally speaking, a period of rest ensued, which was
-only interrupted by minor expeditions of patrols and occasional
-artillery bombardments.</p>
-
-<p>General Smuts realized that his blow had failed. He sent me
-a letter calling upon me to surrender, by which he showed
-that, as far as force was concerned, he had reached the end of
-his resources.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_159" id="Page_159">[159]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER VII<br />
-<span class="wn">HOSTILE ATTACKS IN THE SOUTH-EAST OF THE COLONY</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">MEANWHILE, the situation at Kilwa began to demand
-increased attention. We had there only weak detachments
-for protecting the coast, which consisted mainly of young,
-newly-enlisted Askari, and had been organized as a company.
-This company was not sufficient, and there was a danger that
-the enemy might march from Kilwa to the Rufiji, or to Livale,
-and get in our rear. No doubt the enemy had some such intention,
-and something had to be done to prevent it. Major von
-Boemken, with three companies, had already marched off from
-the battlefield of Dutumi for Kunguliu on the Rufiji, proceeding
-thence to Utete by route march and on the stern-wheeler
-<i>Tomondo</i>. The <i>Tomondo</i> was the only shallow-draught steamer
-on the Rufiji, and carried most of the supplies, which came from
-the lower Rufiji to Kunguliu, whence they were carried to the
-troops at Kiderengwa by donkeys and carriers. It now required
-a certain amount of discussion before the civil authorities would
-place the <i>Tomondo</i> at my disposal for carrying the necessary
-troops. At Kilwa the situation did not develop altogether satisfactorily.
-It is true that a few minor engagements were more
-or less in our favour, but, as so often happened during the war,
-we did not manage to secure united control of our forces.
-Among other things, the enemy succeeded in destroying a
-supply depot west of Kilwa, which was too near the coast. The
-enemy cleverly incited the natives to rebellion, and they rendered
-him valuable service as spies. Several German reconnoitring
-detachments were ambushed and suffered severely. The District
-Commissioner of Kilwa was taken prisoner. The awkwardness
-of the already difficult situation at Kilwa was increased by<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_160" id="Page_160">[160]</a></span>
-the fact that the District Commissioner’s Askari were not
-placed under the orders of the military commander.</p>
-
-<p>At the same time, the pressure of hostile forces was felt from
-the direction of Dar-es-Salaam, in the north, towards the lower
-Rufiji. Our weak detachments, which had fallen back from
-Dar-es-Salaam in a southerly direction towards the Rufiji, and
-consisted principally of a young company of Askari and part
-of the ship’s company of the <i>Königsberg</i>, were not enough to
-protect the rich sources of subsistence in the lower Rufiji country.
-But at the time this country was what the Force depended on,
-for the middle Rufiji country was but sparsely settled, and could
-not maintain both troops and carriers for any length of time.
-In view of this necessitous situation, we had at once started to
-grow maize in the fertile lowlands of Logeloge and Mpanganya,
-but the harvest could not be expected before March, 1917.
-We were, therefore, threatened by a great danger when several
-companies of Indians attacked our advanced officers’ post in
-the Boma of Kissengire. The enemy, who assaulted the steep
-walls without sufficient preparatory fire, was driven off with
-considerable loss. Unfortunately, the German commander,
-Lieutenant Baldamus, of the Reserve, who exposed himself too
-freely to the enemy projectiles, was killed. But his resolute and
-gallant defence secured us in the possession of the seat of administration
-at Kissengire until the arrival of adequate reinforcements;
-it is, therefore, due to this officer that we retained
-control of the rich supply area of the lower Rufiji for months to
-come.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-160.jpg" width="400" height="584" id="i160"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc">Askari. A halt.<br />
-<span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-161.jpg" width="400" height="579" id="i161"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc">The Banyan Tree.<br />
-<span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_161" id="Page_161">[161]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-161a.jpg" width="400" height="539" id="m161"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pc">Fig. xiii. Battles of Kissaki and Dutumi.
-Fig. xiv. March of German Main
-Force, September, 1916, to June, 1917.</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>It has already been mentioned that a pause in the operations
-had occurred at Kiderengwa; an attack on the enemy, who was
-entrenched in a strong position, promised no success. Headquarters
-accordingly left only eight companies, under Captain
-Tafel, in the Kissaki-Kiderengwa area (and this force was
-reduced later), moving with the bulk of the troops to the lower
-Rufiji. The road to Kunguliu led past large lakes, which, like
-the Rufiji, were full of hippopotami. Owing to the general
-demand for fat, hippopotamus shooting became a question of
-existence. One has to watch until the animal’s head is clearly
-visible, so as to hit in a spot that will cause instantaneous death.
-The animal then sinks, and comes up again after a little time
-when it can be drawn to the bank by means of a rope, quickly
-made of bark. There it is cut up, and the expert knows exactly<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_162" id="Page_162">[162]</a></span>
-where to find the white, appetizing fat. The quantity varies:
-a well-fed beast provides over two bucketfuls. But one has to
-learn, not only how to prepare the fat, but also how to kill immediately
-with the first shot. Some foolish people had been reckless,
-and in many places the dead bodies of wounded animals
-were to be seen, which quickly decompose and become unfit for
-food. The elephant also was now regarded in a new light;
-ordinarily the elephant hunter gauges the length and weight
-of the tusk before firing; now the pressing question was: how
-much fat will the beast supply? For elephant fat is very good,
-and possibly tastes even better than that of the hippo.</p>
-
-<p>At Kunguliu the herds of cattle we had brought along were
-driven into the river, and swam across. Up till then the troops
-had crossed by ferry, on which Herr Kühlwein, the former
-traffic manager of our lost Northern Railway, now contented
-himself with the more modest post of “Traffic Manager, Kunguliu
-Ferry.” When we arrived, a bridge, three hundred and
-thirty yards long, had been completed, which was also capable
-of taking vehicles. On the south bank we went into camp near
-Niakisiku Plantation, belonging to Lieutenant Bleeck, of the
-Reserve, who had been called up. The Europeans’ houses had
-been fitted up as hospitals, and were fully occupied. At Logeloge
-we found the Headquarters of the Line of Communication,
-where a large number of roomy grass huts had been put up for
-the troops. The plantation itself, belonging to a company,
-comprised extensive sisal fields. Food also was cultivated in
-plenty. The country being free of tse-tse, supported a large
-amount of cattle, and the survivors of our pack-donkeys had been
-brought there from the tse-tse country north of the Rufiji.
-Here the families of the Europeans still lived in their solidly-built
-houses, and were thankful that the course of the operations
-had enabled them to continue their home and business life
-undisturbed for more than two years.</p>
-
-<p>At Logeloge, and at the agricultural experimental establishment
-of Mpanganya, which we reached next day, other Europeans
-of the neighbourhood had also collected, and, where the existing
-buildings failed to accommodate them, had built themselves<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_163" id="Page_163">[163]</a></span>
-houses with poles and cane, or grass. Here an unpleasant
-symptom also made its appearance. While the troops at the
-front were animated by the best spirit and great enterprise,
-things behind the front were not always the same. The people
-who understood least of the business always knew everything
-better, and fostered a certain amount of discontent. That
-kind of thing is catching, and in the long run undermines right
-feeling. Fortunately, however, many of the troops behind the
-front had enough soldierly pride to shut up the grousers pretty
-bluntly on occasion. In one of the hospitals there someone was
-becoming rather too free with his destructive criticism, and a
-wounded man answered: “I tell you what, the Commandant
-is the brain of the Force, but you’re its backside!” This
-unvarnished epithet was so apt, that it at once turned the laugh
-on the side of the speaker, and polished away the spot of tarnish
-that threatened to spread.</p>
-
-<p>The question now was, whether we should first turn to the
-north against the force at Kissengire, or against the one at
-Kilwa. The latter had not, as Major von Boemken had feared,
-moved on towards Livale, but, possibly influenced by the movements
-of our troops, had turned towards the north. It thus
-worked into the Kibata country, which, though rich, was very
-mountainous, and difficult for manœuvre, and as long as it
-remained there I did not think it would be very dangerous. I
-considered it sufficient merely to prevent it from pushing further
-towards the Rufiji, for which a weak force of five companies,
-under Major Schulz, was enough. Major von Boemken, who was
-anxious about Livale, had, with two companies and a 4-inch
-gun, made his way into the neighbourhood of Mpotora, a chance
-circumstance, from which, as will be seen, we later reaped great
-benefit. I had, therefore, a free hand to move on towards Kissengire.
-That was important, and enabled us to secure the rich
-supply country north of the lower Rufiji, and to get away the
-valuable stocks from thence to the middle Rufiji. Whether there
-would be an opportunity of obtaining a success in the field it
-was not possible to tell; but I thought that the enemy, since he
-had pushed troops from the Uluguru Mountains in an easterly<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_164" id="Page_164">[164]</a></span>
-direction to the neighbourhood of Kissengire, would exert some
-pressure from the north. So it was quite possible that we might
-find a favourable opportunity for a fight. We crossed the
-Rufiji at Utete in boats, and in a few days reached Makima,
-one day’s march south of Kissengire. By that time a sufficient
-garrison of two companies had been assembled at Kissengire,
-where it was actively employed in strengthening the position.
-A little to the north, at Maneromango, was a strong force
-of the enemy, and a European patrol, which had started out
-from Kiderengwa, reported that hostile troops had been moved
-from the west towards the Maneromango-Kissengire area.</p>
-
-<p>A few days after leaving Kiderengwa this patrol had got into
-a waterless country in terrible heat, and the various members
-had lost each other in the dense bush. They made their presence
-known by firing, and had no choice but to surrender to the
-English. Only the determined patrol-leader had managed to
-escape to a native village, where the inhabitants greeted him
-with apparent friendliness and brought him eggs. As he bent
-down to take them, they fell upon him, and handed him over
-to a patrol of English Askari concealed close by. An Askari with
-a mule, who behaved rather arrogantly, was to escort the German
-back. On the way the German, during conversation, drew his
-attention to faults in his bridle, and succeeded in seizing the mule
-and riding off on it with all speed. In the struggle which took
-place, he had seized the Askari’s rifle and shot him with it.</p>
-
-<p>To the east of Kissengire our patrols also pushed on to the
-north, and quite a number of minor engagements took place in
-the bush, in which the enemy at times suffered very severely.
-Further to the east, on the coast near Kissiju, other hostile
-detachments were also roaming about, and a small English man-of-war
-was there too. One morning Captain von Lieberman,
-with the 11th Company, surprised this opponent, and our Askari
-went for him with a will, cheering. The man-of-war was also
-fired upon with the field gun, and apparently several hits were
-obtained. After driving the enemy out of Kissiju, Captain von
-Lieberman returned. We also operated against the enemy’s
-communications, and small fights occurred almost daily.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_165" id="Page_165">[165]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The closely-settled country is of simply fabulous fertility.
-Besides abundant flour, both Europeans and Askari had mangos,
-paw paws, mustapheles, cocoanuts, and other tropical fruits.
-We were surprised to see the large rice-fields, which were here
-close to the south side of Dar-es-Salaam, seeing that in peace-time
-most of the rice had come from India. Of cattle there was
-but little, but the companies began to send out shooting parties
-into the prairie, which was full of game, and extended especially
-on the western side of our positions. That there must be game
-in the vicinity was proved by the presence of numerous lions.
-Frequently a family of five lions wandered through our camp at
-night, and occasionally killed animals in it.</p>
-
-<p>While Headquarters was at Makima in October, a report came
-in which caused me to suppose that the landing of strong enemy
-forces at Kilwa, and the appearance of hostile detachments
-which, coming from the west towards Livale, had arrived on the
-Mbaranganda river, formed part of a big converging movement
-by the enemy against Livale. Strong forces of Portuguese had
-crossed the Rovuma, invaded the highlands of Makonde, and
-established themselves in the district of Nevala. The captain
-of the <i>Königsberg</i>, Captain Looff, had, after the evacuation of
-Dar-es-Salaam, proceeded by land, first to the <i>Königsberg’s</i> old
-area on the Rufiji, and then to Lindi. He had now taken over
-command in the south. With the three newly-raised companies
-of Askari, the only troops available there at the moment, he
-had entrenched himself in front of the strong positions of the
-enemy who had landed at Lindi, covered the removal of the cargo
-of the store-ship from Ssudi to the north, and inflicted damage
-on the Portuguese, who had shown themselves on the lower
-Rovuma, by means of minor expeditions. His force was, however,
-rather too weak to enable him to turn against the Portuguese,
-who were advancing in his rear about Nevala, with any
-prospect of a rapid and decisive success.</p>
-
-<p>It was, therefore, very convenient that, as already mentioned,
-two companies and the 4-inch <i>Königsberg</i> gun of von
-Boemken’s Detachment happened to be at Mpotora. To command
-this detachment, Captain Rothe, of the Reserve, was sent<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_166" id="Page_166">[166]</a></span>
-from the Rufiji, as he could in the circumstances be spared from
-his duties as Principal Postmaster (<i>Oberpostdirektor</i>), and had, at
-his urgent request, been placed at the unrestricted disposal of the
-Protective Force. In a few days he arrived from Niakisiku by
-cycle, took over his detachment, and led it towards Nevala.
-Captain Looff took command of the whole force, the Portuguese
-were thoroughly well hammered by the <i>Königsberg</i> gun, and their
-positions were captured by assault. We took a really very considerable
-amount of booty, including four mountain guns, a
-number of machine guns, several hundred rifles, much ammunition,
-several automobiles, supplies, and all kinds of equipment.
-During the following weeks we continually found quantities of
-buried stores and ammunition. The very secret places were
-particularly well stocked. The Portuguese were driven completely
-out of German territory, and pursued for some distance
-into their own country. But consideration of the general
-situation prevented me from carrying on the pursuit to the
-uttermost. Rothe’s Detachment was brought back to Mpotora,
-in order to keep an eye on the enemy at Kilwa, who grew continually
-stronger. Even before this movement was executed,
-I considered it necessary to transfer strong forces from the
-neighbourhood of Kissengire towards Kibata. No opportunity
-had presented itself of fighting a decisive successful battle north
-of the lower Rufiji; as I had expected, I was obliged to proceed
-to a prolonged operation in the mountains of Kibata, which
-offered but little prospect of leading to a decision.</p>
-
-<p>The transfer of the troops towards Kibata took place at the
-end of November, 1916. On the way we encamped at Utete,
-where roomy hospitals had been established in the building of
-the Civil Government, and where an officers’ mess had been
-established on a <i>baraza</i> (an airy veranda). The place was
-situated on dominating heights, and had been strongly fortified
-with trenches and abatis, and commanded the lower-lying and
-very extensive native town. Almost all night one heard the
-deep grunting of the hippo, and one impudent lion, having failed
-in his attack on a native, tried to kill another man in our camp.
-Fortunately his quarry was taken from him at the last moment<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_167" id="Page_167">[167]</a></span>
-by a European, who hurried to the spot, and several natives.
-Continuing, we reached the Moboro-Kibata road. Captain
-Schulz, who had with his detachment occupied a strong position
-two hours north of Kibata, was drawing his supplies from the
-country round Moboro. Several depots on this road were filled
-from the fertile country immediately surrounding them. In
-addition, Captain Schulz sent out parties to buy supplies in the
-districts near his camp, in which the whole wealth of the country
-is revealed.</p>
-
-<p>From a mountain near Mbindia, the camp of Schulz’s Detachment,
-one could see a broad forest track passing over the
-heights. This was the road for a 4-inch <i>Königsberg</i> gun, which
-was being brought up to its position before Kibata by Lieut.-Commander
-Apel. Chanting in rhythm, hundreds of natives
-dragged the heavy load up and down the steep slopes, over which
-a suitable track had been surveyed and cut through the thick
-bush. Shortly after its arrival at Mbindia, the gun had been
-placed in position on a mountain saddle from which, later on,
-the bombardment was successfully carried out. One of the 4-inch
-howitzers was also got into position further forward in a valley,
-so as to fire over the high ground in front and reach the enemy’s
-camps. Detailed reconnaissances had disclosed the possibility
-of moving our infantry, concealed by the dense bush, into some
-high ground which commanded the country north of Kibata.
-The weak hostile force holding this high ground was surprised
-by an attack from the rear and quickly driven off. Then another
-height was attacked, situated at a water-hole immediately to the
-north of the solid European buildings. We could soon see our
-Askari climbing up it, and establishing themselves on it about
-eighty yards in front of a hostile position.</p>
-
-<p>By this time the deployment of our artillery was completed;
-besides the 4-inch <i>Königsberg</i> gun and the field-howitzer the two
-mountain guns had been brought into action, in line with our
-infantry. We had delayed opening fire on the buildings, where
-we saw numbers of men and animals walking about on the bare
-hill-top, until everything was ready. One company which had
-got round the enemy’s rear, and established itself on his main<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_168" id="Page_168">[168]</a></span>
-line of communication, running from Kibata to Kilwa, observed
-that the heavy shells falling near the Boma (Fort) caused a
-frightful panic. Heaps of the enemy’s Askari ran away as fast
-as they could, across the front of the company which was lying
-in concealment. But unfortunately the company allowed itself
-to be deterred from taking advantage of this favourable opportunity.
-It hoped that the scattered parties of Askari would
-soon be followed by larger bodies, and did not want to give away
-the chance of a surprise prematurely. But the expected large
-bodies did not come, and thus, as unfortunately happened often,
-a good opportunity was lost through waiting for a better. The
-infantry attack on the above-mentioned heights immediately
-north of Kibata had involved the loss of several very efficient
-Europeans. Sergeant-Major Mirow was killed, Vice-Sergeant-Major
-Jitzmann was shot in the leg and sustained a severe and
-very painful injury to the nerve of his leg. He had previously
-often distinguished himself by his untiring and successful raids
-on the Uganda Railway. Through prolonged detention in hospital
-he was now lost to the Service, and fell into the enemy’s hands
-before he was recovered.</p>
-
-<p>It was very difficult to find one’s way in the extraordinarily
-rugged mountains of Kibata. A number of reconnoitring expeditions
-were sent out and after a few days we felt more or less at
-home. It was possible to obtain a good view of Kibata and of
-the enemy’s communications, and we ascertained that he was reinforcing
-his troops more and more. As a matter of fact he
-employed at Kibata the main body of the division landed at
-Kilwa. Our observations and the peculiarities of the ground
-led us to expect that the enemy intended to work from Kibeta
-round our right, or western, flank, and thus force us to evacuate
-the heights commanding Kibata and its water-supply from the
-north. A direct attack by the 120th Baluchis had been defeated
-with great loss to the enemy. During the opening days of
-December we observed at first weak, and then stronger detachments,
-which pushed forward from hill to hill towards our right
-flank, and whose advanced parties soon reached a commanding
-mountain, known to the English as Gold Coast Hill. Our<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_169" id="Page_169">[169]</a></span>
-counter-stroke against this force was at first favoured by ravines
-and forests, and our Askari surprised even us when they became
-visible close in front of the enemy’s positions. Our guns were
-ready to fire, but unluckily the first shell pitched among our own
-men, and the infantry attack, which could only succeed by
-rapidity and surprise, failed. However, the fire of our two
-mountain guns at under 1,800 yards, and of our howitzers,
-which were further back, caused quite considerable casualties
-among the Gold Coast Regiment. The enemy was on a narrow
-hog’s-back, the steep slopes of which were for the most part
-bare. He could, therefore, hardly withdraw, and in the hard
-ground entrenching took a long time. We then surrounded the
-hill with infantry, and poured a converging fire on the good
-targets presented to us. It became impossible for the enemy
-to hold this highly important position any longer. After it was
-evacuated we found a large number of graves, each for many
-bodies, and at this point the enemy must have lost not less
-than 150 killed.</p>
-
-<p>The advance of the Gold Coast Regiment had nevertheless
-been of advantage to the enemy. My force being so weak&mdash;we
-had, all told, about nine companies&mdash;I had withdrawn one of
-the two companies stationed in the immediate vicinity of Kibata
-in order to employ it against Gold Coast Hill. After I had
-returned to camp that night I heard the sound of a number of
-small detonations emanating from the one company left alone
-to face the enemy. It was only after some time that we recognized
-this as a grenade attack, a manœuvre then unknown to us.
-Several companies of the enemy attacked with such rapidity
-and skill, that they penetrated the trenches of our weak company
-by surprise and drove it out. The loss of this position deprived
-us of the possibility of firing at close range from that very
-suitable height at hostile troops moving about, or proceeding to
-their water-supply. Until then I had done so with success,
-and had even occasionally sent up a light gun to the place,
-withdrawing it again after it had ceased fire.</p>
-
-<p>But the loss of this high ground and the casualties sustained
-in it faded into insignificance beside the success achieved on<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_170" id="Page_170">[170]</a></span>
-Gold Coast Hill. In spite of our inferiority in numbers, we completely
-dominated the situation. Our patrols and stronger
-raiding parties worked right round the enemy’s rear and pushed
-on to his communications. Minor enterprises on his part produced
-no results. On the whole, the enemy suffered very considerable
-casualties at Kibata, and I think they should be estimated
-at not less than four hundred men. The operations
-intended by him were also completely wrecked. There can be
-no doubt that he waited to advance from Kilwa on Livale.
-Our vigorous action at Kibata forced him to move from Kilwa
-against us, and to leave the rest of the country and the whole
-of our supply and transport apparatus in peace. Towards
-the end of December hostile planes appeared, cruising about
-over our positions and dropping bombs. Although they now
-used far more powerful bombs than formerly, they hardly inflicted
-any casualties. On Christmas Day we saw a larger mass
-than usual falling on the Boma of Kibata. We were disappointed
-in our hope that the enemy was bombing his own
-camp; it was only a large quantity of cigarettes as a Christmas
-present for the troops.</p>
-
-<p>One day, during that period, I received a personal letter from
-the British Commander-in-Chief, General Smuts, in which he
-informed me that I had been awarded the Order Pour le Mérite,
-and expressed the hope that his cordial congratulations would
-not be unacceptable to me. I thanked him equally politely,
-although I at first believed that he was confusing it with the
-Second Class of the Order of the Crown with Swords, which I
-had received a short time before. I mention this letter from
-General Smuts as a proof of the mutual personal esteem and
-chivalry which existed throughout in spite of the exhausting
-warfare carried on by both sides. On many other occasions also
-the enemy intimated his great appreciation of the achievements of
-the German forces.</p>
-
-<p>At the end of 1916 I regarded the military situation in the
-Colony as remarkably favourable, for I knew that the South
-African troops were for the most part worn out with battle-casualties
-and sickness, while a large proportion of the remainder<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_171" id="Page_171">[171]</a></span>
-were returning to South Africa at the end of their engagements.
-Prisoners had repeatedly assured us that they had had enough
-of the “picnic” in East Africa. The Indian troops also, who had
-been in the field in East Africa for some length of time, were
-reduced in numbers, while the late arrivals&mdash;we identified
-Indian Pathan Regiments at Kibata&mdash;consisted largely of young
-soldiers. Other regiments, like the 129th Baluchis, who had
-fought in Flanders, were no doubt very good, but they might not
-be expected to stand the fatigues of African warfare for a very
-prolonged period. The enemy’s Askari were, generally speaking,
-new troops, and only a small proportion of them had at that
-time been in the field. So we could continue calmly to contemplate
-the continuation of the war for a considerable time. I
-still believe that we would have succeeded not only in holding
-our own, but even in beating the enemy, if he had not enjoyed
-the power of continually filling up his reduced units and of
-bringing up fresh ones. At the end of 1916 I did not know that
-this had already been effected on an extensive scale. Among
-other reinforcements a strong brigade of black troops had been
-brought from Nigeria to Dar-es-Salaam, whence it had been
-moved on without delay to Dutumi and Kissaki.</p>
-
-<p>In the early days of January, 1917, the five companies encamped
-there under Captain Otto were attacked by General Smuts
-with at least two brigades. In planning his attack the enemy had
-provided for simultaneous wide turning movements, which, with
-his greatly superior numbers, enabled him to bar the retreat of
-our troops towards Kungulio. More than once our Askari
-had to clear their way with the bayonet, and in the close country
-some of our companies got into very awkward situations. In
-withdrawing to Behobeho our field howitzer, having only a weak
-escort, was ambushed by a hostile force of several companies,
-and was lost, after the whole detachment had been killed. But
-in the end all portions of the detachment successfully avoided
-being surrounded, and in assembling at Behobeho. At this
-place very heavy fighting immediately took place, in which the
-enemy also fought with great bravery. It was in this action that
-the old hunter Selous was killed, who was well known even<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_172" id="Page_172">[172]</a></span>
-among Germans, on account of his charming manner and his
-exciting stories. He had joined as a subaltern. With a superior
-enemy before him and on both flanks, and behind him the
-mighty Rufiji, crossed only by the one frail bridge, Captain Otto
-yet succeeded in reaching the south bank of the river, with all
-his troops, and in destroying the bridge, in accordance with his
-instructions.</p>
-
-<p>We had also observed a wide turning movement which the
-enemy was making from Kissaki further west towards Mkalinzo
-on the Rufiji, which now became ineffective. The hostile
-brigade undertaking it did not reach the south bank of the Rufiji
-in time to oppose Captain Otto’s passage, and thus render his
-situation desperate; on the contrary, we gained partial successes
-which were quite considerable. The enemy following us from
-Behobeho came on very vigorously and passed a large part of his
-force over the Rufiji at Kungulio in boats. Captain Otto held
-his detachment in readiness a little to the south of the river, and
-now attacked the enemy, of whom part only had crossed over, and
-completely defeated him with heavy loss. This partial success
-was favoured by the inaction of the hostile column, which, as
-already mentioned, was making the turning movement by
-Mkalinzo. It consisted principally of whites, and a part of the
-black Nigerian troops. Neither of them were equal to the long
-march involved, and had therefore reached the Rufiji exhausted
-and unfit for further operations. They remained out of action
-for quite a long time, and the unity of General Smuts’ otherwise
-quite well-planned operation was wrecked.</p>
-
-<p>In consequence of the enemy’s advance in force at Kungulio,
-the danger arose that he might gain possession of the middle
-Rufiji, and of the country to the south of it. He might then
-easily seize the bulk of our stores, and our whole system of
-communications, which for the most part ran from the middle
-Rufiji towards Livale. It was therefore necessary for me to
-meet his movements with our main body, which was before
-Kibeta, and so I marched off with the greater part of it to Lake
-Utungi, where I would be in a position to help Captain Otto, or
-to seize any favourable opportunity that might offer.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_173" id="Page_173">[173]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER VIII<br />
-<span class="wn">ANXIETIES AND HARDSHIPS DURING OUR STAY IN THE RUFIJI
-COUNTRY</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap08">OUR march from Kibata was on the first day carried out
-according to plan. On the following day I rode ahead
-with a few companions, in the expectation that the troops who
-had several native guides with them would not fail to find the
-way. In the Kissi mountains we came upon large numbers
-of natives who, however, were very timid and often deserted
-their flourishing rice plantations on our approach. Later in
-the day I regretted that I did not appropriate some of this
-abundant produce for our own use. During the midday heat we
-rested at Pori. Some of my companions who knew the country
-called my attention to the acid Mbinji fruit, which we found very
-refreshing. Unfortunately we did not know at that time that
-the stone of this fruit, when roasted, makes an excellent dish,
-tasting like our hazel-nut. The heat was overpowering, but as
-we were in the neighbourhood of the enemy patrols we had to
-keep a sharp look-out. The springs and water-courses were
-now dried up; after a long search we at last found a small pool
-of dirty water, which, however, we were told was not injurious
-to health. Towards evening we reached the great deserted
-settlement. Here we were fortunate enough to find a negro in
-the employ of the German Government, who informed us that
-we were at Ungwara, our destination for that day. After we
-had walked through the place, the man showed us a pool near
-which we pitched our camp. My old black cook, the bearded
-Baba, well known to many East Africans, had very nearly kept
-up with our horses, and, following our trail, soon arrived. He
-had soon prepared his <i>uzeli</i> (boiled rice), and was sitting contentedly<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_174" id="Page_174">[174]</a></span>
-by the fire. We watched him enviously, for we had
-nothing, and were waiting for our baggage and the troops. But
-no one came and we lay down, hungry, to sleep. The friend
-in need, however, was approaching in the shape of a splendid
-sable-antelope, which in the brilliant moonlight was coming down
-to drink. Almost simultaneously the rifles of two of my companions,
-van Booyen and Nieuwenhuizen, experienced Boer
-hunters, who had become Germans, rang out. We sprang from
-our blankets as though we had received an electric shock, and
-within a short time the first pieces of delicate flesh were roasting
-on the spit.</p>
-
-<p>On the following day we reached Lake Utungi, where Captain
-Feilke was awaiting us, and we refreshed ourselves with bread,
-coffee and sausage made from antelope flesh. There was still
-no trace of the troops. They had lost us in Pori, and almost
-all completely lost their bearings. One detachment did not get
-into touch with us until several days later, when they came upon
-our telephone line in the neighbourhood of Utete. In view
-of the difficulty of communication, it had hitherto been impossible
-to get an accurate estimate of the state of our supplies.
-I had expected to find well-filled depots at Mpanganya on Lake
-Utungi and in the neighbourhood of Madaba. This was why
-I had pressed on out of the fertile country north of the lower
-Rufiji through Mpanganya to the line-of-communication area.
-The question of supplies had developed quite differently from
-my expectations.</p>
-
-<p>In the line-of-communication area, in addition to the large
-numbers of bearers necessary for the transport of war material
-to the south, a numerous <i>personnel</i> was maintained, who were
-employed on road-making, building grass huts and for other
-purposes. Even in the small depots there were always a number
-of men who, whenever possible, did nothing but fetch supplies,
-which they ate themselves. Often the supplies were even
-fetched by others who, in their turn, had to be fed. In many
-places it was almost the case that a load of supplies collected
-and forwarded by the fighting troops in the north finally landed
-in a small depot, and were devoured by these people who had<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_175" id="Page_175">[175]</a></span>
-nothing else to do. In view of the difficulties of transport, and
-the great distances, even the energy and thoroughness of Captain
-Stemmermann, who had taken charge of the depots, did not
-succeed in detecting and putting a stop to these abuses. Further,
-there were too many people in Africa whose propensity for
-diverting valuable energy to non-essentials to the prejudice of
-the really important things that it would take a very strong
-broom to sweep them away. The general result of all these
-obstacles was that thousands and thousands of useless mouths
-were devouring the supplies which had been collected with
-great effort in the region occupied by the fighting forces. The
-depot did nothing for the supplies, but, on the other hand, lived
-on them, and the most serious point was that the moment was
-at hand when the areas from which the supplies were drawn
-would have to be evacuated by the fighting forces. It was a
-difficult situation. It was necessary to lose no time in putting
-under cultivation the territory we were then occupying&mdash;that
-is to say, the country round Madaba and Livale, and in the
-southern parts of the Protectorate, which were likely to be the
-scene of the subsequent operations. But months must elapse
-before any results could be obtained from these measures.
-During these months we should have to remain on the Rufigi
-and live there. Here, it is true, some hundreds of acres of maize
-were standing, but even these would require months to ripen.
-Until this time came the force could not move south; it would
-have to remain in the unproductive area which it was then
-occupying.</p>
-
-<p>The accomplishment of this task was difficult. The order had
-at once to be given for the removal of every man who was not
-absolutely indispensable for carrying on the war during the
-next few months. This meant that thousands of bearers and
-workmen in the line-of-communication area were sent home.
-The most serious drawback to this step had to be reckoned with;
-we were sending over to the enemy thousands of men from
-whom he was bound to gain detailed information as to our
-strength, the condition of our supplies and our internal organization.
-Nor was it enough to cut down the <i>personnel</i> of our<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_176" id="Page_176">[176]</a></span>
-lines of communication. The non-combatant <i>personnel</i> of the
-companies was also reduced. Among other things, it was
-laid down that henceforward no European should have more
-than five native attendants. That sounds a generous allowance
-to European ears, but under African conditions native
-attendance is really indispensable to the European. He requires
-at least one man or boy to cook for him and attend to his personal
-needs, and, in addition, it must be remembered that all baggage,
-kit, rations, blankets and tent-material, has to be carried whenever
-he moves. When one considers that in peace-time a
-travelling official on a long <i>safari</i> (journey) took with him from
-eleven to thirteen bearers, in addition to two or three personal
-servants, it will be understood how drastic this new order was
-and what a storm of indignation it aroused. Fortunately I was
-in a position, when appealed to on grounds of health and
-decency, to point to the fact that I myself had for months
-managed with three, or at a pinch two, loads&mdash;that is, four
-negroes&mdash;and had kept in good health. I am still particularly
-grateful to those regimental officers who, as on so many other
-occasions, saw the necessity of this vexatious regulation and set
-the example. They upheld the tradition of our officer-corps
-by not claiming any special comforts for themselves, and were
-the first to submit to the unavoidable discomfort. I believe
-that among all the soldiers and non-combatants up to the highest
-civilian official, there is not one who still condemns this order,
-at first so strongly opposed.</p>
-
-<p>But reduction of the number of food-consumers alone was not
-sufficient to solve the problem of existence; the supplies would
-not go round. It was already obvious that the supplies from
-the area of the fighting force, which were, of course, being
-worked at high pressure, would not suffice to feed us until the
-new harvest at the end of March. After close and mature consideration,
-we found it impossible to avoid the necessity of
-cutting down the rations, a measure which went very much
-against the grain, as even the native, if he is to be relied on,
-must be well fed. This gave rise to a fresh and much stronger
-outburst of indignation. From all sides came telegrams and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_177" id="Page_177">[177]</a></span>
-messages to say that it was impossible to get the calories of
-nourishment necessary for a fighting man from the daily cereal
-ration, fixed at six hundred grammes of meal. But the hard fact
-had to be faced that only a certain quantity was available, and
-we must make the best of it. The reduction of the cereal ration
-could not be avoided. For the rest, each man and each company
-would have to try to make good the shortage by hunting, which
-in this region, where game abounded, could be managed with
-the exercise of a little agility. But logic is apt to go to pieces
-with many people when it comes to a question of daily food,
-and many did not scruple to lay the whole blame for the at times
-barely sufficient ration at the door of the wicked commander-in-chief,
-and even to do all they could to have the daily ration
-increased to its former amount. This I had to bear calmly,
-and I made my own observations as to who were the men to
-make the best of an unavoidable necessity and who were not.</p>
-
-<p>In carrying out these drastic measures new difficulties were
-encountered. A crowd of Askari women had followed the
-force, and had attached themselves to various camps on the
-Rufiji, where they were very comfortable. I was most anxious
-to send them south, where the question of supplies was less
-difficult. The necessary transport was arranged for, and the
-women were given rations for the march. After one short day’s
-march, however, the women simply lay down, and declared
-that they could go no further. Their rations, which were
-intended to last a considerable time, were all eaten by the third
-day, and they were crying out for more. Some even went so
-far as to attack and beat the European who was in charge of
-the transport. Even under a dark skin the gentler sex did
-not always scruple to make full use of their prerogatives, which
-are usually justified.</p>
-
-<p>Finally we got over this difficulty, and a tolerable solution
-was found to the ration problem. The Askari, to whom the
-position was explained, saw the difficulty and were very reasonable.
-Skilled hunters were sent to the different hunting-grounds,
-and the empty stomachs from time to time more generously
-filled. I remember that with us on Lake Utungi our two<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_178" id="Page_178">[178]</a></span>
-hundred blacks in one day completely devoured a big buffalo and
-an elephant. It was often found possible to give a piece of
-antelope to the passing caravans of bearers.</p>
-
-<p>In the course of February the stores in our supply dumps,
-of which I took stock every day, ran out. I began to fear
-that for reasons of supply we would not be able to wait for the
-ripening of the corn on the Rufiji. In that case, not only
-would the harvest be lost, but the crops growing further south
-could not be used to the best advantage. There we should have
-to use the grain that was actually ripe and pass on, leaving the
-unripe portion standing. A lucky chance came to my aid in this
-dilemma. I went one day from Lake Utungi to Mpanganya to
-see Captain Tafel, who was handling the tactical and commissariat
-problems there with admirable efficiency. I spent the
-night in his camp, and he set before me an excellent dish of
-young maize prepared like asparagus. This led us to speak of
-the maize fields of Mpanganya and the neighbourhood. These
-were full of women and other natives who had swarmed over
-them like a flock of birds, and were living on the young, unripe
-corn. This was as bad economy as well could be, but it gave
-me the idea that in case of need the maize crops could be largely
-used before they were ripe. This need very soon occurred, and
-an experiment with the ears which had ripened most showed that
-these could be artificially dried and a very good meal made from
-them. After this, the ripest ears were gathered daily, and as
-the whole crop ripened the food situation improved from day to
-day. By 1st March it was found possible to increase the ration
-to seven hundred grammes, or nearly the normal allowance.</p>
-
-<p>The increasing severity of the whole campaign called for a
-more intensive and energetic exploitation of our food resources;
-the slow, deliberate supply methods of the civil authorities, which
-had sufficed for the first phase of the campaign, were no longer
-adequate. Twice, at Kissaki and on the Rufiji I had been put
-in a most difficult position with regard to supplies, which had
-almost made it impossible to carry on the operations. A more
-efficient supply service which would know the military needs,
-look ahead and work more quickly and energetically was a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_179" id="Page_179">[179]</a></span>
-vital necessity for the further carrying on of the campaign.
-Fortunately I was able to convince the Governor on this point,
-and, as a result, a new supply detachment was raised from the
-force, and sent ahead to Massassi, via Livale. They established
-several subsidiary detachments, which were attached to the
-administrative stations in the Lindi area, and in this way worked
-side by side with the civil authorities in organizing, and, later,
-in carrying out, the cultivation and storing of food. In this
-way the desired impregnation of the supplies and transport
-service with the necessary military spirit was completely
-attained.</p>
-
-<p>At this time there was no appreciable shortage of kit, and
-there was also an adequate supply of arms and ammunition.</p>
-
-<p>With a view to the envelopment of the enemy at Mkalinzo,
-where he was reported to be in strong force, Captain Otto had
-marched his detachment south from Kungulio. North of Mawa
-he covered the fertile area of Madaba, and the line of transport
-and telephone communication running from Lake Utungi, via
-Mawa to Madaba. On 24th January, 1917, Captain Otto was
-attacked north of Mawa by several battalions of the Nigerian
-brigade. The enemy was beaten off with heavy losses and
-pursued several miles through the bush to an entrenched position,
-where he took refuge. The troops under Captain Schulz, who
-had been left behind after our departure from Kibeta, were gradually
-withdrawn to Ungwara. They had been reinforced and
-relieved from time to time after the fighting in the region of the
-Kibeta-Utete-Kissi mountains. Strong enemy forces&mdash;identified
-as an infantry brigade&mdash;had followed them. In spite of
-his numerical superiority, the single engagements were very
-costly, and for the most part unfavourable for the enemy.
-Captains von Lieberman, Goering and Koehl, and numerous
-patrol leaders on many occasions completely routed more than
-twice their number of Indian or negro troops, and captured
-rifles, machine guns and ammunition. The long war had produced
-a large number of capable leaders, and their example,
-as in the case of Lieutenant Kroeger, who was afterwards killed,
-roused unbounded enterprise and daring. Over and over again,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_180" id="Page_180">[180]</a></span>
-and without stopping to ask the strength of the opposing force,
-this officer, followed by a handful of men with fixed bayonets
-and cheering loudly, had charged the enemy in the thick of the
-bush. He had even trained the Askari. Several of these distinguished
-themselves as patrol leaders, and when later the brave
-Effendi, of the 4th Field Company, with his patrol, routed an
-entire Indian company, we owed the success to this training
-at Ungwara.</p>
-
-<p>Our line of communication to the south, passing through
-Madeba and Livale, was in danger from a strong enemy force
-west of Kibata, and it was necessary that we should afford it
-adequate protection. This meant a gradual move south of our
-forces from the Rufiji, especially as our supplies on this part of
-the river were coming to an end and the rainy season was at
-hand.</p>
-
-<p>It was particularly important that we should not evacuate
-this part of the Rufiji until the rains had set in. This would
-mean a considerable gain in time for us, as, during the actual
-rainy season and immediately after, the operations would, of
-necessity, come to a standstill, and the corn, particularly the
-<i>mtema</i> (millet), would have time to ripen.</p>
-
-<p>When the migrations of the ants warned us that the rains
-were at hand, orders were given, as a precautionary measure,
-that the women, children and non-combatants should as far as
-possible be transferred to the north bank of the Rufiji, and
-thence transported to Dar-es-Salaam. This step, which the
-approaching rains and the state of the supplies made necessary,
-aroused much discontent, which I was obliged to treat with the
-same indifference as the previous outbursts of indignation. I
-am, however, still of the opinion that the timely removal of these
-people was much better for them than spending part of the
-rainy season on the drenched ground or in flooded dwellings
-with insufficient food.</p>
-
-<p>The rains, which set in at the end of March, were particularly
-heavy in 1917. The site of our camp, which was slightly elevated,
-became an island, from which access to the outer world was only
-possible by boat through the Rufiji wood. A number of people<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_181" id="Page_181">[181]</a></span>
-were drowned in the wood during the rains; others had to take
-refuge for days in the trees. The water rose so high that in
-Mpanganya it reached the high-lying dwellings of the Europeans,
-and invaded the hospitals and disturbed every kind of filth. It
-was impossible for women and children, sick and wounded to
-remain, and after the withdrawal of the troops they had to give
-themselves up to the English, who took pity on their need,
-and provided them with food and transport.</p>
-
-<p>The majority of the troops marched south out of the flooded
-districts on the Rufiji and Lake Utungi in good time, after using
-up the available crops almost to the last grain. The evacuation
-was carried out gradually and in echelon; the greater part of the
-troops were assembled in Mpotora, which was occupied by
-Captain Rothe, in a fortified camp, with his two companies which
-had defeated the Portuguese at Nevala. Only a few small
-detachments were left on the Rufiji, and these were gradually
-reduced to the strength of patrols. Four days’ march east of
-Madaba the detachments of Koehl and Goering had the opportunity
-of some successful skirmishes against enemy detachments
-on the western edge of the Matumbi Mountains. Gradually,
-however, all these detachments were brought to Mpotora,
-and only Captain Otto remained in the higher regions of Madaba.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_182" id="Page_182">[182]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER IX<br />
-<span class="wn">THE END OF THE FRONTIER DEFENCE IN THE SUBSIDIARY
-THEATRES</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">IN August, 1916, Major Kraut had gradually retired from
-Kilossa on Mahenge, leaving only Schoenfeld’s division at
-Kidodi, on the Ruaha. Captain Braunschweig’s force was
-embodied in Major Kraut’s command. Of these Captain Falkenstein,
-with the 5th Field Company, had retired, at the end of
-May, 1916, from Ipyana, and Captain Aumann, with his company,
-from the Mbozi region in the direction of Lupembe and Maubire.
-During the retirement there was continual skirmishing. Our
-weak divisions had to make a stand against the pursuing enemy,
-at least a brigade strong.</p>
-
-<p>At the end of June, 1916, Captain Braunschweig, who was
-then at Dodoma, was sent through Iringa, and his force was
-strengthened to five companies by the addition of the Kondoa
-troops and others brought from Dar-es-Salaam, including the
-two companies from Langenburg. One hundred of the crew of
-the <i>Königsberg</i> from Dar-es-Salaam and a field howitzer were
-added to this force. At Malangali he accepted battle with the
-enemy, and apparently inflicted heavy losses. Then, however,
-he evacuated the position, and abandoned the howitzer, which
-was difficult to move, first making it useless. The difficulties
-of Braunschweig’s position were increased by the action of an
-important Wahehe chief in his rear, who rebelled and went over
-to the enemy with all his people and cattle. Captain Braunschweig
-then retired on Mahenge, fighting a succession of minor
-rearguard skirmishes, and put himself under the orders of Major
-Kraut.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_183" id="Page_183">[183]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-183.jpg" width="400" height="576" id="m183"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pc">Fig. xv. March of Major-General Wahle in the West</p>
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_184" id="Page_184">[184]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>After numerous minor engagements Major Kraut’s retiring
-divisions established themselves on the line of the Ruhudje
-and Ruaha rivers. In the fertile region round Mahenge the
-supplies were excellent, even after the evacuation of a large
-part of the rice-field west of the Ruhudje. On this river the
-enemy had established a strongly fortified camp at Mkapira.
-With our insufficient resources it was impossible to take this
-position by force, but there was a chance that by cutting the
-enemy’s line of communication with Lupembe, we might force
-him to evacuate the camp owing to shortage of food.</p>
-
-<p>Major Kraut crossed the river with five companies and a
-light field gun, and occupied a position in a semi-circle of hills
-in the enemy’s rear and right across his line of communication.
-In the enemy’s front weak forces covered the river bank on the
-Mahenge side. Unfortunately the fortified positions of our
-companies were so extended that, owing to the difficulties of
-the country, there was no guarantee that support could be brought
-up in time. On the&mdash;&mdash;, before daybreak, the 10th Company
-on the right wing was surprised by a heavy enemy attack. The
-enemy also cleverly took the company’s position in the rear
-and, after inflicting heavy losses, put the machine guns out of
-action. On the left wing Lieutenant von Schroetter’s company
-was also attacked from all sides, and had to cut its way out with
-the bayonet, losing the light field gun and a machine gun. In
-view of the heavy casualties of the enemy, Major Kraut would
-have been able to remain on the west bank of the Ruhudje, in
-spite of this partial disaster, but fighting could be heard from
-the direction of Lupembe, where the 25th Field Company was
-covering his rear. Major Kraut thought, wrongly, that there,
-too, a sharp attack had been made, and, therefore, retired again
-to the east bank of the Ruhudje. To his astonishment the
-enemy’s strong entrenchments at Mkapira were found to be
-evacuated a few days later, the enemy having withdrawn in
-the night. Closer inspection showed that he had suffered
-heavy losses in the recent fighting. This, however, was not
-enough to explain his withdrawal; this riddle was not solved
-until later, on the appearance of General Wahle, with whom
-no communication had been established.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_185" id="Page_185">[185]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>In expectation of the opening of the big operations of 1916
-the reinforcements that had been provisionally sent to Victoria
-Nyanza, Ruanda, the Russissi and the Tanganyika area were
-brought back and embodied into our main forces along the North
-railway. A single command for these minor theatres of war was
-required, and with this object a “western command” was established
-under Major-General Wahle, who for the most part
-co-ordinated and directed these operations from Tabora. In
-April and May, 1916, when the British main forces in the Kilima
-Njaro area had completed their march, and, after the rainy
-season, were beginning a fresh advance to the south, English
-and Belgians from Muansa, Lake Kiwu, the Russissi and Bismarckburg
-began to advance concentrically on Tabora through
-these minor theatres of war. Our weak divisions retired on
-this place.</p>
-
-<p>Major von Langenn retired at once from Tschangugu to Issawi,
-followed by Captain Wintgens from Kissenji. Heavy casualties
-were inflicted on the pursuing Belgian brigades in successful
-rearguard actions. The German detachment later continued its
-retirement on Mariahilf. The danger to our district from the
-strong Belgian forces on our heels had been correctly estimated
-by Captain Gudovius. When in June, 1916, strong English
-forces advanced across the Kagera, he retired south from Bukoba
-with his division. Owing to the difficulties of communication
-and getting information, a part of his force unfortunately ran
-upon strong Belgian forces in Ussuwi district. Captain Gudovius
-himself was wounded in the abdomen and fell into the enemy’s
-hands. The engagement went badly for us and cost us heavy
-losses. Individual bodies of the detachment, however, managed
-to fight their way through to Muansa and Uschirombo.</p>
-
-<p>In the middle of July, 1916, the English succeeded in effecting
-a surprise landing with about a brigade in the neighbourhood of
-Muansa. There, too, there was some skirmishing, favourable
-to us, and there the Commanding Officer, Captain von Chappuis,
-retired in the direction of Tabora. The troops from Muansa
-and those under Major von Langenn and Captain Wintgens
-established a new front, approximately on the line Schinjanga-St. Michael,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_186" id="Page_186">[186]</a></span>
-and repulsed several Belgian attacks. Captain
-Zimmer had sunk the steamer <i>Goetzen</i> at Kigoma and blown up
-the Wami. He then retired slowly along the railway to Tabora.
-Captain Hering von Usumbura followed suit. The fact that
-the operations were nearing Tabora gave General Wahle the
-opportunity to bring up quickly part of the troops from the
-north of Tabora, to make a dash west by rail and retire again
-at once. In this raid the 8th Field Company completely routed
-a Belgian battalion west of Tabora, and Wintgens’ detachment
-brought off a successful surprise attack west and north of Tabora.
-These minor victories were often considerable, and on several
-different days of skirmishing the enemy losses amounted to
-hundreds; several light howitzers were also captured in these
-raids.</p>
-
-<p>On 2nd June, 1916, the 29th Field Company was surrounded
-in its fortified position in the Namema mountains. In fighting
-his way through, the brave company commander, Lieutenant
-Franken, was severely wounded and taken prisoner. Lieutenant
-Hasslacher retired step by step on Tabora. In an affair of
-patrols south of this place he met with a hero’s death.</p>
-
-<p>In this way the troops of the western command were actually
-assembled at Tabora, and the moment had come for a systematic
-retirement to the south-east. These last operations and the
-capture of Tabora were not known at Headquarters until long
-afterwards. There was no means of communication with the
-western command. Major-General Wahle was aware that
-this retirement of our main forces was of first importance for the
-Mahenge area. Accordingly he gave orders for the march. At
-first the railway could be used for supplies and transport.
-The eastern column, under Major von Langenn, marched on
-Iringa, the centre column, under Captain Wintgens, on Madibira,
-and the western column, under Lieutenant Huebener, on
-Ilembule. Major Wahle accompanied the centre column. In
-this way they came upon the line of communication between
-Neu-Langenburg and Iringa, and the enemy’s dumps along
-this line. Huebener’s detachment lost touch, and surrendered,
-being enveloped by a superior force of the enemy at Ilembule.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_187" id="Page_187">[187]</a></span>
-Langenn’s detachment was most unfortunately surprised by a
-burst of fire while crossing a ford near Iringa and lost heavily.
-The subsequent attack on Iringa was also costly and without
-success.</p>
-
-<p>Wintgens’ detachment surprised enemy dumps and columns
-near Madibira, and also captured a gun and some wireless
-apparatus. In spite of several days of stubborn fighting, they
-were unable to take Lupembe and the surrounding farms. The
-influence of Wahle’s advance immediately made itself felt
-in the Mahenge district. The apparently strong enemy troops,
-who from their fortified positions at Mkapira had carried out
-the successful raid against Major Kraut, now felt themselves
-seriously threatened in their rear. They evacuated their strong
-positions and retired on Lupembe. General Wahle took over
-the command of all the forces at Mahenge.</p>
-
-<p>At the end of 1916 the troops of General Wahle’s western command
-were grouped round Mahenge. From here he directed
-the operations extending approximately to the line Ssongea&mdash;Lupembe&mdash;Iringa&mdash;Kidodi.</p>
-
-<p>It has been said that all touch with General Wahle had been
-lost since July, 1916, until in October, 1916, his patrols joined
-up with those of Major Kraut south of Iringa.</p>
-
-<p>It was not, therefore, until after the fighting at Mkapira
-that Major Kraut, and through him Headquarters, learned of
-General Wahle’s advance; the development of the situation
-made a very different impression on the enemy. He must have
-regarded the advance of General Wahle’s columns against the
-English line of communication from Iringa to Langenburg,
-and Major Kraut’s accidentally simultaneous threat to Mkapira,
-as a widely-planned joint operation, which was seriously endangering
-his troops at Mkapira, even after Major Kraut had withdrawn
-to the east bank of the Ruhudje. He avoided this danger
-by a hasty retirement from Mkapira in a westerly direction.</p>
-
-<p>General Wahle’s columns at once concentrated in the Lupembe-Mkapira
-area. No news was received of Huebener’s western
-column. Its capitulation was not known until much later.</p>
-
-<p>Welcome though this reinforcement of the forces in the west<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_188" id="Page_188">[188]</a></span>
-was, there were difficulties of supplies, and it became necessary
-to put under cultivation a considerable area, stretching almost to
-Ssongea. Major Grawert’s detachment advanced to Likuju
-on the Ssongea&mdash;Liwale road, that of Major Kraut to the Mpepo
-region and Captain Wintgens’ surrounded an enemy detachment
-in a fortified camp at Kitenda. The enemy quickly
-marched to the relief of this force, but the relieving troops
-were driven off with heavy losses. At the same time the position
-of Grawert’s detachment took a very unfavourable turn. The
-enemy had succeeded in driving off this force’s live-stock.
-As other supplies in the district were scanty, Major von Grawert,
-exaggerating the difficulties of supply, thought his position hopeless
-and surrendered in January, 1917. A transportable 8.8
-air naval gun which had been brought to Lihuju with great
-difficulty fell into the enemy’s hands, as well as a number of good
-machine guns. In reality the position of Grawert’s force does
-not appear to have been so desperate as he supposed; at any rate,
-a strong patrol under Sergeant-Major Winzer, who refused to
-surrender, made its way south without being molested by the
-enemy, and, a few days later, found abundant supplies at small
-cost in the districts west of Tunduru. The conduct of this patrol
-gave further proof that there is almost always a way out, even of
-an apparently hopeless position, if the leader makes up his mind
-to face the risks.</p>
-
-<p>Meanwhile General Wahle’s supply difficulties were increasing.
-Whether they could have been modified by ruthlessly reducing
-the number of non-combatants, as had been done on the Rufiji,
-or whether the material welfare of the western command could
-have been substantially improved by greater care in procuring
-and rationing the available resources, could not be decided from
-my position on Lake Utungi. The temporary telegraph to
-Mahenge was very inefficient and often interrupted, and it took
-several days to get a despatch through from General Wahle in
-Mahenge to the troops. This made it difficult for me to get a
-view of the situation from the incomplete information at hand.
-Suffice it to say that the difficulties of supply in Mahenge were
-regarded as so acute that it was not considered possible to keep<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_189" id="Page_189">[189]</a></span>
-such strong forces concentrated there, and part of them would
-have to be withdrawn.</p>
-
-<p>Kraut’s and Wintgens’ forces were marched west to Gumbiro,
-whence they were to press on across the Ssongea-Wiedhafen
-road. It was thought that they would find adequate supplies
-in the mountains south of Ssongea. The report of this move
-reached me too late for me to interfere. From Gumbiro Captain
-Wintgens turned north and, near Lake Rukwa, successfully engaged
-an enemy column which had been following him; on
-nearing Tabora he got typhus and was taken prisoner. Captain
-Naumann led the force on until finally he surrendered to the
-pursuing enemy column near Kilima-Njaro towards the end of
-1917. It is to be regretted that this operation, carried out with
-so much initiative and determination, became separated so far
-from the main theatre of war as to be of little use.</p>
-
-<p>Major Kraut had separated from Captain Wintgens in Gumbiro,
-and, carrying out General Wahle’s orders, had marched south.
-There was no difficulty about crossing the line of communication
-Ssongea-Wiedhafen, but as the enemy had strongly entrenched
-and secured his supply dumps, no booty was captured. In the
-open little was to be found in March, 1917, the poorest season of
-the year, a few months before the new harvest. After some
-rearguard actions against English troops a success was scored in
-a surprise attack on the small Portuguese camp at Mitomoul,
-on the Rovuma. Major Kraut then followed the river downstream
-to Tunduru and himself came to Headquarters to report.
-Two of his companies remained at Tunduru to guard the fertile
-district. The other three marched further east and were temporarily
-taken over by Captain Loof at Lindi.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_190" id="Page_190">[190]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER X<br />
-<span class="wn">LINDI AND KILWA</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">THE operations of the last few months had narrowed the
-area from which supplies for the troops could be obtained.
-The productive areas of Lupembe, Iringa, Kissaki and the lower
-Rufiji had been lost, and the newly-occupied districts included
-wide stretches of barren land. The productivity of the more
-fertile areas was for the most part unknown; for instance, it
-was not known until during the subsequent operations what
-yield could be expected south-west of Kilwa and south-west of
-Livale, for example. At that time I only had a general idea
-that the eastern part of the Lindi area was very fertile and known
-as the granary of the colony. But this fertile region, owing to
-its nearness to the coast, was in a very precarious position, and
-it was already necessary to consider what should be done if it
-were lost.</p>
-
-<p>Our eyes naturally turned to the Portuguese territory across
-the Rovuma, but we had even less information about this than
-about parts of the German colony. Fortunately, however, a
-number of Portuguese chiefs had immigrated into German
-territory out of hatred for their oppressors, and, apart from this,
-we Germans enjoyed a very good reputation among the intelligent
-natives of Portuguese East Africa, many of whom worked
-on German plantations. Thus we were able to get at least an
-approximate picture of the district east of Lake Nyassa, and to
-take it as probable that south of the steppe-like zone of the
-Rovuma, in the neighbourhood of Mwembe, several days’ march,
-broad and thinly populated, lay a fertile region. An expeditionary
-force of a few hundred rifles under Major von Stuemer,
-crossed the Rovuma south of Tundura, and quickly took possession<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_191" id="Page_191">[191]</a></span>
-of Mwembe from where our patrols explored the banks of
-Lake Nyassa as far as the neighbourhood of Fort Jackson, and
-east half-way to Port Amelia.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-191.jpg" width="400" height="503" id="m191"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pc400">Fig. xvi. March of Main Force during operations on interior lines west of Lindi,
-June to November, 1917. Fig. xvii. Battle of Mahiwa.</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>In view of the difficulty of communication&mdash;messengers from
-the telegraph station at Livale took about three days to get to
-Tunduru and five from there to Mwembe&mdash;it was difficult to get<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_192" id="Page_192">[192]</a></span>
-a clear idea of the situation at Mwembe. We had no definite
-news until Lieutenant Brucher personally reported at Headquarters
-in January, 1917. The European potatoes he brought
-with him gave us good hopes that supplies could be expected
-there. He reported that the country was fertile, as was also the
-region round Tunduru, where the war had so far hardly been felt.
-There were still large numbers of eggs and fowls in the richly cultivated
-district. When Brucher slept on the ground in Tunduru,
-this was regarded as a piece of bravado by the inhabitants, so
-little did they know about war. In view of the difficulties of
-transport and the constant movement of the troops, it became
-increasingly necessary to make the force less and less dependent
-on their inadequate line of communication. With this object
-the forces of Captains Goering and von Lieberman were also
-moved to the region south of Kilwa, where, according to the
-stories of some Europeans in the Kiturika mountains, there was
-plenty of food. In order to relieve the transport of supplies
-from the rear the troops were marched off to Kilwa without
-waiting for further investigation, and it was fortunate that the
-reports as to the fertility of this district were realized. In order
-to take the enemy, who had already moved some small forces
-half-way to Livale, as far as possible from south of his point of
-debarkation, and at the same time to secure the fertile districts
-south of Kilwa to Mbemkuru, Goering’s and von Lieberman’s
-divisions made a détour from Mpotora southwards and pressed
-forward, Goering’s force following the coast straight to Kilwa,
-and von Lieberman keeping further west and making for the
-Kilwa-Livale road. A weaker force followed this road to Kilwa
-and served as a reserve for the patrols, which several times
-surprised the enemy in his camps and threw him back. Our
-patrols were soon swarming in the neighbourhood of Kilwa.
-Several enemy dumps were surprised and part of the garrisons
-killed. On one of these occasions brave Sergeant-Major Struwe,
-who was afterwards killed, skilfully forced his way, with a large
-part of the 3rd Field Company, inside a dump, and, taking
-cover behind the sacks of flour, inflicted heavy losses on the
-enemy, who appeared from outside in great force. It was
-difficult to get much away from the dump, so the patrol had
-to content itself with destroying the greater part of the stores.
-One patrol took a field gun with it&mdash;a strange weapon for a
-patrol. After careful reconnaissance this reached the coast
-at Kilwa&mdash;Kissiwami, and bombarded some of the transports
-lying there.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-192.jpg" width="400" height="633" id="i192"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc400">Native Types (1).<br />
-<span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-193.jpg" width="400" height="541" id="i193"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc400">Native Types (2).<br />
-<span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_193" id="Page_193">[193]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>In May, 1917, Captain von Lieberman, who, with the 11th and
-17th Companies, was occupying an entrenched position at
-Ngaula, a day’s march south of Kilwa on the Kilwa-Livale
-road, was attacked by eight companies with two guns. Lieutenant
-Buechsel, with his 17th Company, made such a heavy
-flank attack that he completely routed, one after the other,
-several of the enemy’s Askari companies, who took to their
-heels, followed by the 40th Indian Pathan Regiment. The enemy
-left about seventy dead on the field, and, as the English related
-afterwards, it was only by chance that we did not find his guns,
-which had stuck fast in a river.</p>
-
-<p>On the whole it seemed to us that the enemy’s forces were
-once more getting exhausted. Unless he brought over very considerable
-reinforcements it was obvious that the forces available
-would before long be worn out and his operations end in failure.
-It was already apparent that they were involving a great strain.
-It had been ascertained that a battery from the Indian interior
-had been brought to Kilwa and that a large number of new
-Askari companies were being raised.</p>
-
-<p>More dangerous than the enemy seemed to me the material
-position of our men. The cargo of wheat from the relief ship
-was coming to an end, and I thought it questionable whether
-bread could be baked from Mtama flour alone, without the addition
-of wheat flour. At that time I still regarded bread as an
-indispensable necessity for the nourishment of Europeans, and
-therefore I made experiments personally in baking bread without
-wheat flour. Unfortunately the results were unsatisfactory.
-Afterwards, under the stress of necessity, we all produced excellent
-bread without wheat. The methods differed widely. Later
-we made bread not only with mtama, but also with muhogo,
-sweet potatoes, maize, in short, with nearly every kind of meal,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_194" id="Page_194">[194]</a></span>
-and with mixtures of all sorts of combinations, and later still
-improved the quality by the addition of boiled rice.</p>
-
-<p>The necessary kit also required attention. A shortage of boots
-was in sight. My experiments showed me that a European can
-go barefoot where there are tolerable paths, but never through the
-bush. Sandals, which anyone can make, given an odd bit of
-leather, proved helpful, but did not take the place of boots. To
-be ready for any emergency, I had some lessons in boot-making,
-and succeeded, with supervision, in producing an object that
-at a push could be taken for a left boot, though it was intended to
-be a right. It is very convenient for a European who knows the
-simplest rudiments of this craft to be able to kill an antelope and
-make a boot, or at any rate repair one, from his skin a few days
-later, without the help of any of the tools of civilization. A
-nail must serve as an awl, a tent-pole as a last, and the thread he
-can cut from the tough leather of a small antelope. As a matter of
-fact, however, we were never driven to these extremities, as we
-were always able to obtain the necessary kit and equipment
-from captured stores, and many captured saddles were cut up to
-make soles and heels for boots.</p>
-
-<p>Every European was becoming more and more like a South-African
-“Trekker” and was his own workman. Naturally,
-not always in person, but within the small independent household,
-consisting of his black cook and his black servant, which followed
-him about. Many had even provided themselves with a few hens
-which they took about with them, and the noise of these betrayed
-the position of German camps even as far as the native settlements.
-An order issued in one force that the crowing of
-cocks before 9 a.m. was forbidden brought no relief.</p>
-
-<p>The important question of salt was very simply solved by the
-troops at Kilwa, by the evaporation of sea-water. In order
-to secure the supply, which was beginning to run short, against
-the loss of the coast, salt-yielding plants were collected and the
-salt obtained from their ashes by lixiviation. We got this idea
-from the natives of the district, who supplied themselves with salt
-in this way. The salt thus obtained was not bad, but was never
-required to any extent, as we were always able to meet our requirements<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_195" id="Page_195">[195]</a></span>
-from the captured stores. The large numbers of
-elephants in this district furnished us with fat; sugar was replaced
-by the excellent wild honey which was found in large
-quantities. The troops had made an important step forward
-as regards supplies of grain. They found out how to ripen it
-artificially, and in this way provided against want.</p>
-
-<p>It should be noted here particularly that the Medical Corps,
-in spite of the difficult and constantly changing circumstances of
-life in the field, had succeeded in satisfactorily solving the important
-questions of quinine and material for bandages. It has
-already been mentioned that in the north quinine tablets of better
-quality than the English had been added to the stock of Peruvian
-bark. After the evacuation of the northern area a large consignment
-of Peruvian bark had been sent to Kilossa. Through the
-efforts of the Deputy Staff Medical Officer, Staff-Surgeon Teute,
-a part of this was transported further south. It was of course
-impossible without the necessary apparatus to manufacture
-tablets, but liquid quinine was produced by boiling Peruvian
-bark. This had an infernal taste and was drunk unwillingly
-but with beneficial results by the patients, among whom it was
-known as “Lettow-Schnaps.”</p>
-
-<p>The other difficulty was the supply of bandages. To supplement
-the stock of linen, which was beginning to give out, not
-only was clothing of all kinds disinfected and used for this purpose,
-and then after being boiled used again, but quite a good
-bandage-material was made from bark. This idea, too, we got
-from the methods of the natives, who for a long time had made
-clothing and sacks from Myombo bark. The medical service had
-done everything humanly possible to keep the troops alive and
-well. The great resource of this service and the necessary husbanding
-of the primitive material available deserve special
-recognition, as this service had always been accustomed under the
-special conditions of a tropical climate, and rightly so, to be very
-free with their stocks. The Staff Medical Officer, Staff-Surgeon
-Stolowsky, and later his successor, Staff-Surgeon Teute, showed
-exemplary devotion, energy and foresight.</p>
-
-<p>The surgery was on an equally high level. The hospitals<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_196" id="Page_196">[196]</a></span>
-which, during the early part of the campaign, had been accommodated
-for the most part in solid buildings, and had worked the
-whole year round without moving their quarters, had now to
-turn themselves into movable columns, which might at any
-moment be called upon to pack up, with patients and baggage,
-and keep up with the march in various directions of the troops.
-All not absolutely indispensable material had to be eliminated,
-so that the preparations for a surgical operation had always to be
-more or less improvised. The operating-theatre was as a rule a
-newly-erected grass hut. In spite of all this, Staff-Surgeon
-Müller, Dr. Thierfelder, of the Imperial Medical Service, and others
-successfully performed even serious operations, including several
-for appendicitis.</p>
-
-<p>As has already been mentioned, the confidence even of the
-enemy in the German medical service was fully justified. The
-successful and devoted activity of these men went far to strengthen
-the mutual confidence between white and black. In such ways
-as this the strong bond was formed which united the different
-elements of our force.</p>
-
-<p>At Lindi the enemy had strengthened himself more and more,
-and it was reported that detachments were being transported by
-sea to Lindi, which hitherto had been posted west of Kilwa.
-General O’Grady, who had commanded a brigade at Kibata,
-also appeared at Lindi. The obvious idea that the enemy would
-advance from Lindi against our weak forces and our main supply
-area, as had been his intention earlier at Kilwa, appeared to be
-materializing. Several attacks had been beaten off by Captain
-Looff’s force west of Lindi. At the request of the Governor three
-of the companies which had arrived under Major Kraut were not,
-as had been the original intention, used to subjugate quickly and
-thoroughly the rebellious inhabitants of Makonde, in the south-east
-corner of our Protectorate, but were put under the command
-of Captain Looff. Two of them took part in an attack on Sudi,
-south of Lindi, where the enemy was strongly entrenched. The
-attack on the fortified position was bravely launched, but suffered
-heavy losses, and could not be brought to a successful conclusion.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_197" id="Page_197">[197]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Later, Captain Rothe was ordered to Lindi with reinforcements
-consisting of three companies from Mpotora. But the rains
-spoiled our plans. The crossing of the Matendu had already
-become difficult. All the rain that had fallen in Donde district
-collected ultimately in the valley of the Matendu, which in the
-dry season is simply a series of pools. It had become a strong,
-rushing torrent, like the Fulda in spate at Cassel, and tore up
-great trees in its course. By making use of some islands, tree-trunks
-were got into position under the direction of skilled
-engineers and a bridge to take transport was built; but a sudden
-rise in the stream repeatedly swept it away, several men being
-drowned. A footbridge further downstream met with the same
-fate; a narrow suspension-bridge of ropes made from twisted
-bark was only of slight service and was somewhat uncertain
-as, in view of the alternation of strong sunlight and wet, there
-was always a danger of the ropes rotting and giving way.</p>
-
-<p>At Nahungu, on the Mbemkuru, similar conditions hindered
-Captain Rothe’s march. The stream was so strong that the
-first attempt to cross by the few ferry-boats available failed.
-Driven out of Nahungu by scarcity of supplies, Captain Rothe
-marched into the fertile region to the north-east, in this way
-seriously compromising the plans of Headquarters. It was
-necessary that this fertile country north-east of Nahungu should
-be spared to serve as a reserve for the forces south of Kilwa and
-to provide for a strong reinforcement of these troops should
-tactical reasons make this necessary. The time that was lost
-before a message could be got through to Captain Rothe was
-very vexatious, but finally his division was diverted towards
-Lindi again in time to take part in some of the fighting.</p>
-
-<p>In view of the need for reinforcement of our troops at Lindi
-owing to increased tension of the military situation and the projected
-transference of fresh troops to that area, General Wahle
-had been withdrawn from Mahenge and had taken over the
-command of the Lindi front; Captain Tafel succeeded him at
-Mahenge. In the middle of June, 1917, General Wahle had, after
-several engagements which had brought to light a considerable
-increase in the enemy’s strength, retired so far up the Lukuledi<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_198" id="Page_198">[198]</a></span>
-river that the enemy seemed to be incautiously exposing his
-north flank.</p>
-
-<p>I decided to make use of this advantage without, indeed,
-knowing exactly how it was to be done. So much was clear:
-that only a surprise attack promised success. I therefore
-advanced, with four companies and the mountain-battery consisting
-of two guns, through Nahungu, along the main road
-leading via Lutende to Lindi. At Lutende were encamped
-Captain von Chappuis’ company and Lieutenant Wunder’s company,
-and the rest were further back. I went on ahead to
-reconnoitre, with my able companion Nieuwenhuizen, who had
-played the chief part in the horse-drive on Erok mountain. From
-the height on which Chappuis’ company lay, there was an extensive
-view: one could see the different farmhouses round Lindi
-and the Lukuledi river with the steamer <i>President</i>, which had
-taken refuge there and been rendered useless. It was, perhaps,
-fortunate that no wild pigs or bush deer had come within range
-of our guns in this otherwise gameless district, for not far from
-Chappuis’ camp we crossed the trail of a strong enemy patrol
-which must only just have passed. The talk of the natives, too,
-led us to suppose that they had recently seen something interesting.
-When we questioned them they would tell us nothing. Making
-a wide détour, we arrived in the evening, after dark, at the camp
-of Wunder’s company. We reported our observations to the
-company commander and the capable guide Inkermann, who died
-a hero’s death a few days later, warning them to keep a sharp
-look-out. Orders were also given that this camp, situated as
-it was in an open plain and exposed to fire from the surrounding
-bush, should be moved. After a cup of tea we returned to our
-main force about a quarter of an hour’s march to the rear.</p>
-
-<p>On the morning of 30th June we heard increasing rifle-fire from
-the direction of Wunder’s company. Assuming that the enemy
-had taken advantage of the lie of the ground and was firing on
-the camp from the surrounding bush, I immediately advanced
-with the three companies to the right through the bush, so as
-to strike the road further south and so take the enemy in the
-rear. Soon, however, we met some Askari, who told us that a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_199" id="Page_199">[199]</a></span>
-strong force of the enemy had forced its way into the camp,
-taking the company by surprise and driving it out. A young
-Askari complained to an old “Betschausch” (sergeant) of the
-third company that the enemy had taken everything from
-them. “Niemaza we, tutawafukuza” (shut your mouth, we’ll
-soon have ’em out), was the defiant answer which at once shamed
-the excited youth into silence. The sergeant’s answer indeed
-hit off the position. The enemy, consisting of the 5th Indian
-Regiment and a few natives, had thought to find only a weak
-German outpost. He had rashly penetrated into our badly-placed
-entrenchments and was now in his turn exposed on all
-sides to a concentrated fire from the bush.</p>
-
-<p>The position was so clear that it called for the quickest possible
-independent action by the subordinate leaders, and Captain
-von Chappuis also attacked at once. Staff-Surgeon Mohn
-(afterwards killed), who had remained in Wunder’s camp and had
-temporarily fallen into the enemy’s hands, described the very
-harassing effect of our concentrated fire at short range and the
-panic it caused among the enemy. Nevertheless, the cover
-afforded by a few ravines and the undergrowth enabled some of
-the enemy to get away. These fled wildly. A number so entirely
-lost themselves that they were picked up in the bush days
-afterwards by our patrols in a half-starved condition. We
-inflicted about 120 casualties. In addition to recovering our own
-ammunition, which had fallen temporarily into the enemy’s
-hands, we captured the enemy’s ammunition which he had just
-brought into the camp, about a hundred rifles and some machine
-guns. Among the severely wounded whom we took to the
-English camp at Naitiwi, and there handed over, was the commanding
-officer of the English regiment. He afterwards died
-of his wound.</p>
-
-<p>We stayed a few weeks longer in the fertile district of Lutende
-and tried with our patrols to inflict losses on the enemy, whose
-fortified camps at, and south of, Naitiwi offered no prospect
-of successful attack. Far to the south we often heard the explosion
-of air-bombs and of the heavy guns which were bombarding
-Wahle’s division. Von Chappuis’ company was marched to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_200" id="Page_200">[200]</a></span>
-reinforce Wahle’s force. Apart from some skirmishing our
-success at Lindi was followed by a lull in the operations.</p>
-
-<p>That this was only the prelude to new efforts on the enemy’s
-part was borne out not only by the reports of the transport of
-strong forces to Kilwa, and also by the fact that at the end of
-May General Hoskins, who had taken over command from
-General Smuts, had been relieved by General van Deventer.
-Once more a Boer was in command, and the rumours that fresh
-European troops were being brought from South Africa seemed
-to be confirmed. South of Kilwa the enemy attacked our nine
-companies with three brigades, but Captain von Lieberman,
-who had taken over from Captain Goering, the latter being
-seriously ill, succeeded with extraordinary skill in beating off the
-superior forces of the enemy. On July 6th, at least a brigade
-made a frontal attack on Captain Lieberman at Unindi and
-was repulsed with heavy losses. The bold charge of our companies
-cost us heavily too; among the casualties was Lieutenant
-Bleeck, who received a mortal wound in the stomach while leading
-his company. This brave and upright personality had done
-excellent service both as a fearless patrol-leader and on the
-Headquarters Staff, and I knew him intimately. Von Lieberman’s
-right flank was covered against another enemy brigade by Captain
-Spangenberg with two of the nine companies. He carried out
-his task and attacked the enemy brigade so energetically with
-his two companies that, as we heard later, the English reports
-spoke of an attack by very strong enemy forces.</p>
-
-<p>In spite of this success at Unindi, the great superiority of the
-enemy and the danger from enveloping movements to our supplies
-in the rear, induced Captain von Lieberman to withdraw
-gradually south, fighting all the time. I thought the moment
-had come to make a rapid counter-march with the available
-companies at Lutende, and the mountain-battery come unexpectedly
-to the aid of Captain von Lieberman and perhaps
-seize a favourable opportunity to inflict a decisive defeat upon
-the enemy. We moved due north from Lutende by forced marches
-and crossed the Mbemkuru, now once more an insignificant stream,
-without difficulty, two days’ march below Nahungu. The only<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_201" id="Page_201">[201]</a></span>
-opposition we encountered was from swarms of wild bees which
-forced us to make a slight détour. North of Mbemkuru we continued
-our march north into the Ruawa hills.</p>
-
-<p>I made use of the two days required to muster the force again
-to reconnoitre thoroughly the surrounding country, and on
-the 28th July, to my astonishment, I learned accidentally from
-some natives that a road through the mountains led almost in
-a straight line from our camp to Captain Lieberman’s camp at
-the Narungomba water-hole, about six hours’ march. A patrol
-of Europeans was sent at once to reconnoitre this road. In
-the morning of the 29th July I heard from my camp at Ruawa
-some explosions from the direction of Lieberman’s force.
-I did not think this could denote serious fighting, as the sounds
-ceased and, further, the patrol which I had sent to Lieberman’s
-force, and which had returned that morning, reported that
-everything was quiet there. I had, however, to change my
-mind when at noon van Rooyen, who was very reliable, returned
-from a hunting expedition and reported that he had certainly
-heard continuous machine-gun fire. The reader will, perhaps,
-wonder that I had not already begun the march to Lieberman’s
-camp, but it must be remembered that there was no
-water on the way, and my men were very exhausted, while some
-had only just reached Ruawa. By nightfall I was just three
-hours’ march nearer the scene of action, but it was not until the
-night was well advanced that my companies had all come up.
-A continuance of the march through the bush in pitch darkness
-was hopeless; it was bound to lead to a good deal of misunderstanding
-and would have meant a useless waste of the men’s
-strength, which had already been severely tried.</p>
-
-<p>At 3 a.m. the march was continued and soon after a
-report came from the advance officer patrol that Captain von
-Lieberman had certainly defeated the enemy, but, owing to
-shortage of ammunition, had marched to Mihambia during
-the night. The rearguard had evacuated the springs and at
-the time of the report was following the rest. My order to hold
-the springs at all costs until my arrival at 6 a.m. to join in the
-battle had, therefore, been disregarded owing to pressure of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_202" id="Page_202">[202]</a></span>
-circumstances. I now thought that the enemy, who was stronger
-than we, would have strongly entrenched the springs position,
-as was his habit, and that I should have to carry out any attack
-with thirsty troops. That seemed to offer little prospect of
-success. Later, when I learned the enemy’s real position, I
-inclined to the opposite view. In spite of his superiority the
-enemy had suffered a severe defeat. His 7th South African and
-8th European regiments were almost broken up. Again and
-again his infantry had hurled themselves in deep waves against
-the front of our Askari regiments, and each time they had been
-driven back by counter-attacks. A forest fire had broken out
-and spread among his ranks. Finally the main body of his
-troops had broken away and fled in wild disorder through the
-bush. Machine guns, masses of rifles and hundreds of cases of
-ammunition had been left on the field. In this condition, my
-attack, even after the withdrawal of Lieberman’s force, would
-perhaps have sealed the doom of the enemy’s main body. It is
-much to be regretted that at that time large numbers of the
-troops did not show sufficient initiative to make good the shortage
-of German ammunition during the battle itself, by using the
-enemy rifles and cartridges which were lying about in quantities.
-We had been within reach of a most important success which
-was snatched from our grasp by accident. We must, however,
-be grateful for the feat of arms which the 7th Askari Company
-performed under the doubtless brilliant leadership of Captain
-von Lieberman, against overwhelming odds.</p>
-
-<p>I did not get a clear report of this action, however, until later.
-For the moment I thought it right to march to Mihambia in order,
-by joining with Lieberman’s detachment, to secure unity of
-command, to supply it with sufficient ammunition to carry on
-and, if necessary, to raise its <i>moral</i> after the severe battle by a
-visible reinforcement. This last turned out to be unnecessary;
-when I arrived I found Lieberman’s detachment in excellent
-spirits, all the companies being proud to have dealt such a heavy
-blow to the superior enemy. For me the operation at Narungombe
-was a further proof how difficult it is in the unknown
-African bush and in face of the uncertainty of communication,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_203" id="Page_203">[203]</a></span>
-even if other circumstances are favourable, to carry through an
-operation in which several columns are taking part, so as to
-secure the necessary unity of action on the battlefield. At
-Narungombe, where all the conditions were as favourable as could
-have been hoped, the decision was finally thwarted by slight
-mischances, and my belief was strengthened that if I wanted
-to use different bodies of troops in one operation it was necessary
-to secure the closest connection first.</p>
-
-<p>The engagement at Narungombe brought the enemy at Kilwa
-to a standstill for a considerable time, and the fighting was confined
-to patrols, who inflicted losses on the enemy’s lines of communication,
-firing out of the bush on his detachments and
-motor transport and attacked at close quarters when a favourable
-opportunity offered. In order, for one thing, to put this patrol
-work on a broader basis, but also to counter the moving of enemy
-troops westward, and finally for reasons of supply, I deployed
-the force laterally on the line Mihambia-Ndessa. A large number
-of aircraft appeared over the fertile Ndessa district against
-whose bombs we were defenceless, and some severe wounds
-resulted; from this air-reconnaissance we could infer the enemy’s
-keen interest in the district and soon it was reported that he was
-moving still further west. Our patrols did such good work that
-from time to time whole companies of the enemy were put to
-flight with heavy losses. But the enemy continued his efforts
-to obtain information. He hardly took the trouble to hide his
-intention when sending flags of truce. I remember one occasion
-when the party bearing the white flag arrived at our camp out
-of the bush; they had, therefore, not only avoided the roads
-leading to it but had deliberately crossed them. The closer
-proximity of the enemy made it more difficult for us to get up
-our supplies, which were gradually running out. It was unavoidable
-that the position of our requisitioning and hunting-parties
-should become known to the enemy and that they should be
-surprised. The influence of the enemy on the natives was shown
-by the fact that south of Mihambia several villages had been
-suddenly deserted. I had long regarded this phenomenon
-as a sign of the enemy’s intention to advance in that direction.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_204" id="Page_204">[204]</a></span>
-The state of our supplies made it impossible for us to maintain
-so strong a force in the Mihambia-Ndessa area. As in any case
-the evacuation of this area could not long be delayed, and as the
-enemy west of Lindi was at the same time developing increased
-activity in strong force on General Wahle’s front, I decided to
-join General Wahle with some of the companies from Ndessa
-and perhaps bring off the operation that had failed at Narungombe;
-a decisive success by an unexpected reinforcement.
-On the 3rd August General O’Grady’s forces had certainly suffered
-a serious defeat. An Indian regiment, which had advanced
-through the gap between two strongly fortified German outposts,
-was attacked by our reserves, held ready for such a contingency,
-and almost annihilated. In the pursuit much valuable material
-fell into our hands. The enemy, however, had renewed the
-attack a few days later, and in face of the enveloping movement
-of his strong detachments, General Wahle had fallen back on
-Narunyu and a mountain of equal height south of the Lukuledi
-river.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Koehl, with six companies and a battery, remained
-behind at Ndessa; I crossed the river Mbemkuru below Nahungu
-with four companies and two mountain-guns, and then marched
-diagonally across the Muera plateau to the mission-station at
-Namupa. The prefect in charge entertained us, among other
-things, with muhogo (a species of corn with edible roots), prepared
-like fried potatoes, and supplemented the scanty provisions
-of our Europeans with bananas and other fruit out of his
-extensive gardens.</p>
-
-<p>In the camp at Njangao the receipt of part of a German wireless
-message directed to me, expressing his Majesty’s acknowledgments
-on the occasion of the third anniversary of the outbreak
-of war, delighted us all.</p>
-
-<p>We pitched our camp with the first company at Njengedi,
-on the main road between Njangao and Lindi, in the rear of
-Wahle’s division, in unpleasant, rainy weather. I immediately set
-out for Narunyu to inform General Wahle of our arrival. Here, in
-an almost impenetrable country broken by numerous ravines,
-at the bottom of which lay deep swamps, friend and foe faced<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_205" id="Page_205">[205]</a></span>
-one another in close proximity. Our men were working at
-dug-outs covered by branches cut from the trees. Only five
-of General Wahle’s seven companies were at Narunyu, the two
-others being on Ruho Mountain on the south bank of the Lukuledi
-river. In view of the danger of a surprise attack on our
-weak forces at Narunyu I ordered them to be reinforced by the
-companies on Ruho Mountain and marched two of those that
-had come with me to take their place. The enemy attack on
-Narunyu occurred the following day. Captain Lieberman’s
-Company from Ruho Mountain and the two companies I had
-brought with me all took part in the engagement. The third
-company had literally started their forced march to Karungu
-immediately after their arrival at Njengedi. I can still see the
-Askari coming up just before dawn and hear their shouts
-of delight at the thought of once more routing the enemy.</p>
-
-<p>Our attempt to envelop the enemy’s right wing, however,
-only served to press it back; the bush was too thick for an
-offensive movement which had to be developed at short range
-under a continuous machine-gun and rifle fire. The darkness
-made it still more difficult to direct the operations, and there
-is no doubt that in the confusion of the two fronts in this broken
-country our detachments often fired on one another: it was
-almost impossible to recognize friend or foe. For instance,
-hearing loud sounds of shouting in front of me, in the complete
-darkness of the bush, I thought this came from our enveloping
-attack driving back the enemy. It was not discovered till some
-time afterwards that this was the enemy and soon we heard him
-working at his trenches. The exact location of his trenches gave
-us the advantage of being able to get the range for the 10·5 cm.
-gun of the <i>Königsberg</i>, which was with Wahle’s force. This
-was done with good results; at any rate the enemy evacuated
-his trenches on the following day and retired.</p>
-
-<p>The complete victory desired had not been attained and, in
-view of the difficulties of the ground, could not be expected, as
-we had discovered our strength to the enemy in the fighting of
-the 18th, and lost the advantage of a surprise. Once more I
-had to content myself with delay. In this fertile country there<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_206" id="Page_206">[206]</a></span>
-was no difficulty about holding our ground from the point of
-view of supplies. The force has rarely been so well fed as in the
-Lindi area. Great fields of sweet-potatoes and muhogo stretched
-as far as the eye could see, and there was an abundant supply
-of sugar-cane. The numerous Arab plantations indicated the
-fertility and the ancient civilization of the country. We made
-ourselves at home, and though rifle bullets often whistled through
-our camp and aircraft dropped bombs on us, not much harm was
-done. On one occasion the dentist, who had set up his surgery
-in a European house and was giving us the attention we had
-long needed, was attending to a patient when a bomb fell into
-the room. It was discovered later, when the place was examined,
-that the planter kept his store of dynamite in this very room.
-Fortunately the bomb did not touch this or both patients and
-dentist would have been permanently freed from toothache.</p>
-
-<p>It was no easy matter to decide what to do with the German
-women and children, some of whom had fled from Lindi and
-did not know what to do. A number of them had taken refuge
-in the planters’ houses, which were within range of the enemy’s
-guns. In view of the restriction of supplies and the difficulties
-of transport and accommodation, it was desirable that these
-women and children should be sent back to Lindi. Some were
-intelligent enough to see this. By means of a parley their transference
-behind the British lines was duly arranged, and they were
-able to leave for Lindi. For reasons unknown to me the English
-then refused to keep to the arrangement, and the women and
-children, as well as male non-combatants, gradually collected in
-the Catholic mission at Ndanda. A military convalescent home
-had been quartered there for some time and had developed into
-an important hospital. All the people who were brought here
-found good food and accommodation in the spacious buildings
-of the mission with its extensive gardens.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_207" id="Page_207">[207]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER XI<br />
-<span class="wn">IN THE SOUTH-EAST CORNER OF THE COLONY</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">WHILE at Narunyu there was a lull in the fighting for
-several weeks, the enemy had shown considerable
-activity in the section of Portuguese territory occupied by
-Stuemer’s force. Several English columns from the south-west
-and south had concentrated on Mwembe, and Major von
-Stuemer, not thinking himself strong enough to resist, had
-evacuated Mwembe. The different companies had then gradually
-retired on the Rovuma. North of this river Lieutenant-Commander
-Jantzen, who had been sent from Headquarters to
-Tunduru, and under whom the various companies of Stuemer’s
-force had re-formed, had taken over the command. Enemy
-forces were also advancing on Tunduru from Ssongea.</p>
-
-<p>It was difficult to obtain detailed information about the enemy.
-My impression was that he wanted to bring our main force to
-a halt, invade our supply-area in the Tunduru-Massassi-Ruponda
-district with strong forces, and carry off our supplies. I did
-not then think it out of the question that we might score a
-success, and I, therefore, marched on the 10th September, 1917,
-with five companies, from our camps at Narunyu towards Massassi.
-From there Captain Goering immediately marched with three
-companies towards Tunduru; Jantzen’s division stood north-east
-of this place. I reconnoitred the road to Tunduru on a
-bicycle and feared that the difficulties of supply would be very
-serious. These fears were unfortunately realized. Supplies
-from the land could not be brought up and there was no time
-for a prolonged operation that would allow of additional supplies
-being obtained from Massassi.</p>
-
-<p>The small English and Portuguese patrols which attacked<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_208" id="Page_208">[208]</a></span>
-our supplies and transport from across the Rovuma to the
-south did not cause us to hurry our movements. But the enemy
-from Kilwa, whom Captain Koehl’s heavy attack from Mbeo-Chini
-and a number of lesser encounters had not been able to
-stop, reached the neighbourhood of Nahungu. His flying
-columns, for the most part mounted, outflanked Koehl’s force,
-and pressed forward up the Mbemkuru river to Nangano. Communication
-with Captain Koehl by means of the telephone-line
-from Nahungu to Nangano was first interrupted for a few days,
-and then broken off completely. The supply dumps fell into the
-enemy’s hands and were destroyed. To provide against the
-interruption of the exposed telephone-line a new line had been
-laid from Ruponda, running north-east, but connection by
-messenger between this line and Koehl’s division took several
-days.</p>
-
-<p>In view of the slow means of communication with Koehl’s
-detachment, it was not possible to get an accurate view of the
-situation in time, and as the intended success at Tunduru could
-not in any case be attained, I marched the five companies from
-Massassi to Ruponda at the beginning of October, and then
-further north-east, joining forces with Koehl’s force at Likangara.
-On receiving the report that enemy detachments were
-approaching Ruponda, I ordered the removal of the sick and the
-stores from Ruponda to Lukuledi and Mnacho. On 9th October,
-1917, an enemy patrol was beaten off with some losses at Ruponda.
-On 10th October a considerable force of the enemy&mdash;the 25th
-Indian Cavalry Regiment was identified&mdash;assaulted Ruponda
-from several sides. The withdrawal of our companies had,
-therefore, unfortunately been rather premature; otherwise the
-enemy might have encountered some of our passing companies
-at Ruponda and perhaps suffered a serious defeat. As it was,
-there were no troops in Ruponda except a few of our patrols;
-most of the sick fell into the enemy’s hands, and also some 90,000
-kg. of supplies. At Likangara there was no fighting worthy of
-notice. Some enemy patrols and weak detachments did appear,
-but our fighting-force, which was attacking the enemy’s main
-line of communication along the Mbemkuru river, firing on and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_209" id="Page_209">[209]</a></span>
-destroying motor-transport, and capturing mails and supplies,
-led me to suppose that the strongest part of the Kilwa force
-was recuperating further west in the direction of Ruponda.</p>
-
-<p>The increased enemy activity a few days’ march east of
-Likangara, where he established requisitioning stations, as well
-as the stories of the natives, made it seem probable that considerable
-enemy forces were marching from Nahungu towards
-the south, and therefore against General Wahle. Captured
-mails revealed the fact that in spite of his extensive intelligence
-and spy systems the enemy was groping in the dark. He did
-not know, for instance, where I was, although he seemed to place
-the greatest importance upon knowing. The knowledge of
-my Headquarters would tell him the probable position of our
-main force. While one letter thought that I was in the neighbourhood
-of Lukuledi, another professed to know that I was at
-Tunduru, and according to a third I was at Mahenge. The
-talkativeness of these Europeans, who, in spite of all warnings,
-cannot refrain from communicating to one another in their
-private letters their knowledge and their conjectures about the
-war situation, had in this case done good: there was so much
-gossip, the rumours were so contradictory, and even the most
-improbable things were so indiscriminately believed, that anything
-at all could be read into the German correspondence. In
-spite of this unintentional misleading of the enemy, it is difficult
-to understand how intelligent people can entrust to the post
-important matters, the knowledge of which must be kept from
-the enemy, knowing how unreliable the post is, and that the
-letters often fall into the enemy’s hands.</p>
-
-<p>It was clear to me that the enemy’s obvious uncertainty about
-the situation would give me a great opportunity if it could be
-used quickly and decisively. I ventured to hope that the
-intended decisive blow might now be struck for which I had
-tried twice near Lindi and once at Tunduru, and the success of
-which at Narungombe had hung on a hair. The development
-of the situation on Wahle’s front seemed favourable for this
-attempt. His forces had gradually withdrawn from the Mtua
-district to Mahiwa. The enemy’s whole handling of the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_210" id="Page_210">[210]</a></span>
-campaign suggested that his various columns would press forward
-with all their weight and try to crush us by a concentration
-from all sides. The enemy’s Lindi Division was advancing
-energetically with the rest. General Wahle’s nine companies,
-fighting stubbornly, had retired before them to Mahiwa. I
-had a fair personal knowledge of the country at Mahiwa. It
-was very probable that my march in that direction would not
-be observed by the enemy in time.</p>
-
-<p>On the 10th October, 1917, trusting in the fortune of war, I
-crossed the Linkangara mountains to Mnacho with five companies
-and two mountain guns. I arrived there at dark and
-left again at daybreak on the 15th. On the narrow mountain
-paths the force got very scattered. The guns were left far behind,
-and the pack-animals gave trouble. Askari and bearers came
-to the rescue, and again and again Sergeant-Major Sabath rose
-superior to the difficulties and brought his guns forward. It
-surprised me that we were unable to get any information from
-Mahiwa, but the rifle and machine-gun fire indicated that fighting
-was in progress. Before dark I reached Lieutenant Methner’s
-company, which was in reserve behind Wahle’s left wing. The
-enemy seemed to be attacking this company with a view to
-enveloping it. His fire had the unfortunate effect of causing
-the disappearance of my bearer, with my dispatch-box, containing
-most important dispatches and maps: he did not return for
-two days. The first two companies to come up were immediately
-thrown against the enemy’s enveloping movement, and the
-enemy was thrown back. The companies then dug themselves
-in. On the morning of the 16th I went to reconnoitre, and
-found that the enemy had also entrenched himself immediately
-in front, at a distance of sixty to a hundred metres. When
-Lieutenant von Ruckteschell offered me a cup of coffee, care had
-to be taken, as the enemy was keeping a fairly sharp look-out,
-and shot with tolerable accuracy. I thought the opportunity
-favourable for a determined surprise attack. It was decided to
-launch the attack at noon, on the left (north) wing, and try to
-turn the enemy’s flank. Goering’s detachment was to lead the
-attack.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_211" id="Page_211">[211]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>After we had eaten our midday meal undisturbed, I went at
-once to the left wing, where Captain Goering had just begun his
-advance with his two companies. When he had crossed a wide
-depression in the ground, to my surprise he changed direction
-still further to the left. The companies were soon in action.
-Only gradually I realized the significance of this surprising move.
-Captain Goering had come unexpectedly upon a new enemy
-who had come from Nahungu and was now attacking from the
-north. The force consisted of several battalions and two guns
-of the Nigerian Brigade who knew nothing of our arrival at
-Mahiwa and were expecting to smash General Wahle’s force by
-an attack on his left flank and rear, while his front, facing east,
-was vigorously attacked by a division. The Nigerian Brigade
-was as much taken by surprise as Captain Goering and was not
-so quick to adapt itself to the new situation. Captain Goering,
-closely supported by the reserves, threw himself so vigorously
-against the enemy in the bush that he ran through some of
-his detachments, threw them into confusion, and finally put them
-to flight. An enemy officer in command of an ammunition
-column took our men for his own, with the result that we captured
-about 150,000 rounds of ammunition. A gun with ammunition
-was taken by assault, and the killed did not consist wholly of
-Nigerian Askari. On Captain Goering’s right, where two companies
-under Lieutenant von Ruckteschell and Lieutenant
-Brucker, wounded in this action, were fighting, the enemy was
-also thrown back some way into the bush.</p>
-
-<p>While this fighting was going on on the flank, and on the
-following day also, the enemy attacked Wahle’s force with all
-his strength. Here the enemy was in great superiority; wave
-after wave of fresh troops were thrown against our front. There
-was a danger that General Wahle’s front would give way, and the
-fighting was very severe. There was also serious danger that our
-enveloping movement, in the very difficult swampy ground of
-the bush, would be held up so long by weak enemy forces that a
-defeat would be inflicted upon our front before it could make itself
-felt. In that case the battle was lost. I thought it expedient
-to increase the disadvantages that the enemy was bringing upon<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_212" id="Page_212">[212]</a></span>
-himself by his costly frontal attack and used all my available
-strength in such a way that the enemy by the increasing fierceness
-of his frontal attack was bleeding himself to death.</p>
-
-<p>The original intention of enveloping the enemy’s left wing
-was not developed further on the following days, but, on the contrary,
-every available company was withdrawn from the left
-wing to stiffen General Wahle’s front. In this way we not only
-succeeded in holding our ground, but, by immediately taking
-advantage of the enemy’s moments of weakness to make heavy
-counter-attacks with our reserves, we were able to inflict a real
-defeat. My, perhaps surprising, tactics were prompted by the
-personality of the enemy commander. I had learned in the
-engagement at Reata (11th March, 1916) that General Beves
-threw his men into action regardless of loss of life and did not
-hesitate to try for a success, not by skilful handling and small
-losses, but rather by repeated frontal attacks which, if the defence
-held its ground and had anything like adequate forces, led to
-severe losses for the attack. I guessed that here at Mahiwa
-he was carrying out the same tactics. I think it was by taking
-advantage of the enemy leader’s mistaken tactics in this way
-that we were able to win this splendid victory. Until the 18th
-October, for four days therefore, wave after wave of the attack
-broke on our front, but my own observation told me that the
-weight of the attack here on the right wing was diminishing and
-that the enemy’s defeat was absolute.</p>
-
-<p>On the evening of the 18th October we had, with some 1,500
-men, completely defeated a whole enemy detachment at least
-4,000, and probably not less than 6,000, strong. With the
-exception of Tanga, it was the most serious defeat he had
-suffered.</p>
-
-<p>According to a high English officer the enemy lost 1,500
-men; but I have reason to believe that this estimate is much
-too low. Our casualties were: 14 Europeans and 81 Askari
-killed, 55 Europeans and 367 Askari wounded, 1 European
-and 1 Askari missing. Considering the smallness of our forces
-these losses were for us very considerable, and were felt all
-the more seriously because they could not be replaced. We<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_213" id="Page_213">[213]</a></span>
-captured a gun, six heavy and three light machine guns, and
-200,000 rounds of ammunition.</p>
-
-<p>The situation, unfortunately, did not allow us to take full
-advantage of our victory; in our rear was the enemy who had
-occupied Ruponda on the 10th October, advanced in strong
-force further south and on 18th October attacked Major Kraut
-at Lukuledi. It must be remarked in passing that our troops
-which had fought under Lieutenant-Commander Jantzen near
-Tunduru had gradually retired north-east to the upper Mbenkuru
-and had reached Headquarters above Ruponda before the occupation
-of that place by the enemy on the 10th October. Two
-of these companies had reinforced the company which was
-guarding our supplies near Lukuledi, and it was these three companies,
-under the command of Major Kraut, which were attacked
-by a superior enemy from the north on the 18th October.</p>
-
-<p>The enemy, believed to be six companies of the Gold Coast
-Regiment, was driven off, but in order to protect our supplies and
-material lying at Chigugu and Chiwata, Major Kraut retired to
-the first of these places. As well as Chigugu and Chiwata,
-Ndanda, where we had large stores of war material, was also
-threatened by the enemy, who had doubtless, in my opinion,
-been reinforced at Lukuledi. The enemy from Lukuledi might
-at any moment attack our lines of communication, capture our
-stores and supplies, and so put us out of action. We had no
-means of protecting our lines of communication locally, for the
-few thousand men we had were required for fighting. As, however,
-the force had to be kept alive, the danger had to be overcome
-in some other way.</p>
-
-<p>There was only one way: to beat the enemy decisively at
-Lukuledi. It was necessary therefore to lose no time at Mahiwa,
-and, hard though it was, I had to abandon the idea of an annihilating
-pursuit. When, early on the 19th October, a few scattered
-detachments of the enemy were seen and fired on, I had
-already begun my march with six companies and two guns. On
-the next day at two o’clock we entered Lukuledi from the east,
-and on 21st of October at dawn we attacked the enemy, who
-was apparently taken completely by surprise. North of Lukuledi,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_214" id="Page_214">[214]</a></span>
-on the Ruponda road, Major Kraut’s column surprised the camp
-of the 25th Indian Cavalry Regiment, which, with transport
-harnessed, stood ready for the march on Massassi; the camp
-was taken by storm and the regiment lost almost the whole of
-its transport horses, altogether 350. Whilst I was engaged
-with the detachments of Koehl and Ruckteschell in a fairly serious
-action against the enemy entrenched at Lukuledi, I waited in
-vain for the intervention of Kraut’s force. An attack on the
-camp without the advantage of surprise had little hope of success.
-When the force began to come under the fire of the enemy’s
-mine-throwers on the flank, I withdrew the greater part from the
-zone of the effective cross-fire, after beating off a strong enemy
-attack, in order to avoid unnecessary losses. A fresh enemy,
-in the shape of a company of King’s African Rifles (English East
-African Askari), who appeared unexpectedly from the bush, was
-quickly driven off. In this engagement Lieutenant Kroeger fell
-at the head of his company. The action was then broken off.
-No news came of Major Kraut until night; thinking he could
-no longer attack successfully at Lukuledi, and hearing no sounds
-of fighting, he had made a détour and then approached Lukuledi
-from the south.</p>
-
-<p>Owing to unfavourable circumstances we had not succeeded
-in inflicting a decisive defeat on the enemy at Lukuledi, and the
-operation had only in part gained its objective, but the enemy’s
-losses must be regarded as serious. The impression made on
-him was even greater than I had supposed. At any rate, it was
-reported that he had evacuated Lukuledi and withdrawn to the
-north. Among our casualties were three company-commanders
-killed. I can still see Lieutenant Volkwein, severely wounded in
-the leg, limping through the bush at the head of his company.
-I had also spoken with Lieutenant Batzner and Lieutenant
-Kroeger shortly before they fell. Sergeant-Major Klein also fell,
-who had so often led his patrol on the Uganda railway. He was
-a capable machine gun leader. But our losses were not in vain.
-Our patrols pursued the enemy and fired on his camp near
-Ruponda and also his lines of communication. The impossibility
-of maintaining large bodies of troops in the neighbourhood<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_215" id="Page_215">[215]</a></span>
-of Ruponda&mdash;our supplies collected there had fallen into the
-enemy’s hands&mdash;forced me to give up all idea of pursuing the
-enemy.</p>
-
-<p>At that time I thought it possible that the enemy’s withdrawal
-from Lukuledi might have been due to the movements of Captain
-Tafel’s force, which was marching from Mahenge to join us. We
-had lost touch with him since the beginning of October. He had
-received orders to retire gradually before the strong enemy
-columns which were advancing on Mahenge from the north
-(Ifakara), west and south-west (Likuju, Mponda), and to try to
-get into touch with the main force under my command. I
-thought it quite possible that he had already arrived in the
-district of Nangano, or west of that place, and that the enemy
-had turned about again out of anxiety for his lines of communication.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_216" id="Page_216">[216]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER XII<br />
-<span class="wn">THE LAST WEEKS IN GERMAN TERRITORY</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap08">ON 24th October, the Governor of Chiwata, which had become
-the centre of the Administration, arrived at my camp
-east of Lukuledi for a conference. I firmly stated my opinion
-that, in spite of all difficulties of supply which must shortly
-arise in German East Africa, the war could and must be carried
-on. One possibility that offered was to base the operations on
-Portuguese territory. This could only be done by evacuating
-German East Africa and invading Portuguese East Africa.</p>
-
-<p>The question of supplies was becoming very serious; we had
-in our stores only about 500,000 kg. of supplies. That would
-last us about six weeks. But it had been found that these
-figures were deceptive. The piled-up sacks had to a great extent
-lost weight and the grain had been eaten by insects. The new
-harvest could not be expected until March at the earliest. If
-the operations were to be continued it was necessary from this
-point of view alone to move south. I was still reckoning with
-the possibility that Captain Tafel’s force might arrive in the
-neighbourhood of Massassi and Chiwata, in which case I should
-hand over to him the supplies at Chiwata, while I crossed the
-Makonda hills in the direction of Lindi with part of the Chiwata
-force and attacked the enemy’s main line of communication on
-the Lukuledi river. In whichever way the situation might
-develop, the Chiwata district was, on account of its fertility, of the
-greatest importance to us. Chiwata was, however, not protected
-and was further threatened by the fact that enemy operations
-were taking place in the north against Mnacho, and enemy
-mounted forces had been seen on the Lukuledi-Lindi road in the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_217" id="Page_217">[217]</a></span>
-neighbourhood of Ndanda. Also enemy aircraft were paying
-our camp at Chiwata increasing attention.</p>
-
-<p>These were my reasons for withdrawing from Lukuledi at the
-end of October with the main part of my forces. It could not
-be foreseen whether another opportunity would offer of making
-another attack from Chiwata on one of the enemy columns that
-would be passing before long. For the next few weeks the
-enemy’s pressure was again directed against Wahle. Quite
-fresh troops were appearing there, among them the Cape Corps
-of South African half-castes. This corps had been stationed
-along the Central railway and had been brought up to reinforce
-General Beves’ troops, apparently via Dar-es-Salaam and Lindi.
-Fortunately General Beves had not waited for this reinforcement
-before his defeat at Mahiwa.</p>
-
-<p>General Wahle was retiring step by step up the Lukuledi
-river. I was, unfortunately, not able to send him any support,
-but even had to draw on his forces to have troops in hand ready
-for a favourable opportunity for an attack and to protect the
-supplies. In the almost daily bush-fighting of General Wahle’s
-force heavy losses were apparently inflicted on the enemy, and
-he was held severely in check. There was, however, no defeat
-and no considerable capture of booty, and meanwhile our supplies
-were getting lower and lower. On 6th November, I rode from
-Chiwata to Nangoo, near Ndanda, where, close behind Wahle’s
-force, I found a suitable point of attack for the Chiwata troops.
-On 7th November I rode back from Nangoo to Chiwata, making
-a détour south across the Makonde hills. On the same day
-enemy troops were again reported at Lukuledi, and on 9th November
-an affair of patrols took place at Chigugu, just west of Chiwata.</p>
-
-<p>At this critical time, when the heads of the enemy columns
-were nearing Chiwata, it was urgently necessary for us to throw
-all our strength against one of these columns as soon as possible
-before the others could intervene. The first essential to make this
-blow effective was to bring the whole strength of our all too weak
-forces to bear simultaneously. This depended chiefly on the
-supply of ammunition. Our whole supply had dwindled to about
-400,000 rounds, a very scanty allowance for our 25,000 rifles and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_218" id="Page_218">[218]</a></span>
-50 machine guns in a serious engagement, after which it would
-only be possible to continue the struggle if ammunition were
-captured. For this the nature of the ground was unfavourable.
-In the thick bush there was a tendency for each individual to fire
-many rounds and make few hits, so that the supply of cartridges
-was quickly used up without producing the decisive results we
-needed. What made a satisfactory solution of the ammunition
-question still more impossible was that the cartridges were for
-the most part the smoky ’71 type, whereas only about one-third
-of the troops were armed with ’71 rifles; the other two-thirds
-had modern German, English or Portuguese rifles, and for these
-the supply of cartridges was very small. What there were were
-required for our most important weapon, the machine gun. It was
-a difficult position. There was nothing else for it but to make the
-attack with only those troops who were armed with the ’71 rifle
-and to hold in reserve the rest, who had only twenty rounds of
-ammunition suitable for their modern rifles, the rest being the
-smoky ’71 type. The two forces would then be interchanged
-so that the first, armed with the ’71 rifles, could hand them over
-to the relieving force, taking the modern weapons in exchange.
-This meant that at the best only one-third of the available
-strength could be in action at the same time and even then would
-have to be very sparing with their ammunition.</p>
-
-<p>Our artillery ammunition had already been exhausted with
-the exception of a few rounds for the two mountain guns and some
-Portuguese ammunition. Our last field-howitzer, as well as the
-English gun captured at Mahiwa, had burst. The last two 10·5
-cm. guns from the <i>Königsberg</i> had been destroyed a few days
-before. On the day after a German mountain gun had been destroyed
-and sunk at Kitangari. We were thus left with one German
-and one Portuguese mountain gun. During the last few
-months the lack of artillery ammunition had been so serious
-that we had rarely more than three hundred rounds all told.
-That was about the allowance per engagement for one of the
-numerous English guns.</p>
-
-<p>Under such circumstances an attack could only promise success
-if the situation was exceptionally favourable. This was never<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_219" id="Page_219">[219]</a></span>
-the case. The patrols were kept active, and the enemy harassed
-as much as possible, but otherwise there was nothing left but for
-General Wahle’s force and the 11th Field Company, which had
-been left at Mnacho to bring away the supplies, gradually to
-give way before the pressure of the enemy and retire to Chiwata.
-On 10th November the Ndanda mission, immediately in the rear
-of General Wahle, who was at Nangoo, was surprised by a strong
-enemy force and captured. The field-hospital quartered there,
-and part of our stores, fell into the enemy’s hands. Lieberman’s
-force, south of Ndanda, ensured the retreat of General Wahle’s
-force, which ascended to the Makonda plateau, by the road
-south-east of Nangoo, the road I had reconnoitred on 7th
-November, and, by crossing the plateau diagonally to Chiwata,
-escaped from the enemy’s trap. The 11th Company also found
-its way to Chiwata from Mnacho, so that, with the exception of
-Captain Tafel’s Detachment and some small bodies of troops
-further south, the whole force was concentrated at Chiwata.
-The gradual transport of our supplies from Chiwata east to Nambindinga
-had begun, and with that our march to Kitangari.
-Meanwhile I kept an anxious look-out for a vulnerable point
-in one of the enemy columns. On the 14th November I thought I
-had discovered one.</p>
-
-<p>A strong enemy column, to which belonged the 10th South
-African Mounted Infantry, had passed close to our position
-while marching from Lukuledi via Massassi, and had attacked
-Mwiti, two hours’ march south of Chiwata. In this place, which
-until then had been only weakly held, Lieberman’s force (three
-companies) had arrived the day before. In spite of the shortage
-of ammunition there was, I thought, a chance that by unexpectedly
-throwing into the fight Koehl’s force from Chiwata, this
-enemy might be defeated separately. I was, however, very
-busy with the preparations for the withdrawal to Nambindinga
-and unfortunately let the opportunity at Mwiti pass without
-taking advantage of it.</p>
-
-<p>There was nothing for it, then, but to retire gradually to Nambindinga.</p>
-
-<p>Through the evacuation of Chiwata the European prisoners,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_220" id="Page_220">[220]</a></span>
-as well as the Indians, who had been carried to the hospital,
-and the hospital itself, full for the most part of seriously wounded,
-fell into the enemy’s hands. The march to Nambindinga was
-carried out under continuous fighting between the 15th and 17th
-November. I wanted to make the enemy complete the concentric
-march of his columns, advancing north-west and south, so as to
-effect a junction; then, when the enemy’s masses were helplessly
-crowded on a narrow area, I could march where I liked. On
-November 17th I had to take a fateful decision at Nambindinga.
-The continual bush-fighting was threatening to consume all our
-ammunition. It would have been madness to go on with this
-fighting, which could not bring about a favourable decision. We
-had therefore to withdraw.</p>
-
-<p>The supply question pointed the same way. Only by a
-drastic reduction of strength could we carry on with the stores in
-hand. Our supply area had been narrowed, fresh requisitioning had
-been interfered with by the enemy, and the produce of the land
-exhausted. The supply of quinine would last the Europeans a
-month longer. After the consumption of this the Europeans
-would certainly fall victims to malaria and its attendant evils;
-they would no longer be able to contend with the rigours of a
-tropical campaign. Only by reducing the number of Europeans
-to a minimum could enough quinine be ensured for each man to
-enable us to carry on the operations for months.</p>
-
-<p>At the same time we had to reduce our total strength. Our
-large force with little ammunition was of less value in the field
-than a smaller number of picked men with plenty of ammunition.
-It amounted to the reduction of our strength to about 2,000
-rifles, including not more than 2,000 Europeans. All above this
-number had to be left behind. It could not be helped that among
-the several hundred Europeans and 600 Askari that we were
-compelled to leave behind in the hospital at Nambindinga, there
-were men who would have liked to go on fighting and were
-physically fit to do so. Unfortunately, it must be admitted
-that among those who were left behind at Nambindinga, even
-among the Europeans, there were many who were not unwilling
-to lay down their arms. It is, however, worthy of mention<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_221" id="Page_221">[221]</a></span>
-that not only the majority of the Europeans, but also many
-Askari, were bitterly disappointed at having to remain. We
-had repeatedly to refuse the request of a brave Askari that he
-might come and fight for us. But when, two days later, Lieutenant
-Grundmann, though severely wounded and scarcely able
-to walk, reported himself, saying that he could not, in spite
-of orders, bring himself to surrender, I have seldom been so
-pleased as at this breach of discipline. It may be mentioned
-here that in general the enemy, as far as I am in a position to
-judge, treated our prisoners with humanity, but it seems to me
-that he was anxious to convict us of cruelty to English prisoners,
-perhaps in order to justify reprisals, perhaps for other reasons.
-Lieutenant Cutsch had been left sick in Nandanda, and fell
-into the enemy’s hands. On the totally unfounded and unproved
-evidence of a negro that Lieutenant Cutsch had on one occasion,
-when commanding a patrol, burned to death a wounded Englishman,
-he was put in irons and sent by sea to Dar-es-Salaam, being
-imprisoned during the voyage just outside the ship’s roundhouse.
-At Dar-es-Salaam he was locked up for several weeks in
-the prison without a trial. When at last he was tried, it came
-out that the charge of senseless cruelty rested purely on the lying
-evidence of the negro. Again, General Deventer informed me
-that Captain Naumann, who had surrendered near Kilima
-Njaro, had been tried for murder. He, too, as I heard later, was
-kept imprisoned for a long time without a hearing, until his innocence
-was finally established. I find it all the more difficult to
-understand this mockery of justice, as the English prisoners were
-always humanely treated by us, and were often better cared for
-materially than our own people.<a name="FNanchor_5_5" id="FNanchor_5_5"></a><a href="#Footnote_5_5" class="fnanchor">[5]</a></p>
-
-<p>These decisions placed the conduct of the war on an entirely
-different basis. Hitherto we had stored the supplies in dumps
-and for the most part had been able to satisfy our demands from
-these; the ammunition also had been maintained from stores.
-This system had laid us more open to attack and offered the enemy
-points of attack which we could not protect. But by the methods<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_222" id="Page_222">[222]</a></span>
-adopted hitherto it had been possible to keep the troops in the
-field at great strength, considering our position, and to employ
-a great part of them on a small area for a considerable period.
-It had further been possible to give a permanent character, at
-any rate to some of our hospitals, where sick and wounded
-could recuperate in peace, and in this way we could fill the gaps
-in our front with refreshed and experienced men. This system
-had made our operations dependent to a great extent on the
-situation of the supplies and reinforcements, and had hindered
-freedom of movement. The advantage, however, in our position
-of being able to employ strong troops and with them successfully
-to engage, and often defeat decisively, superior enemy forces was so
-great that I held to this system as long as it was at all possible.</p>
-
-<p>It was now no longer possible, and the advantages I have
-mentioned had to be sacrificed under the pressure of necessity.
-It was certainly questionable whether the reduced force could
-be maintained without supply dumps, and without reinforcements
-the prospect of remaining, after twelve days in the plains, with
-five thousand hungry negroes and without supplies was not
-attractive. Should we succeed in satisfying those requirements
-of the force which could not be obtained on the spot, especially
-ammunition and arms, by means of capture from the enemy&mdash;for
-the only possibility of renewing our supplies lay in capturing
-the enemy’s&mdash;in sufficient quantities to make the continuation
-of the war possible? That was the all-important question. If
-we succeeded, however, in maintaining the force on the new
-territory the increased independence and mobility, used with
-determination against the less mobile enemy, would give us a
-local superiority in spite of the great numerical superiority of the
-enemy. In the unlimited territory at our disposal it would be
-possible to withdraw from unfavourable positions. The enemy
-would be compelled to keep an enormous amount of men and
-material continually on the move, and to exhaust his strength
-to a greater extent proportionately than ourselves. There was
-also the prospect of tying down strong enemy forces and protracting
-the operations indefinitely if&mdash;my forecast proved correct.
-This was at that time doubtful, but the risk had to be taken.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_223" id="Page_223">[223]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>We did not stay long at Nambindinga; this place situated on
-the plateau had no water and the springs in the valley were within
-range of the enemy’s guns and machine guns. Under the protection
-of patrols, which held back the enemy at Nambindinga,
-Headquarters and the main part of the forces arrived at Kitangari
-on 18th November. The enemy did not follow, probably he
-could not. As had been foreseen, he had strained every nerve
-to strike the so long hoped-for knockout blow at Chiwata and
-had to re-form before undertaking further operations. At Kitangari
-the old experience was repeated of finding that the supplies
-stored there had been estimated much too highly. The supplies
-at all serviceable would, all told, only feed the force for about ten
-days; we could reckon on no appreciable addition to these stores
-from the region south of Kitangari. The question in which
-direction the march should be continued focussed itself in the
-main on the prospect of again finding the means of adequately
-feeding the force. There was no time to be lost.</p>
-
-<p>I knew that in the area along the Rovuma the English and
-Portuguese had systematically destroyed our supplies. Our
-small dumps, requisitioning stations and supply columns had
-been attacked and the supplies destroyed. The natives had been
-influenced against us. The north and south banks of the middle
-Rovuma were only thinly populated; at Tunduru, further up the
-Rovuma, strong forces of both sides had been engaged and the
-supplies there were probably exhausted. I could get no reliable
-information about the Mafia plateau south of the lower Rovuma.
-Even if, as many reported, this had been a richly-cultivated
-district before the war it was very doubtful whether now, after
-strong Portuguese forces had been billeted there for years, there
-would be any food left. The most probable place for finding
-supplies seemed to me at that time to be the district where Major
-Stuemer’s operations had taken place: the corner between the
-Rovuma and the Ludjenda rivers and further south in the region
-of Nangware and Mwembe. Even this was doubtful, for here, too,
-war had interfered with the agriculture of the natives. Meanwhile,
-of the various improbabilities this last seemed to me the least
-improbable, and I decided to march at once up the Rovuma.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_224" id="Page_224">[224]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>A determining factor in the choice of this direction was my wish
-to equip my force for a prolonged period of action by a large capture
-of ammunition and other war material. Previous observation
-and the reports of the natives led me to believe that somewhere
-near the Rovuma the enemy still possessed large stores.
-On 20th November we reached Nevale, where we were joined by
-the patrols which had secured our southern flank, and the reorganization
-of the force was finally carried through. At Nevale the
-last men unfit for marching were left behind, and on 21st
-November we marched south to the Rovuma with 300 Europeans,
-1,700 Askari, and 3,000 bearers and other natives. Every man
-was loaded to his full capacity. In general, as the supplies were
-consumed, the bearers no longer required were left behind, so
-as to keep the number of consumers as low as possible. In many
-cases we had to refuse the urgent requests of our good old bearers
-to remain with us, a large number offering to carry on without
-pay, some even without either pay or rations; these were ready
-to provide their own rations from what we threw away and Pori
-fruit. The quartermaster at that time, Naval Lieutenant
-Besch, reorganized the supplies and transport service very
-efficiently. He deserves the chief credit for the force’s ability to
-carry on.</p>
-
-<p>As was to be expected, only small detachments of the enemy
-were reported in the neighbourhood of the Rovuma. On 21st
-November we arrived at Mpili, on the bank of the river, and were
-about to pitch our camp when several shots passed close to a
-hunting party. On reconnoitring we found in front of us a large
-pond, on the opposite side of which horses were being watered.
-Behind rose a rocky mountain. Soon afterwards a native,
-apparently a spy, appeared, bringing a written message: “We
-are English cavalry, and we want to get into touch with Portuguese
-infantry regiments.” Whether this was a ruse could not
-be ascertained. It was clear that for the moment we had only
-to do with a small squadron of cavalry. By a sharp attack the
-enemy was soon routed and in the pursuit sustained several
-casualties: five European prisoners belonging to the 10th South
-African Mounted Infantry were, for reasons of supply, sent back
-to the enemy. The captured horses were welcome as chargers
-and as a possible addition to our rations.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-224.jpg" width="400" height="573" id="i224"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc400">Native Types (3).<br />
-<span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-225.jpg" width="400" height="560" id="i225"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc400">Native Types (4).<br />
-<span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_225" id="Page_225">[225]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The rest of the march up the Rovuma progressed very slowly.
-A great part of the force were unaccustomed to long route-marches.
-The columns straggled endlessly. The Askari women
-followed singly, several hundred yards apart. It was some time
-before they learned to keep to a regular marching order. Incidentally
-it became obvious that in some companies the Askari
-who had come with us had not been selected from the most suitable
-point of view. In the reorganization of the companies
-which had had to be carried out during the fighting, many good
-and reliable men had been left behind, and replaced by others,
-stronger perhaps, but less reliable. Many went into battle with
-their children on their shoulders; it would have been better to
-choose an equally reliable man who was not burdened by having
-to drag about a wife and family.</p>
-
-<p>But it was too late now to alter anything.</p>
-
-<p>Apparently we had quite got outside the enemy’s range of
-observation. The aircraft which usually followed our marches
-were absent and no bombs fell on our camps. Once an enemy
-supply column crossed the Rovuma right into our camp. It
-was a welcome capture. Of grain we found practically none
-in this district, but on the other hand, we shot plenty of game.
-Several buffaloes and quite a number of antelopes, particularly
-Wasserbok, fell to our guns. But we dared not delay; our
-shrinking supplies urged us continually forward. Fortunately
-I had with me a few Europeans who knew the country, and
-who, shortly before, had been working near the confluence of
-the Ludjenda and the Rovuma. In peace time a Portuguese
-station had been situated there, and even in war a more or less
-strong garrison had been reported there. It might be assumed
-that even now we should find some traces of the enemy. The
-few natives we came across even spoke of a stronger garrison,
-amounting to two thousand English or Portuguese. The natives’
-figures could not, of course, be relied on, but they strengthened
-my belief that in the neighbourhood of Ngomano something
-might be done.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_226" id="Page_226">[226]</a></span></p>
-<p>&nbsp;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_227" id="Page_227">[227]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<p class="pc4 xlarge"><b>PART III</b></p>
-
-<p class="pc1 mid">FIGHTING ON FOREIGN SOIL<br />
-<span class="reduct">(From the Crossing into Portuguese East Africa to the Armistice)</span></p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_228" id="Page_228">[228]</a></span></p>
-<p>&nbsp;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_229" id="Page_229">[229]</a></span></p>
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER I<br />
-<span class="wn">ACROSS THE ROVUMA</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap06">EARLY in the morning of November 25th, 1917, our advance
-guard waded across the Rovuma, a little above the
-Ludjenda confluence; the main force of nine companies followed
-in the course of the forenoon, the rearguard about two days’
-march in the rear. Captain Goering with three companies had
-crossed much further downstream to surprise a Portuguese
-camp reported there. We had no news of Captain Tafel, and
-I thought it probable that he would strike the Rovuma much
-further west.</p>
-
-<p>The feeling that we were cut off from all support, as well as
-the absolute uncertainty as to the fate before us, had produced
-what is popularly known as “<i>allgemeine Wurschtigkeit</i>”
-(absolute callousness). Undisturbed by the tactical situation,
-our hunting parties went on with their work, and their shots
-were, as afterwards transpired, distinctly heard by the enemy.</p>
-
-<p>While crossing the river, many took a careful bath in full view
-of the enemy; in many cases it required some effort to make
-clear the requirements of the state of war.</p>
-
-<p>On the south bank we soon came under fire. The company
-acting as advance guard came upon enemy scouts, several of
-whom were killed. I employed the next few hours, while the
-troops gradually came up and covered the crossing of the rest,
-to reconnoitre. Not far from our front, on the far bank of the
-Ludjenda river, signals could be heard and men could be seen.
-We came close to the enemy camp and saw men in white suits
-moving about, a few hundred yards away. Others were building
-earthworks and a transport column was also observed.
-The troops were certainly in great force.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_230" id="Page_230">[230]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>While I was still considering whether, and in what way, a
-prospect of attack offered, a column of Askari in khaki advanced
-from the camp towards our troops. About a company of the
-enemy left the camp. Guessing that the enemy was wisely about
-to attack our troops with all his force while they were still
-occupied in crossing the river, I ran back quickly and ordered
-those of our companies who had crossed first to put themselves
-in a defensive position. The favourable opportunity I had
-hoped for did not, however, materialize: the enemy did not
-come. Thus I was again faced with the question what to do.
-I was doubtful whether, in view of our large numbers of bearers,
-it would not be more expedient to march past the enemy stationed
-here at Ngomano and advance further up the Ludjenda river.
-Either the enemy would not hinder us, or, if he did, he would
-have to emerge from his entrenched positions and make up his
-mind for a difficult attack.</p>
-
-<p>On the other hand, it was not unlikely that an attack by us
-on the enemy camp would be successful, for its defences were
-not yet especially strong. Reconnaissance had established
-that on the far bank of the Ludjenda river a belt of thick wood
-led right up to the camp and offered the opportunity of surprising
-the enemy here in strength, and bringing off a decisive
-attack. I had not yet fully made up my mind when Captain
-Müller decided me to take that one of the two decisions which,
-though very risky, offered a prospect of the long awaited decisive
-success and the capture of ammunition and war material which
-had become an urgent necessity. No time was to be lost.</p>
-
-<p>The attack was, therefore, made while part of the force was still
-crossing the river. While our light mountain-gun fired on the
-enemy’s entrenchments from the west, and while at the same
-time several companies engaged the enemy on this side as
-also from the north, Captain Koehl’s detachment crossed the
-Ludjenda half a mile above Ngomano, marched through the high
-wood on that bank and made a determined attack on the enemy’s
-camp from the south. I took up my position on a little hill
-west of the camp, near our guns. Immediately behind me the
-last company of General Wahle’s force to cross the river was<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_231" id="Page_231">[231]</a></span>
-advancing along a valley. In front I had a fairly good view
-of the enemy’s entrenched positions. The enemy’s machine guns
-were not shooting badly, and their fire was at times directed upon
-our little sand hill, from which I had to send into cover a number
-of Europeans and Askari, who had collected there immediately
-and were visible to the enemy. The clear ring of the enemy
-rifles, which we had heard before, and the absence of trench-mortars,
-made it probable that the enemy were Portuguese.
-We had already learned to distinguish clearly between the dull,
-full detonation of our ’71, the sharp crack of our S-rifle, the double
-report of the English rifle and the clear ring of the Portuguese
-rifle of a little over 6 mm. calibre. Even our Askari had noticed
-at once that in short skirmishes the speed with which the enemy
-trench-mortars always got the range of our positions had been
-very harassing.</p>
-
-<p>Our ’71 rifles threw up so much smoke that it was impossible
-to guard against this. To-day, however, there were no mine-throwers,
-and the treacherous smoke of our good old rifles was
-not so bad. On the other hand, when they did hit their target
-they made a very considerable hole. Our Askari soon realized
-that to-day they were able to bring their soldierly superiority
-to bear without being handicapped by inferior weapons. “To-day
-is the day of the old rifles!” they shouted to the German
-leaders, and from my hill I soon saw the firing line of Koehl’s
-detachment storm the enemy’s entrenchments at the double
-and capture them.</p>
-
-<p>This was the signal for attack on the other fronts also. From
-all sides they charged the enemy, who was badly shaken by the
-concentrated fire. Scarcely more than 200 of the enemy force,
-about 1,000 strong, can have survived. Again and again our
-Askari troops, in search of booty, threw themselves ruthlessly
-upon the enemy, who was still firing; in addition, a crowd of
-bearers and boys, grasping the situation, had quickly run up
-and were taking their choice of the pots of lard and other supplies,
-opening cases of jam and throwing them away again when they
-thought they had found something more attractive in other
-cases. It was a fearful <i>mêlée</i>. Even the Portuguese Askari<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_232" id="Page_232">[232]</a></span>
-already taken prisoner, joined in the plunder of their own stores.
-There was no alternative but to intervene vigorously. I became
-very eloquent, and, to make an example, dashed at least seven
-times at one bearer I knew, but each time he got away and
-immediately joined in the looting somewhere else. At last I
-succeeded in restoring discipline.</p>
-
-<p>We buried about 200 enemy dead, and about 150 European
-prisoners were released after taking an oath not to fight again
-during this war against Germany or her Allies; several hundred
-Askari were taken prisoner. Valuable medical stores, so
-necessary to us, and, as a result of the Portuguese experience of
-centuries of colonial campaigning, of excellent quality, were
-captured, as well as several thousand kilos of European supplies,
-large numbers of rifles, six machine-guns and about thirty horses.
-Unfortunately we captured no native supplies. Almost half of
-our force was re-armed this time with Portuguese rifles; and
-a plentiful supply of ammunition was served out. A quarter
-of a million rounds of ammunition were captured, and this number
-was increased in the course of December to nearly a million.
-From captured dispatches we learned that the Portuguese-European
-companies had only reached Ngomano a few days
-before, in order to carry out the impossible English order to
-prevent a German crossing of the Rovuma. It was really a
-perfect miracle that these troops should have arrived so opportunely
-as to make the capture of the place so profitable to us.
-With one blow we had freed ourselves of a great part of our
-difficulties.</p>
-
-<p>But yet another serious difficulty arose, which drove us
-remorselessly on. This was the necessity of procuring food for
-our large numbers of natives. Accordingly we advanced up the
-Ludjenda river. Day after day our patrols searched for native
-guides and supplies. During the next few days, however, they
-had little success. The natives, never numerous in this district,
-had fled before the advance of the Portuguese, fearing their
-ruthlessness and cruelty, and had hidden what stores they possessed.
-One after another, mules and horses found their way
-into our stew-pots. Fortunately this district is very rich in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_233" id="Page_233">[233]</a></span>
-game, and the hunter can always shoot one of the numerous
-antelopes or guinea-fowl.</p>
-
-<p>Though at first our marching columns were too long and
-straggling, here again practice made perfect. Bearers, boys,
-women and children, soon learned to keep pace and distance
-as exactly as the Askari. Regularly and in good order, the
-expedition wound along the narrow native paths, and even
-through the thick bush, into the unknown land. Half an hour’s
-halt was called after every two hours’ march; the rule was six
-hours’ march a day, <i>i.e.</i>, about fifteen to twenty miles, and this
-was often exceeded. The force was for the most part divided
-into detachments of three companies, each with one supply
-train and one field hospital. The advance detachment was a
-day’s march ahead of the main body, the last a day’s march
-behind. At the head of each detachment marched the fighting
-companies with their machine guns; they had with them only
-the necessary ammunition and medical stores, and each European
-was allowed one load of necessities. The Askari marched gaily
-forward, straight as lances, and with their guns reversed over
-their shoulders, as has always been the custom in the rifle regiments.
-Lively conversation was kept up, and after the plundering
-of an enemy camp, which often yielded rich booty, cigarette
-smoke rose on all sides. The little signal recruits strode bravely
-forward, half-grown youths in Askari uniform for the most
-part, carrying all their worldly goods in a bundle on their heads.
-The Askari would call out their friendly, “Jambo Bwana Obao,”
-or “Jambo Bwana Generals” (“Good-day, Colonel”), or a little
-signalman would express his hope of coming some day to Uleia
-(Europe) and Berlin. “Then the Kaiser will say to me, ‘Good-day,
-my son,’ and I shall give him an exhibition of signalling.
-Then he will give me roast meat and present me to the Empress.
-The Empress will say, ‘Good-day, my child,’ and will give me
-cakes and show me the shop-windows.” During all their talk
-the Askari kept a sharp look-out, and no movement in the thick
-bush escaped their lynx eyes.</p>
-
-<p>The head of the column investigated every trail, and from it
-gave the number and the distance of the enemy. Equally<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_234" id="Page_234">[234]</a></span>
-soldierly were the machine-gun bearers, mostly strapping
-Waniamwezi and Wazukuma. The companies and detachments
-were followed by bearers with the loads of supplies, baggage,
-camp-kit and stretcher cases. The loads, about 25 kg., were
-carried alternately on the head and shoulders. The endurance
-of these men is enormous. They became more and more attached
-to the troops. If ever the supplies were short and the hunting
-parties unsuccessful, they would say, “Haiswu’b (it doesn’t
-matter), we wait, get some another time.” Many marched
-barefoot and often got thorns in their feet. Often one would
-promptly take his knife and calmly cut out a piece of flesh from
-the wounded foot. Then he would start off again. The bearers
-were followed by the women and the Bibi. Many Askari had
-their wives and children with them in the field, and many children
-were born during the march. Each woman carried her own
-Mali (property), as well as that of her lord, on her head. Often
-they carried on their backs a small child, his woolly head peeping
-out of the cloth in which he was wound. The women were kept
-in order and protected by a European or a trustworthy old non-commissioned
-officer, assisted by a few Askari. They all liked
-gay colours, and after an important capture, the whole convoy
-stretching several miles would look like a carnival procession.</p>
-
-<p>Even during the march the obtaining of supplies had to be
-attended to. Hunting patrols marched ahead of the column or
-on the flanks in the bush. Often they would remain behind near
-the old camping sites, where game or traces of game had been
-observed. Other patrols followed human tracks leading to
-settlements to requisition supplies. On arriving at the camping-ground,
-four Askari and my boy Serubiti would cut down
-branches and erect a frame for the tent sections or for a grass-hut.
-Sometimes a raised bivouac of branches was arranged
-and covered with grass. Soon afterwards the bearded Baba,
-my cook, would arrive and give careful directions for the
-arrangement of the kitchen. The bearers would come and
-fetch water, cut grass and firewood with their bush knives.
-The hunting patrols brought in what they had shot, and soon
-the smell of cooking rose from the camp-fires on all sides. Meanwhile,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_235" id="Page_235">[235]</a></span>
-parties of bearers had been threshing in the villages, and
-brought back corn. In the Kinos (thick wooden vessels) the
-corn was crushed by beating it with thick clubs, the dull thuds
-sounding far into the bush. Messages, reconnaissance reports,
-and captured dispatches were brought in; a box in a shady spot
-served as a desk. During the longer halts a table was built of
-branches. The evening meal was eaten in company with friends
-round the camp fire, the boys bringing cases to sit on. The more
-lordly had deck-chairs. Then to bed under the mosquito-nets,
-and in the early morning once more into the unknown. Should
-we find supplies, and could we make what we had last out
-until we did? These uncertainties cropped up every day afresh,
-and haunted us week after week and month after month. The
-eternal marching was, as will be understood, no mere pleasure.
-At&mdash;&mdash; I heard some remarks about myself, such as: “Still
-further? The fellow must come from a family of country
-postmen!”</p>
-
-<p>When we reached the confluence of the Chiulezi, difficulties of
-supplies had become so serious, and the district hitherto regarded
-as fertile had so greatly altered, that I dropped my original
-intention of keeping the force together. For the moment it
-seemed impossible, from the tactical point of view also. From
-the English, who were probably following us, we need not expect
-any strong pressure, owing to the daily lengthening of their
-line of communication and the consequent difficulty of bringing
-up supplies.</p>
-
-<p>A written message from the British Commander-in-Chief,
-General van Deventer, in which he summoned me to surrender,
-was brought under protection of the white flag, and strengthened
-me in my belief that our escape had taken him by surprise, and
-that our invasion of Portuguese territory had put him at a loss.
-Neither he nor General Smuts had ever thought of sending a
-summons to surrender when the situation was favourable to
-the English. Why should they do so in a situation like the
-present, or that of September, 1916, at Kissaki, which was
-undoubtedly favourable to us? Only because they were at
-their wits’ end. That was indeed not difficult to see through.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_236" id="Page_236">[236]</a></span>
-The time before the setting in of the rainy season, at the end
-of December, was too short to prepare for a fresh operation,
-and after the rains had begun the enemy transport of supplies,
-which depended largely on motors, would be faced with new
-difficulties.</p>
-
-<p>We had, therefore, plenty of time, and could divide ourselves
-into several columns without hesitation. We had nothing to
-fear from temporary loss of touch one with the other. Accordingly
-General Wahle’s detachment was separated from the rest,
-and marched through the Mkula mountains, while I marched
-further up the Ludjenda.</p>
-
-<p>The surrender of Captain Tafel, which I learned from General
-van Deventer’s message, came as a severe and unexpected blow.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Tafel had taken over the command at Mahenge from
-General Wahle, when the latter left to take over the forces on
-the Lindi front. He secured the fertile region of Mahenge
-to the north, with Commander Schoenfeldt’s detachment of a
-few companies. The latter succeeded in holding his ground
-with his weak force by skilful use of his 10·5 gun from the
-<i>Königsberg</i>, and put his force in a very favourable position
-materially by the cultivation of gardens and fields.</p>
-
-<p>On the middle Ruhudje was a weak detachment under Captain
-Aumann, and north-east of Ssongea Captain Lincke’s detachment
-near Likuju. The latter engaged the enemy repeatedly, and in
-the barren district suffered from lack of supplies. They therefore
-gradually retired north to Mponda. There they were reinforced
-by two companies and one gun from the main force. Captain
-Otto took over the command. In August, 1917, strong English
-and Belgian forces converged on Mahenge; Captain Tafel had
-foreseen this, and withdrawn his supplies out of the Mahenge
-district to Mgangira. On September 11th, Mahenge was evacuated.
-Even though the individual engagements were often
-successful, the superiority of the enemy made itself seriously
-felt, and the shortage of ammunition handicapped more and
-more the Askari companies, mostly armed with the smoky
-’71 rifle.</p>
-
-<p>I learned later through Captain Otto, who had fought his way<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_237" id="Page_237">[237]</a></span>
-through to me with one of Captain Tafel’s patrols and joined me
-at&mdash;&mdash;, that Captain Tafel, from west of Livale, had marched
-south in three columns, and on the upper Mbemkuru had fought
-several partially successful actions, capturing large quantities
-of ammunition. He had then marched further south to the
-Bangala river, and turned east when he thought he was near
-Massassi. South of this place he heard from the natives that
-the Germans had not been fighting north of Rovuma for several
-days. Captain Tafel turned towards the Rovuma and crossed
-near the Nangala confluence, hoping to find supplies on the
-south bank. His own were literally exhausted. He found
-nothing and had no idea that about a day’s march from him
-Goering’s detachment of my force had captured the Portuguese
-camp and found enough food on the prosperous farms to enable
-them to live well for fourteen days. Captain Tafel therefore
-returned to the north bank of the Rovuma and surrendered to
-the enemy.</p>
-
-<p>The news of Captain Tafel’s surrender strengthened my
-reluctance to detach another part of my force, though, in view
-of my proximity, the junction at which we were both aiming
-had as nearly as possible been effected. I was straightway put
-upon the rack by the cessation of news from Goering’s detachment
-with which, while it was at Ngomano, we had kept touch
-by means of patrols. During the march up the Ludjenda,
-when we had to keep the different detachments and companies
-further apart, in order to facilitate the search for food, it was
-necessary to impress upon subordinate leaders the importance
-of keeping the whole force in touch. It was, however, not to
-be expected that these officers, who later performed such excellent
-work as leaders of detachments, and worked so successfully in
-co-operation with the rest, should possess the necessary training
-from the beginning. The Governor had remained with the
-force even after leaving the Protectorate, in accordance with the
-regulation (certainly not intended to provide for war with a
-European power) that he was the military head of the Protectorate.
-He had interpreted this authority in such a way as
-to interfere most seriously with that of the Commander-in-Chief,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_238" id="Page_238">[238]</a></span>
-and had often encroached upon my sphere of activity. I had
-been powerless to prevent this, and now that we were outside
-the Protectorate I attached the greatest importance to the fact
-that now, at any rate, I had a free hand. Even if I did not
-yield to the Governor’s claims, it must be understood that in the
-unprecedented military situation there were enough differences
-of opinion to overburden the Commander-in-Chief, who, whatever
-happens, is held actually, if not morally, responsible.</p>
-
-<p>It was perhaps natural that at this time I was not always
-very gentle and considerate to those around me. So it happened
-that those very officers of my Staff who were working with the
-greatest devotion to the cause and deserved the most recognition,
-were the objects of much unjustified reproach. For not
-taking offence or allowing this to prejudice the cheerful continuation
-of their work, they deserve particular gratitude. It is
-largely to the work of these officers, often carried out under
-adverse circumstances, that are due the successes which the
-public is so generously inclined to place wholly to my credit.
-For me, who have always delighted in the good comradeship
-characteristic of our officer corps, this general atmosphere of
-snarling and fault-finding was naturally not ideal. Fortunately,
-however, it was only a passing phase.</p>
-
-<p>Our position was now such that in case of an encounter with
-the enemy we could not investigate his strength. We had no
-time for prolonged reconnaissance. Perhaps this conviction,
-together with the determination with which we attacked the
-Portuguese forces whenever we met them, accounts for the
-fact that, during December, three more Portuguese fortified
-positions were taken in quick succession. Of decisive importance
-in these enterprises was the personality of the officer
-in command who first engaged the enemy. He must lose no
-time, and so could not wait for orders. On the 2nd November,
-Lieutenant Kempner, commanding the 11th Company, which
-was acting as advance-guard in the march up the Ludjenda,
-came upon a fortified Portuguese camp at Nangwale. Like
-most Portuguese camps, it lay on a bare hill, with a wide range
-of fire. The brave 11th Company at once deployed along the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_239" id="Page_239">[239]</a></span>
-edge of the bush, and advanced to the attack across three hundred
-metres of open ground exposed to the enemy’s fire. The
-Askari, who were carrying full marching kit, could not keep
-up with the company commander and his Effendi (black officer).
-Lieutenant Kempner and the Effendi leapt upon the enemy’s
-breastwork, and from there into the enemy’s entrenchments,
-and so for a time found themselves alone among the enemy
-garrison, consisting of a platoon. The latter were so dumbfounded
-that, hearing the cheers of the oncoming Askari, they
-at once obeyed the order to lay down their arms. In addition,
-a considerable ammunition dump fell into our hands, as well as
-enough rations to feed our whole force for several days. When
-the Portuguese officer invited Lieutenant Kempner to a glass of
-special brandy and found the bottle empty, its owner had further
-reason for being taken aback, but with the difference this time
-that his enemy was taken aback equally. An Ombascha (black
-lance-corporal) had the best of the joke.</p>
-
-<p>I was filled with grave anxiety about the fate of Captain
-Goering, of whom I had received no news. From General
-Wahle’s force, which had marched up the Chiulezi river, we
-heard subsequently that they had attacked and annihilated a
-force of several Portuguese companies in a strongly entrenched
-position in the Mkula mountains. The repeated attempts to
-establish communication with Wahle’s force by means of the
-heliograph did not succeed, although the Portuguese in the
-Mkula mountains had clearly observed our signals from Nangwale.
-The Portuguese Europeans captured by our detachment
-had refused to give their word not to fight against us again in
-this war. They had been sent north to the Rovuma by General
-Wahle owing to the difficulty of feeding them.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Stemmermann succeeded, after several days’ siege, in
-capturing another very strongly held and vigorously defended
-fortified position. As the storming of this offered no prospects
-of success, the enemy’s water supply was cut off, which made
-his position in the trenches untenable, and forced him to surrender.
-Among our casualties, unfortunately, were a number
-of very good native non-commissioned officers. I was not<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_240" id="Page_240">[240]</a></span>
-present at the fighting at Nangwale, as I was occupied in dealing
-with delays in the rear companies and arranging that the march
-should be kept up to the intended standard. By a double day’s
-march I easily made up for the delay this had caused me, and
-arrived in Nangwale in time to superintend the division of the
-captured stores. In the most favourable circumstances we
-were only living from hand to mouth. At Nangwale, where six
-months before our troops had found such a rich neighbourhood,
-the position was now quite different. Apart from the captured
-stores there was absolutely nothing; even the game in a considerable
-area round Nangwale had been shot or frightened
-away. This was a disappointment, for I had hoped at this
-place to be freed from the more ordinary difficulties of supplies.
-The force had, therefore, to be split up. From the information
-of the prisoners and captured documents it appeared that the
-garrison in Nangwale had been fed by columns of bearers from
-the distant neighbourhood of Mwalis. There must, then, be
-something to be found there.</p>
-
-<p>On 5th December Captain Koehl, with five companies, a gun
-and an ammunition column, left Nangwale to march to the
-Mwalia&mdash;Medo district. I myself continued the march up the
-Ludjenda. Fortunately the assurance of Lieutenant von
-Scherbening and other Europeans, who had already patrolled
-this district, that we should soon come into a region rich in
-supplies was confirmed. These supplies, however, were not
-excessive, and we were very glad that they could be largely
-supplemented by hunting. The enormous numbers of hippopotami
-which lived in the river above Nangwale, often in large
-herds of from fifteen to twenty, had become quite a staple dish.
-I myself could not resist having a shot at a huge bull; the animal
-sank at once, the water above it swirling as over a sinking ship.
-After a time it came to the surface again, feet uppermost, and
-made little further movement. The animal was then drawn to
-the bank with a rope. The numerous crocodiles made us cautious,
-and many a good prize had to be left from fear of these. The
-flesh of the hippopotamus tastes like coarse beef; the tongue,
-however, is particularly delicate. The most valuable product,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_241" id="Page_241">[241]</a></span>
-however, is the excellent lard which the men had very quickly
-learnt to prepare. Its snow-white, appetizing appearance now
-was quite different from the dirty yellow of the first attempts
-on the Rufiji. On my many reconnoitring and hunting expeditions
-into the bush the Askari, who came with me and the bearers
-to carry the spoils of the chase, gradually revealed some of the
-secrets of the bush. We had long ago learned to make excellent
-spinach from different foliage plants (called Mlenda); now
-they showed me many different kinds of excellent wild fruit.
-We also learnt that the kernel of the Mbinji-fruit, the pulp of
-which I already knew contains prussic acid, is quite free from
-acid, and when roasted makes an exceptionally delicate dish,
-tasting like our hazel-nut.</p>
-
-<p>On the 17th December, 1917, Headquarters arrived at Chirumba
-(Mtarika). Lieutenant von Ruckteschell, with his company,
-had gone on ahead and had soon driven off the weak Portuguese
-outposts. This was a station of the Portuguese Nyassa
-company; this merchant company also administered the northern
-part of the colony. Further south, too, the administration is
-in the hands of other private companies. The Portuguese
-official in Chirumba, called Fernandez, seems to have been very
-capable. The massive buildings of his station, situated at the
-top of a bare eminence, were spotlessly clean. A trench ensured
-it against surprise. Beautiful gardens with fruit and vegetables
-stretched along the bank of the adjacent Ludjenda river. Avenues
-of mulberry and mango trees fringed the carefully laid-out roads.
-Many species of this mango fruit, known to the natives as Emben,
-were to be found in the station and the neighbouring native
-villages. It was already beginning to ripen and was so plentiful
-that it was found worth while to have the fruit systematically
-gathered. The waste to which the natives are generally prone
-was prevented as far as possible. The beautiful, sweet fruit
-was enjoyed by all the Europeans and a great part of the natives,
-and, in view of the shortage of sugar, for weeks provided a really
-valuable addition to the supplies. When, on my arrival at
-Chirumba, I stepped on to the veranda of the European house,
-Lieutenant Ruckteschell set before me some hog’s lard, which<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_242" id="Page_242">[242]</a></span>
-I had not seen for a long time. Here, as at many other Portuguese
-stations, there had been European pigs.</p>
-
-<p>We remained here for several weeks. One detachment moved
-further upstream and took possession of the small station of
-Luambala. At the same time General Wahle marched to the
-prosperous station of Mwemba, already known to us. The
-richly-cultivated triangle Chirumba-Luambala-Mwemba and
-beyond the frontier was patrolled by our requisitioning and
-reconnaissance patrols. The natives of this district showed
-themselves for the most part intelligent and friendly; they
-already knew that they had nothing to fear from the German
-troops. In spite of that they had hidden their stores of food
-in the bush and would let us have little or nothing. Our men
-had, however, long since learned to examine closely, for example,
-a suspicious-looking tree stump, and often found that it had been
-put together by hand and was the hiding place for stocks of
-food. Others would drive their sticks into the hollow ground
-of a freshly laid-out garden and found stores of grain buried there.
-In short, many such hiding-places were found, and when, at
-Christmas, we sat down to dinner in a large grass-hut, we were
-relieved of the most pressing shortage of food. According to
-the descriptions of our men the Ludjenda river was, during several
-months of the year, so full of fish that they could be pulled out
-in basketfuls. Oddly enough, on this occasion only very few
-were caught. Most of them were sheat-fish, about eighteen
-inches long, and smaller fish which were best fried crisp. These,
-too, contributed their modest share towards the improvement
-of the rations.</p>
-
-<p>Touch was kept with Koehl’s detachment in the neighbourhood
-of Medo by means of a system of relays. I thought it
-probable that the enemy, following his usual tactics, was preparing
-a great concentric movement against us which would not
-be ready for at least a month. We could thus rely on there
-being no considerable enemy activity until after the rains, which
-would end at the end of February. About this time I intended
-to concentrate my forces in the neighbourhood of Nanungu.
-Until then we must husband our supplies in this area and live<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_243" id="Page_243">[243]</a></span>
-as far as possible on what could be obtained in the outer fringe
-of our present locality. At first there was not much game
-shot at Chirumba, but the bag increased when we found considerable
-herds of antelopes on the east bank of the Ludjenda,
-and particularly further upstream. During the remainder of
-the dry season, while the river was low, caravans of bearers were
-continually crossing the river by several fords, carrying their
-loads to the dumps on the east bank. As well as the fords,
-canoes made from hollowed tree-trunks were used for crossing.
-Patrols were sent out for weeks at a time to collect supplies
-and reconnoitre. Lieutenant von Scherbening, with his patrol,
-made an expedition lasting months, marching from Chirumba
-via Mtenda, Mahua and finally south, via the Lurio river, then
-up the Malema, where they surprised the Portuguese Boma
-Malema. An Italian, who had been hunting elephants on the
-Ludjenda and had joined us in a ragged, starving condition,
-accompanied Lieutenant von Scherbening’s patrol. The man’s
-health was, however, so undermined by lingering malaria and his
-spleen so terribly swollen that he had to be carried from Mahua
-to a plantation near Malacotera.</p>
-
-<p>At the beginning of January, 1918, the English began to move.
-From the south-east corner of Lake Nyassa two battalions&mdash;the
-1st and 2nd King’s African Rifles&mdash;began to advance towards
-Captain Goering’s detachment, which had joined up with us
-and occupied the acute angle between the Luhambala and
-Ludjenda rivers. He was covering the supply stores further up
-the Ludjenda. On 9th January, in the forenoon, a detachment of
-the enemy, attacking unsupported, was defeated. When, in
-the afternoon, the enemy returned to the attack after the arrival
-of his reinforcements, and at the same time an enemy force pressed
-forward in a northerly direction toward the supply dumps on
-the east bank, Captain Goering crossed to the east bank with
-the main part of his force. Only a strong patrol was left in the
-old camp on the west bank, and they held the enemy in check.
-At the same time an enemy force&mdash;the 2nd Cape Corps of South
-African half-breeds was identified&mdash;was advancing on Mwembe.</p>
-
-<p>Then began innumerable small skirmishes and patrol actions,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_244" id="Page_244">[244]</a></span>
-which often put us in an awkward position, owing to our inability
-to protect the bearers bringing up supplies. The English cleverly
-took advantage of these difficulties to try to undermine the
-loyalty of our Askari. Many were very war-weary. Added
-to this, there was in many cases the feeling of uncertainty as to
-where the campaign was going to lead them. The great majority
-of black men cling to their homes and their relations. They
-said to themselves: “If we go further we shall come into country
-we don’t know. We can find our way back from where we are
-now, but soon we shan’t be able to.” The English propaganda,
-by word of mouth and pamphlets, fell in many cases on fruitful
-ground, and, as a result, a number of good Askari and even older
-non-commissioned officers deserted. Small annoyances, such
-as are bound to arise&mdash;the persuasion of the women and so on&mdash;all
-contributed to their decision to desert. One old <i>sol</i> (native
-sergeant-major) suddenly disappeared, who had led a brilliant independent
-patrol and had brought a strong detachment of bearers
-with their loads right through the enemy lines, and for his good
-service had been promoted to “Effendi.” He, too, had deserted.
-The impulsiveness of the black makes him very sensitive to
-insinuation. But even if the English Colonel can boast of having
-lowered the <i>moral</i> of certain elements, this was only a passing
-phase. The old lust of battle and the old loyalty returned,
-even among those who had begun to hang their heads. The
-example of the faithful Askari, who simply laughed at the mountains
-of gold the English promised them if they would desert,
-won the day. In so long and trying a campaign the <i>moral</i>
-was bound to be low from time to time. It was no use to be
-astonished and discouraged, the important thing was to fight
-against it firmly, and for this the loyal elements, of which there
-were many, both among Europeans, Askari and bearers, had
-firmly made up their minds.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_245" id="Page_245">[245]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER II<br />
-<span class="wn">EAST OF THE LUDJENDA</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">THE patrol of Captain Otto, who had been sent from Captain
-Tafel to me after the latter’s surrender, and gave me
-details about the events leading up to it, had arrived at Chirumba.
-Captain Otto, with two additional companies, now marched to
-Luambala and took over the command also of Goering’s detachment
-(three companies). As was expected, the main pressure
-of the enemy was felt at Luambala, as also on the east bank of
-the Ludjenda. It was clear that if the enemy advanced downstream
-my position at Chirumba on the west bank of the river,
-in a district where the supplies were being gradually exhausted,
-and with the river swollen by the rains in my rear, was extremely
-unfavourable.</p>
-
-<p>It was necessary to evacuate this position and to move my
-force, while there was time, to the east bank of the Ludjenda.
-Unfortunately the fords were impassable, owing to the height of
-the river, so that the whole crossing had to be effected by means
-of the three canoes available.</p>
-
-<p>Gradually, and without interference, the companies were
-transferred to the east bank. The supply question was beginning
-to become very serious. Fortunately Captain Koehl, who, in
-the neighbourhood of Medo and Namunu, had kept the very
-intelligent natives to the cultivation of the quickly ripening
-grain, reported that a good harvest could be relied on as early
-as the middle of February. But that was not for another month,
-so we should have to try by every possible means to hold out a
-bit longer at Chirumba. Welcome as the manna to the children
-of Israel, the fungi which shoot up at this season helped to keep
-us from starvation. I had already in Germany interested<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_246" id="Page_246">[246]</a></span>
-myself in mycology, and soon found fungi closely related to our
-German species of mushrooms and yellow boleta and others, in
-the African bush. I had often gathered basketfuls in a very
-short time, and even though an excessive diet of mushrooms is
-indigestible and not very sustaining, they were a considerable
-help.</p>
-
-<p>In torrential rain we marched east. The usually dry ravines
-had become raging torrents. Trees, felled in such a way as to
-fall over the stream, formed bridges, a hand-rail being improvised
-from poles or bark lashed together. The mule I was riding on
-account of fever&mdash;I am apparently very sensitive to malaria,
-from which I suffered a great deal&mdash;as well as the few other
-riding animals that had not found their way into the cooking-pot
-swam across. When we arrived at the camping ground my
-men soon built me, on account of the damp, a raised shelter
-of branches over which both my tent-cloths were laid as a roof.
-Veterinary Surgeon Huber, who was responsible for the material
-welfare of the staff, and under him our capable black cook, old
-bearded Baba, at once got to work and, no matter how wet
-the wood, we were always able in a short time to sit down to our
-meal beside the camp-fire. Dr. Huber often managed even to
-have a grass roof erected for our protection.</p>
-
-<p>On sunny days tobacco was eagerly dried and cut. The
-efficient Quartermaster-Lieutenant Besch, who was full of resource
-where the comfort of the men was concerned, had thought of this
-and had collected very good tobacco from the natives. But
-in spite of everything the deprivations were very great and the
-insidious whisperings of the enemy, that every native who deserted
-should be free to go home and there live in comfort on his own
-land, did not always fall on deaf ears. Even the faithful boy
-of one of our officers, whom he had served for years, had one
-morning disappeared; probably his Bibi (wife) had had
-enough of campaigning.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Otto’s detachment marched from Uambala due east
-to Mahua, and there, on the Lurio river, found a district rich
-in supplies. Goering’s detachment, marching from Luambala
-across country to Mtende, found considerable supplies on the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_247" id="Page_247">[247]</a></span>
-way. In this district the harvest was very much earlier than in
-German East Africa; the maize was beginning to ripen and could
-to a large extent already be eaten. Headquarters next moved
-from Chirumba to Mtende and, some days later, on to Nanungu.
-Wahle’s detachment, which had followed us from Chirumba
-to Mtende, was here cut off by several enemy companies which
-appeared unexpectedly on a height on their rear and interrupted
-the messenger service and the transport. General Wahle extricated
-himself by a détour from this uncomfortable position
-and advanced nearer to Headquarters at Nanungu.</p>
-
-<p>At Nanungu we found abundant supplies and we thought it
-expedient, as before, to establish requisitioning stations and supply
-dumps in the district between Nanungu and Namunu and further
-south. There was good shooting, and the natives readily brought
-garden produce and honey to exchange for meat or, preferably,
-clothing. Very welcome was a delicate sweet, cherry-like Pori
-fruit, which ripened in millions in the neighbourhood of Nanungu.
-I preferred to have it made into jam. We also occasionally
-obtained other dainties, particularly pig-nuts, and the crowing
-of cocks proclaimed far and wide that there were fowls and eggs
-in the camps and among the natives.</p>
-
-<p>The setting in of the rainy season did not quite coincide with
-the forecasts of the natives. There were some sharp downpours,
-but in the undulating country the water quickly ran off and
-collected in the main artery of that region, the Msalu river, which
-was soon swollen so as to form a strong obstacle. Over the
-Msalu river the post-service official, Hartmann, who had joined
-the force as a Sergeant-Major, had built a pontoon bridge which
-connected us with General Wahle’s force, which was still on the
-west bank. The floating supports of the bridge were boats
-made from bark. The necessity in this well-watered country
-of being able to cross the swollen rivers without difficulty had
-drawn my attention to this question. Hitherto our sole provision
-for such contingencies consisted of a few hollowed canoes.
-Their continued transport, however, was too difficult and their
-capacity too limited. A planter named Gerth, who had joined
-us as a volunteer, interested himself particularly in this matter<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_248" id="Page_248">[248]</a></span>
-and had himself instructed by the natives of the district in the
-building of boats from bark. The ensuing experiments soon
-produced good results, after which the building of these boats,
-which took barely two hours to put together, for crossing rivers
-was enthusiastically taken up by every company. Most of these
-boats were not used, but they gave us a feeling of security that,
-if necessary, even a full stream would not be impassable for our
-unwieldy caravans and baggage.</p>
-
-<p>When we became better acquainted with the neighbourhood,
-we found fords over the Msalu which could be used even when the
-river was in flood. Our patrols, in charge of Sergeant Valett
-and others, left our fortified camp at Nanungu, crossed the river
-which formed the boundary of our camp on the west, and went
-to look for the enemy in his camps at Mtenda. One of these
-patrols, which was particularly strong and armed with two
-machine guns, succeeded in surprising an enemy column west of
-Mtenda. Our men, however, did not get away quickly enough
-to escape the enemy’s covering force and, attacked from all
-sides, found themselves in a difficult position. Both machine
-guns were lost and the Europeans working them fell. Gradually
-the Askari all returned to Nanungu, but the patrol leader, Sergeant-Major
-Musslin, who had got away from the rest during the
-march, had fallen into the enemy’s hands. Another patrol, with
-which Captain Müller crossed the Msalu to the north, quickly
-drove off an English outpost at Lusinje. In the neighbourhood
-of Lusinje, also the camp of the English, Lieutenant Wienholt,
-who, as has already been mentioned, escaped from arrest and
-became one of the best English patrol leaders, was captured.
-The natives were thoroughly exploited by the English patrols
-and acted as spies for the enemy in return for articles of clothing.
-The volunteer, Gerth, who has been mentioned in connection with
-boat-building, was attacked and killed by an English patrol
-while in the house of a native chief.</p>
-
-<p>In the second half of March, 1918, our spirits were greatly
-raised by the news, received by our wireless, of the powerful
-German March offensive on the Western front. I laid a wager
-with the Staff Medical Officer, Staff-Surgeon Taute, that Amiens<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_249" id="Page_249">[249]</a></span>
-would soon fall. I used the period of rest that now set in
-for several weeks during the lull in our operations to have my
-foot attended to. It had been bitten by a sand-fly, and for the
-last six months had caused me inconvenience. These sand-flies,
-which infested many of the camps, bore their way into the flesh,
-round the edge of the toe-nails, causing painful inflammation. If
-care is not taken they attack the flesh round them and, according
-to medical opinion, the maiming of the feet frequent among
-the natives is very often to be traced to the sand-fly. I, too, was
-suffering from this inconvenience, and on the march the inflammation
-constantly recurred. Fortunately Staff-Surgeon Taute,
-using a local anæsthetic, was able to extract the nail.</p>
-
-<p>I was also inconvenienced in another way. On a reconnoitring
-expedition a blade of the tall grass, which grows above a man’s
-height, had pierced my right eye. During the subsequent
-treatment it was feared that the use of the lens might be affected
-by atropia; the result was that I could not see properly with
-my right eye and was unable to read hand-writing or sketch-maps.
-This was very awkward, as my left eye had been so seriously injured
-by a shot wound received during the Hottentot rebellion
-in South-West Africa, that I could only see through it with the
-help of spectacles. Suitable spectacles could not, however, be
-obtained, and so I was compelled to carry out various enterprises
-without being able to see properly.</p>
-
-<p>The patrols of Koehl’s detachment in the Medo-Nanungu district
-had meanwhile reached the coast, after taking Portuguese
-fortresses on, and far south of, the lower Lurio river, and carrying
-off a few guns and, what was more important, rifles, ammunition
-and considerable supplies. The natives showed themselves very
-friendly towards our men, whom they regarded as their deliverers
-from Portuguese oppression. Patrols from Otto’s detachment
-from Mahua had also reconnoitred as far as the region south of
-the Lurio. Lieutenant Methner, so experienced in the ways of
-the natives, and first <i>referant</i> of our government, praised the capacity
-and cleverness of the Portuguese natives and the intelligence
-and far-sightedness of their local chiefs.</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant von Scherbening, who with his patrol had taken<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_250" id="Page_250">[250]</a></span>
-the Boma Malema, reported that this neighbourhood was very
-productive. As a specimen he sent us a captured pig to Nanungu.
-As it refused to walk it was carried the 500 km. Unfortunately
-it turned out eventually not to be a European pig at all, but
-a Pori pig, like those we frequently shot in the bush.</p>
-
-<p>Once more a time had come when it was difficult to obtain
-news of the enemy, but a good deal could be conjectured from
-the incomplete maps at our disposal. I could have no doubt
-that the imminent enemy operations would be launched from
-the neighbourhood of Port Amelia with their main force from the
-coast. The appearance of strong enemy forces at Mtende, as
-well as the report, unconfirmed it is true, that troops were on the
-march from the south-west towards Mahua, showed me that other
-troops from the west were going to co-operate with the approaching
-attack of the enemy main force. A situation seemed to be
-developing in which I could make use of my inner line to attack
-one part of the enemy singly. The enemy’s position with regard
-to reserves and supplies made it obvious that the columns
-marching from the west could not be over strong. This seemed
-to be the chance I had so long been awaiting. I, therefore,
-remained with my main force at Nanungu and also recalled
-Captain Otto’s detachment from Lurio. With these forces I
-intended to assume the offensive in a westerly direction. Captain
-Koehl, whose detachment was assembled at Medo, was charged
-with the duty of holding up the enemy’s main force advancing
-from Port Amelia and retiring gradually on my force.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Müller, who, after years of work at Headquarters, had
-taken over an independent detachment of two companies, was
-sent on from the neighbourhood of Nanungu to Mahua to harass
-the enemy as far as possible. He passed round Mahua and
-surprised, south-west of this place, the fortified supply depot of
-Kanene. The defending English European troops saw that all
-the stores were lost. To prevent this, at least to some extent, they
-fell upon the stores of liquor in the camp and were captured in a
-thoroughly intoxicated condition.</p>
-
-<p>For myself, I, likewise, advanced in the middle of April in the
-direction of Mahua, and during the march could hear from afar<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_251" id="Page_251">[251]</a></span>
-heavy sounds of firing. At Koriwa, north-east of Mahua, Captain
-Müller had attacked an enemy battalion under Colonel Barton,
-which had been making a reconnoitring expedition and was at
-once attacked by our troops on the march. In spite of the fact
-that on our side scarcely 70 rifles took part in the action, our
-troops succeeded in enveloping the enemy’s right wing, and
-from a large ant-hill poured upon him such a vigorous and effective
-machine-gun fire that he fled wildly. He lost over 40 men
-in this action. Lieutenant-Commander Wunderlich, who had
-received a severe wound through the abdomen, had to be taken
-to the hospital at Nanungu, two days’ march distant, and died
-shortly afterwards.</p>
-
-<p>The blow which I had intended to strike with the main force
-had already been successfully carried through by Müller’s weak
-detachment. I, therefore, turned with my main force to the
-district west of Nanungu. A large force of the enemy had
-arrived meanwhile on the Msalu river and had crossed it with
-several patrols. My calculation that I should be able to surprise
-a strong body of the enemy immediately after crossing the river
-was not fulfilled: the reports received had been incorrect. However,
-in a whole series of minor engagements on the Msalu river
-and further west our fighting patrols inflicted, gradually, severe
-losses on the enemy and his patrols soon evacuated the east bank
-of the Msalu. On 3rd May our supply patrols, whose duty it
-was to obtain further supplies from the direction of Mahua, surprised,
-in the neighbourhood of Saidi, strong enemy detachments
-which were seriously threatening our field hospital and supply
-depots at Makoti.</p>
-
-<p>Part of our stores had been brought to Makoti in readiness for
-the operations planned to be carried out further west. Our
-fighting patrols, which were sent out immediately, had several
-encounters with the enemy near the Kireka mountain at Makoti.
-I thought at first that these were only enemy patrols, so sent
-Captain Schulz there with a strong patrol as a reinforcement,
-and myself marched on the 4th of May, with the main body, to
-the Nanungu-Mahua road. From here I expected to be able
-to carry out a swift attack on the enemy forces, which were trying<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_252" id="Page_252">[252]</a></span>
-to surprise us somewhere in this neighbourhood. The general
-situation was made clear when it was known that patrols had,
-in the course of the day, encountered a new enemy near the
-Kireka mountain. An enemy detachment had been thrown
-back and it was probable that strong forces were in entrenched
-positions in the rear. In the morning of the 5th May I marched
-from my camp to Makoti. During the march I hoped sincerely
-that the enemy would spare us the necessity of making the attack
-on his fortified positions and that, as in view of the general situation
-was not improbable, he would emerge from his entrenchments
-and offer battle in the open. If this happened, and we
-succeeded in attacking with our main force before the
-enemy was aware of our arrival, a considerable success was
-probable.</p>
-
-<p>At eleven o’clock in the forenoon I arrived at the Kireka
-mountain and went on ahead to see Captain Schulz who, with
-his patrol, had occupied some rocky grottos in the copse. As
-soon as I had arrived a <i>sol</i> (native Sergeant-Major), who had just
-returned from a patrol expedition, reported that the enemy was
-advancing in great force and must soon appear at close quarters.
-I passed on this report to Lieutenant Boell, who had just brought
-up his company in the rear of Schulz’s detachment, and instructed
-him to go up at once in case of an enemy attack. I then went
-back and ordered the advance of our companies which were
-gradually arriving. Meanwhile the fighting in front began.
-The enemy, advancing in close order, had quickly thrown back
-our patrols out of the grottos, but had then been completely
-taken by surprise by the effective machine-gun fire of Boell’s
-company and partially driven back. Goering’s detachment,
-coming up at that moment, began an enveloping movement
-on the right, completely surprising the enemy, who was rapidly
-driven back with very heavy losses.</p>
-
-<p>After several miles of hot pursuit we reached the enemy’s
-entrenchments. On our left wing, where two more companies
-had been sent into action, the fight wavered, and it was difficult
-for me in the thick bush to distinguish friend and foe. It was,
-therefore, some time before I could get a clear idea of the situation<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_253" id="Page_253">[253]</a></span>
-on the left wing, and it was not until I received a report
-from Major Kraut, whom I had sent to investigate, that I realized
-that, in advancing, our left wing had come under a withering
-enemy fire in a clearing which had brought it to a standstill.
-A counter-attack by the enemy, which had brought him very near
-to the position of our Headquarters, looked very dangerous.
-Fortunately for us, however, just at this moment Lieutenant
-Buechsel, whose company had been detached from the main
-force and so arrived late, came upon the scene of action and was
-able to avert the danger.</p>
-
-<p>Meanwhile, on the right wing, Captain Goering had realized
-that a frontal attack on the enemy entrenchment offered no
-prospect of success. He had, therefore, sent Lieutenant Meier
-with a strong patrol round the enemy’s position to fire on the
-enemy mine-thrower from the rear and if possible to capture it.
-This capture was not brought off, for the enemy had at his disposal
-unexpected reserves which were able to keep Meier’s patrol
-at a distance.</p>
-
-<p>The action thus came to a standstill. When it had grown
-quite dark we were close in front of the enemy. Shots were
-still being exchanged from both sides, but only occasionally.
-The clerical work&mdash;even in Africa there was writing to be done,
-though not as much as is usually the case&mdash;was postponed
-during the fighting. A number of charges and other tiresome
-details had to be written up. I was able from time to time to
-talk personally with the company leaders, and called them
-together for this purpose. I changed my own position as little
-as possible to avoid difficulties and annoying delays in the dispatch
-and receipt of messages. A meal was cooked further in
-the rear, where the dressing station had also been established.
-We at Headquarters had our meal prepared as usual by our black
-servants, who brought it up to the firing-line.</p>
-
-<p>In order to get the force in hand ready for further action,
-some parts of it were withdrawn from the front line and mustered.
-I came to the conclusion that it would be expedient to remain
-where we were for the night, to be in readiness to renew the
-action on the following day, and especially to cut the enemy off<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_254" id="Page_254">[254]</a></span>
-from his water-supply, which must be somewhere outside the
-camp.</p>
-
-<p>About midnight it was reported that one of our patrols had
-encountered a strong enemy force on the Nanungu-Mahua road.
-I was afraid that this force, which I took to be strong in view of
-its independent movement, would advance further on Nanungu
-and capture our company’s stores (ammunition, medical stores,
-supplies, etc.), which were on this road as well as the depot
-at Nanungu. I therefore withdrew during the night with the
-greater part of my force, via Makoti, to the Nanungu-Mahua
-road. Only strong patrols remained in front of the enemy,
-but these did not notice that the enemy, too, evacuated his
-position during the night and withdrew towards Mahua. On
-6th May it became apparent that the report of strong enemy
-forces on the Nanungu-Mahua road, which had caused my
-retirement, was incorrect. There was no enemy there. Captain
-Müller, hearing the firing of the English trench-mortars, had,
-with admirable initiative, immediately begun a forced march
-from his camp north-east of Mahua, towards the sound and
-had apparently been taken for the enemy.</p>
-
-<p>When he arrived on the battlefield he found that the enemy
-had retired. The enemy, consisting of four companies and a
-machine-gun company, and to judge from his fortifications a
-thousand strong, had been completely defeated by our force
-of little more than 200 rifles&mdash;we were 62 Europeans and 342
-Askari. He had lost 14 Europeans and 91 Askari killed,
-3 Europeans and 3 Askari taken prisoner. In addition, his
-hospital with about 100 wounded had fallen into our hands,
-and according to the natives he had taken other wounded with
-him. Our casualties were: 6 Europeans, 24 Askari, 5 other
-natives killed; 10 Europeans, 67 Askari and 28 other natives
-wounded.</p>
-
-<p>While this gratifying success against the enemy’s western
-columns was being attained, Koehl’s detachment had been
-engaged in continuous fighting, often on a considerable scale,
-against the enemy divisions which were advancing on Nanungu
-from Port Amelia. At Medo the enemy, according to his own<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_255" id="Page_255">[255]</a></span>
-statement, suffered heavy losses in one engagement west of
-Medo. Captain Spangenberg, with his two companies, had
-succeeded in getting round the enemy, falling on and capturing
-from the rear his light field howitzer battery. Nearly all the
-men and horses of this battery were killed. Unfortunately it
-was not possible to remove the guns and ammunition. They
-were rendered useless. But in spite of this individual success,
-Koehl’s detachment had to retire. The moment was approaching
-when the timely intervention of my main force with Koehl’s
-detachment might bring about a decisive success against General
-Edwards. Once more, however, the question of supplies dragged
-our movements. The crops of the district had all been consumed,
-except the Mtama, which ripens much earlier in this
-country than in German East Africa. But it was not yet ripe.
-In order to avoid having to withdraw simply for reasons of
-supply, we ripened the Mtama artificially by drying it. This
-made the grain quite edible, and as there was plenty of it in the
-district everyone got as much as he wanted, and there was no
-want.</p>
-
-<p>The condition of the crops prompted me to march with the
-main body of the force further south-west, in the direction of
-Mahua, and pitch my camp beside the Koroma mountain, not
-far from the Timbani mountain. I intended, if necessary, to
-march further south, to avail myself of the abundant crops in
-the fertile districts near the confluence of the Malma and Lurio
-rivers. West of the Timbani mountain the country was favourable
-for a decisive action against General Edwards, who was
-following Captain Koehl’s detachment south-west from Nanungu.
-The extraordinarily rocky and broken country near the mountain,
-and four miles north-east of it, as far as the place to which
-Koehl’s detachment had retired, was not favourable for the
-decisive attack I had in view. On 21st May smoke indicated
-fresh enemy camps west of the positions of Koehl’s detachment.
-I guessed that this new enemy would march on 22nd May to
-take Koehl’s detachment in the rear from the west. Unfortunately
-I omitted to give Koehl’s detachment definite<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_256" id="Page_256">[256]</a></span>
-orders to withdraw their main force immediately from the
-unfavourable country to the south-west of the Timbani mountain.
-Instead of a positive order I gave him instructions which
-left him too much freedom of action.</p>
-
-<p>Thus it came about that Koehl’s detachment did not get
-their bearers with the ammunition and baggage on the march
-until the forenoon of the 22nd of May. Even then all would
-have been well if the Governor, who had attached himself to
-Koehl’s division, had not marched at their head. Not understanding
-the seriousness of the situation, he made a considerable
-halt in the middle of this unfavourable country, where he was
-exposed to a surprise attack from the enemy at any moment,
-without being able to put up an effective defence. The bearers
-of Koehl’s detachment, in spite of Captain Koehl’s orders, allowed
-themselves to halt likewise. During the morning of this day,
-I once more personally reconnoitred the very favourable country
-south-west of the Timbani mountain, and met, among others,
-Lieutenant Kempner, who had been wounded the day before
-with Koehl’s detachment and carried to the rear. From Koehl’s
-detachment itself, where, since the morning, several enemy
-attacks had been beaten off, sounds of distant fighting were to
-be heard. There was telephonic communication with Captain
-Koehl, and I returned about 11 a.m. to the Koroma camp without
-having any idea of the situation of his transport. At noon I
-had just entered the camp when suddenly there was a loud sound
-of firing, from a very short distance, of trench-mortars, beyond
-doubt between us and Koehl’s detachment. Immediately
-afterwards telephonic communication in that direction was
-broken off. There was no alternative but to march my whole
-force immediately from the Koroma camp against this new
-enemy. I secretly hoped that, in spite of the unfavourable
-country, we might perhaps succeed in taking him by surprise,
-and in inflicting a decisive defeat. Barely an hour later we
-reached the Timbani mountain and quickly threw back the
-advanced detachment of the enemy. A few scattered men
-reported that the Governor and Captain Koehl’s transport had
-been surprised by the enemy and all the baggage lost. The
-Governor himself had only just managed to get away; others
-said he had been taken prisoner. The enemy had opened a
-fairly lively fire with several mine-throwers, and was attacked by
-our companies from several sides. He had, however, taken up
-a good position, in which he entrenched himself and had hidden
-part of the captured baggage. Unfortunately we only recaptured
-a small quantity. But the enemy position was surrounded
-and subjected to a concentrated and gruelling fire. According
-to a dispatch captured later, the 1st King’s African Rifles alone
-lost about two hundred men.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-256.jpg" width="400" height="552" id="i256"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc400">Native Types (5).<br />
-<span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-257a.jpg" width="400" height="535" id="i257"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <div class="caption"><p class="pc400">Native Types (6).<br />
-<span class="wn2">(From a drawing by General von Lettow-Vorbeck’s Adjutant.)</span></p>
-</div></div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_257" id="Page_257">[257]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-257b.jpg" width="400" height="285" id="m257"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pc">Fig. xviii. The Action at the Kireka Mts.</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>Several companies and patrols of Captain Koehl’s detachment
-took part in this envelopment of the enemy. Captain Koehl
-himself had turned his main force against the new enemy, attacking
-his rear, and hoped to be able to defeat him while a strong
-patrol facing north-east held his former enemy in check. This
-patrol, however, was much too weak. It was pressed back, and
-had again to be reinforced with troops from Captain Koehl’s
-detachment. Even though the enemy had without doubt
-suffered on the whole considerable losses, a decisive success
-was unattainable. The fighting was broken off at dark, and we<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_258" id="Page_258">[258]</a></span>
-withdrew to the favourable country I had reconnoitred between
-the Timbani and Koroma mountains.</p>
-
-<p>Meanwhile the Governor had found his way to the camp by
-the Koroma mountain. He had lost all his belongings in the
-adventure, and was looked after by Heder, a non-commissioned
-officer, and the trustworthy and cautious leader of the supply
-column. I, too, came up to help the Governor in his adversity,
-and honoured him with a pair of blue socks, which his wife
-had made me at the beginning of the war, but which unfortunately
-had faded.</p>
-
-<p>Apart from the serious loss of about 70,000 rounds of ammunition,
-we had also lost a considerable amount of notes&mdash;I believe
-it was 30,000 rupees. My desire to give requisition notes in preference
-to bank notes, and so save a lot of transport of securities
-and avoid unnecessary losses, had not been acceded. Millions
-of rupee notes had been printed, the dragging about of which,
-in the present war situation, was particularly burdensome.
-In order, at least, to avoid similar losses in the future, the
-Quartermaster, on my instructions, destroyed a great part of
-the notes which had been obtained with so much trouble.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_259" id="Page_259">[259]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER III<br />
-<span class="wn">IN THE REGION OF THE LURIO AND LIKUNGO RIVERS</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap08">ON May 23rd the rest of our transport and the main body of
-the troops were started off from Coroma camp on a track
-right through the bush to Koriwa. The bulk of our carrier
-columns and the sick had gone on ahead. The rearguard under
-Captain Otto remained a few days longer on the Koroma Mountain
-and there successfully repulsed several hostile attacks.
-It looked as if our enemy had once again collected the bulk of
-his troops at Timbani, after the conclusion of a concentric operation,
-and needed some time to reorganize his supply before
-resuming his march. Returning patrols reported heavy motor
-traffic on the Nanungu-Timbani Mountain road. Other patrols
-informed us that hostile forces from the east were approaching
-the northern bank of the Lurio river.</p>
-
-<p>Unmolested by the enemy, I now made for the fertile district
-of Kwiri, south of Mahua, and from thence on to the Lurio. It
-turned out, however, that some of our seriously wounded and sick
-would not be able to endure several days of such marches in their
-“Maschille” (litters). Nor was it easy to ensure medical attention.
-We had too few attendants to be able to leave the sick
-behind individually. So there was nothing for it but to collect
-our invalids from time to time, turn them into a complete Field
-Hospital, under a single medical officer, and take our leave of
-them finally. Even the senior medical officer of the Protective
-Force, Dr. Meixner, was left behind at Kwiri with one such
-hospital. On that occasion I said farewell to Lieutenant Schaefer
-who had rendered us such exemplary service in the preparations
-for the action at Jassini, and was now stricken with black-water<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_260" id="Page_260">[260]</a></span>
-fever. This experienced “African” was fully aware of his situation,
-but was as cheerful as ever and faced his inevitable end,
-which was approaching fast, with composure.</p>
-
-<p>I did not wish to linger long north of the Lurio, for I thought
-that this river, which had been very high only a short time before,
-would be a serious obstacle. For that reason I proposed to
-cross it with our large quantity of transport quickly and without
-let or hindrance. When we actually reached the Lurio it
-appeared that at this time of the year there were plenty of fords
-which offered a comfortable crossing. We left some of our troops
-on the northern bank without anxiety as to the drawbacks involved,
-and established a camp for the main body on the southern
-bank. The country was very fertile and the inhabitants trusted
-in us; good relations had been established by the earlier visits
-of the patrols and raiding parties. One of my orderlies had a
-hearty reception from some old acquaintances.</p>
-
-<p>I was pretty sure that the English would attack us here and
-be compelled to bring up ever more troops. If I only withdrew
-slowly enough, the strong enemy forces would, I believed, probably
-follow, but in view of their immense supply difficulties,
-it would be in vain. In this way I might achieve my main purpose
-of gaining enough time to raid the weaker hostile camps
-and posts further south. Captain Müller’s detachment, which
-had been sent south, discovered one such camp at Malema, the
-same place where our troops had won heartening successes
-before.</p>
-
-<p>After fighting for several days Captain Müller captured the
-Boma Malema. It had been occupied by an English half-battalion
-which retired south at night. Simultaneously a Portuguese
-patrol had gone north from the Boma Malema and returned.
-Captain Müller took the latter for the retreating English, attacked
-them on the march and was very astonished to find that the
-killed were Portuguese.</p>
-
-<p>After the action Captain Müller shifted his camp. In the move,
-Lieutenant von Schroetter, who was ill with malaria, was left
-behind for a short time and taken prisoner by an English patrol
-which suddenly appeared upon the scene. When this patrol<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_261" id="Page_261">[261]</a></span>
-marched off to the Boma Inagu he managed to escape, and rejoined
-us at length, quite exhausted. But he lost all his belongings,
-and had nothing on his head&mdash;a very serious matter under a
-tropical sun.</p>
-
-<p>From the reports of the natives and our own patrols there was
-no longer room for doubt that strong enemy forces, which had
-disembarked at Mozambique, were marching west on the Boma
-Malema, and were already only a few days’ march from that
-place. Simultaneous reports were received that troops were also
-marching towards the Boma Malema from the west, the direction
-of Malacotera. A few days later the enemy following us from
-the north reached the Lurio, so we evacuated its northern bank.
-From captured documents and the fighting that took place on
-the northern bank, we judged that this hostile force was stronger
-than I had suspected. Thanks to its light motor transport
-columns it had been able to follow us up quickly with all its supply
-as well as a body which I estimated at about three or four battalions
-with auxiliary arms.</p>
-
-<p>The country along the river Malema in which we had our
-camp was quite extraordinarily fertile. The <i>mtama</i> was perfectly
-ripe, and there was an abundance of tomatoes, bananas,
-sweet potatoes (<i>batatas</i>) and other fruits. The food was also
-very varied. Game and fish were plentiful. The natives knew
-the German troops from previous acquaintance, and were very
-friendly. When I rode from one detachment to another the
-women came running out of their houses to see the “Njama”
-(animal, game, flesh), a creature quite unknown to them. I
-was riding a horse, of course! The fertile country was so
-extensive that we could not even approximately exploit or protect
-it. We could not prevent it supplying the necessities of life to
-the large number of Askari and non-combatants with our enemies,
-as well as ourselves. We could not deprive the enemy of the
-possibility of also making this prolific region in a large measure
-into a new base and shortening his line of supply. From our
-point of view the country was, if anything, too fertile and we were
-not in a position, as on earlier occasions, to exploit it to such an
-extent before we left that it was insufficient to support the enemy<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_262" id="Page_262">[262]</a></span>
-masses. But at any rate it had the result that for the moment
-we were very mobile as, thanks to our sojourn of several
-weeks, our wounded and sick were so far recovered that all,
-even the inmates of the field hospitals, were quite fit for
-marching.</p>
-
-<p>This advantage would have been lost once more by any considerable
-actions. I decided gradually to evacuate the region,
-in spite of its extraordinary fertility, and slip through the ring
-in which the enemy columns were enclosing me in the fertile district
-of the Malema river. My idea was that a small part of my troops
-should hold off these enemy columns and keep them so busy
-that they would think they were involved in a serious affair,
-and attack my rearguard properly. In coming to this decision,
-good service was done me by the orders of the English commander
-which had fallen into our hands. He had no intention of being
-“foxed” by us a second time, as he had been at Koriwa, and had
-therefore arranged that whenever contact was established with
-us at any point, several detachments should immediately execute
-a flank march round us at a distance of five or six English miles.
-I told General Edwards about this later on, and he was extraordinarily
-amused that this had given me an intimation of his
-intentions, and enabled me to take my counter-measures against
-them. It was obvious that if I only echeloned my troops deeply
-enough the enemy’s enveloping detachments would be placed in
-the greatest peril. They would find themselves sandwiched
-between my detachments and in this way could be taken by
-surprise in the flank or rear by my troops echeloned further
-back. Unfortunately the execution of this plan was only
-imperfect. In the very thick bush, however carefully one
-watched camp fires and the dust, there were too few indications
-to follow a column properly and it was very difficult for a column
-to keep its direction. In addition there were a number of factors
-that threw out one’s calculations, factors such as dense bush,
-marshes and water-courses. In spite of all these obstacles, we
-succeeded every now and then in taking one of the hostile enveloping
-columns by surprise and bringing it under fire. The inevitable
-difficulties of moving separate columns in the thick bush<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_263" id="Page_263">[263]</a></span>
-were even greater on the English side than on the German.
-When a collision occurred there was often a complete mix-up in
-which neither friend nor foe knew whom he had before him.
-On one occasion Lieutenant von Ruckteschell’s detachment,
-which had been nearest to the enemy, fell back on some of our
-troops which had been echeloned further back. In so doing
-it came across a reconnoitring party in the bush, at a distance
-of about thirty paces. This patrol was recognized as an
-enemy. The machine guns were brought into position
-under the nose of the enemy and without any interference on
-his part, and the patrol, which had taken our men for English,
-was fired on lustily at point-blank range and put to flight in
-a second.</p>
-
-<p>In the same way our own patrols continually found themselves
-in the middle of enemy troops. On one such occasion <i>Vizefeldwebel</i>
-Schaffrath made his patrol lie down in the high grass and
-then opened an effective fire on the head of approaching enemy
-columns. Then he took cover again. In this way he succeeded
-in the course of a few hours in inflicting sensible losses on the
-enemy several times and capturing some material.</p>
-
-<p>I wanted to gain time by these holding actions, so that I could
-get my main body into the country further south, which was
-supposed to be fertile, according to report, and fall upon and drive
-away the smallish hostile garrisons we expected to find there.
-The first objective of this nature was the Portuguese <i>Boma</i>
-Alto-Moloque. A captured map showed that this had been the
-seat of a higher administrative authority in peace time and the
-military station of a force exceeding a company. Both natives
-and food must certainly be there. Between us and Alto-Moloque
-lay the high range of Inagu. An English battalion in its entrenched
-camp at Inagu barred the road which led from the
-Boma Malema round the west side of the Inagu Mountains to Alto-Moloque.
-It was therefore probable that our advance by that
-road would be contested, and that would have been unpleasant
-in view of the length of our carrier columns. In any case we
-should have been delayed and our intended surprise attack on
-Alto-Moloque would have been spoilt. But surprise I regarded<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_264" id="Page_264">[264]</a></span>
-as absolutely essential, as we suspected the presence of ammunition
-and arms at Alto-Moloque.</p>
-
-<p>Accordingly we left the enemy in peace in his entrenchments
-at Inagu and marched round the east side of the Inagu Mountains
-on Alto-Moloque. The strategic situation was somewhat remarkable,
-and well described in the words of an old Boer, words
-that were not quite pure High German: “Is das eine Komische
-Orlog; ons lopt achter de Portugies an, und de Englanders lopt
-achter ons an” (<i>This is a funny war. We chase the Portuguese,
-and the English chase us</i>).</p>
-
-<p>We marched by native tracks or straight through the bush.
-Several considerable streams had to be negotiated on the way.
-This district, too, was fertile, and we soon came across unmistakable
-human tracks leading towards Alto-Moloque, not to mention
-kraals, the first I had ever seen. They were grass huts,
-very thick and carefully built. Ashes were smouldering in places
-and the heads of hens which were lying about were still fresh.
-We exchanged shots with some Portuguese patrols and a few
-rifles with ammunition were captured.</p>
-
-<p>No time must be lost, so Müller’s detachment, made specially
-mobile by being relieved of all its transport, went on ahead and
-found in Alto-Moloque only a few Portuguese officers and non-commissioned
-officers who were just drinking coffee on the
-verandah of the very fine European house. These were taken
-prisoner.</p>
-
-<p>I now followed slowly with the main body. Our rearguard,
-under Captain Koehl, had quite a series of little collisions, which
-in bulk caused the enemy not inconsiderable losses. One of our
-Askari patrols had been surprised and captured by a stronger
-enemy patrol when engaged in foraging for food. These Askari
-subsequently looked on while this English patrol fought quite a
-bloody action with another English detachment in the thick
-bush and the occurrence gave them their opportunity of escaping.
-The lack of caution which many of our Europeans continually
-showed, in spite of all warnings, caused us many unnecessary
-losses. There was one Askari, a particularly reliable and intelligent
-man, whose father, the old Effendi Plantan, had already<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_265" id="Page_265">[265]</a></span>
-been with Von Wissmann’s Zulu Askari, whom I had been only
-too glad to take with me on patrol. He never came back from
-some quite unnecessary mission on which he was sent, and was
-probably taken prisoner. It was a phenomenon common to both
-sides that a large part of the losses in the war in East Africa were
-unnecessary and due solely to thoughtlessness.</p>
-
-<p>Koehl’s detachment gradually came up with the main body,
-which had reached the Alto-Moloque-Inagu road at a European
-plantation which was well stocked with provisions. From this
-place it had rung up Alto-Moloque on the enemy’s telephone and
-received a reply, first from a Portuguese, then from Captain
-Müller. Müller reported that only a small amount of ammunition
-had been captured, and that the bulk must have been got
-away to the south-east just in time by several carrier parties.
-Strong patrols were immediately sent out after them.</p>
-
-<p>When the main body entered Alto-Moloque on June 16th we
-found some very fine and massive European houses. They were
-charmingly situated on a little hill, and had a view for miles
-over the neighbouring forests to the mighty rugged mountains
-in the distance. There were thousands of orange trees in full
-bloom and our coloured men immediately christened it the
-“Boma ja machungwa” (Orange <i>boma</i>).</p>
-
-<p>The numerous maps and documents of all kinds which were
-found at the station gave us a tolerably clear idea of the country
-towards Quelimane. We could see that there was a telegraph
-wire from Alto-Moloque to Quelimane via Ili. A large company,
-the Lugella Company, had its headquarters at the confluence
-of the Lugella with the Likungo. There were great
-plantations and factories and large supplies of food. Above
-all, it looked as if preparations were in progress to make this
-station a main supply depot for food and ammunition for considerable
-bodies of troops.</p>
-
-<p>If we wished to exploit the opportunity that this situation
-presented, our subordinate commanders would have to act very
-promptly and must not be hampered by too rigid instructions.
-The impression that I formed in my mind rested in many respects
-on unproved assumptions. Our pursuing patrols must be able<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_266" id="Page_266">[266]</a></span>
-to act according to circumstances independently and rapidly if
-that original impression was not confirmed subsequently. Time
-must not be lost, or the enemy would be able to get his supplies
-away in time. He would have the advantage of a railway which
-began not far south of the Lugella Company’s station and led
-south to the river Namacurra, as well as the steamer which plied
-on that stream.</p>
-
-<p>As so often happens, our pursuing patrols and companies
-were occasionally found wanting in some respects. Yet it must
-not be forgotten that besides many other qualities a very mature
-tactical judgment is required to give an independent decision on
-the question when the very exhausting pursuit of a fleeing foe is
-to be continued at top pressure or should be broken off. To
-exploit the promising situation to the greatest possible extent,
-on the very day of my arrival at Alto-Moloque I had sent in
-pursuit the whole of Müller’s detachment, which I had hitherto
-kept by me. In the course of various patrols and raids in the
-neighbourhood we caught individual Portuguese Askari who
-in many cases had set up off their own bats as little tyrants in the
-villages of the district. The natives reported their presence to us.</p>
-
-<p>The region of Alto-Moloque turned out to be very fertile, as
-we anticipated. We were therefore in a position to give Müller’s
-detachment a greater start in following up the enemy. One of
-the patrols of this detachment had captured a hostile supply
-depot near Ili. An enemy carrier column, turned off by an Anglo-Portuguese
-detachment which was now several days’ march east
-of Alto-Moloque, and trying to pass through Alto-Moloque
-in ignorance of our presence, was a welcome acquisition to our
-Intendant, who needed it to carry the supplies captured at Ili.
-Unfortunately this intended removal succeeded only partially,
-for a fresh English detachment appeared at Ili, apparently from
-the direction of Inagu, and drove off our patrols.</p>
-
-<p>The advance of our main body on Ili was contested by considerable
-hostile patrols which were approaching the Alto-Moloque-Ili
-road from the north. One of these patrols was immediately
-pursued energetically and attacked in its camp, but I gained the
-impression that larger enemy forces were advancing on us from<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_267" id="Page_267">[267]</a></span>
-the north of Ili and Alto-Moloque. I had no intention of delaying,
-but wished rather to join up as soon as possible with Müller’s
-detachment, which was on its way to Lugella. Accordingly I
-marched south, skirting Ili and occupied the Portuguese post of
-Nampepo. In this district, at about a day’s march from each
-other, the Portuguese companies had established a number of
-clean, well-arranged stations around which lay the fields, which
-they cultivated. A whole series of these posts and their field-depots
-fell into our hands during the march. Nampepo was one
-of them, only larger than usual, and the centre of an extraordinarily
-fertile district. A special feature of the Nampepo camp
-was our chase after domestic pigs. Large numbers of these were
-running loose in the bush, so that we had excellent sausages to
-eat, as well as roast pork and brawn. A German planter named
-Hauter, from the district of Morogoro, who had delivered large
-supplies of sausages to Morogoro during the war, had acquired
-expert skill in preparing them, and this now came in very useful.
-He now had the insides of pigs to practise on instead of the insides
-of cows, and our enjoyment of this unwonted luxury was so great
-that we did not allow ourselves to be disturbed even by the shots
-that fell into our camp.</p>
-
-<p>For as a matter of fact a considerable enemy column from the
-north was approaching the station of Nampepo, which was held
-by Captain Spangenberg with our outposts. From the commanding
-ground the approach of a large enemy column could be
-noted quite easily. As a particularly favourable opportunity
-for attacking it presented itself we did not disturb the enemy in
-his approach. However, contrary to expectation, he did not
-attack us. Pillars of smoke arising from the bush about 1,500
-yards away showed us that he had encamped there. Our patrols
-which went round the enemy crawled up to his camp at night
-and fired into it. Koehl’s detachment had come up meanwhile
-and I marched off with the main body to follow Müller’s detachment
-in the direction of Lugella. Captain Spangenberg remained
-with our rearguard in touch with the enemy, and then followed
-us at a distance of a day’s march.</p>
-
-<p>Meanwhile Captain Müller’s detachment had succeeded in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_268" id="Page_268">[268]</a></span>
-crossing the Likungo river, near the confluence of the Lugella,
-at a ford. It had been able to give an apparently severe drubbing
-to a Portuguese battalion which had rushed up from the
-south to protect it. Several machine guns were captured. The
-great depot of the Lugella Company fell into our hands. It was
-possible to distribute a large amount of food and clothing. The
-buildings themselves, which had been adapted for defence, and
-about 300,000 kilograms of food were burnt.</p>
-
-<p>As no other remunerative objective presented itself Captain
-Müller considered he had fulfilled his mission for the time being,
-retired to the southern bank of the Likungo and there awaited
-my arrival.</p>
-
-<p>I was afraid that our wonderful captures of the last few weeks
-would tempt some of our Europeans to help themselves to things
-improperly, and I took advantage of the occasion to point out
-the evils of such behaviour. It must not be forgotten that
-war booty belongs to the State, and that the individual soldier
-has to notify to his superiors if he happens to want any particular
-object he has captured. An estimate is then made of the
-value of the object and he has to pay the amount. It was
-important for me to maintain the <i>moral</i> of our troops
-unconditionally if I was to be able to appeal to their sense of
-honour and make calls on their endurance.</p>
-
-<p>A certain amount of ammunition was captured here and there,
-and, further, a small Portuguese gun had fallen into our hands,
-but the great haul of cartridges for which we had hoped and
-striven had not materialized. I thought it extremely doubtful
-whether there ever had been such large stocks at Alto-Moloque
-and Ili, and suspected that the whole thing was a case of exaggeration
-of the approved native type. That did not imply
-evil intentions on the part of those concerned. On the contrary,
-the natives were well-disposed towards us. For example, they
-brought back of their own accord one of our captured Portuguese
-officers who had escaped. They also brought us some
-German black boys who had been enjoying themselves looting,
-and had been caught and well beaten by the natives, excusing
-themselves on the ground that they had taken them for Portuguese!</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_269" id="Page_269">[269]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>It is an extremely difficult matter even for a European to
-estimate, for example, the numerical strength of a detachment
-on the march. The native finds it much more difficult, especially
-when it comes to larger numbers. The words he so frequently
-uses, <i>mingi</i> (much) or <i>kama majani</i> (as thick as grass) can mean
-50 just as well as 5,000.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_270" id="Page_270">[270]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER IV<br />
-<span class="wn">ON TO THE SOUTH</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">HOWEVER, wherever these large ammunition depots
-might be, they had certainly not fallen into our hands.
-We had to start out on the search again. The whole strategic
-situation, as well as the documents we captured, showed that
-they <i>must</i> be somewhere in this region. There was a high degree
-of probability that the more considerable stocks, whose existence
-we suspected, were further south, either because they had been
-there from the start or because they had been moved there as
-a result of our approach. It seemed likely that before long
-they would be transported to the coast and transferred to ships,
-in case of emergency.</p>
-
-<p>During our march considerable patrols had reconnoitred the
-region within a radius of a day’s march, and captured a few
-small enemy food depots, but no arms or ammunition. Müller’s
-detachment, with which we had joined up at Mujeba on June
-27th, marched further south again the same day. The natives
-told us of a large <i>boma</i> at Origa, which was said to be somewhere
-further south, near the coast, and to have large ammunition
-supplies. Müller’s party was to find this <i>boma</i>. Our directions
-were thoroughly inaccurate, as usual. I was quite certain that
-on the march other and conflicting reports would infallibly
-arrive. Unfortunately we had not a long time in which to
-test the intelligence that came in. All we could do was to trust
-that it contained at least an element of truth.</p>
-
-<p>As the situation demanded, Captain Müller was given the
-greatest freedom of action. If any promising objective presented
-itself during his march, he was to decide without hesitation
-what his best course was. I would bring up our main<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_271" id="Page_271">[271]</a></span>
-body and intervene unconditionally in his support, and, in any
-case, I would accept the situation he had created. The main
-thing was that he should not wait for special orders and instructions.
-I realized that in acting thus I was in a large measure
-placing the conduct of our operations in the hands of a subordinate
-commander. It was only possible because that
-subordinate commander possessed a very sound, tactical judgment
-and great initiative.</p>
-
-<p>Our leading troops, with their three weak companies, had to
-perform the double function of cavalry sent out far and wide
-to reconnoitre, and that of an advance guard led with the
-greatest energy. In any other circumstances I should have been
-with the advance guard myself, in view of its important task,
-so that I could have a surer hold on the course of operations.
-Experience had taught me, however, that in view of the distance
-between our columns, my presence with the main body was
-indispensable, both to overcome obstacles quickly and to be
-able to act in face of some unforeseen change in the situation.
-It must not be forgotten that our whole advance was based on
-combination, and that, as actually happened often enough, the
-unsuspected appearance of hostile detachments from some
-other direction transformed the situation at a blow and made
-fresh dispositions necessary.</p>
-
-<p>Accordingly we marched by small native tracks or right
-through the bush in single file. Owing to the great length of
-our columns, on a day’s march of nineteen miles or so the head
-had to start off in the dark&mdash;about 5 a.m.&mdash;if the tail was to
-reach the camp appointed the same day, that is, late in the
-evening and just before darkness fell. It was inevitable, because
-camping material had to be procured, wood to be chopped, grass
-to be cut and shelters to be built, in case of need, for the sick.
-For that reason our whole force could not march concentrated.
-It was much too extended. Müller’s detachment, forming the
-advance guard, marched one or two days’ march ahead. The
-rearguard, Spangenberg’s detachment, followed the main body
-at a distance of about a day’s march. Communication was
-maintained by means of runners.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_272" id="Page_272">[272]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>In the reports which reached us by the runners of Müller’s
-detachment, the name “Kokosani” was now perpetually
-recurring. Considerable enemy depots, strongly protected by
-hostile troops, were to be found there, so it was said. But
-where was this Kokosani? The word could not be found on
-our maps. It gradually came to light that Kokosani was the
-same place that figured on Portuguese maps as Namacurra.
-In any case, all our previous intelligence, as well as a glance at
-the situation on the map, showed that Kokosani must be our
-most promising objective. We had no means of knowing whether
-it would be possible to capture this place, probably very strongly
-fortified, with our relatively limited resources. Only the attempt
-itself could enlighten us on that point. Captain Müller had
-turned west towards the place independently. On the way it
-became clear that, as the natives had told us, there actually
-was a ford over the river Likungo.</p>
-
-<p>I now marched on quickly with our main body, in order to
-join up, and gave orders to the same effect to our rearguard
-under Captain Spangenberg. In the afternoon of July 1st, the
-main force reached the Likungo and immediately crossed it.
-The water of this great river, more than four hundred yards
-wide, came up to our necks at the deepest parts of the ford.
-It took each man about an hour to cross. When the troops had
-successfully reached the western bank, we bivouacked, and next
-morning continued our march in the tracks of Müller’s detachment
-ahead.</p>
-
-<p>On the way some thirty natives met us. They had worked
-in Kokosani, and told us that a large number of Portuguese and
-Askari were encamped there, and that a number of chests had
-arrived. We had to employ interpreters in our talk with these
-men, as they did not know Kisuaheli. Several of our Askari
-were masters of the local tongue or related dialects.</p>
-
-<p>Before long we received an important report from the advance
-guard. On the previous day Captain Müller had completely
-surprised the enemy at Kokosani by an encircling move. Marching
-on the factory buildings from the north in broad daylight,
-through a field of knee-high agaves and without any cover, he<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_273" id="Page_273">[273]</a></span>
-had succeeded in getting into the Portuguese entrenchments
-and, in several hours of very severe hand-to-hand fighting,
-defeating the three Portuguese companies holding them, with
-very heavy losses to the enemy. In the course of the action
-a number of rifles, as well as two field guns with their ammunition,
-were captured.</p>
-
-<p>I myself went on a little ahead of our main body, and in the
-morning came across several extensive and well-arranged plantations.
-Next I followed the track of a field railway, which
-ran along the main road right through the fields, and after a
-short time joined up with a standard-gauge line. As was to
-appear later, the latter led from the river Namacurra northwards
-to the neighbourhood of Lugella. When Captain Müller struck
-this standard-gauge line the day before, he held up a train which
-had just come from Lugella. It is easy to realize the mutual
-amazement when there descended from the train several Portuguese
-non-commissioned officers whom Müller had captured at
-Lugella and released again.</p>
-
-<p>When I reached the factory buildings, Captain Müller came
-limping up to me, pretty lame. He expressed his astonishment
-that I had brought my detachment direct to Kokosani by the
-main road and without opposition, for he thought that there
-must be quite two English companies somewhere in the neighbourhood.
-He had not yet been able to ascertain their whereabouts,
-but documents which Captain Müller had captured
-pointed conclusively to their presence in the district. Müller
-also told me that he had not yet found the considerable quantity
-of infantry cartridges. All his people were still busy trying
-to find them and anything similar.</p>
-
-<p>When I considered the matter more closely, it seemed to me
-more probable that the ammunition stores we were hunting
-for would not be near the factory, but must be somewhere
-directly on the railway, and, indeed, at its southern terminus.
-That was the place for a large ammunition depot, for it must
-be the unloading point where the stuff was transferred to rail
-from ships on the Namacurra. We had to find out whether
-these deductions were sound. I went back immediately and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_274" id="Page_274">[274]</a></span>
-met the leading files of our main body among the plantations.
-The leading companies were anything but pleased to have to
-retrace their steps in order to follow the standard-gauge railway
-southwards. After the long, tiring march a few complimentary
-remarks about my arrangements were comprehensible
-enough. Fortunately for me, I did not hear them.</p>
-
-<p>It was in a rather bad humour that the men at the head of
-the column arrived in the neighbourhood of the railway-station.
-They did not seriously believe in the possibility of a fight. It
-was upon them suddenly, however, and several Askari were
-struck by hostile bullets at quite short range and fell. The
-rest of our main force, which was near at hand and ready for
-action, was brought up. When I arrived, the situation was not
-at all clear; the enemy was obviously entrenched and closer
-reconnaissance was in progress. An indecisive exchange of
-shots now developed. It began to rain and was unpleasantly
-cold, so that everyone felt thoroughly uncomfortable. I myself
-went to Lieutenant von Ruckteschell’s company, which was
-lying opposite to and about ninety yards from the corrugated-iron
-buildings of the station and directing a well-aimed rifle
-and machine-gun fire from some high ant-hills every time anything
-showed.</p>
-
-<p>I considered that the situation at the moment was unfavourable
-to storming the station. We would have been compelled
-to rush at the enemy’s position through the thick bush, which
-was commanded by a most effective hostile fire. That offered
-but little prospect of success. A number of our men would
-probably not have joined in the rush at all, and those who did
-and got close to the enemy’s fortress would probably have
-been held up and found themselves unable to get on. We
-should, therefore, achieve nothing.</p>
-
-<p>On the other hand, my reconnaissance had brought the idea
-to my mind that on targets, some of which were very visible,
-artillery fire would be effective, especially from two sides. It
-would frighten the enemy’s Askari and make them run away.
-That would be a favourable moment for good machine-gun
-fire. But the day was already too far advanced, and our gun<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_275" id="Page_275">[275]</a></span>
-was smashed, so that nothing definite could be ventured on for
-that day. The larger portion of the troops retired to our camp,
-and only three companies of Captain Poppe’s detachment
-remained in close contact with the enemy.</p>
-
-<p>The next day, July 3rd, we got our gun into working order
-again, after strenuous efforts. As luck would have it, it was
-of the same model as the guns Captain Müller had captured,
-and so, by interchanging the individual serviceable parts of these
-three guns, we produced a field-piece fit for use. There was
-thus a prospect of putting to good use the two hundred rounds we
-had captured two days before. In the afternoon the gun was to
-be brought up to within a few hundred yards of the station, and
-open fire upon it. Another smaller, 4-cm., gun was ready in the
-foremost infantry line&mdash;and therefore about a hundred and twenty-five
-yards off&mdash;to start a cross fire. All our machine guns were
-held ready. In the morning I had been to the factory buildings
-again for a conference, and had told the civilian personnel there
-they need not get frightened if they heard the sound of firing
-in the afternoon. The white women and children had been
-very frightened by the fighting, and some of them had fled into
-the bush.</p>
-
-<p>I had gone back to our camp, extremely tired, when the sound
-of fighting at the station suddenly made itself heard. We
-received a telephone report that loud yells and cries of “hurrah”
-could be heard coming from the station. By degrees the
-following facts were established: the enemy was apparently
-tired of the well-aimed, concentric fire which had been directed
-at them since the afternoon. They were now being subjected
-to artillery fire from two sides at once, and the moment there
-was the slightest movement machine guns opened on them.
-Their young troops could not stand it, and were very restless.
-Our companies recognized that this was their weak moment
-and used it immediately, showing splendid initiative. They
-leaped up with loud hurrahs, and the next minute were in the
-enemy’s position. The enemy began to run away. The English
-maintained that they had been infected by the example of the
-Portuguese. However that may be, they ran away and our<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_276" id="Page_276">[276]</a></span>
-companies immediately went after them as hard as they could.
-Our flying foes reached the river Namacurra, which ran immediately
-behind their position, quickly pulled off their boots
-and dashed into the water. Here most of the hostile troops were
-drowned, including their commander, Major Gore-Brown.</p>
-
-<p>Between July 1st and 3rd the enemy had 5 Europeans and
-100 Askari killed, 4 Europeans and about 100 Askari drowned,
-while 421 Askari were taken prisoner. Of the Europeans (5
-English and 117 Portuguese) who also fell into our hands, 55
-Portuguese escaped and 46 sick and wounded Portuguese were
-left behind in the hospital at Kokosani. We had 8 Askari and
-1 machine-gun carrier killed, 3 Europeans, 11 Askari and 2
-machine-gun carriers wounded. At first it was quite impossible
-to estimate, even approximately, what amount of ammunition
-and food we had captured at the station. Seven heavy, 3 light
-machine guns and 2 guns had fallen into our hands, but these
-2 guns had been rendered useless.</p>
-
-<p>More and more cases of captured ammunition were brought
-into our camp. The Intendant, Lieutenant Besch (retired naval
-officer), was in despair because he did not know where he was
-going to get enough carriers to remove such vast stores. They
-included more than 300,000 kilograms of food and the stocks
-from the Kokosani sugar factory. The amount of booty enabled
-all our coloured men to receive as much clothing material as
-they wanted, and my boy, Serubili, said to me: “This is a very
-different matter to Tanga; we’re all getting as much sugar as
-we want now.”</p>
-
-<p>It is a fact that the whole camp was littered with sugar.
-Each of the blacks was so well-off for food and clothing of all
-kinds that they stopped stealing, as if by word of command.
-Everyone knows what that means where blacks are concerned.</p>
-
-<p>The booty included large quantities of European food and
-preserves. Every European found himself well provided for
-for months ahead. Unfortunately it was not possible for us
-to get away the whole stock of excellent wine we had captured.
-After a sufficient quantity had been set aside as a restorative
-for the sick, the rest had mainly to be drunk on the spot. The<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_277" id="Page_277">[277]</a></span>
-risk of a wholesale “jollification” <i>that</i> involved was gladly
-taken, and everyone was allowed to let himself go for once, after
-his long abstinence.</p>
-
-<p>In addition there was some fine schnapps in a large number
-of casks in the Kokosani factory. These were being stored
-ready for the English troops. With the best will in the world
-it was impossible to drink it all, so we had to empty a large
-number of the casks into the Namacurra.</p>
-
-<p>Column after column of carriers arrived in the camp with
-booty, and the Intendant became more and more desperate.
-Affairs reached a climax when a telephone message came from
-the station that a river-steamer had arrived. An English
-medical officer, all unsuspecting of what had happened at
-Namacurra, disembarked from it and closer examination of the
-boat revealed the presence of a considerable consignment of
-cartridges, exceeding three hundred cases.</p>
-
-<p>In all we had captured about three hundred and fifty modern
-English and Portuguese rifles, a welcome addition to our resources,
-which brought our armament once more up to requirements.
-We were able to discard our ’71 pattern rifle almost entirely.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_278" id="Page_278">[278]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER V<br />
-<span class="wn">BACK NORTH TO THE NAMACURRA RIVER</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">IN face of the enemy’s orders we had captured I had to
-anticipate that within a short time comparatively strong
-hostile forces would be coming from Quelimane to attack us.
-The country between the Namacurra and the Zambesi, however,
-offered a large number of river barriers, so that a march to the
-Zambesi would be full of difficulties for us and hinder our freedom
-of movement to an extraordinary degree. Equally unfavourable
-for campaigning, from our point of view, was the country south
-and south-west of our present halting-place. In the last resort
-we should find ourselves cooped up on the Zambesi without being
-in a position to effect a crossing of that mighty river which was
-commanded by the enemy’s gun-boats.</p>
-
-<p>I thought it better to abandon our previous march direction.
-Yet in view of the total absence of news it was very difficult
-to say where I ought to make for. Only one thing appeared
-to be clear&mdash;that the enemy was not directly on our heels.
-At any rate our rearguard and the patrols they had sent out
-behind them were not being pressed at all by the enemy. It
-seemed probable that if hostile bodies were following us at all
-they were engaged in trying to overhaul us on some route parallel
-to that we had taken. If I were right in that view&mdash;and it
-seemed to be confirmed by such reports as the natives brought
-in&mdash;we could assume that the enemy was insufficiently informed
-of our presence at Namacurra and further that the Portuguese
-soldiers among our prisoners whom we had turned off could
-give him no clear or trustworthy information.</p>
-
-<p>We had, therefore, to devote all our efforts to making those<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_279" id="Page_279">[279]</a></span>
-fellows believe we intended to fortify and put up a stiff defence
-of Namacurra and, further, that we had our eye on Quelimane.</p>
-
-<p>The unexpected disaster at Namacurra was bound to speed
-the steps of the pursuing enemy. It was probable that his columns,
-advancing on a parallel line to us, would overshoot the mark,
-especially as they must be anxious about the important port
-of Quelimane. I therefore decided to wait at Namacurra until
-the pursuing enemy columns had actually shot ahead of me
-and then turn about to the north-east. What chiefly influenced
-me in this decision was that a march in this direction, leading
-towards Mozambique, on the main line of communication, would
-cause the enemy anxiety, and as soon as he became aware of
-it he would at once turn about to protect the neighbourhood
-of Mozambique with its wealth of stores. If he did not do so
-we should have a free hand at Mozambique. As the position
-would then develop the enemy would be forced to undertake
-marches that would exhaust his troops, while we gained time to
-recuperate our strength and allow our sick and wounded to
-recover.</p>
-
-<p>It was difficult to decide on the most favourable moment for
-our change of direction north-east; we should have to rely
-to some extent on the fortune of war. Even if I made the
-movement too soon and encountered one of the enemy columns
-there was always a chance of defeating it when cut off from the
-rest. The first thing, however, was to get safely across the
-Likungo river again. The available information as to the
-fords was very unreliable. In order not to use the same fords
-as before I marched with my main body on the evening of 4th
-July to a crossing further to the south. Lieutenant Ott, however,
-ascertained by personal reconnaissance that no ford existed
-at the place of which we had been informed. On the other hand,
-it was apparent from native information as well as from tracks
-discovered that on the same day an English patrol had halted
-in this neighbourhood. The position might become awkward.
-In order to lose no time in investigation I marched along the
-west bank of the Likungo to our previous ford. Unfortunately
-I had withdrawn the covering force that had hitherto been left<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_280" id="Page_280">[280]</a></span>
-there and I did not know whether it was free. I was therefore
-very relieved when on 5th July the crossing was effected without
-further interference. Koehl’s detachment was still at Namacurra
-and followed as rearguard.</p>
-
-<p>When we were again marching as a single column through
-the bush, the great length of the column was unwieldy and,
-in the event of an encounter with the enemy, would be a source
-of danger. We therefore tried to shorten the column and to
-march in two, and later in several parallel columns through the
-bush. The disadvantage of this arrangement was that instead
-of one head of a column having to cut a way through the bush
-this had now to be done by several. But the advantages of
-the shorter length outweighed this disadvantage.</p>
-
-<p>Information from our patrols and from the natives indicated
-that the march of the enemy columns to the south-west had not
-been pressed so far as I had anticipated. Enemy troops were
-reported both between the Moniga and the lower Likungo and
-also at Mujebain; in some cases they were ascertained to be
-marching south-west. This brought about the extraordinary
-situation that the enemy troops were marching in several columns
-south-west while we were passing between these columns in the
-contrary direction, north-east. This fact could not long remain
-hidden from the enemy, especially as the patrols soon began
-to come in contact, and the enemy troops, marching along the
-line of telephone communication from Mulevalla to Murubella,
-crossed our track. We continued our march to Oriva, threw
-back a weak Portuguese detachment west of this place, and
-occupied Oriva itself on 14th July. Unfortunately the abundant
-stores of supplies and ammunition that we had expected to
-find at this station were not forthcoming; apparently either
-the numerous enemy troops had drawn heavily on the resources
-of the neighbourhood or the stores that had been originally
-left here had already been removed. A small patrol, sent
-out to Muatama under Sergeant-Major Hüttich, succeeded in
-surprising a small mixed detachment of English and Portuguese;
-as it was unfortunately impossible to get away the supplies
-found in this station the stores had to be burned.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_281" id="Page_281">[281]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Meanwhile our attempts to get information from the natives
-as to the whereabouts of supplies met with no success; it was
-impossible to wait for the reports of other patrols dispatched
-to Murua in search of supplies. Various patrol actions showed
-us that the enemy had meanwhile become aware of the change
-in the situation and had accordingly turned his columns about.
-Want of supplies forced us to continue our march, and the attack
-of a mixed Portuguese-English column on our rearguard under
-Captain Koehl could not be developed into a complete success
-as our main force was already on the march. We halted for
-a few days in the tolerably fertile territory between Oriva and
-Murua. Captured papers showed us that an English patrol had
-closely observed our movements.</p>
-
-<p>It was interesting to notice that the English prisoners whom
-we took with us, for the most part, accepted as a matter of course
-the hardships of the long marches, the constant crossing of
-rivers and the countless difficulties connected with supplies
-and transport; they realized that we Germans had exactly
-the same hardships to endure as themselves and were in addition
-burdened with a number of further duties such as patrol expeditions,
-fighting, carrying of supplies and watch-keeping. They
-bore everything with a certain humour and it was obviously
-interesting to them to see the war from the German point of
-view. It was quite otherwise with the Portuguese officers. It
-is true they were in an unenviable position: for the most part
-they were infected with syphilis and were carefully avoided
-by the English prisoners. In addition they were not real
-campaigners. They had received a generous share of the booty
-captured at Namacurra, but had not learned how to make the
-best of it. They had at once consumed the precious oil with
-rice and it was too much to expect that the Germans should
-now share with them their own meagre ration. Marching was
-a burden to them, their boots were torn to pieces&mdash;in short,
-their spokesman, the general staff officer captured at Namacurra,
-was continually complaining to me of the inconveniences which
-with the best will in the world I could not help. He was continually
-asking to be released. I should have been only too<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_282" id="Page_282">[282]</a></span>
-glad to consent if he would have given his parole not to fight
-against us, but this he would not do. I could not be expected
-to release people without any obligation and so put them in
-a position to attack us again immediately.</p>
-
-<p>Considerations of supply drove us on. After the failure of the
-Oriva neighbourhood to come up to our expectations in this
-respect, I planned to reach the territory east of the Ligonja, which
-was marked on the map as thickly populated and well cultivated.
-On the way the advance guard, under Captain Müller, quickly
-took Boma Tipa, where several days’ supplies, particularly
-pig-nuts, fell into our hands. The weak Portuguese garrison
-offered only slight resistance and then fled at once; the leader,
-a Portuguese sergeant, was the only prisoner captured.</p>
-
-<p>We had reached a high degree of efficiency in the rapid and
-systematic distribution of booty; the main force hardly lost
-a day’s march and I can still see the approving smile of one of the
-English prisoners who seemed to have entirely forgotten that
-the Portuguese were his allies. Apparently it amused them
-to see with what little ceremony we took from them their depots
-one after the other, together with their supplies. The captured
-enemy papers repeatedly gave us valuable information. Two
-days’ march from Tipa lay another <i>boma</i> called Namirrue, where
-the Portuguese garrison had been strengthened by an English
-company. Apparently considerable stores lay here. At any
-rate, according to information, supply columns had been sent
-to replenish at Namirrue. The English troops there probably
-belonged to an enemy force newly appeared from the direction of
-Mozambique. It was impossible for the enemy force to which
-we had hitherto been opposed, and which had taken part in the
-general march south-west north-east, to have established such
-a lead on us. Accordingly the advance guard with our gun
-at once marched on Namirrue (the smaller gun had been put out
-of action at Namacurra and left behind after firing its few cartridges).
-Captain Müller was instructed to reconnoitre the position
-at Namirrue and act independently as might be required.
-For the time being the main force remained at Tipa, on the east
-bank of the Moloque. It was to obtain supplies and hold up the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_283" id="Page_283">[283]</a></span>
-enemy advancing from the south-west long enough to allow
-Captain Müller the necessary time at Namirrue. It was not long
-before small enemy reconnoitring forces appeared at Tipa, or
-the west bank of the Ligonja, which at this point offers no obstacle
-worth mentioning. There was a series of unimportant patrol
-engagements on the east bank also. The rearguard, under
-Captain Koehl, carried out a number of delaying actions at places
-along the Tipa-Namirrue road which for the most part have
-already been mentioned. As I was not clear whether the main
-force would find the best opportunity to attack in Koehl’s position
-or at Namirrue I began by following cautiously with him
-Müller’s detachment. The report then came in from Captain
-Müller that an enemy force of some two companies was entrenched
-on the heights at Namirrue and that he could not get
-at them even with his gun. On the other hand, he reported that
-in all probability English troops would come to the support of
-the enemy from the north or north-west. There was a favourable
-opportunity for us to defeat these troops in the open. I therefore
-marched the main force to Namirrue and on the 22nd July
-crossed the Namirrue river, about three miles above the
-rocky hill occupied by the enemy. Camp was pitched on the
-east bank and immediately there were patrol engagements.
-I myself, with Lieutenant Besch, made a detour of the hill to join
-Captain Müller, who was encamped immediately south-east of it.
-The enemy position had been encircled with patrols and machine
-guns. On the heights above several horses could be seen and,
-here and there, men too. Wherever a target offered the enemy
-was fired on to prevent him from sending down men to fetch water.
-It appeared, however, that the enemy must have been able to
-keep himself supplied with water from a source unknown to us.</p>
-
-<p>After drinking a cup of coffee with Captain Müller we went
-further round the hill and came upon Lieutenant Kempner and
-other patrols, keenly engaged on reconnoitring work. In order
-to keep under cover we had to work our way partly through the
-thick bush and came on large quantities of cow-itch: contact
-with this plant produces an intolerable irritation of the skin.
-We were just in the middle of a thicket of this plant when we<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_284" id="Page_284">[284]</a></span>
-heard lively firing from the camp of our main force. At the
-same time the enemy in the hill fired several salvoes, apparently
-as a signal to their friends. I was immediately convinced that
-a not very strong enemy detachment was approaching which was
-unaware of the arrival of our main force. I was seized with
-the desire to use this rare opportunity at once with my full
-strength. I tried with all haste to get to the main force, but the
-cow-itch hampered my progress and the irritation was maddening.
-Eventually we reached the camp before dark. My second
-in command, Major Kraut, had begun the attack with small
-forces. In the bright moonlight I could still hope to use the
-approaching night for a successful battle. All available forces,
-with the exception of a company left to protect the camp, were
-at once prepared for action. On the left wing, Captain Goering,
-who was to undertake an enveloping movement, took his force
-round to a position in the rear of the enemy. There he heard the
-barking of a dog, ran forward at once and found the English
-commanding officer, Colonel Dickinson, with his adjutant and a
-medical officer, telephoning in a ravine and took them prisoner.
-Captain Goering at once attacked and the detachments of
-Captains Spangenberg and Poppe, in front and on the left wing,
-did the same. In a very short time the enemy, consisting of one
-battalion, was completely overwhelmed and routed. All the
-detachments engaged in a hot pursuit, but in the darkness and
-the thick bush touch was lost with the enemy.</p>
-
-<p>It turned out later that the enemy’s troops marching parallel
-with us had crossed the Namirrue at the same time a little further
-upstream. In view of the constantly changing situation, due to
-the continuous movement of the forces and the impenetrable
-screen of the bush which made it impossible to see far in any direction,
-and also owing to the large number of his marching columns,
-it was quite impossible for the enemy, in spite of the unremitting
-labours of his wireless service, to obtain a clear picture of the
-situation as a whole and to keep his subordinate leaders informed
-in time of all the changes of the situation. In this case a column
-had become detached and had run upon us with only a part of
-its strength: only one battalion had crossed the river. In an<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_285" id="Page_285">[285]</a></span>
-exposed and very dangerous position this battalion had been
-badly handled by our main force.</p>
-
-<p>A company detailed for the further pursuit of the retreating
-enemy returned the following day without having achieved anything
-more; here, again, after such a favourable action the subordinate
-leaders and the troops themselves could only with
-difficulty be persuaded to throw themselves in to the last ounce
-to wring every possible advantage from their success. Lieutenant
-Schroetter, who then for several days carried on the pursuit
-in a manner in keeping with the situation, was unable to effect
-more than a few patrol skirmishes. The enemy had, in the
-meantime, gained too great a start. No information was
-obtained except as to the very hurried flight of the enemy.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-285.jpg" width="400" height="315" id="m285"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pc">Fig. xix. The Action at Namirruë, July 23, 1918.</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>I, with the main part of my forces, stood my ground. The
-full exploitation of the success lay less in the pursuit of the
-beaten enemy than in the chances offered by the situation of the
-enemy we were surrounding on the hill, now that the help intended
-was for the moment unavailable.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_286" id="Page_286">[286]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>For the first time in this campaign we had captured a trench-mortar
-with ammunition. The various parts were collected on
-the field of action and the seventeen rounds of ammunition made
-ready for firing. Experiments made with practice ammunition
-gave satisfactory results, and we were able to arrange for the
-bombardment of the enemy among the rocks at four o’clock in
-the afternoon. The command of this attack was entrusted to
-Captain Müller, whose detachment had not taken part in the
-fighting on the previous day and had known nothing about it.
-To this detachment was added Lieutenant von Ruckteschell’s,
-which had remained in the camp. The trench-mortar was placed
-in position on one side of the hill, the gun on the other; our
-machine-guns were disposed round the hill in readiness for the
-attack. At 3.45 Lieutenant von Ruckteschell took leave of the
-English Colonel Dickinson, who had been placed in his charge,
-saying that he expected to be back in an hour. At 4 o’clock
-the first round from our trench-mortar burst in the centre of the
-enemy’s position. The enemy commander was just considering
-whether he should make a sortie during the night. In a moment
-the hill burst into life: everywhere men could be seen running
-up and down the rocks. They were brought under the fire of
-our gun and machine guns. Very soon the enemy showed the
-white flag, but continued to fire.</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant von Ruckteschell returned to his guest as he had
-promised, an hour later, but unfortunately with a shattered leg.
-His orderly who, when he was wounded, had tried to carry him
-out of the fight, was shot down under him. Meanwhile Captain
-Müller had climbed the hill from the other side and stormed
-the camp. It was occupied by a squadron of mounted infantry
-of the Gold Coast Regiment of whom hardly one came out alive.
-Even the horses were killed almost without exception. On our
-side brave Lieutenant Selke was killed by an enemy bullet shortly
-before the storming of the camp. He was buried on the battlefield.
-The <i>matériel</i> captured was small, but the two days of
-fighting had cost the enemy heavy losses in men. His detachments,
-which were numerically hardly less strong than our
-own, were literally annihilated. Here, as at Namacurra, it turned<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_287" id="Page_287">[287]</a></span>
-out that the English had conscripted black troops from German
-East Africa into their fighting force, including a considerable
-number of old German Askari.</p>
-
-<p>Our thorough work at Namirrue had been made possible by
-Koehl’s detachment, consisting only of three companies, which
-had kept us free from interference. This detachment had
-fallen back gradually from Tipa on Namirrue, daily fighting rearguard
-actions with the enemy who was pressing on with all
-his strength. They were now within half a day’s march of
-Namirrue and I ordered them across to the east bank of the
-Namirrue river. Patrols sent out to reconnoitre had meanwhile
-learned from the natives that there was an enemy depot with
-a garrison at Pekera. This seemed to me very probable, as Pekera
-lies in the thickly populated area east of the Ligonja river,
-said to be a fertile district. Our expectations were realized
-when after two days’ march we arrived at Pekera. The mounted
-squadron of the Gold Coast Regiment stationed there was at
-once destroyed and several motors were captured. In the
-same way we quickly took possession of the Boma of Chalau and
-a number of other stations where the Portuguese had stored
-large quantities of supplies, particularly pig-nuts. Our patrols
-advanced as far as Angoche and in a very short time we were
-masters of the wide and exceptionally fertile district. One night
-some of the Portuguese officer prisoners escaped and succeeded
-in joining the enemy troops at Angoche. Apparently there were
-among these gentlemen some who knew the country well by
-reason of their occupations in peace.</p>
-
-<p>The period of rest during our stay in the Chalau district made
-it possible for our sick and wounded, who had been brought
-with us on the long marches, to recover; the fit, too, benefited
-by the respite. All had suffered more or less from the uninterrupted
-marching and exertions they had just gone through. It
-was noteworthy how the recent successes brought out the warlike
-spirit of the bearers, who were for the most part a very sound
-and reliable lot of men. A large number offered their services
-as Askari. Even my old cook was not disinclined to take up
-arms.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_288" id="Page_288">[288]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>On 5th of August supplies began to run short and there remained
-as our chief article of diet only the still bitter <i>muhogo</i>.
-Several enemy patrols approaching us from the north-east showed
-me that the enemy columns following us from the south-west
-had actually overtaken us during our halt and were concentrating
-for an attack at Wamaka, north-east of our camp.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_289" id="Page_289">[289]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER VI<br />
-<span class="wn">BACK TO THE LURIO RIVER</span></h2>
-
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">IN order to confirm the enemy in his mistake as to our objective
-I marched on 7th August along the road to Wamaka
-and pitched my camp three hours’ march north-east of Chalau,
-in a good supply area. Several enemy patrols were driven off.
-From Wamaka an enemy officer appeared with a flag of truce to
-announce that the English Commander-in-Chief would like
-to arrange for an exchange of medical prisoners. He was also
-instructed to inform me as to when and where equipment for the
-English prisoners could be handed over to us. These very
-transparent proposals showed me that the enemy had something
-serious in hand from the north and was trying to make his task
-easier by enticing me into a trap. Various enemy spies were
-captured and confirmed my belief. Their report that the enemy
-intended to attack in three columns was in accordance with the
-usual plan of such undertakings.</p>
-
-<p>When several patrol and outpost actions on 10th and 11th
-August indicated that a strong enemy column was advancing
-along the Wamaka-Chalau road, I assumed that at least one
-other column would be marching parallel with this further
-south; their objective was obviously Chalau. I decided to
-engage this southern enemy column by itself. The prospect
-of the success of my plan was certainly not great, as the enemy
-was marching for the most part through the bush, avoiding the
-paths. To meet such a development of the situation I had had a
-path reconnoitred and marked. In spite of this our march,
-begun in the evening of 11th August, lasted through the whole
-night. Not until daybreak did we arrive east of Chalau at the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_290" id="Page_290">[290]</a></span>
-place I had selected. Strong patrols, among them a whole
-company under Captain Koehl, were still on the march.</p>
-
-<p>My general idea was a march west to enable me to turn either
-to the Blantyre district or east of Lake Nyassa. Without any
-hindrance from the enemy we crossed the Ligonja at Metil and
-the Tipa-Namirrue road. There the grave of an officer of the
-1st battalion 2nd King’s African Rifles proved that the enemy
-column, which had first followed us from Tipa to Namirrue,
-had gone round us to the north to Wamaka: for this 1st battalion
-2nd King’s African Rifles belonged to the force which was now
-approaching from Wamaka. On the further march to Ili we
-passed through the camps of the enemy forces which had come
-from the south-west and had continued their march in the
-direction of Alto-Moloque. They too had made a wide détour
-and had accomplished correspondingly long marches. It was
-strange that all these enemy columns should suddenly display
-such a high degree of mobility; they had changed their supply
-system and, partially at any rate, left their lines of communication.
-According to the reports of prisoners they sent
-requisitioning parties on ahead to commandeer supplies from
-the natives, which were then distributed among the troops.
-This requisitioning of supplies seems to have been carried out
-with great ruthlessness. The confidence which the natives had
-shown during our recent stay in the Ili district had vanished.
-They now saw an enemy in every Askari and individual men
-who were left behind were on several occasions attacked by the
-natives.</p>
-
-<p>When we came to Ili, the English telegraphic station situated
-there was quickly captured. The papers found there gave
-useful information as to the movements of the enemy troops.
-According to this there were considerable stores at Numarroe
-and Regone; strong forces were to try to overtake us from
-Alto-Moloque and Mukubi, while one column followed immediately
-on our track. The enemy, who up to a short time
-back had been groping in the dark, had apparently received, a
-few days before, reliable information as to our movements.
-It was very difficult to find the road to Regone, as no guides could<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_291" id="Page_291">[291]</a></span>
-be raised. From Ili, however, a newly erected telephone line
-of copper wire led to Numarroe. If we followed this line we were
-sure to come upon something useful. As a matter of fact parts
-of the enemy columns were near us when we left Ili. The patrols
-we had left behind even met some Askari whom they took to
-be friends: they exchanged cigarettes and lights with these and
-did not realize until afterwards that they were enemies.</p>
-
-<p>During these days I was much occupied with a domestic
-question. The supply of bread for the European prisoners became
-difficult in view of the prolonged marches. The men were
-unskilled and not in a position to help themselves. At last I
-succeeded in getting over the difficulty, and had considerable
-quantities of flour prepared by other methods. Captain Krüger,
-who had charge of the prisoners of war and died soon afterwards,
-was already very ill and exhausted by hardships; with
-the best intentions he had not always managed to find the ways and
-means of meeting the wishes of the prisoners, which were often
-very exacting.</p>
-
-<p>In the morning of 24th August we crossed the Likungo river,
-and continued our march towards Numarroe. We could already
-see, several miles in breadth, the hill and the buildings of Boma
-Numarroe. During a halt we lunched in the congenial company
-of Lieutenant Ott, Sergeant-Major Nordenholz and the other
-officers of the advance guard. We had long grown accustomed
-during the halts to bring out, without ceremony, a piece of bread
-and a box of lard or hippopotamus fat. Naval Lieutenant
-Freund even still possessed some butter from Namacurra.
-Even the Askari and bearers, who formerly used to wait for their
-meal until camp was pitched, adopted more and more the “desturi”
-(manners, customs) of the Europeans. As soon as a halt
-was called every black would bring out his lunch. It was very
-jolly when the whole force bivouacked in this way in the forest,
-in the best of spirits, and refreshed themselves for fresh exertions,
-fresh marches and fresh fighting.</p>
-
-<p>We were still two hours east of Numarroe when the advance
-guard was fired on. An enemy company had camped on our
-line of march and was slowly and cleverly retreating before us<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_292" id="Page_292">[292]</a></span>
-from kopje to kopje in the direction of Numarroe. Lieutenant
-Ott, who was shot through the chest, was in a very serious
-condition. With the main body led by Goering’s detachment, I
-made a detour, and, passing the enemy to the south, made straight
-for the Boma of Numarroe. Before dark our gun was brought
-into position and fire opened on the Boma and its entrenchments.
-Goering’s detachment, without loss of time, made a still wider
-detour to the south in order, by using a ravine, to come close
-up to the Boma in the rear. The advance guard (Müller’s
-detachment), which was out of sound of the fighting, was
-also quickly brought up. The enemy shooting was not bad,
-and in spite of the distance the rifle bullets of the infantry came
-very close whenever one of us exposed himself.</p>
-
-<p>It soon grew dark; the firing increased and died down again,
-until suddenly heavy firing was heard from the direction of
-Goering’s detachment. Then there was silence. Goering’s
-detachment had surprised the enemy in the rear and stormed
-some stubbornly defended trenches. The retreating enemy was,
-however, not recognized as the enemy by another German
-detachment and got away. The night was unpleasantly cold;
-it was pouring with rain and our baggage had not yet come up.
-On the following day 3 enemy Europeans and 41 Askari
-were buried by us; 1 European and 6 Askari wounded, 1
-European, 7 Askari and 28 other blacks unwounded were
-taken prisoner. Among the prisoners was the enemy Commander,
-Major Garrod, who commanded the half of the 2nd
-battalion 4th King’s African Rifles here. On our side, Sergeant-Major
-Nordenholz was shot through the head; 6 Askari and
-1 machine-gun bearer were killed; 3 Europeans, 18 Askari
-and 4 machine-gun bearers were wounded; 40,000 rounds
-of ammunition and two light machine guns, in addition to
-hand-grenades, medical stores and large quantities of supplies,
-were captured. Among our wounded left behind in the clean,
-massively built houses was Lieutenant Ott, cheerful as ever.
-Fortunately, his wound was not so serious as was feared at first,
-but it was not possible to take him with us.</p>
-
-<p>On August 25th I wanted at all costs to reach the camp of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_293" id="Page_293">[293]</a></span>
-Regone. From captured papers I knew that valuable stores
-had been taken to Regone to be safe from us, including trench-mortar
-ammunition. Regone was probably, for the moment,
-still weakly garrisoned. In view of the proximity of the enemy
-columns it might, however, be assumed that August 26th would
-already be too late for a <i>coup de main</i>. The path led through
-a pass in the steep rocky hills. During the march our advance
-guard soon came upon the enemy and engaged him, while I,
-with the main force, passed round this enemy and marched
-direct on Regone. During the climb over the hilly country,
-where it was only possible to see a short distance ahead, two
-German detachments, mistaking each other for the enemy,
-nearly became engaged. The machine guns were already in
-position when the mistake was fortunately discovered.</p>
-
-<p>We then advanced further over the hills, while below us,
-already considerably in the rear, could be heard the machine-gun
-fire of our advance guard. The march was so difficult, and
-as we could only cross the hills in single file, our column was so
-long that Regone, my objective for that day, was not nearly
-reached. As a matter of fact we had no exact idea where Regone
-was. Only the fact that we could see in the distance the converging
-of several paths led us to conclude that Regone must
-lie there. Half way to Regone we saw a large encampment of
-tents which I took to be the other half of the battalion which
-had marched from Regone to the support of Numarroe.</p>
-
-<p>In pouring rain we had to pitch our camp in the bush. On the
-next day the camp we had observed had been struck. The
-Boma of Regone was held in considerable strength. An attack
-on this place over the bare hills offered no prospect of success,
-and we confined ourselves to skirmishes with patrols and single
-detachments. As I had seen from his papers, the enemy had
-given orders that we should be allowed to strike at Regone unhindered
-and then attacked in the flank or rear by the strong
-reserves which lay outside. It was therefore necessary to
-exercise particular caution, and the impetuosity with which
-Lieutenant Boell’s company, in spite of all these considerations,
-advanced on the Boma might have had serious consequences.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_294" id="Page_294">[294]</a></span>
-Several enemy camps and columns outside the entrenchments were
-surprised by our fire and some supplies captured. The captured
-papers informed us of the approach of strong enemy columns
-from the south and south-east towards Regone. But there were
-also troops to the north; whether these were in the neighbourhood
-of Lioma-Malacotera or at Malema could not be ascertained.
-It was, however, certain that they were at hand and it was
-probable that they were approaching Regone, and that from
-the north.</p>
-
-<p>As a <i>coup de main</i> against Regone offered no prospect of
-success, and a prolonged enterprise, in view of the intervention
-to be expected from outside, could not be relied on, I determined
-to resume the march. On account of the obstacles formed by
-the rivers and swamps south of Lake Nyassa, the line of march
-I had formerly decided on to the west appeared ill-advised,
-especially as the enemy could, with the help of steamers and
-railways, easily concentrate and maintain a force there. A
-further march north seemed to me more practicable, passing the
-lake on the east; it seemed probable that our return to German
-East Africa would be a complete surprise to the enemy, who
-would take our objective to be the natural capital of this district,
-Tabora. Under this impression he might be expected, in order
-to save his main force the difficult overland march to Tabora, to
-withdraw to the Portuguese coast, take ship from there to Dar-es-Salaam,
-and proceed by rail to Tabora. These calculations were
-to a large extent realized. It was natural that, having reached
-the north end of Lake Nyassa, I should continue my march,
-not to Tabora but in another direction, probably west. In any
-case, the first thing was to reach the north end of the lake. This
-could not be done in less than a month and meanwhile the
-situation might alter considerably.</p>
-
-<p>At Regone we observed the concentration of strong enemy
-forces, who examined our camps immediately after our departure
-but followed us only slowly. The country, with its numerous
-ravines and water-courses, was particularly favourable to us.
-On the way to Lioma a considerable enemy supply dump was
-captured, including a large quantity of tobacco. Müller’s<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_295" id="Page_295">[295]</a></span>
-detachment, which had gone on ahead to Lioma, soon reported
-the enemy occupation of this place, but could not obtain any
-exact information as to his strength. I reached this advance
-detachment on 30th August with the main force. The position
-of the enemy entrenchments in the thick bush had not yet been
-located with any exactness. Apparently he had only just
-arrived and had not yet completed his works. I therefore
-attacked immediately. The detachments of Müller and Goering
-marched round the enemy to take him from the north. Meanwhile
-the main force gradually closed in along several ravines
-in the forest.</p>
-
-<p>In view of the lack of information I could get no clear picture
-of the situation. Suddenly lively firing was heard from the rear,
-where our carrier columns were still on the march. A strong
-enemy patrol had unexpectedly opened fire on our bearers. A
-great part of our baggage was lost. Captain Poppe, who with
-two companies was standing by in case I required him, was sent
-to attack. He could no longer find the patrol, but followed
-their line of retreat and came upon an entrenched camp which
-he immediately stormed. Sergeant-Major Schaffrath was severely
-wounded. These events were personally reported to me by
-Captain Poppe, who was brought back severely wounded in the
-chest. He reported that the enemy had been completely
-defeated, and that large captures of arms and ammunition had
-been made. The companies of Poppe’s detachment had pursued
-the fleeing enemy and come upon a fresh and larger camp.
-This same camp was also attacked from the north by Goering’s
-detachment, so that the enemy was taken under an effective
-cross fire. Meanwhile, a new enemy, advancing from the north-east,
-was held up by Müller’s detachment.</p>
-
-<p>I did not get anything like a clear view of these different events
-until I personally reconnoitred the position long after dark.
-On one of these reconnaissances an enemy rifle-bullet, of which
-many were being fired, passed through the trousers of one of
-my companions (Hauter, of the Landsturm), struck my other
-companion, Lieutenant Besch, in the thigh and severed the
-artery. Fortunately we were near the dressing station. I was<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_296" id="Page_296">[296]</a></span>
-thus able to take leave of this officer, who had hitherto acted as
-Quartermaster and at the same time had undertaken the duties
-of orderly officer, with the knowledge that he would recover.
-His few possessions he gave to his companions together with his
-wishes for good luck for the future. I, too, was honoured with
-a handful of cigarettes. It was my habit to smoke continuously
-during serious fighting.</p>
-
-<p>In the middle of the bush I met Lieutenant Von Ruckteschell
-with some bearers, on his stretcher which he was forced to use
-temporarily because of his wounded leg, which had not yet
-healed; he had kept the column together as far as possible
-during the long march and now, rifle in hand, was beaming with
-joy at the possibility of taking part in the engagement with the
-enemy patrol which appeared on the flank and in our rear.
-Part of our columns had lost their way in the thick bush and only
-found us some hours later. After nightfall the dressing station
-in a ravine had been filled with wounded. It was reported that
-Lieutenant Schroetter and Naval Lieutenant Freund had fallen.
-In a further patrol-attack, Sergeant-Majors Bolles and Hüttig
-accidentally came close to the enemy positions and were fired on
-suddenly; Bolles fell, Hüttig was captured, severely wounded.
-Sergeant-Major Thurmann had come within five yards of the
-enemy trenches, and being an excellent shot he repeatedly
-picked off from an ant-hill any of the enemy inside the camp
-who exposed himself, until he, too, received a mortal wound.</p>
-
-<p>Captain Goering, regarding it as hopeless to storm the camp,
-did not attempt this and, after dark, withdrew the force, leaving
-only patrols in front of the enemy. The main force was thus
-collected in several groups north of the enemy camp, and I decided
-to evacuate the scene of action on the following day and march
-on.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_297" id="Page_297">[297]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-297.jpg" width="400" height="522" id="m297"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pc">Fig. xx. Through Portuguese East Africa.</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>By force of necessity we had to leave behind part of our sick
-and wounded, as well as the sick prisoners, in charge of an English
-medical officer, and at nine o’clock in the morning we began
-our march north in several columns. We had no guides; the
-country was quite unknown to us and I could only give the
-Commander of the advance guard general instructions that I
-intended to pass round one of the hills that lay before us to
-the north. Soon firing could be heard from the advance guard.
-It gradually became clear in the bush that our advance guard
-had turned against an enemy who had attacked in the rear<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_298" id="Page_298">[298]</a></span>
-from the left. The shooting was at close range, and from Headquarters,
-which was with the main body, seemed to come from
-a considerable force.</p>
-
-<p>I sent back an Askari to lead the head of the main force to
-the place where I was. The position certainly invited us to
-catch the enemy between our advance guard and our main
-force, and overwhelm him. I waited, but our main force did
-not arrive. At last I ran back and saw from the tracks that
-the main force had been wrongly guided and had marched
-past us a long way to the side. On the other hand, I saw
-the head of Stemmermann’s detachment, to which the greater
-part of our columns and our sick belonged, in the very act of
-marching unwittingly straight into the enemy. There was just
-time to head off this detachment. I myself now joined the
-advance detachments of Müller and Goering, who had meanwhile
-continued their march further north. They were following
-a road which led up the hill and was then completely lost. I
-paid no further attention to the firing which I heard from time
-to time further to the rear. In the late afternoon I was astonished
-to notice that the rest of the troops had not followed the detachments
-of Müller and Goering, but were marching along the valley
-to our right. I had no idea that our column had meanwhile
-been fired on again by a new enemy from the east and that a great
-part of a field hospital had fallen into the enemy’s hands.</p>
-
-<p>In order to bring the force together, I tried to descend from
-my hill. The descent, however, proved impossible; the rocks
-were steep, almost perpendicular. We continued along a native
-path, and evening was falling when Captain Müller reported
-that this path, too, ended abruptly in a precipice. Fortunately
-there was another small bypath. This we followed and succeeded
-in climbing down. Even here it was very steep in places, but
-the bare feet of the carriers gave them a good foothold and I,
-too, after taking off my boots, managed the descent. It was
-pitch dark and we had no water. At last, however, we found
-some, and a load fell from my heart when we came upon the rest
-of the force which, under General Wahle, had, on their side, been
-trying to join us. On the 30th and 31st of August, we had lost<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_299" id="Page_299">[299]</a></span>
-6 Europeans, 23 Askari killed; 11 Europeans, 16 Askari
-wounded; 5 Europeans, 29 Askari missing; 5 Askari taken
-prisoner; 48,000 rounds of ammunition, important medical
-and surgical stores, a considerable number of rifle parts and
-the whole transport of Müller’s detachment had been lost. The
-enemy losses were also severe, as appeared from a casualty list
-of the 1st battalion 1st King’s African Rifles which was captured
-later. In addition to this battalion part of the 3rd battalion
-of this regiment and the 2nd King’s African Rifles had taken
-part in the fighting against us.</p>
-
-<p>Our men fought brilliantly; some of the carriers, it is true,
-had been somewhat unnerved by the unexpected fire and more
-than 200 were missing. There was no news of Koehl’s detachment,
-but our leaders had become so experienced and skilled in
-bush warfare that there was no need for me to be anxious. On
-the next day, on arrival at our camp, we surprised an English
-supply column.</p>
-
-<p>We then crossed the Cutea-Malema road on which enemy
-troops also appeared, and then crossed the Lurio river at Mtetere.
-An English requisitioning force fled and some supplies were
-captured. Here Koehl’s detachment rejoined the main force.
-They had followed the enemy who was following us and had
-ascertained that he was several battalions strong. We then
-marched down the Lurio to the fertile district of Mpuera. Here
-Sol (Sergeant-Major) Salim, who, during an earlier patrol expedition,
-had married a wife who had followed him faithfully,
-left her behind with her father, the local Jumbo, in view of her
-approaching confinement.</p>
-
-<p>As there was plenty of food in this district, I gave our troops,
-who had been very exhausted by recent events, a day’s rest.
-It was necessary, anyhow, in the interests of our numerous invalids.
-Captain Koehl had been left behind with his company without
-transport so that he could do the enemy as much damage as
-possible. He reported that strong bodies of enemy troops had
-arrived in the neighbourhood and east of Mtetere. It was clear
-that for the time being the enemy was devoting his whole
-energies to pursuing us, and for that purpose had concentrated<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_300" id="Page_300">[300]</a></span>
-all his forces. On that account I did not think the moment
-favourable for some partial success, because it could not be
-exploited, and an action would have cost us wounded whom we
-could not take away with us. As my idea was to forage the
-district north of Luambala for food, I was unwilling to postpone
-the march thither any longer.</p>
-
-<p>The day of rest, September 5th, was employed in completing
-our food supplies from the fertile region of Mpuera, and early
-on the 6th we continued our march in a northerly direction.
-It was to be assumed that the enemy would march downstream,
-and therefore in a north-easterly direction, in several columns.
-Our troops advanced in order of echelon through the bush, and
-I expected any moment to come across the most northerly of
-the enemy columns, but we crossed its probable course without
-discovering its tracks. About midday we were approaching our
-objective, a water-hole on Mount Hulua. Here our advance
-guard was shot at and before long a lively action was in progress.
-Captain Müller, in command of the advance guard, had stumbled
-on the rear of a hostile column which was marching north-east
-on a course making an acute angle with ours. He had immediately
-attacked the 2nd battalion 2nd King’s African Rifles,
-which was at the end of the column, and put it to flight, capturing
-the enemy’s field-hospital and his mule train.</p>
-
-<p>I deployed Goering’s detachment on the right of Müller’s
-detachment, and it quickly threw back part of the opposing
-forces, but did not press on as the enemy deployed larger bodies&mdash;the
-1st battalion of the 2nd King’s African Rifles and apparently
-parts of the 3rd battalion as well.</p>
-
-<p>Our left wing, which had arrived in rolling, open country in
-its advance, and also collided with fresh hostile troops, had
-retired a few hundred yards and occupied a slight eminence,
-giving a field of fire of several hundred yards. I was not able
-to get a clear picture of the situation until I went from the right
-wing, where I had joined Goering’s detachment, back to the left.</p>
-
-<p>The action was pretty violent and at length came to a standstill.
-We now heard the sound of trench-mortar fire coming
-from the rearguard, under Captain Spangenberg, whose arrival<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_301" id="Page_301">[301]</a></span>
-I was awaiting. The rearguard had beaten off the attack of
-another enemy column at Mpuera and driven part of it away in
-disorderly flight. In accordance with its instructions it had
-followed the main body at seven o’clock in the morning. It arrived
-on the battlefield about five in the afternoon, and I considered
-whether I ought not to throw in all my reserves to inflict a decisive
-defeat on the 2nd King’s African Rifles there and then on Mount
-Hulua. I gave up the idea, however. Time was very short,
-for there was only an hour to darkness, and I felt perfectly
-certain that very early next morning fresh hostile forces would
-appear on the scene. If we were to achieve a decisive victory
-it would certainly cost us appreciable losses, and I was anxious
-to avoid such losses in view of the small numbers&mdash;176 Europeans
-and 1,487 Askari&mdash;which our strength return of September 1,
-1918, revealed. Lieutenant Wenig (Navy), who had been employed
-with his gun in Goering’s detachment, told me that he
-had taken over the command of that detachment, because all
-the other officers were incapacitated. Before long, Captain
-Goering, with a severe wound in the breast, and Lieutenant
-Boell, with one in the head, were brought to the dressing station.</p>
-
-<p>Accordingly I would not commit our reserves to the confusion
-and uncertainty of a night battle in the bush, and determined
-to slip away from the battlefield in a north-westerly direction.
-It was soon quite dark and our progress was very slow in the
-thick, high grass. After going three miles we bivouacked. Our
-losses in the action of September 6th had been 5 Askari, 4
-machine-gunners killed; 13 Europeans, 49 Askari, and 15
-other natives wounded; 3 Europeans, 13 Askari, and 12 carriers
-missing; 3 Askari and 3 bearers captured. The enemy were
-seen to have some 10 Europeans and 30 Askari hit, while 8
-Europeans and 45 Askari were captured; those of the prisoners
-who were sick or wounded, and our own more severely wounded,
-were left on the battlefield under the charge of English R.A.M.C.
-Documents captured later on at Mwembe showed that “Karturol”
-(abbreviation for “Column of the 2nd King’s African
-Rifles”) had heavy losses on the 6th September and was put
-out of action for a time.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_302" id="Page_302">[302]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The enemy did not molest our further progress. Captain
-Koehl had remained behind with his company to the west of
-Mpuera, in order to operate from the rear against the enemy
-and his communications. He followed our trail, having
-slight encounters at Milweberg with the 1st battalion of
-the 4th King’s African Rifles, which arrived at that point
-from the south on the 8th September. We moved in several
-columns right through the bush, a region rich in game. We
-even killed several buffaloes on the march. At Kanene we
-crossed the road that ran from Lake Amaramba to Mahua.
-The enemy had burnt down the store at Kanene, but we found
-ample supplies in the country itself, and the material condition
-of the troops would have been good, if only the influenza epidemic
-had not made such strides. About half had bronchial catarrh,
-and from three to six men in each company had inflammation
-of the lungs; as it was only possible for some eighty sick to be
-carried in the whole force, about twenty men suffering with
-slight inflammation of the lungs had to march at times. No
-satisfactory solution of the problem of transport of sick was
-to be found, short of abandoning the campaign; we could not
-simply leave the sick to die in the bush. This difficult position
-inevitably placed the greatest possible strain on the nerves of
-Surgeon-Major Taute, our splendid senior medical officer. It
-was the greatest good fortune that this officer, singularly gifted
-both in medicine and in organization, proved equal to his grave
-responsibility. We owe it to the measures adopted by him,
-as well as to the change of district and climate forced upon us
-by circumstances, that the epidemic soon abated. A number
-of Askari and other natives not in a fit state for heavy work
-followed the force slowly; many of them lost courage when they
-continually found our camping-places empty. A large number,
-however, caught up with us, especially when the force did one
-of its short marches, or was able (a rare occurrence enough)
-to take a day’s rest.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_303" id="Page_303">[303]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER VII<br />
-<span class="wn">ON GERMAN SOIL ONCE MORE</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap08">BUT we could not afford many halts. The military position
-imperatively demanded that we should pass quickly
-through the districts to the east of the centre of Lake Nyassa,
-which were not fertile and had been largely stripped in the
-latest period of the war. Rapidity was all the more essential
-as it was possible for the enemy to move troops by sea to the
-north end of the lake and thus anticipate us by strongly occupying
-the district there. As we approached the river Lujenda, the
-ground became more mountainous and was scored with many
-water-courses and ravines. We could not simply march by
-the compass, but had to have regard to the watershed and keep
-along the mountain ridge. Fortunately, the leader of the advance
-guard, Captain Spangenberg, found some natives who acted as
-pathfinders and made it much easier to discover a good route.
-But a certain amount of doubling was unavoidable, and that
-retarded our progress, while the enemy were in a position to
-move troops and supplies swiftly from Malacotera along a good
-road to Luambala.</p>
-
-<p>I was somewhat anxious to know whether the water of the
-river Ludjenda would have fallen sufficiently to enable us to use
-the fords. It would no doubt have been easy to construct
-bark boats, but the transport of the whole force could hardly
-have gone smoothly forward, having regard to the violence of
-the current. In any case, I thought it most important that there
-should be no enemy opposition, and that again made haste
-essential. Fortunately patrols which we sent ahead found a
-ford below Luambala, where the wading of the river presented
-no difficulty. Several slaughtered hippopotami enabled us to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_304" id="Page_304">[304]</a></span>
-prepare some fat again, and in the neighbourhood of Mwembe,
-which we reached on the 17th September, we were able to replenish
-our supplies once more. At this point we took our first
-day’s rest for a long time. It was here at Mwembe that the
-lung epidemic reached its crisis. Since the middle of August,
-7 Europeans and about 200 natives had been attacked, of whom
-2 Europeans and 17 natives had died. The stores at Mwembe
-had been destroyed by the weak enemy posts, but there were still
-ample supplies to be had in the district. The question of carriers
-began to cause anxieties. The men had been severely tested
-by the continual marching, by the epidemic, and by the carriage
-of the sick; and we were approaching their home districts.
-It was probable that the Wangoni carriers would desert the
-moment they reached their home, which lay to the north of the
-Rovuma. In the district of Mwembe and the well-cultivated
-valleys of the river Luscheringo, several patrols of the enemy
-“Intelligence Department” were encountered; true, they were
-easily driven off, but their presence showed that the enemy was
-in the main aware of our movements.</p>
-
-<p>We sent long-distance patrols towards Mitomoni and Makalogi.
-To the south of the Rovuma, after leaving the Luscheringo
-valley, the steppe through which our march led us was amazingly
-rich in game, as was the Rovuma itself, which we reached on
-the 28th September. But the big game had its drawbacks, for
-once again a sentry was killed by lions. We came on to German
-soil again, and stayed two days at Nagwamira; we surprised
-several enemy depots and columns, which had had no news of our
-appearance. The country was amazingly fertile, and the troops
-were able to get thoroughly fit again. Our patrols sent out
-towards Mitomoni reported a camp somewhat strongly held
-and the arrival of reinforcements coming from the west. Ssongea,
-too, was occupied by the enemy, but in what strength could
-not be ascertained. Various reports, as well as the geographical
-position, made it likely that reinforcements were also on their
-way to Ssongea from Lake Nyassa.</p>
-
-<p>We continued our march, moving in the direction of Ssongea,
-and southwards of this place came into thickly settled country.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_305" id="Page_305">[305]</a></span>
-The enemy wireless disclosed that enemy troops were present
-in Ssongea, and that another column had arrived in the neighbourhood,
-in all probability from Mitomoni. On the 4th October
-I passed Ssongea on the west and continued to the north. When
-the advance guard under Captain Spangenberg reached the
-high road from Ssongea to Wiedhafen, it was attacked with
-trench-mortars by three enemy companies, which had come
-from the west. The enemy was forced back a little. On account
-of the hilly and ravine-scored nature of the ground and the
-advanced hour, it was improbable that we could achieve a really
-effective success on this day. By the morrow, however, there
-would be further enemy troops on the spot. I accordingly carried
-the attack no further, and marched by to the west of the enemy
-into a camp at the Peramiho mission station.</p>
-
-<p>As we passed through the Wangoni territory, a large number
-of our carriers deserted, as we had feared would happen. It
-would after all have been asking too much of human nature,
-to expect that these men, who had not seen their people for years,
-should now march straight through their native district. The
-nigger’s love of home is too strong. Even Samarunga, one of
-my own carriers and a very devoted and trustworthy fellow, asked
-for leave to visit his village, which lay near by. He came back
-faithfully enough and brought his brother with him. The two
-then marched on with us, and Samarunga stayed on even when
-his brother left. To revive his depression, I gave him some of
-my meat ration, but on the next morning he proved to have disappeared
-after all, having first put all my things in order.</p>
-
-<p>To the north of Ssongea a few enemy reconnoitring patrols were
-again met with. Day after day we moved through territory
-formerly fertile and well settled. Thousands of farmers could
-settle there in a healthy and beautiful climate. On the 14th
-October, we reached Pangire (Jacobi), a pleasantly situated
-mission station, in which, before the war, the missionary Gröschel
-had entertained me on my last tour. The missionary’s family
-had been removed, but the natives, who were of the Wabena
-tribe, had remained, and received us as in peace time, in a most
-friendly manner. Several old Askari, also, who had left the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_306" id="Page_306">[306]</a></span>
-force for one reason or another, now reported again. Here,
-too, some patrols were met with and driven off. In the Wabena
-country, which is well stocked with cattle, our very scanty stocks
-were replenished, and a mobile food-reserve thus constituted,
-which helped greatly to lighten our transport. After we had
-quitted Pangire, a patrol that we had left there was fired on by
-an enemy detachment. Near Ubena our rearguard, under
-Captain Müller, was attacked by several enemy companies
-arriving from the south. A fairly strong enemy column was
-thus following our track. The free open steppes of Ubena were
-not favourable ground for us to fight on, as they were commanded
-from long range by rifle and gun fire. Several reports were also
-received of the advance on Ubena of strong enemy forces from
-Mwakete; these reports proved to be in part incorrect, and led
-to a short fight between two German patrols.</p>
-
-<p>It was highly probable, and later it proved to be the case,
-that enemy troops would be moved by water to the northern
-end of Lake Nyassa and march from there on Ubena or
-further to the north. If I desired to give up the march towards
-Tabora, and to move instead between Lakes Nyassa and Rukwa,
-and later between Lakes Nyassa and Tanganyika, to Rhodesia,
-the time for the change of direction was now approaching and
-there was not a day to lose; this was all the more so as our
-freedom of movement was severely restricted by the steep slopes
-of Mount Livingstone and the hills round Mbeja. In settling
-our line of march we had to bear in mind that our stocks of provisions
-had dwindled considerably and required replenishing.
-Native information pointed to this being possible in the region
-of Kidugala and Sombowano, while famine was said to be raging
-in Ussangu, and especially round New Utengule.</p>
-
-<p>On the 17th October, I quitted Ubena with the main body,
-leaving behind there, sick or wounded, General Wahle, two
-other Europeans, and some Askari. I reached Kidugala on this
-day. Koehl’s detachment followed on the 18th October. On
-the same day, the Boma Ubena was occupied by some 100 enemy
-Askari, while 200 to 300 advanced northwards to the Iringa
-road. We learnt from captured newspapers that Cambrai had<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_307" id="Page_307">[307]</a></span>
-fallen on the 29th September and that the Belgians had advanced
-3 kilometres west of Roubaix. We read, too, of the cessation of
-hostilities in Bulgaria, of the retirement of Count Hertling, and
-of the capture of St. Quentin and Armentières. But positions
-could be given up for so many different reasons that I did not
-attribute any decisive importance to this news.</p>
-
-<p>Our further march past Ngombowano and Brandt led us
-through a district well stocked with cattle. Missions and schools
-had been deserted, but we were very glad to find garden fruits,
-especially mulberries and peaches. In the bush we also found
-great quantities of wild figs and other sweet and tasty fruits.
-Small patrol encounters indicated that enemy troops were moving
-direct from Lake Nyassa northwards into the Brandt district.
-In Ruiwa we found large English depots, and we had to destroy
-a whole warehouse full of leather. We went on to the mission
-of Old Utengule, also well known to me from peace time, and
-now lying deserted. We then reached Mbozi mission, where
-the English had assembled the men from the district, examined
-them, and sent them to New Langenburg, probably in order to
-turn them into Askari there. At Mbozi there was a large English
-depot, containing, among other things, 75 loads of salt and 47
-loads of coffee.</p>
-
-<p>It was difficult to feel our way through the district. In the
-main it was but little known to us, and for years the enemy had
-been altering it by building storehouses and transport roads.
-To have reconnoitred in advance would have made too great a
-demand on our time and strength, besides depriving us of the
-advantage of surprise. The inhabitants were very hostile to
-the English and rendered us valuable service, but their information
-was too often very vague. While we rested a day in Mbozi
-and replenished our stores, our patrols were far afield, one towards
-Galula (St. Moritz’ mission), another towards Itaka, one
-in the direction of New Langenburg, and one in that of Fife.
-Some of them would be away for weeks, and we could not wait
-for their reports.</p>
-
-<p>This much, however, became clear, that a main communication
-road of the enemy ran past Mbozi from Fife via Rwiba<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_308" id="Page_308">[308]</a></span>
-to New Langenburg. On this road we captured a lot of stores
-and several supply columns on the march. The existence of this
-road showed that a large English depot must lie in the neighbourhood
-of Fife. It would probably be possible to capture this
-by swift action, before stronger enemy forces arrived there. On
-the morning of 31st October a fighting patrol was dispatched
-against Fife. On the evening of the same day natives and
-patrols reported the advance of strong enemy forces on the New
-Langenburg-Rwiba road. In the early morning of the 1st
-November I moved off with the whole force, advancing in the
-first instance towards Mount Rwiba. There the track showed
-that a strong enemy column had passed the Rwiba hill shortly
-before us, in the direction of Fife. This enemy force had not
-been observed by a German fighting patrol that had been sent
-out to Mount Rwiba.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_309" id="Page_309">[309]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER VIII<br />
-<span class="wn">THE ADVANCE INTO BRITISH RHODESIA</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap04">THE second patrol dispatched by us on the 31st October
-towards Fife had halted at Mount Rwiba. I had now
-to advance with the whole force towards Fife, in order to
-reach it before the enemy, or to attack if our first patrol
-should prove to be engaged there. The ten-hour march (actual
-marching time) from Mbozi to Fife was a tremendous strain
-on the force, but the reports of our patrols, the track of the
-enemy, and his notes found on the trees, proved beyond a doubt
-that the enemy was doing everything possible to reach Fife on
-the same day, the 1st November. The great distance which
-they, too, had to march justified us in assuming that our patrol,
-which I expected would reach Fife on the 31st October, or at the
-latest on the 1st November, would be equal to preventing the
-enemy occupying the depot at Fife on the 1st. In the course
-of the afternoon we fired on several patrols, without halting
-in our advance. Late in the afternoon weak enemy detachments
-in the hills near Fife were quickly thrown back. I myself,
-with Spangenberg’s detachment, which had moved off the road
-to the right, advanced along a mountain ridge on to a point
-where we judged that Fife would lie.</p>
-
-<p>The ground was becoming more open, being mainly covered
-with knee-high bush and grass, when a few hundred yards
-before us we observed men moving about and tents pitched
-close together. The men were moving about in such unconcerned
-fashion that I almost took them for our own patrol, but
-at 200 yards we were received with violent and at first very
-well directed rifle and machine-gun fire. It was fortunate that
-our men did not answer it, for I had happened to get in advance<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_310" id="Page_310">[310]</a></span>
-and was between the two parties. After a time the enemy,
-who had apparently become very excited, began to fire high.
-It started to grow darker, so that my patrol was able to get back
-to our line. We had, at any rate, reached certainty. We knew
-that the enemy with a strength of several companies was lying
-before us in an entrenched position with a good field of fire.
-His advanced detachments had been thrown back. His depots lay
-in part outside the trenches, and later fell into our hands. I did
-not want to undertake the storming of the position, which would
-have been costly, but the opportunity seemed favourable to
-bombard the enemy, massed as he was in the position, with our
-trench-mortar, and also from a height with our gun, as well as
-with rifle and machine-gun fire if he should show himself. Our
-machine guns were accordingly moved forward in the night
-close to his position and entrenched. Reconnaissance for a
-good gun position was postponed to the next day.</p>
-
-<p>It was probable that the opening of our trench-mortar and
-gun-fire would lead the enemy advancing from New Langenburg
-to attack us. Such an attack against our heights would have
-been very difficult. But in spite of the bombardment on the
-2nd November, which was observed to cause some losses, no new
-enemy appeared. The definite success for which we hoped against
-the camp was not achieved, since our trench-mortar was destroyed
-at one of the first shots by a prematurely bursting shell.
-Flat trajectory fire alone could do nothing against the well-protected
-enemy. In the afternoon, therefore, our main body,
-with its herds of cattle more than 400 strong, marched off, between
-Fife and the Mwenzo mission towards Rhodesia. When
-we had reached camp, we saw heavy columns of smoke rising
-from the depots at Fife, to which Müller’s detachment had set
-fire after our departure. From the direction of the Mwenzo
-mission we heard short bursts of fire on several occasions.</p>
-
-<p>Reports came in gradually from that direction. In addition
-to our fighting patrols dispatched from Mbozi, other patrols
-of ours had arrived, and had fought with English patrols, and
-also with each other. One report stated that one enemy patrol
-had been observed with quite dark uniforms, hitherto unknown,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_311" id="Page_311">[311]</a></span>
-and that it must be some recently arrived body. After many
-inquiries I finally ascertained that one of our own patrols, whose
-equipment was certainly no longer quite in accord with regulations,
-had been continually mistaken for the enemy. In the
-Mwenzo mission itself there was a stationary enemy hospital,
-from which we were able to replenish our medical stores. Our
-quinine stocks were brought up to over fourteen kilos, supplies
-thus being insured until June, 1919.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
- <img src="images/ill-311.jpg" width="400" height="333" id="m311"
- alt=""
- title="" />
- <p class="pc">Fig. xxi. The March into Rhodesia.</p>
-</div>
-
-<p>Various reports and statements of prisoners showed that enemy
-transport was moving from the Broken Hill district to Kasama,
-and from there onwards to Fife, with motor-cars and ox-wagons.
-Kasama itself seemed to be a large place and an important road
-centre. In any case, we could expect enemy depots on the way
-from Fife to Kasama, and Kasama itself would be a valuable objective.
-So far as one could tell from the map, the position also
-seemed to be such that we should be able there to decide to go
-further southwards round Lake Bangweolo and reach the Zambesi-Congo<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_312" id="Page_312">[312]</a></span>
-watershed, or to march further westwards between
-Lakes Bangweolo and Moero. The information was certainly
-very uncertain, resting almost exclusively on several Askari,
-who as children had been employed in trade caravans in the
-neighbourhood of Lake Moero.</p>
-
-<p>The important question of the nature of the rivers, and in
-particular of the Luapala, which flowed from Lake Bangweolo
-into Lake Moero, was for the time quite unsolved. We did not
-clear up these points until we captured some maps and notes.
-About this time, according to these, the Luapala was a mighty
-barrier; deep and in many places very broad; it is enclosed by
-extended marshes. In the rainy season that was just approaching,
-any attempt to cross the river in canoes would meet with
-difficulties, since on our approach the canoes would certainly be
-removed to the opposite bank or concealed. I devoted every
-minute to the study of maps and travel-descriptions, burying
-myself in them at every halt in the march. There was great
-danger that in ignorance of our position we might run into an
-<i>impasse</i> in this region of great rivers and lakes.</p>
-
-<p>The first thing was to sweep rapidly along the communication
-road Fife-Kajambi mission-Kasama. Mobile detachments were
-sent on by forced marches, capturing several small depots,
-taking their guards prisoner, and also securing a few ox-wagon
-teams. Captain Spangenberg followed immediately with three
-companies, and then the main body, at a distance of about one
-day’s march.</p>
-
-<p>The heavy marches and the deviation to the south-west,
-into quite new and unknown territory, was too much for a number
-of carriers. On one single day there deserted from the staff
-20 Wafiri, who had their homes in the region of Bismarckburg,
-and 13 carriers from other districts.</p>
-
-<p>The main body arrived at Kajambi on the 6th November.
-The Catholic mission station there consists of wonderful, spacious
-and massive buildings. The missionaries had fled, quite unnecessarily.
-In the nuns’ house there was a letter for me from
-a Catholic nun. She was a native of Westphalia, and as a fellow-countrywoman
-appealed to my humanity. She would certainly<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_313" id="Page_313">[313]</a></span>
-have spared herself many discomforts if both she herself and the
-other people attached to the mission had remained quietly at
-their posts. We should have done as little to them as we had
-done earlier to the old English missionary at Peramiho, near
-Ssongea. The soil was extraordinarily fertile; in the mission
-garden magnificent strawberries were growing. At midday
-we heard rifle fire from the rearguard, which was encamped
-two hours’ march north-east of Kajambi; Captain Koehl had
-remained there to gather supplies, and his Europeans and Askari
-had largely been distributed into separate supply patrols. In
-this situation he was attacked by an enemy patrol. Captain
-Koehl extricated himself from this unpleasant position and on
-the next day established his front by Kajambi mission, and we
-had the opportunity, which we used with great success, to take
-the enemy under our fire by surprise. On the 7th November
-our main body resumed its march on Kasama. The enemy
-were not observed to be following up. If, however, they were
-to press on behind us, it was to be assumed that questions of
-supply would prevent their doing so in really great strength.
-We had the prospect of swiftly seizing Kasama, and then of
-making this place our base and giving battle under favourable
-conditions.</p>
-
-<p>But these were hopes of the future; the first thing was to
-take Kasama itself quickly; according to our information it
-was not strongly held, but was well fortified. Captain Spangenberg
-with the advance guard kept increasing his distance from
-the main body by longer and longer marches. I followed with
-the main body; ample supplies were found, and we also met
-with confirmation of the descriptions given in various books
-to the effect that the forest is well stocked with tasty bush fruits.</p>
-
-<p>On the 8th November Spangenberg’s detachment had several
-patrol fights to the north of Kasama, and on the 9th it took
-Kasama, whose garrison, in the strength of half a company,
-retired to the southward. Only a little ammunition was captured
-and there was little else of value in the armoury. There
-was a large repair shop for motor and other vehicles, and
-more than a score of Boer wagons were taken. There was considerable<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_314" id="Page_314">[314]</a></span>
-booty in food supplies for Europeans. It was noteworthy
-that an English company in Kasama&mdash;I think it was
-the African Lakes Corporation&mdash;had given written instructions
-for the destruction of its depots by the natives. These came
-in large numbers to loot, and Spangenberg’s detachment
-found buildings and their contents largely destroyed by looting
-natives. It is due to his action that among other things the
-house of the British Commissioner, which was built and furnished
-with great taste, was preserved.</p>
-
-<p>During our advance from Fife it had appeared that the further
-we went the fuller were the enemy depots. We gained the impression
-that we were working up a line of communications
-which started around Broken Hill or somewhat to the north
-of it, and was only just being established. We had grounds
-for hoping that if we moved rapidly forward, we should find
-depots even more plentifully stocked; and the documents taken,
-besides information from natives, seemed to confirm this. Three
-days’ march further along the telephone line, large stores were
-said to be lying at the Chambezi ferry, which had in part been
-brought thither by boat. I myself on the 11th November
-cycled to Kasama and met Captain Spangenberg there, and
-he immediately resumed his march, with two companies, southwards,
-in the direction of the Chambezi ferry.</p>
-
-<p>On the 12th November the main body reached Kasama. Towards
-evening rifle and machine-gun fire was heard from the
-direction of our march. Our rearguard had been attacked
-in its camp, two hours to the north of Kasama. The enemy
-who had fought at Kajambi had not followed us directly, but
-had taken a parallel course. In the evening Koehl’s detachment
-arrived in Kasama. I had now formed the opinion that the
-attempt on the Chambezi depot was the more promising and important
-undertaking, especially as the whole position made it
-probable that the pursuing enemy would continue to follow and
-thus again afford us an opportunity to give battle.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_315" id="Page_315">[315]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">CHAPTER IX<br />
-<span class="wn">THE ARMISTICE AND OUR RETURN HOME</span></h2>
-
-<p class="drop-cap16">ACCORDINGLY only Koehl’s detachment remained at Kasama,
-with instructions to follow us a day’s march behind.
-Early on November 13th I followed Spangenberg’s detachment
-with our main body. I had gone on ahead on a bicycle, selected
-the site for our camp and was waiting for the troops to come
-up when Captain Müller appeared before me, also on his bicycle,
-and reported that an armistice had been concluded. An English
-motor-cyclist who was to have brought the news to the British
-troops had apparently passed through Kasama and been captured
-there by Koehl’s detachment. Thanks to the English
-telephone line, along which we were marching, we were soon able
-to understand each other, and thus did we get the news of the
-armistice.</p>
-
-<p>The telegram of the motor-cyclist ran as follows:</p>
-
-<div class="pbq">
-
-<p class="p1">“12. 11. 18. To be fwded via M.B. cable and despatch rider.</p>
-
-<p>“Send following to Colonel von Lettow Vorbeck under white
-flag. The Prime Minister of England has announced that an
-armistice was signed at 5 hours on Nov. 11th, and that hostilities
-on all fronts cease at 11 hours on Nov. 11th. I am ordering
-my troops to cease hostilities forthwith unless attacked, and of
-course I conclude that you will do the same. Conditions of
-armistice will be forwarded you immediately I receive them.
-Meanwhile I suggest that you should remain in your present
-vicinity in order to facilitate communication.&mdash;General van
-Deventer. As message is also being sent to Livingstone, it is
-important Karwunfor receives this same time as enemy; every
-effort must be made to get message to him to-day.”</p></div>
-
-<p class="p1">Our feelings were very mixed. Personally, as I had no knowledge<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_316" id="Page_316">[316]</a></span>
-of the real state of affairs in Germany, I felt convinced that
-the conclusion of hostilities must have been favourable, or at
-least not unfavourable to Germany.</p>
-
-<p>Spangenberg’s detachment, which was on ahead, had to be told
-as soon as possible, and I immediately set out on my bicycle after
-it, taking with me Haouter, a Landsturm soldier, as my sole
-companion. About half-way, Reissmann’s cyclist patrol of
-Spangenberg’s detachment met me and reported that Captain
-Spangenberg had arrived at the Chambezi. Although I had no
-doubts about the correctness of the English news, our position
-was very uncomfortable. We were in a district where there was
-little food, and were therefore compelled to move on from place
-to place. This circumstance had already compelled us to reconnoitre
-and secure for ourselves the crossings of the Chambezi.
-If hostilities were resumed we must be certain of a safe crossing.
-This was a burning question, as the rainy season, meaning a great
-rise of this river, was near at hand. We had already encountered
-heavy storms. I had, therefore, much to discuss with Captain
-Spangenberg and the English officer who would presumably be
-on the far bank of the river. In any case we must continue to
-devote our energies to buying or getting food. Full of that
-idea, I sent my companion back and cycled myself with Reissmann’s
-patrol to Spangenberg’s detachment.</p>
-
-<p>We arrived about eight o’clock, when it was quite dark. Captain
-Spangenberg was away on a reconnaissance, but Assistant-Paymaster
-Dohmen and other Europeans looked after me well
-as soon as they learnt of my arrival. I was able to convince myself
-that the supply depot of Kasama really existed. I tasted jam
-and other good things which had been unknown to me hitherto.</p>
-
-<p>When Captain Spangenberg came back he told me that he had
-already heard of the armistice through the English. After I
-had gone to bed in his tent, he brought me about midnight a
-telegram from General Deventer which had been brought in by
-the English. It had come from Salisbury. It stated that Germany
-had accepted the unconditional handing-over of all troops
-operating in East Africa. Deventer added that he demanded
-the immediate surrender of all our English prisoners of war, and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_317" id="Page_317">[317]</a></span>
-that we should march to Abercorn. All our arms and ammunition
-were to be given up at Abercorn, but our Europeans were to
-be allowed to keep their weapons.</p>
-
-<p>The full text of the telegram ran as follows:</p>
-
-<div class="pbq">
-
-<p class="p1">“13. 11. 18. To Norforce. Karwunfor via Fife.</p>
-
-<p>“Send following to Colonel von Lettow Vorbeck under white
-flag: War Office London telegraphs that clause seventeen of the
-armistice signed by the German Govt. provides for unconditional
-surrender of all German forces operating in East Africa within
-one month from Nov. 11th.</p>
-
-<p>“My conditions are. First: hand over all allied prisoners
-in your hands, Europeans and natives to the nearest body of
-British troops forthwith. Second: that you bring your forces
-to Abercorn without delay, as Abercorn is the nearest place at
-which I can supply you with food. Third: that you hand over
-all arms and ammunition to my representative at Abercorn. I
-will, however, allow you and your officers and European ranks
-to retain their personal weapons for the present in consideration
-of the gallant fight you have made, provided that you bring
-your force to Abercorn without delay. Arrangements will be
-made at Abercorn to send all Germans to Morogoro and to repatriate
-German Askari. Kindly send an early answer, giving
-probable date of arrival at Abercorn and numbers of German
-officers and men, Askari and followers.”</p></div>
-
-<p class="p1">This was news enough if it were confirmed, and showed the
-desperate situation of the Fatherland. Nothing else could account
-for the surrender of a force still maintaining itself proudly and
-victoriously in the field.</p>
-
-<p>Without being in a position to examine the ground in detail,
-I had to tell myself that the conditions imposed upon us were
-inevitable, and must be loyally carried out. I met the British
-Commissioner, who had come from Kasama to the Chambezi
-rubber factory, at the river at eight o’clock on the morning of the
-14th. There I handed to him a telegram to His Majesty, in which
-I reported what had happened and added that I would act accordingly.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_318" id="Page_318">[318]</a></span>
-The Commissioner told me that the German fleet had
-revolted, and that a revolution had also broken out in Germany;
-further, if he was to accept a report which was official but had
-not yet been confirmed, the Kaiser had abdicated on November
-10th. All this news seemed to me very improbable, and I did not
-believe it until it was confirmed on my way home months later.</p>
-
-<p>All our troops, native as well as Europeans, had always held
-the conviction that Germany could not be beaten in this war,
-and were resolved to fight on to the last. Of course it was doubtful
-whether our resources would last out if the war lasted several
-years more, but we faced all possibilities tranquilly for at least
-another year. The men were well armed, equipped and fed, and
-the strategic situation at the moment was more favourable than
-it had been for a long time. The Askari, it is true, saw that our
-numbers were dwindling&mdash;we were still 155 Europeans, comprising
-30 officers, medical officers and higher officials, 1,168 Askari,
-and about 3,000 other natives&mdash;but whenever I discussed this
-topic with one of my orderlies he always assured me: “I will
-always stick by you and fight on till I fall.” Many others spoke
-to the same effect, and I am convinced that it was not merely a
-case of empty words.</p>
-
-<p>In the afternoon of the 14th November, I cycled back to our
-main body and told the Europeans what I had learned at the
-Chambezi, and that it was my intention to carry out the conditions
-which had been officially communicated to me, conditions the
-accuracy of which I did not doubt.</p>
-
-<p>Before the prisoners were released Colonel Dickinson, the most
-senior of them, came to look for me to say good-bye. He said
-that his period of captivity (it had been more than three months)
-had given him an interesting insight into our camp life, our marching
-methods, and the way in which we conducted our actions.
-He was full of praise for the simplicity of our arrangements and
-the absence of friction which distinguished our operations. There
-is no doubt he had been using his eyes.</p>
-
-<p>Our Askari were now informed of the turn of affairs. It was to
-be anticipated that there would be difficulties when it came to
-settling up with them for their pay, which was years overdue, and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_319" id="Page_319">[319]</a></span>
-the same applied to the carriers. Yet it was a matter of honour
-for us to see that these people, who had fought and worked for us
-with such devotion, should receive their rights. The sum involved&mdash;about
-one and a half million rupees&mdash;was relatively
-small, and so Lieutenant Kempner was sent out on a bicycle to
-get this sum from the English, or induce them to procure it as
-quickly as possible. Our repeated efforts were without result.
-We were told at different times and places that the matter was
-“under consideration” by the War Office, and there it remained.
-I never even received a reply to my telegram to the German
-Government in Berlin. There was nothing for it but to draw up
-lists of all the back pay that was due, and give the individual
-carriers and Askari certificates against it.</p>
-
-<p>We then marched by short stages through Kasama to Abercorn.
-The British gave us further details about the armistice
-conditions. It appeared that not “unconditional surrender”
-(as General van Deventer had said originally) but “unconditional
-evacuation” was what was required. I made several protests
-against the interpretation of the British War Office, which made
-the word “evacuation” include surrender and disarming, but I
-received no answer either from the Governments of the allied
-countries and the United States, or from the German Government.
-In view of the doubtful interpretation of the word
-“evacuation,” I considered whether I should not cut short negotiations
-and march to join the Belgians or somewhere else. But
-in comparison to the whole series of peace conditions which
-affected the Protective Force, this seemed a small point, and in
-the end I decided to go to Dar-es-Salaam, as General van Deventer
-required, though certainly in the expectation that in accordance
-with the terms the English would immediately send us back from
-there to Germany. As will appear later that expectation was not
-fulfilled.</p>
-
-<p>Not far north of Kasama we came up with the enemy with
-whom we had fought our last engagement. They were the 1st
-battalion of the 4th King’s African Rifles. I had to refuse the
-invitation of Colonel Hawkins (their estimable commander, who
-was barely thirty years old), communicated to me on the march<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_320" id="Page_320">[320]</a></span>
-by Colonel Dickinson, to bring all the German officers to lunch,
-much though I appreciated such an expression of chivalry. Yet
-Colonel Dickinson did not neglect to pay me his promised visit
-on one of the following days, and we had a very pleasant hour
-over a cup of coffee. I must record that the officers of this battalion,
-even in the somewhat difficult circumstances in which they
-were placed, behaved with great tact and with that regard which
-is due to an honourable foe. Hawkins told me that for reasons
-of supply he would not have been able to follow us any further,
-and in fact we had to help him out with cattle, of which we had
-an ample stock.</p>
-
-<p>Lieutenant Kempner had gone on to Abercorn on his bicycle.
-When he came back I went there myself in a car which General
-Edwards had sent for me. My reception by General Edwards,
-as well as his Staff, was very kind. I put forward my point of
-view to General Edwards that I did not recognize any duty to
-surrender of our arms, but was ready to do so if I was thereby
-conferring some advantage, not on ourselves individually, but on
-the German Government. I was then informed that the arms
-we surrendered would form part of the quantity which Germany
-had to hand over to the Allied Governments in accordance with
-the terms of the armistice. Further, the surrender of our arms
-should not have the character of a laying-down of arms.</p>
-
-<p>As regards the Askari and carriers, I was informed that the
-English would take them to an internment camp at Tabora, until
-the question of their pay had been settled and their repatriation
-arranged. The Europeans were to be interned at Dar-es-Salaam
-until their ship left, presumably, therefore, for a few days. Not
-only the Askari but the Europeans at Dar-es-Salaam were kept
-behind barbed wire for a month and a half and more.</p>
-
-<p>The troops arrived at Abercorn on the 25th November. The
-English flag was waving on the parade-ground where the handing-over
-of arms took place, and this shows that the character of a
-surrender of our arms was not altogether avoided. What we
-handed over was as follows:</p>
-
-<p>1 Portuguese gun, 37 machine guns (7 German, 16 heavy and
-14 light English), 1,071 English and Portuguese rifles, 208,000<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_321" id="Page_321">[321]</a></span>
-rounds, 40 rounds of artillery ammunition. The English were
-mighty quick at getting away the surrendered material. There
-was not a single modern German rifle among it! The strength
-of our troops was: the Governor, 20 officers, 5 medical officers,
-a doctor of the Voluntary Medical Detachment, a senior veterinary
-officer, a senior chemist, a field-telegraph officer, 125 European
-other ranks, 1,156 Askari and 1,598 carriers. The arrival of
-individual detachments was delayed for hours by heavy rain.</p>
-
-<p>The camp for the Askari was surrounded by a thick thorn
-hedge, and was much too small. This led to a good deal of bad
-feeling among our Askari, which vented itself in frequent demonstrations
-against the English Askari. But at length our people
-resigned themselves to the uncomfortable conditions, and even
-General Edwards realized that the treatment provided an opportunity
-for unnecessary friction. We were not ordinary prisoners
-of war, whose escape he had to fear, but had given ourselves into
-his hands voluntarily in the performance of an unpleasant duty.
-He took precautions against similar occurrences during our march
-to Bismarckburg, and we went there with Hawkins’ battalion
-and without the slightest friction. On November 28th we
-bivouacked by the mighty waterfall of the river Kalambo, three
-hours’ march from Bismarckburg. Here we remained several
-days, as the departure of the steamer from that place was being
-continually delayed. Many of my officers continually badgered
-me to know whether we could not fight on. These suggestions
-were far from comfortable, as I had already quite enough to do to
-consider how we should get out of so unpleasant a situation. But
-putting aside the difficulties involved, I could only feel glad and
-proud of such a revelation of true soldierly spirit, a spirit which
-did not shrink, even after we had handed over all our arms,
-from storming an enemy camp and once more procuring for ourselves
-the means to continue the war.</p>
-
-<p>On December 3rd I received a telegram, dated the 2nd December,
-from General van Deventer. It ran as follows:</p>
-
-<div class="pbq">
-
-<p class="p1">“I beg to acknowledge receipt of your telegram setting
-forth your formal protest against your troops being treated as<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_322" id="Page_322">[322]</a></span>
-prisoners of war. This will duly be forwarded to the War Office.
-Meanwhile I am sure you will recognise that pending the receipt
-through the War Office of a communication on the subject of
-the German Govt. I have had no choice but to act in accordance
-with the orders of the War Office, and treat your force as prisoners
-of war.”</p></div>
-
-<p class="p1">The same day the first lot of troops for transport went on board
-four ships. One of them, the <i>St. George</i>, had, in addition to its
-crew of English bluejackets and an escort officer, only the
-Governor and the officers of our force with their black servants.
-For food the English gave us corned beef, dates and biscuits,
-and Dr. Huber, the veterinary officer, looked after our bodily
-welfare here on board as carefully as he had done for so many
-years in the bush. The British commander, the escort officer
-and the whole crew were extraordinarily kind. After a short
-stop on the evening of the 3rd, at the Belgian station of Vua, a
-violent storm arose in the night. It tore away the awning and,
-among other things, carried off Dr. Huber’s coat. The English
-sailors did all they possibly could for the Germans, who were
-quite wet through.</p>
-
-<p>On December 5th we arrived at Kigoma. The place was under
-Belgian control, and the Belgians received us with a hospitality
-which could not have been anticipated. They displayed a
-tactful reserve to us which had never been shown before. Tables
-covered with cloths had been set out for all the Europeans, a
-sight we had not seen for years. Some red wine was produced.
-The Belgian Governor had sent his orderly officer, who spoke
-German fluently, to receive us officially, and I was glad to take
-the opportunity, before we started on our railway journey, to
-thank the Belgian commandant for the <i>camaraderie</i> shown us,
-<i>camaraderie</i> which always exists among soldiers, even between
-enemies, when they have a mutual regard for each other.</p>
-
-<p>Among the English, too, examples of discourtesy on the part
-of individual officers, who apparently had not been brought
-up in the South, were absolutely exceptional. The senior men
-immediately adopted a tactful attitude, whereas one or two<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_323" id="Page_323">[323]</a></span>
-juniors did otherwise&mdash;for example, they were inconsiderate
-enough to want to keep a German invalid out of the compartment.
-We Europeans were very well looked after on the train, and it
-was like peace time to get a good night’s rest by letting down the
-bunks and using a leather pillow.</p>
-
-<p>There was quite a crowd of Germans on the station at Tabora.
-They complained of many cases of theft on the part of the Belgians
-and English. It is undoubtedly true that such outrages
-had taken place. We stopped for the night at Dodoma and
-next morning had an opportunity of fetching water and having
-a bath.</p>
-
-<p>The news of the approach of our train had reached Morogoro,
-and when we arrived there in the afternoon we once more found
-the German women whom we had left behind us in and about
-Morogoro two years before. They had tea and coffee waiting
-for us. They had arranged tables and baked plenty of rolls
-and cakes. In addition they had got the finest fruit for us.
-The English were almost as much interested as the Germans.
-Besides a very amiable elderly medical officer I have a particularly
-lively recollection of a tall, lanky corporal who had apparently
-drunk a whole series of glasses to our health before our train
-arrived. I managed to slip away from him at last.</p>
-
-<p>We reached Dar-es-Salaam at seven o’clock on the morning of
-December 8th. The Europeans were well housed in tents in a
-camp within a barbed-wire fence. Food was good and plentiful,
-and we were able to buy necessaries of all kinds cheaply from the
-English canteen. Governor Schnee and I were received by the
-Chief of Staff of the British commander, General Sheppard,
-and conducted to our very pretty house outside the camp.
-General van Deventer had very kindly sent a luncheon there
-as a welcome to us. Major Kraut, Captain Spangenberg, and
-Dr. Huber were all quartered here. We found General Wahle,
-who had been left behind sick at Ubene and fallen into the enemy’s
-hands a few months back. He had quite recovered. We had a
-common mess and our freedom of movement out of the house
-was only limited to the extent that we had always to be accompanied
-by a British officer as escort. At the start these gentlemen<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_324" id="Page_324">[324]</a></span>
-were very unpunctual, but gradually quite tolerable relations
-were established between us, and I had an opportunity of
-visiting acquaintances in Dar-es-Salaam and arranging my personal
-affairs. A car was also usually placed at my disposal.
-Major Hosken, the Commandant of the prison camp, who had
-previously shown himself extremely considerate to the captured
-German women and children in Tanga, now again devoted himself
-to preserve us from unnecessary annoyance.</p>
-
-<p>On our railway journey we had already been surprised to find
-almost more English Europeans at every station than we had in
-the whole of the Protective Force. Dar-es-Salaam itself literally
-swarmed with white troops. I estimated their number at not
-less than five thousand, and hundreds and hundreds of motor
-lorries and cars were awaiting repairs in the motor transport
-park.</p>
-
-<p>This close concentration of human beings revealed its dangers
-when Spanish influenza made its appearance. Escort officers
-told me that frequently five or seven English officers had died of
-this disease at Dar-es-Salaam. We soon came across its traces
-among ourselves. Infection had probably taken place while we
-were on the ship on Lake Tanganyika, and subsequently on the
-train. It spread from man to man in the concentration camps in
-Dar-es-Salaam. Captain Spangenberg was going about with me
-in the town shortly after his arrival at Dar-es-Salaam. Then he
-felt ill, and though his iron constitution had successfully overcome
-all the hardships of the campaign, he died in hospital on December
-18th of influenza and inflammation of the lungs.</p>
-
-<p>Almost all the Europeans in our camp were attacked by it, and
-it was very sad that in addition to Captain Spangenberg, nine
-other Europeans, in all, therefore, ten per cent. of our strength,
-succumbed. Numbers of our Askari interned at Tabora also died.</p>
-
-<p>My comings and goings often took me to the Administration
-Staff (corresponding more or less to our Commandant on the
-Lines of Communication). After much questioning I had found
-it in my old house which I had occupied before the war. Among
-intelligent Englishmen I found the view prevailing that Germany
-must have colonies on economic grounds, as well as on account<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_325" id="Page_325">[325]</a></span>
-of her over-populousness. England was considered to have too
-many colonies. For the time being, at any rate, she had not
-sufficient suitable personnel to manage them.</p>
-
-<p>If the English, when telling us of the armistice, insisted on our
-coming to Dar-es-Salaam at once, in order that we should be transported
-punctually&mdash;that is, by the 12th December&mdash;they showed
-no haste on their own part to carry out the terms of that armistice.
-Our embarkation was continually postponed, and, finally,
-it did not take place until the 17th January, 1919, five years to
-the day after I had landed at Dar-es-Salaam.</p>
-
-<p class="p2">To describe my return home in detail would furnish material
-for a whole book and could hardly be excelled for tragi-comic
-events. In addition to 114 German soldiers, we had 107 women
-and 87 children on board, and an escort of 200 British soldiers.</p>
-
-<p>Voyaging by Cape Town, we reached Rotterdam at the end of
-February. The large crowd of Germans who turned up to meet
-us at the quay showed me, to my surprise, that our East African
-war had been watched very closely in the homeland. Many
-Dutch also gave us proofs of goodwill.</p>
-
-<p>In cold truth our small band, which at the most comprised
-some 300 Europeans and about 11,000 Askari, had occupied a
-very superior enemy force for the whole war. According to what
-English officers told me, 137 Generals had been in the field, and
-in all about 300,000 men had been employed against us. The
-enemy’s losses in dead would not be put too high at 60,000, for
-an English Press notice stated that about 20,000 Europeans and
-Indians alone had died or been killed, and to that must be added
-the large number of black soldiers who fell. The enemy had
-left 140,000 horses and mules behind in the battle area. Yet in
-spite of the enormously superior numbers at the disposal of the
-enemy, our small force, the rifle strength of which was only about
-1,400 at the time of the armistice, had remained in the field always
-ready for action and possessed of the highest determination.</p>
-
-<p>I believe it was the transparency of our aims, the love of our
-Fatherland, the strong sense of duty and the spirit of self-sacrifice
-which animated each of our few Europeans and communicated<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_326" id="Page_326">[326]</a></span>
-themselves, consciously or unconsciously, to our brave black
-soldiers that gave our operations that impetus which they possessed
-to the end. In addition there was a soldierly pride, a
-feeling of firm mutual co-operation and a spirit of enterprise
-without which military success is impossible in the long run.
-We East Africans know only too well that our achievements
-cannot be compared with the military deeds and devotion of those
-in the homeland. No people in history has ever done more.</p>
-
-<p>If we East Africans received so kindly a reception in the homeland
-it was because everyone seemed to think that we had preserved
-some part of Germany’s soldierly traditions, had come
-back home unsullied, and that the Teutonic sense of loyalty
-peculiar to us Germans had kept its head high even under the
-conditions of war in the tropics.</p>
-
-<p>It is true that that feeling has suffered eclipse in many of our
-people under the impression of the present tribulations of our
-Fatherland. But it is part of the flesh and blood of us all, and it
-is just that enthusiastic welcome which hundreds of thousands
-of our countrymen gave us that strengthens our conviction that,
-in spite of the momentary distractions and perplexities, the
-healthy spirit of our German people will prevail again and once
-more tread the upward path.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_327" id="Page_327">[327]</a></span></p>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">INDEX</h2>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_328" id="Page_328">[328]</a></span></p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">A</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Adjutant</i> (steamer), <a href="#Page_85">85</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Adler, Captain, <a href="#Page_35">35</a>, <a href="#Page_56">56</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Aeroplanes:</p>
-<p class="pnii">first appearance, <a href="#Page_80">80</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">brought down, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Alto Moloque:</p>
-<p class="pnii">surprise, <a href="#Page_263">263</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Portuguese officers taken prisoner, <a href="#Page_263">263</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">large supplies of food, <a href="#Page_265">265</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Amaramba, Lake, <a href="#Page_302">302</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Amboni plantation, <a href="#Page_62">62</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Armistice, first news of, <a href="#Page_13">13</a> Nov., <a href="#Page_315">315</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Arrival of first store-ship, <a href="#Page_67">67</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">second ditto, <a href="#Page_117">117</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Artillery, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>, <a href="#Page_46">46</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Arusha:</p>
-<p class="pnii">cattle extensive, <a href="#Page_11">11</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">potentiality of the district, <a href="#Page_11">11</a>, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Askari:</p>
-<p class="pnii">native soldiers, <a href="#Page_27">27</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">training, <a href="#Page_8">8</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">old, well-to-do, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">back pay, <a href="#Page_319">319</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">women follow our force, <a href="#Page_177">177</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Astræa</i>, English cruiser, <a href="#Page_27">27</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Attendants reduced, <a href="#Page_176">176</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Augar, Captain, <a href="#Page_35">35</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Aumann, Captain, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>, <a href="#Page_100">100</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_329" id="Page_329">[329]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Auracher, District Commissioner, <a href="#Page_35">35</a>, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">B</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bagamoyo:</p>
-<p class="pnii">bombarded, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">reconnoitre, <a href="#Page_146">146</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">falls into enemy hands, <a href="#Page_148">148</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bangweolo, Lake, <a href="#Page_311">311</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Baron Dhanis</i>, steamer (Belgian), <a href="#Page_95">95</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Barrett, Lieutenant (English), <a href="#Page_107">107</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Barton, Colonel (English), <a href="#Page_251">251</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bast, Sergt.-Major, killed, <a href="#Page_87">87</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Batzner, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_214">214</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Baudouinville (Congo):</p>
-<p class="pnii">White Fathers, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">French missionaries, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">native industry, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Baumstark, Captain, <a href="#Page_33">33</a>, <a href="#Page_36">36</a>, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Baziots, The, Administrator, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Becker’s post, <a href="#Page_90">90</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Before the war, re-arming companies, <a href="#Page_13">13</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Behobeho:</p>
-<p class="pnii">field howitzer lost, <a href="#Page_171">171</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">heavy fighting and Selous killed, <a href="#Page_171">171</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Belgian steamer <i>Delcommune</i> shot to pieces, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Belgian Commander-in-Chief at Lake Kivu, <a href="#Page_92">92</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bergmann, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_39">39</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Besch, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_224">224</a>, <a href="#Page_246">246</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Beves, General (English), <a href="#Page_212">212</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_330" id="Page_330">[330]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Bismarckburg-Langenburg operations, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bleeck, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_56">56</a>, <a href="#Page_162">162</a>, <a href="#Page_200">200</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bock, Lieut.-Colonel von, <a href="#Page_8">8</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bock, Captain von, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>, <a href="#Page_136">136</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Boell, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_138">138</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">wounded, <a href="#Page_301">301</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Boemken, Major von, <a href="#Page_159">159</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bolles, Sergt.-Major, killed, <a href="#Page_296">296</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Boot-making experiments, <a href="#Page_194">194</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Botha, General, reported coming, <a href="#Page_72">72</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Braunschweig, Captain, <a href="#Page_82">82</a>, <a href="#Page_149">149</a>, <a href="#Page_182">182</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bread without wheat flour, <a href="#Page_193">193</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bridge building, <a href="#Page_71">71</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">British North Lancashire Regiment, <a href="#Page_42">42</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">British Regular officers chivalrous, <a href="#Page_107">107</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">British treatment of German prisoners, <a href="#Page_221">221</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Brits, General, <a href="#Page_147">147</a>, <a href="#Page_149">149</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Brucher, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_192">192</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bueschel, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_87">87</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Buffaloes, best in East Africa, <a href="#Page_12">12</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Buiko, <a href="#Page_141">141</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Bukoba, <a href="#Page_88">88</a>, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Buller, Major (English), wounded, <a href="#Page_147">147</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Burungi Mountains, <a href="#Page_134">134</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">supplies plentiful, <a href="#Page_134">134</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">C</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Camaraderie</i> of escort, <a href="#Page_322">322</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Carriers, numbers of, <a href="#Page_22">22</a>, <a href="#Page_24">24</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Cecil Rhodes</i>, steamer, sunk, <a href="#Page_97">97</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Chalau taken, <a href="#Page_287">287</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Chambesi depot, <a href="#Page_314">314</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Chappuis, Lieutenant von, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>, <a href="#Page_185">185</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Chirumba station, <a href="#Page_241">241</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Chiulezi, <a href="#Page_235">235</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Chiwata, position, <a href="#Page_217">217</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">ammunition shortage, <a href="#Page_218">218</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Christiansen, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_68">68</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Cloth-making at Kilima Njaro, <a href="#Page_70">70</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Coast towns defence, <a href="#Page_63">63</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Command of Lake Tanganyika, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Communications cut off, <a href="#Page_34">34</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_331" id="Page_331">[331]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Concentration at Pugu, <a href="#Page_21">21</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Congo Act, against England, <a href="#Page_19">19</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Containing the enemy on Uganda, <a href="#Page_77">77</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Cook, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_101">101</a>st Grenadier Guards, <a href="#Page_45">45</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Cotton spinning, <a href="#Page_69">69</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Cutsch, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_221">221</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Cutting down rations, <a href="#Page_176">176</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">D</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Dar-es-Salaam:</p>
-<p class="pnii">first action, artillery fire, <a href="#Page_27">27</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">negotiations for surrender, <a href="#Page_28">28</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">English ships appear, <a href="#Page_52">52</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">English Consul King, <a href="#Page_20">20</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">internment at, <a href="#Page_323">323</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">embarkation, <a href="#Page_325">325</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Delcommune</i>, Belgian steamer, destroyed, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Delschitz, Lieutenant von, <a href="#Page_97">97</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Dessel, Dr., <a href="#Page_38">38</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Destructiveness of termites, <a href="#Page_30">30</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Deventer, General van:</p>
-<p class="pnii">arrives, <a href="#Page_138">138</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">at Kondoa, <a href="#Page_144">144</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">at Kilossa, <a href="#Page_146">146</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">at Kilwa, <a href="#Page_200">200</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">calls for surrender, <a href="#Page_235">235</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">telegram of Armistice, <a href="#Page_315">315</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">conditions of Armistice, <a href="#Page_317">317</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Dickinson, Colonel (English), <a href="#Page_284">284</a>, <a href="#Page_318">318</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Discontent at Logeloge, <a href="#Page_163">163</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">District Commissioner, <a href="#Page_6">6</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Dodoma, enemy reach, <a href="#Page_145">145</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Dsalla, Lake, <a href="#Page_110">110</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Dürr, Father, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Dutumi action, <a href="#Page_156">156</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">abandoned, <a href="#Page_157">157</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">E</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Edwards, General (English), <a href="#Page_255">255</a>, <a href="#Page_262">262</a>, <a href="#Page_320">320</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Embarkation, January 17th, 1919, <a href="#Page_325">325</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Enemy, The:</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_332" id="Page_332">[332]</a></span></p><p class="pnii">vital point, <a href="#Page_4">4</a>;</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Enemy, The:</p>
-<p class="pnii">propaganda captured, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">scouts use poisoned arrows, <a href="#Page_90">90</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">advances north-west and south-west, <a href="#Page_140">140</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">take a rest, <a href="#Page_158">158</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Engare Len, <a href="#Page_78">78</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">England among our enemies, <a href="#Page_18">18</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">English Consul King, <a href="#Page_20">20</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">naval expedition, <a href="#Page_97">97</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">plans discovered, <a href="#Page_290">290</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">recruits make good, <a href="#Page_104">104</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">spies active, <a href="#Page_99">99</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Enslin, General, <a href="#Page_154">154</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Erdmann, Second Lieutenant, killed, <a href="#Page_63">63</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Erok Mountain ambush, <a href="#Page_64">64</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Europeans and natives interned, <a href="#Page_320">320</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">F</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Falkenstein, Captain, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Fate of German possessions, <a href="#Page_3">3</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Feilke, Captain, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>, <a href="#Page_51">51</a>, <a href="#Page_134">134</a>, <a href="#Page_174">174</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Field companies increased, <a href="#Page_71">71</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Fife, enemy depots captured, <a href="#Page_310">310</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">First action, Dar-es-Salaam, <a href="#Page_27">27</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">First journey of inspection, <a href="#Page_4">4</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">First Masai:</p>
-<p class="pnii">pure Hamites, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">original Jews, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">characteristics, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Fischer, Major, <a href="#Page_119">119</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Franken, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_97">97</a>, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">French missionary propaganda, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Freund, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_291">291</a>, <a href="#Page_296">296</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">G</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Galula, <a href="#Page_307">307</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Gararagua encounters, <a href="#Page_110">110</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Garrod, Major (English), captured, <a href="#Page_292">292</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Gerlich, Lieutenant, killed, <a href="#Page_63">63</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">German Fleet revolt, <a href="#Page_318">318</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">patrol rides into enemy camp, <a href="#Page_144">144</a>;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_333" id="Page_333">[333]</a></span></p><p class="pnii">possessions, fate of, <a href="#Page_3">3</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">German prisoners, British treatment of, <a href="#Page_221">221</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Reservists mobilized, <a href="#Page_22">22</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Revolution, <a href="#Page_318">318</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">settlers source of military power, <a href="#Page_7">7</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Goering, Captain, <a href="#Page_210">210</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">wounded, <a href="#Page_301">301</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Goetzen</i>, steamer:</p>
-<p class="pnii">building, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">completed, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">sunk, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Gold Coast Hill, enemy grenade attack, <a href="#Page_169">169</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Gore-Brown, Major (English), drowned, <a href="#Page_276">276</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Gothein, Lieutenant Dr., <a href="#Page_99">99</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Grabow, Master Butcher, <a href="#Page_40">40</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Grawert, Major von, surrenders, <a href="#Page_188">188</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Grote, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_75">75</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">died, <a href="#Page_121">121</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Gudovius, wounded and prisoner, <a href="#Page_185">185</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Guerilla warfare imperative, <a href="#Page_63">63</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">commenced, <a href="#Page_64">64</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Gwendoline</i>, steamer, <a href="#Page_99">99</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">H</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Hammerstein, Captain von, <a href="#Page_18">18</a> 31, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>, <a href="#Page_42">42</a>, <a href="#Page_44">44</a>, <a href="#Page_56">56</a>, <a href="#Page_58">58</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">died of wounds, <a href="#Page_63">63</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Handeni, collecting station, <a href="#Page_130">130</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Hasslacher, Lieutenant, killed, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Haun, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Haxthausen, Lieutenant von, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Hedwig von Wissmann</i>, steamer, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">captured, <a href="#Page_28">28</a>, <a href="#Page_100">100</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Henneberger, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Hering’s battery, <a href="#Page_43">43</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Hiffmeister, Veterinary Officer, <a href="#Page_12">12</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Himo, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Hindenburg’s name not heard of, <a href="#Page_48">48</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Horn, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_28">28</a>, <a href="#Page_94">94</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">builds cottages, <a href="#Page_130">130</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Hoskins, Major (English), <a href="#Page_200">200</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_334" id="Page_334">[334]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Huber, Dr., <a href="#Page_323">323</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Huebner, Lieutenant, surrenders, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Hulua Mountain, <a href="#Page_300">300</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Hüttich, Sergt.-Major, <a href="#Page_280">280</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Hyacinth</i>, The, off Tanga, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">I</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ili, <a href="#Page_266">266</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">return to, <a href="#Page_290">290</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">English plans discovered, <a href="#Page_290">290</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Imminence of universal war, <a href="#Page_3">3</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Inagu, von Schroetter’s escape, <a href="#Page_261">261</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Indian Brigade, <a href="#Page_42">42</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Expeditionary Force, <a href="#Page_25">25</a>, <a href="#Page_44">44</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Influenza epidemic, <a href="#Page_302">302</a>, <a href="#Page_324">324</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Insufficient interest of authorities, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Internment of Europeans and natives, <a href="#Page_320">320</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Iringa, <a href="#Page_15">15</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Irangi:</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy shell headquarters, <a href="#Page_138">138</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">food in abundance, <a href="#Page_139">139</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">series of actions, <a href="#Page_139">139</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy casualties heavy, <a href="#Page_139">139</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">general view of position, <a href="#Page_140">140</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">J</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Jantzen, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_207">207</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><a name="Jassini" id="Jassini">Jassini</a>. <i>See</i> <span class="smcap"><a href="#Yasin">Yasin</a></span>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Jericho, <a href="#Page_97">97</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Jews, first Masai the original, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Jipe, Lake, <a href="#Page_108">108</a>, <a href="#Page_125">125</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Johannes, Lieut.-Colonel, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">K</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kaempfe, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_87">87</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kahe, <a href="#Page_121">121</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">our retreat, <a href="#Page_123">123</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kaiser’s, The, abdication, <a href="#Page_318">318</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kajambi Catholic Mission, <a href="#Page_312">312</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kaltenborn, Captain von, <a href="#Page_130">130</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_335" id="Page_335">[335]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Kanene, <a href="#Page_250">250</a>, <a href="#Page_302">302</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kanga Mountain encounters, <a href="#Page_142">142</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Karongo, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kasama captured, <a href="#Page_313">313</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kasigao Mountain action, <a href="#Page_75">75</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kauffman, Second Lieutenant, killed, <a href="#Page_63">63</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kayense, <a href="#Page_47">47</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kempner, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_319">319</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kepler, Major, <a href="#Page_57">57</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">killed, <a href="#Page_63">63</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kibata:</p>
-<p class="pnii">occupied, <a href="#Page_167">167</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">guns brought up, <a href="#Page_167">167</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">congratulations of General Smuts, <a href="#Page_170">170</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kidodi heliograph station, <a href="#Page_18">18</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kifumbiro, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kigoma (Tanganyika), <a href="#Page_13">13</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">as naval base, <a href="#Page_95">95</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kilima Njaro:</p>
-<p class="pnii">supply depot, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">activities at, <a href="#Page_68">68</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">cotton shortage, <a href="#Page_69">69</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">making cloth, tyres, motor fuel and boots, <a href="#Page_70">70</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">bridge building, <a href="#Page_70">70</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kilimatinde, best buffaloes in East Africa, <a href="#Page_12">12</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kilossa, <a href="#Page_145">145</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kilwa:</p>
-<p class="pnii">demands attention, <a href="#Page_159">159</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Commissioner taken prisoner, <a href="#Page_159">159</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy dumps surprised, <a href="#Page_192">192</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">bombarding enemy transports, <a href="#Page_193">193</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy’s strong forces, <a href="#Page_200">200</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kimamba depot, <a href="#Page_133">133</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">King, English Consul, <a href="#Page_7">7</a>, <a href="#Page_20">20</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Kingani</i>, steamer, <a href="#Page_95">95</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">lost, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kirnamba, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kissaki:</p>
-<p class="pnii">stores destroyed, <a href="#Page_152">152</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy defeated, <a href="#Page_153">153</a>, <a href="#Page_155">155</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">prisoners taken, <a href="#Page_155">155</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kissangire Station, <a href="#Page_123">123</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">minor engagements, <a href="#Page_164">164</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kissenyi fighting, <a href="#Page_92">92</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_336" id="Page_336">[336]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Kissi Mountains, <a href="#Page_173">173</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kissija:</p>
-<p class="pnii">capture of enemy propaganda, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy driven out, <a href="#Page_164">164</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kitangari, <a href="#Page_223">223</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kitendu, enemy division surrounded, <a href="#Page_188">188</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kituta, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kivu, Lake, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>, <a href="#Page_126">126</a>, <a href="#Page_140">140</a>, <a href="#Page_185">185</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Klein, Sergt.-Major, killed, <a href="#Page_214">214</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Klinghardt, Captain, <a href="#Page_93">93</a>, <a href="#Page_126">126</a>, <a href="#Page_134">134</a>, <a href="#Page_142">142</a>, <a href="#Page_144">144</a>, <a href="#Page_145">145</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Koehl, Captain, <a href="#Page_68">68</a>, <a href="#Page_112">112</a>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>, <a href="#Page_204">204</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">transport surprised, <a href="#Page_256">256</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><a name="Kokosani" id="Kokosani">Kokosani</a> (Namacurra), <a href="#Page_272">272</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Portuguese heavy losses, <a href="#Page_273">273</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">search for ammunition, <a href="#Page_273">273</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">large supplies captured, <a href="#Page_276">276</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kondoa:</p>
-<p class="pnii">occupied, <a href="#Page_135">135</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">fight in the dark, <a href="#Page_137">137</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">English civil administration, <a href="#Page_137">137</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kondoa-Irangi:</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy shell Headquarters, <a href="#Page_138">138</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">food in abundance, <a href="#Page_139">139</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">series of actions, <a href="#Page_139">139</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy heavy losses, <a href="#Page_139">139</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">general view of position, <a href="#Page_140">140</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Konduchi, <a href="#Page_27">27</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Königsberg</i>, The, <a href="#Page_19">19</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">puts to sea, <a href="#Page_28">28</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">destroys English cruiser <i>Pegasus</i>, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">concealed in Rufiji delta, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">blown up, <a href="#Page_85">85</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">ten guns salved, <a href="#Page_85">85</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Adjutant recaptured, <a href="#Page_85">85</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Koriwa, Wunderlich wounded, <a href="#Page_251">251</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kornatzki, Captain von, <a href="#Page_33">33</a>, <a href="#Page_52">52</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Korogwe, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>, <a href="#Page_33">33</a>, <a href="#Page_36">36</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kraut, Major, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>, <a href="#Page_182">182</a>, <a href="#Page_184">184</a>, <a href="#Page_323">323</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kraut, Captain, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>, <a href="#Page_47">47</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kröber, Railway Commissary, <a href="#Page_36">36</a>, <a href="#Page_57">57</a>, <a href="#Page_79">79</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kroeger, Lieutenant, killed, <a href="#Page_214">214</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Krüger, Secretary, <a href="#Page_30">30</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kühlwein, Herr, <a href="#Page_162">162</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kungulio:</p>
-<p class="pnii">Enemy defeat, <a href="#Page_172">172</a>;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_337" id="Page_337">[337]</a></span></p><p class="pnii">hippo shooting, <a href="#Page_160">160</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kurungu, our envelopment fails, <a href="#Page_205">205</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Kwiri, field hospital left behind, <a href="#Page_259">259</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">L</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lake Amaramba, <a href="#Page_302">302</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; Bangweolo, <a href="#Page_311">311</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; Dsalla, <a href="#Page_110">110</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; Jipe, <a href="#Page_108">108</a>, <a href="#Page_125">125</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; Kivu, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>, <a href="#Page_126">126</a>, <a href="#Page_140">140</a>, <a href="#Page_185">185</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; Moero, <a href="#Page_322">322</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; Nyassa, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>, <a href="#Page_306">306</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; Rukwa, <a href="#Page_189">189</a>, <a href="#Page_306">306</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; Tanganyika, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>, <a href="#Page_52">52</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; Tshahafi, <a href="#Page_92">92</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; Utungi, <a href="#Page_174">174</a>, <a href="#Page_177">177</a>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>, <a href="#Page_188">188</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; Victoria, <a href="#Page_47">47</a>, <a href="#Page_88">88</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lang, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_92">92</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Langenburg:</p>
-<p class="pnii">fertility and native industries, <a href="#Page_15">15</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">ours for eighteen months, <a href="#Page_99">99</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Langenn, Major von, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>, <a href="#Page_185">185</a>, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">division loses heavily, <a href="#Page_187">187</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ledebur, Freiherr von, <a href="#Page_8">8</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lembeni country, <a href="#Page_124">124</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">aeroplanes brought down, <a href="#Page_140">140</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">“Lettow Schnapps,” 195.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Liebermann, Captain von, <a href="#Page_164">164</a>, <a href="#Page_200">200</a>, <a href="#Page_202">202</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ligonja, <a href="#Page_282">282</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lincke, Captain, <a href="#Page_136">136</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lindi, <a href="#Page_196">196</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lioma:</p>
-<p class="pnii">retirement after heavy fighting, <a href="#Page_296">296</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">transport detachment lost, <a href="#Page_299">299</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">severe enemy losses, <a href="#Page_299">299</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Logeloge discontent, <a href="#Page_163">163</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lolkisale Mountain:</p>
-<p class="pnii">28th Company surrender, <a href="#Page_126">126</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Captain Rothert wounded, <a href="#Page_126">126</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Longido Mountain:</p>
-<p class="pnii">English attack, <a href="#Page_67">67</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy reinforced, <a href="#Page_106">106</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Low level of musketry training, <a href="#Page_9">9</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_338" id="Page_338">[338]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Luambala, <a href="#Page_242">242</a>, <a href="#Page_303">303</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lugella:</p>
-<p class="pnii">depot captured, <a href="#Page_268">268</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">no ammunition found, <a href="#Page_270">270</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lukuledi, <a href="#Page_213">213</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">conference on aspects, <a href="#Page_216">216</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lupembe, enemy retire, <a href="#Page_187">187</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Luscheringe River, <a href="#Page_304">304</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lusinje, Captain Wienholt captured, <a href="#Page_248">248</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lutende:</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy surprised and routed, <a href="#Page_199">199</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">English commanding officer wounded, <a href="#Page_199">199</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Luwungi, <a href="#Page_92">92</a>, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Lyncker, Lieutenant von, <a href="#Page_106">106</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">M</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mafia Island, English take, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Magad Railway, <a href="#Page_65">65</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mahenge country, <a href="#Page_141">141</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mahiwa:</p>
-<p class="pnii">flank surprise, <a href="#Page_211">211</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">severe fighting, <a href="#Page_211">211</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy defeat absolute, <a href="#Page_211">211</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">guns and ammunition captured, <a href="#Page_213">213</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mahua, <a href="#Page_246">246</a>, <a href="#Page_250">250</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Makatan, English defeat, <a href="#Page_74">74</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Makima headquarters, <a href="#Page_165">165</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Makoti, enemy retire with heavy losses, <a href="#Page_254">254</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Malangali action, <a href="#Page_149">149</a>, <a href="#Page_182">182</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Wahehe chief rebels, <a href="#Page_182">182</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Malaria, native immunity against, <a href="#Page_24">24</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Malema:</p>
-<p class="pnii">fertility of, <a href="#Page_261">261</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy advance, <a href="#Page_262">262</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">difficulties of bush tactics, <a href="#Page_262">262</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Boma captured, <a href="#Page_260">260</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Malleson, General (English), <a href="#Page_74">74</a>, <a href="#Page_106">106</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mara Bay, <a href="#Page_90">90</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Marangu, <a href="#Page_105">105</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Masai, first, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Massako, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Matendu floods, <a href="#Page_197">197</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Matuschka, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_80">80</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mawa action, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_339" id="Page_339">[339]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Maximum strength, <a href="#Page_72">72</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mayita, <a href="#Page_90">90</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mbinji fruit, <a href="#Page_241">241</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mbizi depot, <a href="#Page_307">307</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mbosi Mission, <a href="#Page_15">15</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">reports of English intentions, June, 1914, <a href="#Page_15">15</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">country, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mbuyuni, <a href="#Page_73">73</a>, <a href="#Page_79">79</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mechanical transport, <a href="#Page_50">50</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Meda, <a href="#Page_245">245</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Medical supplies, <a href="#Page_195">195</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Meinhertshagen, Captain (English), <a href="#Page_44">44</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Meixner, Dr., <a href="#Page_259">259</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Merensky, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_36">36</a>, <a href="#Page_38">38</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Merker, M., and the Masai, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Michels, District Commissioner, <a href="#Page_146">146</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mihambia, bombs dropped, <a href="#Page_203">203</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mirow, Sergt.-Major, killed, <a href="#Page_168">168</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mkulu Mountain, <a href="#Page_239">239</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mlali, enemy advance, <a href="#Page_150">150</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mletere, <a href="#Page_299">299</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mobilization, August, 1914-18, not extended to overseas, <a href="#Page_18">18</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Reservists, <a href="#Page_22">22</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Moero, Lake, <a href="#Page_312">312</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Moewe</i>, steamer, <a href="#Page_19">19</a>, <a href="#Page_28">28</a>, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>, <a href="#Page_94">94</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mori Bay, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Morogoro as base, <a href="#Page_142">142</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">headquarters, <a href="#Page_146">146</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy converge on, <a href="#Page_149">149</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Moshi, <a href="#Page_52">52</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mosquito, The, <a href="#Page_25">25</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Moving forces to Northern Railway, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mpapua action, <a href="#Page_145">145</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mpili, <a href="#Page_224">224</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mpoororo, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mpotora base, <a href="#Page_181">181</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Msalu river, <a href="#Page_247">247</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mtende, <a href="#Page_246">246</a>, <a href="#Page_248">248</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Muanza</i>, steamer, <a href="#Page_47">47</a>, <a href="#Page_87">87</a>, <a href="#Page_88">88</a>, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mujeba, <a href="#Page_270">270</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mujebain, <a href="#Page_280">280</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Müller, Staff Surgeon, <a href="#Page_46">46</a>, <a href="#Page_196">196</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Musketry training low level, <a href="#Page_9">9</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Musslin, Major-General, <a href="#Page_248">248</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Musoma, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mwasge Mission, <a href="#Page_96">96</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_340" id="Page_340">[340]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Mwembe, <a href="#Page_191">191</a>, <a href="#Page_242">242</a>, <a href="#Page_304">304</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mwenzo Mission, <a href="#Page_311">311</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mwurnoni, <a href="#Page_56">56</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">My early experiences, <a href="#Page_16">16</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Mzima Camp, <a href="#Page_69">69</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">N</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Nagawamira, <a href="#Page_304">304</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Namacurra. <i>See</i> <span class="smcap"><a href="#Kokosani">Kokosani</a></span>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Nambindinga, <a href="#Page_220">220</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">reducing the strength, <a href="#Page_220">220</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Namirrue:</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy routed, <a href="#Page_283">283</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Colonel Dickinson captured, <a href="#Page_284">284</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Lieut. Ruckteschell wounded, <a href="#Page_286">286</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Lieutenant Silke killed, <a href="#Page_286">286</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy annihilated, <a href="#Page_286">286</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Nampepo, roast pork and brawn, <a href="#Page_267">267</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Namunu, <a href="#Page_245">245</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Nangwale, <a href="#Page_238">238</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Nanungu concentration, <a href="#Page_242">242</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Narungombe:</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy flee in disorder, <a href="#Page_202">202</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Liebermann’s great success, <a href="#Page_202">202</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Narunyu, enemy attack, <a href="#Page_205">205</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Native carrier difficulty, <a href="#Page_24">24</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">interchange of communications, <a href="#Page_13">13</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">method of warfare, <a href="#Page_9">9</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">immunity against malaria, <a href="#Page_24">24</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">industries, <a href="#Page_15">15</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Naumann, Captain, <a href="#Page_189">189</a>, <a href="#Page_221">221</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Naval guns salved from the Königsberg, <a href="#Page_85">85</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ndanda Catholic Mission, <a href="#Page_206">206</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Nevale, <a href="#Page_224">224</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">New Moshi, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>, <a href="#Page_33">33</a>, <a href="#Page_36">36</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">headquarters, <a href="#Page_49">49</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">pleasant times at, <a href="#Page_59">59</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">aeroplane drops bombs, <a href="#Page_113">113</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">abandoned, <a href="#Page_119">119</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">New Steglitz headquarters, <a href="#Page_116">116</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">New supply detachment raised, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">News:</p>
-<p class="pnii">from home, <a href="#Page_67">67</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">of German Fleet revolt, <a href="#Page_318">318</a>;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_341" id="Page_341">[341]</a></span></p><p class="pnii">German Revolution, Kaiser’s abdication, <a href="#Page_318">318</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ngaula, enemy routed, <a href="#Page_193">193</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ngomano action, <a href="#Page_230">230</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Niemeyer, Commander, <a href="#Page_7">7</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Njango Camp, <a href="#Page_204">204</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">telegram from His Majesty, <a href="#Page_204">204</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Nordenholz, Sergt.-Major, <a href="#Page_291">291</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Northey, General, <a href="#Page_140">140</a>, <a href="#Page_149">149</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">North Pare Mountains, <a href="#Page_125">125</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Numarroe, <a href="#Page_291">291</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Nyanza hostile enterprises, <a href="#Page_47">47</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Nyassa, Lake, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">O</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Old Askari, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Old 1871 rifle, <a href="#Page_8">8</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Oldorobo Mountain, <a href="#Page_80">80</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy retreat in disorder, <a href="#Page_104">104</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">English recruiting bait, <a href="#Page_104">104</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">English orders, “Take no prisoners,” 104.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Old Utengule Mission, <a href="#Page_307">307</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Oriva occupied, <a href="#Page_280">280</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ott, Lieutenant, wounded, <a href="#Page_292">292</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Otto, Captain, <a href="#Page_58">58</a>, <a href="#Page_145">145</a>, <a href="#Page_172">172</a>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Our movements from North-West to Central, <a href="#Page_127">127</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Our departure from North final, <a href="#Page_129">129</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">P</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Pangire Mission, <a href="#Page_305">305</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Pare Mountains, <a href="#Page_125">125</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Pegasus</i>, English cruiser, <a href="#Page_27">27</a>, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Pekera captured, <a href="#Page_287">287</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Peramiho Mission, <a href="#Page_305">305</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Poisoned arrows used by enemy, <a href="#Page_90">90</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Police Askari, <a href="#Page_6">6</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Poppe, Captain, wounded, <a href="#Page_295">295</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Pori (bush) difficulties, <a href="#Page_12">12</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">not easy to disappear in, <a href="#Page_13">13</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Portuguese:</p>
-<p class="pnii">invade Makonde, <a href="#Page_165">165</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">driven into their territory, <a href="#Page_166">166</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">territory entered, <a href="#Page_190">190</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>President</i>, steamer, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>, <a href="#Page_198">198</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Prince, Captain von, <a href="#Page_4">4</a>, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>, <a href="#Page_41">41</a>, <a href="#Page_45">45</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Protective Force, <a href="#Page_6">6</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">strength of, <a href="#Page_19">19</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_342" id="Page_342">[342]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Pugu, concentration of troops, <a href="#Page_21">21</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">Q</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Quelimane, <a href="#Page_265">265</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Quinine production, <a href="#Page_71">71</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">R</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ras-Kasone, <a href="#Page_36">36</a>, <a href="#Page_39">39</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Rations cut down, <a href="#Page_176">176</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Reata-Kahe:</p>
-<p class="pnii">our withdrawal by night, <a href="#Page_114">114</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">evacuated, <a href="#Page_116">116</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy occupy, <a href="#Page_116">116</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Reata-Latima Mountain repulse, <a href="#Page_114">114</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Reata-North defences, <a href="#Page_111">111</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Recke, Lieutenant, killed, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Regone, <a href="#Page_293">293</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Rentell, Engineer, <a href="#Page_71">71</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Reservists mobilized, <a href="#Page_22">22</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Revolt of German Fleet, <a href="#Page_318">318</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Revolution in Germany, <a href="#Page_318">318</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Rifle, old 1871, <a href="#Page_8">8</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Rothe, Director of Postal Service, <a href="#Page_30">30</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Rothert, Captain, <a href="#Page_119">119</a>, <a href="#Page_125">125</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Rotterdam welcome, <a href="#Page_325">325</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ruckteschell, Lieutenant von, <a href="#Page_75">75</a>, <a href="#Page_147">147</a>, <a href="#Page_286">286</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Rufiji, Delta, <a href="#Page_84">84</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">loss of the Königsberg, <a href="#Page_85">85</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy advance on, <a href="#Page_160">160</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">evacuated at rainy season, <a href="#Page_180">180</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Rugesi Passage, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ruhudje, fighting on the, <a href="#Page_184">184</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Rukwa, Lake, <a href="#Page_306">306</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ruponda, we lose supplies, <a href="#Page_208">208</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Russissi minor actions, <a href="#Page_93">93</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Rwiba Mount, <a href="#Page_308">308</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">S</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Saidi, <a href="#Page_251">251</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Salt supplies, <a href="#Page_194">194</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Schaefer, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_57">57</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Schaefner, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_259">259</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Schimmer, Captain, <a href="#Page_93">93</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_343" id="Page_343">[343]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Schleuntz, Colonel von, <a href="#Page_8">8</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Schnee, Dr., <a href="#Page_27">27</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Schmid, Captain, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Schoenfeld, Lieut.-Commander, <a href="#Page_7">7</a>, <a href="#Page_85">85</a>, <a href="#Page_144">144</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Schottstaedt, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_45">45</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Schroetter, Lieutenant von, <a href="#Page_51">51</a>, <a href="#Page_260">260</a>, <a href="#Page_296">296</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Schulz, Captain, <a href="#Page_33">33</a>, <a href="#Page_94">94</a>, <a href="#Page_98">98</a>, <a href="#Page_130">130</a>, <a href="#Page_146">146</a>, <a href="#Page_163">163</a>, <a href="#Page_167">167</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Second store-ship arrives, <a href="#Page_117">117</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Selke, Lieutenant, killed, <a href="#Page_286">286</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Selous killed, <a href="#Page_171">171</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">“Shensi” spies, <a href="#Page_108">108</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Shirarti, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Singida stud farms, <a href="#Page_11">11</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Sisal plant, <a href="#Page_56">56</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Smith-Dorrien, General, <a href="#Page_104">104</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Smuts, General:</p>
-<p class="pnii">takes over command from Smith-Dorrien, <a href="#Page_104">104</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">at Kitovo, <a href="#Page_110">110</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">at Handeni, <a href="#Page_142">142</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">calls for surrender at Uluguru Mountains, <a href="#Page_158">158</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">congratulates Von Lettow on decoration, <a href="#Page_170">170</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">operations wrecked on Rufiji, <a href="#Page_172">172</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">relieved by General Hoskins, <a href="#Page_200">200</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">South Pare Mountains, <a href="#Page_76">76</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Spalding, Lieutenant, killed, <a href="#Page_63">63</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Spangenberg, Captain, <a href="#Page_323">323</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">died, <a href="#Page_324">324</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Sphinx Harbour, <a href="#Page_100">100</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ssongea, enemy at, <a href="#Page_304">304</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ssonyo treachery, <a href="#Page_87">87</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Stemmermann, Captain, <a href="#Page_113">113</a>, <a href="#Page_146">146</a>, <a href="#Page_153">153</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Sternheim, Lieutenant, <a href="#Page_114">114</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Stewart, General (English), <a href="#Page_110">110</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Stolowsky, Staff Surgeon, <a href="#Page_195">195</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Store-ships arrive, <a href="#Page_67">67</a>, <a href="#Page_117">117</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Strength of Protective Force, <a href="#Page_19">19</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Struwe, Sergt.-Major, <a href="#Page_192">192</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Stud farms at Singida, <a href="#Page_11">11</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Stuemer, Major von, <a href="#Page_87">87</a>, <a href="#Page_130">130</a>, <a href="#Page_134">134</a>, <a href="#Page_190">190</a>, <a href="#Page_207">207</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Supplies devoured at depots, <a href="#Page_174">174</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Supply system, <a href="#Page_23">23</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_344" id="Page_344">[344]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Supreme military power, <a href="#Page_21">21</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Surgery under difficulties, <a href="#Page_196">196</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Surrender:</p>
-<p class="pnii">Smuts calls for, <a href="#Page_158">158</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Deventer calls for, <a href="#Page_235">235</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Swahili, <a href="#Page_15">15</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Sybil</i>, steamer (English), <a href="#Page_88">88</a>, <a href="#Page_90">90</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">T</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Tabora</i>, hospital ship, <a href="#Page_51">51</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tabora retirement, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tafel, Captain, <a href="#Page_22">22</a>, <a href="#Page_28">28</a>, <a href="#Page_33">33</a>, <a href="#Page_132">132</a>, <a href="#Page_178">178</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tafeli surrender, <a href="#Page_236">236</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">“Take no prisoners,” English order, <a href="#Page_104">104</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tanga:</p>
-<p class="pnii">hostile cruisers off, <a href="#Page_35">35</a>.</p>
-<p class="pnii">plans for defence, <a href="#Page_36">36</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy attack, <a href="#Page_41">41</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">British North Lancashire Regiment defeat, <a href="#Page_42">42</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy mowed down, <a href="#Page_42">42</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">transfer of wounded, <a href="#Page_44">44</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tanganyika, Lake, command of, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>.</p>
-<p class="pnii">”&nbsp; &nbsp; &nbsp; Railway, <a href="#Page_52">52</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Taveta, <a href="#Page_29">29</a>, <a href="#Page_33">33</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Termites, <a href="#Page_30">30</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Thierfelder, Dr., <a href="#Page_195">195</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Thurmann, Sergt.-Major, killed, <a href="#Page_296">296</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Timbani Mountain, <a href="#Page_256">256</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Koehl’s transport surprised, <a href="#Page_256">256</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tipa, Boma, <a href="#Page_282">282</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tombeur, Belgian commander at Kivu, <a href="#Page_92">92</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tombwe post captured, <a href="#Page_95">95</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Tomondo</i>, steamer, <a href="#Page_159">159</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Treachery of Ssonyo, <a href="#Page_87">87</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Trench mortar captured, <a href="#Page_286">286</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tse-tse fly, <a href="#Page_11">11</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">plague, <a href="#Page_26">26</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tshahafi, Lake, <a href="#Page_92">92</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tuliani headquarters bombed, <a href="#Page_143">143</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tunduru district, <a href="#Page_192">192</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Tunga:</p>
-<p class="pnii">enormous booty, <a href="#Page_45">45</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">our losses insignificant, <a href="#Page_45">45</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">U</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_345" id="Page_345">[345]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Ubena, <a href="#Page_306">306</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Uganda Railway, containing the enemy on, <a href="#Page_4">4</a>, <a href="#Page_77">77</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Ukerewe, <a href="#Page_89">89</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Unconditional “surrender” or “evacuation,” 319.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Unindi, enemy repulsed, <a href="#Page_200">200</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Universal war imminent, <a href="#Page_3">3</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Unprepared for war, <a href="#Page_10">10</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Unterrichter, Lieutenant von, <a href="#Page_68">68</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Usambara country, <a href="#Page_4">4</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">volunteer rifle corps, <a href="#Page_4">4</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Utengule (Old) Mission, <a href="#Page_307">307</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Utungi, Lake, <a href="#Page_172">172</a>, <a href="#Page_174">174</a>, <a href="#Page_177">177</a>, <a href="#Page_179">179</a>, <a href="#Page_188">188</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">V</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Victoria, Lake, <a href="#Page_47">47</a>, <a href="#Page_88">88</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">in English hands, <a href="#Page_87">87</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Volunteer Rifle Corps at Usambara, <a href="#Page_4">4</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Vorbeck, General von Lettow-:</p>
-<p class="pnii">landing at Dar-es-Salaam, <a href="#Page_3">3</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">tour of inspection, <a href="#Page_4">4</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">buffalo hunting, <a href="#Page_13">13</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">water on the knee, <a href="#Page_13">13</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">a raw hand, <a href="#Page_16">16</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">early experiences, <a href="#Page_16">16</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">had malaria ten times, <a href="#Page_25">25</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">slightly wounded, <a href="#Page_138">138</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">congratulated by Smuts, <a href="#Page_170">170</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">experiments in bread-making, <a href="#Page_193">193</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">wireless from Kaiser, <a href="#Page_204">204</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Deventer calls for surrender, <a href="#Page_235">235</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">hippo shooting, <a href="#Page_240">240</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">receives news of German offensive, Western Front, <a href="#Page_248">248</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">operation on toe, <a href="#Page_249">249</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">injury to eye, <a href="#Page_249">249</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">Deventer’s telegram of Armistice, <a href="#Page_315">315</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">and conditions of surrender, <a href="#Page_317">317</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">sends telegram to Kaiser, <a href="#Page_317">317</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">no reply from German Government, <a href="#Page_319">319</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">declines Colonel Hawkins’ invitation, <a href="#Page_319">319</a>;</p>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_346" id="Page_346">[346]</a></span></p>
-<p class="pnii">Deventer’s reply to protest, <a href="#Page_321">321</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">at Kigoma, <a href="#Page_322">322</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">at Tabora and at Morogoro, <a href="#Page_323">323</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">at Dar-es-Salaam, December 8th, 1918. Embarked January 17th, 1919, <a href="#Page_325">325</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">reached Rotterdam, <a href="#Page_325">325</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">W</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Waganda Warriors, <a href="#Page_47">47</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Wahehe tribe, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Wahle, Major-General, <a href="#Page_23">23</a>, <a href="#Page_31">31</a>, <a href="#Page_51">51</a>, <a href="#Page_97">97</a>, <a href="#Page_140">140</a>, <a href="#Page_184">184</a> <i>et seq.</i>, <a href="#Page_323">323</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Waimi</i>, steamer, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">blown up, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Wajagga tribe, <a href="#Page_24">24</a>, <a href="#Page_32">32</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Wamaka, <a href="#Page_288">288</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Wangoni desertions, <a href="#Page_305">305</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Wassukuma people, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Water-finding, <a href="#Page_80">80</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Welcome at Rotterdam, <a href="#Page_325">325</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">White Fathers, <a href="#Page_14">14</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Wienholt, Lieutenant, capture and escape, <a href="#Page_143">143</a>.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_347" id="Page_347">[347]</a></span></p><p class="pni">Wienholt, Captain, captured, <a href="#Page_248">248</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Wilhelmstal native police, <a href="#Page_6">6</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Wintgens, Captain, <a href="#Page_91">91</a>, <a href="#Page_185">185</a>, <a href="#Page_186">186</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">division captures gun, <a href="#Page_187">187</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">taken prisoner, <a href="#Page_189">189</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Winzer, Sergt.-Major, gets through, <a href="#Page_188">188</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Wülfingen, Captain Bock von, <a href="#Page_87">87</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Wunderlich, Lieut.-Commander, wounded, <a href="#Page_251">251</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">Y</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><a name="Yasin" id="Yasin">Yasin</a>. <i>See</i> <span class="smcap"><a href="#Jassini">Jassini</a></span>:</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy advance, <a href="#Page_30">30</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">country, <a href="#Page_34">34</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">English concentration, <a href="#Page_56">56</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">our attack, <a href="#Page_58">58</a>;</p>
-<p class="pnii">enemy surrender, <a href="#Page_61">61</a>.</p>
-
-
-<p class="pi6 p2 mid">Z</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Zambesi Ferry, <a href="#Page_314">314</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Zelewski’s expedition, <a href="#Page_15">15</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni"><i>Ziethen</i>, steamer, <a href="#Page_86">86</a>.</p>
-
-<p class="pni">Zimmer, Captain, <a href="#Page_28">28</a>, <a href="#Page_82">82</a>, <a href="#Page_93">93</a>, <a href="#Page_94">94</a>.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_348" id="Page_348">[348]</a></span></p>
-
-<p class="pc4 reduct"><i>Printed at The Chapel River Press, Kingston, Surrey.</i></p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-</div>
-
-<div class="chapter">
-
-<h2 class="p4">FOOTNOTES:</h2>
-
-<div class="footnotes">
-
-<p class="pfn4"><span class="ln1"><a name="Footnote_1_1" id="Footnote_1_1"></a><a href="#FNanchor_1_1"><span class="label">[1]</span></a></span>
-M. Merker, “Die Masai,” Berlin, 1904 (2nd Edition, 1910).</p>
-
-<p class="pfn4"><span class="ln1"><a name="Footnote_2_2" id="Footnote_2_2"></a><a href="#FNanchor_2_2"><span class="label">[2]</span></a></span>
-Askari are “soldiers,” not a distinct tribe.</p>
-
-<p class="pfn4"><span class="ln1"><a name="Footnote_3_3" id="Footnote_3_3"></a><a href="#FNanchor_3_3"><span class="label">[3]</span></a></span>
-Seitenschlag.</p>
-
-<p class="pfn4"><span class="ln1"><a name="Footnote_4_4" id="Footnote_4_4"></a><a href="#FNanchor_4_4"><span class="label">[4]</span></a></span>
-We have no corresponding rank. He is a reservist who has served as a
-“One-year Volunteer,” but has not yet done enough reserve training to
-qualify as an Officer in the Reserve.</p>
-
-<p class="pfn4"><span class="ln1"><a name="Footnote_5_5" id="Footnote_5_5"></a><a href="#FNanchor_5_5"><span class="label">[5]</span></a></span>
-The English Government issued to us articles of food for the English
-prisoners which we could not get for ourselves.</p></div></div>
-
-
-</div>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-<pre>
-
-
-
-
-
-End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of My Reminiscences of East Africa, by
-General von Lettow-Vorbeck
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK MY REMINISCENCES OF EAST AFRICA ***
-
-***** This file should be named 51746-h.htm or 51746-h.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/1/7/4/51746/
-
-Produced by Giovanni Fini, Brian Coe and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive/Canadian Libraries)
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org
-
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
-</body>
-</html>
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/cover.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/cover.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 5673a07..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/cover.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/fr.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/fr.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 231913d..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/fr.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-005.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-005.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 87d9611..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-005.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-032.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-032.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 99e543c..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-032.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-033.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-033.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 4557843..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-033.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-037.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-037.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 48f4771..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-037.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-083.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-083.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 616334f..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-083.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-096.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-096.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 359358d..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-096.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-097.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-097.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 7ea0026..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-097.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-105.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-105.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 94e6269..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-105.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-128.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-128.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 7b52c7f..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-128.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-129.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-129.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index cc81c71..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-129.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-131.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-131.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index ecceaad..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-131.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-160.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-160.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 1953b21..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-160.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-161.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-161.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 9360f1b..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-161.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-161a.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-161a.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 66b32e9..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-161a.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-183.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-183.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index fcb1037..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-183.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-191.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-191.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 06d04b0..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-191.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-192.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-192.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index d45ac91..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-192.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-193.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-193.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 63a8505..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-193.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-224.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-224.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index cd1ac47..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-224.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-225.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-225.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 594019a..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-225.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-256.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-256.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index e32a65b..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-256.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-257a.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-257a.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 055943c..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-257a.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-257b.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-257b.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index fe3bc29..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-257b.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-285.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-285.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 302754d..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-285.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-297.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-297.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 8a1ea99..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-297.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/51746-h/images/ill-311.jpg b/old/51746-h/images/ill-311.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index ef52823..0000000
--- a/old/51746-h/images/ill-311.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ